You are on page 1of 206

.L.J,, . ueva.

Juan lu1s Delgado, lbrahim Akubat, Pieter Jacobs,


Pim Koolwijk, l icvcn De Vcirman, Anâré Aubert, Peter Catteeuw, Guido Seerden,
stcvcn Probst, Malhicu Gram, Rcnaldo Landburg, Glen Reed, Sally Hara, Bart De Roover,
Balder Bcrckman.,, f.'>ter l owetle, Arne Jaspers, John Fitzpatrick, Kyle Woodruff
Faculdade de Despow
Universidade cio Por+c
Serviços de
PGQUITlênracão

FITNESS IN SOCCER
THE SCIENCE AND PRACTICAL APl'llCATION

[IPORTO

l 1 li~lil1li1\i i~Íl lllll lllll llll llll


:9:~:32227ü.;9;

DE PO!~TO
SERVIÇOS DE
DOCUMENTACAO
Nº .Q . .z..z;Z,.,~.Q.
D!-\TA %./Q2?.1fbllí

Jan Van Winckel, Werner Helsen, Kenny McMillan,


David Tenney, Jean-Pierre Meert, Paul Bradley

FACULDADF OE DESPORTO
DA UNIVERSIDADE DO PORTO
FOREWORD

"Trairzing is an exact science


and relies on reason.
Coaching is an art
and comes fro111 the heart.
A good coach should be
a reasonable artist."

Prof Mart Buekers

While writing and revising this book, I often thought of the almost poetic words
above. As a soccer coach, you often tread a thin line between what has been proven
scientifically and what is consi<lered "best practice." Unfortunately, science in soc-
cer is still in its infancy, and there are still many question marks in this regard.
Soccer is a very complex sport in which different physica1 abi1ities are used in tan-
dem, often competing for adaptation. Because not everything in the field of soccer
science has been "mapped out'' yet, we often have to rely on our experience and
intuition.
I hope this book can help in some small way to make you a better "reasonable
artist."
During the discussions on how we would promete the book, the publisher asked
me for some quotes from coaches I have worked with. Although you will find
some, I felt I would rather not do this. I prefer to sincerely thank all the coaches,
board members, physicians, physiotherapists and other staff I have worked with
for the knowledge they have given me and for their marvelous cooperation. I have,
it seems, purloined a little piece of kno\.vledge from each of them.
I would also like to thank the coauthors of this book-Kenny, Dave, Jean-Pierre
and Pau1-who have spent considerable time writing and reviewing this book. It is
thanks to their knowledge and effort that this book has been a success in Belgium
and Holland, success that will hopefully be repeated in the rest of the world.
Special thanks to Wemer Helsen, who has been my friend and mentor for over
lsbn-number: 9789082132304
20 years.
Publisher: Moveo Ergo Sum I K!ein-Gelmen Finally I would like to thank my wife, Ester, for supporting me in everything I have
Proofreading: Jim Newall Quill Content IWriting, Editing and Web site services http://YNN1.quillsites.co.uk done. My thanks also goto my parents, Anita and Hugo. They gave me the chance
Photos: Jean Leemans and Etienne C!aessens to study over the years, sacrificing many things in their own lives for my brothers
Cover and lay-out: Dots & Bits (Bart, Tom and )elle) and me.

© 2014 Jan Van Winckel For ]osephine and Bente,

jan
Printed and bound ai Manipal Techno!ogies lld., lndia

AI/ rights reserved. No part of this book may be reproduced or transmítted in any fonn or by any means whatsoeverwíthout
express written pennission from lhe au!/Jor, except in the case of brief quotations embodied in criticai articles and reviews.
Pie ase refer ali pertinent questions to the publisher.
USJ OF AUJllORS Guido See1·den has a master's degree in Human and Movement Science (specialized in
Sport & Exercise) and has also had a research internship at Liverpool John Moores Uni-
versity. He cooperated \.vith LJMU's Science and Football department during his final
project about talent development in soccer. He has completed further intemships, such
as at Tranmere Rovers FC, where he 1vorked as a fitness coach and sports scientist. He
is currently working in Saudi Arabia as the Head Coach of the U9's and UlO's at the
Steven Probst, MSc, has a master's degree in sports physiotherapy and rehabilitation Al-Ahli Saudi football club.
sciences from the Katholieke Universiteit Leuven. Since 2009, he has worked for Top-
SportsLab as a research and development manager. Aside from this, he is involved as a Steven Va111tarett is a certified strength and conditioning coach, a physical soccer coach,
sport physio and rehab coach in the youth academy of Oud-Heverlee Leuven, a Belgian and a soccer-periodization expert. He has worked with U17 and U21 teams in the Bel-
first-division club. gian premier league. He worked at K. Sint-truidense VV as head coach and physical
coach (2010-2012). After this, he became assistant coach/ strength and conditioning
Píttt Koolwijk, MSc, has a master's degree in human movement science from the VU coach of the first team at Ujpest FC in the Hungarian premier league (2012-2013). He
University Amsterdam and a bachelor's degree from the Sport Academy in The Hague. currently works as field training specialist and physical coach at the Al-Ahli Saudi foot-
Since 2007, he has \Vorked as an exercise physiologist/physical trainer at FC Utrecht, ball club in Saudi Arabia (2013-).
which performs in the highest Dutch division. ln the past, he has worked as a human
movement scientist at several sporting organizations. He still works as an indepen- Mathieu Gra111, MSc, holds tvvo mas ter' s degrees: one in Physiotherapy & Rehabilitation
dent sports consultant for several sporting organizations and individual athletes in Science and one in Physical Education & Kinesiology. He has been active as a Sports
the Netherlands. He has severa} specializations, including Strength and Conditioning Physiotherapist and Rehabilitation specialist at the Al-Ahli Saudi football club. Prior to
Coach NSCA, Tennis and Skiing. this, he worked as a Sports Physiotherapist at the West Coast Eagles AFL club in Perth,
Westem Australia.
Alberto Me11dez-Villanueva, PhD, is a Senior Football Fitness Coach and Sports Scien-
tist at the ASPIRE Academy and Qatar Football Association in Doha, Qatar. Before this, Carlo Buzziclielli, is an invited professor of "The Theory and Methodology of Training"
Mendez-Villanueva was the head of the Football Physiology Unit at the ASPIRE Aca- at the Sport University of Camaguey and the Center of Football Studies at Camaguey,
demy. He holds a doctoral degree in sport physiology from the University of Oviedo Cuba. He is technical director of the Tudor Bompa Institute, International. ln 2012, he
in Spain anda master's degree in exercise physiology from the University of Westem was invited as a guest speaker to the "International Workshop on Strength & Conditio-
Australia. He has published over 60 peer-reviewed scientific articles. He has also presen- ning" (Trivandrum, India) and to the University ofSao Paulo and the Olympic Center of
ted nearly 50 lectures on team strength and conditioning and physiology-related issues. Sao Paulo (Brasil). As an S&C coach for tearn sports, Carlo's tearns have achieved eight
promotions, as well as a first and a second place in their respective league Cups. As a
Kyle Woodruff, BSc, has a bachelor's degree in Kinesiology frorn the University of Con- coach of individual sports, Cario has contributed to the World Track & Field Champi-
necticut. He has worked as a physical coach for the Al-Ahli Saudi football club and also onship and the Cornmonwealth Games. His athletes have won sixteen medals in the
as an assistant for the men's and women's soccer and basketball teams at UConn. national championships of four different sports (track & field, S\Vimrning, Brazilian jiu-
jitsu, and powerlifting), as well as tvvo international gold rnedals (track & field), one
Lieven De Vein11a11, FAFS, has a certificate in Applied Functional Science from the Gray silver and one bronze (Brazilian jiu-jitsu), setting five national records (in powerlifting).
Institute in Adrian, Michigan. He has worked mainly as a personal trainer for lower
levei athletes and is currently a strength and injury-prevention coach at the youth aca- Juan Luis Delgado joined the ASPIRE Academy in 2007. He has held diverse positions as
demy of the Al-Ahli Saudi football club. a soccer coach and worked with different groups from U13 to U17, developing players
for Qatar' s national junior tearns. ln 2013, he was appointed as coordinator of the ne\vly
André E A11be1·t, PhD, has a doctorate in physics frorn the Katholieke Universiteit Leu- created Scouting Department. Part of this ne'"v responsibility included the complete
ven, Belgium, where heis currently emeritus professor at the Faculty of Medicine. His structuring and strategic setup of the department. Prior to this (1999-2006), Juan began
rnain research domains are cardiovascular sport physiology and the cardiovascular con- his coaching career at Villarreal CF in Spain, working in several positions including both
dition of astronauts, both on Earth and during the weightless conditions of space. academy and first-tearn level. He then moved to Valencia CF where he worked as aca-
demy training methodology coordinator. He graduated from Valencia University with
Peter Catteeuw, PhD, \vas awarded his doctorate in sports sciences in 2010 from the a bachelor' s degree in Sport Sciences and a minor in soccer. He also holds a master' s
University of Leuven. He has worked as a research and development rnanager for Top- degree in Sports Psychology from UAM, Madrid. He is currently undertaking his docto-
SportsLab in the field of performance management. As physical coach, he \Vas active in ral thesis on "Football Tactical age-related differences." ln line with his soccer education,
the youth tearns of K Lierse SI( (2004-2007) and RSCAnderlecht (2007-2009). Since 2011, heis a UEFA Pro accredited coach and has enjoyed coaching development opportunities
he has \vorked as physical coach for the first team of KRC Genk. in the Netherlands and the US.
Ibraltint Akubat, PhD, has a doctorate in exercise physiology, focused on training load Ester Lowette, MSc, has a master's degree in Sports Psychology from The University of
monitoring in soccer, from the University of Hull, UK. He has examined a whole portfo- Leuven. She has played professional volleyball for over 20 years, winning the European
lio of dose-response relationships with physical, perceptual and biochemical measures Top Team Cup with Asterix Kieldrecht. Ester played severa} years for the Yellow Tigers
in rested and fatigued states, all of which will be published in due course. He is now a (the national team) and has won the Belgian Championship with three different teams.
lecturer in exercise physiology at Newman University, Birmingham anda consultant to
numerous teams and athletes. He is also the founder of Training Impulse, a company Ante Jaspers, MSc, has master's degrees in Physical Education and Kinesiology and in
providing information, workshops, training and software for matters related to training Rehabilitation Sciences and Physiotherapy from the University of Leuven. He is cur-
load monitoring. rently conducting his doctorate about the use of athlete-tracking data in soccer for per-
formance optimization and injury prevention. This project is a cooperation between AZ
Renaldo Charles Landburg is a former athlete from the Netherlands. After finishing his Alkmaar, the University of Leuven, and TopSportsLab. Before that, he worked as a per-
study at the Central Institute of Sport Instructors (CIOS) he has completed courses to formance analystwith the KBVB, UEFA and FIFA in supporting the physical preparation
specialize in running technique, coordination and fitness in soccer. Following his work of elite soccer referees.
at many amateur clubs in the Netherlands, Louis van Gaal and Danny Blind approached
Renaldo in 2004 to come and \.Vork for the youth academy of AFC Ajax, Amsterdam. John Fitzpatrick, MSc, is an aspiring sports scientist and researcher with a master's
After this \.VOrk atone of Europe's best youth academies, he decided in 2010 to move to degree in strength and conditioning from Teesside University. He is currently a sports
Saudi Arabia, where he continues to work for the Al-Ahli Saudi football club as physical science intem at Newcastle United Football Club. His research focuses on the monito-
coordinator of the youth teams. ring of recovery and fatigue in soccer players.

Glen Reed, MSc, ASCC, has a mastens degree in strength and conditioning (S&C) from Pieter Jacobs, MSc, holds a master's degree in sports sciences anda bachelor's degree
Middlesex University, London. He currently works in youth soccer, serving as the S&C in rehabilitation sciences from the Vrije Universiteit Brussels. He previously worked as a
coach for the U16 squad of Crystal Palace, where he has also had experience with the physiotherapist for Beerschot AC in the Belgian professional league. He works currently
first team (2009-2010). Prior to this, he worked in the area of tennis at Highgate Perfor- at Al-Ahli Saudi football club as Head of Rehabilitation (2012-).
mance Tennis (2011) and Hills Road High Performance (2011-2012).

Sally Hara, MSc, RD, CSSD, COE, is a board-certified specialist in Sports Dietetics and
a certified diabetes educator. She has bachelor's degrees in both Nutrition Science and
Exercise Physiology, as well as a master's degree in Nutrition Science, all from the Uni-
versity of Califomia, Davis. Sally has worked in research laboratories and medical cen-
ters and has run a private practice, where she provides medical nutrition therapy and
sports nutrition coaching, near Seattle for over 10 years. As a nationally recognized
public speaker, former college instructor, and writer, she has authored and co-authored
multiple research studies and sports nutrition articles. She is a contributing author of
The American Dietetic Association's Sports Nutrition: A Cuide for the Professional Wor-
king with Active People (4th ed.).

Bart De Roover is a former international professional soccer player, having played five
games for the national team of Belgium. After his playing career, he served as head coach
of several first-division teams, including SV Zulte Waregem and Antwerp RAFC. Bart
holds a UEFA Pro coaching license and is involved in the post formation of the Asian
Vice-Champions, the Al-Ahli Saudi football club.

Balder Berck11za11s, MSc, has a master's degree in both sports sciences and rehabilita-
tion sciences from the Free University of Brussels. He has gained experience in soccer
through intemships at Manchester City FC, FC Cologne, and Club Brugge K.V. Since
July 2012, he has worked mainly as an injury-prevention and end-of-rehabilitation spe-
cialist at the Al-Ahli Saudi football club. Before that, he worked for KV Mechelen as a
strength and conditioning coach, with specific attention on efficient moving in soccer.
TABU: OF CONTENTS

1. TRAINING PRINCIPLES ................................................................................................ 13 5. PHYSICALABILITIES AND THE ROLE OF AEROBIC FITNESS ................................ 73

;,·~ ~~~~~~~t~~iiit1~~·::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::: ;!
1.1 lntroduction ..................................................................................................... 13
1.2 Supercompensation ........................................................................................ 13
1.3 Delayed transmutation .................................................................................... 14 5.3 Aerobic fitness ................................................................................................ 76
1.4 Cumulative training effect ............................................................................... 14 5.4 Soccer-specific training drills using the continuous principie .......................... 77
1.5 Residual effects of training ............................................................................. 14
1.6 lnterference or superposition of training effects ............................................. 15 6. HIGH·INTENSITY INTERVAL TRAINING (WITH SPECIAL REFERENCE
1.7 Training process and goal setting ................................................................... 15 TO SMALL SIDED GAME PLAY) .................................................................................. 83
1.8 Specificity (SpecificAdaptations to lmposed Demands) ................................ 16 6.1 lntroduction to High-lntensity lnterval Training (HllT) ..................................... 83
1.9 Transfer effect (cross-training) ........................................................................ 16 6.2 HllT effects on cardiovascular and muscular adaptations .............................. 85
1.10 lnitial value and diminishing returns ............................................................... 17 6.3 Lactate formation during HllT ......................................................................... 85
1.11 Inter-individual variability ................................................................................ 18 6.4 Lactate clearance during HllT ........................................................................ 86
1.12 Nature ar Nurture? .......................................................................................... 18 6.5 High-intensity interval training versus tow-intensity continuous training ......... 87
1.13 Principie of reversibility ................................................................................... 19 6.6 High-intensity lnterval training with ar without the bali .................................... 88
1.14 Progression .................................................................................................... 19 6.7 Small-sided games (SSGs) ............................................................................ 90
1.15 Variation .......................................................................................................... 19 6.8 Training Time Distribution ............................................................................... 97
6.9 Soccer-specific training drills .......................................................................... 98
2. TRAINING MODELS ...................................................................................................... 21
2.1 lntroduction ..................................................................................................... 21 7. SPEED, AGILITY AND QUICKNESS (SAQ) AND REPEATED
2.2 General Adaptation Syndrome (GAS) ........................................................... 22 SPRINT ABILITY (RSA) ............................................................................................... 109
2.3 The Supercompensation ar one-factor theory ................................................ 23 7.1 lntroduction ................................................................................................... 109
2.4 Fitness-fatigue model ..................................................................................... 25 7.2 Nature or Nurture ........................................................................................... 11 o
2.5 Performance potential model .......................................................................... 31 7.3 Blomechanics of Sprinting ............................................................................. 11 O
7 .4 Running technique ......................................................................................... 112
3. THE PHYSICAL DEMANDS OF ELITE SOCCER MATCH PLAY ................................. 33 7 .5 Speed, agility, quickness and cutting ............................................................. 112
3.1 lntroduction .................................................................:.................................. 33 7.6 Definitions ......................................................................................................113
3.2 Activity profile ................................................................................................. 33 7 .7 Soccer-specific SAQ drills ............................................................................. 113
3.3 Positional variation ......................................................................................... 34 7.8 Speed ............................................................................................................115
3.4 Competitive standard ...................................................................................... 35 7.9 Tips ................................................................................................................ 117
3.5 Gender Differences ........................................................................................ 36 7.10 Exercises .......................................................................................................118
3.6 Match-to-match variability and stability .......................................................... 37
3.7 Contextual and tactical factors ....................................................................... 37 8. FITNESS TESTING ...................................................................................................... 123
3.8 Fatigue during match play .............................................................................. 38 8.1 lntroduction ................................................................................................... 123
8.2 Criteria ......................................................................................................... 124
4. NUTRITION .................................................................................................................... 43 8.3 Why measure? ............................................................................................. 125
4. 1 lntroduction ..................................................................................................... 43 8.4 Test environment .......................................................................................... 126
4.2 Energy ........................................................................................................... 43 8.5 The terms "to beH and "as is" ........................................................................ 126
4.3 Substrate Utilization and Macronutrient Needs .............................................. 46 8.6 Tests ............................................................................................................. 127
4.4 ATP (adenosine triphosphate) ........................................................................ 53 8.7 Analyzing Testing Results ............................................................................. 145
4.5 Energy systems .............................................................................................. 55
4.6 Macronutrient needs ....................................................................................... 56 9. HEART RATE AND GPS MONITORING IN SOCCER ............................................... 149
4. 7 Eating patterns of soccer players .................................................................. 57 9.1 lntRoduction ................................................................................................. 149
4.8 Glycogen metabolism and nutrient timing for recovery .................................. 58 9.2 Use of heart rate as an indirect measure for oxygen consumption .............. 149
4.9 Energy Balance and Body Composition ......................................................... 61 9.3 Resting heart rate (HRr) ............................................................................... 150
4.10 Vitamins, minerais and free radicais ............................................................... 64 9.4 Maximum heart rate (HRmax> ......................................................................... 150
4.11 Water and electrolyte balance in soccer players ........................................... 66 9.5 Lactate threshold .......................................................................................... 150
4.12 Food supplements .......................................................................................... 69 9.6 Relating the lactate curve to the heart rate ................................................... 153
4.13 Recommendations .......................................................................................... 71 9.7 lnterpreting HR measurement ...................................................................... 154
9.8 Effect of training on heart rate and lactate accumulation ............................ 155
9.9 Autonomic nervous system .......................................................................... 156
9.10 Examples of heart rate interpretation ........................................................... 159
9.11 GPS Monitoring ............................................................................................ 161

1h
10. TRAINING LOAD MONITORING IN SOCCER ............................................................ 167 17. MACROCYCLE: IN-SEASON ...................................................................................... 307
10.1 Jntroduction ................................................................................................... 167 17 .1 lntroduction ................................................................................................... 307
10.2 The Training Process .................................................................................... 168 17.2 Duration ofthe mesocycle ............................................................................ 307
10.3 Internai Load ................................................................................................. 169 17 .3 Organization of the mesocycle ..................................................................... 309
10.4 Externai Load ............................................................................................... 177 17.4 Three phases ofthe "in-season" mesocycle ................................................ 310
17.5 Remarks .......................................................................................................311
11. TRAINING CONTINUUM ............................................................................................. 185
17.6 Individual periodization ................................................................................. 315
11.1 lntroduction ................................................................................................... 185
17.7 How to implement individual periodization ............................... , ................... 317
11.2 Different stages of the training continuum ................................................... 186
11.3 Load and load tolerance ............................................................................... 190 18. MICROCYCLE: WEEK PLANNING ............................................................................. 333
11.4 Overtraining detection scale ......................................................................... 193 18.1 lntroduction ................................................................................................... 333
11.5 Trainingflaws ................................................................................................ 194 18.2 Structure of a training session ...................................................................... 333
11.6 Relation between load, injuries, fitness and performance ............................ 195 18.3 Pre-activation ................................................................................................ 334
18.4 Warm up ...................................................................................................... 334
12. FATIGUE ...................................................................................................................... 201
18.5 Central section .............................................................................................. 339
12.1 lntroduction ................................................................................................... 201
18.6 Progression phase ........................................................................................ 339
12.2 Fatigue in a soccer match ............................................................................ 202 18.7 Recovery phase ........................................................................................... 339
12.3 Underlying mechanisms of fatigue ............................................................... 203 18.8 Prevention phase .......................................................................................... 341
12.4 Effects of fatigue ........................................................................................... 209
12.5 Countering fatigue .........................................................................................211 19. STRETCHING .............................................................................................................. 343
19.1 lntroduction ................................................................................................... 343
13. FATIGUE MANAGEMENT ........................................................................................... 217 19.2 Types of stretching ....................................................................................... 343
13.1 tntroduction .................................................................................................. 217 19.3 lncreasing flexibility or preparing the body ................................................... 347
13.2 Performance stabilization ............................................................................. 218 19.4 Use during the training week ........................................................................ 349
13.3 Fatigue management. ................................................................................... 219
13.4 Recovery strategies ...................................................................................... 220 20. STRENGTH TRAINING ANO FUNCTIONAL TRAINING ............................................ 351
13.5 Monitoring Fatigue and Recovery in Soccer................................................. 232 20.1 lntroduction ................................................................................................... 351
13.6 Tapenng ........................................................................................................ 244 20.2 Physiology of muscle strength ...................................................................... 351
20.3 Strength training and the nervous system .................................... , ............... 353
14. PERIODIZATION IN SOCCER ..................................................................................... 253
20.4 Types of strength .......................................................................................... 354
14.1 History of periodization ................................................................................. 253 20.5 Types of strength training ............................................................................. 355
14.2 Types of periodization ................................................................................... 255 20.6 Plyometrics ................................................................................................... 355
14.3 Season planning ........................................................................................... 255 20.7 Setting up general strength training programs ............................................ 358
14.4 Types of periodization ................................................................................... 257 20.8 General strength training exercises .............................................................. 360
14.5 Periodization models: lntensity and volume ................................................. 258 20.9 TRX/Suspension Training ............................................................................. 362
14.6 Periodization models: Physical abilities ........................................................ 260 20.10 Medicine Bali ................................................................................................ 364
14.7 Workload ...................................................................................................... 263
20.11 Functional strength training for the soccer player ........................................ 366
14.8 lntegrated ..................................................................................................... 264
14.9 Types of microcycles .................................................................................... 265 21. INJURY PREVENTION ................................................................................................ 381
14.11 Periodization in soccer ................................................................................. 265 21.1 lntroduction ................................................................................................... 381
21.2 Consequences of injuries ............................................................................. 382
15. THE TACTICAL PERIODIZATION MODEL (UNDERSTANDING
21.3 Conceptual model: injury prevention ............................................................ 382
THE GAME'S DEMANDS TO ENHANCE SOCCER PERFORMANCE) ..................... 273
21.4 lntrinsic risk factors ....................................................................................... 385
15.1 lntroduction ...................................... , ............................................................ 273 21.5 Extrinsic risk factors ..................................................................................... 393
15.2 Tactical Periodization: A new soccer training approach ................................ 274
21.6 General injury prevention for soccer players ................................................ 397
15.3 Game model ................................................................................................. 276
21.7 lnjury-prevention programs ........................................................................... 403
15.4 Principies of play and game model.. ............................................................. 278
15.5 Tactical Periodization: methodological principies ......................................... 280
16. MACROCYCLE: PRESEASON ................................................................................... 291
16.1 lntroduction ................................................................................................... 291
16.2 Preseason training principies ....................................................................... 292
16.3 Organization of the mesocycle ..................................................................... 296
16.4 Friendly match planning in the preseason stage .......................................... 298
16.5 Organization ofthe preseason training camp ............................................... 300
1
FITN ESS 1N SOCCER
Training principies

1
TRAINING PRINCIPLES
Werner Helsen, Kenny McMillan, David Tenney, Paul Bradley,
Jean-Pierre Meert & Jan Van Winckel

1.1 INTRODUCTION
Performance in association football (known as soccer in North-America) depends
upon a myriad of aspects, such as technical, tactical, physical and mental parame-
ters. As with other sports, soccer is not a science, but science can assist in impro-
ving performance (Stolen et al., 2005) and preventing injury. Training principies are
systematic summaries of scientific findings, and these are highly important for the
appropriate organization of training sessions and competitions. They are defined
as iules and methods that can be used to prepare a player or team for competition
in a professional manner. Training principies provide a reliable guidance, and they
are therefore important for coaches to understand in order to maximize perfor-
mance and minimize the chance of failure.

1.2 SUPERCOMPENSATION
The Soviet scientist Yakovlev offered probably the first scientifically based expla-
nation of fitness enhancement in 1955. Yakovlev demonstrated the phenomenon
of "supercompensation" of muscle and liver glycogen and muscle phosphocrea-
tine stores during recovery from exercise (Yakovlev, 1955). The training principie of
supercompensation states that improvements only become evident after a period
in which the accumulated fatigue from training can be reduced. A period of relative
rest enables the results of training to be better reflected. Son1e important processes
occur after the actual training session or match, a períod when the players' bodies
are given valuable time to adapt to the training stimuli provided one or hvo days
before. Therefore, rest or recovery should be considered an important phase in the
overall training process.
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
Training principies Training principies

If training is suspended for a given physical ability, the performance levei of that
Supercompensation ability will drop. Therefore, after a period of detraining, players will be at a resi-
dual levei of performance. For example, at the amateur levei, players often have
Supercompensation six to eight weeks off during the summer. The fitness levei remaining after this
off-season period is referred to as the residual effect. Long periods of training, com-
plex and multi-component training, and appropriately periodized loads will lead
to longer-lasting residual effects (Issurin, 2010). Older and more experienced athle-
tes also have longer-lasting residuais. Some physical abilities, such as strength and
aerobic endurance, have longer-lasting residuais when compared with anaerobic
parameters.
Decreased performance

Time
Residual effects of training
Fig. 1.1: The accumulated training /oad (and the corresponding fatigue) results in decreased 95%
performance in lhe days immediately after exercise. An adequate recovery results in increased
performance through a reduction in fatigue (supercompensation).
.. 90%

~ 85%
~
1.3 DELAYED TRANSMUTATION .5 80%
li:
This principie holds that in order to realize performance enhancements, specific
exercises must be used to transform and maximize the fitness acquired during pre-
vious training activities. For example, if a player performs strength training exer-
cises for his or her legs (e.g., squats), there will only be a visible improvement if
the player also performs specific exercises (e.g., jumps and sprints). This way, the
strength gained is "transmuted" into functional movements. Zatsiorsky (1995)
defined delayed transmutation as "the time period needed to transform acquired
motor potential into athletic performance." Aspecific work improves the potential
for performance, but it \vill not directly improve performance without specialized Fig. 1.2: A theoretical representation of the residual effects of training. The p/ayer trains four times
(once every two days) until day seven. His fitness levei increases through training, but aller eight
specific training afterwards (Zatsiorsky and Kraemer, 2006). days of rest, his fitness levei has decreased from 93% (on day 8) to 85% (on day 15).

1.4 CUMULATIVE TRAINING EFFECT 1.6 INTERFERENCE OR SUPERPOSITION OF TRAINING EFFECTS


The cumulative effect of long-term training is the primary factor determining a Players are often exposed to training different physical abilities during the sarne
player's physical fitness. The cumulative training effect can be described as "a training cycle, particularly for strength and aerobic power. Improvements in
change in physiological capabilities and level of physical/technical abilities resul- strength may be compromised when practiced simultaneously with aerobic power,
ting from a long-term athletic preparation" (Issurin, 2008). and this has been referred to as the interference phenomenon (Docherty and Spo-
rer, 2000). The interference effect can be negative or positive depending on the form
and sequence of exercise.
1.5 RESIDUAL EFFECTS OF TRAINING
One of the primary aims of soccer training is to develop various physical abilities.
These physical abilities remain at an elevated levei for a certain period after trai- 1.7 TRAINING PROCESS ANO GOAL SETTING
ning ceases. This retention of fitness is explained by the residual training effect, Each training process needs to have a clear training objective. Thls training goal can
which can be described as "the retention of changes induced by systematic work- be determined in both a general way, such as to get into the top five, as well as in a
loads beyond a certain time period after the cessation of training" (Counsilman and more specific manner, such as to run 3,000 meters in 12 minutes.
Counsilman, 1991). These residual effects have been defined in two ways: in terms In their meta-analysis, Kleingeld et al. (2011) showed that specific, difficult goals
of the retention of physical changes following a series of many training sessions yield considerably higher group performance when compared with aspecific goals.
(delayed effects) and in terms of the results of a series of many training sessions Moderately difficult and easy goals were also associated with performance benefits
(accumulative effects) (Hellard et ai., 2005). relative to nonspecific goals. These findings demonstrate that group goals have a
f ITN ESS 1N SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
Training principies Training principies

robust effect on group performance. Individual goals can also promete group per- their endurance levels after a period of deep-water running, which involves run-
formance, but they should be used with caution in interdependent groups. ning movements in deep water while the athlete wears a flotation belt. This method
is therefore not only useful during periods of injury, but it can also act perfectly as
an altemative training or recovery workout following a match. Reilly et al. (2003)
1.8 SPECIFICITY (SPECIFIC ADAPTATIONS TO IMPOSED DEMANDS) concluded that aerobic performance is maintained by deep-water running for up
The principie of specificity is often referred to as the Specific Adaptation to Imposed to six weeks in trained endurance athletes, while sedentary individuais showed
Demands (SAID) principie. Scientific research has shown training to lead to dura- greater improvements in their maximal oxygen uptake V0 2mnx than athletes. There
tion, task and speed specific changes (Rutherford, 1988; Givens, 2010). A sprinter, is also limited evidence showing improvements in anaerobic measures and upper-
for example, will improve in speed, through specific training, but not in aerobic body strength in individuais who engaged in deep-water running.
endurance. The research literature clearly shows that any form of specific training produces
The rule of specificity states that a player has to train in a specific way to acquire more effective results than cross-training. However~ specific types of training are
a specific adaptation (i.e., specific training results in improvement of that specific sometimes not possible (e.g., because of injury or overtraining). On these occasions,
movement). This means the biggest physiological changes take place in the struc- cross-training is an ideal substitute to help preserve as much fitness as possible.
tures that were subject to the training stimulus. Magel et al. (1975) provided a good Different modes of aerobic training (e.g., aqua-jogging, swimming, cycling or
example when they showed how swimmers, after a period of training, achieved an ro\ving) can be used to obtain positive adaptation phenomena or training effects.
11.2% improvement in aerobic endurance while swimming. However, when they
performed a running test, the improvement in aerobic endurance was shown to
be just 1.5%. This finding clearly demonstrates the specificity of training principle, 1.10 INITIAL VALUEAND DIMINISHING RETURNS
specifically why it is so important that training should mimic the actual demands The principie of initial value and diminishing returns implies that progress will
of the sport as closely as possible. Therefore, training should always be oriented be greater for individuais with a lower baseline level than those who have already
toward the sport itself. The more specific the energy systems used, as well as the reached a high level of performance. When commencing strength training, results
actual activity (e.g., biomechanics, position, body coordination, speed, resistance, are quickly evident in the initial phase. However, experienced players need to train
etc.), the greater the chance that specific improvements will occur. more often and with greater intensity to see the sarne progress after a few weeks.
Therefore, it is important for training to be adapted and evaluated relatively quick-
ly at the beginning of the training program.
1.9 TRANSFER EFFECT (CROSS-TRAINING)
ln contrast to the rule of specificity, a transfer effect can be obtained if correct plan- Law of diminishing returns
ning is carried out. For example, research has shown athletes are able to maintain 100
90

'° /
] '°
! 60 ,,, /

1 4050 /
i 30
/
/


10
o Ci Tim~ ln 1mlnlnc

Fig. 1.3: When unfit players begin a training program, their physical fitness leveis increase rapidfy.
When they become fitter and approach their genetic /imits, lhe law of diminishing returns becomes
apparent.

ln conclusion, good progress can be observed for a soccer player during the initial
phase of a program. However, as the player's fitness and stamina increases over
time, the less pronounced this progress will be.
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
Training principies Training principies

1.11 INTER-INDIVIDUAL VARIABILITY 1.13 PRINCIPLE OF REVERSIBILITY


Adaptation to training is known to be a highly individual phenomenon (Avalos et Detraining is defined as the partial or complete loss of training-induced adaptati-
al., 2003). The improvement in response to a training stimulus varies from person ons in response to either the cessation of training or a substantial decrease in the
to person not only because of differences in "nature" (genetic predisposition) but training load (Mujika and Padilla, 2003). We all know the adage of "Use it or lose
also because of "nurture" such as pre-training condition; gender, age and ethnicity; it." Adaptations resulting from training disappear when training is discontinued.
health, diet and sleep; environmental factors such as heat, cold, and humidity; and of
course motivation. Players respond to the sarne training stimulus in different ways,
with some players adapting better and quicker to a particular stirnulus than others. 1.14 PROGRESSION
Therefore, each player can be categorized as a low, moderate or high responder. A particular training load needs to be increased systematically and progressively
Hohman (1988) examined the training variations of the West German water polo over time, with adequate time being given to reach the training objectives. A sud-
team for the Olympic Games in Seoul, specifically the relationship between the trai- den increase in training load can lead to an imbalance between load and load tole-
ning load and competitive performance. Two different types of athletes emerged: rance, •vhich subsequently increases the likelihood of injury.
those that responded quickly to training stimuli and those that did not respond so
quickly.
Inter-individual variability also depends on the type of exercise. For example, some
players will progress more in terms of speed development, while others will improve
more rapidly in the area of aerobic endurance. Training responses can differ to a huge
extent, with the level and speed of progress varying widely between players. Four
weeks of preparation may be sufficient for some players, while others may need up
to eight weeks. The impact of h·aining also depends in part on the athlete's physical
maturity. Training is less effective before puberty than it is afterwards.

1.12 NATURE OR NURTURE?


Is a top soccer player born as such, or is that player the result of years of hard trai-
ning? This is a question that has preoccupied scientists for decades. Is it nature (i.e.,
son1eone's genetic predisposition) or is it nurture (i.e., the amount of training) that
makes someone a top soccer player? The predominant factor that determines an 1.15 VARIATION
individual's response to exercise training is genetic predisposition, because players Training requires a varied approach where all the basic physical abilities can be
\vill respond to exercise training differently. Some individuals respond better to trained. A varied program needs to be established \.Vithout losing sight of the other
endurance-type training, •vhereas others respond to shorter activities biased more principies. Variety in the exercises perforn1ed ensures the greatest progress and
to power and strength. Many scientific papers have examined the genetic response n1inünizes the chance of injury, because the monotony of traíning load represents
to exercise training, and Bouchard et al. (1992) concluded that heredity can account a significant risk factor for injuries. Monotony is a measure of the variability over
for 25-50% of the variance in V02 m.ix values. Costill and Wilmore (1998) reported training sessions, and it is calculated by dividing the \veekly training load by the
improvements of 0-43% when a group of subjects followed identical endurance standard deviation of that load for the \Veek (Poster, 1998). Enhancement of per-
training programs for up to 12 months. Indeed, it is commonly said, "The best \vay formance is achieved by systen1atically n1aking changes in training parameters,
to become an elite athlete or football player is to be selective when choosing your with volume and intensity being the most general training characteristics. Barre
parents!" lt should not be forgotten, of course, that the amount (quantity) and qua- (1982) suggests that programs where athletes are subjected to a steady, regular
lity of training will determine whether you fulfil your genetic potential. ln conclu- load should be díscouraged. Strain is the product of the \veekly training load and
sion, talent has to be first identified. Specific training programs are then needed to n1onotony (Foste1~ 1998). Foster (1998) showed that high training load and high
develop and fulfil a soccer player's genetic potential. training monotony are both factors relating to negative adaptations to training.
Furthermore, Putlur et al. (2004) reported a significant relationship bet\veen índi-
ces of training, such as strain and monotony, \Vith the incidence of illness. Finally,
recent research demonstrated that the \Veekly duration, training load, monotony
and strain over the preceding week were significantly higher for players with a
traumatic injury \Vhen compared with healthy players. (Brink et al., 2010).
FITNESS IN SOCCER
FITNESS IN SOCCER
201 Training principies
Traíníng models

SUMMARY
It is important for a soccer coach to have an understanding and appreciation
of training principies. Coaches should be aware that not all soccer players will
adapt the sarne way to training sessions - the training load may be too much for
one player, predisposing him to injury, but too little for another player, perhaps
causing a detraining effect. Soccer training should be specific to the needs of the
soccer player and should vary from session to session, with a clear and safe pro-
gression to induce positive training adaptations and avoid the accumulation
of fatigue, illness and injuries.
TRAINING MODELS
Jan Van Winckel, David Tenney, Kenny McMillan, Paul Bradley

REFERENCES

AvaJoe., M., Hcllnrd, P. and Chatard, J,C., 200J. Moddini; lhe tr.1íning·porformani::c rdat10n"h1p uoing a mixcd modd in chtc ~wimmers. 2.1 INTRODUCTION
Mcd. Sci. Sports Excrc., 35, pp.1!3$-846.
Douchord, e., Dionnc·, f.T., Simoncau, J.A. and lloulny, M.R. (1992). Gcnctic; o( acrobic nnd anncrobic pcrforrnanC\.'S. Excrcioc and Sport Training models are theoretical models that enable coaches to understand the trai-
Sacnres Rcvkws, 20, pp. 27·58. . . .·
Brink, M.S., Vit<S<:hcr, C., A"'nds, S., Zwcrvcr. ]., Po8t, W.J. and Lcmmink, K.AP.M., 2010. Monilormr, Sl"''" and "'covcry: ncw 1m1ght,; ning process and its impact on physical performance. These models can then be
for thc P"'vcnlion of injuries and illncfiocr. ln clilc youth e.ocrer plnycro. British Joumal OfSports Medicine, 44(11), pp.SCl9.Jll5,
Coun:;ilman, ll. E. and Coun,;ilmnn, )., 1991. Thc n»i<lunl dfccl~ of trnining. Swimmmg RcS<:arch, ·!. used as a framework to design training programs. Most coaches are aware of the
Dodicrly, D. nnd Spo,..,r, ll., WOO. A propO$Cd modcl for cxamirüng thc inlcrfr,..,ncc phcnomcnon bctwccn concummt ncrob1c and
strcngth trnining. Sports Medicine, 30(6), p.385·39·1. . . .
supercompensation model (the one-factor model), which clearly explains why per-
Fmtcr, C., 1993. Monitoring training in athletc'S with "'forcnre to ()Vcrtraimnr; syndromc. Mcdmnc and ~c1cncc m sports and cxcrcisc,
30(7),p 116-1
formance improves after a period of rest. Unfortunately, this model is incomplete,
Hcllard, l'., Av,11m, M., Mille! G., L.1co,;le L. and Q,,1tnrd,).C., 2005. Modchng the ,..,s;duol dfoct> and thrcnhnld oaluratrnn of lrnining: A and it has been replaced over the last few decades by the fitness-fatigue model (the
cascotudy ()f Olympic swlmmcrn. j, Strcngth Cond. Reo, 19(1}, pp.67-75.
Hohmaon, A., 1992. Annly,.is of dclaycd trnining dfccl!; in th~ prcp.ua\ion of thc Wcr.t·Gcrrnnn w.1lcr polo lc.1m for thc Olympic games two-factor model). This model provides coaches with additional insight, enabling
1983. ln: D. l-.facL1ren, T. Rcilly and 1\. Lccs, Eds., 1992. Sw1mmi11g scicncc V!. London: Eb. FSpon
J,,,;urin, V., 21)0$. Prindplco nnd b.>,.iOJ of advan«:d troining of athlctcs. Mur.kegon (MI): Ullimale ;\thlclesC?nrepl5 Publbher. them to make more accurate predictions about the impacts of various training regi-
Jr- 5urin, V., 2010. New horizo"'' lor lhe mclhodology and physiology ()f !r.1imng pcnod1zalmn. Sportc. mcdkme, ·\0(3), pp.189·2G6. .
Klcingcld, A., van Micdo, H. and ,\,..,nds, L., 2011. The dfect oi gonl ocllinB on group pcrformnnre: A mct.1·.>nnlyr-10. )ou mal ()f r\pphed mes. This allows the training Ioads of individual athletes to be anticipated and ulti-
l'sychology, %(6), p.1289.
Mngel, j,R., foglio, G.f., McArdle, W.D., Gulin, B., l'cchnr, G.S. ,1nd Katch, F.i., 1975. Spcdficily of ,;wim lr,1ining on maximum oxygen mately modified to suit their requirements. Clearly. the primary aim of any soccer
uplakc. joumõl oi Applicd l'hyr.i()logy, 35(1), pp.151·155. . . . . . .
Mujib, 1. and Pndilln S., 2003. Physiolo;:;icnl ""d P"rform;mcc con.<cqucni:l!fo of !ramrn;:; c:"'""t1on m <;.lhlctcs: dclrornrng. ln: W.R. Fron-
training program is to ensure the players are in peak fitness on match day, so it is
tcra, cd. 2003. Rchabihtnlioo ofSporb !n1un...,;: Scicnt1fic Bnsis. Maldcn, MA: Blackwcll Socncc. pp.l\t-143. . , .
Putlur, !'., fostcr, C., Miokowski, j.r\., Kanc, 1'1.K., Uur!on, S.E., Schcctt, T.P. and McGuigan, M.lt, 200-1. Altcrnlmn of1mmunc lunction m
therefore important to also consider fatigue effects resulting from training and its
womcn collcgiate wcrer playcro and collc;:;c studcnts. Joumal of SpMl> Sdencc and Medicine, 3, pp.23-1-243. eventual impact on match fitness.
Rcilly, T., Dowzcr, e. N. and Cnble, N. T., 2003. Thc physiology of dccp·walcr mnning. )ou mal ofSports Socncc, 21(12), pp.959-972.
Rutherford, O. M., 19SS. Muscul,1rçoordinntion and strcngth lr.1inin!). Sp()r!!; Medicine, 5(3), pp.196-202. ln recent years, a considerable amount of research has been published on the effect
S.11c, D. and MacDougall, D .. 1981. Spccifidly in strcngth tr.1ining; a rcview for thc coaclt and athletc. Cnnndian joumal oi npplicd spurt
~denccs, 6(2), p.87. , , .
of different training models. A brief summary of this research is provided below,
Wilmorc and Cost1!1, 2005. Physiology oi Sport and Excrcisc: 3rd Edit1on. Chnmpaign. lL: Human Kmcl1o;.
Y,1kovlc•~ N.N., 1955. Survcy on ~pari biochcmbtry. Mosww: FiS.
ranging from the original model from Hans Selye to the supercompensation model
Zlt~ioroky, V.M. aod Krncmcr, W.j., 2006. Scicnre and prncliceof strcngth .lrnining. Champ~ii;n: Hunrnn KincliC!>. (the one-factor model) and the fitness-fatigue model (the two-factor model).
Z.1l!>iorsky, V, M .. 1995. Sdcncc and prncticc oi strcnglh trnming. Champ.11gn, 11.: Humõn KmcliC!>.
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
Training models Training models

2.2 GENERALADAPTATION SYNDROME (GAS) 2.2.2 Use of lhe GAS model in sport
Prokop and Rõssner (1959) were one of the first to use Selye's concept of GAS to
2.2.1 Hans Selye explain the concept of periodically decreasing the amount of training. Forbes Car-
Dr. Hans Selye, an endocrinologist, was one of the first scientists to describe the lile (1961) applied Selye's theory to sport in a series of Track Technique articles
response of the human body to any kind of stress. ln 1938, he proposed the Gene- narned The Athlete and Adaptation to Stress. He suggested using the GAS modelas a
ral Adaptation Syndrome theory (GAS), which involved two major systems of the theoretical foundation. Indeed, Hans Selye's GAS can serve as a theoretical frame-
body: the nervous system and the endocrine system. ln 1946, he defined GAS as \VOrk for adaptation to training, since training can be regarded as a type of stress.
the sum of all the non-specific, systematic reactions of the body that ensue from Matvejev (1964), however, criticized the use of the GAS model to explain periodiza-
continued exposure to stress. tion, postulating that the GAS theory was based on pathological material. Coaches
and scientists should be wary of rigidly translating Selye's biochemical model to
1. The alarm phase sport, because performance does not only result from the storage or release of bio-
The first stage of GAS, the alarm reaction, is the immediate reaction to a stressar. chernical substances.
In the initial phase of stress, humans exhibit a "fight or flight" response that pre-
pares the body for action.
The alarm phase is divided into two further phases: the shock phase and the anti- 2.3 THE SUPERCOMPENSATION OR ONE-FACTOR THEORY
slwck phase. The terms supercompensation, superadaptation and adaptive reconstruction
• ln the shock phase, the resistance to the stressar drops temporarily below (Russian science) are widely used to explain the results of optirnal training and
the normal range (baseline). the effect of subsequent recovery. Overload training is a method of stressing an
• The anti-shock phase is when the threat ar stressar is identified or realized. athlete ata higher level than formerly tolerated \Vith the aim of stimulating adapta-
The body then starts to respond and is now in a state of alarm. tion and thus supercompensation (Steinacker et al., 2002). The supercornpensation
2. Resistance effect that can occur after stressing an athlete is a relationship between \Vork and
The resistance phase depends on the athlete's levei and genetic potential. If stress recovery that leads to horneostatic adaptations to higher levels (Bompa and Haff,
continues during this phase, the body adapts to the stressors it is exposed to. 2009). The training phenomenon known as the supercompensation effect was pro-
According to Dr. Selye, this adaptation begins after 48 hours and within a period bably first described by Folbrot in 1941. In the 1950s, the Russian biochemist
of four weeks. Yakovlev (1955) demonstrated supercompensation of muscle and liver glyco-
3. Recovery or exhaustion gen and muscle phosphocreatine during post-exercise recovery. Yakovlev (1967)
The recovery stage follows once the systern's compensation mechanisms classified supercompensation as a four-step process:
have successfully overcome the stressar effect. Alternatively, exhaustion may be
the third stage in the GAS model, and at this point, all of the body's resources are Phase 1: Fatigue after training. There is a predictable drop in performance due to
ultimately depleted, leaving it incapable of maintaining normal function. the stress induced by training (1 to 2 hours).
Phase 2: Compensation (rest) phase. Energy stores and performance return to the
baseline (24 to 48 hours).
General adaptation syndrome (GAS) Phase 3: Supercompensation of performance (36 to 72 hours).
-·--·- -·--··-·----neslstance to sfreSf"füiforeexnaUst1on-s·etsin--- Phase 4: A decrease in the physiological benefits, the so-called detraining pheno-
menon, obtained during the supercompensation phase. This occurs when
Sij°: 'í" '.: : :_~=: : _: : : :_:=:::=::::::j::::::-:7":--= ==-====-~:~~==-:~~~:-~-= ~~~--~- the athlete does not apply another stimulus within an optimal period of
time (i.e., during the supercompensation phase) (3 to 7 days).
--!---------------+-/------------ ---------------------- !-'---·-·---.----------·--
--1----------------V------------- -- - --------------- --!-- ----"-<------------ - --
--+--------+1------------------r---"ç-------------------

____
-r~=- -+- !-
_
-=====r-- ---;=------ -~
Basehne_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ ,_ - - - - - - -
Shock___________An~hock_I i_ _ __
_______ ! ______,_
?hase 1: Alarm phase ?hase 2: Resistance (cope wíth stressar) Phase 3: Exhaustion

Fig. 2. 1: General adaptation syndrome


FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
Training models Training models

Training sarne day. This is of course perfectly possible, and it will improve perfor-
j mance over the long term when applied properly. So, is the supercompen-
j sation model incorrect? This model can be interpreted as the consequence
of accumulated load followed by a rest period that allows supercompensa-
tion to take full effect. Each physical ability-such as speed, endurance, strength,
and so on-has its own response and recovery rates and supercompensation curve.

:: - ---~:--- , -----1-/ : The replenishment of ATP and CP requires only a few seconds to a few minutes

Lo ad
---r·: '

\Recoverv: Lo a d
. : Recovery:
'
ir.ecovervi
lo ad Lo ad
to return to baseline leveis, while the
reloading of glycogen in soccer can
Fig. 2.2: Supercompensation or one4actor theory take up to 48 hours. One of the conse-
quences of supercompensation is an
A sufficient training load results in a temporary decrease in performance. enhanced load tolerance when reco-
With an optimal recovery, this stress eventually leads to a greater perfor- very is adequate and the new load is
mance than the initial level. This next training load might be higher because of timed properly.
increased fitness leveis and a consequently higher levei of load tolerance. The soc-
cer players' performance levei will increase as a result.
Ho"\vever, if too much time elapses betvveen tvvo training sessions, performance 2.4 FITNESS-FATIGUE MODEL
does not increase and can even decrease (detraining). The GAS ar supercompensation
model offers a theoretical framework
for the process of adaptation that is
-----------~----
easy to understand. Both models,
, '
' ' ., '
:'
. . however, have their limitations, and
they cannot be used to predict future
'' ' '' performance. The fitness-fatigue
''
-----~- .. - model was first conceptualized
.'''
' :
'' by Banister (1975). This model
states that a training stimulus
Fig. 2.3: Excessive time between traininfl /oads. leads to two internai effects on
the body: fatigue (a negative effect) and fitness (a positive effect). The fit-
ness-fatigue model, also known as the two-factor model, associates the superimpo-
sed effects of the fitness and fatigue processes. The principie holds that the fitness
effect of training is relatively small but long lasting, while the fatigue effect of trai-
ning is shorter in duration but greater in magnitude. ln this model, the two after-
effects of training fitness and fatigue both influence the preparedness of the player.
Preparedness, unlike fitness, is influenced by acute changes in the subject.

+
Traínlng --.---lll>i FITNESS
Fig. 2.4: lnadequate recovery periods

This is where the interval between the training stimuli is too short, so recovery
is not complete. The body is still recovering when the next training stimulus is FATIGUE
encountered. According to this model, performance will decrease. However, this
model does have its limitations. For example, a coach would need to wait
until a player is fully recovered before providing a new training stimulus.
ln reality, however, a new training stimulus can be imposed on players Fig. 2.5: The fitness-fatigue mode/. The athlete (player) is viewed as a system with training impulse
as input and performance as output.
before they are fully recovered, such as having two training sessions on the
FITNESS IN SDCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
Trainíng models Training models

A training stimulus results in two effects. There is a "fitness effect," which is rela- G 1 2 -4 -3 -2 -1 G
tively small and disappears slowly, anda "fatigue effect," which is greater in mag-
õ •"'
nitude but may also dissipate quickly. The extent to which fatigue disappears >
.!!
•"'e •"'e "'•
"C
••e •"' "'
"E•
"C
,~ •"'
:g•"'
"C
depends on the individual, but it may also be influenced by the recovery strategies "C
••
employed. Preparedness is the combination of fitness and fatigue.
""
~
,
"C
o
:E
"C

~ ~
"-
~ ,e
"C

"' 1-
"' "'
Training load 100 o "'
20 80 65 30 10 o
Fitness Fitncss effect 0.8 -0.48 -0.24 0.64 0.48 -0.24 -0.4 -0.48
' .............. ~
--- --- --- Fitness leve! 80 80.8 80.32 80.08 80.72 81.2 80.96 80.56 80.08

............................._.....,.:.::-.::·::::::·:.:::::·:.:·:::·:.:·::··.:::·············· Fatigue effect 200 -120 -70 160 130 -80 -100 120

..........··· Fatigue lcvel 25 225 105 35 195 325 245 145 25

Preparedness 55 -144.2 -24.68 45.08 -114.28 -243.8 -164.04 -64.44 55.08

Tabfe 2.1: A theoretica/ examp/e of how lhe effects (fitness and fatigue) of training load can be
estimated.

Detraining Match day: Before the match, the player displays hardly any fatigue (25). He or
she therefore has the necessary freshness (preparedness levei of 55) to play in the
Preparedness is optmized as
fitness leveis are stil! high but
match. After playing the match (training load = 100), the player improves in terms
Fitness leveis are high fatigue has dissipated of fitness due to the game, but fatigue also increases, causing the preparedness to
but are masked due to immediately diminish to -144.2 following the match.
accumulated fatigue
Match day + 1: ln this example, the day follo\ving the match is a complete rest day
Fig 2.6: The fitness-fatigue model (training load = O). The player's fitness level drops slightly but not to the extent
that fatigue drops, meaning the player's preparedness level starts to rise again.
Depending on his or her physical ability (i.e., speed, endurance, etc.), the player's
This model can be explained by using the following theoretical example: performance level only returns to its pre-match level after 48 to 72 hours.
We assume a normal training stimulus with a value of 6,300 arbitary units (AU) (90
minutes training x 70% = 90 x 70 = 6,300 AU). This creates a fatigue effect of 200 and Match day + 2: Two days after the match, a light training session is organized
a fitness effect of 0.8. (Note that these are abstract figures to illustrate the impact (active recovery: training load = 20), resulting in fatigue and fitness continuing to
of a training stimulus). This fitness and fatigue effect is in addition to the existing decrease. The preparedness leve}, however, rises to approximately 80% of its pre-
fitness levei of 80 and fatigue level of 25. match leveL
This results in a fitness level of 80.8, which is the existing fitness of 80 plus the fit-
ness of 0.8 acquired through the match, and a fatigue of 225 (200 + 25). The prepa- Match day + 3-4: During the third and fourth days after the match, loading stra-
redness is the difference betvveen fitness and fatigue. After the match, this is then tegies to induce overload are imposed. Fatigue can be increased over these two
-144.2 (fitness -fatigue= preparedness). Although the fitness level increased dueto days (accumulated fatigue) to induce acute fatigue, disrupt homeostasis and elicit
the load of the match, the preparedness dropped immediately following the match. performance enhancement. After these two days, a player will consequently have
The increased level of fatigue masks the increase in fitness. It is only after an ade- improved fitness, but his or her preparedness will decrease beca use of accun1ulated
quate recovery and a reduction training load that the increases fitness levels can fatigue.
be seen.
Match day + 5-6: During these two days, tapering strategies are imposed. The trai-
ning load is reduced through decreased training volume in particular.
FITNESS IN SOCCER
2s I Training models
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Training models l 29

Preparedness
Training load distribution
1l 120
..9 100
~
.se 80

.~ 'º
~
40

., 20

" o

of•º"
Days ofthe week

Fig. 2. 7: Training load distribution.

Fitness status Fig. 2.10: The evolution of preparedness over the lrainlng week. Preparedness drops alter the
match because of the fitness levei being masked by accumulated fatigue. Tapering stralegies are
used at the end of the week, causing the fatigue to dissipate and performance to increase again.

One of the n1ost important extensions to this model is the "specificity of fatigue."
This rneans each physical ability has its own fatigue and fitness curve. For exarnple,
\vhen training endurance, aerobic fitness will increase, but there will be a lirnited
(or even negative) effect on strength.

·--
Days of the week Specific fitness effect
., ,.<___- General htness
Fig. 2.8: An example of the evolution of fitness during the training week. Fitness increases slighfly '''·
' '~ ... .:.~-. Specífic fitness effect
during the week.
'.'. ~~~-:;;~:"""~·?::·::::::.~:·
Fatigue status
/
/
..,.,--- .~--- ---------:::.-_--
,,""
/ ,, " Specífic fatigue effect
1
350 ~--------~-----~---~~-
'ºº ·!-------------- /; '1t- "";>:,, Generill Prepilredness
] 250 - /I /
fI 'lt-"
-; 200 ·!---- !1 ,~
Specífic fatigue effect
~ 150 ·!---- ft / Generill fatigue
& 100 +---- ' ,
;;, ,'
so01-_
·1---
_
, 01'..'trnining
Preparedn!.'SS Is optimízed as
fitness levei is still h!gh but
F1tness increases but fatigue has dissipated
masked dueto
~ccumulated fatlgul'..'
Days ofthe week
Fig. 2. 11: A modified fitness~fatigue mo dei representing multiple types of fitness and fatigue
Fig. 2.9: The course of accumulated fatigue during a training week. Fatigue increases contlnuously aftereffects. The original model presented the effects of training as one fitness cuNe and one
dun'ng a training week (accumulated fatigue). This especia/fy occurs during the training days of fatigue cuNe. ln reality, however, there are specific training effects. Forexampfe, sprint lraining
Wednesday and Thursday, when training can be intense and lhe /oad can be high. lt is therefore induces different effects when compared to aerobic fitness training. Consequently, there appears
important to incorporate rest ora significantly reduced /oad (reduce duration of training) before to be specific windows for lhe adaptafion for each physical ability (Gamb/e, 2012). Particular acute
a game (tapering) to maximize lhe fitness effect ofthe lraining week (defayed transformalion of adaptive responses are described as being restricted and specific to lhe systems used in the
gains). training stimu/us, rather than a generic response (Chiu and Barnes, 2003).
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
Training models Training models

2.5 PERFORMANCE POTENTIAL MODEL


Su Mo Tu We Th Fr Sa Su
.... -· -·-. -· -·-. -·-. The fitness-fatigue rnodel has been recently criticized for its inability to predict per-
formance with accuracy, as well as for the fact that the model is poorly corrobora-
ted by physiological mechanisrns (Hellard et al., 2006). A different approach was
Fítness levei
taken by Perl (2001) with the development of the Performance-Potential (PerPot)
meta-model. This model studies the non-linear interaction between load and per-
formance and is based on the antagonistic concept of PerPot.

Load Rate (LR)

~ F11tigue ofter-effect Response-Potential


1 Training loJd
Overflow (RP)
Fitness levei
- - - - • Preparedness levei
--- F11tlgue leve!
+

Fig. 2.12: Fitness-fatigue effects during a microcycfe in soccer. The figure depicts the (accumulated) Performance-Potentíal (PP)
fitness and fatigue curves, the specific fitness and fatigue aftereffects of training, and the resufting
preparedness curve.

Fig. 2. 13: Modified and simpfified representation of the Petformance-Potentia! meta-mode/

ln this meta-model, the output (performance potential) is influenced by the input


load (training). This input load is controlled by two interna} buffer potentials:
the strain potential and the response potential. Both potentials are influenced
equally by training, and they affect performance in an antagonistic \vay. After cer-
tain delays, the response potential raises the performance potential and the strain
potential reduces the performance potential. The relationship between these delays
specifies the performance profile. An overflow pathway \Vas added to the basic
structure (Perl, 2004) to allO\V a breakdo\vn if the load over a period of titne beco-
mes too high. This overflo\V pathway reduces the performance potential with a
small delay. As was described in the fitness-fatigue model, the PerPot paran1eters
need to be adapted individually based on empirical data. ln contrast to the fit-
ness-fatígue model, only a few scientific studies has been conducted to validate
PerPot, although Hellard et al. (2006) postulate that the PerPot method appears to
be conceptually very rich.
FITNESS IN SOCCER
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Training models The physicaf demands of elite soccer match p/ay

SUMMARY
Training models help coaches to understand the training process and can be used
to design training programs. The supercompensation model helped explain why
performance improves after a period of rest, but this model has been replaced
over the last few decades by the more complete fitness~fatigue model. This model
enables coaches to make more accurate predictions about the impacts of their
training regimes. Preparedness is the combination of fitness and fatigue, and the
main aim of the soccer training program is to ensure the players are physically
fit and fatigue free on game day, so that they can cope with the imposed physical
demands of 90 minutes of competitive play. The physiological demands of soc- THE PHYSICAL DEMANDS
cer are discussed in detail in the next chapter.
OF ELITE SOCCER MATCH PLAY
Paul Bradley

3.1 INTRODUCTION
Time-motion analysis is a valuable data-collection technique used to quantify the
match performances of elite soccer players (Carling et al., 2008). Interest has sub-
stantially grown in this area over the last decade, because it enables sports scien-
tists to identify the current demands placed on players in competition and apply
the data to training and testing protocols (Bradley et al., 2011). This has been dri-
ven, above all, by the availability of new technologies that help further our know-
ledge of trai9-ing and testing modes to optimize soccer performance (Castellano et
al., 2011). One such technology regularly used in elite soccer involves semi-automa-
ted monitoring through video tracking, using systems from match analysis compa-
nies, such as Prozone® and Amisco®, to simultaneously track the movements of
ali players, the referee and the ball. This chapter therefore aims to detail the factors
that impact the physical demands of modem elite soccer \vith special reference to
position, gender, and standard, as well as contextual influences and fatigue.

REFERENCES
3.2 ACTIVITY PROFILE
Budgclt, R. \<)')S. fíltiguc and undcrpcrfonnancc in a!hlclcs: thc ovcrlrainini; ~.y~dromc. llr J Sporl,; Mcd, 32(2), pp.107':"1rn.
llompo, T.O., and Hafi, G., 200\I. l'criodiiat1on: thcory om! mcthodology o! trmmng. 5th cd., Champo1gn, !L: Humnn Kmct1c::, pA24. The activity profile of soccer is intermittent, with players regularly alternating bet-
C.nhlc, E, 1961, Thc Athlclc ,1nd Adaptalion loStrc!ls. Track Tcchniquc, 5, pp.1%-15$
Car!M, F., 1961. ScicnlificTrends in Trninini; thc Sportfiman. Tmck Tcclmiquc, 3, pp.&l·SS
ween brief bouts of high-intensity exercise and longer periods of low-intensity exer-
n.
Chiu, LZ.F. nnd 1mcs, j.L, 2003. Thc Fitncno--Fntiguc Modcl Rcvisilcd - !mplications for Plannmg Slrnrt- nnd Long-Tcrm Training. cise (Rampinini et al., 2007). During elite matches, players cover 9-14 km of distance
Strrngth nnd Condilioning )ou mal, 25(6), pp.·12·51
Folbrot, 19·11. ln: M C. Siff and Y.V. Vcrkhoohansky (1999). Suf"'rtrnming. (·llh cd.). Dcnvcr, CO, p.Sl in total, with high-intensity exercise accounting for 1-3 km of this (Bangsbo et al.,
G,1mblc, !'., 2012. Strength and Cond1tionini; lor Tcam Sporls Sport·Sf"'dÍlc Phy~ical l'wpamt1on for High l'crfonn.1nc.', Scrond Edition.
Abingdon: Routkgdc. . . . .. 1991; Bradley et al., 2009; Di Salvo et al., 2009; Mohr et al., 2003). This results in an
MalWJCV, L., 1964. Da 5 problcm der pcriodioicruni; dc1; :;portlichm trniníng' [Thc problcm of thc f"'ru.id1zatJon m sporls tr,10nmg].
Mo,cow. average intensity of approximately 70% of maximal oxygen uptake and elicits blood
Mohr, M., Krustrup, !', and Bang,bo,J_., 2005. Fatiguem soccc" a brid "'vicw, Joum,1! of sporl~ ocicnce•, 23(6). pp.S?J._599
Pfdlfrr. M., 2003. Mode!ing thc J<clahonr.lup botwccn Traming and l'crforman"-~A Companson of Two Antagomslic Conc.:pts. Jnt. J. lactate concentrations of 4-6 mmol/L (Mohr et al., 2005). However, expressing match
Comp. Sd. Sport, 7(2). _ . _ .
Perl,)., 2001. Pcrl'ol: a Mctomo<le! for simulahon oflo.1d pcrfonn,1nc.: inlcrachon. Elcclromc)oumol ofSportScicnc.:, 2. intensity as an average value disguises the unique physiological stress induced
Perl, J., 200·1. 1\ neural nctwork upproach to movcmcnt p.1t1cm analyoif.. Human Mo:·cmcnt Sc1cn.cc, 23, pp.60.5-620. during intense periods (Glaister, 2005). During these periods, heart rate (HR) can
Perl,) .. 2005. DynomicSimulolionof Performance Dcvc!opmcnl: l'"'diction nnd Opl1mal Schcduhng. tntcmahonaljouma! ofComputcr
Scicnc.: in Sport, 4(2), pp.28·37 exceed 95% of its maximum, and peak blood lactate concentrations can reach
Perl, J., 2006. Jntcrnction in Games; QualitMivc ,\noly~is by Mc.im; oi th" Load-Pcrforman"-~Mctamo<ld Pcrl'ot. lnlcmationa!joumul of
Computcr Scicnc.: inSpor!, 5(2). pp.38-11. 8-12 mmol/L (Ali and Farrelly, 1991; Bangsbo, 1994). During a typical English Pre-
Prokop, L and Rl>ssncr, F., 1959. Erfolg im Spo'.t:Thconc und l'r.1xis der L<.'i"l"ngsc.tcigcrung. H.S. Füdmgcr. _ _
Sclyc H., 1938. Exf"'rimcntal Evidcn,,.,Supportmg thc Conccption of"Adapt,1lion Encrgy." Am) Phy~iol, August.31123,(3), pp.158-:65. mier League match, players stand still for 6% of the total time. Low-intensity activity
Sc!yc H., 19·l6.111cGcncrnlAdaptalion Syndrnmc and lhe Dbca!;cs of Adaptation. Thc joumolofChmml Endocnnology & Mctabolrnm,
frbruary 16(2), pp.117-230. . . . ,
represents 85% of the total time, which comprises 59% walking and 26% jogging.
Stcinackcr, J.M. and Lchm,1nn, M., 2002. Chnlcal find 1 ng~ and mcchonism:; of olwt'5 and n:covery m n1hlcws. ln: Kcllmann, M., cd. 2002,
Enhandng "'rovcry; prcvcnting undcrl"'rformano.> in alhlctcs. Champ,1ign, ll: Human Kinctics, pp.103-118.
High-intensity activity represents 9% of the total time, which is broken down further
Yakovlcv N .. 1967. Sporlr. biochcmistry. Leipzig' Dcutche Hochr.chulc íür Kõrp<'kultur. into 6% running, 2% high-speed running, and 1% sprinting (Figure 3.1).
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
34 The physica/ demands of elite soccer match play 35
1 The physical demands of elite soccer match p/ay

3.3 POSITIONAL VARIATION


The large differences observed between various playing positions for the energetic 4000 111 lstHalf

and physical performance characteristics of elite players is one of the most robust 02ndHalf
3500 ~Total
findings from time-motion analysis studies (Di Salvo et al., 2009; Bradley et al.,
2009; Rampinini et al., 2007). When comparing the five most-common positions, it
3000
is clear that central and wide midfielders cover more total distance than any other g
position, with the wide midfielders and fullbacks also displaying superior high-in- m
e 2500
ê
tensity activity profiles (Bradley et al., 2009). The attackers and central defenders e
2
consistently sho\v the lo..vest physical performances during a game (Figure 3.2).
These findings have implications for developing position-specific training drills "
;;;
e
2000

that mimic the characteristics of each position by taking into consideration the uni- ~
~
1500
que tactical, technical and physical demands of various positions in the team (Di
Salvo et al., 2007). Thus, separate dril1s for each position can be constructed, eit- "'
~
1000
her as a rehabilitation tool or for isolated drills. However, conditioning simulation
drills in which all positions are worked together in unison with game- and posi- 500

tion-specific ball work are much more fruitful in the applied environment due to
player enjoyment and coach acceptance.
o
Central Defenders Fui! Backs Central Mdfie!ders Wide Mdfielders AUackers

Playlng Positlon
100%
'' ''
'' Fig. 3.2: Pbsitional variation in high·intensity running profiles during Eng/ish Premiar League
'' ' ' ' '' matches (Data from Bradley et ai., 2009).
80%
'' ' ' ' ''
'' ' ' '' ''
60%
'' ''
~ '' '' 3.4 COMPETITIVE STANDARD
'' '' Research has shown players ata higher standard of play to perform more high-in-
~ '' ''
1- 40% tensity running than their peers at lower standards (Bangsbo et al., 1991; Mohr et
al., 2008). For instance, Mohr et ai. (2003) found that elite Italian League players
performed 28% more high-intensity running than sub-elite Danish League peers.
20%
Similarly, Ingebrigtsen et al. (2013) reported that distance covered in high-intensity
running was 31-38% greater in players in top-ranking Danish teams when compa-
0% red with middle- and bottom-ranking Danish teams, Based on this data, one would
assume that the distances covered at high-intensity increase as we move up the
Playing Time Distance Covered
competitive standards, but this is not entirely correct. For instance, studies demon-
strate that players cover more total distance and perform more high-intensity run-
o High-lntensity Running ning when playing against higher-quality opponents in the sarne domestic league
" Sprinting (Castellano et ai., 2011; Di Salvo et ai., 2009; Rampinini et ai., 2007).
"' High-speed running
"' Running There are also no differences in the activity profiles of international players and
., Jogging those who play in the best domestic European leagues (Bradley et al., 2010). Thus,
"' Walking the relationship between competition standard and physical match performance is
" Standing more complex than we might initially think. Interestingly, English Premier League
players (top tier) cover less distance at high-intensity than Championship (middle
tier) and League 1 players (bottom tier) (Figure 3.3). Given there were no real dif-
Fig. 3. 1: Average values of different activities during English Premier League matches. Va/ues are ferences in the physical capacity of the players at each tier, it was concluded that
expressed both as a percent of total p/aying time and distance covered (Data from Bradley et ai.,
this trend was related to the style of play used in the lower tiers, with the Cham-
2009).
pionship and League 1 teams employing a more direct style of play while the Pre~
mier League teams used a more possession-based style. This tvas evidenced by
FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
FITNESS IN SOCCER 37
36 The physícal demands of elite soccer match p/ay
1 The physica/ demands of elite soccer match pfay

more successful passes in the Premier League and more long passes, headers, clea- Male Players Female Players
rances and interceptions in the lower tiers (Bradley et al., 2013a). Thus, it seems that
tactical variables and style of play have an influence on the distances covered by
elite players. It is important to note that while Premier League players cover shor- Physicalffechnical
ter match distances at high intensity, it does not necessarily mean the overall match lndicators First Second Total First Second Total
demands are markedly different than in the lower tiers, because Premier League High intensity (m) 1049 1063 2112 854 718 1571
players may display superior accelerations or decelerations and lateral movement
Time possession (s) 33.8 35.8 69.6 34.6 31.9 66.5
profiles that are metabolically taxing (Osgnach et ai., 2010).
Total balis lost (No.) 7.5 5.1 12.6 9.2 8.2 17.4
Successful passes (o/o) 78.1 80.1 79.4 72.0 70.4 71.5
1800
**
:§: Table 3. 1: Gender differences in physical and technical indicators for elite players in the UEFA
~ Champions League (data from Bradley et ai., 2013b).
·;;; 1200
e:
.l!le: 3.6 MATCH-TO-MATCH VARIABILITY ANO STABILITY
'T When players' match performances are analyzed across a season, it is very evident
.e that substantial differences exist between games. Mohr et al. (2003) reported that
:e"' 600
the hlgh-intensity running distances of elite players differed by approximately 10~~
between successive matches but it differed by 25% between different stages of the
"'"'
~

season using the coefficient of variation as the variability measure. Gregson et al.
> o (2010) also found that English Premier League players' high-intensity and sprint
EPL CH L1 profiles differed by 16-30% from one match to the next. The technical profiles of
Standard players seem to also illustrate similar differences, with the total number of passes
for English Premier League players differing by approximately 30-50% from match
to match (Bush et al., unpublished observation). This makes it very difficult for
Fig. 3.3: Very high-intensity running profi/es in the Eng/ish Premier League (EPL), Championship
(Ch) and League 1 (L 1) players. (Data from Bradley et ai., 2013a). sports scientists to evaluate the impact of various technical, tactical and physical
training interventions because of limited consistency in the performance measu-
res. Substantial match-to-match variability is less likely to be caused by changes in
3.5 GENDER DIFFERENCES
physical capacity, because this does not differ substantially in the short term, but it
The relative physiological loadings experienced during matches are similar for
could also possibly be dueto technical, tactical and contextual factors.
both genders, suggesting that the aerobic system is heavily taxed throughout mat-
ches, particularly during intense periods (Bangsbo, 1994; Krustrup et al., 2003, 2005,
2006, 2010; Mohr et al., 2004). Female players, however, seem to possess a lower
3.7 CONTEXTUAL ANO TACTICAL FACTORS
physical capacity than male players across a range of aerobic and anaerobic fitness
Research examining contextual factors-such as match status (i.e., win, lose or
tests (Bradley et al., 2011, 2012; Mujika et al., 2009). Thus, it is not surprising that
draw), location (i.e., home or away), levei of opposition (i.e., top, middle or bot-
studies have reported that high-intensity running in elite female matches is around
tom) and match half-demonstrates these have a real impact on the activity profiles
30% lower than that of their male counterparts ata similarly competitive standard
of elite players (Lago et al., 2012; Catellano et al., 2011). For instance, Castellano
with similar total distances (Krustrup et al., 2005; Mohr et al., 2008). Recently, Brad-
et al. (2011) found the distance covered when the ball was in play (effective play-
ley et al. (2013b) analyzed the gender differences in the match performance charac-
ing-time distance) in various movement categories to be greater when playing at
teristics for male and female players taking part in the UEFA Champions League.
home rather than away, as well as when the opposition team was losing and of a
They found that while male players covered just -2-5% more total distance than
higher competitive level. Other contextual factors, such as score line but not match
female players, they performed -30-35% more high-intensity running and had a
importance, also seem to be important factors in dictating physical performance.
superior technical performance {Table 3.1). This finding illustrates the importance
Bradley and Noakes (2013) observed that elite players covered similar high-inten-
of high-intensity running to the female game and the inferior anaerobic capabilities
sity running distances in matches with differing score lines, but position-specific
of female players vvhen compared to elite male players. Practical applications are
trends indicated that central defenders performed 17% less high-intensity running
clear, and this suggests that elite female players may possibly benefit from speci-
and attackers 15% more during matches that were decisively \Von when compared
fic high-intensity aerobic and speed endurance training in the form of small-sided
to matches that were lost. However, high-intensity iunning distances were com-
games or generic running drills (Ade et al., 2013).
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
The physical demands of elite soccer match play 39
The physical demands of elite soccer match play

parable over matches of differing importance (e.g., games linked to relegation or There are also temporary declines after intense periods of match play that are rela-
promotion and local derbies), but tren<ls between halves indicated that declines ted to depletions in muscle creatine phosphate, changes in intramuscular acidosis,
only occurred in the second half of criticai matches when compareci to matches of or the accumulation of potassium in the muscle interstitium (Krustrup et al., 2006).
less importance. Altematively, some suggest that reductions in match running performance could
be caused by players employing conscious or subconscious pacing strategies aimed
Tactical factors, such as the playing formation, also seem to be an influential fac- at successfully completing the match (Bradley and Noakes, 2013). Although this is
tor on the physical performance of elite players. For instance, no differences were an attractive hypothesis, there is limited data to support or reject such a statement.
found in the overall physical profiles of players playing in 4-4-2, 4-3-3 and 4-5-1 for- Carling and Bloomfield (2010) observed how teams coped with an early player dis-
mations, but high-intensity running with ball possession in offensive and orthodox missal by sparing low-intensity activity in an attempt to preserve essential high-in-
formations was approximately 30-40% higher than it was in defensive formations tensity running, and this possibly suggests pacing or modified tactics. If players
(i.e., 4-3-3 and 4-4-2 vs. 4-5-1). ln contrast, around 20% more distance was covered pace their efforts, then only covering "low" to "moderate" distances in the first half
at high-intensity without possession in defensive formations when compared to enables them to have the available capacity to maintain match running performan-
offensive and orthodox formations (Bradley et al., 2011). This coincided with the ces in the second half. Although, some studies have established this, it is important
lowest bali possession for the defensive forrnation when compared to the offensive to realize that other factors could be responsible for these findings (Bradley and
and orthodox forrnations (44% vs. 50%), so ball possession could have been a fac- Noakes, 2013; Rampinini et al., 2007).
tor. This clearly indicates the complexity of match play, and sports scientists and It seems players don't really tax their full physical capacity during matches, but
coaches need to consider various contextual and technical factors before making they certainly do during intense periods when they perform a flurry of high-in-
inferences from the time-motion data supplied by match analysis companies. tensity bouts with minimal recovery, such as during the peak five-minute period.
If you observe the following five-minute period, you will typically see it is 8-12%
below the game mean, possibly indicating temporary fatigue (Figure 3.4). The prac-
3.8 FATIGUE DURING MATCH PLAY tical application of these findings is that sports scientists should condition players
Research demonstrates that physical perfor- to be able to cape with multiple bouts of intense actions with speed endurance
mance declines between the first and second drills in small-sided games or with a generic drill format (Ade et al., 2013). Typi-
halves of elite match play (Oi Salvo et ai., cally, speed endurance maintenance training would be best for this, and coaches
2009; Mohr et al., 2003), although others only should employ exercise bouts with a varied duration (e.g., 30-90 seconds) with
observe minimal differences (Bradley et al., reduced rest periods (e.g., 1-3 times the exercise duration) across 6-12 repetitions.
2013a). Reductions in match running per- Research recommends this type of training to enhance the players' capacity to sus-
formance in the second half, or temporarily tain high-intensity actions and recover from intense periods (Bangsbo, 1994; laia
after the most intense period, could be attri- and Bangsbo, 2010).
buted to fatigue (Bradley et al., 2009; Ben-
diksen et al., 2012; Di Mascio and Bradley, .§,
2013; Krustrup et al., 2006), pacing strategies
(Bradley and Noakes, 2013), ar contextual
..•
o 300
variables (Lago et al., 2012). They could also ""•e. 250
e
be related to the time the ball is out of play "ê
and the available opportunities to engage in ' 200
match activities (Carling and Dupont, 2011). .s"'
Although each factor has the potential to
impact the physical performances of elite
.."
e
e
150

players, match-índuced fatigue seems evident, because physical capacity markedly


•• 100

declines after matches in comparison to baseline measures (Krustrup et al., 2010; .f'• 50
Mohr et al., 2004). Thus, fatigue results in an inability to repeatedly cover distances •• o
~
during criticai situations, and it could also reduce technical capabilities that are 1 Pc:ik 5-min Ncxt5-min Fin:il 5-min Mcan5-min
important indicators of match outcome (Rampinini et al., 2009). Down regulation .!!
~
of running performance in the second half could be attributed to fatigue because Timc(min}
studies have reported depleted muscle glycogen stores at the end of a match (Ben-
diksen et al., 2012; Krustrup et al., 2006). Fig. 3.4: The most intense period of English Premier League matches and the drop in performance
in the fol/owing five-minute period when compared to the mean five-minute period.
FITNESS IN SOCCER
FITNESS IN SOCCER
The physical demands of elite soccer match play The physical demands of elite soccer match play

SUMMARY REFERENCES
Ade,/., Harlc}~J. and Br.1dley, P.S. (in revicw). Thc Physiological Rcsponw, limc-Motion Chor«Ctcriotic; and Rcproducib1lity ofVarious
During elite matches, players cover 9-14 km of distance in total, with high-in- Spced Enduran<:<> Drills in Elite Youth S-Occer Player:;: Sma!! Sidcd Gam!.'S vs Gcncric Running. !ntJ Sports l'hy and Pcrf.
Ali, A. and l'mwlly, M .. 1991. Rccording soccer playcr:/ hcJrt rat~'S during malches. J SporlsSci, 9, pp.183-189.
tensity rnovement accounting for 1-3 km. Central and wide midfielders typically Biing,bo, J., 1994. Tiie phyr.iology of socccr--with spccial referen<:<> lo inte""" inlcrmitlcnt cxcn:is?. Acta Physiol Scand Suppl, 619,
pp.1-155.
run more total distance than all other positions, with the wide midfielders and Banr;'>bo, )., Norresaard, L and Thor:;o, F., 1991. Aclivity profilc oi rompctítion wc<:<>r. CanJ Sport Sei, 16, pp.110-116.
B~ndikscn, M., Bi~choff, ll, Randers, M.B. Mohr, M .. Hollo, J., Suctta, C, Bangsbo,J. and Krustrup P., 2012. Thc Copcnhagcn S-OccerT,.,t
fullbacks also displaying superior high-intensity activity profiles. Central defen- physiologica! respons~ and fatigue dcvclopment. Mcd Sd Sports E><erc, 4-1. pp.1595-1603
ders tend to exhibit the lowest physical performances during a game. However, Bradlcy, P.S .. Dendlks.cn, M., Ddfal, A., Mohr, M., Wllkie, A., Datson, N., Omtofl, C., Z,,.bio, M., Gomez-Diaz, A., Bangsbo, J. and Kruslrup,
P., 2012. Thc Application of lhe Yo-Yo lnlcrmittcnt Enduran<:<> Levei 2 Tcst to Elite Fcmalc Socccr Popufatioru;. S<:,1nd J Mcd Sei Sport:;.
the physical profiles of players in various competitive standards are influenced E-pub ahcad of print
Bradlcy, P.S., Carlini;. C., An:hcr, D., Robert:;,)., Doddo, A., Oi Moocio, M., Paul, D., Di:iz, A.G., Pcart, D., omd Kruotrup, !~, 2011. Thc
by the technical, tactical, and physical aspects of the game. For instance, in the dfcct of playing formation on high-intcnsily running and tcchnical profilcs in Enslish FA P"'micr Lcaguc soccer matchco. J Sport~ So,
29, pp.821-1130.
English game, lower-tier teams use a more direct style of play compared to the Bradlcy, P.S., Carlin& C, Gomez Diai, A .. Hood, P., BamCi', C., Ade,J., Doddy, M., Krustrup, P. and Mohr, M., 2013a. Match pcrformon<:<>
and physic.~! c,1pacity of playcr.; in lhe top lhrl'e competi tive standard~of Engfüh profcwional oocrcr. Hum Mov Sei, 32, pp.808-821
top-tier teams, and this results in more distance covered at high intensity. The Bradlcy, P.S., Dclla!, A., Mohr, M., Cas!cllano, J. and Wilkie, A., 2013b. Gendcr diffo"'""'' in match p<!rformance charactcris!irn of socccr
plarcr.; rompcling in the UEFA Champions Lcaguc. Hum Mov Sd, [E-pub ahcad of print].
distance covered by players is also influenced by match location, opposition Bradley, P.S., Di Maseio, M., Pcart, D., Olscn, P. and Shcldon, D., 2010. High-in!cnr.ity ac!i;·ity prolil"" of elite so«er playcrs ai diffcnmt
standard, score line and game half. Substantial match-to-match variability is performance levelr.. / Strenglh Cond Rcs, 24, pp.23.\3-2351.
Bradlcy, P.S., Mohr, M., Bcndikscn, M., R.1ndcrs, M.D., Flind~ M., B.im.,,,, C., Hood, P., Gom~z, A., Andersen, J.L, Di Masdo, M., Uangobo,
evident in the physical and technical performance measures for elite soccer. This J. and Krustrup, P., 20ll. Sub-maximal and maximal Yo-Yo intcrmiltcnt enduran<:<> tc:;t leve! 2: he.trl rate reoporu;e, n:producibility and
applkation to elite socccr. Eur J App! Physiol, 111, 969-978.
is unlikely to be due to changes in physical. capacity, but it could possibly be Bradlcy, P.S. and Noakcs, T.D., 2013. Match running performance fiucluations in elite soccer: indicati\'C of fatigue, pacing or situational
influcnces? JSporls Sd, 31, pp.1627-1638
caused by technical, tactical and contextual factors. Finally, reductions in match Bradlcy, l'.S., Shcldon, W., Wooolcr, B., Ols<.n, P., lloanas, I'. and Krustrup, P., 2009. High-intcnsity running in English FA Premier Lcaguc
wccer malchc~. / Sporu Sd, 27, pp.159-168.
running performance in the second half, or temporarily after the most intense Carlin& C. and Bloomfidd,J., 2010. The cifre! of an carly dismisoal on playcr work-ratc in a profcsoional socrcr match. JSei Mcd Sport,
period, could be attributed to pacing strategies, contextual variables, and deple- 13, pp.126-128.
Carling. C., Bloomficld, J., Nc!scn, L. and Rcilly, T., 200$. Thc role of motion analysin in elite ~occer: contcmporary pcrforman<:<> mcJEu·
ted muscle glycogen levels. Good nutritional practice may help to attenuate the remcnt lcchniqucs and work '"te data. Sporls Mcd, 38, pp.839-862.
Culini;. C. and DuponL G., 20!1. Are declines in physic.il performance asoocialcd with a reduction in skill-relatcd performance during
decrement in running performance in U1e second half of matches. The impor- profc5sional soccer match-play? J Sporls Sei, 29, pp.63-71
C.1.1tcllano, J., Blanw-Villascnor, A and Alvarez, D., 2011. Contextual variabl.,; and timc-mo!ion analyois in wc<:<>r. lnl J Sports Med,
tance of nutrition in soccer is discussed in the following chapter. 32, 415-421.
Di Mascio, M. and Dradlcy, P.S., 2013. Evaluation of thc most inlc"'5C high·intcnsity running pcriod in Engli~h FA premier lcar;uc w=r
match.,;. J Slrength Cond Rcs, 27, pp.909-915.
Di S.11\-0, V., Baron, R., Tschan, H., Caldcron Monlero, F.J., Dachl. N. and Pigoui, F., 2007. Pcrforman<:<> charilcleri&tics acrording to plar-
ing position in elite soccer. !nt / Sporu Mcd, 28, pp.222-227.
Di Salvo, V,, Gregson, W., Atkinson, G., Tordoff, !~ and Drust, B., 2009, Analysis oi high intcn~ity achvily in Premicr Lcague socccr. lnt
J Spmts Mcd, 30, pp.205-212.
Glaislcr, M., 2005. Mu!hple sprint work: physio!ogkal rcsponscs, mcchanisms oi fatigue and lhe influcnce of acrobk fitnem. Sporffi
Med, 35, pp.757-m.
Gn.'gSOn, W., Drust, B.,Alkinson, G, <md Salvo., V.D., 2010. Match-to-match variabilityof higlHp<!Cd nct1vili"" in pNmicr lcaguesoccer.
lnl J Sports Mcd, 31, pp.237-2·12.
faiíl, F.M. and 6.1ngobo, /,, 2010. Spccd cnduran<:<> training is a powcrful stimulus for phyoiological adaptations and p4.'rforman"' impro·
vcmcnl~ of '1thlctcs, SClnd J Med Sei Sports, 20(Suppl 2), pp.11·23
lngcbrigtscn,)., Bcndikscn, M., Rnndcro, M.B., Dstagnn, C, Kru5lrup, P. and Hollcrmnnn, A., 2012. Yo-Yo IR2 l!.'Sting of elite and sub·
elite soc<:<>r playcrs: pcrformanct'. hcart rate rcsponsc and rorrelations to othcr intcrval lcst>. J Sports Sei, 30, pp.1337-1345.
Krustrup, P., Mohr, M., Amstrup, T., Rysgaard, T., JohanS<'n, J.. Stccnsbcrg. A., Pcdcrocn, P.K. '1nd D.1ng5bo, J., 2003. Thc yo-yo intcrmil·
tcnt rerovcry tcst: physiological rcsponw, reliability, '1nd valid1ty. Mcd Sei Sporn fucrc. 35, pp.697·i05
Krw;trup, P., Mohr, M., E11ing~gaard, H. and Banr;sbo, L 2005. Physical dcm'1nds during an chie fomale soccer game: importan<:<> oi
tralnins status. Mcd Sd Sports Excr.:, 37, pp,1242-1248.
Kruotrup, !'., Mohr, M., Slccnsberg. A, llcnch, J., Kjacr, M. and Dangsbo, )., 2006. Musclc and blood mclabo!itcs during a soccer g,1mc:
implications for sprint performance. Mcd Sei Sporls Exerc, 38, pp.1165-l174
Krw;trup, P., Zcbio, M., Jcru;cn, J.M. and Mohr, M., 2010. Gamc-mduccd fot•guc pattcms in elite fcmale toccer. / Stn:nglh Cond Rcs, 2.J,
pp.437-141.
L.1go-Pcn"--S, C, 2012. The role of situational variablcs in analysing physical performance in soc<:<>r. J Hum Kinet,35, pp.89·95
Mohr, M., Krustrup, P. and llang~bo,J,, 2003. Matd> J"'rformance ofhigh-standard "occcr playcrs withspccial refcrcn<:<> lo dewlopmcnl
of fatigue. J Sports Sei, 21, pp.519-526
Mohr, M., Krustrup., P, and Bangsbo, )., 2005. Fatigue insocrcr: a brief revicw.J Sporw Sei, 23, pp.593-599
Mohr, M., Kruolrup, P., Andcrs.:;on, H., Kirkcndal, D. and llangsbo, J., 2008. Malcl1 ac!ivitics of e!ite womcn wcccr playcr.; at dificrenl
pcrforman<:<> lcvcls.J Strength Cond Rcs22, pp.341-349.
Mohr, M., Kru~trup, P., Nybo, L, Niclscn, J.J. and llange,bo, )., 2004. Musde lcml"'mture and ~prinl pcrforman<:<> during socccr mat-
ch1..-s-bcncfieial cfícct of re-warm-up at half-timc, Scand J Mcd Sei Sporls, 14, pp.156-162.
Mujib, 1., Sanliotcb.1n, J., !mpclliucri, F.M. and C.1,;tugno, C., 2009, Filncso dctcrminanto of oucccss in mcn's and women's footboll. J
Sports Sd, 27, pp.107-11.J.
Oq;nach, C, Poscr, S., Bcmardini, R., Rinaldo, R. and di PramJ"'ro, P.E., 2010. Encrgy coõt and metabolic power in elite Goc.xr- a ncw
matcl1 analyr.is approach. Mcd Sei Sports Excrc, 42, pp.170-173.
Rampinin~ E., Cou!ls, A.J-, C.1ot~gnn, C., Sar"3i, R. and lmp<!lfüzcri, F.M., 2007. Variation in top leve! soc~r mnlch performance. Jnt J
Sports />.fod, 28, pp.1018- lOU.
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
42 Nutrition
1 The physical demands of elite soccer match play

NUTRITION
Jean-Pierre Meert, Sally Hora, David Tenne~ Jan Van Winckel

4.1 INTRODUCTION
Nutrition can significantly influence a soccer player's health and athletic perfor-
mance. Most athletes realize that food choices are important, but many underesti-
mate just how much of an impact the right dietary choices can have on success in
their sport. Good nutrition cannot replace talent, skill, or physical training, but it
can support and enhance all of these. When elite players compete, the small details
often make the difference between a win and a loss. Diet is one such detail. The
foods athletes choose for training and competition will affect their ability to train
and compete. While attention is often given to the composition of pre-match meals,
the everyday training diet is at least as important. A good diet helps promote adap-
tation to training, resulting in greater improvements for the sarne training load
and/or skills practiced. It also provides nutrients to support the immune system,
aid in post-exercise recovery, minimize injuries, and expedite recovery from inju-
ries. There are many opinions about the best way for athletes to eat, but ultimately,
nutrition is a science rather than an opinion. The emerging field of sports nutrition
involves an understanding ofbiochemishy, bioenergetics, endocrinology, and exer-
cise science that guides dietary recommendations to help optimize sport perfor-
mance and associated health parameters.

4.2 ENERGY
What is energy? Simply put, energy is the capacity to do work. Food contains
energy, which is ultimately used to power physical activity. Energy is generally
measured in joules (J), where 1 joule is defined as the energy used to move 1 kilo-
gram (kg) a distance of 1 meter (m) with a force of 1 Newton (N). However, the
energy in food is usually measured in calories. A calori e (cal) is defined as the
amount of heat needed to raise the temperature of 1 gram (g) of water by 1 degree
Celsius (ºC). ln practice, ldlocalories are typically used (kcal or Cal). One kcal or
Cal is equal to 1,000 cal. The conversion of kilojoules (kJ) to kilocalories is dane by
dividing the value in kJ by 4.2.

1 kcal =1 Cal = 1,000 cal


1 kj = 1,000) Example: 1,000 kj 238 kcal
kcal = kj / 4.2
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
Nutriiion Nutrition

4.2.1 Energy Requirements 4.2.2 Metabolism


Soccer is an intermittent, high-inten- To determine an athlete' s energy requirements, we must start by assessing the base-
sity sport with a high energy expendi- line energy needs. Basal metabolic rate (BMR) is the minimum level of energy requi-
ture. It is characterized by short bursts red to sustain the vital functions of the human body and regulate body temperature
of high-intensity activity combined with when awake. A person' s BMR is influenced by age, gender, weight, diet, exercise
intermittent bouts of rest or low-inten- and ambient temperature. BMR is calculated based on a person's oxygen consump-
sity aerobic activity (e.g., walking or jog- tion. When resting, the body consumes about 0.3 liters of oxygen per minute and
ging). Studies estimate the average heart bums a mixture of (mostly) carbohydrates (CHOs) and fat as fuel. Although the
rate of players during a match to be average non-athlete burns around 2,000 kcal per day, figures over 10,000 kcal/ day
approximately 85% of maximum heart have been measured in elite athletes. Beyond the kcal needed for vital functions,
rate (HRm~J, with a corresponding respi- additional energy is needed for the activities of daily life and physical exercise.
ration of 70-75% maximum oxygen con- When added to the BMR, this is referred to as the active metabolic rate (AMR) and
sumption (V02mnJ· This suggests that represents the total number of kcal burned on a typical day.
average exercise intensities are around Severa! formulas have been developed to estimate BMR values. The equation most
the lactate threshold, with periods above widely accepted to be the most accurate is the Mifflin-St Jeor Equation (kcal/ day}:
and below this threshold during high
energy bursts and recovery periods, res-
pectively. This indicates that the energy Male: (9.99 x weight) + (6.25 x height) - (4.92 x age) + 5
demands are high, so attention must be Female: (9.99 x weight) + (6.25 x height) - (4.92 x age) - 161
given to supplying adequate fuel for
h·aining and competition. It has been 1.veight in kilogranis, height in centi1neters, age in years
estimated that professional male soccer
players expend about 1,500 kcal per match. Energy expenditure for female players
has been estimated at approximately 1,100 kcal per match. This gender difference is When possible, it is always best to use measured BMR values because studies sug-
due in part to smaller body mass and differences in body composition, but it is also gest that calculated values may underestimate the energy expenditure of trained
likely linked to ·a greater tendency by female athletes to significantly under-fuet athletes. This is likely due to higher than average muscle mass and physiological
suggesting their performance may become more compromised as the game pro- adaptations to training.
gresses because of fatigue caused by low fuel availability. Indeed, with both male
and female players, one of the most common nutritional errors is under-fueling, The quantity of energy calculated for BMR is multiplied by an activity factor to
resulting in early fatigue, decreased performance, and increased errors and inju- account for relevant daily activity:
ries. The total energy requirement for each player is unique and a combination of
the requirements of the basal metabolic rate, the thermal effect of food, the thermal
effect of activity, and in some instances, growth (Burke et al., 2006). Very low BMR * 1.3 Low BMR * 1.6 Moderate BMR * 1.7 High BMR * 2.1

4.2.1.1 A soccer player's energy consumption


A player's energy expenditure can be expressed in an equation that includes the ln most cases, a player's daily activity levei outside of the sport can be described as
following elements: light. Energy needs can thus be estimated by BMR (using the Mifflin-St Jeor Equa-
tion above) and then multiplying the result by an activity factor of 1.3. The kcals
1. Resting metabolic rate (RMR), which consists of the basal metabolic rate associated vvith sporting activities are then added.
(BMR) and the sleep metabolic rate (SMR)
2. Thermal effect of food (TEF) The energy requirements for sporting activities can be calculated separately using
3. Energy expenditure for activities of daily living or the thermal effect of the metabolic equivalent (MET) values. One metabolic equivalent (MET) is defined as
activities concemed the metabolic rate for someone at rest sitting quietly in a chair (which corresponds
4. Energy for the player's sporting activities. to approximately 3.5 ml 0 2 /kg/min). The MET value for soccer is generally accep-
ted to be 10.3 (kcal/kg/hr), but it may be higher in some elite athletes.
The energy expenditure for an activity is calculated using the following equation:
(kg body wt) x (MET value) x (hours of activity) = kcal for activity
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
Nutrition Nutrition

Example: For a 20-year-old rnale athlete who is 185 cm tall and weighs 80 kg 4.3.1 Carbohydrates (CHO)
• Mifflin-St Jeor Equation
(9.99 x 70) +(6.25 x 185 cm)- (4.92 x age)+ 5 4.3.1.1 Varieties
= 799.2 + 1156.25 - 98.4 = 1857.05 kcal/ day (calculated BMR) CHOs are composed of carbon, hydrogen and oxygen. Their only function is to
• Activity factor to allow for activities of daily living provide a continuous source of energy to cells.
(1857.05 kcal/ day) x 1.3 = 2414.2 kcal/ day They are classified based on the number of saccharides (sugar molecules) or their
• Add in energy needs for 90 minutes of training or game degree of polymerization.
(80 kg) x (10.3 MET) x (1.5hr)=1,236 kcal dueto sportíng activity
• Total energy requirement per day = 1. Monosaccharides: glucose, fructose and galactose. These single-molecule sugars
(2,414.2 kcal) + (1,236 kcal) = 3,650.2 kcal/ day are the basic units of all CHOs.

2. Disaccharides: sucrose, lactose and maltose. These contain two sugars attached
4.3 SUBSTRATE UTILIZATION ANO MACRONUTRIENT NEEDS to each other. The well-known sucrose, used on a daily basis as table sugar, con-
There are four sources of energy in the human diet. tains a glucose molecule and a fructose molecule.
1. CHOs Sucrose =glucose+ fructose (table sugar)
2. fats Lactose = glucose + galactose (milk sugar)
3. proteins Maltose = glucose + glucose
4. alcohol
3. Oligosaccharides are short chains of three to ten monosaccharides linked
Energy value of the various nutrition components: together. These are commonly found in dried beans and peas (legumes).
1 g of CHO 16 k) or4 kcal
lgoffat 37kjor9kcal 4. Polysaccharides are polymers derived from glucose. These are chains of tenor
1 g of protein 17 k) or 4 kcal more monosaccharide units linked together. There are short-chain (10-15 mono-
1 g of alcohol 23 k) or 7 kcal saccharide units) products, which are used in sports drinks, obtained through
the enzymatic breakdovvn of starch and other long-chain products. Starch is
CHOs and fats are the prima1y sources of energy for metabolic processes. While the form in which CHOs are stored in plants. Most starches can be easily bro-
protein can supply energy, it is not its primary function. Protein (or its subcompo- ken down in people's intestines via enzymes, but a subcategory, referred to as
nents, amino acids) are the building blocks of cells, so the body prioritizes them resistant starch, is more difficult to digest. Resistant starch can be defined as any
as an available substrate for building and starch that escapes digestion in the small intestine and passes to the Iarge inte-
repairing muscles and other tissues. Under stine for fermentation by the microflora residing there. Some starches that can
normal resting conditions, protein only con- be broken down are made resistant by the way they are treated. For example,
tributes 10% or less of the body's total energy. baked potatoes that are kept in the refrigerator become resistant. There are hvo
However, the body is resourceful, and it will forms: amylose, a linear chain of glucose molecules, and amylopectine, a highly
use whatever is available for fuel, so if there branched chain of monosaccharides. There are also non-starch forms, such as
is limited CHO available, the body will burn cellulose, pectins and gums. These are classified as fibers and cannot be digested
a higher percentage of protein and fat as fuel. by humans, but they can be beneficial in regulating bowel function and blood
Since fat cannot be used as fuel under anae- cholesterol levels.
robic conditions, this means a greater percen-
tage of protein is used for fuel when CHO is
limited during intense exercise. The source
of that protein is either muscle catabolism or
free amino acids, which will then be unavaila-
ble for muscle repair and recovery. A player
whose diet is inadequate in CHOs will the-
refore have compromised performance and
recovery.
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
Nutrítion Nutrition

4.3.1.2 Properties 4.3.1.3 G/ycemic índex and glycemic load


CHOs are energy providers. This is their main function. Monosaccharides and The glycemic index (GI) is a means of identifying the relative rate at which various
disaccharides are sometimes referred to as simple sugars. They are typically sweet types of CHOs are converted to blood glucose when consumed (Table 4.1). The clo-
and often used for taste and stimulating appetite. Fructose is the sweetest, with ser this figure is to 100), the more quickly the blood sugar will rise after the CHO is
sucrose, glucose, maltose and lactose in decreasing arder of sweetness. consumed. CHOs with a high GI are absorbed quickly and can therefore be inge-
sted during physical exertion.
Because simple sugars are easily digested and quickly absorbed into the blood The term "glycemic load" was introduced in recent years to describe the relative
stream, they are also described as fast sugars, and they are especially useful where glycemic response of a normal portion. For example, 50g of glucose has a higher
sugar is needed immediately to help increase or maintain blood sugar leveis. Thus, glycemic load than 50g of carrots. The values used for this are 1-10 for a low load,
they can provide a quick and easily digested fuel source during sporting activity 11-20 for a medium load and more than 20 for a high load.
as well a~ aid in glycogen repletion and provide a fuel source for post-exercise
recovery.
Glycemic Glycemic
Oligosaccharides and polysaccharides are collectively known as complex CHOs, Serving size
index (glucose load per
(g)
and these are slower to digest and absorb into the blood stream. Because of this, Food = 100) serving
they provide a more gradual and sustained rise in blood glucose than an equivalent Bakery products and breads
amount of simple sugars. These are primarily the starches. They also have impor-
Baguette, white, p!ain 95 30 15
tant roles in sports nutrition:
0 They have an important part in glycogen recovery: 8-10 g of CHO per kg of White wheat f!our bread 71 30 10
body weight per 24 hours. Whole wheat bread, average 71 30 9
o They help in the immediate recovery after a match or training session: possi- Wheat tortil!a 30 50 8
bly replenishing lg per kg oi body weight.
Beverages
0 3-4 hours before a match: 4 g of CHO per kg
o During physical exertion: 30-60 g of CHO per hour (can be a combínation of Coca Colaº, average 63 250 mL 16
simple CHOs and easily digested complex CHOs, as tolerated by individual Fanta0 , orange soft drink 68 250 mL 23
athletes). Apple juice, unsweetened, average 44 250 mL 30
Gatorade 78 250 mL 12
Orange juice, unsweetened 50 250 mL 12
Breakfast cereais and related products
120 +-"\-------;<r-------:;;:--------
l 100 t-··-',-·-·---;;/'C---'~--·-···-,"'-·-'1---·---··-;?''-­ Cornflakes ™, average
Muesli, average
93
66
30
30
23
16
~ aot--~·~-,'-----\---,'----\c---7'~--
Í 60·~-~'.:::::::::::::'.',,~-""~---.'\,L___ -e-10% c~rbohydrate

-2-40% C3rbohydratc dict


diet Special Km (Kel!ogg's) 69 30 14
o
J 40J------------',-~"~"'"-"~----c0?\-· Couscous, average
White rice, average
65
89
150
150
9
43
,, .1----------------CY.•""':.____
Tr~!ning sesslons of 2 hours Quick cooking white basmati 67 150 28
Brown rice, average 50 150 16
Oays
Dairy products and alternatives

Fig. 4. 1: GHO reserves Mi!k, full fat 41 250mL 5


CHO rese1Ves in lhe form of g/ycogen in the musc/es. ln the case of a low-GHO diet, a series of
training sessions will lead to depletion of the musc/e glycogen. A high-GHO diet will maintain the
Reduced-fat yogurt with frui!, average 33 200 11
musc/e glycogen reserves at an acceptabfe levei. Fruits
Apple, average 39 120 6
Banana, ripe 62 120 16
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
501 Nutrítion Nutrition

Beans and nuts 4.3.2 Fat


The FATmax zone is the zone where energy is provided primarily by the oxidation
Baked beans, average 40 150 6
of fat. This zone is located between 55% and 70% of V0 2max or between 65% and
Cashews, salted 27 50 3 75% of the HRm,,x· This zone varies considerably between individuals.
Peanuts, average 7 50 o It is flawed to claim that the best way of burning fat is through long, monotonous
Pasta and noodles endurance training. A well-trained athlete burns approximately 220 kcal during
32 180 15 a 30-minute run at 50% of V0 2mJx· If the sarne person ran at 75%, he or she would
Fettucini, average
then burn 330 kcal. At 50% of V02 max' 50% is produced by the burning of fat, while
Macaroni, average 47 180 23
the equivalent figure at 75% of V0 2 m~x is 33%. This means that the sarne amount of
Spaghetti, white, boiled, average 46 180 22 fat is bumed in both cases (i.e., 50% of 220 kcal and 33% of 330 kcal, resulting in
Spaghetti, white, boi!ed 20 min, average 58 180 26 110 kcal being consumed from buming off fat in both cases). However, the more
Spaghetti, wholemeal, boiled, average 42 180 17 intensive workout at 75 % of VO~ consumes another 220 kcal from other sources.
This means the more intensive ~~;k.out will burn more kcal than the low-intensity
Snack foods
exercise, but it will utilize different energy substrates. Additionally, not all fat bur-
Corn chips, plain, sa!ted, average 42 50 11 ned as a result of exercise is burned during exercise. While CHO may be the pri-
Microwave popcorn, plain, average 55 20 6 mary fuel used during high-intensity exercise, fat is a significant source of energy
51 50 12 during post-exercise recovery when ample oxygen is available.
Potato chips, average
Vegetables
4.3.2.1 Dietary Fats
Green peas, average 51 80 4 Fats are an important part of a well-balanced diet and have many crucial functions
Carrots, average 35 80 2 in the body. They are components for cell membranes, hormones, and of the myelin
82 150 21 sheath that protects nerve cells. Fats are also necessary for temperature regulation,
Boiled white palato, average
shock absorption, and the transportation and absorption of fat-soluble vitamins (A,
Miscellaneous
D, E, andK).
Hummus {chickpea sa!ad dip} 6 30 o Fat can be used as a fuel during physical exercise and is a significant source of fuel
Pizza, plain baked dough, served with for physical exertion of a moderate to low intensity (<60% vo2mil) and long dura-
80 100 22
parmesan cheese and tomato sauce tion (> 30 minutes).
The utilization of fat as an energy substrate requires adequate oxygen, so it is only
Table 4. 1: ilfnternational tab/es of glycemic index and g/ycemic foad values: 2008" by Atlrinson et ai. a significant source of fuel under aerobic conditions. During high-intensity, anae-
(2008) robic activity, there is insufficient oxygen for fat to be oxidized. Other factors that
affect the body's ability to use fat as a fuel include the nun1ber of mitochondria in
the muscle cells and the ratio of different types of muscle fibers. Type I muscle tis-
sue tends to store more triglycerides than type II muscle tissue.
Recovery
4.3.2.2 Saturated and unsaturated fatty acids
_25~----------------

í~
Dietary fats are typically differentiated by their positive or negative effects on our

~ .:t;-~<;-%
\a:J±Filli
~ o -'------------------
'\- ~ '\.O '?O r,,..O .:.,O õ'l:t~<,
-@-Carbohydrate diet

--:~::;~"Fat and protein diet


health. When consumed in excess, saturated fats and trans fats are believed to have
detrimental effects on blood cholesterol levels, possibly contributing to high LDL
cholesterol, cardiovascular disease, and inflammation. With the exception of tropi-
cal oils such as coconut oil and palm oil, most saturated fats come from animal
sources and are relatively solid at room temperature. Examples include butter,
cheese, lard, and fats found in meat and poultry. Trans fats, also known as hydro-
,,.* " genated fats, are found primarily in processed foods. Monounsaturated fats are
considered to belong to the group of "good fats," because they are believed to have
Hours recovery a positive effect on cardiovascular health and blood cholesterol. Monounsahtra-
ted fatty acids are found in olive oil, avocados, and nuts. Omega-3 fatty acids are
Fig. 4.2: Effect of diet and the recovery of musc/e g/ycogen reserves after a two-hour training another beneficial dietary fat. They are believed to help regulate blood cholesterol,
session decrease inflammation, and stabilize moods and brain health. Additionally, there is

FACULDADF OE DESPORTO
DA UNIVERSIDADE DO PORTO
FITNESS IN SOCCER
f ITN ESS 1N SOCCER Nutrition
sz I Nutrítion

4.4 ATP (ADENOSINE TRIPHOSPHATE)


evidence that omega-3 fats may help protect eye health in athletes whose eyes are ATP, or adenosine triphosphate, is the biochemical carrier of energy for the move-
often exposed to the sun. Omega-3 fats are found most commonly and abundantly ment of a muscle. We refer to movement rather than contraction because of mus-
in fish oils, but they are also found in a less concentrated form in flax seeds and cular activity having different movement patterns (i.e., isometric, concentric and
flax seed oil. eccentric movement). ATP is present in the muscle cell to a very limited extent,
It is also important to be aware that fat is slow to digest and absorb, and it slows barely sufficient for a few seconds. However, it can be deployed directly. ln other
down the transit absorption of other foods consumed with it. Because of this, it words, ATP has great power but very limited capacity. ln chemical terms, we can
is wise to avoid high-fat food immediately prior to physical exercise in arder to describe it as follows: ATP undergoes hydrolysis in the sarcoplasm, releasing
prevent food from uncomfortably sitting in the stomach during exercise. Likewise, energy that is used by the muscle filaments (actin and myosin activation).
consuming high-fat foods within the hour immediately following exercise may
slow down the absorption of ingested CHOs and protein enough to interfere with ATP + H,O produces ADP (adenosine diphosphate) + W (hydrogen ion) +
optimal recovery. However, if consumed later, post-exercise dietary fats may be a Pi (free phosphorous ) + release of energy that can be used directly by the muscle.
good source of energy to help meet the high demands of the sport.
Because ATP is the only forro of energy that can be used directly by the cells, the
4.3.3 Proteins small quantity has to be continuously replenished. This is done by converting the
The amino acids supplied by dietary proteins are used in the body as building ADP by-product back into ATP. This requires energy from the various energy sys-
blocks for growth and the maintenance of muscle and organ tissue. They are also tems, which differ in their speeds of production (their power) and the quantity of
used for repairing other damaged tissues. Proteins can be used to build muscles and energy they can produce (their capacity).
other tissues (anabolism) and can be broken down into amino acids (catabolism).
Although nota preferred fuel, amino acids can be used as an energy source during 4.4.1 Replenishment of ATP
exercise. The oxidation of protein during exercise is inversely related to glycogen To restore ADP to ATP, we have four systems.
availability. Thus, consuming a diet rich in CHO, which helps maximize glycogen 1. ATP-CP system: Hydrolysis of phospho-creatine (PCr) in the sarcoplasm produ-
stores, will in turn decrease the use of protein as a fuel source. This protein-sparing ces the immediate release of energy for converting ADP into ATP.
effect helps prevent the catabolism of muscle protein and the subsequent need to The quantity of PCr is also limited, but it is the first energy system accessed, it
restore it during recovery (or the resulting risk of injury if not restored). Without responds very quickly, and it is sufficient to sustain exertion for about 8 seconds.
adequate dietary CHO, an athlete's protein requirements increase because of incre- This is the energy system responsible for short bursts of energy.
ased protein needed for recovery and for fuel. When the diet contains enough This system is extremely important for soccer and the most important energy
CHO, protein needs are relatively small. Although athletes do have higher protein provider for typical high-intensity activities in soccer, such as short and repea-
requirements than the general population, the requirements are not nearly as high ted sprints, jumps, tackles, kicks, and so on. The pool of PCr can be increased to a
as many athletes or coaches suspect. limited extent through specially adapted training and creatine supplementation.
Proteins are composed of amino acids. There are 20 amino acids, of which eight are
considered essential. Essential amino acids must be obtained from the diet because 2. Anaerobic Glycolysis: produces energy in the sarcoplasm to ensure that the
the human body cannot synthesize them. The biological value (BV) of a protein high intensity of an exertion can be sustained for longer than 10 seconds. In this
refers to its completeness for supplying essential amino acids. Animal proteins regard, glycogen from the muscles is converted to pyruvate and lactate via a
have high biological value, because they contain all of the essential amino acids. number of chemical steps in which no oxygen is used, releasing a limited quan-
Proteins of plant origin (with the exception of soy protein) lack some of the essen- tity of energy (hvo or three ATPs depending on whether the source of glucose
tial amino acids, so they are considered to be of lower biological value. ln general, is stored glycogen or glucose coming from the bloodstream). At high intensity,
the essential amino acids absent in grains are present in legumes (dried beans, peas it is mainly the muscle glycogen that is used and, at lower intensity, the blood
and lentils), and vice versa. Thus, even if a diet contains little orno meat, it can ade- glucose coming from the liver glycogen is used.
quately provide all the essential amino acids if it includes a variety of both grains
and legumes. A healthy, balanced diet that contains a variety of foods can easily 3. Oxidative Phosphorylation: For the exertion to be carried out longer, the inten-
supply sufficient protein for even elite athletes. sity of the exertion falls and Aerobic Glycolysis (Oxidative Phosphorylation)
takes over. The time that elapses before the system is in full \vorlcing order is
determined by the level of training and genetic potential, and it follows an expo-
nential function with values behveen 30 seconds and hvo minutes (which is
the duration that anaerobic activity can be sustained). Aerobic energy produc-
tion takes place in the mitochondria, with the glucose and fatty acid substrates
converted entirely to water and C02• The CHO reserves are limited, \vhile fat
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Nutrition
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Nutrition i ss
reserves are virtually unlimited. Fats become the primary fuel source during 4.5 ENERGY SYSTEMS
low-intensity physical exertion where adequate oxygen is available for the oxi- These energy systems differ from each other in terms of:
dation of lipids. This is in contrast to the high-intensity anaerobic exertions,
which are fuelled by CHOs. However, it is important to note that the use of fat as The use of substrate: Anaerobic energy consumes 18 times more substrate
a fuel is most efficient when there is at least a baseline amount of CHO present. (although the end product, lactate, can be later reused by the cardiac muscle,
It is often said that fat burns best in the flame of CHO. Without adequate CHO, for example, or converted to glycogen in the liver via the Cori cycle).
there is an incomplete combustion of fat that produces ketones as a by-product. Speed of action (power): the ATP-CP system is faster than anaerobic glycoly-
While ketones can be used as a fuel source, they are not an efficient source of sis, which in turn is quicker than aerobic phosphorylation.
fuel, especially for the brain. Ketones are also known as keto acids, and as such, ·The quantity of energy they can produce (capacity):
are a source of metabolic acidosis. CHO is therefore extremely important as a aerobic > anaerobic > PCr > ATP.
fuel source in soccer. Their power development expressed in watts: The maximum anaerobic
power is 4-5 times greater than the maximum aerobic power. ATP /PCr gene-
4. The Kinase Reaction can produce a limited amount of energy through the com- rates a maximum of 5,000 watts, while anaerobic generates 2,000-4,000 watts.
bination of tvvo ADPs (i.e., ADP+ADP produces ATP+AMP). This reaction is Aerobic generates less than 2,000 watts.
important for high-intensity exertions. Excessively high intensity at the begin-
ning of a physical exertion can cause a very high quantity of AMP to be conver- There is also a noticeable difference in energy supply according to the muscle type.
ted to IMP and further transformed into urea (typical smell of sweat in these Type I: slow muscle cells, characterized by their fine structure and red colar {due
cases), which causes an insufficient store of ADP and a need to discontinue the to large amounts of myoglobins), mainly display aerobic energy produc-
exertion. tion with little formation of lactate.
They are economical •vith regard to substrate consumption because of
the total oxidation of the energy sources (i.e., CHO, protein and fat).
Type II: muscle cells, or white muscle cells, are subdivided into:
Type lia: These have a mixed aerobic and anaerobic effect and are characteristic of
soccer players (with a part of type IIb probably being transformed into
type Ila).
Type IIb: These are the strongest, but they have a mainly anaerobic metabolism
with very high glycogen consumption.

Conclusion: Given that physical exertion in soccer is partly anaerobic (during


the brief high-intensity exertions) and primarily aerobic (repleting ATP leveis
during the longer periods of recuperation), it is clear that the main energy source
for soccer activity is CHO fron1 glycogen stored in the liver and muscles, as •vell as
blood glucose from food and beverages consumed before and during play .

ATP-CP system Anaerobic process Aerobic process

lntensity 95-100% 60-95% < 60 %)

Duration < 10 sec 30 sec to 30 min Long duration

Fue/ Creatlne phosphate CHOs CHOs, fats, proteins


(from b!ood glucose and
stored glycogen }

Residual Nane Lactic acid Water and carbon


product dioxide

Recovery lmmediate 20-60 min Until the fuel reserves


have been replenished
Tab/e 4.2: Overview of lhe different energy systems.
ss I Nutrition
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITN ESS 1N SOCCER
Nutrition

4.6 MACRONUTRIENT NEEDS 4.7 EATING PATTERNS OF SOCCER PLAYERS


Due to the limited supply of both sources of CHO (i.e., 350g of muscle glycogen, Little research has been conducted regarding the dietary habits of soccer players.
120g of liver glycogen, and 5g of blood glucose), constant replenishment via food Glycogen reserves may decrease quickly during a match through the alternation
and drink is an absolute necessity. Macronutrient needs are sometimes expressed between low- and high-intensity moments. A thirty-second sprint at full speed can
as percentages of the total kcal needed, which is calculated based on body weight, reduce the glycogen concentration in the muscles by 30%. Top players work for
age, gender and everyday activities. With this system, 70% of an athlete's energy two-thirds of a match at 85% of their HRm~~· Research has shown that soccer players
is provided by CHOs, 20% by fat, and the remaining 10% by protein. However, expend up to 90% of their glycogen reserves during a match. Exhausting glyco-
most sports nutritionists now provide macronutrient recommendations in terms of gen reserves leads to fatigue, guaranteeing fewer sprints in the second half. Eating
grams per kilogram of body weight (g/kg BW), and this is a more precise way of an easily digested CHO before the match and drinking a sports drink (containing
targeting the needs of individual athletes. With this method, the CHO recommen- 4-6% CHO) during the half-time break increases the distance that can be covered
dation for soccer players is 5-7g CHO/kg BW for moderate daily recovery and at high speed in the second half. It is therefore not sufficient to consume a sports
match preparation. During times of enhanced daily recovery and match prepara- drink just before the match. The body needs to be trained to ingest sufficient CHOs
tion (e.g., heavy training loads, frequent matches and/ or injury recovery) 7-12g before and after a match.
CHO /kg BW is recommended. If the diet does not contain enough CHOs, athletic At least 9-lOg of CHOs per kg of body weight need to be ingested over the few
performance and muscle recovery will be compromised. The majority of these are days before a match and during periods of intense training.
complex CHOs-present in bread, rice, vegetables, and so on-with a small por-
tion of simple sugars that are often added to the food. 4.7.1 Food intake and beverage consumption before and after a match
The recommended protein intake for the training diet of elite soccer players is
l.4-l.7g/kg BW. While slightly higher protein consumption may be helpful for ath- 4.7.1.1 Prior to commencement ofthe match
letes recovering from injuries or surgery, research suggests there is no advantage to Nutrition is, of course, an important factor in the days leading up to a match. The
protein intakes greater than 2g /kg BW in daily training diets. In fact, protein regu- day before the match, it is necessary to start replenishlng the glycogen reserves in
larly consumed at these leveis may have detrimental effects, such as increased risk the muscles (i.e., provide a diet rich in CHOs for the few days before a match).
of dehydration, kidney stones, calcium loss, GI distress, gout, and liver or kidney We use sports meals to enhance the body's CHO reserves, but trying out new foods
damage. Among other concerns, there is an increased risk of dehydration when before a match is not advisable. The best time to do this is before training. Always
high amounts of protein are consumed due to the obligatory water lasses associa- try to eat the sarne things prior to a match, because this helps to gather experience
ted with the excretion of urea, which is a by-product of protein oxidation. with regard to quantities. A full meal should be eaten at least three hours before
the match starts. Eating within three hours of kick-off time can cause stomach pro-
Fat appears to be the blems during the game. A relatively empty stomach also helps ensure that the mus-
macronutrient that cles have a sufficient supply of blood and oxygen. High-fat foods are not advisable
requires the least preci- because these slow down the digestion process in the stomach.
sion in terms of balan- The meal should be rich in complex CHOs-such as potatoes, rice, grain, fruits,
cing the diet. Generally and vegetables-while the quantity is determined individually and also influenced
speaking, once CHO by the previous meal. Proteins can also be ingested provided they are not from a
and protein needs have high-fat source.
been calculated, the Examples of pre~match food:
remaining kcals can 0 cornflakes with low-fat milk
usually come from the 0 pasta (possibly with a low-fat sauce)
healthier varieties of o baked potatoes
dietary fats. The accep- 0 fruit (e.g., raisins, bananas, oranges)
table amount of dietary fat for most athletes is between 10% and 30% of total energy o bread rolls
intake. Healthy varieties of fats include monounsaturated fats-such as those • rice
found in nuts, clives and avocados-and omega-3 fatty acids, which are found in
fish oil and flax seed oil. It is best to limit saturated fats (found in cheese and other On average, around Sg of CHOs per kg of body weight should be ingested
dairy products and in meats) and trans fats (found in processed foods containing (e.g., 375g for a player weighing 75 kg). Additional CHOs should be eaten around
hydrogenated oils). Excess amounts (more than 10% of dietary energy) of these lat- two hours prior to the match in the form of bread or bananas.
ter two types of fats can increase the risk of heart disease and contribute to inflam- Try to eat or drink another SOg of CHOs 20 minutes before the match starts.
mation. Omega-3 fats, on the other hand, may actually help decrease inflammation.
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
ss I Nutritíon Nutrition

Examples of foods that contain around 50g of CHOs include: Insulin is a storage hormone that acts to get substrates (glucose and fatty acids) into
o two bananas cells for storage, so the release of catecholamines at the onset of exercise initiates a
0 two slices of bread and jam feedback loop that inhibits insulin secretion.
0 75g of breakfast cereal During moderate-to-high-intensity exertion, the body activates an insulin-inde-
o biscuits pendent mechanism to transport glucose into the cells via GLUT4 receptors. There
is an increased concentration of GLUT4 glucose transporters, which carry glucose
4.7.1.2 DUR/NG THE HALF-TIME BREAK from the cell membranes into the cells. The muscle's cells also become more sensi-
The glycogen reserves need to be replenished during the half-time break. This can tive to insulin during moderate to intense exercise. During post-exercise recovery,
be achieved by eating two bananas or drinking a high-CHO beverage. Care must the insulin sensitivity and GLUT4 receptors remain elevated and active for about
be taken to consume sufficient fluids along with any CHOs in arder to prevent an 60 minutes. At the cessation of exercise, catecholamine leveis decrease, allowing
overly high solute load in the gut. If too concentrated, this will slow gastric empty- for a restoration of insulin secretion. This can rebound with an insulin response
ing and cause "sloshing." to CHO that is up to ten times greater than normal. Because insulin is a storage
hormone, heightened insulin sensitivity combined with abundant insulin secretion
4. 7.1.3 After the matc/1 allows for an increased capacity to transport glucose and protein into muscle cells
After the match, the glycogen reserves need to be replenished as quickly as possi- for enhanced glycogen storage and muscle recovery.
ble. Muscle glycogen is produced considerably faster after physical exertion. Also Additionally, high-intensity exercise leads to an increase in proteins that convey
try to consume around lg of CHO per kg/BW vvithin two hours of the physical Jactate outside the cell and aid in the recovery of the cell. Experts emphasize the
exertion, and do not goto sleep on an empty stomach. importance of refueling within 60 minutes after exercise, because this will take
advantage of the temporarily enhanced ability to transport and store CHO and pro-
tein. The immediate administration of CHO at the cessation of exertion (training or
4.8 GLYCOGEN METABOLISM ANO NUTRIENT TIMING FOR RECOVERY n1atch) is therefore decisive for glycogen supercompensation.
ln this chapter \Ve have discussed the decisively important role of glycogen as a
fuel for soccer players. Given the limited reserves in the body, it is ímportant to The question remains as to what CHOs to eat and in what quantity.
know how the level of glycogen stored ín the muscles and liver can be maintained Severa} studies have shown that, up to a certain limit, there is a parallel betvveen the
or even increased. ln other words, we have to understand how the synthesis of gly- quantity of CHOs absorbed and the quantity of stored glycogen.
cogen works and \Vhat influences this.
Glycogen synthesis (glycogenesis) is regulated via the enzyme glycogenin. A range of 1.2 to l.67g of CHOs per kg/BW would appear to be ideal.
Post-exercise glycogen repletion proceeds in two phases.
Type of CHO: Preferably eat a mixture of simple and complex CHOs with a small
1. The rapid Plmse 1 is not dependent on insulin and takes about an hour. The for- amount of fructose (see below).
mation of glycogen is controlled by the glycogen synthase enzyn1e, the activity Timing: Eat immediately after physical exertion (\vithin 30-60 minutes) and every
of vvhich is inversely proportional to the initial glycogen store (i.e., the lower the 15-30 minutes for the next 2-5 hours post-exercise.
glycogen reserves, the more active the enzyme becomes). The enzyme binds the
first glucose molecules together. There is also an increased permeability of the Research has alsn shown that this regime can be continued for a fe\v hours, provi-
cell membrane for glucose. ding 1.0-1.Sg of CHOs per kg/hour. This can perhaps be provided in several small
snacks and / or beverages every 15-30 minutes.
2. Phase 2 is insulin-dependent and ten times slower than phase 1 in the absence Providing a small amount of protein post-exercise may enhance muscle recovery.
of CHOs. If CHOs are ingested directly after exercise, the synthesis of glycogen Although athletes are often inclined to consume large quantities of protein at this
increases, and levels can even become higher than normal. This additional gly- time, research suggests that athletes only need 0.1-0.2g of protein per kg/hour for
cogen storage is known as glycogen supercompensation (often referred to as recovery from both endurance- and resistance-type exercises. For a 70kg person,
CHO loading). this would be only 7-14g of protein. ln practice, this can be easily provided by
consuming 250-500ml (8 -16 fl. Oz.) of low-fat chocolate milk. Chocolate milk is
This phase of glycogen synthesis is also dependent on the type of exercise per- often touted as the "ideal recovery drink" because it provides the recommended
formed. A quick review of exercise endocrinology will help explain why. During amounts of CHO and protein, as well as fluid and electrolyte replacement (i.e.,
moderate-to-high-intensity exercise, catecholamines (epinephrine, norepinephrine, sodium, potassium and calcium).
glucagon, human growth hormone) are released in response to the physiological
stress. These hormones help make fuel available for the active muscles by encoura-
ging glycolysis and gluconeogenesis and by mobilizing fatty acids out of storage.
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Nutrition FITNESS IN SOCCER
Nutrition

Food Grams (g) Serving size CHO (g) Fructose is metabolized differently than the other sugars. Most sugars are absorbed
from the intestine into general circulation, where they are then taken up by cells
Bread 130 50
and metabolized. Fructose, in contrast, is transported from the intestine directly
Pasta (cooked) 200 50 to the liver, the only place where fructose metabolism occurs. ln the liver, fructose
Muse!i 75 50 is converted to glycogen, and once the glycogen stores are full, it is converted to
Rice (brown or white) 130 50 triglycerides (fat). Because of this, fructose does not have a direct effect on blood
pretzels sugar and therefore does not elicit an insulin response. Both of these factors cause
tvvo times more glycogen to be stored via glucose.
Torti!la {Corn or flour) 15 cm across, {6") 15
As already mentioned, fructose is metabolized primarily in the liver, while glucose
Naan lndian Bread 60 is metabolized in the muscles. Because fructose has no direct effect on blood sugar,
Oats, oatmeal, cooked 1 cup 30 it is not an immediately available source of energy for the brain or muscles. Additi-
Corn 1 cup 30 onally, some athletes have an intolerance to fructose. These individuals often expe-
Quinoa, cooked 1 Cup 45 rience the symptoms of cramps, and fermentation can occur quickly in the area of
the intestine. Fructose is therefore only useful in limited quantities because of its
Potato 250
role in the storage of glycogen in the liver and its pronounced sweet taste.
Sweet palato ar Yam
It does not appear to make a difference whether CHOs are ingested in solid or
Beans, peas ar lentils 1h Cup, cooked 15 liquid forro. The type of exertion, however, does have an influence on the formation
of glycogen, because there is a clear difference between prolonged aerobic exertion
Apple, orange Small (tennis ball size) 15
(longer than an hour) and short, high-intensity exertions.
ln the first case, the synthesis is dependent on the availability of CHOs, while in the
Mango 1 smal! ( 1 Cup) 30
second case, the synthesis runs parallel to the fall in lactate level. (Lactate is used
Berries 1 Cup as a source for glycogen.)
Melon 1/8 Ih ar 1 Cup cubed Eccentric exercises (such as in soccer) appear to have a negative influence on gly-
watermelon 1.25 Cup 15 cogen accumulation, possibly due to a decrease in GLUT4 proteins, although this
Unsweetened juice 4 oz rnay be a direct effect of a high demand for glycogen and inadequate CHO in the
training diet. This can be countered by ingesting adequate arnounts of CHO and
Jelly or Jam 4tsp
protein after the training session or rnatch.
Milk 8oz
l<iwi 1 15
Dates 3 15 4.9 ENERGY BALANCE AND BODY COMPOSITION
Pineapple YiCup 15
4.9.1 Body composition
Papaya 1 cup cubed 15
The body is rnade up of 73.8% water, 19.4% proteins, and 6.8%.1 minerais. The ideal
Raisins 2Tbsp 15 body cornposition varies frorn sport to sport. The body is divided into two com-
Sorbet %Cup 30 ponents: fat-free mass and fat mass. Correct training can increase the fat-free rnass
Honey 1 Tbls 15 and reduce the fat rnass. The body rnass index is a test used to give an indication of
Sugar 1 Tb!s 15 body fat. However, it is a poor indicator of health in athletes because it is merely a
ratio of height to weight. Athletes typically have more muscle rnass, which is den-
Frozen fruitjuice bars,
100% juice
1 bar 15 ser than fat. Athletes with a lot of rnuscle mass score high on this index, giving an
Fruitjuice 8 oz 30
incorrect impression of body composition.
500 mi

Table 4.3: CHO content offood.


BMI is calculated as follows:
BMI (kg/ m') = body weight in kilograms divided by height in meters squared

Example: Weight: 75 kg, height: 1.75 - BMI = 75 / (1.75 x 1.75) = 24.5 kg/ m'
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
Nutrilion Nutrition

Height and weight vary considerably in soccer. Asmall build is nota disadvantage,
FAT º/o
but it can determine the choice of position on the field. ln soccer, there are con-
Min. Max. Stdev. Avg siderable variations between the different positions, with defenders, strikers and
goalkeepers being taller than players of other positions.
Elite U21 5.00 16.00 2.04 8.45
A way of describing body composition is the somatotype. This is expressed in three
Elite First team 6.29 14.13 1.68 9.51 dimensions:
Tab/e 4.4: Reference data based on tests at different top cfubs (TopSportsLab). • endomorphy: indicates the tendency to put on weight
• mesomorphy: indicates the tendency towards muscularity
• ectomorphy: indicates the tendency towards linearity
These values are measured based on the circumference of the person' s limbs, leg
diameter and skinfold measurements. There are also other methods of measuring
the somatotype by estimation. Soccer players tend toward 2-5-2, meaning that they
are more muscular. Bach dimension ranges from one to seven (Table 4.5).

Rugby (7 >< 7) Gaelic football Soccer

Endomorphy 2.3 2.7 2.0


1
Mesomorphy 5.9 5.7 5.3
,J\) Ectomorphy 1.5 1.9 2.1
\ 1

\
I' Tab!e 4.5: Somatotype of top players in various forms of footbal!

J(
<'~.J The average fat percentage for men around 25 years of age is around 16%. ln the
Ectomorph Mesomorph Endomorph literature, the value for soccer players is 9-13%, vvhile it is somewhat lower for indi-
vidual athletes (e.g., track-and-field athletes). The values measured for top athletes
Fig. 4.3: Exemples of different somatotypes. The somatotype is expressed in three digits. Most are between 3% and 7%. Soccer players average out at around 9-10% fat.
peop/e have a somatotype somewhere in the midd/e.

4.9.2 Energy balance


For most elite soccer players, balancing energy for the purpose of weight manage-
Mesomorph ment is not a primary focus (exercise to eat). During active training seasons, the
1-7-1
Weight lifters greatest challenge is supplying enough kcal and CHO to meet the substantial
energy demands that result from training and match play (eat to exercise). Ath-
Gymm1sts letes who attempt to create an energy deficit in an effort to lose body fat often end
up compromising their performance and/ or increasing their risk of injury. Ideally,
any reductions in body weight should be done during the player's off-season. It is
impossible to lose weight while simultaneously fueling for optimal performance.
Likewise, it is unwise for an athlete to follow a low-CHO diet in an attempt to
Sumo wrest!ers
lose weight. This would interfere with the energy available for training and match
Tennis p!ayers play, resulting in reduced performance and increased risk of injury. Also, much of
the weight loss associated with low-CHO diets is due to depleted glycogen stores,
High jumpers
particularly the loss of the water stored \vith them. This can easily result in a loss
of 5kg, but it will also remove a valuable source of stored fuel for sport while doing
little, if anything, to <lecrease body fat.
Endomorph Ectomorph
7-1-1 1-1-7
It is better to focus on body composition rather than body weight, especially since
the addition of muscle and/ or glycogen can significantly increase weight, because
Fig. 4.4: Somatotypes in different sports. Over the last decade, soccer players have evofved from it is ultimately advantageous if the ability to produce power is increased. Stu-
being more ectomorphic to mesomorphic. dies suggest that elite male soccer players have around 8-13% body fat, while top
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
Nutrition Nutrition

female players have approximately 16% body fat. The fat percentage is commonly vitamin D deficiency would affect athletic performance and injury. Recent studies
measured with a skinfold caliper, which estimates the fat percentage on the basis of suggest that a vitamin D deficiency does indeed compromise athletic perfo1mance.
skinfold thickness. Care has to be taken with skinfold measurements where age is It is estimated that as much as 77% of the general population of the United States
not taken into account, because older players tend to have somewhat thicker skin rnay be deficient in vitamin D (serum vitamin D< 20 ng/ml), suggesting that ath-
and are therefore likely to be overestimated. Other methods of estimating body letes may have similar levels. Areview of studies ofvarious populations of athletes
composition include dual-energy X-ray absorptiometry, hydrostatic weighing, and across the globe suggests a relatively high incidence of vitamin D deficiency (<20
bioelectrical impedance. ng/ml) and insufficiency (<32 ng/ml) in athletes worldwide. Furthermore, it has
been suggested that in athletes with vitamin D insufficiency, supplementation with
D3 may improve muscle strength. However, improvement in muscle performance
4.10 VITAMINS, MINERALSAND FREE RADICALS (e.g., sprint times and vertical jumps) did not occur when serum leveis were nor-
Vitamins, minerals and phytochemicals are micronutrients. They are only needed in malized, but improvements were noted when serum vitamin D leveis rase above
small quantities, but they are vital in supporting health and growth. Micronutrients 40 ng/ ml. Thus, it has been recommended for athletes, such as soccer players, to
are involved in many metabolic processes. Six of the B vitamins (thiamine, ribof- monitor their vitamin D levels regularly and strive to maintain serum 25(0H)D
lavin, niacin, pyridoxine, pantothenic acid, and biotin) are necessary for the meta- levels > 40 ng/ml. To achieve this, a protocol for oral supplementation with 5000
bolic reactions that produce energy during exercise. Two others, vitamin B12 and IU of vitamin D3 per day is recommended.
folate, are essential to red blood cell formation, protein synthesis, and the growth
and repair of tissues. Deficiencies of Bl2 and/ or folate result in macrocytic anemia, 4.10.3 Minerais
which compromises health and performance by limiting the amount of oxygen a In addition to selenium, whose role as an antioxidant has already been discussed,
given volume of blood can deliver to working muscles, the brain, and other vital there are several minerais that are important for soccer players to include in their
organs. diets. Calcium is important for the growth, maintenance and repair of banes. It is
also essential for muscle contractions, nerve conduction, and normal blood clot-
4.10.1 Antioxidants ting. Zinc is involved in building and repairing muscle tissue, maintaining immune
Vitamins C, E, and A (beta carotene), selenium and several phytochemicals serve health, and the energy metabolism. Iron is an important component of the oxy-
as antioxidants, which help to prevent oxidative damage to cells caused by free gen-carrying hemoglobin portion of red blood cells. When iron is deficient, the abi-
radicais. Free radicals, often referred to as "chemical terrorists," are molecules or lity to carry oxygen to the cells diminishes and fatigue sets in. It therefore follows
atoms that contain an unpaired electron. They are highly reactive and can initiate that a deficiency in sodium will also cause a drop in performance. Possible causes
chain-like reactions that can damage cell membranes and DNA, causing cells to of iron deficiency include inadequate dietary intake of iron and inadequate total
malfunction or die. Antioxidants neutralize free radicais, thus helping to prevent energy intake. Recovering from an iron deficiency can take three to six months.
or reduce the oxidative damage to body cells. Soccer players, like many other ath- Sodium, potassium and chloride are the three major electrolytes. Electrolytes
letes, are at increased risk of oxidative damage to cells because the increased oxy- become ians in solution and have the ability to conduct electricity. In the body, they
gen exchange associated with aerobic physical activities increases the exposure of are important for the conduction of electrical nerve impulses and neuromuscular
cells to oxygen by 10-20 times. It is now believed that athletes adapt to regular impulses. These three electrolytes are also important for maintaining fluid balance
training by developing an enhanced antioxidant defense system, so they are better in and around the cells. While all of these are lost in sweat to some extent, sodium
protected against free radical damage than the occasional exerciser would be. Still, is lost in the greatest concentrations and therefore is the most important to replace
there may still be some advantage to providing dietary antioxidants to enhance during exercise. The amount of potassium typically lost during 90 minutes of play
protection from free radicais. All of the aforementioned antioxidants can be found or practice is relatively small and can be replaced during recovery. While there has
in a diet that contains a variety of fruits and vegetables. No supplementation is been recent debate in scientific research as to whether ar not sodium depletion
necessary with such a diet. results in muscle cramping, the personal experiences of many athletes and coaches
convinces them that it does, at least for some athletes.
4.10.2 Vitamin D Minerals are also best obtained through the diet. These are inorganic substances
Vitamin D is a micronutrient that has received increasing interest of late. The that have regulatory and structural functions in the body.
well-established functions of vitamin D include calcium regulation, bane health, Both vitamins and minerals are present in food to an adequate extent. Try to eat as
and development and homeostasis of the skeletal muscle and nervous system. varied a diet as possible to obtain all the different types of minerais and vitamins
Emerging research suggests that vitamin D may also be significantly involved in on a daily basis.
other vital processes, such as signaling gene response, protein synthesis, hormone
synthesis, immune response, and cell tumover and regeneration. A vitamin D
receptor has been discovered within muscle, suggesting that vitamin D may have a
significant role in muscle tissue function. This has raised the question of whether a
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
Nutrítion Nutrition

4.11 WATERAND ELECTROLYTE BALANCE IN SOCCER PLAYERS "Drink large quantities" is the motto here, and this needs to be taught on the trai-
ln addition to glycogen depletion, dehydration can be a significant source of fati- ning ground as some feel it to be bothersome. Gastric emptying also depends on
gue for athletes. ln energy production, the largest portion of the chemical energy the glucose content, with concentrated solutions remaining in the stomach for lon-
released is converted into heat. This heat has to be emitted through physical trans- ger. An increase in osmolality slows down the emptying process, meaning that it
fer, although the most significant partis discharged through perspiration. is better to use glucose polymers, which lower the osmolality. Glucose absorption
Although a higher ambient temperature is a hindrance because of the reduced in the small intestine is an active energy process linked to the transportation of
physical transfer possibilities, the bigger concem is an excessively high level of sodium. Water follows the osmotic gradient in a passive way. The assimilation of
humidity, because this makes sweating much more difficult. fructose is a passive process that proceeds more slowly and can give rise to osmotic
A soccer player's fluid loss can be described as follows: diarrhea in larger quantities. Research has shown concentrations of CHO above 6%
• Sweat production, which is a consequence of energy production, is deter- to slow gastric emptying. It has also been established that a combination of tvvo ar
mined by the intensity of the physical exertion. three different CHOs (sugars) are more rapidly absorbed than a single type. It is
o Water Ioss through breathing is normally 200 ml per day, but it can be more in believed this is caused by the different monosaccharides being absorbed via diffe-
cases of dry air and high altitudes. rent channels, so when there is more than one source of CHO in a sports drink, they
o Urine production is typically 800-900ml per day. can be absorbed simultaneously.

The most important contributor to fluid loss is perspiration, which is an essen- 4.11.1 Sports drink
tial mechanism for thermoregulation. The evaporation of sweat cools the skin, hel- No sports drink is ideal for everyone and all situations. A compromise has to be
ping to keep the core temperature within acceptable limits. It has been shown that made betvveen proper rehydration and supplying as much energy as possible in the
relatively small fluid lesses (2% of body \veight) are sufficient to have a negative form of CHOs. Drinks should never be carbonated, however.
influence on performance. ln the event that fluid losses exceed 3%, there is clear The following factors are important in thls regard, and these are typically charac-
evidence of a fall in V02max ln addition to water loss, there are electrolyte lesses teristic of sports drinks:
associated with perspiration. Sodium lesses through sweat can vary considerably
behveen individual athletes. While the concentration of NaCl is generally around 1. The osmolarity (or osmolality) is the number of particles of a substance expres-
3-4g per liter of sweat, it is considerably hlgher in some athletes. Furthermore, tole- ses per liter (osmolarity) or per kilogram (osmolality).
rance to externai heat and internai heat production is reduced. Isotonicity says something about the quantity of particles in a solution, but
not very much about the type of dissolved particles (e.g., sodium, potassium,
Thirst can be a very poor indication of fluid deficiency, so players need to learn to CHOs, etc.).
estimate their lesses by, for example, determining their weight lesses at the training The blood has a tonicity of 290-300 mosmols and contains, in this regard, 0.9g
facility after severa! tough workouts. Fat contains less \Vater than muscles (i.e., 10% of NaCl and 5g of glucose per li ter. Drinks \vith the sarne tonicity are referred to
in fat compared to 75% in muscle), resulting in substantial differences betvveen the as isotonic solutions, while those with greater tonicity are described as hyperto-
tvvo. It can generally be said that soccer players do not drink enough fluids, partly nic solutions, and those with lower tonicity are referred to as hypotonic soluti-
because drink breaks are not provided during the match. After a soccer match or ons. An isotoníc sports drink therefore has an osmolarity comparable to that of
equivalent training session, players are confronted \vith two significant negative plasn1a, and it is primarily a thirst quencher, providing \Vater and replenishing
phenomena. Firstly, they experience glycogen loss (see above), and secondly, fluid salt and CHO to a limited degree.
loss combined \vith limited salt loss. These can be restored in a combined manner. The tonicity of a solution plays a role in the emptying of the stomach, the
Fluid loss can be estimated based on weight loss and then compensated for by absorption via the intestine, the quantity of kcal in the form of CHOs, the supply
150% (i.e., compensating for 1 liter of fluid loss by drinking 1.5 liters of fluid) to of \Vater, and the supply of electrolytes, prin1arily sodium and potassium. The
account for the resumption of diuresis. size of the dissolved particles (i.e., the type of CHO) and the quantity of sodiurn,
Preferably do not drink purified water, as this \Vill lower serum osmolality and as \vell as the quantity of CHOs, determine the tonicity.
stimulate diuresis, resulting in even greater fluid loss. It is better to drink a 4-6%
CHO solution made from a mixture of glucose and glucose polymer (see sports 2. Type of CHO present
drinks) \Vith 0.5-0.7g of sodium per liter. Be careful about consuming alcohol after Only monosaccharides can be absorbed directly through the intestines, while
a match, because alcohol also stimulates diuresis. It can also only be broken do\vn other CHOs have to be first broken down by an enzymatic process. In the event
in the liver, therefore slowing down other metabolic processes in the liver, such as of an immediate need for CHOs, glucose is the best solution, but if it is being
the formation of liver glycogen. Gastric emptying can constitute a challenge for administered for the purpose of glycogen recovery, slow CHOs (i.e., normal
soccer players and athletes in general. This emptying is determined by the volume food) are better.
and composition of the fluid ingested. The volume is decisive, and the emptying
follows an exponential function, decreasing quickly as the remaining fluid drops.
FITNESS IN SOCCER
FITNESS IN SOCCER Nutritíon
Nutrition

4.12 FOOD SUPPLEMENTS


4.11.2 Use of sports drink
The characteristics of a sports drink will determine the best moment to use it: Food supplements can be dealt with very briefly: They are not necessary. lf a player
feels tired, it is better to take a blood test before resorting to food or vitamin sup-
plements. The blood analysis will clearly show where the deficiencies lay, so sup-
a. Before and during physical exertion: a solution of fast CHOs, such as dextrose,
sucrose or maltodextrin. Maltodextrin, or dextromaltose, is a sugar obtained plements can then be prescribed in a purposeful and effective manner. A normal,
varied diet is sufficient, although vegetarians should consult the club physician.
through partial hydrolysis of starch containing a particular quantity of free
glucose. It is given a dextrose equivalent to indicate the quantity of free glucose.
For example, pure starch has an equivalent of O, while it is 100 for glucose and 4.12.1 Creatine
An adult man weighing 80kg has approximately 130g of creatine reserves, mainly
lo>ver than 20 for dextromaltose. Its advantage lies in its lower osmolarity,
in the muscles (95%). An average of 2g is lost each day, although this is replenished
because it is a larger molecule than other sugars.
The terms "slow and fast CHOs" are relative, because other factors also play a through food intake.
Creatine has often been misrepresented in recent years, with claims that it is tan-
part. For example, chocolate contains "fast" CHOs, but slower gastric emptying
tamount to doping and a cause of cramps in soccer players. ln many cases, these
occurs because of the presence of fat. Much has also been said about rebound
accusations are the result of incorrect creatine regimes. It is not the intention here
hypoglycemia. This was shown in a study once but not since, and it is very rare
to either promote creatine ar advise against it. It is simply an attempt to put the
among athletes.
ingestion of creatine into the right context. Creatine is available in food, and eating
b. Wíthin 15 minutes after the exertion, start rehydrating up to 150% of the quantity of
sufficient quantities of meat, fish and dairy products ensures that a large part of the
fluid lost, initially with fast CHOs in an isotonic solution combined with a pro-
creatine needed is ingested. For this reason, the most substantial effects of supple-
tein solution, such as low-fat chocolate milk. Follow this later with slow CHOs
ments are measured in vegetarians. The intake of creatine increases the CP reserves
in the form of a normal meal. It is important to repair the structural damage
in the muscles. As already demonstrated above, these CP reserves are important for
through a combination of limited amounts of protein and CHO in a ratio of 15
providing energy during short bouts of physical exertion lastingjust a few seconds.
kcal per 1 gram of nitrogen.
The ingestion of creatine speeds up the recovery of CP reserves. ln addition, maxi-
c. Depending on the circu111stances, take an isotonic solution in the event of severe
mum muscle strength is increased through the hormonal effect, with muscle relaxa-
dehydration, such as from a tough match or warm environment. A hypertonic
tion also being improved. The long-term effects are not yet known. Although no
solution (300-500 mosmols) can be used in cold weather, but take care vvith this,
negative effects have so far been established in the short term, creatine does result
because high tonicity can quickly lead to stomach and intestinal problems.
in an increase in weight dueto the buildup of fluid in the muscles. Seen in practical
d. Depending on the duration of the exertion:
terms, creatine is a fairly expensive supplement. Nonetheless, the doses prescribed
• < 1 hour: 6% solution
are often excessive.
0 1-3 hours: 6% solution with 10-20 mg of sodium chloride
0 more than 3 hours: 6% solution with 20-30 mg of sodium chloride
How should it be used?
The presence of sodium improves the absorption of water and CHOs, prevents
!. Quick charge for five days with 20-25g (for players weighing 65-82kg), taken
hyponatremia, inhibits urine production, and stimulates the feeling of thirst. ln
over three daily doses at Sam, 3pm and 9pm together with 25g of sugar (e.g.,
this case, we also refer to recuperation drinks.
Glucopur or dextra-maltose) dissolved in water.
65 kg: 7g three times with 25g of sugar
80-85 kg: 8g three times with 25g of sugar
2. After five days
65 kg: lg with 5g of sugar
80-85 kg: 1.2g of creatine with 5g of sugar

Weight can increase by 1-2kg. Although other side effects, especially regarding the
kidneys, are as yet unknown, it is wise to stop administering for 14 days after 6
weeks. ln the event of cramps, it might be possible to take magnesium in consul-
tation with the club physician. Some players do not respond to creatine supple-
ments. Because creatine can cause an increase in weight, performance may drop.
Taking food supplements must therefore be done only in consultation with a sports
physician.
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
NutriHon Nutrition

4.12.2 lron inefficient use of substrate, faster lactate formation and reduced oxidative phosp-
One of the effects of endurance training is an increase in plasma volume, which horylation. The athlete's general capacity to perform therefore declines.
causes the blood volume to rise from 5 liters to 5.8 liters, for example. This results A low iron level can be the cause of poor performance, so it is therefore useful to
in a dilution effect because of the production of red blood cells not keeping up with determine the ferritin levei three times per year.
the increase in plasma volume. The hematocrit can therefore decrease from the nor-
mal 42 to 39. This is referred to as pseudo-anemia, which, as the name suggests, is
not really anemia but rather an advantage because of the work decreasing through 4.13 RECOMMENDATIONS
the lower viscosity. The diagnosis is made by the laboratory in this case, with the We can give a number of recommendations regarding food choices:
ferritin normal. 1. Alcohol is a non-nutritional food product. lt can only be broken down in the
Real sports anemia is caused by disturbances in the metabolism of iron, caused liver at an average rate of 150 mg per kg per hour, inhibiting the formation of
by sports participation. A slight iron deficiency can already have significant reper- glycogen and slowing down lactate elimination. It also has a diuretic effect and
cussions for a player's fitness. The daily iron requirement is lmg for a man to disrupts the fluid balance.
replace losses through urination, defecation, and sweating, while 2mg are required 2. A diet must be varied and balanced with large proportions of fruits and vege-
for women because of menstruation. Intensive sports can disrupt Fe metabolism tables, whole grains, and low-fat dairy products. The calorific value of food is
through malfunctioning absorption, increased loss, hemolysis anda poor diet. usually underestimated, while the calorific cost of sport is overestimated. Kilo-
ln addition to factors specific to athletes, there are also other non-sporting-specific calories intake should therefore be calculated. Fat contains a huge amount of
causes, such as giving blood, and these may not be compensated for by an athlete kilocalories.
because of the mucosal block (see below), severe menstruation, or frequently occur- 3. Energy intake must be balanced against energy consumption.
ring periods with small daily losses. 4. Choose foods that give the appropriate energy balance while meeting the high
energy needs of soccer.
The factors relating to athletes are: 5. Limit saturated fat (i.e., fat that is solid atroam temperature) to 10% of the kcal
• Dietary mistakes: Following a weight-loss diet in which only 10-lSmg are ingested per day. This particularly applies to animal fats in food products like
ingested instead of the required 18mg per day. Westem food typically con- cheese, full-fat milk, butter, ice cream, salami, mincemeat, and so on. Note that
tains 5-6 mg per 1,000 kcal. eating whole eggs does not appear to negatively affect serum cholesterol levels,
• Red meat contains easily absorbable heme iron, but too little is eaten. and egg yolks are an excellent source of vitamin D.
• Frequent milk drinks convert bivalent into trivalent iron, which is useless. 6. CHOs are best obtained from fruits, vegetables and whole grains, with \vhole
• lncreased hemolysis, especially when running and through repeated muscle products being preferable to juices. During peak training season, however,
contractions with damage to the red blood cells. \vhen CHO and energy needs are very high, sometimes drinking CHOs in the
• A number of physicochemical factors also lead to hemolysis, such as dehydra- forro of juice or blended fruit smoothies can be a good strategy for meeting
tion, acidosis, increased osmolarity, rises in temperature, higher catecholamine dietary intake goals. CHOs are absolutely essential given the limited glycogen
level, and peroxidation of the red blood cells through free radicais. reserves in the body and the dependence of the red blood cells, brain, and mus-
Athletes have absorption disturbances in the area of the intestine: Endurance ath- cles on them. Candy is a poor source, as are added sugars.
letes absorb less iron because of apoferritin deficiency. They also have accelerated 7. For most elite athletes there is no need to limit dietary salt because so much is
intestinal transit, meaning there is less time to absorb iron, and they exhibit what is lost through perspiration.
known as a mucosal block (i.e., the absorption of ironis limited to 5-7 mg per day).
Finally, athletes also have less acid in their stomachs, with the result that there is
less bivalent iron.

All these factors mean that athletes are more prone to iron deficiency. They need
more iron than non-athletes because:

• They lose more iron through their sport.


• It is more difficult for them to absorb iron because of their sport.
• ln particular, a relative iron deficiency is immediately significant for an athlete
because of the rapid negative consequences for performance. There is a close
connection between iron and hemoglobin and vo2m~x·
A fall in the iron concentration leads to a decrease in V021n:ut which means a drop in
the 0 2 supply to the muscles anda decline in the oxidative processes. This results in
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
n j Nutrition Physical abilities and the role of aerobic jitness 73

SUMMARY
This chapter has conveyed to the reader the importance of nutrition in soccer.
Good nutrition cannot replace talent, skill, or physical ability, but good nutrition
enables a player to train to his maximum and to perform to the best of his ability
on match day. A poorly fuelled player cannot express his technical and physical
abilities on match day and is also more susceptible to injury. Adequate CHO
intake is essential in order for a player to recovery quickly for the next game.
Protein intake is also essential for repairing damaged muscle fibers. An adequate
intake of vitamins and minerais is needed to support recovery and the immune
systern. As we discussed in the previous chapter, U1e physical demands of the PHYSICAL ABILITIES
modern game are high, so it is important that the modem soccer player optimi-
zes his nutritional strategies in order to cope with these demands. Good nutriti- AND THE ROLE OF AEROBIC FITNESS
onal practices are also essential for the soccer player to cope with the demands Jan Van Winckel, Werner Helsen, Bart De Roover, Steven Vanharen
of intensive weekly training, so that physical abilities can be improved. These
physical abilities, and the importance of high-intensity interval training, are
now discussed in the following three chapters.

5.1 INTRODUCTION
The physical preparation of elite soccer players has become an indispensable part
of contemporary professional soccer dueto the high fitness levels required to cope
with the ever-increasing energy demands of match play (Carling et al., 2008; laia
et al., 2009). Team sport athletes require a high level of aerobic fitness in order to
generate and maintain power output during repeated high-intensity efforts. A
well-developed levei of aerobic fitness also helps to recover quickly between these
high-intensity efforts (Bishop and Spencer, 2004), This ability to recover between
bouts of high-intensity activity and subsequently repeat these efforts is a criticai
REl'ERENCES physical ability of the modern-day soccer player (Gabbett and Mulvey, 2008).
The amount of high-intensity exercise carried out accounts for about 15-19% of
Alkin,on. f.S., foster·Powcll, K-, and Drnnd·Milkr, ].C., 2003. Diabetes Can>, 31 (12), pp. 2281-2283. the total distance covered and 10-15% of match play (Stone and Kilding, 2009).
Burkc, L, Louck,,A. and Broad, N .. 2006. Encrgy and carbohydmtc for lraining and n>covc'!)< J oi Sport.>Scicn<:e;<;, 2·1(71 pp.675.fiS5.
Dunford M. cd., 2006. Sporb:< Nulrition:A l'ractm.' Manual for Profoooionals4lh cdition. Amcric.1n DiclcticsMooc. Although 60% of the time between consecutive high-intensity actions across match
Du"'n, D.L., Shcrwood, R.J ., Czcrwlnski. S.A., Lcc, M., Choh, AC., Sicrvogd, R.M. and Chumlc.l, W.C., 2003. Dody Compo,ilion Mcthodo:
Comparisons ,1nd Intcrp,.,,tation. J Diabetes Sei Tcchnol, 2(6), pp. J l39--ll·l6 performance is spent walking, evidence shows that per game, top-class soccer play-
Frankcníicld, D., Roth-You&ey, L. and Comphcr, C., 2005. Comparir.on ofprcdklivc cquation,' for n.-sting mcL1bolio rale in hcalthy nono-
bc.<;c and obcscadul\s; a sy1;tcrnatic rcview.J Am Dict ,\J;:;oc, 105(5). pp,775-59 ers perform 150-250 intense actions (Mohr, Krustrup and Bangsbo, 2003), with a
Higgins, J.A., Higb<:e, D.R, Donahoo, W.T., Brown, t.L., Deli, I.L. and Bcs:;eom, D.H., 2004. Reoiwint slar<:h consumption pro motes lipid
o~idation. Nutrition & l\ktabolir,m, 1(8).
high-intensity action every 72 seconds (Bradley et al., 2009). Based on the physical
Hosscin·nczhnd,A- nnd Holick, M.F., 2013. Vilamin D for Hcalth:AGlobal Pcrr.pcctivc. MaynClin Proc, 88(7), pp.72(1.SS.
jçnkin.,, M.A.,1995. Antioxídanlo ;md Fn.>c Rodicnh Sport:;!\lcd Web. hllp:/ /www.ric•H•du/-jcnky/~porW/un!iox.html
demands and characteristics of team sport competition, and the potential impor-
Jellc, M., Sidney, K. and Blurnchent, G., 1990. Mct,,bolic Equivillcnlr. {METS) in ExcrcL<c Tcsting, E.l<crcisc Prescription, and Evalualion oi tance of aerobic fitness, it is clear that a significant portion of the conditioning pro-
Functmnal Capadly. Chn. Curd1ol., 13, pp.555-565.
Maf>&ey, L. K., 2003. Didary nnirnul and pl.1nl protcin and hurnan bane heulth: A wholc foods approach, Joumnl of Nulrilion 133: grams for soccer players should focus on improving their aerobic fitness in order to
8625-8655. 30
McArdl~, W., Katch, F.I.. and Ka1ch, V.L., 2012- Spor!Sand fu<cmsc Nutrition.·lth cdilion. fo!timo,.,, MD: \Vi!Hams nnd \\'ilkins. repeatedly perform high-intensity exercise bouts and recover adequately between
Ogan, D. and Pritchct~ K, 2013. Vitarnin D ,1nd thc Ath!etc; Rir.ks, Recornmcndalions, and Bcncfits. NutricnW, 5(6), pp.1&56-1B6S.
Po,ilion oi thc Amcrican DicMk As.socialion, Dictitians of Canuda, and lhe Amcrican College of Sporlf., 2009. Medicine: Nulrition and these bouts (Stone and Kilding, 2009). Aerobic fitness measurements such as maxi-
Athklíc !'crfonnnnre.J Am DictNJ,;oc,109, pp.509·527.
Schwellnus, M.P., o,.,,w, N. and Collins, M., 2011. lncrcased running SP"cd and P"'vious oamps rathcr than dehydration or scmm sodíurn
mum oxygen uptake (V02rn,,) and the anaerobic threshold may also discriminate
drnng"'> P"'dict cxerci:><.~ar,socialcd rnusclc oamping: a ptOS!"'cliw cohort study in 210 Jronrnan triath!clcs. Dr j Sports Mcd, 45(8), between players of different competitive leveis (St0len et al., 2005), so soccer trai-
pp.65!l-6.
SjOdin, A.M., Forslund, A.H., We~ter!erp, K.R., Andersoon, A.6., Forslund, J.M. and Harnbraeus, 1..M., 19%. 111e infiucncc oi phye.ica! ning programs should regard aerobic conditioning as an important part of the sea-
activily on BMR. Medicine ~nd Scicnre in Sporlnand Exercite, 28(1), pp.85·91.
sonal training plan (Impellizzeri et al., 2005).
~
5.2 PHYSICAL ABILITIES ,,::r - ~

We have adapted the classification developed by Steinhofer (Steinhofer, D., Leistungssport, Vol. 26, No. 6, 1993) to define the various physical ~~
abilities and the corresponding training methods. This classification will be used throughout this book to set up training plans. ?i' m
" V>
- V>
" -z
!?
::: VI
''"o
~n
lntensity lntensity lntensity Work/ "~ n
m
Physical Methodical Training Me- Abbrevia- Volume Repetiti-
ability Training thods tion
Characteristics
(min) ons
(average
velocity)
(HR.n)
%
{V02mn)
%
rest
ratio
""~ "'
~
Long slow dis-
Long sfow distance. .Q,
LSD 60- 100

l
Uninterrupted low load 1 60 60 40 8/1
tance
intensity high volumes

Uninterrupted low to
.,,,;;·
Continuous
ConE 15 - 30
:;
medium load intensity 1-4 70 70 58 5/1
Continuous extensive
high volumes ffi
Aerobic principie
Endurance (without reco-
veries) Variab!e enduran- Unplanned intensity
CV 30-45 1-3 60-100 60-100 40-100 5/1
ce method changes

Fartfek variable Systematic intensity


method
Fa 30-45 1-3 60-100 60-100 40-100 5/1
changes

Continuous High intensity, medium


Conl 8-15 3-5 75 75 65 3/1
intensive volumes

Tab/e 5. 1: Aerobic endurance and the different training methods

lntensity lntensity lntenslty


Methodical Characteris- Volume Worklrest
Physical ability Training Methods Abbreviation Repetitions (average (HRmax) (V02ma•)
Training tics (min) ratio
velocity) '% %

lnterval method {Medium to intensity, medium to high volumes)

High intensity,
vo=, lnterval v02tnt high volume
5-8 6-12 85-90 85-90 75-83 2/1

Long interval
Lint 2 to 5 minutes 3-5 5-8 90-95 90-95 83-90 2/1
loads
Medium interval
Mini 1 to3min 1-3 8-15 90-95 90-95 83-90 211
loads

Short interval 30- ~


lnterval Sint 15sto1min 10-20 90-95 90-95 83-90 211 ';;;
loads 60sec
Anaerobic end-
urance
principie
(incomplete
[
recoveries) Repetition method (High intensity, limited to low to medium volumes) §.
VOZm:;,, repetition V0 2Rep
High intensity,
high volume
4 6-12 85-90 90-100 83-100 211 "'~
Long repetition
load
LRep 2min 2-3 3-5 90-95 95-100 90-100 211 ~
:;.
.,,
Medium repeti!ion MRep 1 minto2min 1-2 8-12 90-95 95-100 90-100 211 ~

Short repetition
Srep 15sto 1min
15-
8 tot 10 90-95 95-100 90-100 211 .Q_Z
~ :s
!oads 60sec Q m
.,, V>
~ V>
Q -
Table 5.2: Anaerobic endurance and the different traíning methods .,. z
(:;' VI
.,,, o
:; n
.,, n
"'m
"' "'
""'
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
76
Physical abilities and the role of aerobíc fitness Physical abi/ities and the role of aerobic fitness

5.3 AEROBIC FITNESS 5.4 SOCCER-SPECIFIC TRAINING DRILLS USING THE CONTINUOUS
Ahigh level of aerobic fitness is important for the modern-day soccer player. Ahigh PRINCIPLE
vo2max has been correlated with work-rate during a game and is reported to aid
recovery during high-intensity intermittent exercise (Reilly, 1997). An increase in 5.4.1 Continuous extensive
the capacity of the 0 2 transport system leads to a higher aerobic contribution to the
energy expended, taxing the anaerobic energy system less and subsequently redu- Explanation:
cing fatigue by saving glycogen and preventing decreases in muscle pH (Impel- Create hvo diamond-shaped forma-
lizeri et al,. 2006). Helgerud et ai. (2001) concluded that enhanced aerobic fitness tions next to each other with a mini-
in soccer players improved their performance by increasing the distance covered mum of six players. The positions of
the cones can be position specific.
(20%), enhancing work intensity, and increasing the number of sprints (100%) and Player Xl plays to player X3, who sets
involvements with the ball during a match (24%). This study found a 10% incre- the ball to player X2, \Vho then plays to
ase in V02max after the addition of 20 specific training sessions to a normal soc- player X4. Player X4 dribbles with the
cer training regime in 10 weeks, a finding reproduced by McMillan et al.(2005). A ball toward the starting position XS on
the other side.
reduced attention to aerobic conditioning during the competitive season, in some
sports, suggests that the importance of aerobic endurance may be underrated. This · Progression
may be warranted in some instances, such as if other aspects (technical or physical) XI -X2- X3- X4- XS- ...
are shown to be more important. Accordingly, it appears that coaches, along with Variation:
strength and conditioning professionals, prioritize training regimens that focus on Player Xl plays to player X2, who
improving anaerobic fitness during the competitive season. This is most probably sets it back to Xl. Player Xl passes to
because high-intensity activities are associated with important game-winning situ- player X3, who sets it back to player
X2, \Vho then plays to player X4.
ations, such as scoring points in basketball or scoring a try in rugby union. Howe-
ver, it should be emphasized that a lack of aerobic conditioning is also very likely
to influence the ability to repeatedly perform, and recover from, high-intensity acti-
vity (e.g., sprints), so the absence of aerobic conditioning during the competitive Explanation:
Xl passes to X2, who receives, turns,
season, regardless of sport, may not represent best practice in terms of optimizing and then plays the bali to X3. X3 passes
the condition of athletes (Stone and Kilding, 2009). to X4, \vho receives the bali and plays
Continuous extensive and continuous intensive training drills train soccer players the ball to the GK using the inside of
to be able to sustain 90 minutes of competitive match play. These drills particu- the foot and keeping the ball lo\v. After
finishing, X4 dribbles back \Vith the
lary invoke beneficial peripheral (muscular) adaptations in soccer players, but also
bali, performs a SAQ exercise as indi-
are of benefit to the cardiovascular (central) system. For example, these training cated, and begins a new exercise at the
drills increase muscular capilliarisation and increase the concentration of specific other side to ensure both feet are being
intra-muscular enzymes that helps the player to burn more fats during match-play, used.
therefore crucially preserving muscle glycogen stores. Some examples of these trai-
ning drills are now presented in a soccer-specific manner. Variations
0 Xl passes to X2, lvho plays back to

Xl. Xl then plays to X3, \vho recei-


ves, turns and plays to X4. X4 shoots
the ball into the hands of the GK.
o Xl passes to X2, 'vho plays back to Comments
0 Passing quality
Xl. Xl then plays to X3. X3 plays
back to X2, who passes to X4. X4 o Continuous running exercises
then finishes by putting the ball in a
comer of the goal.
0 XI passes to X2, who plays back to Progression
XI. XI then plays to X3. X3 plays XI - X2- X3 - X4- XS- X6- X7 - XS
back to X2, \vho passes to X4.
X•l then puts the ball back to X3,
rnaking a feint before receiving the
ball again frorn X3 and finishing in a
Ivl situation \Vith the GK.
o Integration of defenders.
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
Physical abilities and the role of aerobic fitness 79
Physical abílíties and the role of aerobic fitness

5.4.2 Continuous intensive


Explanation . . .
Positions can be changed and the pass1ng direction
can also be altered. The exercise starts with a thro\v Explanation
from the goalkeeper ora pass from the coach. Xl plays to X3, who then plays the bali to X2.
X2 plays the bali to X4, \vho puts the ball, over
Variations the ground using the inside of the foot, to the
o Different passing directions. GK. After finishing, X4 returns down the mid-
o Different formations dle and begins a nelv exercise at the other side,
so both left and right sides are practiced.
Progression
Stay in position or rotate:
Xl-X2-X3-X4-X5-X6-X6-Yl-Y2-... Variations
o Xl to X2, X2 to Xl, XI plays to X3, X3 to X2,
\vho then plays the bali to X4, lvho recei-
ves, turns and shoots into the hands of the
keeper, still with a controlled shot.
o XI to X2, X2 to XI, XI to X4. X4 plays to
X3, \vho then dribbles and shoots on goal.
If desired, X3 can make a skill movement
before finishing.
o Integration of defenders.

Explanation:
Xl plays to X2, \vho then plays to X3. X3 takes the position of X4.
Progression: Comment
0 Playing to the goalkeeper with inside of the Adapt distances to the objective of the peri-
Variation
foot. odization and the number of players.
0
Xl passes to X2. X2 passes to Xl, and Xl plays to X3. 0 Playing into the goalkeeper' s hands
0 Xl passes to X2. X2 passes to Xl, who plays to X3. X2 then puts (passive) pressure on X3, and
• Playing to the corners \Vith the inside of the
Xl asks for the ball on the inside or outside for a 1-2. X3 then has the option to take on the foot. Progression
defender and go past X2 or engage in a 1-2 with Xl. 0 Normal finishing to score a goal. Xl-X2-X3-X4
0 Xl to X2, \vho sets it back to Xl. Xl plays to X3, \Vho does a 1-2 \vith X2.

Progression:
Xl-X2-X3-X4-XS-6-Xl
FITNESS IN SOCCER
FITNESS IN SOCCER
801 Physical abilifies and the role of aerobic jitness Physical abilities and the role of aerobic fitness

Explanation Explanation
The game is played 10v10 on the field pJayer Xl plays the ball to X2. Player X2
with one neutral player of each team plays the ball straight back to player Xl.
on both sides of the pitch. The neutral Player Xl receives the ball and passes
players have to play the ball back into
the game while using a maximum hvo
to X3, and player X3 plays straight to
X2, ,vho passes back to X3. X3 receives t
touches and then change position \Vith and plays a long bali to XS. The sarne
A:i
the player he received the ball from.
The aim is to get width into the game.
exercise is then started on the other side
with another bali.
After X3 has kicked a long ball, he has
t1
a ball played to him by the coach and
Variations finishes in one or hvo touches. He then
0 The neutral player gets the bali, puts it runs to position X4.
back in the game \vith one touch and
• .,
then changes positíon. Comments
• The neutral player receives the ball o Various passing configurations are
and is obliged to dribble into the field
possible.
before playing the ball to one of his Comments o The exercise is best started off with
teammates (decision making). Emphasize the movement of the neutral players one ball
• Sarne as variation 2, but when drib- along the side of the field. They need to participate
bling into the field, his third touch of in an active way and anticipate the changing posi- Progression
the ball needs to be a pass (speed of tions of the players in the field. X2-Xl-X3-X4
execution).
• Variation in the number of touches.
• Variation in how to make goals (one
touch, keep possession after goaL .... } Explanation
• If you \vant to bring depth in the The play starts with a dribble by Xl. Xl
game, you can put the neutral players plays the ball to X3, 'vho plays to X.2.
between the small goals. X2 then dribbles inside and plays to X4,
who receives, turns, and plays the bali

...
Explanation to the other side (to XS). After X4 has
The game is played using lüvlü in the given the pass to XS, the GK thro\VS a
middle of the pitch. Each player is given bali to\vard X4, which he has to contrai
a particular number. The coach calls out nnd finish. Sarne exercise at both sides
four numbers each time. These players lvith both groups working simultane-
have to Ieave the box as quickly as pos- ously. The coach gives a signal \vhen
sible, run around one of the sticks sur- the next players can begin to coordinate
rounding the pitch, and return to their and control the intensity.
positions as quickly as possible. This
means there are six playing against 10 Variations
every time the coach calls four numbers 0 Xl to X3, who plays it back to Xl. Xl
from the sarne team.
to X2, who dribbles inside and plays
• to X4. X4 puts it back to X2, \vho
Variations gives a long bali to XS.
• You can vary the amount of numbers o Xl to X3, ,vho puts it back to Xl. Xl to
you call from each team, so the teams X.2, \vho puts it back to X3. X3 plays
play against each other in different to X4, \vho plays it back to X.2. X2
Comments
numbers, changing the intensity each gives the long bali to XS.
o Players can be set up in a normal playing system. o Integration of defenders.
time.
0 When calling the nurnber of a player,
o Assistant coaches can control offside rule.
you can add the nurnber of a specific Comments Progression
cone around \vhich they have to run, • Various passing configurations are Xl-X3-X2-X4-XS-X6-X7-X8
as \Vell as the direction {Left/Right) possible.
0 The exercise can be started off vv·ith
(different distances}.
o Numbers can be paired, so players one ball
from both teams have to leave the box.
• Play one or hvo touches.
f ITN ESS 1N SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
sz I Physica/ abilities and the role of aerobic fttness High-intensity interval training

SUMMARY
Both low-to-moderate-intensity "extensive" soccer exercises and more intense,
but shorter, "intensive" soccer drills are important to improve soccer-specific fit-
ness. Continuous extensive games (e.g., 4 x 20 minute bouts of 11v11 on a full-size
pitch) train the soccer players' capacity to complete 90 minutes of competitive
match play. More intensive soccer drills of shorter duration (e.g., 8 x 4 minute
bouts of 4v4 small-sided games) train soccer players to play at a high intensity
and cope with the demands of an intensive period during a game. High-intensity
interval training is discussed in the next chapter.
HIGH-INTENSITY INTERVAL
TRAINING (WITH SPECIAL REFERENCE
TO SMALL SIDED GAME PLAY)
Kenny McMillan, Jan Van Winckel, Guido Seerden, Werner Helsen

6.1 INTRODUCTION TO HIGH-INTENSITY INTERVAL TRAINING (HllT)


Interval training can be defined as a single or repeated interval of sport-specific
exercise with no additional resistance (Paton and Hopkins, 2004), \vhile high-inten-
sity training refers to exercise performed above the second ventilatory threshold
(Seiler and Kjerland, 2006). Because training at high intensity puts a high strain
on the player, high-intensity training can be organized through interval training.
Interval h·aining at high intensities (i.e., just below or around V02 ma) improves
endurance performance through improvements in all of the three components of
the aerobic system: V0 2max' anaerobic threshold, and running economy.
REFERENCES
HIIT (High-Intensity Interval Training) may consist of high-intensity workloads
Bishop, D. and Spencer, M., 200-1. OQlNmirmits of rcpcalcd·sprint ability in wdl-train~d tcam+port athlclcr. and cndurnnc1-~trilincd
uthlctcs.J Sports Mcd Phys Fitnoso, 4·1{1), pp.1•7.
J
(> 85% V02 m 11 executed for a short duration (between 30 seconds and 4 minutes)
!lri!dlcy, P.S., Sheldon, W., Woostcr, !I., Oloen, P, Boana5, /'. and !<ru<lrup, !'., 2009, High-lnlcmity running ln FA P"'mier l<eaguc ~,occcr interspersed with recovery times in between each exercise bout (usually in a 1:1, 1:2
mntdic". joumal oi SportsSdcncc3, 27, pp.15<J-16S.
Gabktt, T.J. and Mul,·c;~ M.J ., 2003. Time-motion analysis of small·r.idcd lrnlning gümcs and compctilion in dite womcn r.occcr playcm. or 2:1 ratio). HIIT can be traced back to as long ago as 1912, when the Finnish Olym-
Joumal ofStr<.'ngth and Conditioninz Rcocardl, 22, pp.S.H-552.
Hclgcrud )., Wir.lofi, U., Engcn L. and Hofi, J. (2001) Acrobic cnduran<'<' lraining imprm·cr. socccrpcrformancc. Medicine and Sdcncc in pic long-distance runner Hannes Kolehmainen was reported to be using interval
Sporls nnd facr<:i!W, 33:11, pp.1925-1931
tmpdhzcri, F.M., Rampinini, E. und Marcora, S.M., 2005. Physiologkal a5"cssmcnt of acrobk training in socccr. l Sporls Sei, 23(6), training in his workouts (Billat, 2001). Severa! years later in the 1930s, the German
pp.58.3-92.
Jmpcllizzcri, F.M., Ma reora, S.M., Cilc.tagna, C., Rdlly, T., Sa%i, A.faia, F.M., 2006. Pliysiological .lnd pcrfom1ancc dfects of gcnclic ''C!'Jur.
professor Dr. Woldemar Gerschler further developed interval training at the Uni-
spcciflc acrobic training in wcccr playcm. lntcmationnl joumal of Sports Mcdidnc, 27, ppA83-192
McMilfan, !<., Helgerud, /., Macdonald, lt, nnd Hoff, J.,2005 Phy$iologka! adapti!IÍO!l.' \o •occcr·opccific endurnn<:c training in profc,:si-
versity of Freiburg. Gerschler teamed up with cardiologist Dr. Herbert Reindel, and
onal youth "'"'"'' playcrs. Br JSports Mcd 39; pp.273-277. together they developed a training system consisting of running intense but short
Mohr, M., Krustrup, P. and füngsbo,J., 2003. 1'.fatcli pcrformnnreofhigh+tandard soc<'<'r pfoyers with spcdal .,,[c.,,ncc to devclopmcnt
of fatigue.Joumal of SportsScicnres, 21, pp.519-528. distances followed by brief recovery "intervals" (Sears, 2001). Gerschler did not
Reíl!y, T., Atkiru;on, G. and Waterhousc J., 1997. Travd fatigue and jct-lag.J Sports Sci., 15(3), pp.365-9. _ _
Stnlcn, T., Chama ri, K, C.1stagnn, C. and Wislolf, U., 2005. Phy~io!ogy ofScx:<:cr.An Update. Sports Me, 3~, pp.501-536. allow a runner to begin the next repetition until the HR had retumed to 120bpm
Stonc, N.M. and !<ilding, A.E., 2009. Acrobic Condilioning for Tcam Sport Athlcles. Sports Mcd, 39(8), pp.615-6-12.
(Jenkins, 2005).
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
High-intensity interva/ training 85
High-intensity interval training

Today, HIIT is regarded as one of the most effective means of improving the physi- 6.2 HllT EFFECTS ON CARDIOVASCULAR ANO MUSCULAR ADAPTATIONS
cal performance of athletes (Buchheit and Laursen, 2013a). Indeed, in already well- The cardiovascular and muscular adaptations to HIIT are summarized in the table
trained athletes, the supplementation of high-intensity training on top of an already below.
high training volume seems to be extremely effective (Laursen, 2011; Laursen and
Jenkins, 2002). Various studies have shown the significant effects of HIIT in as little Effects of High lntensity lnterval Training
as 2-3 weeks (Acton-jacobs et ai., 2013; Bogdarus et a!., 2013; Buchan et ai., 2013; Cardiovascular adaptations
Tjonna et ai., 2013; Boyd et al., 2013). Scientific research on the optimum length
lncreased cardiac muscle capillary density
of high-intensity intervals is equivoca}, although positive results have been found
with various interval lengths ranging from 30 seconds up to 4 minutes (Little et al.,
2010; Esfatjani and Laursen, 2007; Laursen et ai., 2002; Billat et ai., 2000; Smith et ai.,
. Lowered HR at similar pre-training work levels
lncrease cardiac efficiency and the maximal mitochondrial capacity of the heart

1999). With regards to the training intensity, scientific research demonstrates that .. (Hafstad et ai., 2011 ).
lncreased stroke volume (Helgerud et ai., 2007)
sub-maximal (i.e., 90-95% V02 ) (Zuniga et ai., 2011) or maximal intensities (100% Lower blood lactate levels for a given work intensity
VO 2m~x ) (Bishop et ai., 2011) eli~it the greatest adaptations. ln their review on HIIT, lncreased left ventricle volume and increased contractibility (Slordahl et ai., 2004)
Buchheit and Laursen (2013a) suggest that maximal ar close to maximal intensities lncrease in V0 2max (Oaussin et ai., 2008)
are the most effective at increasing aerobic capacity because they stress the oxygen Muscular adaptations
transport system the most, activate more and larger motor units of muscle fibers,
and are performed at near maximal cardiac output. While there is evidence that
. lncreased transcription and biogenesis of mitochondria in the skeletal muscle cells
of highly trained athletes (Acton-Jacobs et ai., 2013)
there are still benefits to be gained from HIIT training programs using lower inten- lncrease in mitochondria (number and size) (Gibala, 2009)
sities (Boyd et al., 2013), the most profound benefits are realized at higher intensi- lncrease in maximal activities of mitochondrial enzymes in skeletal muscle
(Kubekeli et ai., 2002; Laursen and Jenkins, 2002)

...
ties (Acton-jacobs et ai., 2013; Boyd et ai., 2013; Cicioni-Kolsky et ai., 2013; Moholdt
lncreased proportion of Type lla fibers (Billat, 2001)
et ai., 2013).
Optimized oxidative phosphorylation
lncrease in oxidative enzymes (Burgomaster et ai., 2008)
When examining the effect of training intensity distribution on aerobic fitness vari- Activation of PGC-1 a via AMPK pathways
ables in elite soccer players, Castagna et al. (2011) reported that even though almost
two-thirds of players' training time was spent at low intensities, only the time spent . lncrease in fat oxidative capacity (Talanian et ai., 2007)
lncrease in GLUT4 and glycogen
at high intensity (90% of HRmn) was related to changes in aerobic fitness. Impelliz-
zeri et ai. (2005) reported similar findings and demonstrated a significant correla- Table 6. 1: OveNiew of the effects of HllT
tion between time spent in high-intensity zones and changes in oxygen uptake at
lacta te threshold. These results highlight the effectiveness of high-intensity training
in soccer. It is believed that an optimal stimulus to elicit both maximal cardiovascu- 6.3 LACTATE FORMATION DURING HllT
lar and peripheral adaptations is one where athletes spend at least several minutes During oxygen-independent glycolysis, glucose/ glycogen molecules are processed
per session in their "red zone," which generally means reaching at least 90% V0 2m.•x and broken down inside the muscle cells. Each molecule of glucose is broken down
(Buchheit & Laursen, 2013b). High-intensity training that raises the HR to above to deli ver ATP, and two molecules of lactic acid are produced (a proton and lacta te).
90% of HR should constitute at least 7-8% of the total weekly training plan for Many coaches still believe that lactate is a metabolic dead-end only formed under
elite soccermPlayers during preseason and in-season (Castagna et al., 2013). anaerobic conditions, with lactate playing the role of the toxic by-product. This
oxygen-independent glycolysis works continuously (even during rest) and not
only when sufficient oxygen is unavailable (Brooks, 1986). All energy systems are,
to a greater ar lesser extent, active ali the time, and their contributions depend on
the energy requirements and therefore the intensity and duration of exercise.
The levei oflactate found in the blood and muscles is the difference behveen lactate
produced and lactate processed. At some point of increasing intensity, lactate pro-
duction will become higher than lactate clearance. ln the past, this was referred to
as the anaerobic threshold or the Onset of Blood Lactate Accumulation (OBLA).
We use the term lactate threshold in this book. This lactate threshold is determined
not just by lactate production but also by the ability of muscle cells to remove and
process lacta te. If lactate levels accumulate, as may happen during HIIT, glycolysis
is inhibited and the muscle fiber fatigues dueto the protons associated \vith Jactate
ians.
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
High-intensity interval training High-intensity interval trainíng

6.4 LACTATE CLEARANCE DURING HllT Although the research into MCTs is still in its infancy, it can already be concluded
Lactate can be cleared via two mechanisms. It can be metabolized back to pyru- that lactate processing can be improved through appropriate training. To improve
vate and processed in the muscle cell by oxidative phosphorylation, which is an lactate clearance and processing in soccer players, training at fluctuating high
oxygen-dependent process. On the other hand, lactate can leave the muscle cell intensities (i.e., HIIT) is necessary. During soccer-specific HIIT for example, Iactate
through the cell membrane. It may then be absorbed and utilized in oxidative meta- is produced, and during recovery intervals, the body is trained to efficiently utilize
bolism by other muscle cells within the sarne muscle, ar it may leave the muscle and clear the lactate. Therefore, HIIT is important to improve MCT concentrati-
and enter the circulation system. ons, lactate processing, lactate clearance, the lactate threshold, and performance
Once in the circulation, lactate can be: capacity.
o Transported to other skeletal muscles where it can be stored
o Used by the heart for oxidative energy production
• Transported from the peripheral tissues to the liver by means of the Cori 6.5 HIGH·INTENSITY INTERVAL TRAINING VERSUS LOW·INTENSITY
CycleL where it is then reformed into pyruvate through the reverse reaction CONTINUOUS TRAINING
using lactate dehydrogenase Both HIIT and low-intensity continuous training are important in impro~ing aero-
e Transported to the brain for oxidative energy production. bic fitness. The main goal of interval conditioning is to induce a greater training
stimulus at intensities higher than what would be tolerated in a single bout of
The lactate shuttle, which describes the movement of lactate intracellularly and continuous exercise (Wenger and Bell, 1986). Continuous lo1v-intensity training
intercellularly (cell to cell), was hypothesized by Dr George Brooks in the 1980s. recruits predominantly slow-hvitch motor units, while HIIT will recruit additio-
This theory states that lactate produced at sites with high rates of glycolysis and nal fast-twitch motor units for relatively short durations (Enoka and Duch, 2008).
glycogenolysis can be shuttled to adjacent or remote sites, including the heart and The cardiovascular adaptations that occur with HIIT are similar, and in some cases
other skeletal muscles, where the lactate can be used as a gluconeogenic precursor superior, to those that occur with continuous endurance training (Helgerud et al.,
or substrate for oxidation (Brooks, 2009). During HIIT, fast-tvvitch fibers begin pro- 2007; Wisl0ff, Ellingsen and Kemi, 2009). Moreover, HIIT can often produce a broad
ducing lactate at high rates. Because fast-hvitch fibers are not built well for oxida- range of physiological effects in less time than high-volume low-intensity conti-
tive phosphorylation, lactate is emitted and subsequently picked up by slow-tvvitch nuous exercise (Londeree, 1997; Daussin et al., 2008; Psilander et al., 2010). This
fibers, which are better equipped for oxidative phosphorylation, or the circulatory may be because the time course for performance improvement with increases in
system may carry it to the heart, the liver, the brain or less active muscles. training volume may not occur as rapidly as when using acute increases in high-in-
tensity training (Laursen et al., 2002; Laursen, 2011).
6.4.1 Monocarboxylate transporters (MCTs) and HllT Ho1vever, some important physiolo-
Monocarboxylate transporters (MCTs) are proton-linked plasma membrane trans- gical adaptations occur in response to
porters that carry molecules having one carboxylate group (monocarboxylates), Jo;v-intensity continuous training that
such as lactate and pyruvate, across biological men1branes. are not observed with HIIT (Laursen,
In the literature, at least 14 MCTs have been identified, although MCTl and MCT4 2011). For instance, Ingham et al. (2008)
seem to be most relevant to lactate and pyruvate transportation 1vithin cardiac and demonstrated that a low-intensity con-
skeletal muscle (Bonen, 2001). MCTl and MCT4 have been identified as H+ /lactate tinuous training group improved their
symporters capable of mediating the bidirectional transport of lactic acid across the speeds at lactate threshold to a greater
plasma membrane (Halestrap and Meredith, 2004). extent than the mixed-intensity training
MCTl is the most important MCT for endurance athletes because it is the key group. It is often purported that these
lactate mover in muscle cells. Slow-hvitch muscle fibers in particular have relati- periods of relatively low intensity and
vely large amounts of MCTl in their membranes. The presence of large quantities high training volumes may provide
of MCTl in slow-twitch fibers and cardiac n1uscle cells demonstrates that MCTl is the "aerobic base" needed to facilitate
probably responsible for clearing lactate to cells that are better equipped for oxida- the specific adaptations that occur in
tive phosphorylation. response to HIIT (Laursen, 2011). The
Unlike MCTl, MCT4 is more common to fast-twitch muscle fibers, suggesting that periodization of continuous extensive
MCT4 is better equipped to transport lactate out of the muscle cell. Exercise trai- soccer drills (e.g., 2 x 15 minutes of 9 v 9
ning can increase the expression of both MCTI and MCT4 in muscle cells, and this play at an intensity of 70-75% of HR 0 . , )
effect is related to the intensity of training. MCT4, like other glycolytic enzymes, is and higher intensity "intensive" drills
up-regulated by hypoxia. This adaptive response allows the increased lactic acid (e.g., 6 x 4 minutes of 4 v 4 small sided
produced during hypoxia to be rapidly cleared from the cell (Ullah et ai., 2006). game play play) throughout the soccer
season is discussed in Chapters 14to18.
ss I High-intensity
FITNESS IN SOCCER
interval training
FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
High-intensity interva/ training 89

6.6 HIGH-INTENSITY INTERVAL TRAINING WITH OR WITHOUT THE BALL Hoff and Helgerud (2004) argue that continuous interval training for 3-S min using
ln soccer, two different conditioning methods are usually used to improve fitness: a working intensity of 90-95% of HRmnx should eleva te V02max of soccer players by
conditioning exercises without the ball and conditioning exercises with the bali. enhancing stroke volume and thereby increasing cardiac output. Hoff et al. (2002)
Conditioning exercises using the ball are being increasingly implemented in soccer designed a soccer-specific dribbling track (Hoff track) for this purpose, and they
practice (Hoff et al., 2002; McMillan et al., 2005). The main advantage of skill-based reported that this form of interval training resulted in physical loads equivalent to
conditioning games and exercises over traditional interval training without the ball 94% HRmax and 92% V02ma-"' which are optimal intensities for developing aerobic
(e.g., generic running drills) is that they also provide the opportunity to develop fitness (figure 6.1). When using the Hoff track to conduct 4 x 4 minute intervals at
decision-rnaking and problem-solving skills while under stressful physical loads 90-95% of each players HRm,>1 McMillan et al. (2005) increased the average V0 2max
(Gabbett, 2001). Moreover, soccer-specific conditioning drills such as small-sided of the Celtic FC U-18's squad by approximately 10% in only 10 weeks. Two inter-
games (SSGs) may be slightly more strenuous than traditional training approaches vals sessions were performed per week in addition to the normal soccer training
(Impellizzeri et al., 2005). These higher responses in soccer players may be attribu- regime.
ted to use of the ball, which increases the metabolic cost of performing any given Importantly, by using the Hoff track soccer players can improve their aerobic end-
activity (Little and Williams, 2006; Kelly and Drust, 2009). The motivation and ent- urance in a safe and controlled manner, due to the low number and magnitude of
husiasm of players may also be greater when engaging in soccer-specific conditio- accelerations and decelerations involved (low neuromuscular load), and of course
ning games and dri11s (Stone and Kilding, 2009). a lack of tackles and body contact. When using SSGs for fitness training, there is
always the risk of injury due to lots of twisting and turning movements, mistimed
6.6.1 Generic continuous running drills tackles and body collisions.

25m 6.6.2 Generic intermittent running drills


30m Soccer coaches can also prescribe high-intensity intermittent drills to improve anae-
robic and aerobic fitness. Generic running drills involving short exercise times and
recoveries (e.g., lSs running:lSs recovery and 30s running:lSs recovery are typi-
cal examples). Work-rest ratios, running velocity, accelerations, decelerations and

6~
}
'.
""
changes of direction can all affect the intensity of these drills. Running at intensities
dose to ar just over the velocity at V02m,,, (vV0 2m,J for a period of 5 - 8 minutes is
an example of a generic intermittent running drill that would serve useful to soccer
players. The running velocity at the end of the 30-15 Intermittent Fitness Test (vIFT)
as described in Chapter 7 is an example of an individualized running velocity that
' } tom can be used to design and implement effective generic intermittent running drills
to improve a soccer player's endurance capabilities. Since the main scope of this

~
6 chapter is on high-intensity SSG play, the readeris referred to the excellent work of
Buchheit and Laursen (2013a; 2013b) for a comprehensive overview of such drills
} lOm
55m and the physiological adaptations they manifest.

6~
One of the main advantages of using generic running drills to improve the end-
urance capabilities of soccer players is that intensity can be easily controlled and
}
!Om individualized for each player. For example, when using the Hoff track, each player
runs at his own individualized 1unning speed to keep his HR at behveen 90-95%
.ó.B: HRmux· Another example vvould be a squad of players all performing intermittent
running at 90% of their vV02 m,,,, ar vIFT.

15 m

!Om

J
<E·,.···································
START

Fig. 6. 1: The "Hoff track" used for soccer-specific interval training.


FITNESS IN SOCCER flTNESS IN SOCCER
High-intensity interval training High-intensity interva/ training

6.7 SMALL·SIDED GAMES (SSGs) 6.7.1 Pitch size


Recently, many people have tried to rediscover the usefulness of SSGs within soc- Increasing the pitch size results in higher cardiovascular strain (Aroso et al., 2004;
cer fitness training (Aguiar et al., 2012; Clemente et al., 2012, Hill-Haas et al., 2011). Tessitore et al., 2006), although Clemente et al. (2012) concluded that there is no
SSGs have the benefit that they reproduce the movements, technical conditions, and consensus within the literature about the effects of pitch size on HR. Overall, incre-
physiological intensities of a real soccer game (Gamble, 2004; Ovven, 2003; Gregson ased pitch area increases HR, rate of perceived exertion (RPE) and blood lactate
and Drust, 2000; Little, 2009) 1vhile simultaneously obliging players to <leal with concentration. However, when looking at the effect of pitch dimensions on exercise
pressure and decision making in a fatigued status (Gabbet and Mulvey, 2008). They intensity within SSGs, we need to differentiate between the absolute and relative
also help players to develop their technical and tactical skills within a realistic pitch areas. The absolute area is the total pitch area (e.g., 40x20m), while the rela-
game situation. Research has shown that athletes regard match-like training sessi- tive pitch area is the total pitch area divided by the total number of players (Hill-
ons to be the most important practice activities for improving performance (Singer Haas et ai., 2011). This gives the individual playing area for a player (e.g., 10 square
and Janelle, 1999; Hodges and Starkes, 1996; Starke et al., 1996; Helsen, Starkes, and meters). Rampinini et al. (2007) found that a larger absolute pitch size resulted in
Hodges, 1998). Moreover, SSGs also increase the players' motivation and compli- higher exercise intensities (HR, RPE and blood lactate concentration) compared
ance when compared to traditional fitness training sessions because they find them to medium- and small-sized pitches. On the other hand, Kelly and Drust (2009)
more sport specific (Gregson and Drust, 2000; Little, 2009). stated that the pitch size does not influence the intensity of SSGs when the num-
Due to the interaction between technical ability, tactical skills, and the physical ber of players involved is kept constant, but rather that it only altered the number
component, the use of SSGs can be more time efficient as these three factors can be of tackles and shots. It did not significantly change the number of other technical
trained alongside each other (i.e., concurrent training) (Gregson and Drust, 2000; actions, such as passing, receiving, turning, dribbling, interception and heading.
Little, 2009). Nevertheless, this depends on the specific game format. Some vari- Casamichana and Castellano (2010) indicated that an increase in relative playing
ables affect the exercise intensity, tin1e-motion characteristics, and technical load. area results in a larger physical (i.e., total distance covered; distance covered in
Coaches try to change the training stimulus by altering variables such as: low-, medium- and high-intensity running; distance covered per minute; work-to-
0 the size of the pitch rest ratio; maximum speed; and sprint frequency) and physiological workload (i.e.,
o number of players involved percent of HR"'""' percent of mean HR, time spent above 90~& HR"'"). The effective
0
use of goalkeepers playing time and RPE was also higher. Some motor behaviors (i.e., interception,
0
type of ball possession contrai and dribble, control and shoot, clearance, and putting the ball in play) were
o goal orientation shown less frequently, however. Some other studies have even found lower exer-
0 tactical obligations cise intensities '\Nith an increased relative pitch area (Rampinini et al., 2007).
0 coach encouragement
0
training regímen 6.7.1.1 PitclJ size and tactica/ training
0 players' characteristics Fradua et al. (2013) looked at pitch sizes extrapolated from full-size professional
matches in relation to the training of tactical aspects. Individual playing areas of
65-110 square meters with a length-to-\vidth ratio of 1:1-1:1.3 are recon1mended
\vhile training different tactical components. Coaches may use a relative pitch
area of 90 square meters (\vithin a range of 70-110 square meters) for playing out
fron1 the back and finishing, while 80 square meters (range 65-95 square meters) is
recommended to recreate transition play in the middle of field. Also, longer width-
to-length ratios are suggested for training transition play at this part of the field
(length-to-width ratio of 1:1.3), anda square-shaped pitch (1:1) is recommended for
playing out from the back and finishing sessions.

Fig. 6.2: The factors influencing the intensity of


a small-sided game.

It is hard not to get lost within the massive amount of research data, so presented
below is a brief overview together with some practical implications of the different
types of SSGs and the effect they may have on the acute physiological responses of
the players, as well as long-term physiological adaptations.
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
High-intensity interval training High-íntensíty ínterva/ traíníng

6.7.2 Number of players involved 6. 7.2.4 Havíng a floater or numbers up!numbers down
Some studies have focused on the effects of having a fixed overload or underload
6.7.2.1 Decreasing the number of p/ayers situation, also known as having numbers up or numbers down, and the effect of
Generally, a lower number of players results in a higher exercise intensity, with having a floater (a player who is only allowed to play with the team in possession
increased HR, RPE and blood lactate concentration (Duarte et al., 2009; Owen et al., of the ball). Underloaded teams showed higher RPE scores compared to the nume-
2004; Sampaio et al., 2007; Williams and Owen, 2007). For example, a 3v3 results rically superior team but with no differences in blood lactate concentrations and
in higher HRs with more goal attempts, dribbling, passing, tackling, high-inten- %HRm~x· A 4v3 ora 6v5 showed no significant difference in physiological and per-
sity activities, and total distance covered, combined with less jogging and walking, ceptual responses compared to the games with a floater (3v3 +1 and SvS +1), but it
than during a 5v5 (Platt et al., 2001). An interesting observation was that players seems that playing with a floater might be more beneficial for developing aerobic
covered greater distances moving backward and sideways in a 4v4 compared to fitness. The floater covered more total distance, completed more sprints (>18km/h)
an 8v8 0-ones and Drust, 2007). Reductions in the number of players also increased and had a higher RPE score post-training when c;:ompared to the players on either
the ball contacts per player (Balsom, 1999; Jones and Drust, 2007). This increased the overloaded or underloaded team (Hill-Haas et al., 2010). Coaches sometimes
individual possession of the ball might be the reason for an increase in exercise put players returning from injury into the position of floater because they may have
intensity (Balsom, 1999; Reilly and Ball, 1984). Castellano et al. (2011), on the other less risk of a contact injury due to the fact they cannot defend. However, coaches
hand, stated that reducing the number of players does not alter the physical load need to be aware of the abovementioned facts before they puta player in a floater
but rather just the physiological workload. A 3v3 provoked higher HR responses position. That said, if you want to increase a rehabilitating player's aerobic fitness,
and RPE scores than a 4v4, 5v5 or 6v6 (Rampinini et al., 2007). Therefore, the smal- you might want to consider him or heras a floater in a SSG.
ler format was shown to be more intense.
This was also concluded in some research studies concerning youth soccer. The
physiological demands were found to be higher during 2v2 and 3v3 games when 6.7.3 Rule modifications
compared to a 4v4 game (Dellal et ai., 2011a). In another study, the HR and per-
centage of HRmnx were higher during 3v3 and 4v4 games in comparison to lvl 6.7.3.1 The use of goa/keepers
and 2v2 games, although the 1vl game showed higher blood lactate concentra- Generally, the use of goalkeepers may decrease exercise intensity, both in terms of
tion (Kõklü et al., 2011). It was therefore concluded that smaller game situations physiological and physical load. The HR of the players will drop (Sassi et al., 2004;
(e.g., 1vl) might support anaerobic adaptations for youth soccer players (Kõklü Mallo and Navarro, 2008) because players will protect their goal more carefully,
et al., 2013), but they also increase the technical demands. Players increased their and this reduces the tempo of the game. Dellal et al. (2008) did find an increase
number of touches from, on average, 13 ball contacts in a ten-minute 8v8 game to in HR while using goalkeepers in an SSG, and this might be due to an increase in
36 ball contacts in a ten-minute 4v4 Uones and Drust, 2007). players' motivation to attack and defend. The total distance and the time spent in
high-intensity running will also decrease, and the time spent standing and wal-
6.7.2.2 lncreasíng the number of players king will increase correspondingly (Mallo and Navarro, 2008). Players will have a
Generally, a greater number of players reduces the exercise intensities during SSGs. higher HR and cover more distance when playing without a goalkeeper, and they
Owen et al. (2004) found a lower mean HR and peak HR when players were added will also have more ball contacts and make more short passes (Mallo and Navarro,
to a SSG. They also concluded that an increase in the number of players on the pitch 2008). Kõklü et ai. (2013) not only found an increase in HR but also in RPE, blood
leads to a decrease in technical actions per player. lactate concentration, total distance covered, and greater distances at speeds of
7.0-12.9 km/h, 13.0-17.9 km/h and greater than 18 km/h. So, if coaches want to
6.7.2.3 Player number ín relatíon to pitch area place higher physiological strains on players, they should choose SSGs without
An increase in absolute pitch area and player number may also result in a greater goalkeepers if they want to reduce the physiological strain, or vice versa.
relative pitch area, as has been shown in severa! studies (e.g., Rampinini et al., If we look at the use of goalkeepers and the pitch dimensions in relation to tactical
2007), and it seems that this lowers exercise intensity Uones and Drust, 2007). This training, we can divide the pitch into six different areas: areas 1 and 2 for playing
observed reduction in the physiological parameters Uones and Drust, 2007; Katis out from the back, 3 and 4 for midfield play, and 5 and 6 for finishing. Therefore,
and Kellis, 2009; Rampini et al., 2007) might have been the result of increasing the we can use the guidelines set up by Fradua et al. (2013). The distance noted is the
total number of players ora failure by the additional players to cover more ground distance between the goalkeeper and his closest teammate, according to the loca-
within the absolute pitch area. When we decrease the number of players while tion of the ball, regardless ofbeing in or out of possession of the ball. The following
keeping the relative pitch area constant, the physiological and perceptual workload distances are suggested: 5-lSm for zone 1, 10-20m for zone 2, 15--25m for zone 3,
increases as a result (Hill-Haas et al., 2009a). 20-30m for zone 4, and 25-35m for zones 5 and 6.
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
High-intensity interval training High-intensity interval training

6.7.3.2 Ball possession 6.7.4 Coach encouragement


Possession play generally affects the players' physical and physiological respon- Even though we want our players to be internally motivateci, active anci consistent,
ses, meaning that the game demands are higher (Castellano et al., 2013). When the coach encouragement provokes a sígnificant increase in players' physiological res-
number of players was altered in a possession-based SSG, the HR response did not ponses ciuring SSGs (Balsom, 1999). Higher HR, blooci lactate concentration, anci
shov.r a significant change, but the physical demands decreased ivith a decrease in RPE scores were noted for SSGs with coach encouragement when compareci to
player numbers. SSGs without. It even had a greater impact on these factors than an alteration in
An alteration in the type of possession game can also influence the technical and pitch size anci playing numbers (Rampinini et al., 2004).
physical demands of SSGs. Forcing the players to play one-touch leads to less suc-
cessful passes and duels. Therefore, more balls were lost during the game. It also 6.7.5 Training regimen
lea<ls to higher blood lactate concentrations, RPE, and total distance covered in
high-intensity rnns and sprints (Dellal et al., 2011b; Dellal et ai., 2012a). Even a 6. 7.5.1 Continuous vs. intermittent
permitted maximum of two touches leads to a higher perceptual training response An SSG can be conciucteci in either a continuous ar an intermittent manner. Casa-
in terms of a higher RPE score (Sampaio et al., 2007) and high-intensity running michana et al. (2013) stated that a continuous format leads to higher physical load.
(Dellal et al., 2012a). Free play, on the other hand, led to lower RPE scores but only However, others (Hill-Haas et al., 2009b) have founci that the intermittent format
for defensive midfielders, wide midfielders and forwards (Dellal et al., 2012a). A increased distances covereci faster than 13 km/h. These latter researchers also
coach can therefore manipulate the technical, physical and physiological demands found higher percentages of HRmax anci RPE scores. Both regimens can be useci for
by altering the amount of touches allowed. aerobic maintenance training during the in-season (Hill-Haas et al., 2009b). The-
refore, coaches can alter the physical anci physiological loads by choosing either a
continuous or an intermittent SSG.

6.7.5.2 Work~to#rest ratio

A factor that also influences the players' physical anci physiological loads is the
tvork-to-rest ratio. Unfortunately, there is a lack of research looking at the effect of
different ratios within SSGs, so \ve cannot make a clear recommendation of tvhich
ratios might be better for alternating the load, but coaches need to keep in minci
that this is also a crucial factor tvhen using SSGs in fitness training.

6.7.5.3 SSG duration


The duration of an SSG can also influence the exercise intensity, but it does not
affect the technical actions per minute. When we increase the duration of a 3v3
from 2 minutes to 4 and 6 minutes, there is a significant effect of duration on HR.
The HR response was lower in the first setting when compareci to the other two,
6.7.3.3 Goa/ orientation but the intensity dropped when moving from the 4-min to the 6-min SSG. The RPE
It seems that changing the 1ules of the game influences the technical, physical and score increased linearly with duration. Even though the differences were small in
physiological load, but also altering the task and goal orientation can influence this study (Fanchini et al., 2011), coaches may change the duration of an SSG to
the acute physiological response. Duarte et al. (2010) showed that players' HRs influence the physiological load.
were less variable during an SSG with goals scored by dribbling over a line when
compareci to both double and central goal orientations. Therefore, if you want an 6. 7.5.4 Number of sets and repetitions
SSG with less variation in HR, it might be better to choose an SSG tvith a line goal The number of sets and repetitions can also alter the technical, physical and physio-
constraint. logical performance. Generally, the amount of high- anci very-high-intensity acti-
vity decreases, while blood lactate concentration, RPE and HR response increase
6.7.3.4 Tactical obligations from the first repetition of an SSG to the fourth and last repetition. The amount of
Besides giving the players technical constraints to <leal with during SSGs, we can ciuels and percentage of successful passes is also higher at the beginning of the first
also alter the tactical objectives during the game. Obligíng players to put pressure two repetitions when compareci to the last. Therefore, more balls were lost during
on the team in possession results in a higher mean HR (Sassi et al., 2004). Player- the four reps (Dellal et al., 2012b). Hence, the number of sets and repetitions also
to-player marking increases blood lactate concentration (Sassi et ai., 2004) and RPE seems to be an important variable in determining the training stimulus when fit-
scores (Sampaio et al., 2007). Therefore, coaches can also alter the physiological ness training with SSGs.
load by giving the players tactical assignments during SSGs.
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
High-intensity interval training High-intensity interva/ training 97

6.7.6 Players' characteristics 6.8 TRAINING TIME DISTRIBUTION


When examining the effect of training intensity distribution on aerobic fitness vari-
6.7.6.1 Fitness levei ables in elite soccer players, Castagna et al. (2011) reported that even though almost
Stone and Kilding (2009) reviewed the literature carefully and concluded that play- two-thirds of players' training time was spent at low intensities, only the time spent
ers with the highest V02max had the lowest percentage of V02 nrnx during SSGs. It at high intensity (90% of HRma..) was related to changes in aerobic fitness. Impelliz-
follows that maybe the players with high vo2max values should play as floaters in zeri et al. (2005) reported similar findings and demonstrated a significant correla-
arder to get a higher aerobic workload during SSGs (Hill-Haas et al., 2010). Indeed, tion between time spent in high-intensity zones and changes in oxygen uptake at
a ceiling effect on improving aerobic fitness when solely using SSGs for fitness lactate threshold These results highlight the effectiveness of high-intensity training
training may be evident for players who have a very high leve} of aerobic fitness in soccer. It is believed that an optimal stimulus to elicit both maximal cardiovascu-
(McMillan, unpublished observations). These players may have to include generic lar and peripheral adaptations is one where athletes spend at least several minutes
running sessions into their weekly training regime (i.e,. 4x4 min runs at 90-95% of Per session in their "red zone," which generally means reaching at least 90% VO2m~>:
HRmax' McMillan, 2005) in order to further improve their aerobic fitness, (Buchheit and Laursen, 2013b). High-intensity training that raises the HR to above
90% of HRmax should constitute at least 7-8% of the total weekly training plan for
6.7.6.2 Skill /eve/ elite soccer players during preseason and in-season (Castagna et ai., 2013).
A lower skill level usually results in a lower technical performance during SSGs,
but with higher physical and physiological loads. Amateurs had a lower percen-
tage of successful passes, and even though they had a greater amount of ball pos-
session, they lost more balls per possession time. ln contrast, they >vere involved in
fewer duels per minute (Dellal et al., 2011c), but this may be explained by the fact
that professional soccer players have better anticipation skills (Reilly et al., 2000)
and a faster running speed (Kaplan, Erkmen and Taskin, 2009). The type of bali
possession and goal orientation in SSGs had a strong influence on the HR response
of amateur soccer players. For example, an SSG with free play and an objective to
keep possession of the ball showed a higher HR compareci to an SSG with a floater
or the presence of a neutral zone (Dellal et ai., 2011c).

Non-professionals also covered less distance overall, especially during high-inten-


sity running and sprinting in one-touch soccer and free play. Reducing the amount
of touches allowed (one or tvvo touches) led to a greater difference betvveen ama-
teurs and professionals in terms of physical load. Amateurs also showed higher
RPE and blood lacta te concentrations, \Vhereas the HR responses, expressed in per-
centages of HRm"" were similar to professionals (Dellal et ai., 201lc). Therefore, D~l­
lal et al. (2011c) recommend that amateur coaches use at least tvvo touches, while
professional soccer coaches should use only one or two touches per ball possession
to recreate an elite game situation within SSGs. Coaches should also ensure that fit-
ness and skill mismatches are not present betvveen the teams participating in SSGs.

6.7.6.3 Age
Dellal et al. (2011a) stated that youth players do not have the sarne technical abili-
ties and experience as adults, and this could lead to greater physical demands for
youth soccer players within SSGs. However, youth players with lesser skill may
not be able to achieve and maintain the required physiological stress because they
are unable to consistently maintain the speed of the technical executions. This may
lead to counterproductive training sessions (Castagna et al., 2005). Therefore, the
age of the players has to be taken into account when developing SSGs.
FITNESS IN SOCCER
FITNESS IN SOCCER
High-intensity interval training
High-intensity interval training

Explanation
6.9 SOCCER-SPECIFIC TRAINING DRILLS A possession game \Vith three teams of
The drills presented below are examples of soccer-specific drills than can be per-
forrned as high-intensity interval training to elicit anaerobic and aerobic adaptations.
four players. T\VO teams of four players
try to keep possession, while the third
i:
team of four players tries to win the bali.
The team that Iases the ball becomes the
6.9.1 vo2m~x interval defending team. This \Vay, the game is
played 8 against 4.
Explanation
Position play 7v6 in the box. When the ball is
intercepted, the defending team plays the ball Variations
to the other side, where their teammate asks for • When the defending team recovers
the ball and continues to play 7v6. ln the middle the bali, they need to dribble outside 1-------i--~-+-----­
of the field, \Ve put three openings, marked by of the field to emphasize the infiltra-
cones. This is dane to oblige the waiting player tion into the available space. The two
to move during the game and ask for the ball possession teams need to prevent
through one of these openings. this (transition). If the hvo possession
teams prevent them from dribbling • Number of touches on the ball:
outside the field, they keep posses- • Unlimited
Variation sion of the ball. • T\vo touches
If the team in possession of the ball can make o After the defending team recovers • Mandatory one touch after playing hvo
ten consecutive passes, they can finish on the the bali, they need to dribble outside touches
goal and keep possession of the ball \vhen they the area and score in one of the small o Ball may not be played to a teammate
score. One player of this team can infiltrate the goals. The two other teams need to o The ball may not be passed back to the player
16 meter and score in a lvl situation \vith the prevent this. you received the ball from.
GK. Afterwards the coach puts a ball back into
play.
Explanation
This game is played 6v6 in the center
Comments of the pitch. A player can enter the end
When the bali is out of play, the coach puts a zone after three successive passes and
new one into play. The defending team has to finish on the big goal or score in one of •
intercept the ball and then play to the other side the two small goals, which are placed {j
in arder to become the attacking team. in the beginning of the end zone. The
player who has to finish on goal has a
maximum of two touches.
Explanation By adding the small goals to the game,
This game is played 6v6 in the center zone. we create more decision-making
When three successive passes have been made, moments for the players and emphasize
a player in the end zone can be played to. This the transition movements of the players.
player may then finish with a maximum of two
touches.
Variations
Variations 0 When a player enters the end zone and
• Number of touches:
receives a pass, one opposing player
• Unlimited
can enter the end zone to defend.
• Two or three touches 0 When a player enters the end zone
• Two teams of eight players on the entire pitch,
and receives a pass, one of his team-
\Vith the hvo end zones in the large rectangle.
mates can enter the end zone as well,
• One-touch finishing.
together with one opponent, and
finish in a 2vl situation plus the GK.
Comment 0 Number of touches:

• The game is played with offside. • Unlimited


• The reference point is the line of the end zone. 0 T\VO or three touches

• T\VO teams of eightplayers on the entire


pitch with the hvoend zones in the box. Comment
• One-touch finish • The game is played using the offside rule.
• Numbers of passes before playing to • The reference point is the line of the end zone.
the end zone
FITNESS IN SOCCER
lOO FITNESS IN SOCCER
High-intensity interval training j 101
1
High-intensity interval training

6.9.2 vo2max interval and repetition exercises Explanation


Possession game with SvS. A point can
be scored by playing to a teammate in
Explanation one of the two end zones.
3+GK versus 3+GK+2. A transition exer-
cise with hvo teams of six players each. Variations
Three players of each team \vait next to o The team that scores a goal can gain an
the goal, \vith one player keeping a ball extra point by having a second player
at his feet in order to be ready to enter
the pitch as quickly as possible. Each
time the ball cresses the goal line (as \Vell
entering the end zone and receiving
the ball from the first player that ente-
red the end zone. The defending team
l
as in the event of a goal), the team stan- is now allowed into the end zone to
ding behind that goal line can immedia- prevent the pass from the first to the
tely enter the pitch by dribbling the bali, second player and therefore avoid
which means that the attacking team has conceding another point.
to change over to defense straightaway. o The game can also be played with two
goalkeepers in the end zones.
o Free play, one or two touches.
Variations
Number of players: 3 v 3
Comment
Coaches monitor offside rule on the
Comments offside tines (line between the hvo
At least one pass must be made before a zones).
goal can be scored.

Explanation
Explanation
T\VO teams of five players. On one half
of the field, they play 5v3, 'vhile the
remaining hvo players wait on the other
. Ball possession exercise using two teams
of eight players. On one half of the pitch,
half. When the three players recover
{t ,.,,e play an 8v4 possession game, \Vhile
the ball, they can score on the big goal. four players of the defending team wait
After they make an attempt on the goal,
1( • on the other half of the pitch. When the
the coach plays a new ball towards the
hvo waiting players, and the minority
11 t t majority team can make five consecu-
tive passes, they transition to the other
team becomes the majority team and 11 half of the pitch, \Vhere they also play
vice versa. You \vill create many defen- 8v4 and try to score a goal as quickly
sive and offensive transitions with this
organization. *) as possible. After a goal attempt by the
attacking team, the coach plays a bali
to the four 'vaiting players (defensive
team), and they play the sarne game. If
Variations the defending team can recover the ball
o Number of touches before the goal attempt, they change
o Different numbers of players sides and play 8v4 as the majority team.

Comments Variations
° Coach plays a ne\v ball into the vacant ° Can be played \Vith different numbers
rectangle \vhenever the ball goes out. • Can be played without GK and with
° Coaches keep track of hoiv often the small goals
attacking team loses the bali.
0 Game can be played position specific, Comment
Coaching to\vard quick transition
creating many defensive/ attacking
transitions. moments.

FACULDADF OE DESPORTO
DA UNIVERSIDADE DO PORTO
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
102 j Hígh~intensity ínterval trainíng High-intensity interval training J 103

6.9.3 Long interval and repetition exercises Explanation


Three teams of six players each. T\VO
tean1s of six players (attacking) take
Explanation
3v3 in the playing area. Three suppor- up their places in the outer boxes. The
ting players from each team stand on defending team puts three players in
three sides of the rectangle. The three the middle section and three players
supporting players can occupy the four play 6v3 in one of the two rectangles.
sides of the pitch, encouraging them ~ The hvo attacking teams play the bali
to see and use the free space and make n around, and they can also play the bali
to the other rectangle. The players in the
space for each other. The players inside
the field play a possession game, using
the three supporting players, and try to
t middle section of the defending team
then try to win the bali in that rectan-
make ten consecutive passes in arder to gle, while the other three players move
score a point. The players inside cannot ~ to the middle section. They try to inter-
use the sarne supporting player twice "f{ cept the ball from being played to the
in a row, obliging them to change direc- other rectangle. The game is played for
nvo minutes. The defending team tries -~-------------"-----­
tions. The supporting players cannot
defend each other. to intercept the ball as often as possible.
li li The teams are then changed.
Variations Comment
• Number of touches on the bali Players off the pitch cannot pass directly to each Variations
• Points can be scored in other \Vays, for other. o Number of touches
example by: º Can also be played with three teams of
• Passing to a third player eight players each
• 1-2 after passing to the second
player, etc.
• It's possible to add small goals, anda
Comments
team may score after a certain number
• Coaches play a ne\V ball into the
of consecutive passes.
vacant rectangle whenever the bali
goes out.
o Coaches keep track of how often the
Explanation attacking teams lose the ball.
ln this exercise, hvo teams (right side
v left side) play against each other. The
players are set up according to the posi-
tions they play in matches. The players
then try to score as much as possible on
the left and right. A point is scored when
scoring directly from a cross. The trai-
ner / coach can then install the tactical
guidelines according to his own running
lines and movements by introducing
ne\v passing directions each time.
Variation
The game can be played with ar \vithout
defenders.
Comments Progression
• Ensure that all positions are covered. The players are allo\ved to S\Vitch to the wing
The players resume their positions as position. The fullback then becomes the \Vinger.
fast as possible immediately after the The backs and midfielders can also change so as
action. to give everyone the chance to finish.
• Emphasize the competitive element. Medium interval and repetition exerdses
flTNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
1041 High-intensity interval training High-intensity intervaf training l 1os

,
6.9.4 Short interval and repetition exercises SUMMARY
Explanation High-Intensity Interval Training is a time efficient and very effective way of
The game is started by one of the coa- improving a football player's anaerobic and aerobic fitness levels. Training drills
ches \vho centers to the GK, \vho then - - __ ___ _ with or without the bali can be both used, but as much training should be per-
launches the counter-attack. The game
is played 4v2 or 4v3, depending on the formed with the ball as possible. Therefore, SSGs are an excellent choice of drill
progression. The players are given a to improve a player's physical abilities. The coach has to remember that factors
limited amount of time to score. such as pitch size, number of players, rules, and coach encouragement can all
affect the intensity of SSG play. Soccer players with very high leveis of fitness
Comments may benefit from the addition of individualized generic running drills to their
Defenders can score in the other goal training program. Performing 4 x 4 min intervals at 90-95% of HRrnax using the
\vhen they recover the ball. ~--- J-Ioff track is a useful drill to use in addition to SSG play. Although perhaps less
motivating for players to perfonn, it is easier to control the intensity of generic
Progression running drills, making it easier to individualize training. Using a combination
Groups of four attackers and hvo or of SSG play and generic running drills during a high-intensity interval training
three defenders. session is suggested as an optimal way of improving the anaerobic and aerobic
fitness of soccer players. It seems important that high-intensity interval training
that raises the HR to above 90% of HRmox should constitute at least 8 to 10% of
the total weekly training plan for elite soccer players during the preseason and
in-season periods.

Explanation
Severa! boxes are set out, each contai- REFERENCES
ning two players. Two neutral players
move from box to box soas to play 3vl. ,\cton·/açobc,, R., Fluck, D., Bom1'', T.C., Burgi, S., Chriotcnson, P.M., Toii;;o, M. and Lundb}~ C, 2013. !mpro"cmcnts in cxcrci~c perfor-
The player in the box can play the ball to mance with high·inlenoily intcrvnl trainini;; coincide woth an incn:a~c ln ~.kdc!nl mw;clc milochondrinl rontent and funclion. Joumnl of
Apphcd Physiology.
a teammate in another box. The player 1\guinr, M., Botelho, G., l:igo, C., Maça.<;, V. and S.imp;iio, )., 2012. A Rc,·icw on thc Effocto oi &>crer Smnll·Sidcd Games. Joumal of
in the box keeps the ball until he gets Humnn Krnctics, 33, pp.103-113
Armo,)., Rcbdo, N. nnd Gomco·Pcrcir.1, )., 200.J. !'h)-'Mologic.l! 1mpact of <electcd gamo·rdated cxNdoeo. /ournal of Sporlo Sdmces,
support from the other players. 22, p.522.
Babom, P., 1999. Prcdnrnn football. Kempcle, Finland; Polar Ek<:tro Ó)-'.
Btlla1, L.V., 2001. lnlcrval Tr.1ining for Pcrforrn,1ncc: A Sdont1fic and Empnkal Praclice: Spt.>onl Rccommcndnhoru; for M1ddlc- and
Long-Distance Running. l'.ut l!: 1\nacrobic !nlcrval Training. Sporb Medicino, 31(2), pp.;5-911
Variation llbhop, D., Girard, O. and Mcndcz-Villanucva, A., 2011. Rcpealed·Sprint Abílity - P.ut lt Rccummcndalionr. for Trainini;. Sportr. Mcd,
Play lvl in each rectangle, with hvo 41(9), pp.741-756.
Bogd.mi•;, G.C., St.wrinou, P, F.1louros, l.G, Ph1hppou, A., Chatzmikolauu, A., Draganidi!;, D , Ennidb, G nnd Maridakl, 1't, 20U Shorl·
neutral players providing support in the tcnn high·inlcnoity intcrval '""rcisc traming attcnuatcs o~id,1hve stf<'m n»pom.cr. nnd improves anlioxidant stalu5 in hc;i!th humano
boxes to create a 2vl situation. Food and Chcmical Toxicology
Bonen, A., 2001, 111c cxpr=,ion ol laclatc lr.1noportcrs (MCTl and MCT·l) in heart and mu~de, Eur J Appl Phyc.iol, 86(1), pp.6·11
Boyd, Cj., Simpoon, C.A, Jung, M.E. and Gurd, B,J_, 2013. Rcdudng thc inknc.ity oi intervnl traínmg d1mini<,heo cardio\',1'lrular adapt.l·
Mn but no! mitochondrial biogcnct•i~ ln overwcight/ober.c mcn. PloS ONE, 8(7).
Brookl;, GA., 1926, Thc Iadatc shuttlc during cxcrdec and recO\'cry. Mcd Sd Sports Excrc, 16(3), pp.360-S.
Buchhdl, M. nnd L1urrcn, P.TI., 2013a. High·inlenoity in1crtal trnining, solubon~ lo the programming puzzle. Part 1: Cardiopu!mon~ry
Empho,;io. Sport5 Medicine, ·13, pp.313-33S
lluchhcit, M. and Lourocn, P.TI_, 2013b, l·hgh-intcnmty mtcrval trainini;, r,olutiono to lhe programming puzzle. P.1rl 2: Anacrob1c <:ncrgy,
ncuronm,;culnr load, nnd practícal applicaliono. Sporlc. Mcdicmc, doi 10.1007 N10279·013-0066·5
llurgomaotcr, K.A .. cl ai, 2008. S1m1!ar mct«bohc adaptahon!! dunng cxero:,c alter !ow volume "print rnlcrval nnd lr,1d1t1onal cnduranC<I
training in hum.1no. Joum.11 of Physiolom~ !iS6 (1), pp.151-160.
Car.amichana, D. and Cagtcllano, /., 2010. Time-motion, hc;irl r.itc, pcrceplu.1! and motor bchaviour dcrnand,; m ~m,,lhidC'.i •;occcr
games: Effccffi of pitd1 oiic jouma! ol5ports5dences, 28(1·1), pp.1615-1623
C.1"amichano, O., Caoldlano, J. and Dcl!.11, ,\., 2013. lnflucnce of Diffcf<'nt Trmmng Regimesº" Phyoical and Php1ological Dcmand'
Dunni; 5mall·5idcd Socccr G.;m<-~i' Continuou,; V,;. lntcrmitlent Form,11. joumal of Slf<'nglh and Conditiomng Rc"c.rn:h, 27(3),
pp 69()-.(,97.
Caotagna, C, lmpe!lizzcri, F.M., Chnouachi,A, Bordon, C. and ~fanzi, V., 2011, Effo<:l oi training intcn:;ily d1,;lnbulion on n•·robic fil11c·so
vamblco in d1lc oocccr pl.1ycro: Ac.,,e otudy. / Stnmgth Cond RC'.3, 25(1), pp.66----71
Ca,;ta1;na, C., !mpclliucri, F.M., Chaouadti, A. and Mnnzi, V., 2013. Pnu,caoon varintiono in acrobic fi1MOS and rcrfonnanc<• m~hlc·~,tnn­
d,in:I ooccer playcro: n toam i•ludy. J Sln:-ngth Cond Res, 27(11), pp.2959-65.
Caotdlano, )., Ca"umichono, J. nnd Dcll«t A, 2013. lnflucncc of Game Formal and Number of Players on H~ar1 R~tc RC'.;poncc" nnd
Phy~ical Dcrnond§ in Srnoll·S1dcd Socccr Game,;. Joumnl oi S!n:-ngth and Condílioning Recear-eh, 2;(5), pp. 12'1S·1J03
Cicionl-Kobky, D., Lof<'nzcn, C., \\lillia11"1, M.D, and Kcmp, J-G,, 2013. Endur.1ncc and spnnl bcncfils oi h1gh-intcm1l)-' ,1nd r.upr.tm,m·
m«I intcrvnl truining. EuropeanJoumal of5por1 Scicnce, 13(3), pp.30.1-31\.
Clemente, F., Couceiro, M.5., Martins, F.M.L. and Mcndc,;, R., 2012 1110 u~dulncss of omall·r.idcd game~ on "occcr traimni;. )ou mal oi
Phy,;ical Educ~tion and Sport, 12(1), Art 15, pp.93- 102.
Oaussin, F.N., Zoll, J., Dufour, S.P., Pml.!mt, E., Lon5dorfcr-Woll, E.• Doutn:-kau, S,, Mcttaucr, B, Piquard, f_, Gcny, TI, Rich.ud, !t,
2003. Effoct of inlen:al vertm" ron!inuouo trainini; on c,1rd1orcspiralory and nütochondrial lunchons: rdat1on,h1p to ~crob!C pcrfor·
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
High-intensity interval training High-intensity interval training i 107

mnncc irnprovcrncnU> in r,cdcntory subjccls. Amcricnn /oumal of Physiology: [~cgulntory, Intcgralivc nnd Compnr.1tivc l'hy~.iology, 295, Mallo, j. and Navurro, E., 2003. Phyokal load imp0<.;cd on soc"'r playel'J during smalkiídcd training gomcs. J Sporto Mcd Phys filneoo,
pp.26-1-272. .m,pp.1&6-111.
Ddlnl, A., Chmnari, K., !'intuo, A., ct ai., 2008. Hcurt r.1tc respon<cs during smnlhidcd snme-s and shor! inlcrmittcnt running trnining in Moholdt, T., Mads.scn, E., Rognmo, O. and Aamot, l.L., 2013. Thc highcr thc betterl lntcri.·,1! training inlcnoity in coronary hcMt di,car.e.
dite comer playcrs: a cornparativestudy.J Strcngth Cond Rcs, 22(5), pp.l·\.19-57. joumal oi Scicn"' nnd Medicine in Sport, doi.org/10.1016/j.jsams.2013.07.007
Dcllal, A., Jnnnault, R., Lopcz-Scgovia, M. and Pialoux, V., 20lla. lnflucncc of thc Nurnbcrs of Pluycm in lhe HeMt Rale Rc•.ponscs of Owen, A, 2003. Physiological •md lcchniml analyois of omnll-r,idcd condilioncd trnining games wilhin profo,;:;,onal foolbnll. Wrexham:
Youth Socccr P!nycm within 2 ,.,, 2, 3 '"'· 3 and •l vs. 4 Small-sidcd Games. joumnl oi Hurnan Ktncti<:J, 28, pp.107-114. S1\GE Publications.
Dellnt A., Chamo ri, K., Owen, A.L., Wong. D.P., Lago-Penas, C. and Hill-Hnn~, S., 201 lb. Influcm:c of tcrhnicnl in-;truclions on lhe phyoi<>- Owen,"'.., Twisl, C. a~d Ford,..P., 200.l. Smol!-r.ided gam°'" lhe pltysiological and le<:hnic;! dfecl of altcring pitch oizc and pl,1ycr num-
logkal and physicnl dcmands of small-sidcd socccr games. Europcanjourn.1l ofSport Scicncc, 11(5), pp.3-11-3-16. bcr.l. lns1ght FACAJ, 1(2), pp.~0-3.
Oelbl, A., Hill-Haao,S., Lago-Penas, C. ond Chama ri, K., 20!k. Srnall- sidcd g.1mcs in soc"'r: Amatcurvs. prok"'5ional playc!"s' phys•<>- P~ton, C.D. an~ Hopkins, W.G, 200.1. Effc..:ts of High-intcnsily Training on Performance ,1nd Phpiology of Endurance ;\thlc!cs. Sport
logkal re:;ponws, physkal, and tcchnical activitics.J Strenglh Cond Rcs, 25(9), pp.2371-2381. scicnce, S, pp.25-10.
Dcfül,A., Owen, A., Wong. D.P;, Krustrup, P., vnn Exscl, M. and !>follo,J., 2012a. Tcchnkal and phyr.kal dcmnndr. of small vs. largcsidcd Ilnmpinini, E., lmpcllizzeri, EM., Castugna, C., Abt, G., ChamMi, K., S.1,;si,A. and Marrorn, S.M., 2007. Faclon; inllucncing phyr.iologicil
gamcs in rdution to playing position in elite socccr. Humun MovcmcntSdencc, 31, pp.957-969 <Cf,ponocs to small·sidcd socccr games. J Spor!sSci, 25(6), pp.659-66.
Dcllal, A., Orust, B. and Lago-Penas, C., 2012b. Voriation of Activity Dcmands in Small-Sidcd Socccr Games. lntcmnlional Journal of Ramp;nini, E., S;is:;i, A., l>forelli, A., Mnzoni, S., Fnnchini, M., Coutts, 1\.)., 2010. !tcpcaled-sprint ability in profcosional and amatcur
Sports Medicine, 33, pp.37Q-.375. soe<:cr playcrr.. Appl Phyr.iol Nutr Mctab; 34, pp.1048-S·I.
Ouarlc, R., Bnlu!ha, N., Folgado, H. and Sampaio, J., 2009. Effccts of cxercisc durution and numbcr oí playcr.; in hcart ril!e responst'S and Rcilly. T. and Bull, D .. 193-1. Thc nct physiological cost of dribb!ing a socccrball. Rco Q Exen:Sport, 55, pp.267-71.
technk,11 skilb during Futsal small·sidcd games. Open Sports Sci j, 2, pp.37-11. Sumpain,)., Garcia, G., M,1c,1s, V., !bancz, J., ,\brantcs, C. and C1i~inh.1, P., 2007. Hcart r.1tc and pcrccptual responws lo 2x2 and 3.xJ
Enoka, R.M. and Duchalcau, J., 2003. Musde fatigue: what, why and how ít inllucnre; musde function.J Physiol, 5%, pp.Jl-23. small~idcd youlh r.occcr game:<. Journal of Sport5 Scicncc and Medicine, 6(10), pp.121-122.
Esforjani F., Laun;cn P;B,, 2007. Munipulnting high·inlcnsity intcrval training: clfcct.'l on V02max, the !uctate tlm..>shuld nnd 3000 m run- Sar.si, R., IlciUy, T. and lmpellizzeri, F.M., 2004. A comparison oí small·sídcd gumes and intcrval trnining in elite profOó.sional socccr
ning pcrformuncc in moderatcly trained malc". J Sci Mcd Sport, 10, pp.27--35. playcrs. J Sporw Sci, 22. p.562.
Funchini, M .. Azzalin, A., C.1r.tngna, C., Schcn.i, F., McCill, A. nnd lmpdliucri, F.M., 2011. Effcct oi bout durotion on cxcrci~c interuily Sc~r.;, S., 2001. R~nning Through the Ages. Jcffer.;on, NC: McFarland and Cornpany lnc.
and tcclmk<ll pcrformanceof omnll·slded games in socccr. JStrenuth Cond Rcs, 25(2), pp..!53-158. Se oler, K.S .. nnd KJcrland, G.0., 2006. Quantifying training inlcnsity distribution in elite cndur,1ncc alhlctcr.: is thcrc cviden"' for an '"opti·
Fradua, L., Zubíllaga, A., Caro, ú, Fcrn;lndcz·Gan:fa, Á.!., Rui~-Ruí2, A and Tcngn, A., 2013. Dcsigning small-sidcd games for training mal" dir,t.,bution? Scand J Mcd Sd Sports, 16, pp.49-56.
t,ictka1 '1spccts in soccer. Extrapolating pilch sizc.,; from full-slic profcc...slonnl matchcs. joumal of Sports Scicn=·, 31(6), pp.573-5$1. Singcr, R. and Jancllc, C.M., 19Ç/9. Dcterminíng sport cxpcrlisc: From genes to supremcs. lntcmutional Joumal of Sporl Psychology, 30,
Gabbctt, T., 2001. Incrcaoing training intensity in country rugby !cague pfaycr.;. Rugby Lcague Coaching Magazine, 20, pp.30-31. pp.117-150.
Gabbett, T.j. and Mulvcy; M.J ., 2003. Timl'-motion analysio of smaU~íded lraining gnme5 ond compcli!ion in elite women oocccr playcr:;. Slorduh!, S.A., Mod,.!ien, V.O., Sloylcn, A., Kjos, A., Hclgcrud, ). and WisloffU., 2004. Atrio•·cntrículnr plane di5pla.,,,mcnt in untraincd
Joumal of Strength and Conditioning Reocarch, 22, pp.543-552. and traincd fcmalcs. Medicine& Scicn"' in Sports &: Exerci se, 36(11), pp.1871-1875.
G.1mblc. P.A., 2004. Skill-baO<'d conditioning games approach lo mctabolic conditioning for elite• rugby "º'""' plil}"Cr'.i. J Strcn Cond Rcs, Smith, D.J., 2003. A Framcwork for Under.;tanding the Tmining Proccss Lcading to Elite Performance. Spurt~ Medicine, 33(15),
18, pp..!91-197. pp.1103-1126.
Gibalo, M., Littlc, / ., van Esscn, M., WHkin, G., Burgomastcr, K., Safdar, A., Ruh'1, S. and Tamopo!oky, M., 2006. ShorHcrm sprint intcrva\ Slonc, N.M. und Kilding, A.E., 2009. Aerobic Condilioning for Tcam Sport Alhlclcs. Sporls Mcd, 39(8), pp.61S--M2.
ver:iu5 traditional cndurance !raining: similar inltíal adaptationo in human skclcta! muodc ;md c~crcisc pcrforman"'. J Physiol, 575(3), Talunlan, J.L., Galloway~ S.D .. Hcii;cnhiluscr, G.J., Doncn, A. and Sprict. L.L., 2007. Two wccks ofhigh·intensity acrobic interi.·al troining
pp.901-911. mcrear,cg thc capacily for fat nxidation during cxercise in womcn.Joumal of Applied Physiology, 102(.J), pp.1439-14-17.
Gibala, M., 2009. Molecular responsc>s lo hígh·intensity intcrval cxercisc. Applicd Physiology, Nutntion, and Mctnbolism, :J.4(3), Tcc.sitore, A., Mceu.ocn, R., Pinccnlini, M.F., Dcmaríc, S. and Caprnnica, L., 2(1()(,. Phy~iologlcal and tcchnical ac.pccts of"I}. a- ,ide"' wç"'r
0

pp.428-32. dri!!s. Joum.1! ofSports Medicine and Ph}"'ical fitncss, •16, pp.36-B.
Gibala, M.J., Uttlc, J.P., MaçDonílld, M.J. and Hawley, J.A., 2012. Physiologica! adnptnlions to low-volumc, high·inlcnsity intctval trai- Tjonna, A.E., Lcinnn, l.M., Bnrtne5, A.T., Jennscn, B.M., Dibnla, M.J,, \Vinci!, R.A. and \\"tsloff, U., 2013. Low- and high-volume of intcn·
ning in hcalth nnd disca,c. J Physiol, 590(5), pp.1077-1084. sive cnduran.:c tralning signifi.:,1ntly improves mnximal oxygcn uptakc afler 10-weeks of tralning in hcalthy mcn. Pl\lS ONE, S(5):
G"'gwn, W. and Drust, B., 2000. TI1c phyr.iology of football drills. In-,;íght, 3(·1), pp.1-2. c65382. doi:10.l371 /joumal.ponc.ll0653S2.
Hafstad, A.D,, Boordman, N.T., Lund, J., Hagvc, M., Kha!id, A.M., Wisloff, U., Lamcn, TS, Aaoum, E., 2011. High inlcn51ty intcrval trai- Ullah, M.S., Davics, AJ. and Halcotr,1p, A.P., 2006. Thc plasmu mcmbrane lactalc tranr.porlcr MCT4, but nol MCTI, ir. up·regulalcd by
ning al!crnsubstratc uti1lz.1lion and rcduccs oxrncn '°'~'umplion in thc hcart. j App! PhysioL, 111(5), pp.1235-.Jl. hypoxia through a H!F-lalpha-dcpcndcnt mcchnnism. J. Diol, Chcm, 281, pp.9030-9037.
Halcotrap, A.P. nnd Mcrcdith, D., 2QO.!. Thc SLC16 gene family-from monocarlmxylatc tmreporlem (MCfo) to aromatic amino acid trnns- Wcnger, H.A. nnd Bel!, G.J., 1986. TI>e inlcraction oi intcnsity, fn.'qucncy and duration oi cxetcise training in altc.,ng cardion'f.píratory
portcrs and bcyond. Pllugc<$Arch, 447, pp.619--623. lltncsr•. Sports Mcd, 3(5), pp..J.lf>.S.
Helgcrud, J., Hoydal, K., Wang. E., Karlwn. T., Bcrg, P., Bjcrkaas, M. and Hoff,)., 2007. Acrobic High-lntensity lntcrvals Improve V02nrnx Williarn.s, K. and Owen, A., 2007. Thc impact of plnyer numbcrs on lhe physiological responocs to smu!l sidcd Fmc". JSport> Sci Mcd,
More Than Modem te Trnining. Medicine & Scicncc inSports & Excrcisc, 39(.\), pp.665-671. 6(10}, p.100
Hclocn, W.,Sta<kcs,J. and Hodgco, N., 1998. Tcam sportt\and lhe thcory of dcliberntcprnctiçc.joum,1! ofSportand Excrcir,c Pr.ychology, Wisloff, U., El!ing,:"n, 0. and Kcmi, O.j., 2009. H1sh-intcrui\y intilrval tr~ining to maxim1zecardiacbcncfitsolcxcrcisc traoning? lli<erofiC
20, pp.12-34 SportScicncc Revicw; 37(3), pp.139-146
Hill-Haas, S.V,, D.iwson, B.T., Coutt.'l, A.J, and Rowscll, G.J., 200<Ja. Physiologirn! respon..<c<J and timc-motion charnctcristics of various Z~n;g~, J.M., Bcq;. K.,_ Noblc, J., Hardcr, J., Ch~lfin. M.E. and Hanumnnfüu, V.5,, 2011. Phpiologk.1l responsco during intcrval tminmg
sma!l-sidcd "º'"'' gamco in youth playcm. )ou mal of Sports Scicncen, 27(1), pp.1-8. woth differcnt inlc!l'1ibcsand durntion of exeror.c. J Strength Cond Res, 25(5), pp.1279-8·1
Hill-Haas, S.V,, Rowscll, G.J., Oaw,on, B.T. and Coul!s, A.J .. 2009b. Acule physiological rco.ponscs und timc-motion charactcristics of two
.<,rna!l~idcd trnining regimes in youlh so=r plnyer.;.J Strength Cond Rcs, 23(1), pp.111-115.
Hill·Haas, S.V., Coutt.'l, A)., Dawwn, B.1: and Rowsdl, G.)., 2010. nm~'-molion characteristics and physiological respons.cs oi o;mall-
sidcd games in clilcyoulh playcr.;: Thc inlluen"'ofp!aycr numbcr and rule chungcs. J Strength Cond Rcs, 2-1(8), pp.2149-2156.
Holl-Honr., S.V., 0,1wson, B.T., lmpcllizzeri, F.M .•1nd Coutt."., AJ., 2011. Physiology of Smal!-Sidcd Gam<.'S Traini11g in foolball: A Systc'-
matic Review. Sports Med, 41(3). pp.199-220.
Hofi. )., Wisloff, U., Engcn, L.C., Kcmi, O.J., and Helgcrud )., 2002. Soc"'r specific ncrobic cnduruncc tr.iining. llr J Sporls Mcd, 36,
pp.218-21.
Hoff, ). and Hclgerud, )., 200·1. Endurnnce and strcngth \ralning for so=r pfayerr.. Physiologic,1! ron.sidcralions: A revicw. Sportr. Mcd,
3·1, pp.165-180. Hodges, N. nnd Starke,;, J., 1996. '\\'rc;tling with thc nature of cxpertiw: A ~porHpccific !cst of Erim-;on, Krampc and
Tesch-Romer's (1993) thcory of dclibcralc pradice. Intemational /oumal of Sport l'sychology, 27, pp.400-12-1.
lmpelliucri, F.M., Rampinini, E. and Marcora, S.M., 2005. Physiologk.il as:;e,;smcnt of ucrobic trnining in f.Qcccr. J Sports Sci, 23(6),
pp.533-92.
lngham, S.A., Carlcr, H., Whyl<', G.P. and Dom.t, J.H., 2005. Phy~iol\lgical and pcrforman"' cfkcls of low- ''cr.;us mixed-intensily rowing
training. Med SciSports Ei<en:, 40, pp.579-58.J.
Jenkins, S.P.R., 2005. Sport.'l scien"' hnndbook: thc er.~cntial guide to kincsiology, •port and e~crci~c scicn"'. Volume 2. E.=x: Multí-sci-
en"' publishing.
Jone5. S. and Drust, B., 2007. Phy~iological and tcchnicnl demands of 4 v 4 and 8 v 8 gamcr. in elite youth soc"'r plnycrr.. Kincsiology,
39(2),pp.150-6.
Kaplan, T., Erkrncn, N. and T.lskin, N., 2009. The cvaluation of lhe running spccd and ugility performance in proícssional and amatcur
socrcr playcm.J Strength Cond Rc,;, 23, pp.774-778.
Knfo, A. and Kcl!is, E., 2009. Effccts of snrnl!-sidcd game.,; \ln physical ronditioning and performance in young r.~r pluycm. J Sports
Mcd, 8, pp.374-.80.
Kclly, D.M. and Drust, B., 2009. Thc effccl of pilch dimcnsions on hcart rale responscs and tcchnkal demnnds of small-sidcd soc"'r
games in elite plarcr.;. J Sci Mcd Sport, 12(4), pp.475-9.
Kõklü, Y., A~çi, A., Koçak, F,0., Alemdnroglu, U. and Dundar, U., 2011. Comparison of the physiologkal n.,;pon<.cs todilfcrent smnll-si-
ded games in elite young socccr player.;.j Stwngth Cond Rcs, 25, pp.1522-1528.
Kõklü, Y., Ser!, ô., Alemdaroglu, U. and An.fan, Y., 2013. Compnrison of thc Physio!ogkal R~'f.ponscs and TI me Motion Charnctcristics
of Young 5-0<:<:cr Playcrr. in Smnll Sided Gomes: The Effcct of Goalkceper. Journal of S!rength and Conditioning Re<A:«rch, Publishcd
Ahead of Print.
Kubukcli, Slohrdal Sturkc ct al., 2002. Trnining tcchniqucs to improve cndurnncc cxcrciw performances. Sports Med, 32, pp.489·509.
l..iurwn, P.B., 2010. Training for inlcnsc exercioc performance: high-inlcnsity or high-volumc training? S<:andinavian Journnl of Medicine
t< Sdence in SporIB, pp.201-10.
Laurscn, P.B. and Jenkins, D.G., 2002. The Scientifk Basis for High-lntcnsity !n!crval Training: Optimising Training Programmcs and
Mnximisíng Pcrformnn"' in Highly Traincd Enduronre Athlctc.,;. Spott.'l Medicine, 32(1), pp.53-73.
Little, T. and Williams, A.G., 200f>. SuHability oi soccer training drillr. forenduranre training. J Strenglh Cond Res, 20(2), pp.316·9.
Littlc, T., 2009. Optimizing lhe use oi ooc"'r drills forphysiological dcvclopmcnt. Strength Cond J, 31(3), pp.1-8.
Litl!c, )., Suídar, A., Wilkin, G., Tamopo!sky, M. and Gibu!a, M., 2010. A practical modcl of low-volume high·intensity inlcrval training
indu"'s mitochondrial biogcncsis in human skclc!al musde: potcntial medmnisms.Joumal of Physiology, 585(6), pp.1011-1022.
Londerec, B.R., 1997. Effoct of trnining on foctatc/vcnti!atory thre;holds: a meta-analysis. Mcd Sei Sports Exen:, 29, pp.837-&13.
McMitlan, K., Hclgcrud, J., Macdonald, R. and Hoff, )., 2005. Physiologkal adaplotions to wccer-spccific cndurnnre training in profco.si·
onol youlh socrcrpfaycru. Br J Sports Mcd, 39, pp.273--277.
1os I FITNESS IN SOCCER
High~intensity
interval tralning
FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
Speed, agility and quickness (SAQ) and repeated sprint ability (RSA)
109

SPEED, AGILITY AND QUICKNESS


(SAQ) AND REPEATED
SPRINT ABILITY (RSA)
Jan Van Winckel, Nick Winkelman, Rena/do Landburg, Paul Brad/ey

7.1 INTRODUCTION
Although most of a game is played at low intensity, rnany high-intensity actions are
also involved, such as sprinting, jumping, tuming and tackling. Around 2~'b of the
total distance covered during a match is sprinting, \Vhile another 10% of the total
distance covered is from high-intensity running. This equates to a 10-!Sm sprint
every 90 seconds (Bangsbo, 2006). Most of these sprints are short bouts of exertion
(< 15m). Straight-line sprinting is the most frequently occurring action prior to a
goal, for both the scoring and assisting players. Professional players have become
faster over time, indicating that sprinting ability is becoming more and more
important in modern soccer (Haugen et al., 2013). ln a recent study, Andrzejevvski
et ai. (2013) conducted a detailed analysis of the sprinting activity of professional
soccer players during the 2008-09 and 2010-11 UEFA Europa League seasons. The
study demonstrated that the mean total sprint distance covered by players (>=24
km/h) amounted to 237m ± 123m. ln terms of the position of play, forwards cove-
red the longest sprint distance (345m ± 129m), which was 9~1a further than midfiel-
ders (313m ± 119m) and more than twice that of central midfielders (167m ± 87m).
The average number of sprints performed by the soccer players was 11±5. Another
notable fact was that 90% of sprints performed by professional soccer players \Vere
shorter than five seconds, while only 10% lasted longer than five seconds.
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
111
llO 1 Speed, agility and quickness (SAQ) and repeated sprint ability (RSA) Speed, agilíty and quíckness {SAQ) and repeated sprint abi/ity (RSA)

7.2 NATURE OR NURTURE energetic cost. When running without arm swings, the net metabolic power demand
Speed is partly innate. Each individual has a unique blueprint by which their neuro- increases by 8% when compared to running with arm swings. Once a runner is up
muscular system is expressed within the human body. These individual differences to speed, the arms swing largely like passive pendulums. Pontzer et al. (2009) sup-
can allow one individual to run faster, while another may be more inclined to run ports a passive arm swing hypothesis for upper-body movement. During human
farther. Although it seerns that speed is partly innate, deliberate practice plays an walking and running-in which the trunk and shoulders act primarily as elastic
important role in the development of talent. Balyi (2004) described a potential win- linkages between the pelvis, shoulder girdle and arms-the arms act as passive
dow of trainability that seems to exist. Young athletes should train speed at critica! mass dampers, reducing torso and head rotation, and the upper-body movement
moments in order to maximize genetic potential. Strength and power programs is primarily powered by the lower-body movement. Although arm movements do
have been shown to improve speed, with superior running mechanics affecting the not control leg movements and have very little effect on the all-important ground
development of speed significantly. Sander et al. (2013) investigated the influence reaction forces, the arms and legs need each other to achieve proper running form.
of a two-year strength training program on power performance in elite youth soc-
cer players. The players who completed the strength training program displayed 7.3.3 Muscle actions
significantly better improvements in sprinting (up to 6%) when compared to the Running gait can be divided into two phases with regard to the lower extremity:
control group. The researchers suggest that it seems beneficial for youth players the stance phase and s1ving phase (Nicola et al., 2012). These can be further divided
to perform strength training to exploit the reserve capacity in sprint performances. into absorption (foot strike), propulsion, initial s1ving and terminal swing.
Similar to this, Comfort et al. (2013) examined the association between strength and
sprint performance. The researchers concluded that leg strength is closely related
to both sprint and jump performance in well-trained players. Finally, they stressed
the importance of using squat exercises as part of a periodized training program.

7.3 BIOMECHANICS OF SPRINTING


Fig. 7.1: Absorption (foot strike), propulsion, initia/ swing and terminal swing.
7.3.1 Stride length and stride frequency
Speed is simply the product of the frequency (Freq) and length (L) of a runner's Swing phase. At the end of the stance phase, when the foot has straightened
steps. out and left the ground, the hip, knee and foot are stretched. The glutei and
the hamstrings are used to stretch the hip, while the calf muscles cause the foot
to stretch. The iliopsoas muscle (the muscle that bends the hip) then comes
Speed = L step · Freq step into action to move the lead leg forward. The hamstrings ensure the bending
(flexion) of the knee, and the tibialis anterior (the muscle above the shinbone)
Sprinters achieve faster top speeds not by swinging their limbs more rapidly in causes the foot to bend (dorsal flexion). The adductors work to prevent the
the air, but by applying greater forces to the ground. How fast an athlete runs is thigh from turning outwards. Finally, the knee extends through the action of
determined during contact with the ground. Both the greater stride Iengths and the quadriceps to prepare the body for landing.
frequencies of faster runners result from the application of greater mass-specific Stance phase. When running, the large muscle groups work eccentrically to
ground forces in shorter periods of time. Lockie et ai. (2013) investigated stance prevent the runner from sagging at any of his joints by counteracting flexion of
kinetics and step kinematics. Their results indicated that faster acceleration in field the ankle, flexion of the knee and flexion of the hip. When landing, the glutei
sport athletes involved longer steps with shorter contact time. Greater vertical force pull in order to stretch the hip. The antagonists of the thigh, the hamstrings
production was linked with shorter contact time, illustrating efficient force produc- and quadriceps, work mainly to stabilize the knee and control the movement.
tion. Greater step lengths during acceleration were facilitated by higher vertical The antagonists also work together in the lower leg to allo1v the foot to straigh-
impulses and appropriate horizontal force. The researchers concluded that speed ten in a controlled manner. The tibialis anterior at the front of the tibia works
training for team sport players should be customized to encourage these technique eccentrically, while the calf muscle (gastrocnemius) works concentrically. No
adaptations. more muscle activity can be undertaken to push the body forward in this sup-
port phase because the center of gravity is behind the point of support. It is
7.3.2 Arm swinging the movement of the body that ensures itis carried over this point of support.
Humans walk with a moderate step width (+/-12 cm), which guarantees balance
and minimizes energetic cost (Donelan et al., 2001). Conversely, humans run with
a step width of almost zero. This jeopardizes balance and requires a greater ener-
getic cost. While running, arm swings support the lateral balance and reduce the
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
Speed, agility and quickness {SAQ} and repeated sprint abi/ity (RSA) 113
Speed, agílity and quickness (SAQ) and repeated sprint abi/ity (RSA}

7.4 RUNNING TECHNIQUE 7.6 DEFINITIONS


The running motion we are familiar with from the world of athletics cannot be Agility and change of direction (COD): An agility task may be best described as a
fully applied to soccer. The shortest sprint distance in athletics, the lOOm, is more rapid, whole-body change of direction or speed in response to a stimulus (Shep-
than three times longer than the longest typical sprint covered by a player during pard and Young, 2006). Other attempts to define agility have focused on the physi-
a match. The expression of speed is relative to the absolute distance and the pha- cal demands only, generally a change of direction involving the whole body, as
ses leading to the final distance. Fast people, whether on a field or on a track, will vvell as rapid movement and direction change of limbs (Tsitskarsis et al., 2003). The
adopt similar running forms based on the distance. Soccer involves cutting, htrn- unique distinction between the definition used by Sheppard and Young (2006) and
ing, changing direction, falling, jumping, stoppíng, accelerating and various other other previous definitions is the inclusion of reaction to a stimulus, rather than just
basic forros of movement. A player must always have as much contactas possible change-of-direction speed (COD). Agility is an open skill, while COD is a closed
with the ground in arder to be able to anticipate changing situations. skill (Sheppard and Young, 2011).
The following are specific to soccer: Quickness: Moreno (1995) identified quickness as "a multi-planar or multi-directi-
0 The distance is very short, which means that the support point is mainly onal skill that combines acceleration, explosiveness, and reactiveness." Quickness
behind the body. The quadriceps and calf muscles, as well as the glutei and can be defined by the speed of agility or COD over short distances.
the lower-back muscles, therefore push on this support point. This movement Cutting: Unlike the term quickness, cutting seemingly refers only to the specific
is similar to track athletes over the first 15m. portion of a directional change when the athlete's foot touches the ground to initi~
0 A soccer player should be able to change direction quickly. A high heel or ate the change of direction (Sheppard and Young, 2006).
knee lift will make the swing phase too long and therefore compromise a swift
change of direction.
0 Soccer players do not run around bends, like on a track, but rather turn at 7.7 SOCCER-SPECIFIC SAQ DRILLS
sharp angles. SAQ is the harmonious and economical cooperation of the senses, nerves and
0 Sprint distances in soccer are very short, meaning that stride length needs to muscles to produce a specific, controlled movement and a rapid situation-specific
be restricted. For this reason, stride frequency is more important and must the- reflex. This requires the entire locomotor apparatus to work together in a coordina-
refore increase greatly over the first few meters. However, coaches should be ted way in the following areas:
cautious when trying to artificially influence stride frequency, because it could o speed of execution

threaten an athlete's natural running flow. o angle of n1ovement

• Cross-coordination (opposite arm/leg) is not always possible in practical 0 direction of movement


terms because of different arm movements, such as holding off an opponent. 0 activation and deactivation of synergists and antagonists
• The start of the movement does not only go in a forward direction but rather • muscle tension
from all angles and positions, such as crossovers, side stepping, landing from 0 number of motor units recruited
a jump, accelerating away, and so on.
Soccer players therefore have to train especially on short, fast running actions, and Speed, agility and quickness are criticai for success in soccer. SAQ-specific exercises
these can be combined with a good stretch reflex anda high stride frequency. in soccer therefore have to be directed to\vard the following objectives:
0 Making SAQ exercises dependent on visual stimuli: Instead of training with
a whistle, drop a ball, for example, when the players are supposed to take off.
7.5 SPEED, AGILITY, QUICKNESS ANO CUTTING 0 Break up rhythms: A sprint in soccer is characterized by accelerations and
Straight-sprint training appears to have little or no influence on the improvement changes in direction.
of sprinting that involves changes of direction (Young et al., 2001), and this was ° Fast foot contacts and soccer-specific activities.
confirmed by Tsitskarsis et al. (2003). These researchers found a weak relationship • Link a coordination exercise with an activity specific to soccer, such as by orga-
between straight-sprint performance and speed performance when changes of nizing a passing or finishing exercise after a sprinting activity.
direction are involved. ln an interesting investigation by Little and Williams (2005),
the specificity of acceleration, maximum speed, and agility in professional soccer
players was examined. Although the performances in the three tests \Vere all signi-
ficantly correlated, the coefficients of determination (R2l between the tests were just
39, 12, and 21% for acceleration and maximum speed, acceleration and agility, and
maximum speed and agility, respectively. The investigators concluded that accele-
ration, maximum speed, and agility are specific qualities and relatively unrelated
to one another. They therefore suggested the use of specific testing and training
procedures for each speed component when working with elite players.
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
114 Speed, agility and quickness {SAQ) and repeated sprint ability (RSA) Speed, agility and quickness (SAQ) and repeated sprint ability {RSA) 115

7.7.1 Effectiveness of SAQ sessions 7.8 SPEED


Young and Rogers (2013) examined the effect of two different training methods on Speed comprises a number of different components:
planned and reactive agility tests. Twenty-five young adult Australian Rules foot- 1. Reaction/ starting speed: The first three or four strides
ball players (UlS) were randomly assigned to two training groups: 2. Acceleration: 10-20m
3. Speed endurance: 60-70m
1. The change of direction group 4. Repeated sprint ability: Repeated sprints sometimes with little recovery time in
2. The sn1all-sided game group between.

Players participated in one or two 15-minute sessions per week, with 11 sessions 7.8.1 Reaction speed
being conducted over a 7-week period during the season. A planned AFL agility Seen in neuro-physiological terms, reaction speed is the time interval during which
test and a video-based reactive agility test were performed before and after inter- the nerve impulses are conducted to the brain, where they are processed and then
vention. The small-síded games group improved total time in the reactive agility sent to the respective muscles. The reaction speed is determined by various factors,
test (P = 0.008, effect size = 0.93) and this was entirely dueto a very large reduc- including age and gender. Although it has already been proven in the past that
tion in decision time. Meanwhile, the change-of-direction training produced small sprinters react more quickly than long-distance runners, no differences were found
to trivial changes in all of the test variables. ln another study by Jovanovic et al. in the reaction time between different skill groups. Professional soccer players do
(2011), the effects of SAQ training methods on power performance in soccer play- not have a quicker reaction speed than amateur players. The best-known exam-
ers were investigated. The SAQ training program appears to be an effective way ple of this is the boxer Mohammed Ali, who had a very slow visual reaction time
of improving some areas of power performance in young soccer players during (190msec), yet heis one of the best boxers of all time because of his ability to antici-
the in-season period. Soccer coaches could use this information in the process of pate more quickly than others.
planning in-season training. Without proper planning of SAQ training, soccer
players will most likely be confronted with decreased power performance. Finally, 7.8.2 Starting speed
Bloomfield et ai. (2003) compared the effectiveness of two methodologies for speed The energy for this type of exertion is supplied by the ATP still present in the mus-
and agility conditioning for random-, intermittent-, and dynamic-activity sports cles. ATP is always found in the cell, although it can fall to 40%, while CP (creatine
like soccer and investigated the necessity of specialized coaching equipment. Two phosphate) can be exhausted.
groups participated in either a programmed method (PC) or a random method • Duration: One or two seconds
(RC) of conditioning, with a third group receiving no conditioning (NC). The PC • Intensity: 100%
participants used the SAQ conditioning method, while the RC participants played • Repetition: 8-10
supervised small-sided soccer games. The PC group was also subdivided into hvo • Work-rest ratio: 1:10
subgroups, where participants either fc;:;~;?TiTE'i~Ti'::;:!i:c''T:::CX'!::Z"iJi;'iÇ\'.'.~iF''.''.'.
used specialized SAQ equipment or 7.8.3 Acceleration
no equipment. PC in the form of SAQ • Dufation: 2-6 seconds
exercises \vas found to be a superior " Intensity: Building up to 100%
method for improving speed and agi- " Repetition: 4-6
lity parameters, and this study found • Work-rest ratio: 1:10
that specialized SAQ equipment was
not a requirement to observe signifi- Varley et al. (2013) compared the match activity profiles of elite players from Aus-
cant improvements. In addition, the tralian Rules football (AF), rugby league (RL) and soccer (SOC) using identical
authors recommended the presence movement definitions. Rugby league players undertook the highest relative num-
of a fitness specialist in speed and ber of accelerations (1.10 ± 056 per min). Repeated sprint bouts were rare for all
agility conditioning to lead, direct, codes. RL and SOC players performed less running than AF players, possibly due
and control PC, particularly the spe- to limited open space because of field size and code-specific rules.
cificity and overload. This appears
to be more beneficial than the lais- 7.8.4 Speed endurance
sez-faire approach of RC when trying " Duration: 6-10 seconds
to improve aspects like speed, power, " Intensity: Building up to 100%
and agility. " Repetition: 4-6
• Work-rest ratio: 1:6
llG I FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
Speed, agility and quickness {SAQ} and repeated sprint ability (RSA)
1
117
Speed, agility and quickness (SAQ) and repeated sprint ability (RSA)

7.8.5 Repeated sprint ability (RSA) 2. It is also important to include some interval training to better improve the ability
We have already discussed how the ability to repeatedly perform short-duration, to recover between sprints (if the goal is to improve fatigue resistance). High-in-
high-intensity, intermittent exercise bouts with relatively short recovery times (e.g., tensity (80-90% of V0 2m,.J interval training, interspersed with rest periods (e.g.,
repeated sprint ability or RSA) is an important attribute of the modern-day soc- one minute) that are shorter than the work periods (e.g., two minutes) efficiently
cer player. The mean time recorded during an RSA test predícts the amount of improves the ability to recover between sprints by increasing aerobic fitness
high-intensity running and the total sprint distance covered during a professional (V0 2mnx and the lactate threshold), the rate of PCr resynthesis, and buffering
soccer match (Rampinini et al., 2007), and this finding suggests that improving RSA capacity.
should result in greater physical performance in team sports (Bishop et al., 2011}. It
has been suggested that the ability to resynthesize phosphocreatine (PCr) may be o Duration: Varying from 1-6 seconds per sprint
an important determinant of the ability to reproduce sprint performance (Bishop o Intensity: Building up to 100%
et al., 2011). A short recovery time between repeated sprints leads to only a partia! o Repetitions: 5-10 sprints in one set
restoration of PCr stores (Bogdanis et al., 1996). Importantly, Haseler et ai. (1999) o Work-rest ratio: 1:2 between different sets of sprint exercises
demonstrated that PCr restoration is limited by 0 2 availability. This suggests that
individuals with an elevated aerobic fitness should be able to more rapidly resyn-
thesize PCr between repeated sprints (Bishop and Spencer, 2010; Rampinini et al., 7.9 TIPS
2010; Bishop et ai., 2011). Indeed, high-intensity inlerval training (HIIT: 6-12 reps [2 o SAQ training can be completed at the beginning or end of the session or as
minutes at ~ 100% vo2max= 1 minute rest]), can significantly improve the resynthesis part of a warm up.
of phosphocreatine during the first 60 seconds after high-intensity exercise (Bishop All aspects of speed (e.g., agility, change of direction, quickness, and cutting)
et ai., 2008). should be at least maintained in every microcycle.
Sloth et al. (2013) reviewed the effects of sprint interval (repeated sprint ability) o Take into account the mechanical load while training agility, quickness, and
training. All 19 studies in their review used consistent training methods. The trai- cutting. These kinds of training sessions have limited impact (in cases of ade-
ning sessions included 3-7 30m maximal sprints with 2-5 minutes recovery. quate recovery) on the physiological load, but they can have a considerable
They found that high-intensity sprint interval training improves fitness or V02m•x mechanical load.
(maximal oxygen consumption) by 4-13%. Compareci to traditional endurance 0 Try to integrate your sessions with the technical / tactical objectives of training,
training (Iong, slow distance runs-Steinhofer terminology), the improvements in but ensure this doesn't compromise the quality of execution.
aerobic fitness were almost equal. Moreover, a small improvement in running eco- 0 Respect work-rest ratios when developing speed.
nomy was found, meaning that players used less energy for the sarne load. Finally, o Warm up properly before doing SAQ training.
sprint interval training also improved anaerobic fitness and resistance to short- o Don't do static stretching before SAQ training (This is discussed in more detail
term fatigue, thus improving repeated sprint ability. in Chapter 19).
o Power, RSA and resistance (plyometrics) training can be performed on the
Perroni et al. (2013) investigated the effect of eight weeks of preseason training on field, but this should be dane intelligently as part of a periodized plan and
RSA in soccer players. An RSA test, consisting of 7 x 30m sprints with 25 seconds only then in the loading phase of the microcycle.
of active rest, was administered to the players, before and after the eight weeks of
preseason soccer training. An overall significant difference was found behveen the
seven sprints performed pre- and post-training. The study shows that each sprint
time was significantly faster in the pre- than in the post-RSA tests. Dellal and Wong
del (2013) compareci the performance in RSA and repeated COD among elite soc-
cer players in different age categories. The researchers discovered that the RSA and
repeated COD are dependent on age, so coaches should therefore plan a specific
program dífferentiating RSA and repeated COD, while the individualized training
could begin at U17.

Bishop et al. (2011) gave two key recommendations based on the existing literature:
1. It is important to include some training to improve single-sprint performance.
This should include (i) specific sprint training, (ii) strength/ power training, and
(iii) occasional high-intensity (>VOim,,,J training (e.g., repeated, 30-second, all-
out efforts separated by,.., 10 minutes of recovery) to increase anaerobic capacity.
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
Speed, agi/ity and quickness {SAQ) and repeated sprint abilíty (RSA) Speed, agility and quickness (SAQ) and repeated sprint abi/ity {RSA) 1 119

7.10 EXERCISES Explanation


Players do a passing / finishing exercise
Explanation with starting. acceleration, or maximal
T'vo teams are formed next to the goal. speed incorporated. Xl plays to X2, who
Xl plays the ball to X2 and immedia- then plays back to Xl. Xl plays the ball
tely sprints around the flag. X2 takes deep, and X2 sprínts toward the cone
the bali and tries to score from outside and crosses the ball. X3, X4, XS and X6
the penalty box \Vith a maximum of two sprint to\vard the box and finísh the
touches. XI then receives the ball from cross. Make hvo groups \Vho \Vork x
the following player. times left and x times right and make a
competition out of this play. Xl goes to
)(2, and X2 goes to Xl (they stay at the
Variation sarne hvo positions at both sides of the
Xl plays the ball to X2. X2 passes to Xl. exercise). X3, X4, XS and X6 can go one
Xl plays to X3. X2 then receives the ball position to the right each time.
from X4. (See figure)

Advancing Variation Comment


Comment The players stay on the sarne side each time, o Coach can emphasize different run- Assistant coach keeps track of the scored goals.
The coach plays a new ball in if the ball with each player kicking six times before being ning lines to\vard the goal.
goes out. changed. • Adapt distances and maybe the \Vork-
rest ratio for different kinds of speed Advancing
trainíng. You can do the exercise position specific.

Explanation Explanation
Player XI crosses to X4, who then sprints Both players set off \Vhen the signal is
to the position for goal. X4 finishes and given by the coach (by dropping the
immediately sprints out of the 16-meter ball from his hands, a visual signal). The
box. He then takes the place of Xl, \vho players run the course discussed before-
then runs behind the goal to position X2. hand. The first player to run behveen the
flags gets a point.
Comment
Emphasis on the sprint action and imme- Variation
diate sprint after finishing. The course can be altered using the sarne
cones.
Advancing
X4-Xl-X2-X3-X4 Comment
Let the players count the points themsel-
ves and give the laser an additional task.
In the event of a tie, they both Jose.

Advancing
The players change places each time.
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
120 1 Speed, agi/ity and quickness {SAQ) and repeated sprint ability (RSA)
121
Speed, agilíty and quickness {SAQ) and repeated sprint ability {RSA}

Explanation Explanation

"!: l~~
Both players set off \vhen the signal is The player on the right can choose hin1-
given by the coach (by dropping the 1 self \Vhen to set off. Once the player cros-
bali from his hands, a visual signal). The ses the imaginary start line, the other
players run the course discussed befo- player can try to tap him. The person
rehand. On reaching the ball, they try tapping has to cover the sarne course as
1
~ ~l\
to score in the small goals. Scoring gets the starting player. The starting player •
them one point. The first player to run •,• tries to get back over the start line. If he •
behveen the flags also gets a point.
J •..· ·· ..-<.·· crosses the start line, he scores a point. • •
1:::::::::~ .. \_.··~i-il~ •
.. Ji"f. •
Comment
Let the players count the points themsel-
~ f> Variation
ln the first set, the player may only run

ves and give the laser an additional task.
ln the event of a tie, they both lose. j=
-------,."":§;----+------- up to the second row. He can then sprint
one row further each time.

Advancing Comment
The players change places each time. Let the players count the points themsel-
When the player gets back, he takes the ves and give the laser an additional task.
ball he has kicked and replaces it ready ln the event of a tie, they both !ase.
for the next player.

Advancing
The players change places each time.
Explanation
Player Xl plays a long ball to player X2
in the center circle. Player X2 receives
the ball and tries to score. Player Xl,
who passed the bali, becomes a defen-
der and tries to intercept the bali. Only
the attacking player may score.
.... -··
Variation
The defender can also score.

Comments
The players get a point by scoring a goal

Advancing
X2-X1-X2
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
Speed, agility and quickness {SAQ} and repeated sprint ability {RSA} Fitness testing i 123

SUMMARY
Speed of movement is one of the most important components of soccer. Profes-
sional players are getting quicker and quicker over time, meaning that sprin-
ting ability and the ability to control speed is becoming more important in the
modem game. Therefore, soccer players should perform specific exercises in
order to improve their acceleration, maximum sprinting speed, and change of
direction capabilities. By simultaneously improving maximal sprinting speed
and endurance, a player can also improve repeated sprint ability, which enables
him to perform to his maximum during intense periods of match play.
FITNESS TESTING
Jan Van Winckel, Kenny McMi/lan, Jean-Pierre Meert,
Balder Berckmans, Werner Helsen

REFERENCES
Andrzejcwskl, M., Chmura, J., PJu\'1, B., Strzekzyk, R. and Kaspr.i:ak. A., 2013. Analysis of sprinting actlvilies of profcssional socccr
playcrs.J Strength Cond Res, 27(&), pp.2134-2140.
Balyi, !. and Hamilton, A., 2001. L.ons-tenn athlclc devclopment: Train.1bilily in dlildhood and adoles«!n<:e. Windows of opportunily.
Optimal trainabi!ity. Victoria, BC: National Coacl>ing Jru;litutc llritbh Columbia & Advanred Training and Performance ltd.
llangsbo, j., Mohr, M. and Krustrup, P., 2006. Physka! and mctabolk demands of tr.lining and malch·p!ay ln thc cli1c football playcr.
Joumal ofSports Scienll.'s, 24(7), pp.665-67-1.
llishop, D. and Spenll.'r, M., 2004. Ddcrminants of "'f"'aled·sprint abfüty ln wcll·traincd tcam-sport alh!e!e:; and cndurancc-traincd
alhlct<;S. JSport~ Med Phys Fitncss, 44{1), pp.1-7.
llbhop, D., Girard, O. and Mendcz-Villanucva, A., 2011. Repeatcd-Sprint Abi!ity- Part !! Rcrommcndatioru; forTraining. Sports Mcd,
41(9), pp.741-756.
Bishop, D., Edgc, J., Thomas, C :1nd Mcrcicr, C., 2003. Effocts of high·intensity trnining on musdc Jactatc tr11nsportcrs and postcxcrci!'C
rerovcry of musde lacta te and hydrogen ions in women. Am J Physiol Rcgu! lnt•'Sr Comp Physiol, 295, pp.R1991-<l.
Dloomfidd,J., Polman, R., O'Donoghue, P. and McNaughton, L, 2003 or2007. Effoctivespecd ;md agility ronditioning methodology for
random intermittent dynamic type sports. j. Strenglh Cond. Res., 21(4), pp.1093-1100.
Bogdanis, G.C., Nevill, M.E., !loobfo, LH. and Lakomy, H.K., 1996. Contribution of phosphocrcatine and nerobic metaboli:Jm to cncrgy
supply during repoalcd sprint excrcisc. J Appl Physiol, SO, pp.676-&I.
Cavagna, G.A~ Heglund, N.C. and T:>ylor, C.R., 1977. Mochanicnl work in \crrestrial loromotion: two basic mcchanioms for minimizing
energy expcnditutc. Am. J. Physiol., 233, pp.R243-Il261. 8.1 INTRODUCTION
Odiai, A. nnd Wong dei, P., 2013. Rcpcatcd Sprint and Changc-of·Dircction Abilities inSocccr Pbyers: Efiects of Age Group. J Strength
Cond Res, 27(9), pp.25(}.t-2503. Monitoring the physical abilities critica! to soccer performance allows sports scien-
Donclnn, J.M., Krnm, R. :>nd Kuo, A.D., 2001. Mcchanical and mdabolic dctcrminanls of thc prefcrtcd stop width in human walking.
Prore<:dings ofthc Royal Society !l: Bio!ogkal Sden=, 263, pp.19115-1992. tists and coaches to gain valuable information that can be subsequently used effec-
Hasclcr, LJ ., Hogan, M.C. nnd Richardson, R.S., 1999. Skcktnl mundc phosphocreatinc recowry in excrci&i..'-trnincd humans is dependcnt
on 02 1wallnbility. JAppl Physiol, 86, pp.2013-S.
tively to optimize training and recovery. However, in complex sports like soccer,
Haugcn, T., Tonn~>socn, E., Hisdnl, J. nnd Si>ilcr. S., 2013. Thc Role and Development of Sprinting Specd in Socccr. !nt J Sporl~ Physiol the ability to isolate and evaluate specific physical abilities can be problematic.
Pcrfom1, [Epub ahend of print].
Jovanovic, M., Spori~, G., Omn:cn, D. nnd Fiorenli1li, F., 2011. Eficcts oi spc;;:d, agilily, quickncss training mcthod on power performance The physiological and mechanical demands of soccer require players to be profi-
in elite socccr playern. J Strength Cond Res, 25(5). pp.1285-1292.
tittk·, T. :1nd Williams, A.G., 2005. Spccifkity of ncll.'lcration, maidmum spc'\!d, nnd ngility in profc:;.,ional socrer plnycro. j. Strcnglh cient in numerous aspects of fitness, such as aerobic and anaerobic power, muscle
Cond. Res., 19(1), pp.76-78.
L.ockie, R.G., Murphy, A.J., Schu!t:, A.!l., Jcflries,>, M.D. nnd Callílghan, S./ ., 2013, lnfiucnll.' of sprint acrclcration otnnre kinclics on vclo- strength, flexibility, speed, agility and quickness (Reilly and Doran, 2003). These
dty and s\ep kinematio.; in field sport athlcl.,,;.J Strength Cond Rcs, 27(9), pp.2494-2503.
/\fann, R. and Sprague P., 1950. A kinctk analy$iS of the ground leg during sprint running. Res Q Excrc Sport, 51{2), pp.334-48. physical demands can vary according to playing position, players' individual abi-
Moreno, E., 1995. Dcvcloping qukknes,; pari 2. Strenglh and Conditioning. 17, pp.35-39.
Nirola, T.L. andjcwison, D.J., 2012. The Anatomy and lliomechanics ofRunning. Clinical]oumal ofSpor\5 Medicine, 31, pp.167-201. lities, and the tactical guidelines imposed by the coach (Reilly, 2003). Ultimately,
Pcrroni, F., Corvino, M., Cignitli, L. and Minganti, C., 2013. RSA rcsponsc to pn.-:;ca:;on \ralning in scmiprofe~sional ,;ocrer pfoyero. Sport match analysis of physical performance (e.g., distance covered) only provides the
Scicnn_'S for Hcalth. 9, pp.59·64.
Ponl<.cr. H., Holloway, J.H. 4th. Rakhlcn, D.A. and Licbcrman D.E., 2009. Control 11nd function of arm swing in human walking and coaching staff with a one-dimensional perspective, because players do not always
running. ThcJoumal of E><pcrimcntul Bio!ogy, 212, pp. 523-534.
Rampinini, E., !lishop, D., Ma reora, S.M., Ferrari !lravo, D., S=i, R. and Impclliu:cri, F.M~ 2007. V.1lidity of simplc ficld ter.!!! as indka- maximally exert their physical capacities during match play due to factors such as
tors of match·relakd physica! performnnre in top· leve! professional socrcr players. Int JSports Mcd, 28, pp.228-35.
S.1ndcr, A., Kcincr, M., Wirth, K. and Schmidtblcichcr, D., 2013. lnfluençc of" 2-ycar strenglh tralning programmc on powcr performanre tactics, score, and opposition standard. In this regard, research into elite match play
in clitcyouth socccr playcrs. Eur J SportSd, 13(5), pp.4.\S.51.
Shcppnrd, ).M. and Young, W., 2011. Tralning agi!ity and ch11ng<>-of-direction r.pccd (CODS). Jn; M. Cardinalc, R. Newton and K. Nosaka, has found the work rate to be associated with that of the opposing team, as well as
cds. 2011. Strength .1nd Conditioning: !liological Princip!esand Practioil Applications. Wllcy-!llackwell. pp.363-376.
Shcppard, p,t. and Young. W.B., 2006. Agility lítemture rcview: Clamlfications, trnining and tcsting. Joumal of Sports Sdcnces, 2·1{9), their competitive levei (Rampinini, 2007) .
pp.919-932.
Sloth, M.,Sloth, D., Ovcrgaard, K. and Oa!gar,, U., 2013. Effccts of sprint inlcrva! \rüininp; on V02max and aerobkcxercisc performance:
A systcmatic rcvicw and meta-analysis. Scandinavian Joumal of Medicine nnd Scicncc in Sports, 23(6), pp.c341-<'352.
T~iGkarsio, G., Theoharopoulus,A. nnd Gnrefb, A., 2003. Spced, opced dribblc and agi!ity of mate baEkctbal! playcrs pl~ying lndiffcrent
The main purpose of fitness tests is to build a physical profile of the player or
positions.Joumal of Human Movcmcnt Studics, ·15, pp.21-30. squad. There are also other reasons for periodic fitness tests, such as being able to
Varlcy, M.C., Gabbelt, T. and Aughey, R.J., 2013. Activity pro files of profcsoionnl wcccr, rugby !cague and Auotralian foolbal! malch play.
J SportsSd., Si>p9 [Epub ahcad of print]. objectively assess the impact of training interventions (e.g., determine if the play-
Weyand, P.G., Stemlight, D.13., llcllizú, M.J. and Wright, S., 2000. Fastcr top running spceds are achic1·cd with grcalcr ground forces not
more rapid lei; movcmcnW. )ou mal of Applied Physiology, S9(5), pp.1991·1999. ers' physical abilities have improved over the season), as well as to inform the coa-
Young, W. :1nd Rogers, N., 2013. Effccts of small-sidcd game and d1ange-of·direction training on reacti1·e agility and chani;c-<lf.Jirection
5pced.Joumal ofSports Sdcnees, !Epub ahead of print 9 Si>plcmbcr].
ches and sports scientists when a player is ready to return to training and, more
Young, W.B., McDowcll, M.H. and ScarlcU, !l.J., 2001. Sf"'dfidty of sprint and ngilily trnining mcthods. ]oumal of Strength and Condi-
tioning Rc-oearch, 15{3), pp.315-319.
importantly, to competition following an injury.
FITNESS IN SOCCER
124
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER
Fitness testing Fitness testing i 12s

8.2 CRITERIA 8.3 WHY MEASURE?


Fitness testing for soccer players should meet the following criteria: Measuring physical ability is important for both players and coaching staff for a
• They must be objective: A test's results must be reproducible from day to day number of reasons.
and from one rater to the next, thus minimizing any subjective interpretation.
This gives the best chance of observing sensitive changes in fitness over the 8.3.1 For lhe players
season (improvements and decrements). Testing provides feedback about the training process. This gives players a
• It must be specific: A test must be specific to soccer and therefore assess physi- clear understanding of their personal development.
cal parameters important to performance (e.g., utilize similar movements, • Reference data. Tests give an indication of a player's strengths and weak-
muscle groups, and energy systems). nesses, with the results providing reference data for an individualized trai-
• It must be valid: A test must actually measure what it professes to measure. ning program. This makes it possible to outline a performance profile for each
• A test should not require technical competence because of the leaming effect player.
being too great. For example, if speed is being measured, it should be measu- • Tests convey information about the player's state of fitness. Playing soccer at
red without the ball, because the player's technical skill will influence the a high levei is a strain on the body (overload principie), and this can result in
result of the test. overload injuries. Tests can enable overtraining to be detected.
• It must be comprehensible: A test must be as simple as possible to minimize 0 A testing program is an educational process, helping the player to understand
learning effects and maintain reproducibility. the objectives of the training program.
• It must be standardized in terms of administration, organization and environ- 0 Regular testing increases the player's motivation. Being more aware of one's
mental factors. Ideally, tests should be conducted at the sarne time of day, the own possibilities will encourage the player to conscientiously follow the trai-
sarne day in the microcycle, and after a similar amount of load or recovery. ning program.
Even the presence of parents or encouragement from the staff can affect the
test result. 8.3.2 For lhe coach
• It must respect necessary recovery between tests. Coaches should be guided 0Setting positions. Based on the test results, the coach can designate players
by the time needed for replenishment of metabolic substrates when consi- to playing positions where their physical abilities are best suited to match
dering the recovery time betvveen tests. Coaches should taper for at least 48 demands. For example, a player with a good acceleration and high peak run-
hours before conducting a test in order to reduce the effect of accumulated ning speed may be more suited to playing as a winger.
fatigue and allo\v players to be tested in an optimal physical condition (Viru 0 The test results enable the coach to create a team profile. This may give the
and Viru, 2001). coach a better insight into the strengths and weaknesses of his team. As an
• It must be reliable. Intra-rater reliability is the degree of agreement among example, speed tests can give the coach an idea of the speed of his defenders,
multiple repetitions of a diagnostic test performed by a single rater. Inter-ra- and this information can then be used to advise the defensive line on how high
ter reliability is the degree of agreement among different raters. A statistical up the field they should initiate pressure.
measure of inter-rater reliability is Cohen's Kappa, which ranges in general 0 Reference data. Test results are good indicators for the rehabilitation process.
from Oto 1.0. Larger numbers mean better reliability, and values approaching Match fitness can be checked based on earlier results.
zero suggest that any agreement can be attributed to chance alone. As a rule of • Testing data can provide coaching staff with objective feedback on the effecti-
thumb, Kappa values from 0.40 to 0.59 are considered moderate, 0.60 to 0.79 veness of a training program and enable the evaluation and adjustment of the
are considered substantial, and 0.80 and greater are believed to be outstanding training schedule in order to optimize results.
(Landis and Koch, 1977).
o It must follow a logical arder between consecutive tests. The National Strength
and Conditioning Association (NSCA) (Harman, 2008) suggests the follo\ving
arder: resting and non-fatiguing tests first (e.g., resting heart rate (HRr), body
composition, flexibility, and jump tests), followed by tests for agility, power
and strength; sprints; local muscular endurance; and anaerobic and aerobic
capacity.
• Preferably, a test should measure isolated physical abilities (e.g., not speed and
endurance together). A test that measures too many factors at once does not
provide useful information to the coaches and sports scientists as to why the
player performs well or not. It is therefore difficult to set up a specific indivi-
dualized program.
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITN ESS 1N SOCCE R
126 121
Fitness testing Fítness testing J

8.4 TEST ENVIRONMENT 8.6 TESTS


The test environment and conditions must be consistent and standardized for the Different tests that can be used to determine the team's current status ("as is") are
testing data to be interpreted correctly. For example, if an initial fitness test is con- described below. We now describe examples of muscular endurance, power, sprint,
ducted on the pitch in a warm environment, but the following test is carried out repeated sprint, agility and endurance tests that can provide useful information on
in an indoor air-conditioned facility with a hard-floor surface, the two tests will the fitness status of soccer players.
produce differing results.
Always note the conditions in arder to simplify the analysis of the results: 8.6.1 Muscular endurance tests
0 Time (The time of day can influence the result.) Introduction
0 Equipment used (Is the time measured electronically or manually?) Augustsson et al. (2009) demonstrated that males performed significantly more
o Periodization phase push-ups than females and had 44% greater upper-body strength endurance. They
0 Training sessions 48 hours prior to the beginning of the test also stated that females who trained upper-body strength were more likely to avoid
0 The arder of the different tests injury. Kennedy et al. (2012) confirrned this when they suggested that athletes with
• Noise pollution limited upper-extremity endurance, as demonstrated by low push-up performance,
o Temperature and humidity were more likely to be injured.
• Number of hours of sleep
• Emotional state of the athlete Wann up
• Medication The standardized warrn up for muscular endurance tests should be:
• Caffeine and other beverages Five minutes jogging followed by a dynamic activation of the deep musculature.
• Time and contents of the last meal
• Test environment Push-up or press-up test
• Knowledge of the test (Is there a possible learning effect? Is the test "user Aim: The push-up test is used to evaluate upper-body endurance, specifically
friendly"?) the pectoralis major, anterior deltoids, and triceps (Hoffman, 2006).
• Accuracy (such as the unit of time, distances, etc.) Protocol: Many variations on push-up tests exist, such as the duration of the
• Warming up (Was there enough time to warm up?) test, the placement of the hands, how far to go down, and so on. The push-up
• People present (Try to keep the number of people presentas low as possible to test is conducted with a normal hand and foot support position, and the body
minimize outside influence.) and legs are in a straight line with the feet slightly apart. The player lowers the
• Players' rnotivation (Is the player motivated for this type of test? body until there is a 90-degree angle at the elbows and then returns to the star-
• Encouragement (Do not allow encouragement or incentives, because these can ting position. The back must be straight at all times, and the player has to conti-
affect the test results.) nue the upward movement until his arms are fully extended.
Result: The number of repetitions are counted until exhaustion or until the
As a general rule, testing should be conducted under neutral conditions. This player is unable to maintain the proper technique over two consecutive repeti-
means a good surface and a moderate temperature with no other environmental tions. No pause is allowed at elbovv extension, anda self-selected tempo should
factors that could influence results, such as humidity, rain, and so on. be maintained throughout the test.
Some other tests exist, such as timed tests like the two-minute army push-up test
and the one-minute navy push-up test, as well as tempo tests where the push-ups
8.5 THE TERMS "TO BE" AND "AS IS" are performed to the rhythm of a beep or metronome. The push-ups are performed
These two terrns are used in sporting circles to determine the demands of the sport ata rate of one push up every 3s in the cadence push-up testas part of the Fitness-
and measure the current status. In other words, "to be" is an analysis of the sport Gram and the President's Challenge Fitness Award.
and the physical abilities required, while "as is" represents the current state of the
player for each of these abilities. For exarnple, "to be" could be that a winger has Push-up test
to run 1,000m at high intensity during a rnatch. The "as is" is then determined by
Min. Max. Stdev. Avg
looking at how many meters the player actually ran. For instance, if the player only
ran an average of 800rn during matches, the difference between "to be" and "as is" Elite U16 19.00ABS 46.00ABS 7.71 28.40ABS

is then 200m. This implies that the player has to work on his fitness to make up the Elite U17 21.00ABS 50.00ABS 7.35 31.14ABS
difference between the two values. Elite U19 21.00ABS 75.00ABS 9.81 37.82ABS
Elite U21 20.00ABS 61.00ABS 11.70 39.04ABS
Elite First team 22.00ABS 76.00ABS 13.45 48.17 ABS

Tab/e 8. 1: Reference data based on tests at different top clubs (TopSportsLab).


lZB I FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
i 129
Fítness testing Fitness testing

Partia! abdo11iinal niuscle 8.6.2 Power tests


Aim: To measure the muscular endurance of the abdominal muscles and hip Jntroduction
flexors. This provides a foundation for trunk and spine stability (Axler and The jumping ability of a soccer player is considered highly important for per-
McGill, 1997). formance. Jumping is a complex movement that greatly depends on inter-limb
Protocol: The player lies on his or her back with knees flexed at 90°. (This relie- coordination, muscle-fiber type and stiffness, and maximum strength. Literature
ves the strain on the lo•ver back and the hip flexors are extensively immobili- has shown that jump height can be improved through various types of training
zed.) The feet may not be anchored to the ground, and the arms should lay by methods (Kotzamanidis et al., 2005).
the player's side with the fingers touching a line. A second line is positioned at
10 cm. The player then tries to do as many curl-ups as possible in one minute. ln the literature, a range of different terms are used. ln this book, we use the follo-
Many methods of conducting crunches or curl-up tests have been published wing terms:
(e.g., feet anchored, hands crossed over the chest, legs on the ground, etc.). Some Squat jump (SJ): The player starts from a semi-squat position (90°) with no
tests use a certain period (e.g., two minutes in the US Army) and some use a set arm swing and no counter movement
tempo until exhaustion (e.g., the NHL curl-up beep). Vertical jump (VTJ): The player starts from a stationary, semi-squat position
(90º) with arm swing and no counter movement.
Counter movement jump (CMJ): The player starts from an upright standing
position and performs a downward movement (counter movement) with no
arm swing allowed.
Counter movement jump with arm swing (CMJwa): The player starts from
an upright standing position and performs a fast do\vnward movement (coun-
ter movement) with arm swing.
ln the literature, the VTJ is often confused with the CMJ. ln a CMJ, the player can
bend his legs and make a counter movement, \Vhich will enhance the test results
(jump higher) compared to a VTJ. ln addition, the VTJ is not an easy test to carry
out. The player should not conduct any pre-stretching. Even minar pre-stretching
Fig. 8. 1: Abdominal muscle exercise may make a big difference to the height jumped.
lf the abdominal musc/e exercises are performed with extended /egs, lhe musc/es flexing the hip
wilf assist in the exercise. When the knees are bent at 90º, the strength ofthe hip flexors is limited,
enabling the abdominal musc/es to work in iso/ation. Parfrey et af. (2008) did not find any significant
Wann up
effects of knee position in muscfe activation, but they did finda trend towards greater activation of The standardized warm up for power tests is as follows:
the abdominal museu/ature and /ower Rectus Femoris activation when lhe knees were bent. o Five minutes jogging followed by a dynamic activationof the deep musculature
0 Two submaximal jumps, a one-minute recovery, and one maximal jump follo-
Result: The number of repetitions are counted. wed by two minutes of recovery.
Science: Parfrey et aL (2008) examined the effects of different sit- and curl-up
positions on activation of abdominal and hip flexor musculahtre. ln this study, Couuter 111ove111ent ju111p (CMJ)
the highest level of activation carne from the 10 cm sit-up test with non-fixed Aim: To measure the explosive, concentric strength of the legs and re-use of
feet and bent knees as described in this book. This test provides high activation elastic energy during the eccentric to concentric movement.
of the abdominal musculature with minimal activation of the hip flexors. Protocol: The CMJ is performed from a standing start. The test is best carried
out on a contact n1at. lf a contact mat is not available, the CMJ\va test can be
conducted by measuring the reach height and then maximum height by using
a Vertec ora \Vall. -
Three maximal jumps are done with 30s of rest between them.
Instructions for the athlete: The player starts from an upright standing position
and performs a fast downward movement (counter movement) with or \Vithout
an arm swing.
Result: The highest score
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
130 131
Fitness testing Fitness testing

Counter Movement Jump (with Arm Swing)


Min. Max. Stdev. Avg
VERTICAL JUMP (VTJ) AND SQUAT JUMP (SJ)
Aim: To measure the explosive, concentric strength of the legs.
Elite U16 28.80 cm 59.00 cm 5.63 40.55 cm
Protocol: The SJ is performed from a semi-squat position. A total of three maxi-
Elite U17 22.50 cm 59.10 cm 6.54 40.24 cm mal jumps are performed with a 30s pause after each jump. ln the event of dif-
Elite U19 28.70 cm 65.20 cm 7.06 44.63 cm ferent jump tests, a five-minute rest period is taken between the different tests.
Elite U21 30.00 cm 65.70 cm 6.37 44.98 cm The squat jump is done without arm swing (see figure 13.5).
Elite First team 32.20 cm 63.90 cm 5.77 47.82 cm The VIJ is performed from a semi-squat position with arm swing. The test is best
carried outona contact mat. If this is not available, the test can also be conducted
Elite Women first team 27.20 cm 42.50 cm 3.93 32.95 cm
by measuring the reach height and then maximum height by using a Vertec or a
Counter Movement Jump
wall. Three maximum jumps are performed with a 30s rest between each attempt.
Min. Max. Stdev. Avg Instructions for the athlete:
Elite U16 21.40 53.50 4.96 34.98 • Knees kept at an angle of 90º before jumping
Elite U17 23.80 34.26 o No pre-stretching permitted
47.10 5.09
Result: The highest score.
Elite U19 24.80 60.80 6.34 38.53
Elasticity index: The percentage difference between SJ and CMJ height is
Elite U21 28.30 49.90 5.24 38.91
defined as lhe elasticity index (E!) or elasticity rate (Walshe et al., 1996). The
Elite First team 28.70 59.40 4.65 42.12 EI provides information regarding viscoelastic and neuromuscular capacities
Elite Women first team 25.30 34.20 2.39 28.78 (Pacheco et ai., 2011)
Squatjump
Avg
STANDING BROAD JUMP, HOR!ZONTALJUMP OR STAND!NG LONG JUMP TEST
Min. Max. Stdev.
The standing broad jump (SBJ) is an athletic event. It was even an Olympic event
Elite U16 20.30 cm 53.90 cm 4.77 32.16 cm
until 1912. A horizontal jump may be of more value to the sports practitioner,
Elite U17 18.64 cm 49.40 cm 6.26 33.71 cm because horizontal movements occur in many sports actions such as sprinting and
Elite U19 20.70 cm 53.60 cm 5.83 36.20 cm other agility movements. Horizontal jump tests have good reliability, and they cor-
Elite U21 23.30 cm 55.70 cm 5.64 36.51 cm relate well with sprinting both kinematically and kinetically (Ball and Zanetti, 2012).
Elite First team 28.30 cm 53.70 cm 4.53 39.90 cm
Aim: To measure the explosive, concentric strength of the leg muscles.
Protocol: The SBJ is a long jump from a standing position. The player jumps as
Elite Women first team 21.00 cm 35.20 cm 3.37 27.49 cm
far as possible, landing on both feet without falling backwards. Three jumps are
Table 8.2: Reference data based on tests at different top clubs (TopSportsLab). carried out with a break of 30s between attempts. The player may use a counter
movement.
One-legged CMJ Left Instructions for the athlete:
Max. Avg o Feet slightly apart behind the line
Min. Stdev.
o Jump as far as possible, landing on both feet
Elite U16 14.50 37.36 4.32 23.59
It is advisable to use a mat to absorb the shock on landing.
Elite U17 11.40 38.60 5.21 22.65 Result: The best score is measured accurately to the nearest cm with the best
Elite U19 12.60 41.50 6.10 23.16 results being recorded.
Elite U21 17.10 43.00 4.97 27.42
Elite First team 15.80 41.30 4.89 27.68 Standing Broad Jump
Elite Women first team 16.20 25.20 2.85 20.06
Min. Max. Stdev. Avg
One-legged CMJ Right
Elite U16 155.00 cm 274.00 cm 21.73 206.71 cm
Min. Max. Stdev. Avg
Elite U17 161.00cm 246.00 cm 21.34 196.78 cm
Elite U16 14.70 37.10 4.09 23.46
Elite U19 185.00 cm 254.00 cm 14.53 215.00 cm
Elite U17 12.20 39.80 5.03 22.49
Elite U21 185.00 cm 265.00 cm 16.30 226.08 cm
Elite U19 11.90 40.40 6.10 23.75
Elite U21 18.40 4.63 27.06 Elite First team 160.00 cm 283.00 cm 23.74 232.77 cm
41.80
Elite First team 18.00 39.60 4.60 27.48 Elite Women first team I I I I

Elite Women first team 14.30 25.40 2.92 20.03 Table 8.4: Reference data based on tests at different top clubs (TopSportsLab).

Table 8.3: Reference data based on tests at different top clubs (TopSportsLab).
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
132
1 133
Fitness testing Fitness testing

SINGLE-LEG, TRIPLE-HOP TEST LEFT AND R/GHT (SLTHT L & R) Science: This test can be used as a return-to-play criteria by measuring the func-
Functional tests for an individual lower extremity-such as the Single-Leg Vertical tional deficit between limbs. This is done using the Limb Symmetry Index (LSI)
Jump (SLVJ), Single-Leg Hop for Time (SLHT), and Single-Leg Hop for Distance (i.e., LSI = injured leg/non-injured leg x 100). Noyes et ai. (1991) described a
(SLHD)-are used by medical staff to gain information to help decide whether a limb symmetry score of below 85% as being abnonnal.
player is ready to return to full play or not. The popularity of single-limb hop tests
is clearly evident inACLoutcome studies. This is not surprising given there is incre- SEATED CHEST PASS 3 KG
ased functionality over two-legged tests. The use of the healthy limb as a biological Aim: To measure the explosive, concentric strength of the arm muscles. Upper-
control eliminates the need to rely on population-specific normative data (Hopper body power has been quantified using various medicine ball throw tests, inclu-
et al., 2002). Furthermore, pre-injury data is often unavailable (van der Harst, Goke- ding the seated chest pass (Vossen et ai., 2000; Cronin and Owen, 2004).
ler and Hof, 2007). Additionally, functional tests can be used to measure percentage Protocol: The seated chest pass is a maximal throw with both hands from a sit-
deficit after an injury and monitor the effectiveness of rehabilitation (Clark, 2001). ting position. The player sits against a wall with a straight back and extended
A functional deficit of 10% between limbs is accepted as a return-to-play criteria. legs while holding a 3 kg medicine ball in front of his or her chest. The player
throws the ball as far as possible using both hands. The player performs three
throws, and the best score is recorded.
Triple·Hop Distance Test L
Instructions for the athlete:
Mín. Max. Stdev. Avg o Sit with your back against the wall.

410.00 cm 760.00 cm 60.67 606.05 cm


o Keep your legs straight and close together.
Elite U16
0 Hold the ball in front of your chest with both hands.
Elite U17 430.00 cm 761.00 cm 62.64 586.67 cm
o Throw the ball as far as possible.
Elite U19 470.00 cm 766.00 cm 64.98 634.38 cm Result: The distance is recorded accurately to the nearest cm. The score is
Elite U21 548.00 cm 819.00 cm 53.93 678.28 cm measured from the line to where the bali made contact with the floor.
Elite First team 531.00 cm 820.00 cm 49.58 694.52 cm
8.6.3 Sprinting speed
Elite Women first team 466.00 cm 604.00 cm 36.41 537.00 cm
Introduction
Triple-Hop Oistance Test R According to Little and Williams (2005), high-speed actions during soccer competi-
Min. Max. Stdev. Avg tion can be categorized into actions requiring acceleration and deceleration, maxi-
mal speed, and agility. Acceleration is the rate of change in velocity that allows a
Elite U16 438.00 cm 734.00 cm 56.40 599.07 cm
player to reach maximum velocity in the minimum amount of time. On the other
Elite U17 398.00 cm 720.00 cm 67.13 577.38 cm hand, deceleration is the rate at which a player can slow down. Maximum speed
Elite U19 470.00 cm 762.00 cm 67.86 637.42 cm is the maximal velocity at which a player can sprint. The range of sprint distances
Elite U21 388.00 cm 784.00 cm 61.20 677.48 cm documented during games (from l.Sm up to lOSm) indicates the need for both
acceleration and maximum speed abilities. The literature states that acceleration,
Elite First team 435.00 cm 788.00 cm 48.66 688.40 cm
maximum speed, and agility are specific qualities that are relatively unrelated to
Elite Women first team 496.00 cm 581.00 cm 24.62 534.75 cm one another (Bangsbo, 1994; Little and Williams, 2003). Importantly, the results of
Tabfe 8.5: Reference data based on tests at different top cfubs (TopSporlsLab). sprint tests have been shown to differ between different positional roles within the
team (Kollath and Quade, 1993).
Aim: To measure the explosive, concentric strength of the leg muscles and the
difference between the left and right leg. Wann up
Protocol: The SLTHT is a long jump on one leg from a standing position. The Standardized warm up for sprint tests:
player stands on one leg behind the line and hops on that leg three consecutive Five minutes jogging
times, travelling as far as possible. The player lands on one leg. Five minutes of dynamic stretching
Instructions for the athlete: Two submaximal sprints of 20m, a one-minute recovery, and one nearly maximal
0 Stand on one leg behind the line. sprint of 40m followed by two minutes of recovery.
0 Hop as far as possible three times, landing on the sarne foot. 10, 20, 40m sprint test
0 Use your hands and arms to the maximum. Aim: To measure acceleration (lOm) and maximum running speed (40m).
Result: The distance is recorded accurately to the nearest centimeter. The score Protocol: Draw a starting line and set up the photoelectric timing gates at 10,
is measured from the line to where the heel touched the ground on the last 20and40m.
jump. The best score, as well as the average score, is recorded.
[ FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
134 Fitness testing 1135
Fitness testing

The player runs the set distance as quickly as possible. The test is conducted 8.6.4 Repeaied sprint ability
three times, with a rest period of tw"o minutes betw'een each sprint. The player
stands with one foot 50cm behind the first electronic gate and decides when to BANGSBO REPEATED SPRlNT TEST
set off (to eliminate reaction time). It is important for the player to run at full
pace through the final 40m electronic timing gate.
Electronic measuring equipment is essential for all tests, because the distances
(J:"·\ A

for soccer-specific sprint tests are too short to be measured manually. Double i ~
: :
beam timing gates should be used if possible. The timing gates should be set A A Speed gate

at waist height, because this prevents an extended arm or leg from causing an
40m
incorrect time to be recor<led. A
Result: The time is recorded to the nearest 1/lOOth of a second, with the best
time being noted.
Acceleration index = 20 m - 10 m sprint time
··---";;;,>
A.,.._,,
Sm

Maximum speed index = 40 m - 20 m sprint time Sm

 Speed gate
Sprint test 1Om \ •...•..:v
Min. Max. Stdev. Avg Sprint • LED
............. ?> Active recovery
Elite U16 1.66 sec 2.22 sec 0.12 1.90 sec
Bangsbo, 1994 Wragg et ai. 2000
Elite U17 1.57 sec 2.28 sec 0.11 1.90 sec

Elite U19 1.57 sec 2.24 sec 0.14 1.86 sec


Fig. 8.2: Bangsbo repeated sprint test
Elite U21 1.51 sec 2.15 sec 0.14 1.81 sec

Elite First team 1.49 sec 2.05 sec 0.10 1.76 sec Aim: To measure soccer-specific repeated sprint ability (Bangsbo, 1994}.
Elite Women first team 1.99 sec 2.19sec 0.06 2.08 sec Protocol: The protocol includes seven successive 34.2m maximal sprints, inclu-
ding a slalom. The players start with their leading foot 0.3m behind the starting
Sprint test 20m
line. A period of active recovery (25 s to cover the 40m back to the starting line}
Min. Max. Stdev. Avg is given after each sprint.
Elite U16 2.83 sec 3.87 sec 0.20 3.27 sec Guidelines:
Elite U17 2.92 sec 3.93 sec 0.18 3.28 sec
0 Make the player run the course twice as part of the warm up.
0 Emphasize that:
Elite U19 2.69 sec 3.85 sec 0.25 3.16 sec
- the distance between A and B has to be run at maximum speed
Elite U21 2.66 sec 3.67 sec 0.21 3.08 sec - the player has to return to the starting line on time
Elite First team 2.72 sec 3.46 sec 0.13 3.02 sec 0 Two observers are needed: one at the starting line and another at the finish
Elite Women first team 3.41 sec 3.89 sec 0.12 3.58 sec
line. The first one calls out "2-1-go," signaling these three stages by first
extending his arm, then bending his elbow to raise his forearm at an angle of
Sprint test 40m
90º, and then lowering his forearm to a completely horizontal position. The
Min. Max. Stdev. Avg second observer then starts the stopwatch and records the time.
Elite U16 5.06 sec 6.87 sec 0.37 5.84 sec " The player performs seven sprints in total.
0 Testing an entire team takes approximately an hour.
Elite U17 5.20 sec 7.00 sec 0.36 5.86 sec
Result: The time is measured accurately to the nearest 1/lOOth of a second,
Elite U19 4.81 sec 6.82 sec 0.44 5.60 sec with the best time being recorded. The mean time is the average of the seven
Elite U21 3.94 sec 6.53 sec 0.47 5.38 sec sprints. This time indicates the player's ability to perform severa! sprints within
Elite First team 4.81 sec 5.96 sec 0.22 5.36 sec a short period. The fatigue index is calculated by deducting the fastest time
of the first two sprints from the slowest time of the last tvvo sprints. A high
Elite Women first team 6.06 sec 6.98 sec 0.22 6.43 sec
fatigue index suggests the player shows inconsistency in sprint performance,
Tabfe 8.6: Reference data based on tests at different top cfubs (TopSportsLab). and this represents the player's inability to recover during repeated sprints. A
high fatigue index may reflect an inability to replenish phosphocreatine stores
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
136 137
Fitness testing Fitness testing

and adequately remove blood lactate between consecutive sprints (Tomlin and MODIFIED ILLINOIS AGILITY TEST
Wenger, 2001 ).
Wragg et aL (2000) used a modified version of the Bangsbo sprint test. Their 5m
modification involved adding a random right or left turn component to
improve the applicability to the vari-directional nature of team sports and to
place a demand upon both legs. The change of direction was shown using two
light-emitting diodes (LED).

8.6.5 Agility lOm


Introductio1z
Mirkov et al. (2008) investigated the reliability of soccer-specific field tests and pos-
tulated that the most appropriate indicator of overall soccer performance may be
agility testing. A soccer player changes direction every 2-4s (Bangsbo, 1992). This
was confirmed by Verheijen et al. (2010) when they reported that players make
Speed gate  Speed gate

1,200-1,400 direction changes during a game.

War11t up Fig. 8.4: Moditied Illinois agility test


Standardized warm up for agility tests:
Five minutes jogging followed by a dynamic activation of the deep musculature Illinois agility test
Two submaximal sprints of 4x5m shuttle, one minute of recovery, and two maximal Min. Max. Stdev. Avg
sprints of 3x10m shuttle followed by tvvo minutes of recovery
Elite U16 14.22 sec 17.08 sec 0.59 15.27 sec

THE 505 AGILITY TEST Elite U17 14.68 sec 16.99 sec 0.59 15.38 sec

Elite U19 14.00 sec 16.18 sec 0.57 14.85 sec


A B e Elite U21 13.85 sec 15.84 sec 0.55 14.71 sec

Elite First team 14.63 sec 15.61 sec 0.37 15.19 sec

Tab/e 8. 7: Reference data based on tests at different top clubs {TopSportsLab).

Aim: To test agility (Getchell, 1979).


( Protocol: The course is lOm long and Sm wide. The cones in the center are
1 placed 3.3m from each other. ln the original protocol, players were asked to
begin in a prone position at the starting cone. Since this is an unnatural position
J. for a soccer player, we have instead chosen to start in a standing position 30 cm
behind the first timing gate.
Result: The score is determined by recording the time to the nearest 1/lOOth
of a second. The player runs the course tvvice, both from the left side, with a
Fig. 8.3: The 505 test minimum of three minutes betvveen the tvvo attempts. The best time is recorded.
Science: Caldwell and Peters (2009) examined seasonal variations in physiolo-
Aim: Measuring agility (i.e., change of direction). gical fitness. The authors found that both sprint and agility performance decre-
Protocol: The player runs from point A to point C and back to A as fast as pos- ased significantly during the off-season period. This is supported by Ross and
sible. The player must step past the turn line with both feet before retuming to Leveritt (2001), who identified that detraining caused a decrease in speed per-
the start. The time is recorded from when the player first runs through the Sm formance over 10-20m.
marker (B) to when they return through this marker (i.e., the time taken to cover
the Sm there and back, lOm in total).
Result: The score is determined by recording the time to the nearest 1 / lOOth of
a second. Each player has three attempts, with only the best time being noted.
l3S I flTNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
Fitness testing Fitness tesiing 1139

MODIFIED T TEST LEFT AND RIGHT Modified Agility T-test Left

Min. Max. Stdev. Avg


lOm Sm
Elite U16 8.56 sec 10.86 sec 0.37 9.51 sec
Elite U17 8.75 sec 11.00 sec 0.45 9.59 sec
Elite U19 8.38 sec 10.59 sec 0.48 9.38 sec

Speed gate Â
l
Â
ModifledT·test
lOm

 Speed gate Speed gate À,


1
JÍâ Â,
Sm

Speed gate

AgilityT-test Sassl et a!. 2009


Elite U21

Elite First team

E!ite Women first team


8.41 sec

8.48 sec

9.80 sec
10.27 sec

10.85 sec

11.05 sec
0.38

0.43

0.32

Table 8.8: Reference data based on tests at different top c/ubs (TopSportsLab).
9.32 sec

9.22 sec

10.23 sec

Fig. 8.5: Modified T test /eft


HEXAGON AGILITY TEST
Aim: To measure speed and agility. Beekhuizen et al. (2009) investigated
Protocol: The player runs the course as quickly ª"' possible, from point A in the the test-retest reliability of the Hexagon
direction of B, C, D, and B before returning to the start. ln contrast to the pro- Agility test. The researchers concluded
tocols outlined by Paulole et al. (2000) and Sassi et al. (2009), the course may
be covered in as natural a way as possible without shuffling or running bac-
kwards, since neither movements are used often in soccer and are not determi-
that the hexagon test shows excellent
reliability for measuring agility, sup-
porting its use as a tool to measure ath-
00
ning factors.
Sassi et al. (2009) proposed another modified agility T-test. The researchers indi-
cated that this new version of the T-Test (MAT), obtained by reducing the total
distance covered, presents a good relative and absolute reliability for both men
letic performance and lower-extremity
agility. This high levei of reliability, in
addition to its ease of administration,
makes the hexagon testa practical and
00 Fig. 8.6: Hexagon agi/ity test
and women. The nature of displacements in sports like volleyball, basketball, effective method to measure quickness.
and tennis cannot be replicated by using the standard T-Test, because they are Additionally, the researchers suggested that while using this test, a change of grea-
based on very short repeated displacements. They concluded that the MAT ter than 1.015s is necessary to be 95% certain that this change intime reflects impro-
would provide a more specific measurement of agility for these sports. How- vement and exceeds measurement error. A practice triai is recommended prior to
ever, for activities practiced on large courts or fields, such as soccer and rugby, recording scores to reduce the possibility of a leaming effect.
the use of the T-test would be more adequate and is recommended.
Result: The test is performed both from the right and the left. The score is deter- Aim: This test measures lower extremity agility and quickness.
mined by recording the time to the nearest 1/lOOth of a second. The best time Protocol: Draw a regular hexagon (internai angles of 120°), with the sides being
is noted. 60.Scm (2 feet) long. The test begins with the player standing on a line placed
Science: Pauole et ai. (2000) investigated the reliability of the T-Test, finding it in the middle of the hexagon. The test starts when the tester gives the com-
to be a highly reliable test that measures a combination of components, inclu- mand "Ready, go!" and starts the chronometer. The player tries to con1plete
ding leg speed, Ieg power, and agility. The T-Test may be used to differentiate three rounds as quickly as possible by jumping two-footed over each side. The
between those of low and high leveis of sports participation. player keeps his head and body facing in the sarne direction all the time. The
test is carried out in both a clockwise and anti-clockwise direction and perfor-
Modified Agllity T-Test Right med three times in each direction with lOs of recovery in between. There is also
a minimum of five minutes rest between the clockwise and anti-clockwise tests.
Min. Max. Stdev. Avg
If the player touches the line, the triai is stopped and restarted (Baechle and
Elite U16 8.29 sec 10.56 sec 0.38 9.55 sec Earle, 2000).
Elite U17 8.77 sec 11.37 sec 0.47 9.68 sec Result: The score is determined by recording the time to the nearest 1 / lOOth of
Elite U19 8.52 sec 10.71 sec 0.49 9.44 sec
a second.
The best time is recorded. A comparison between the clockwise and anti-
Elite U21 8.03 sec 10.63 sec 0.47 9.44 sec
clockwise tests may reveal an imbalance between left and right movement skills.
Elite First team 8.53 sec 10.95 sec 0.40 9.27 sec

Elite Women first team 9.58 sec 10.74 sec 0.28 10.02 sec

--------------------------""""'
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
140 141
Fitness testing Fitness testing

8.6.6 Anaerobic Capacity tests Modified 300m Shuttle Tempo Test

Min. Max. Stdev. Avg


Warnz up Elite U16 57.03 sec 73.23 sec 3.21 62.24 sec
Standardized warm up for measuring anaerobic capacity:
• Five minutesjogging followed by a dynamic activation of the deep musculature Elite U17 56.30 sec 66.03 sec 2.19 60.46 sec

• Four submaximal sprints of 50m followed by two ffiinutes of recovery Elite U19 55.44 sec 65.38 sec 2.19 59.45 sec

Elite U21 52.90 sec 80.10 sec 4.75 58.71 sec


MOD!FIED 300m SHUTTLE TEMPO RUN 2.21
Elite First team 53.06 sec 63.53 sec 57.17sec
Maximally accumulated oxygen deficit (MAOD) has been argued to be the best
noninvasive method for estimating anaerobic capacity (Scott et al., 1991; Rams- Elite Women first team 65.50 sec 75.69 sec 3.18 70.26 sec

bottom et al., 1997). An easy-to-administer field test that could accurately predict
MAOD would be of great use to many field-sport athletes and coaches. Moore and Table 8.9: Reference data based on tests at different top c/ubs (TopSportsLab).
Murphy (2003) concluded that the 300m Shuttle Run Test is a useful estimate of
anaerobic capacity in soccer players.
8.6.7 Endurance tests
som
20m SHUTTLE RUN TEST
lOm
The 20m shuttle run test was developed by Léger and Lambert in 1982.
Aim: The 20m shuttle run test is used to analyze acyclic endurance capacity. The
test measures cardiorespiratory endurance by means of a progressive maximum
test.
Protocol: Set out tvvo lines 20m apart, with a reference line 3m in front of each
line. A CD player anda compact disc of the Léger protocol are used.
Instructions for the tester: The starting speed is 8 km/h, with 0.5 km/h added
every minute. The intervals are indicated by audible signals. The aim is to start
atone of the tvvo lines 20m apart each time the signal is given.
Fig. 8. 7: Modified 300m shuttle tempo test Instructions for the athlete:
0 Each player runs at the sarne pace (i.e., not faster or slower than the audible
Aim: To measure acyclic anaerobic endurance capacity (shuttle tempo test). signal).
Place: Artificial field. 0 One foot needs to touch the line.
Warm-up: cardiovascular stimulus (five minutes running), followed by dyna- 0 If a player touches the line before the signal is given, he has to wait to set off
mic stretching exercises, and finally, a few submaximal sprints. again.
Protocol: The player runs to the lüm line and back, then to the 20m, 30m, 40m 0 A player must stop if:
and Süm lines. The player has to cross each line with at least one foot. Two he ar she gives up
observers are needed, with one standing by the starting line and recording the - he or she does not touch the finish line three times
time. The other observer moves constantly from the lüm líne to the 20m líne - he or she is not at the 3m line at the moment the audible signal sounds.
(and so on}, checking that the player passes the line and ensuring there is no ° Keep at least lm distance betvveen the players.
confusion about the distance to be covered. Different protocols are used in the Result: The time is recorded when the player stops.
literature, such as a 300m shuttle tempo test and a shuttle test of 300m over a
20m distance (Moore and Murphy, 2003). During the 300m shuttle run test, the
players must run to the 25n1 mark, touch it with a foot, turn, and run back to the
start. This is repeated six times without stopping (Sporis et al., 2008).
Result: The score is determined by the time recorded to the nearest 1 / lOOth of
a second.
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
142 143
Fitness testing Fitness testing

YO-YO INTERMITTENT RECOVERY TEST Aim: For a trained player, the Yo-Yo IRl test lasts 10-20 minutes and is mainly
The Yo-Yo intermittent recovery (Yo-Yo IR) test was first described in Fitness Trai- focused on an individual's endurance capacity. ln contrast, the Yo-Yo IR2 test
ning in Soccer, a scientific approach by Jens Bangsbo (1994). There are two versions lasts 5-15 minutes and tries to evaluate a trained player's ability to perform a
of the Yo-Yo Intermittent Recovery Test: a Level 1 for beginners and an advanced repeated intense bout with a high anaerobic energy contribution. The Yo-Yo IR1
levei 2. Both tests evaluate players' abilities to repeatedly perform intense exercise. test achieves these criteria for a lesser trained player (Bangsbo et al., 2008).
The Yo-Yo IR level 1 (Yo-Yo IRl) test focuses on the capacity to perform intermit- Protocol: The Yo-Yo IR tests consist of two 20m shuttle runs at increasing speed
tent exercise, leading to a maximal activation of the aerobic system, whereas the with a ten-second (2 x 5m) period of active recovery between that is control-
Yo-Yo IR levei 2 (Yo-Yo IR2) test determines an individual's ability to recover from led by audio signals. A player should run until they are unable to maintain the
repeated exercise with a high contribution from the anaerobic system. Evaluations speed, and the total distance covered at this point is the test result. A warning is
of elite athletes in various sports involving intermittent exercise showed that the given whenever the player does not complete a shuttle in time, and the player
higher the levei of competition, the better an athlete performs in the Yo-Yo IR tests must stop if they do not complete a fuil shuttle the next time. There are two
(Bradley et ai., 2010; Krustrup et ai., 2006). The Yo-Yo IR tests have been shown leveis to the test. Level 1 (Yo-Yo IR1) starts ata lower speed, and the increases in
to be a more sensitive measure of changes in performance than V02m""" providing speed are more moderate than in the level 2 (Yo-Yo IR2) test.
a simple and valid way to obtain important information about an individual's Instructions:
capacity to perform repeated bouts of high-intensity exercise. Furthermore, high 0 Each player runs at the sarne pace (i.e., not faster or slower than the audible
correlations were found between Yo-Yo IR test performance and the distance of signa!).
high-intensity running during a soccer match, which was not the case for other 0 Walk slowly around the cone and set off again when the signal is given.
tests, such as repeated sprint tests, the V02m,,x test, and the 20m shuttle run test 0 The test must be stopped after a second warning has been given by the tester.
(Krustrup, et ai., 2003; Bangsbo j. et ai., 2008). Thomas et ai. (2006) investigated the o A11ow at least lm of space per player.
correlation between the Yo-Yo IR test and the 20m shuttle run test and V0 2max· The Result: The level and total distance are noted.
investigators concluded that the level 1 (recreational) and level 2 (elite) test scores
both strongly correlated with the 20m shuttle run (Léger and Lambert, 1982) scores
and vo2max (level 1 recreational subjects only). Mohr and Krustrup (2013) investigated Yo-Yo intermittent recovery test perfor-
mances within an entire soccer league (of semi-professional players) during a full
Estinwtes of V0 2,,,,.,,: Yo-Yo IR1 test: V0 2111 _,,, (111L/111i11/kg) season. YYIR2 performance was 847 ± 227m at preseason. It rose by 128 ± 113m to
= IR1 distance (m) x 0.0084 + 36.4 975 ± 205m at the start of the season, rising further by 59 ± 102m to 1034 ± 2Ilm
at mid-season. Submaximal YYIR1 HR was 90.9 ± 4.2% HRm"" at preseason, higher
Estilnates ofV0 2 ,,,~x: Yo-Yo IR2 test: V0 2111ax(1nL/11lin/kg) than at the start, middle and end of the season (87.0 ±3.9, 85.9 ±4.1, and 87.0 ± 3.7%
= IR2 distance (111) x 0.0136 + 45.3 HRmJx respectively). Peak YYIR2 performance and minimum YYIRl HR were 1068
± 193 m and 85.1±3.8% HRmax respectively, with around 50% of the players peaking
at mid-season.
20m Sm
~

  Â
À À À

 À À

À Â Â

  Â

Fig. 8.8: Yo-Yo intennittent test recovery test


FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
145
Fitness testing Fitness testing

30-15 INTERMITTENT FITNESS TEST (30-15 IFT! Players line up behind one of the end lines (line A). They begin to run on the first
The 30-15 Intermittent Fitness Test (30-15 IFT) was designed by Buchheit (2008) "beep," pacing their efforts so they will be within the 3m mark of line B at the
to replicate the intermittent demands of soccer. This test differs from the Yo-Yo IR second "beep." They then arrive at the next 3m mark (line C) at the third "beep."
tests, however, in that it involves 30s of running followed by 15s of walking. This continues until there is a different, double beep that indicates the end of
the 30s exercise period. Active recovery is then commenced for the next 15s by
40m walking forwards to the next line and waiting for the next 30s running period
20m

'
1
1
1
-
3m
to begin. The test is terminated when participants reach volitional exhaustion or
when an athlete does not make it into the tolerance zone three times.
Score: The running velocity during the last completed stage is recorded as the
maximum running speed (vIFT). The vIFT is also useful for the prescription of
1 generic running drills to improve RSA.
LlneA 1 Line B Line e
The following formula estimates V0 2max based on the final running speed. G
............................................ stands for gender (female = 2; male =1), A for age, and W for weight (Buchheit,
2008).

vo,m" (ml/kg/min)=
28.3-(2.15 x G)-(0.741 xA)-(0.0357 x W) + (0.0586 xAx v!FT) + (1.03 x v!FT)

Sprínt
0 ., .......... l> Aclive rccovery FOUR-MINUTE SUB-MAXIMAL TEST
ln this test, the players run on a motorized treadmill (or use a bike if a treadmill is
Fig. 8.9: 30-15 lntermittent Fitness Test unavailable) at 12 km/h for four minutes. At the end of the four minutes, both the
HR and heart rate recovery (HRR) after 30, 60 and 120s are recorded. This makes
Aim: To measure the ability to recover and repeat intermittent activity it possible to see if a player has recovered well (the HR is lower) and whether his
Procedure: Mark a 40m area with cones at each end and also at the midpoint fitness has improved (the HR is lower and HRR is quicker). This test is ideal for
(20m). Place cones 3m before each end line and either side of the míd-line (tole- monitoring the fitness and recovery of players. It can be performed daily and is
rance zones). The test consists of 30s shuttle runs interspersed with 15s passive easy to administer and carry out.
recovery periods (i.e., walking) on a 40m straight runway. The running velo-
city starts at 8 km/h, increasing by 0.5 km/h at every 45s stage thereafter. As
a result, depending on the speed, the participants have to cover an increasing 8.7 ANALYZING TESTING RESULTS
distance for a given time. It is clear that regular testing of soccer players is advantageous to coaching staff. It
allows coaches to assess the fitness leveis of players and plan appropriate training
throughout the season. However, once a battery of tests has been performed, it is
the job of sports scientists in the support staff to analyze changes in physical per-
formance longitudinally across training periods and seasons.

It has been suggested that analyzing the percentage difference between repeated
tests is a more appropriate method of assessing athletic performance (Hopkins et
al., 2009). This method of analysis also allows for clear comparisons to be made
between changes in different physical abilities, something that is difficult with raw
data.

For example, considera 5% increase in CMJ and a 7% decrease in 40m sprint time
rather than a 3cm increase in CMJ and 0.Ss decrease in 40m sprint time. Using per-
centage differences allows for more meaningful and clear conclusions to be made
about physical abilities.
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Fitness testing
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Fitness testing 1147
Additionally, a method for assessing the true change in athletic performance using SUMMARY
the smallest worthwhile change (SWC) statistic has been suggested (Batterham
and Hopkins, 2006). This is calculated by multiplying the between-player standard By monitoring the physical abilities of soccer players on a consistent basis,
deviation by 0.2. This creates a raw data unit that a player must meet in arder for sports physiologists and soccer coaches can gain valuable information that can
an improvement in performance to be substantial. Again, this can then be made be then used effectively to optimize training and recovery. The tests chosen must
into a percentage SWC. be specific, valid, and reliable. Soccer-specific endurance, strength, power, speed
and agility tests provide a good framework when assessing the physical abilities
of soccer players. When carried out in the correct manner, and with appropriate
Test 1 Re-Test o/o Change
feedback given to the players, testing can become an integral part of the soccer
Player 1 1800 1900 5.6o/o Substantial improvement training program. Strategically timed testing throughout the calendar year can
Player 2 1850 1830 -1.1o/o Trivial decrease help motivate players to improve their individual physical characteristics, ulti-
1900 2200 10.So/o Substantial improvement mately helping team performance.
Player 3
Player4 2000 2300 1°/o Trivial improvement

Player 5 2100 2000 -7.1% Substantial decrease

Player 6 1750 2000 0% No lmprovement REFERENCES


Playcr 7 1800 1950 8.3% Substantial improvement
Augusts:;on, S.lt, llor.<ar>, E., Thomas, E.M., Sahlberg, M., August,;,;on, ). and S\'Ontcswn, U., 2009. C,,nder dilforenc..-s and reliabi!ity of
oclccled physkal pcrfonnoncc tff.lr. in young womcn and men. Advanccs in Physiotherapy, 11, pp.&1-70.
A'lcr, C.T. and McGill, S.M., 1997. Low back load~owr a variety of abdominalexcrdsco: ~e.irching for the safust abdominal challengc.
Average 1885.7 1928.6 2.3°/o Substantia! improvement in Mcd Sd Sport> Excrc 29(6), pp. SQ.1-811.
llacchlc, T.R. and E.1rlc, R.W,, 2000. 8.'cntials of stren!jth training and conditioning. Champaign, IL Human Kinetics.
team performance lfoll, N.B. and ZaneUi, S., 2012. Relationshlp bctwcon Rcactive S!rength Variab!..-s in Horizontill and Verucal Drop jumps. Joumal of
Slnmglh and Conditionin!j R<.-r.carch, 26(5), pp.J.107-J.112.
Bangobo, )., 1992. Time and motion charactcri,-.!ici; of compctition soccer. !n; T. Reilly and F. Korku<uz, cdc,. 1992. Sdcncc Football (vol
Standard Deviation 124.9 116.3 6). london, UK: Routlcdge. pp.3·1-10.
!fong~bo,J., 199·l.111e phrr.iology of w=r: Wíth spcdal refcrencc to inlcnoc phyoical cxcrdsc. Acta. Phy:;\ol. &.1nd., 150, pp.1-156.
swc 25 Bangsbo,J., Mohr, M. and Poulscn, A., 2006. Training and lC8ling thcelite alhlctc, J ExcrcSd Filner.s, ·1(1), pp.1-M.
Balterham, A.M. and Hopkin5. W.G., 2()()6. Making meaningful infcrem:c~ about magnitudcs. lntj Sports Perl Physiol Pcrf, l, pp.50·57.
o;..swc 1.3% llcckhuizen, K., Davis, M., Kolbcr, M. and Chcng. M.S., 2009, Te~t-Rcte:;t Reliability and Minimal Octcctablc Changc of the Hexngon
Ag1lity Ter.t. /oumal of Strcnglh and Condítioning Rescarch, 23(7), pp.2167-217!.
Brodley, P., Oi Masdo, M., Pcart, O., O!~en, P. and Sheldon. B., 2010. High-intcru1ty acli\•1ty profilcs of elite wcccr players .1t difforent
Tab/e 8.10: Exampfe of an intermittent performance test using the SWC. The SWC statistic al/ows pcrfonnance lcvels. Jouma! of strcnglh and condition resi!arch, 24(9), pp.2343-235L
lluchhcit, M., 2008. Thc 30.15 Jntcrmitlcnt Fitness Tcst: 1\ccurncy for lndividualizing lntcrval Training ofYoung lntcrmiltcnt Sport Play-
sporl science and supporl staff to categorize changes in performance and make meaningful er:;. )ou mal ofStrength and Conditioning R"''>Cnrd~ 22(21 pp.365-374.
conc/usions about individual and team performance over time. Caldwcll, B.P. nnd Pctcr.<, D.M., 2009. Sca'!Onal v.1rialion in physiological fitncs~of a ~cmiprof.;e;.,ional soccer leam. JStrength Cond Rco,
23(5), pp.1370-1377.
Clark, N .. 2001. Functional pcrfonnancc tcstini; followini; kncc ligament injury. Physka! thcrapy in Sport, 2, pp.91·105.
Cronin, J.B. and Owen, G.J., 2()1).1. Uppcr-body ~trength and powcr asS<-.>Smcnt in womcn using a cher.t paos. joumal of Strength and
Conditioning Rcscarch, 18(3), pp.401-10.\.
Draf"!r, J.A. and Lancaster, ~l.G., 1933. Thc 505 test: a tcst foragility ín lhe horizontal plane. Aust JSd Med Sport, 17(1), pp.6-15.
Gclchcll, B., 1979. Physkal Fitneso: A Way of Lifo (2nd cd). New York: John Wilcy
Hilnnan, E.,. Prindples oi tcst wlection and administration. ln: T.R. Baechlc and R.W. Earle cds. 2003. Esscntia!s of Strcngth Training and
Conditioning (3rd cd). Champaígn, IL: Human Kinclial. pp.233-216.
Hoffmann, /., 2006. Nonns for Fitncr.s, Pcrfonnancc, and Heallh. Champaign, IL: Human Kinctics.
Hoppcr, D.M., Goh, S.C. and Wcntworth, L.,\., 2002. Tcst-retcr.t reHability of knCi> rating scalc-s and functiona! hop tcr.15 one ycar follo-
wing anterior crudatc ligamcnt reconstruction. Phys 111cr Sport, 3, pp.10--18.
Kennedy, M.D., Fixhcr, R., Fairban\.:5, K., Lefoivrc, l., Vickcry.·, L., MolLln, J. and Paren~ E., 20!2. Can pn.~scason fitnCf.s mcasures
pn.>dict time to injury in varsity alhlct..-s?: a rctrosp~'Ctivc case control study. Sporl5 Medicine, Arthroscopy, Rchabilitation, Thcrapy &
Technology, 4(26), pp.1755-2555-4-26.
Kollath. F. and Quadc, K., 1993. Mcar.uremcnt of sprinting Sf"!Cd of profcssional and amalcurr.o=r players. ln: T. !\cillj~ T. Clarys and
A. Stibbc, eds. 1993. Sdcnce and •occcrll. London: E&FN Spon. p.31.
Kot:<amonidis, C., Chat:<opoulos, O., Mkhailidi~, C, Papaiakornu, G. and Patikas, D., 2005. Thc Effc'l:t of a Combincd Hlgh-tnkruity
Strength and Spccd Training l'rogrnm on thc Running and Jumping t\bility of So=r Playcrs. jouma! of Strength and Conditioning
Jlet"Carch, 19(2), pp.369-375.
Krustrup, P., Mohr, M., and Amslrup, T., 2003. Thc Yo-Yo intcnnittcnt rcrowry los!: physiologkal n_.,;ponsc, rcliability and validity. Mcd
Sei Sport• facrc, 35(·1), pp.697-705.
Krustrup, P., Mohr, M., Nybo, l., Jcn."<Cn, /.M., Niclsen, J.J. and llan!jsbo, J., 2006. 111c Yo-Yo !IU lC8l: phyoiolo!jkal n_.,;pon,;c, reliability,
and applicatíon to elitesocrer. Medicine & Scicncc inSports& facrd~e, 38(9), pp.1666-73.
L1ndis,J.R. and Koch, G.G., 1977. Tilc mc.1suremcnt of ob::.crver agreemcnt forc,1tcgorkal data. Biomctric:, 33, pp.159-174.
legcr, l. and lambcrt,J., 1982. A maximal 20-mf.huttlc run test to predkt V02max. Europcan)oumal oi Applicd Physiology,49, pp.1-12.
Litt!c, T. and Willímns, AG., 2003. Spcdficity of a=lcration. maximum spced and agility in profose.ional s<>C«!T playcrn. ln: Fifth World
CongrcssofSdence and Football, Madrid: Gymnos, pp.J.l-t-145.
litt!c, T. and Williarw., A.G. 2005. Spccifidty of a=lcration, maximum spocd, and agílíty ín profossional wcccr playcrn. /. Stn.-ngth
Cond. R~.,;., 19(1), pp.76-78.
Mírkov, O., Ncdcljkovic, A., Kukolj, M., Ugarkovk, O. and Jaric. S., ZOOS. Evaluation of the reliability of socccr-sp<!dlic Jicld tco<l•. jouma 1
ofStrcngth and Conditioning. 22(4), pp.11).16-1050.
Mohr, M. and Kruslrup P., 2013. Yo-Yo intcnnittcnt n_'COvcry test pcrfonnanccs Within an cnlírc foolball !cague during a fuU season. J
Sports Sd., !Epub ahcad of print].
Moore, A. and Murphy, A., 2003. Dcvelopmcnt of "n anacrobic capadty tcst for field sport athlctes. Joumal ofScicncc and Mcdidnc in
Sport, 6(3), pp.275-284.
Noy..-s, F.R., Barber, S.O. '1nd Manginc, R.E., 1991. Abnonnal lowcr limb symmctry dctcnnincd by function hop !csls alter anterior cru d-
ate ligamcnt rupture. Am J Sports Mcd, 19, pp.SIJ..518.
FITNESS IN SOCCER
1481 Fitness testing
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Heart rate and GPS monitoring in soccer 1149
Pad>cco, L., Baliu~, R.,Afüt<:, L., Pujo!, M. and Pcdrct, C., 2011. Thc Acute Effocts ofDifforcnt Slrctching Excn:iscson)ump Pcrforrnanm
Joumal of Strmgth and Conditioning R<!!'carch, 25(11), pp.2991·2998.
Parfo:y, KC., Dochcrty; D. Workman, C. and Bchm, D.G., 2003. Thccffocto of difforcnt sit ;md curl-uppo:;itionson nctivation of abdomi-
nal and hip flexor muscul.1tun>. App! Physiol Nutr Mctab, 33, pp.888-895.
Pauolc, K., Madolc, K, Gad1ammcr, J., Laoour<.-><', M. and Rozcnck, R., 2000. Rcli,1bility and Validity of lhe T-T1."St a~ n Mcn5urc of Agilit;;
Lcg Powcr, nnd LcgSpccd ln Collcg~~Agcd Mcn nnd Womcn. Joumal ofStrcng~1 & Conditioning R1.~;card>, 14(4), ppA•l'.l--150.
Rampinini, E.. CoultsA.J. ;md Ca5tagna, C., 2007. Variation in top-k•·cl socrer rnatch pcrfonnancc. lntJSporlo Mcd, 28, pp.1015-2.J.
Ramsboltom, R., Ncvill, M.E., NevilJ, A.M. and Hazcldinc, R., 1997. Accumulatcd oxygcn deficit and shuttlc run pcrfonnancc in physi-
c,11!y activc m<!n and womcn. )ou mal ofSporto Scicnres, 15(2), pp.207-2M.
Rdlly, T., 2003. Environmcntal strcr,s. Jn: T. Rcilly and A.M. Williams cdo. 2003. Sdcncc ;md Socccr (2nd cd.). London; E. & F.N. Spon.
pp.165-l!H.
Rcilly, T. and Doran, D., 2003. filnec_,s Asscs.rncn!. ln: T. Rcilly and M.A. Williarno, cds. 2003. Scicncc and Socccr. Roulclcdgc: Ncw
York pp.21-47.
Ros,:, A. and Lcvcrit~ M., 2001. Long-tcnn rnctabolic and skdclal rnusdc adaptMions to short·sprint troininu: irnplications for sprint
HEART RATEAND
trnining and tapcring. Sports Mcd., 31(15), pp.1063-S2.
Sas.i, R.H., Dardouri, W., Yahmcd, M.H., Gmada, N., Mahfoudhi, M.E. and Gharbi z., 2009. Rclativ<! and absolutc rcliabilily oi a rnodi-
ficd agility T-tcot and iW rclationship wilh vcrtkal jun>p and straight sprint.J Strcngth Cond Rcs, 23(6), pp.16.J.l-Sl.
GPS MONITORING IN SOCCER
Srolt, C.B., Roby, f.R., Lohrnan, T.G. and Sunt,J.C., 1991. Thc rnaximally accumufalcd oxygcn deficit i!S an indicalorol i!!li!Crobic perfor- Werner Helsen, Jan Van Wincke/, Kenny McMillan, Jean-Pierre Meert,
mance. Mcdicineand Scicncc inSporW and Excrcisc, 23, pp.618-624.
Spori5, G., Ruzic, L.E. and Lcko, G., 200B.1hc aMcrobiccndurancc of elite socccr pl.1yers impro•·cd aftcra high·inlcnsity trainini;;: intcr- Andre Aubert, Pim Koo/wijk, Peter Catteeuw, Arne Jaspers, David Tenney
vcntion ln thc B-wcck conditioning prograrn.Joumíll ofStrcngth and Conditioning Rcscarcl1, 2(2), pp.559-66.
Thomas,,\., Dawson, a. nnd Goodman, C., 2006. The yo-yo tc-;t: rcliability and =iodation wilh n 20-m ~hultlc run and V02mnx. Intcr-
national Joumal of SporW Phyüiology and Pcrfonnancc, 2, pp.137·149.
Torn!in, D.L. and Wcngcr, H.A., 2001. Thc rclationship hetwcen acrobk fitncss and rccovcry frorn high inleru;ity inlcnnittcnt cxcrcise.
Sporw Medicine, 31(1), pp.l-11.
van der Hars!, J.J., Gokclcr, A. and Hof, A.L., 2007. Lcg: kincrni!tks and kinctko in landing from a ~ingk'-lcg hop for di<tancc. A rornp.1ri-
son bctwccn dorninont nnd non-dorninant lcg. Clin. Biomcch, 22, pp.674-680. 9.1 INTRODUCTION
Vcrhcijcn. R., 2010. Handbuch furfussbnllkondition. ln: G. Sporis, t. Jukic, L. Milanovicand V. Vucctic, cds. 2010. Reliability and factoria\
validily of agility tcsl~ for soro:r players. J Strcngth Cond R~"'' 24(3), pp.6i'9-ó!l6. Heart rate (HR) refers to the number of heartbeats in a set unit of time and is usu-
Viru, A. and Viru, M., 2001. Biochcmical Moniloring ofSporW Training. Charnpaign, !L: Human Kinctks.
Vosscn, J.F., Krnmcr, /.F., Ourkc, D.G. and Vo=n, D.P., 2000. Cornparison of dynamic push·up training and plyomctric push-up training ally expressed as beats per minute (bpm). HR increases ar decreases in response to
on upper-body powcr and ~trcngth.Joumal ofStrcnsth nnd Conditioning Rl-scarch, 14, pp.2-!S-253.
Walshc, A.D., Wllson, G.J. and Murphy, A.J., 1996. Thc validity and rcliabi!ity of a tcst oi lowcr body mu"culotcndinous sliffnecoS. Eur J the demands of the body in arder to balance the requirement and delivery of oxy-
App! Physiot 73, pp.332-339.
Wr,1zi;. C.B., Maxwell, N.S. and Doust,).H. 2000. Evaluation ofthcrcfobility and validity oi asocccr-spcdfic fiel d tcst oi rcpcalcd ~print gen. HR is modulated through the autonomic nervous system and the interaction
i!bílity. Eur J Appl Phyr.iol, 83, pp.77·83. of sympathetic and parasympathetic outflow. Sympathetic stimulation increases
HR, while parasympathetic stimulation decreases it. Over the last two decades, HR
monitors have been widely used in soccer. Using HR measurement as an indirect
marker of 0 consumption has become a valuable, easy-to-use and relatively inex-
2
pensive tool for measuring the internai training load imposed on soccer players.
Validity and reliability have been shown to be good for HR monitors when com-
pareci to ECG measurements for measurement of both HR and heart rate variabi-
lity (HRV) (Achten and jeukendrup, 2003; Kingsley et ai., 2005). Recently, technical
development has focused on real-time monitoring instead of the post-exercise eva-
luation of recorded data (Schõnfelder et al., 2011).

9.2 USE OF HEART RATE AS AN INDIRECT MEASURE FOR OXYGEN


CONSUMPTION
Physical activity may be best assessed by measuring the oxygen uptake (VO)
during exercise. However, this is not very practical to achieve on a soccer field.
Research has shown a linear correlation to exist between oxygen uptake and HR.
The load resulting from physical activity can therefore be measured by using the
HR as an indirect measure of oxygen consumption This comparison is represented
in the Swain formula (Swain et al., 1994):

%HRmax = 0.64 X% vo2mnx + 37

Example: A player has a maximal oxygen uptake (V02ma.) of 55 ml/min/kg.


The coach wants to train at 60% of V02rnax' so the calculation is
0.64 X (0.6 X 55) + 37 ~ 58% of HRm.,,·
For example, if the HRrna• is 200 bpm, the player needs to train at 116 bpm.
150
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER
Heart rate and GPS monitoring in soccer
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Heart rate and GPS monitoring in soccer
l l 5l

9.3 RESTING HEART RATE (HRr) removal (outflux), resulting in a constant lactate concentration (Moxnes and Haus-
Resting heart rate (HRr) in adults is 60-80 bpm on average, but in elite soccer ken, 2009). At exercise intensities above a steady state, a rise in the concentration
players, it can vary between 40 and 70 bpm. According to the French newspaper can be attributed to either an increase in the rate of lacta te production ora decrease
!'equipe, professional cyclist Miguel Indurain had a HRr of 28 bpm. HRr is modu- in the rate of lactate remova! (Moxnes et al., 2012). The lactate concentration in the
lated by the autonomic nervous system, by the parasympathetic branch in parti- blood [La-]b is measured in millimoles per liter of blood, which is abbreviated to
cular. The nervous system ensures a controlled, consistently low HR. One of the mmol/L.
most pronounced cardiovascular adaptations to endurance training is a lower HRr.
This occurs through an increase in parasympathetic or vagal tone (Smith, 1987). A 9.5.2 Aerobic threshold
decrease in HR is not only the result of increased sensitivity of the parasympathe- The aerobic threshold is sometimes defined as the exercise intensity at which
tic nervous system but also a consequence of greater plasma volume and higher [La-]b reaches an arbitrary concentration of 2 mmol/L. This occurs approxima-
stroke volume. An increase in HRr has been suggested as a way of detecting fati- tely at a HR of 20-40 bpm less than the anaerobic threshold and around 60-70%
gue and monitoring overtraining (Budgett, 1998). Bosquet et al. (2008) suggested of HRrnílx· During this phase, the requirement and supply of oxygen is balanced.
in their review that an increase in HRr may be used as a valid sign of short-term, Steady-state physical activity is approximately between 2 and 4 mmol/L.
but not long-term, fatigue. Although nocturnal HRV, rather than HRr, values could
be better indicators of cumulated physical fatigue (Pichot et al., 2000), this requires Blood lactate
[La-],
monitoring HR during sleep, which may prove uncomfortable and impractical for
athletes in the long term (Robson-Ansley et ai., 2009). 7 High intensity

6
9.4 MAXIMUM HEART RATE (HRm,,)
5
HRrn"" is determined by genetic factors, and it decreases gradually from the age
of 20 in untrained people, with it decreasing slower in well-trained individu- 4
ais. HRrnnx can be measured by a maximal incremental exercise test. It can be also
estimated using various methods (Tanaka, 1991; Bruce, 1974; Londeree, 1982). 3
A brief review of various HRrnnx prediction formulas revealed that the majority of 2
:-·-·-·-·-·-.
age-based prediction equations have large prediction errors (> 10 bpm) (Robergs
and Landwehi;. 2002). HRrnnx can also be estimated on the basis of a simple test,
albeit for well-trained soccer players only. Warm up for 10-15 minutes followed
1
-·- ·-·-·-·-·-·-· Low intensity
by 3-4 minutes running at a tempo of 75-80% HRrnox and finally 30-45 seconds of o
maximum physical load (maximal sprint). HRrnnx is then measured immediately Time
after this sprint.
Fig. 9. 1: Blood lactate accumufation for different intensities

9.5 LACTATE THRESHOLD During low-intensity exercise, lactate is processed or re-used in the form of pyru-
vate in the less active muscles. As the intensity of the exercise increases, lactate
9.5.1 Lactate production exceeds lactate remova!. Consequently, lactate starts to accumulate in
Blood lactate concentration ([La-Jb) is the result of the production and removal of the muscles.
lactate. Lactate is formed continuously, under both aerobic and anaerobic conditi-
ons, as a result of substrate supply and equilibrium dynamics (Brooks, 1998). When 9.5.3 Lactate threshold
the rate of ATP production by oxidative pathways is insufficient to respond to the The lacta te threshold (LT), the onset of blood lactate accumulation (OBLA), anaero-
demands of physical activity, high rates of glycolytic (from blood glucose) or glyco- bic threshold (AT) or lactate inflection point (LIP) is the exercise intensity at which
genolytic (from muscle glycogen) ATP production are essential to prolong physical lactate starts to exponentially accumulate in the blood. You will also sometimes
activity. The end product of glycolysis is pyruvate, which can be reduced to lactate encounter the term maximal lactate steady state (MLSS), which is defined as the
or oxidized to H 20 or C02• During increasing exercise intensities, the muscles pro- highest exercise intensity where there is a balance between the rate oflactate appea-
duce more lactate, which is subsequently released into the blood plasma. [La-]b rance in the blood and its rate of removal Gones and Doust, 1998; Denadai, 2005).
is the result of the production of lactate from working muscles and tissues, and Some studies postulated that the MLSS corresponds to a mean concentration of
the remova! of lactate in the muscles, liver, renal cortex and heart (Brooks, 2007). 4 mmol/L (Heck et ai., 1985, Poole et al., 1988). However, individual variability
During steady-state physical activity, lactate production (influx) equals lactate in this concentration has been observed (Steggman et al., 1981). Different indices

FACULDADF OE DESPORTO
DA UNIVERSIDADE D P
1 f ITN ESS 1N SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
152 Heart rate and GPS monitoring in soccer 1 53
Heart rate and GPS monitoring in soccer

related to blood Iactate response to exercise are some of the most widely used para- 9.6 RELATING THE LACTATE CURVE TO THE HEART RATE
meters for exercise prescription in soccer. Helgerud et ai. (2007) demonstrated that Training zones are designed in modem TRIMP calculations based on [La-]b, oxygen
high-intensity aerobic training increased LT in soccer players. ln addition, Coyle uptake, and HR data. We can demonstrate this using the case discussed below
(1995) suggested that the prescription of appropriate exercise intensity is more (Fig. 9.4).
accurate when the blood lactate response to exercise is used. In this graph, the initial [La-]b levei is 2 mmol/L. The lactate level decreases in this
first phase due to the muscles working and lactate being actively processed. When
Blood lactate intensity starts to increase, lactate starts to accumulate.
[La-Jb
7 ./ Aerobic threshold:
- [La-]b: 2.5 mmol/L
6 -HR: 125bpm
-load: 12.1 km/h
s
Lactate threshold ./ Lactate threshold:
4
- [La-Jb: 4.3 mmol/L
3 -HR: 154 bpm
-load: 14.2 km/h
2

1
250 10
o 9
Time 200 r-~~~~~~~~~~~-zS;:-~,.

Fig. 9.2: Theoretica/ presentation of lactate accumulation in the musc/e


ÊCl. 7
e 150 1-~~~~~~~--:,,,.ic:.~-,,.L.:'._~~~~s

"'"'
Above the LT, lactate accumulation increases exponentially and can increase to ~ . 5
10-15 mrnol/L in soccer players (Reilly and Korkusuz, 2008). Regular high-inten- ~
100 1--~~~~,,..e-::_~~~--:'13/{-~~~~~~~-f4
sity physical activity results in a certain degree of mental toughness, enabling the
athlete to tolerate higher lactate values for longer. .
t:
"'
:e 50
flj
3

. 1
Blood lactate
[La-]b o 1-~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~--I· o
8 10 12 14 16 18
7 ""'lh-Heart rnte (bpm) 75 98 127 156 178 197
-::0-B!ood lactate [La-Jb 2,4 1,8 2,4 4 6,5 9,5
6
Shift in Jactate curve
s Fig. 9.4: Determining HR zones

3 This graph shows the results of an incremental exercise test (on a treadmill). The
player starts the test at 8 km/h and ends the test ata speed of 18 km/h. The graph
2
represents the lactate values, intensity (in km/h) and HR. The aerobic and lactate
1 threshold can be estimated using this graph. ln this example, the aerobic threshold
could be set at 4.3 mmol/L (154 bpm) and the intensity is 14.2 km/h.
o
Time

Fig. 9.3: Shift in the lactate curve. Training causes the lactate curve to shift for the sarne intensity.
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
154
1
Heart rate and GPS monitoring in soccer 155
Heart rate and GPS monitoring in soccer

9.7 INTERPRETING HR MEASUREMENT 9.8 EFFECT OF TRAINING ON HEART RATE ANO LACTATEACCUMULATION
There are also other factors that influence HR. Although this complicates the inter- Take the example of the soccer player we tested in preseason. We saw that his speed
pretation, knowledge of the factors set out below should enable coaches to correctly at LT was 14.2 km/h. We tested the sarne player again after two months of training
analyze training. The following factors can cause a small degree of variability in HR: (three weeks in-season). Fig. 9.6 and 9.7 show the values obtained.
Altitude: Because the barometric pressure of air is lower at altitude than at sea
level, the heart has to work harder to transport the sarne amount of oxygen to
the muscles. 14
Quantity of active muscle tissue: The more muscles that are used during physi-
cal activity, the higher the HR. Running therefore induces a higher HR than
'
. 12

10
,fi.
cycling (Millet et a!., 2009). 3 ~
Upper body/lower body: Physical activity using the arms results in a higher HR
~
8 _,.;;
compareci to isolated physical activity of the legs.
Ambient temperature and humidity: Temperature and humidity will affect
ro 6
,/
"
_,' ,
o
o 4
- --
- --
HR. As the ambient temperature rises or the air gets more humid, HR will gra- _.,,. ......
-
-----
dually increase throughout physical activity, even when maintaining the sarne 2
pace. Humidity reduces the effectiveness of sweating, resulting in increased
body temperature and a consequent increase in HR. o -1
8 10 12 14 16 18
Psychological stress: Stress affects the cardiovascular system. Psychological !~=-Testl 2,4 1,8 2,4 4 6,5 9,5
1
stress increases HR.
Medication or illness: HR is usually higher in cases of illness, and medication 1-"- Test 2 2,1 1,7 2 3,4 1 4,2 11,5

can also influence HR.


Eating: After a meal, HR increases to aid with digestion. More blood is directed Fig. 9.6: Effect oftraining on lactate accumulation
toward the gastrointestinal tract to process the food.
Cardiac drift: I-IR will gradually increase during physical exercise carried out at
a constant speed. This phenomenon is referred to as cardiac drift. 250
Age: HRmax decreases as people get older due to the physiological effects of
aging. 200
Dehydration and nutrition: Dehydration causes HR to rise as the blood volume Ê
decreases and the body runs low on the fluids needed to maintain body tem- e"-w 150
perature. Dehydration can occur in cold as well as hot environrnents. A lack of ~

~
glycogen also results in the sarne effect. t:
100
Gender: Women typically have a higher HR than men. ro
w
Caffeine-found in coffee, teas and some sodas-rnirnics the effect of adrena- :i:
50 "'
line, a natural horrnone in the body that is responsible for elevating HR. Other
stimulants, such as cocaine and ephedrine, work in a similar manner. o
8 10 12 14 16 18

Heart rate =-'di=Test 1 75 98 127 156 178 197


(bpm) -=é=-Test 2 70 84 118 146 165 197
200

180 Fig. 9. 7: Effect of training on HR

170

160 These two graphs show the progression after tvvo rnonths of training.
Fig. 9.5: Carc/iac drift. Although the The effects of training, compareci with the first test, were:
150 soccer p/ayer runs constantly at the • The player runs at the sarne speed (intensity) with a lower HRex.
same speed, HR slowly increases
over time and fluctuations are • [La-]b accumulation is lower for the sarne velocity.
140 '------------~
irregular. This phenomenon is known • Aerobic and lactate threshold have risen.
Time as carc/iac drift.
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
156 157
Heart rate and GPS monitoring ín soccer Heart rate and GPS monitoring in soccer

9.9 AUTONOMIC NERVOUS SYSTEM Measuring HRV provides an insight into the relationship between the sympathe-
The autonomic nervous system (ANS), also referred to as the vegetative nervous tic and the parasympathetic systems, which is important for, among other things,
system, regulates a number of bodily functions, such as respiration, digestion and development, diagnosis, and the prevention of overtraining, as well as for general
cardiac function. The ANS works autonomously and is therefore not consciously health. In common practice, HRr is monitored in order to detect overtraining. An
controlled. The ANS actually consists of tvvo systems, the sympathetic system (the increase of a few beats is, however, difficult to interpret because of the influence of
"fight or flight" system) and the parasympathetic system (the "rest and digest" numerous factors, such as circadian rhythms and mental stress.
system). The hvo systems complement each other, functioning alternately and in Anticipation of physical activity inhibits the activity of the vagus nerve and incre-
opposite directions and working closely together with the hormonal system. The ases sympathetic activity. The increase in sympathetic activity and the lowering of
sympathetic system is the body's gas pedal, as it were, enabling us to perforrn. parasympathetic activity cause the HR to rise. During physical activity, the vagai
Adrenaline levels, HR, blood pressure, and respiratory rate increase, and then the activity (and associated parasympathetic activity) diminishes and sympathetic acti-
body consumes more energy. The parasympathetic system can, in turn, be regar- vity increases. As players increase their physical fitness, a number of changes occur
ded as the brake. It is responsible for recovery, rest and energy replenishment. ln in the balance between the sympathetic and the parasympathetic nervous systems.
healthy athletes, the two systems are in balance, with moments of exercise (sympa- First of all, the parasympathetic system continues working for longer, meaning
thetic system) alternating with recovery moments (parasympathetic system). the HR will be lower for a corresponding intensity. However, the influence of the
Devices like iThlete, BioForce and OmegaWave are designed to measure the res- parasympathetic system also affects recovery. Finally, the parasympathetic system
ponse of the ANS. The functioning of this system is measured by way of ECG ensures that HRV remains high, even at higher intensity. A High HRV is, for this
readings of varying duration via appropriate software. HR readings also give an reason, a good value indicator of the preparedness of an athlete.
idea of the sympathetic/parasympathetic balance. The effects of the parasympathetic system in well-trained athletes are:
o The parasympathetic system continues working for longer in well-trained ath-
9.9.1 Heart rate variability (HRV) letes, resulting in an athlete's HR being lower for a similar intensity.
The development of technology in soccer has progressed very quickly over the last o HR will recover more quickly after physical activity because of increased func-
decade. These technological aids enable the coach to better evaluate the players' tioning of the parasympathetic system.
response to a given training load, as well as their fitness and freshness. Heart rate • HRV remains high during physical activity.
variability (HRV) is one of these means. HRV entails the non-invasive measuring of An imbalance in the equilibrium between load and load tolerance will shift the
the R-R intervals between two QRS intervals (heartbeats). These intervals can give ANS towards sympathetic dominance. This dominance can lead to exhaustion of
the coach an insight into the status of the ANS. the endocrine system. This depletion will then later lead to an excessive parasym-
pathetic dominance, especially when athletes are given insufficient opportunity for
9.9.2 Regulation of the hearl recovery.
HR is regulated by the sinus node, which is also referred to as the heart's "pace-
maker." This is a group of specialized cells located in the right atrium of the heart. 9.9.4 Use of heart rate to measure the functioning of the autonomic
The sinus node creates its own stimuli and is under the direct influence of the ANS. nervous system
ln the body, the regulation of the heart is extensively determined by the balance To make progress in soccer, periods of appropriate training have to be alternated
between the parasympathetic (enhanced vagal tone) and the sympathetic nervous with periods of recovery. If there is no balance between the two, players quickly
system. become either overtrained or detrained. Both of these scenarios have a negative
At rest, the sinus node produces around 100-120 impulses. However, these impul- effect on performance. The functioning of the ANS can be measured indirectly via
ses are influenced by parasympathetic function, resulting in HR falling to around the heart rate during exercise (HRex), heart rate recovery (HRR) and HRV. In gene-
55-70 bpm when resting. At rest, the body is almost entirely under the influence of ral, a decrease in submaximal HRex, an increase in HRR and increased vagal-re-
the parasympathetic nervous system, with the sympathetic nervous system taking lated HRV índices are all well-accepted markers of improved aerobic fitness
over when physical activity increases. What is remarkable in this regard is that the (Lamberts et al., 2009; Buchheit et al. 2012). On the other hand, opposite changes in
time interval behveen hvo heartbeats is very irregular (HRV) when resting, while these HR measures have been demonstrated to be indicators of impaired physical
the time interval during physical activity is more regular. performance (Achten and jeukendrup, 2003; Mujika, 2001; Bosque! et ai., 2008). As
previously mentioned, a lower HRex, faster HRR and greater HRV are all linked
9.9.3 The autonomic nervous system as a regulator for exertion and to improvements in fitness. To measure a player's fitness during the season, it is
recovery important that measurements can be carried out easily and inexpensively and do
HRV, a marker of parasympathetic activity, is an accepted term to describe variati- not require too much effort from the players.
ons in both instantaneous HR and RR-interval (Task Force of the European Society
of Cardiology and the North American Society of Pacing and Electrophysiology).
1ss I FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
Heart rate and GPS monitoring in soccer
159
Heart rate and GPS monitoring in soccer

9.9.4.1 HRex
predict a player's trainability. Additionally, baseline values of submaximal exercise
A low submaximal HR for the sarne exercise intensity is one of the most com- HR, HRR and post-exercise HRV measures obtained before the start of preseason
monly observed adaptations to endurance training {Andrew et al., 1966). ln a study moderately correlated with changes in most of the performance variables over the
on highly trained young handball players, a two-month high-intensity training entire season (i.e., cardiorespiratory but also neuromuscular-related performan-
intervention induced a 5% decrease in HRex and I0-20~'o increases in HRR and ces), which suggests these measures could be of interest for player screening.
post-exercise HRV (Buchheit etal., 2008).

9.9.4.2 HRV as an indicator of fatigue and recovery 9.10 EXAMPLES OF HEART RATE INTERPRETATION
Overtraining and extraneous stressors can induce changes in the functioning of
the ANS (Lehman, 1993). HRV can be used to measure the balance between sym-
pathetic and parasympathetic activity. Marsland et al. (2007) were some of the first
to demonsh·ate the relationship between parasympathetic dominance and lo\ver
cytokine levels and reduced inflammation. A larger stroke volume and an incre-
ased parasympathetic response have been suggested to induce changes in the HRV
observed within 24-48hours after exercise {Buchheit etal., 2009).
A relationship clearly exists behveen recovery after exercise and the endocrine and
immune responses of the body. Research has shown, for example, that excessively
long sympathetic dominance goes hand in hand with muscle injuries, while redu-
ced vagal activity (parasympathetic activity) of the heart is associated with illness
and risk of sudden death. Astate of detraining, as well as fatigue, is associated with
a lo\vering of HRV. This often manifests itself in illness or symptoms of overload.
Low HRV can therefore predict possible illnesses or diseases. HRV can be low prior
to an illness, which means it could be a good indicator for detecting high levels of
fatigue or exhaustion. What is also striking is that top athletes have fewer fluctua-
tions in their HRV than less-gifted athletes, probably because they are accustomed
Fig. 9.8: The graph above represents four p/ayers performing an aerobic fitness test.
to dealing with higher training loads.
Another interesting finding in a study by Buchheit (2009) was that following CWI
(cold-water immersion), the parasympathetic system was reactivated after supra- The graph above represents four players performing an aerobic fitness test. The
maximal intensity. The researchers suggested that CWI was effective in resetting black and white lines represent two fast wingers with IO'\V aerobic fitness and
the ANS. Massage may have a similar effect, and research has indeed shown that V~~\max of less than 60 ml/kg/ min. The light gray line represents a midfield player
HRV and the parasympathetic system improved after massage (Tritton, 1993). \VIth a V02 max of 67 ml/kg/min and excellent aerobic fitness.
The dark gray line is an experienced midfield player who has already played at
9.9.4.3 Heart rate recovery (HRR) the top level for several years. He has a V0 2rnax of 63 ml/kg/min. ln the first round
Although both HRV and HRR provide useful information concerning the balance (\varm up), all players run together at the sarne speed. The "black" and "white"
in the ANS, the two have different origins. An increase in the vagal tone, because players have higher relative heart rates (as a percentage of HRmnJ than the "dark
of the reduction in sympathetic activity, is shown during the first few minutes after gray" and "light gray" players. This could possibly be dueto a higher HR at lactate
physical activity. Because HRV recovery (recovery from high HRV) is caused by threshold. The fact that the HR of both the black and white players increase \vhile
the functioning of the vagus nerve and HRR is caused by the discontinuation of the heart rates of the light gray and dark gray players stay relatively stable could
sympathetic activity, results can differ betvveen HRR and HRV recovery. Recent indicate that those players have a weaker fitness. This is confirmed by their HRR,
research has shown that V0 2max is correlated to HRR but not to HRV. Although which is slower than those of the light gray and dark gray players. The aerobic fit-
both indicate a good fitness level, they have different origins and can differ for this ness test starts after five minutes of recovery. The aim of the test is to finish the lap
reason. as fast as possible (maximal test). The light gray player is the fírst to finish the test,
ln an interesting study, Buchheit et al. (2012) monitored changes in physical per- \Vhile the black and white players finish together and the dark gray player comes
formance with HR n1easures in young soccer players. They found that substantial in last. Without HR figures, it could be concluded that the dark gray player is notas
improvements in submaximal HRex (but not HRR) are híghly predictive of impro- fit. However, it is clear that this player did not perform a maximal test. His HR
vements in maximal aerobic speed. Conversely, changes in HRR were moderately does not rise above 90%. The light gray player has also run a submaximal test. Ht~
associated with changes in repeated sprint performance. The researchers postu- aerobic endurance is, however, better than that of the dark gray player, \Vhich is
lated that the magnitude of the associations observed were too low to accurately why he covers the distance faster. The black and white players both performed a
FITNESS IN SOCCER
1 FITN ESS 1N SOCCER Heart rate and GPS monitoring ín soccer 1161
160 Heart rate and GPS monitoring in soccer

maximal test. Their time, however, is less than that of the light gray player because
of their lower leveis of fitness. It is noticeable that increasing fatigue also causes the
HR to rise as the distance covered increases. The interpretation of the recovery is
also interesting. The light gray player, with a high V0 2 max anda high level of aerobic
endurance, recovers substantially quicker than the other players. The recovery of
the two fast wingers (white and black lines) is slower, and after 7-8 minutes, their
HRs have sti11 not fallen below 60% of their maximum HRs.

'' ' 169 bpm


HRM!lX 182bpm
-20bpm ·!!3bpm
R11COVfliyOO"
HBLoa:I
" " Fig. 9.10: Training session with a 15-minute warm up, ending with a sprint exercise. A passing
exercise is then done for 15'. Fina/ly six games of 4v4 + K are played for 5' with 2' rest.

"'
The white player is a central defender with considerable experience (31 years old)
and average fitness. The gray player (24 years of age) is a (fast) striker with a VO 2m~x
of 56 ml/kg/min and low aerobic fitness. The black player is a relatively young (23
'i years of age) midfielder with a lot of potential. He trains hard and has a high VO 2mnx
of 65ml /kg I min.
What is immediately striking in the graphs is the high HR of the gray player. He
reaches a higher HRmnx than in the laboratory tests conducted before the start of
preseason. This is not uncommon. Also striking are the lower HR values of the
white player. His interna! training load is lower compared to the other hvo players.
This could mean that his (tactical) position in the SSGs was not demanding enough,
or he was possibly playing the SSGs submaximally. This is seen more often in older
professional players, \vho avoid exerting themselves maximally in the week so as
to be fresh at the start of the next match. The black line represents a player who
commits himself fully and recovers very well during the breaks. However, the SSGs
are less demanding (a lower internai training load) for him than for the gray player.
When calculating the training load of this session for the three players, the white
player will have the lowest load, the gray player will have the highest training load,
\Vhile the black player will have a lower training load than the gray player because
of his high aerobic fitness. It is therefore possible to give the white player an additi-
onal load (exercise) after the session because of the submaximal training. The black
Fig. 9.9: Example of a submaximal Yo-Yo /SRT test for a Dutch international p/ayer.
player can also be prescribed an additional exercise because the external load was
too low for his fitness levei.
The player was tested at the beginning of the season and again after a few weeks
in preseason (Figure 9.9). The player's HR is distinctly lower for the sarne intensity
(HRex}. This demonstrates an increased physical fitness and increased parasym- 9.11 GPS MONITORING
pathetic dominance. This results in a reduced TRIMPavg as an indicator of lower Global Positioning Systems (GPS) are now more widely utilized by coaches as a
mean HRex. Recovery after completion of the submaximal test is also quicker after means of quantifying the physical workload of players, so they can optimize the
measurement of training sessions within the athlete monitoring system. GPS can
a few weeks of training. This confirms the improvement in fitness.
no\v be used to "individualize" training loads within the sarne team. With the addi-
tion of RPE and/or HR readings (Impellizzeri, 2005}, this GPS data can be used to
better quantify the individual load (mechanical load), but it can also be compared
to the individual response to that load (internai load). Such information derived
lGZ 1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
Heart rate and GPS monitoring in soccer Heart rate and GPS monitoring in soccer 16 3

from GPS also allows coaches to view the breakdown of different exercises in arder Playerload
to optimize a periodized plan and prevent overtraining (and undertraining).

GPS technology and its associated software are now able to provide a coach or
sports scientist \Vith a myriad of metrics and variables. Currently, companies like
Catapult and GPSports have also integrated accelerometers into their GPS units,
with the aim of increasing the validity and reliability of the data acquired from
their technologies. The last ten years have seen major advancements from the less
accurate 1 Hz and 5 Hz units to the increased sampling rates now provided by the
newer 10 Hz and 15 Hz systems.

9.11.1 Reliability and Validity


ln the past few years, research has focused on assessing the reliability and vali-
dity of GPS monitoring (Buchheit, 2013). Most research has found that the newer
10 Hz units with upgraded firmvvare and increased sampling rates have further
improved accuracy and inter-unit reliability (Johnson et al., 2013). While it could be
argued that older 1 Hz and 5 H~ GPS models were valid for longer distances, total
distance, and slower speeds (although not changes of directions) (Jennings et al.,
2010), the latest GPS hardware (10 Hz) has been shown to be six times more accu-
rate at measuring instantaneous velocity than the previous 5 Hz models (Varley et
al., 2011). Fig. 9.11: P/ayer Load gives an indicaüon of an athlete's total workload. lt includes distances and
accelerations/decelerations, as well as changes of direclion. There is a clear difference between the
total /oad in training weeks with one game (W17, W19 (for A-team p/ayers) and W22), two games
(W18 and W20) orno game at ali due to the intemational ca/endar (W21 ).
9.11.2 Traditional GPS Metrics
As the current GPS technology advances, sports scientists also advance the types of D!st<mce HIR {>20km/h)
metrics that are used to quantify performance. Currently, when looking at the cur- ,.
rent research Oohnston, 2013), the performance metrics examined are:

0 Total distance covered


0 Meters / min
• High-speed distance covered
0 Player Load (accelerometry-based)
0 Very-high-speed running
• RHIE (repeat high-intensity efforts)
0 RSE (repeat sprint efforts)
0 Time or distance spent \vithin different velocity bands

Aughey et al. (2013) have also used GPS monitoring during friendly matches and
compareci the physical data from these matches against other football codes, such
as rugby and Australian Rules Football, to create a unique perspective into the exact
physiological \VOrkload required of a soccer player relative to other sports. This
research seems to support the increased importance of RHIE (repeated high-inten-
sity effort) rather than RSE (repeated speed effort) by including accelerations, dece-
lerations and collisions into the equation as high-intensity activities.
Fig. 9. 12: ln weeks with a midweek game, recovery has priority, and little orno Hl-running is
included in training sessions. W21 was a non-game week dueto the international calendar, giving
the opportunity for a high Hl-running training load.
164
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Heart rate and GPS monitoring in soccer
l lGS
Heart rate and GPS monitoring in soccer

9.11.3 Metabolic Power


Playcrlo::id
=I A recent development in the area of training load quantification with GPS techno-
logy has been the work into metabolic power carried out by Osgnach (2010) and
=I
;;rol
di Prampero (2008). The metabolic power approach to training load quantification
begins to view the physiological demand of training sessions from a perspective
of power output and energetic cost. It is measured in W /kg rather than the tradi-
'"""! _ _
'
tional work performed at different velocities. When comparing different exercises
measured with "total power" metrics and "total speed" metrics, Gaudino et al.
·~I (2013) found that coaches and sports scientists underestimated training load when
assessing the load just from a velocity perspective. As a result, many GPS compa-
'~" 1-., nies are now trying to implement this "metabolic power" metric into their software

r
for future clients. Some researchers seem to believe that, in the future, metabolic
power metrics may provide a more valid measurement of the true loads required
in drills such as small-sided game play, such as 3v3 and 5v5. The other advantage
of the metabolic power metric is that it seems to be more sensitive to positional dif-
• I <v _ o~ ' <v ,.~ ferences within such games. According to Gaudino and colleagues, the workloads
-....,.,,.,.,,""'"""' ~-\."+~;"'~:~'º i w:::"'""'~:!'" w,•;:,,,""'f~:' w,~,~V>.' ......'0' ' w:;;.~uln'",':}," 1w';;';:'"""";~':": of central defenders in particular tend to be underestimated with the use of tradi-
'~-~~'f'c!,.,,,..,.t":"!'.
?'! '"' -,- .,, •to
10Õ .,,- ' 4l0
=·'°·~~·-~~~·~cc·~'~~~~·~~~~"·--.-~=- ~.:~--~~-~~=~~ :- -,- ---,---- -----,
i -·,,, - @ - 1'1
----~-~,--
ON

tional GPS and velocity-based metrics.

Distante HlR {>20km/h)

SUMMARY
It is of great importance to measure the training load of soccer training. Internai
load can be rneasured through the use of HR monitors. Resting HR, the HRex,
HRR, and HRV are tools that can be used to help track the fitness status of the
players. GPS technology can be used to measure the external, mechanical load
of training sessions. Information gleaned frorn GPS <levices also allows coaches
to rneasure rnetrics, such as nurnber of accelerations and high-intensity distance
covered, in order to optimize a periodized plan to prevent over- and undertrai-
ning. Training load rnonitoring is discussed in more detail in the following
chapter.

Fig. 9.13 & 9.14: A comparison between two A-team players: a winger (VA) anda central defender
(CA). A cfear difference is seen in externai foad between lhe playing positions, with lhe most
obvious difference in distances covered at high speed (Hf running). This is one ofthe main reasons
for the difference in P/ayer Load between both p/ayers. These differences in Z4 and HI running (and
consequently P/ayer Load) are mainly dueto position-specific games like 11v11, 9v9, 7v7. These
differences are seen /ess in SSGs (5v5, 4v4, 3s3) and other dril/s fike passing and warming up.
1661 FITNESS IN SOCCER
Heart rate and GPS monitoring in soccer
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Training load monitoring in soccer 1167

REf ERENCES
Achlen,J. and jcukcndrup, A.E., 2003. Hcarl rate monitorini;: applic.itions and limilíltiono.Sports Medicine, 33(7), pp-517-538.
Andrew, G.M., Gu~man, C.A. and Bcckfokc, M.R., 1966. Effoct of alhletk training on cxcn:ioc cardfoc output. J ApplPhysio!, 21,
pp.603-600.
Bosque!, L, Mcrbri, S., Arvisai~, D. and Aubcrt, A.E., 20!IB. ls hcart rate a convenicnt too! to monitor ovcr-rcnching? AsyslcmMic rcvicw
1
of lhe litcraturc. Br J Sports Mcd, ·12, pp.709-71-1.
Brooks, G.A., 1998. Mammalian fucl utili«.1tion during "u~taincd cxcrcisc. Comp Biachem Physiol, 120, pp.89-107.
Brooh, G.A., 2007. Link l>etwccn glycolytk and oxidativc mctaholism. Sports Mcd, 37, pp.341-343.
Bruce, R.A., l'ishcr, L.D., Coopcr, M.N. and Ú!'<'Y, G.O., 197·1. ScpMationof cffectsof cardiovascular d;s,,ase and age on vcntricufar func-
tion with maximal excrcisc. Am.J. Cardiol., 34(7), pp.757-763.
Buchhcit, M., Al Haddad, H,, Simpson, B.M., Pala:.zi, D., Bourdon, P.C., Oi Salvo, V. and Mcndcz-Villanucva A., 2013. MoniloringAccc-
!crations Wilh GPS in Football; Time toSlow Down? !ntcmntional Jouma\ ofSports Physiology and Performance, 3{).
Buchheit M., Millct G.P., Parfoy A., Pour<:hcz S., Laurscn P.B. and Ahmaidi S., 200$. Supramaximal trnining and post-e~crcise parasym-
TRAINING LOAD
palhetk rcactivation in adolcsccnts. Mcd. Sci. Sports &crc., ·10, pp.362-371.
Buchheit, M., Laur.mn, P.B., Al Hnddad, H. nnd Ahmaidi, S., 2009. &crcisc-induccd plasma volume cxpansion and poot-e~ercisc
p~ro.sympalhctk reactivntion. Eur.J. Appl. Phy,iol., 105, pp.471-481.
MONITORING IN SOCCER
Buchhci!, M., Simpson, M.B., Al Haddad, H., Dourdon, r.c. and Mcndez-Vlllanucva, A., 2012. Monitoring changes in phy"kal pcrfor- lbrahim AkubatJ Jan Van Winckel
manrewilh hcart rate mcasun.-s in young ~0<:ccr plnycrs. Eurol"'anJoumal Of Applicd Physiology, 112(2), pp.711-723.
Buchhcit, M., Peilfcr,J.J.,Abbiso, C.R. and Laursm, r.B., 2009. Effcct of cold watcr immcrnion on postcxcrcise paranympalhctic rcactivil-
tion. Am. J. Physio!. Hcart Clr<:. Physiol., 296(2), pp.421-7.
lludge!~ R., 1998. Fatigue and undcrpcrformancc in athlcles: the ovcrtrainingsyndromc. Br J Sports MOO, 32, pp.107-110.
Convcrtino, V.A., 1991. Blood volume: its adaptation tocndurancc training. Mcd Sci Sports Exerc, 23, pp.1338-13.JS.
Coylc, E.F., 1995. lnlegration of lhe physiological factor5 detcrmining cndurancc performance ability. &en:. Sport Sci. Rcv., 23, pp.25-63.
Dmadni, ll.S., Gomidc, E.B.G. and Greco, C.C., 2005. Thc r<!blioMhip bctwcm onset ofblood !acta!e accumulation, criticai vclocit;~ and
maximal lacta te stcady ~tale in wccer playcrs.J.Strenglh Cond. Rcs., 19(2), pp.36-1-368.
di Prampero, P.E., Fusi, S., Sepulcri, L., Morin, J.B., llclli, A. and Antonutto, G., 2005. Sprint running: a ncw energetic approach. J Exp
Biol, 203, pp.2809-2816.
Gaudim>, P., !aia, F.M., Albcrti, G., Hawkins, R.D., Strudwick, A.J. and Gregwn, W., 2013. Systcmatk Bias bctwecn Running SpcOO and
Mctabolic Power Data in ElitcSocccrP!aycrs: lnílucncc ofDrill l}'pc. !ntJ Sports Med: DO! 10.1055/s-0033-1355-118.
Hed;, H., Mader, A., Hem;, G., Mucke, S., Muller, R., and Hollmann, W., 1985.Juslifimtionofthc·I mmol/Lloctatcthrcshold. lnt.J.Sports
Mcd., 6, pp.117-13{).
Hclgcrud, J., Hoydal, K., Wang. E., Karl5cn, T., llcrg, P., Bjcrk.lru;, M., Simonscn, T.. Hclgescn, C., Hjorlh, N., llach, R. and Hoff, J., 2007.
Acroblc high-inlensity inlcrvals improve V02max mor<! than moduatc training. Medicine and Scicncc in Sports and Excrdsc, 39 (·1),
665-71.
lmpdlizzcri, F.M., fülmpinini, E. and Man:ora S.M., 2005. Physiological ru;sL"".,smcnt of acrobic training in socrer. joumal of Sports Sd-
cncc-s, 23(6), pp.SSJ...592.
Jcnning,;, D., Cormack, S., Coute:, A.J., Boyd, L. nnd Aughcy, R.j., 2010. Thc Validity and Rcliílbility of Gp;; Units for Mc:tSuring Dio!anre
in Tcnm Spor! Spcdfic Running Pa!tcms. ln!cmationnl)oumal ofSports Physlology and Pcrformnn<:>!, 5, pp.32s-341.
johruton, R.J, Wawford, M.L, Pinc, M./, Spun:s, R.W andSporri, D., 2013. Aso.,,;umcnt ofS H~ and 10 Hz GPS units formN~uringalhlclc
movcmcnt dcmands. Jntcmntional Joumnl of Pcrform;mcc Anulysis in Sport, 13, pp.262-27·1.
Jonc'!', A.M. and Dous!, J.H, 1~3. Thc validity of thc lnctntc minimum test for dctcrmination of thc maximal of thc milXimal lnctatc 10.1 INTRODUCTION
s!cJdy s!ntc. Mcd. Sci. Sporls Excrc, 30, pp.130-1-1313.
Kingslcj~ M., l.<!wL•, M.J. and Maroon, R.E., 2005. Comparison of Polnr lllOs and an nmbulntory ECG 5yslcm for RR intcrval mc,,urumcnt Examining the training process is essential to understanding why we measure
during progreesivc cxcrcisc. lnlcmalionnl Joumal ofSports Medicine, 26(1), pp.39--~l.
L1mbcr!5, R.P. and l.:imberL M.I., 2009. Day·to·day vuriation in hcnrt rale at difforunt leveis of sub maximal cxcrlion: implications for training load. By measuring the training load, we are looking for a dose-response
monitoring trainlng. J Stnmglh Cond Rcs, 23, pp.100:;-1010.
Lchmnnn, M., Fosler, C. and Kcu~). 1993. Overlrainingand endumnce nthlctes: a brief rcvicw. Mcd SciSports Excrc, 25(7), pp.S5·1-(;i2. relationship with the outcome parameter. The dose, or the training load, is the pre-
Londc=, D.R. ;md Moeschbcr&cr, M.L., 1932. Effcct of age nnd olhcr foctors on maximal hcart rate. Res Quarter Exen: Sport, 53(·1),
pp.297-30-1.
scribed exercise, and the response of interest in soccer is the associated fitness gain,
Marolnnd, A.L., Giannros, P.J., Prathcr, A.A., jcnningo, j.R., Ncumnnn, S.A. nnd Manuck, S.ll., 2007. Stimulutcd production of pro-inflam-
mntory cytokines covaries invc,.,,dy wilh hcnrt rale varinbility. Psychosom Mcd., 69, pp.m9-716.
fatigue accrued or injury risk. Examining the dose-response relationship in this
Millct, G.P., Vlcck, V.E. nnd BentlC)\ D.j., 2009. Ph)"'iologic.il difforenres bctwcm cydinB nnd running: lc=ns from trialhlcles. Sports manner allows us to improve our knowledge of ho\V a player might respond to a
Mcd., 39(3), pp.179-206.
Moxncs, J.F. and Hauskcn, K., 2009. A mathcmnlica! modcl for thc training impulse and loctnlc inílux nnd outfiux during excrdsc. lnt J particular training dose. We can also become more proactive in future when mani-
Mod Phys C, 20(1), pp.J.17-177.
Moxn<>r.. J.F., H~uskcn, K. and Sandbakk, 0., 2012. On thc kinctic; of anacrobic powcr. Thcorutical Diology and Medical Modclling. 9(29). pulating the dose, rather than merely reacting to the response. This may help us
Mujib, !. and Padifü, S., 2001. Cardio~piralory and mctabolic ch11roctcristic; of detr11ining ín humans. Mcd Sei Sporls Excrc, 33,
pp.413--121.
to produce desirable responses, such as fitness gain, or prevent undesirable res-
OoBnach, C., !'o5cr, S., llcmardini, R., Rinaldo, R. and di Pr11mpcro, P.E., 2010. Enorgy coot nnd mct11bolic powcr ln elite srn:""r: a new
m11tch 11n11lysis11pproach. Mcd Sci Sports &crc, 42, pp.170-178.
ponses, such as injury. The dose-response relationship is deemed by the American
Picho~ V., Rochc, F. and G:tSpoz, J.M., 2000. Rc!ation bctwcm hc1lrt ;ate variability and training load in middl,,..distunre runneru. Med
Sci Sport; Excrc, 32(10). pp.01729-36.
College of Sports Medicine to be a fundamental principie of training. It has also
Poole, D.C., Ward, S.1\., Gardncr, G.W. and Whipp, D./., 1988. A mctnbolic and rcspir11lory profile of thc Upp<.'r Jimit for prolonged excrdsc been suggested (Banister, 1991; Manzi et al., 2009) that a valid measure of training
in man. fagonomics,31, pp.1265-12i9.
Reill}~ T. nnd Korkusuz, F., 2003. Sciencc and Footba!I: Thc Proc...>Cdings of thc Sixth World Congf<!ss on Scicncc and Football: v.6. Lon- load should show a dose-response relationship with the training outcome. The trai-
don: Tdylor Fr«ncis.
Robe'!>", R.A. and Landwchr, R., 2002. The Surprising Hislory of lhe "Hrmax~22.0·Agc" Equation.Joumal of Excrcioe Phyoiology, 5(2), ning outcome is usually measured periodically using an assortment of fitness tests,
pp.1-10.
Robson-Anslcy, P.J., Glceson, M. nnd Ansley, L., 2009. Fatigue managcmcnt in lhe pr<!paration of Olympic athlctes. Jouma! of Sport; performance parameters and injury records. So, why is the dose-response relati-
Scicnccs., 27(13), pp.1409-1420.
Schúnfcldcr, M., Hintcr:;chcr, G., Pctcr, P. and SpltzcnpfeH, P., 2011. Scientlílc Comp.1rison of Diffcr<!nt Online Hem! Rale Monitoring
onship so important to soccer coaches? We generally react to a response, whether
Systcm.•, ln! J Telemcd Appl., vol. 2011, Artide !D 631!148, 6 pages. doi:l0.1155/2011/ 6318-18.
Slegmann, H., Kindermann, W. and Schnabcl, A., 1981. L1ctatc kinctic; and individual anacroblc thrcshold. !nt. J. Sports Mcd., 2,
it be an injury ora fitness test score. Given that we want to avoid both injuries and
pp.160-165. frequent fitness testing, which may be impractical due to time constraints, under-
Swninct ai., 1994. Targct HR for thc dcvclopmcnt of QI fitncss. Medicine & Scicncc in Sports &. E><en:isc, 26(1), pp.112-116.
Tnnnb, H., Monahan, K.G. and Sca!s, D.S., 2001. Agc-predictcd maximal hc.1rt rale revisitcd.J Am Col! Cardiol, 37, pp.153-166. standing the response to a given dose enables us to be proactive in achieving our
Task Force of thc Europc«n Society of Cardiology and thc North Amcrican Society of Pacing and Elcctrophysiology, 1996. Heart rote
vnriability: ~tandards oi mco.suremcnt, physiological inlcrprctation and clinica! use, 93(5), ppJl).B-65. aims as coaches. Understanding the training process is essential to understanding
Tritton, B., 1993. M=agc and Mrothcropy. Abbotsford, Vk.:TAFE Publkations.
which measurements of training load will show good dose~response relationships.
lGS I FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
Traíning /oad monitoring in saccer Training load monitoring in soccer l69

10.2 THE TRAINING PROCESS ln this chapter, the methods used to examine both internai and externai loads will
The training process has been conceptualized quite nicely by Impellizerri and col- be explored and their validity assessed. Furthermore, in a practical or applied
leagues (Impellizzeri, Rampinini and Marcora, 2005). Figure 10.1 below shows h?w environment, certain factors may influence 1vhich methods you can and cannot
both the prescribed training and the characteristics of the individual (e.g., genehcs, apply, perhaps because of cost, time or practicality. This will also be summarized
training status, etc.) combine to form the intemal training load. for each method. The decision of whether a method is worth the associated cost
and time is one for individuais to make based on their available resources, but the
---------TRAININGPROCF.SS---------...._ decision should also be governed by the validity of each method. This chapter aims

Individual
r-- Extemal
training load
Quality and quantity
j.
Organization
to help coaches and practitioners decipher all these details and help them in a soc-
cer-related setting.

characteristics
10.3 INTERNAL LOAD

10.3.1 Banister's TRIMP


INTERNAL Banister et al. (1975) were among the first to pursue a single value to represent the
TRAINING LOAD
Physiological
training load or training impulse (TRIMP). Banister originally proposed a three-
Assessmcnt zone model where exercise was categorized as being of a low, moderate or high
TRAINING intensity, and each of these zones was weighted by 1, 2 or 3 respectively. However,
OUTCOl\.IE the TRIMP method developed later by Banister (1991) is 'ividely used today, and
this is based on HR and a modelled blood lactate response to increasing exercise
intensity. Banisters TRIMP takes into consideration the intensity of exercise, 'ivhich
Fig. 10.1: The Training Process (fmpelfizerri et ai., 2005)
is calculated from the heart rate reserve method and the duration of exercise. The
mean HR for the training session is weighted according to the relationship between
HR and blood lactate observed during incremental exercise, which is then multi-
This is best explained with the example of two men of differing fitness levels run- plied by the session duration.
ning a 10 km race at the sarne pace and both finishing at the sarne time. The fit- TRIMP is calculated using the following formula:
ter man would find this less demanding inte1nally, and an analysis of his heart
rate (HR) data would show it to be lower than the other man's. ln a soccer-related txLIHRxy
setting, this would also mean that players running the sarne distance would only
show the sarne response if their personal characteristics were exactly the sarne, but Where:
this scenario is highly unlikely. Therefore, as the model shows, it is ultimately the
internai training load that acts as the stimulus for training adaptation. Measuring t = duration (minutes)
training load is particularly difficult in sports such as soccer, because different exer- L.\HR = fractional elevation in HR or HR reserve
cise designs lead to different physiological and mechanical demands, and there are y = weighting factor
inter-individual responses to the prescribed exercise (Bangsbo, Mohr and Krus-
trup, 2006). The .6..HR is weighted in such a manner that it reflects the intensity of effort and
guards against placing disproportionate importance on longer durations of low-in-
The measurement of training load is often described as either internai ar externa!. tensity exercise when compared with high-intensity exercise. The multiplying fac-
Internai training load monitoring is usually based on HR or the rating of perceived tor (y) weights the L.\HR according to the classically described increase in blood
exertion (RPE), and is often calculated with the integration of time, intensity and lactate in trained male and female subjects.
a weighting factor. lntensity has been measured objectively using HR due to its Banister used the TRIMP to model endurance performance when he used it to
linear relationship with oxygen consumption (Bot and Hollander, 2000), which is measure training load, and from this he modelled the dose-response relationships
widely regarded as the gold standard for measuring exercise intensity (Thompson., with fitness and fatigue. Banister theorized that each training bout produced both
2010). Consequently, it seems appropriate to use HR as a measure of intensity and a fatigue and a fitness impulse, \Vith fatigue decaying three times faster than fit-
internal load. In recent years., the development of automated camera tracking sys- ness, providing training adaptation and enhancing performance. Performance at
tems., GPS and accelerometers has also brought forward the measurement of exter- any given point is a result of the fitness leve! minus the accrued fatigue. Morton
nai training loads. These measurements of external load provide us with another et al. (1990) modelled the endurance performance of two athletes using Banister's
tool for measuring the training load of soccer players. TRIMP, and the results gave credence to Banister's TRIMP for endurance events.
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1

º
17 1 Training load monitoring in soccer Training load monitoring in soccer 171

The modelling conducted to date has focused on endi.trance athletes with long trai- ber of methods that have tried to validate themselves through their relationship to
ning schedules. These athletes may need to optimize performance for competition this method. This has been dane on the basis that HR is a valid measure of intensity
periods ranging from a single day (e.g., a marathon) to a few weeks (e.g., a cycling (Bot and Hollander, 2000), but where intensity is only one term in the equation for
tour). The modelling of performance in endurance sports (Morton, 1990) somewhat training load (with the others being time anda weighting factor).
validated Banister's TRIMP, but the modelling process has been subject to modifi- On the other hand, there is evidence to support the use of generic high-intensity
cations (Busso, 2003) to improve predictions. thresholds. Castagna et al. (2011) showed a dose-response relationship between
There are two major limitations when using Banister's TRIMP in intermittent team the time spent above 90% HRm~x and changes in fitness. Although useful, using
sports like soccer. Firstly, the use of mean HR may not reflect the fluctuations in such approaches exclusively risks ignoring the training load accrued from training
HR that occur during intermittent exercise. The mean exercise intensity in soccer below the threshold and the remaining intensity continuum. This could mean that
matches has been widely reported to be around the anaerobic threshold at 85% of vital load information is being missed, and this could make the difference between
HRm"x (Stolen et ai., 2005), but it has also been reported to peak at close to HRm"x fitness and injury.
(Ascensao et al., 2008). Secondly, the use of generic equations for males and fema-
les implies that gender is the only differing factor in athletes, and this doesn't take Costs: HR 1nonitors.
into consideration the individual differences that affect training load, such as those Practicalities: Usually rveightings and zones can be set in the software provided rvith
implied by the model of Impellizzeri et al. (2005). the hardware, so calculation is relatively easy. Availability of 1natch data is again a
proble111 at senior leveis.
Associated Costs: HR rnonitors.
Practicalities: Easy to calcula te once correct data has been identified and dorvnloaded,
and tlie formula is the sarne for each player. Software can also perfonn thís calcula- 10.3.3 Lucia's TRIMP
tion. The availability of 1natch data 1nay be a proble111 at se11ior leveis, because HR Lucia et al. (2003) based their measure of training load around the first and second
1nonitors may not be tvorn. It is, 1wivever, useful at all other levels. ventilatory thresholds (VTl & VT2). The rnethod provides three zones: low (below
VTl), rnoderate (between VTl and VT2) and high (above VT2). Each zone is given
a coefficient of 1, 2 and 3, respectively. The time spent in each zone is multiplied
10.3.2 Edwards' TRIMP by the relevant coefficient and sumrnated to provide a TRIMP score. However, like
Edwards (1993) proposed a zone-based method for the calculation of training load. with Edwards (1993), the weightings are not based on any scientific evidence and/
The time spent in five predefined arbitrary zones is multiplied by arbitrary coeffi- or physiological data. Earlier \Vork by Banister et al. (1975) with swimmers used
cients to quantify training load. The proposed zones are based on HRm"x with 10% the sarne weighting coefficients (1, 2 and 3) for low-, moderate- and high-intensity
zone ranges, and the corresponding coefficients can be seen in Table 10.1. work, but, as previously mentioned, he later changed his approach and based the
\Veighting on the blood lacta te response instead. This sort of weighting irnplies that
high-intensity exercise is three times as demanding as low-intensity exercise.
HR Zone {o/o HRmo.l Weighting Factor Lucia et al. (2003) used this method to successfully compare the training load distri-
bution for two different cycling tours, and they reported no significant differences
50-60% 1 in the calculated training load for the two tours (the Vuelta a Espafia and the Tour
60-70% 2 de France). Training using this three-zone model in endurance sports has received
some attention (Esteve-Lanao et al., 2007; Seiler and Tonnessen, 2009), giving the
70-80% 3
method credibility because of its use in elite settings. Seiler described polarized
80-90% 4 training methods, popular with endurance athletes, where around 80% of their trai-
90-100% 5 ning time is spent in zone 1 (<VTl). The metabolic thresholds used to identify the
zones have shown to relate well to endurance performance (Amann et al., 2006),
Tabfe 10.1: HR weightings proposed by Edwards (1993). but the weightings remain arbitrary. This system appears to be best used by moni-
toring the time in each zone and the distribution in competition and training. This
This method gained popularity as the default setting on a popular HR system. certainly does not mean that a universal score from the associated coefficients is
However, the coefficients lack any physiological underpinning, and the zone limits valid. Furthermore, the weighting of each zone implies that the training adaptation
remain predefined and lack metabolic or physiological performance thresholds. \vould be the sarne regardless of where in the zone an athlete trained. For example,
These zones and weightings imply that the training adaptation in zone 5 is five say the threshold for VT2 is identified at 85% of HR . Now, a training session
times greater than in zone 1, but no study to date has proven this to be the case. The with an intensity of 95% of HRm~~ would be given the s~~e weighting as a training
weightings used by Edwards (1993) are not validated through a relationship with a session at 85% of HRm~x' yet it would be weighted differently if the athlete trained
known physiological response. Throughout this chapter, we will encounter a num- at84%.
in I FITNESS IN SOCCER
FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
Training load monitoring in soccer 173
Training Joad monitoring in soccer

of Stagno rather than the mean HR method used by Banister. The difference has,
The shtdy of Denadai et al. (2006) showed how a 5% difference in training intensity however, been shown to be significant for a single exercise bout (Akubat, 2009).
(95% velocity at maximum aerobic power (vV0 2mnJ vs. lOO%vV02m") produced The zones used by Stagno were based on the HR at LT (defined as 1.5 mmol/L),
different training adaptations. For this reason, the use of any zoning method is and OBLA (defined as 4 mmol/L). They used the blood lactate responses at four
questionable. Impellizerri et ai. (2005) did demonstrate that train_ing above and different speeds from their player sample to create an equation for the weightings
below such thresholds may produce differing training responses in soccer play- (the y value defined by Banister). Zones 2 and 4 were created around the mean
ers althouah the threshold was based on an arbitrary lactate value. However, HR at LT and OBLA. A zone width of 7% fractional elevation was formed at these
m~nitoringjust high-intensity activity in isolation means that the accrued trainin? points. Zones 1, 3 and 5 were then created around zones 2 and 4. The prerequisite
Ioad from Iower intensity activity could end up being ignored. To date, no tra1- for using this method was that the HR at LT and OBLA for ali players fell within
ning study on Lucia's method has been conducted to validate that it demonstrates the created zones. However, the use of zones also has the limitation of awarding
dose-response relationships in soccer. the sarne weighting to exercise spanning the whole zone. For example, if a zone
spanning 70-80% of HRm~x had the sarne weighting, an athlete training at 71 %
Costs: HR nionitors, regular testing and analysis. would get the sarne weighting as another athlete training at 7996. It is difficult to
Practicalities: Weiglitings and zones can usually be set in the sofhoare provided ascertain if this difference would affect physiological adaptation, and there appears
zvith the hardzvare, so calculation is relatively easy. The testing and interpretation of to be a Jack of studies examining this fundamental training question. However,
data for a 1ohole squad is tinie cons11111i11g and potentially costly. It 1vould need the with Stagno' s method, the zones are created around the thresholds, so there may
purchase of gas analysis systen1s/lactate analyzers ar the hiring of tltird parties to do well be situations where players exercising in the sarne zone, and thus gaining the
tlze testing. The avai/ability of 1natch data is a proble111 at senior leveis. sarne weighting, are actually each working above and below a metabolic threshold.
Impellizerri et al. (2005) showed this could produce different results.
It must be highlighted that although the zones are based on metabolic criteria, they
10.3.4 Stagno's modified TRIMP (TRIMPmod) are created with arbitrary values of lactate and are therefore not individualized as
Stagno et al. (2007) developed a modified version of Banister's TRIMP in an attempt with Lucia's method. Another issue with using weighting that is individualized to
to quantify training load for field hockey. Rather than using a generic equation a team is that it still does not account for individual differences. Figure 10.2 below
to reflect a hypothetical blood lactate profile, these authors directly measured the sho\vs data collected from a squad of professional players from the championship
blood lactate profile of the hockey players. The vveightings used therefore reflected division in England. Note how the regression line from which the weightings are
the profile of a typical blood Jactate response curve to increasing exercise ~ntensity calculated is well below the data points for some players, especially at higher inten-
for the specific population, the hockey team in this case. Rather than be1ng truly sities, possibly leading to an underestimation of training load.
individualízed, their method used the mean blood lactate profile from all of the
14
players to generate the weightings, which provided at least some degree of indi-
vidualization. They then anchored five HR zones around the lactate threshold (LT,
1.5 mmol/L) and the onset ofblood lactate accumulation (OBLA, 4 mmol/L), with
the resulting zone \Veightings being 1.25, 1.71, 2.54, 3.61 and 5.16. The accumula-
ted time in each HR zone \Vas then multiplied by its respective zone weighting to
derive an overall TRIMPmod. The research quantified the training load in hockey
and established relationships behveen TRIMPmod and various fitness parameters
during the course of a season.
They found the mean weekly TRIMPmod shared significant relationships with
changes in running velocity at OBLA and V0201ax· They also reported significa~t
correlations between the time spent in high-intensity activity and the change In
VO and the change in vOBLA. The dose-response relationships of this study
sug~~-~t that TRIMPmod is a valid method to measure training load. The original
TRIMP of Banister (1991) is calculated using the mean HR for a particular exercise
session or interval of training. Stagno instead used tin1e accumulated in zones to
reflect the differing intensities at which team-sport players work. By con1parison,
endurance athletes may \Vork at a particular intensity for longer periods, and this 0,4 0,5 0,6 0,7 0,8 0,9
may make the use of a mean HR more suitable and less of an issue for them. Howe- ll.Henrt Rate
ver, the modern training regimens of endurance athletes also use high-intensity,
interval-type approaches. Stagno didn't compare his method to BaniSter's, and \Ve Fig. 10.2: Bfood factate responses for a squad of championship soccer players.
do not kno\v if there is any significant difference when using the zone method
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
174 175
Training /oad monitoring in soccer Training laad monitoring in soccer

ln sumrnary, the work of Stagno highlighted some of the complexities involved in in VO,m,, (r=0.77), velocity at ventilatory threshold (r=0.78), vOBLA (r=0.64)
monitoring the training load in team sports. They lüghlighted the need for specific and Yo-Yo lRl performance (r=0.69). The study conducted in the playing season of
weightings, although they did not fully individualize these, and their use of zones a youth team from an English championship club showed a dose-response relati-
was an attempt to move beyond the use of mean HR. The highlighted limitations onship with changes in vLT(r=0.67) but not with vOBLA. Akubat et al. (2011) also
exist, but they still produced significant dose-response relationships, and at the compared the weekly iTRIMP scores to session RPE and Banister' s TRIMP and a
time, this study was a big step in the right direction. A number of teams have used modified version of Stagno's TRI:MP (group \veightings but no zones). The results
Stagno's "\veightings, but a core point is often missed. These weightings were speci- were similar to previous studies that compared these methods to each other. Ses-
fic to that particular team, and to apply this approach successfully, you would need sion RPE related well to Banisters TRIMP, but iTRIMP showed poor relationships
to do the sarne testing to calculate specific weightings for your own team. with the other measures.
Banister used mean HR, citing that calculating the TRIMP for each reading would This is all great new information, but the versatility of this method is best shown in
be too problematic. However, modem computing can achieve this, so given the another study by the sarne Italian group of researchers, this time headed by lellamo
highlighted limitations of zones, why not assign each HR reading a weighting and et al. (2012). They employed the iTRIMP method to measure training load with car-
avoid the need for zones? The next method described does exactly that. diac patients. They compared the effects of continuous-aerobic training and inter-
val-aerobic training programs on numerous health and fitness measures. They
Costs: HR 111onitors, regular testing and analysis. matched the dose of exercise for each group using the iTRIMP method. There was
Practicalitíes: Weightings and zones can usually be set in the software provided zvith no significant difference behveen the groups in all the measured variables. The
the hardrvare, so calculation is relatively easy. Testing and interpretíng the data for measurements did show changes over the training period (V02peak improved by
a rvlwle squad is ti111e cons1uning and potentially costly. It zvould need tlze purclmse 22% ), but there was no difference between the groups. This has major implications
of lacta te analyzers or the híring of a third party to do the testing. The avaílability of for practices that could be employed in different sporting situations. ln summary,
1natch data is a problenz at senior levels. the iTRIMP research since 2009 has considerably furthered our knowledge of trai-
ning load monitoring.

10.3.5 lndividualized TRIMP (iTRIMP) Costs: HR 111011itors, regular testíng and analysis.
A group of Italian researchers, led mainly by Vincenzo Manzi, were the first and Practicalities: Softzvare is now available tlmt allows quick and easy a11alysis of HR
most prominent researchers of this method. Using this method, the TRIMP weigh- and provides iTRIMP scores, but ntanual calculation is ti111e consurning. Testíng and
ting is based on an individual's own heart rate and blood lactate response to incre- ínterpreting the data for a rvlwle squad is ti1ne consurning. It requires the purchase of
mental exercise, as measured during a standard lactate threshold test. Furthermore, lactate analyzers or tlie lzire of third parties to pe1fonn the testing. The availability of
as a development on previous methods, Manzi et al. (2009) did not use HR zones match data is a probletn at senior levels.
or mean HR. The TRlMP scores were calculated for each HR reading and summa-
ted to give an overall iTRlMP score. ln comparison to methods employing zones,
they had effectively created a zone for each HR reading from resting HR to HRnux· 10.3.6 Session RPE
These researchers had effectively individualized the \Veighting to the athlete, Training load measured by the session RPE is a subjective way of quantifying the
going beyond the previous individualization by gender (Banister, 1991) and group load placed on an athlete. It is calculated by multiplying the session intensity by
(Stagno et aL, 2007). Moreover, the iTRIMP weighting is not arbitrary, as \Vas the the duration to provide a measure of load in arbitrary units. The intensity is des-
case in the methods of Edwards (1993) and Lucia et al. (2003). Consequently, this Cribed as a number (0-10) on the CR-10 Rating of Perceived Exertion (RPE) scale
method overcomes many of the limitations of the previous methods. proposed by Borg et al. (1987). Significant relationships between RPE and other
Manzi et al. (2009) published results using the iTRIMP method. These showed that measures of intensity like HR (r=0.89) and plasma lactate concentration (r=0.86)
after an eight-\veek period of training in recreational runners, the mean weekly have been demonstrated (Gabbett and Domrow, 2007). However, something being
iTRIMP significantly correlated with changes in velocity at lactate threshold (vLT; a valid measure of "intensity" does not imply it will be a valid measure of "load."
r=0.87 and vOBLA; r=0.72). The mean \Veekly iTRIMP also showed significant cor- Poster et al. (1996) showed that increasing the training load (as measured by Ses-
relations with changes in 5,000m (r=-0.77) and lO,OOOn1 (r=-0.82) running perfor- sion RPE) tenfold over 12 weeks resulted in a 109~ performance improvement in
mance. ln contrast, Manzi reported that Banister's TRIMP failed to show significant runners and cyclists. However, the study also showed poor dose-response relati-
relationships \Vith any fitness parameters or performance measures. Since the HR- onships between session RPE and changes in performance (r=0.29). Gabbett and
V02 relationship appears to be valid even during intermittent exercise (Esposito et Domrow (2007) also reported a poor association betvveen session RPE and changes
ai., 2004), the iTRIMP method has potential for use wíthin a soccer environment. in skinfold thickness, speed, and V02 m~x during any of the training phases they
Two studies were recently published that looked at the iTRlMP in senior and youth monitored. In many sports, the usefulness of session RPE stems from its ease of
soccer players (Akubat et al., 2012; Manzi, et al., 2012). During the preseason of use when compared to the technical nature of using HR monitors. Possible issues
an ltalian Serie Ateam, iTRlMP showed dose-response relationships with changes include loss of data and player compliance.
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
176 177
Training load monitoring in soccer Training load monitoring in soccer

The study of Impellizerri et al. (2004) compares session RPE to the methods of These matches were separated by 48 hours, and the data for the high-intensity dis-
Banister (1991), Edwards (1993) and Lucia et al. (2003), and the relationships imply tance covered shows that the externai performance was negatively affected. Players
the validity of session RPE. Impellizerri et al. (2004) concluded that with only 50% were instructed to run as much as they could, so it could be reasonably assumed
of the variation in session RPE being explained by HR, it cannot be deemed a valid that fatigue or a Jack of recovery is the reason for their reduced performance.
substitute. A similar study was conducted by Alexiou and Coutts (2008) where However, the interesting change is in the iTRIMP and session RPE scores. iTRIMP
session RPE was correlated in different types of training sessions for female soc- tvould suggest a reduced interna} load for the second match, whereas session RPE
cer players, with a significant relationship to HR-based methods reported. Such would suggest an increased perception of interna} training load. ln this situation,
approaches, where new methods are compareci to older methods to validate their we are dealing with objective data versus subjective data. A higher session RPE
use, are becoming quite common. However, these relationships presented in such score may be a reflection of the perception of load in an unrecovered state or when
studies could justas easily imply that the new method is justas bad as the old one fatigued. Therefore, in situations where there is inadequate recovery, an identical or
rather than justas good. reduced externai load will be perceived as a greater internai load with session RPE.
More recently, Brink et al. (2010) assessed the dose-response relationship of session
RPE with performance and recovery. They used session RPE, total quality of reco- Costs: 111ini11ml.
very (TQR) and performance in young, elite soccer players over a whole season. Practicalities: Easy to ad111inister and silnple to calculate. Can be difficult to avoíd
Daily logs were kept by players and coaches to report the training load after ses- one player influencing the scores of another player in a tea1n e11viro11111ent, and this
sions and the TQR before the following session. To assess performance, they used can add to lhe poor reliability and variability that has been reported. Software and
an interval shuttle run test on a monthly basis. They applied multi-levei modelling s111artphone apps are norv available to nmke tlzis easier. Match data available.
techniques to examine whether session RPE could predict performance and reco-
very outcomes. They reported that the number of training days significantly pre-
dicted the performance outcome, as represented by a decrease in the HR during the 10.4 EXTERNAL LOAD
ISRT. However, the model did not significantly predict performance with session The measurement of externai load in soccer dates back as far as 1952 (Winterbottom,
RPE or TQR. Although the simplicity of session RPE cannot be denied, the useful- 1952), when hand notation methods were used to estimate the externa} demands
ness of the information it provides is questionable. The studies of Brink et al. (2010), of a game through the use of distance. ln more recent history, the use of automated
Gabbett and Domrow (2007), and Foster et ai. (1996) show that session RPE doesn't camera systems has brought to the fore the use of distances and breakdowns of
appear to fit dose-response models. the velocities at tvhich these distances are covered. This method has enabled the
Although dose-response relationships tvith fitness or performance appear to be lac- determination of positional differences (Di Salvo et al., 2007), leveis of play (Mohr,
king, a recent study looking at the changes in session RPE "\Vithin individuais has Krustrup, and Bangsbo, 2003), and match-to-match variation (Gregson et ai., 2010).
shown it may be useful as a predictor of injury. Rogalski et ai. (2013) found that More recently, much of this research has been reexamined using a newer method.
larger weekly or fortnightly session RPE scores and larger week-to-week increa- The invention and subsequent use of GPS technology has revolutionized the way
ses in load were significantly related to injury risk. Session RPE may relate better we track, monitor, and examine both the loads on players and their performances.
with injuries rather than performance or fitness responses because one of the main Whereas semi-automated can1era systems tvere mostly limited to stadiums, GPS
precursors of injury is fatigue. Table 10.2 shows both internai and externai training technology has the advantages of being usable almost anywhere and providing
load measures from tvvo simulated soccer matches (Akubat et al., unpublished) real-time data. Ironically, the surrounding structures of some stadiums may hinder
using the modified BEAST protocol (Akubat et ai., 2013). GPS units from connecting to the satellites they use to calculate their location. The
use of these <levices has also bought many challenges, because they are also notv
equipped with accelerometers, gyroscopes, and magnetometers, meaning we can
ITRIMP Distance HID Player Load sRPE
accumulate a wealth of data.
Match 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2
The invention of these technologies has also led to the emergence of data mining,
where everything possible is collected and then examined. On the other hand, some
Mcan 409 304 10810 10604 3336 2868 1301 1257 639 728 practitioners prefer to use only data that gives them useful information. Again the
SD 174 91 664 592 718 754 94 145 99 99 approach you choose will depend on the resources at your dispasa} and the effecti-
veness with which you can use the data. Does this ímpact on fitness, performance,
p value 0.015 0.171 0.046 0.426 0.010 wellbeing, and/ or injury risk? ln this section, 1ve will examine what externa! load
Cohen's d 0.48 0.21 0.43 0.27 0.60 can tell us about the dose-response relationship and assess the validity of external
methods for measuring training load.
Effect Slze Smal! Small Small Small Moderate

Tab/e 10.2: Load measures from two consecutive matches 48 hours aparl.
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
178
Training load monitoring in soccer Trainíng load monítoring in soccer 1179

10.4.1 Distance et al., 2013). These can then be used for programming, breaking down the high-in-
As an external measure of training load, any dose-response relationship will be tensity running zone above VT2 into smaller blocks. When MAS has been used for
mediated by the individual's characteristics in accordance with figure 10.1 (pre- individualized training regimens, exercise intensities have been prescribed as per-
sented earlier in this chapter). A theoretical comparison of an elite runner and a centages ofMAS (Baker, 2011).
recreationa1 runner who run SOOOm at the sarne pace exemplifies this. The stress on Using the approach where zones are individualized based on physiological thres-
each runner is determined by their individual fitness states, and even if the distance holds, the intensity becomes rela tive to individuals' fitness levels. Given the frame-
and pace is identical, the dose and therefore response will be different in each indi- work proposed by Impellizerri et al. (2005), this approach could be considered as
vidual. As fitness can also change within individuals, the sarne 5000m at the sarne an internalized measure of training load with the measurement of externai perfor-
pace will not always produce the sarne levei of stress. mance. It would appear that when you are using externa} measurements for moni-
Typically in soccer, we have seen the use of total distance (TD) and high-intensity toring load, these individualizations are essential.
distance (HID) as measures of externa} load or performance. HID has gained some Numerous studies have shown the benefit of high-intensity training programs in
credibility as a measure of exertion and performance through construct validity soccer (Hoff et al., 2002). Castagna et al. (2011) showed how the interna} training
when comparing moderate-to-elite-level players (Mohr et al., 2003). It has also been load at high intensities shows dose-response relationships, but such relationships
shown to vary greatly from game to game (Gregson et al., 2010). It has been sugge- with externai performance have yet to be shown. There is, however, likely to be a
sted that TD and HID may be valid indicators of load, because soccer players will similar relationship, given that training above VT2 or MAS produces a high HR. It
run as much as possible during matches. Others argue it is stimulus-driven expen- is also worth considering the study of Denedai et al. (2006), which showed marked
diture determined by factors such as state of play, position and tactics, to name but contrasts in adaptation between groups that trained at 95% and 100% of vV0 2m""·
a few (Impellizzeri et al., 2005; Rampinini et al., 2007; Rampinini et ai., 2007). When So, the debate about zones and differences remains, because in a zone with a 10%
assessing load using distance data, speed thresholds have also been individualized. width (e.g., 90-100%), a player exercising at 91% would receive the sarne creditas
one exercising at 99%. The approaches somewhat internalize the externai measures
of load, but it still remains difficult to equate the distances covered in all zones,
10.4.2 lndividualization oi Speed Thresholds regardless of ho\v they are reduced to a single number for exercise dose or training
As individuals may possess different leveis of fitness and physical capabilities, load.
comparing variations in the distance data between players may yield comparable There are two major criticisms of the velocity-based measures of load used by GPS
statistics on performance. However, the area of interest in this chapter is exercise companies and researchers to promote other measures.
dose, and generic thresholds for speed will not give comparable exercise dose data. • Movements that don't create
The methods described below have been popular recently in training regimens for vertical displacement are not
soccer. accounted for.
Abt and Lovell (2009) proposed that high-intensity speed thresholds should be • Activity isn't considered to be
individualized based on ventilatory thresholds (VT) in a similar manner to the high intensity unless speed
methods proposed by Lucia et aL (2003), which \Ve discussed earlier. This \vould thresholds are breached, \Vhe-
require a laboratory treadmill test with gas analysis. They found that the median reas accelerations that do not
high-intensity threshold, as determined by the velocity at the second VT, (VT2), result in top speed are justas, if
\Vas 15 km/h (with a range of 14-16 km/h), considerably lower than the defaults not more, energetically deman-
of many GPS and camera tracking systems. They found the mean distance run ding (Gaudino et al., 2013a;
at high intensity, based on the default of 19.8 km/h and the VT2 speed, was 845m Gaudino et al., 2013b; Osgnach
and 2258m respectively. This represents an almost three-fold increase in the high et ai., 2010).
intensity exercise dose. A follow-up study (Lovell and Abt, 2013) found that total This has led to the development of
distance covered in the three different zones proposed by Lucia was 26?1', 57% and both accelerometry-derived load
17% for lov.,r-, moderate- and high-intensity zones respectively. They also identi- and metabolic-power calculations,
fied a 41% difference in the high-intensity distance covered between two players of both of which are now available from
the sarne positional role when zones were individualized, compared to only 5-7% some GPS technology suppliers.
when zones were not individualized.
Speeds above a high-intensity threshold of 15 km/h representa large zone because
peak speeds have been reported to be well above 25 km/h (Gregson et al., 2005).
Therefore, other researchers have proposed the use of maximal aerobic speed
(MAS) and maximum sprinting speed (MSS) to generate training zones. Using this
method, supramaximal running speeds (speeds >MAS) can be identified (Buchheit
lBO 1 FITNESS IN SOCCER
Training load monitoring in soccer FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
Training load monitoring in soccer 181

10.4.3 Accelerometry
vity in the proportions demonstrated has serious implications for training, adapta-
Accelerometry in soccer has come together with GPS technology, because these
tion periodization, fatigue and ultimately injury prevention.
units are now available with accelerometers built into them. The accelerometry-de-
rived load has been described as externai load, mechanical load, and center of mass
10.4.5 Match Load as a Measure of Training Load
acceleration in all three planes of movement. The algorithms used differ between
The use of GPS and its associated technologies has allowed the measurement of
GPS companies. Research studies have sought to validate accelerometry-derived
match-play activities at previously unlmown depths. One of the approaches often
load by correlating it to some of the internal-load measures mentioned earlier. The
used in practice, but not really in research, is that of using percentages of match-ba-
Player Load (Catapult) and Body Load (GPSports) are two oi the accelerometry-de-
sed metrics to periodize and optimize training. For example, a player may aim
rived load measures. Player Load appears to relate to session RPE and Edwards'
to do two games worth of work (in terms of distance, accelerometry-derived
TRIMP (Casamichana et al., 2013), and Body Load doesn't appear to sho\v any rela-
load or metabolic pO\Ver) in a given week. This approach has fundamental flaws.
tionship with session RPE (Gomez Piri et al., 2012). Unpublished data (Akubat et
Firstly, to conclude this method works, \ve must first have evidence that a certain
al., unpublished) suggests that Player Load shows very large correlations with ses-
amount of match-like activity produces a certain response. Secondly, the variation
sion RPE but only trivial relationships \vith iTRIMP. You could speculate that given
in match loads between games and positions (Gregson et al., 2010) means it is dif-
iTRIMP has shown dose-response relationships (Akubat et al., 2012; Manzi et al.,
ficult to make assumptions about a typical match. The question that arises with
2012; Manzi et al., 2009), the lack of any relationship with iTRIMP would bring into
such an approach is this: Are we trying to make the technology useful using match
question the ability of Player Load to show a dose-response relationship. Howe-
demands just because it is something we can measure no\v? Or does this method
ver, this is merely speculation, and to truly assess the validity of any accelerome-
provide an effective measure of training load? Such a method determines the load
try-derived load measure, training studies such as those done previously for other
without considering initial and subsequent fitness levels.
methods are required (Akubat et al., 2012; Manzi et al., 2012; Wallace et al., 2013).
Costs: GPS units are very expensive for an entire squad.
10.4.4 Metabolic Power
Practicalities: Player conzpliance issues for zveari11g 1111its in so111e cases, Lots of data,
Accelerations and decelerations are high-intensity and energy-demanding activi-
but is it actually usef11l? Once data is collected, analysis by analysts is requíred. The
ties, even at low absolute velocities. However, the way high-intensity activity is
availability of 1natch data is a problem at senior leveis.
determined when using velocity thresholds does not always account for this (Gau-
dino et al., 2013a; Gaudino et al., 2013b).
10.4.6 Maximizing Performance using Training Load Monitoring
Di Prampero et al. (2005) developed a mathematical approach to quantify the esti-
The purpose of any player monitoring is to gain information to help understand
mated energy cost associated with any instantaneous change in velocity. It was
the response and produce this response when required. Soccer players may face
proposed that accelerated running on a flat terrain is considered energetically equi-
different challenges to those in other sports where competition is infrequent and
valent to uphill running at constant speed (Minetti et al., 2002). Metabolic power
allows training and taper periods. ln soccer, the ideal scenario for a coach is to have
is calculated as the instant energy cost multiplied by the instant velocity. The abi-
a player able to participate at his maxin1al capability on a number of occasions (this
lity to calculate instant "energy cost" based on known and measured data and the
is discussed in a later chapter). In many European leagues, successful teams regu-
measurement of "instant velocity" using GPS allows this estimate of metabolic
larly play two or three times each \Veek. To help maxin1ize or understand a player's
power to be calculated. As both velocity and acceleration are used, it is argued this
performance capability, we can use some of Banister's (1991) theoretical \vork. He
provides a better estimation of high-intensity activity (Gaudino et al., 2013).
theorized that performance at any given point is determined by the fitness levei of
Gaudinho et al. (2013) showed that when the equivalent high-intensity metabo-
the individual less fatigue. Therefore, by monitoring both fitness and fatigue, \.Ve
lic-power threshold (a metabolic power of 20W.kg is considered the equivalent of
can assess \Vhen maximal performance is possible and when maximal performance
running ata constant speed of 14.4 km/h) is used in the analysis of soccer training,
\.Vill be hindered. The n1easurement of fatigue could be subjective (through ques-
the actual high-intensity activity could be underestimated by as much as 84%. The-
tionnaires and scales) or objectíve (through physiological assessment). Frequent
refore, the availability of metabolic-power calculations in GPS software has been
fitness measurement is also difficult in soccer given the high volume of training
an interesting addition to the monitoring of load. However, there are also some
and matches. Could training load measures be used to help assess fih1ess? A recent
theoretical limitations that must be considered. Acceleration measurement with
study by Akubat et al. (2013) sho\ved ho\.v integrating the internal and external load
GPS units at higher velocities has been shown to display increased error (Aken-
could produce ratios that relate to fitness measures, or in other \vords, assess the
head et al., 2013), and there has also been substantial inter-unit variability repor-
interna} cost of the externally prescribed exercise. This provides a pseudo-measure-
ted (Buchheit et al., 2013). There are also inter-individual variations in energy cost,
ment of exercise economy / efficiency. Regular assessn1ent of internal:external ratios
because the sarne acceleration velocities may not result in the sarne energy cost
could give you informatíon on fitness. Ho-i.vever, unpublished data also shows
when the data is examined closely (Gaudino et al., 2013).
acute changes in such ratios \vith fatigue during competition (Weaving et al., unpu-
Over the next few years, research in this area will hopefully clarify this method's
blished} and between exercise bouts (Akubat et al., unpublished).
usefulness in the training process, but the underestimation of high-intensity acti-
FITNESS IN SOCCER
1a2 I Training load monitoring in soccer
FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
Traíning load monitoring in soccer l83

Buchhcit, M., Simpoo1t, B.M. and Mende;.-\lillunueva, A., 2013. Rcpc.itcd high~;pced activi!iea during youth socccr game~ in "'1"tion to
To maximize performance, we must understand the internal load for each exter- changcc. in maxim.1! oprinting and acrobk opceda. !ntJ Sport~ Mcd, 3-1(1), ppA0-18.
BlliSo, T., 2003. V.1riablc dosc-rc.sporuc "'l1tionship bctwcen cxcrcioc trainin!l and performance. Medicine and Socncc in Spml< il!ld
nai load prescribed for each individual, so comparing players with each other in Excrci,;c, 35(7), pp.ll&l·1195.
Bu,;so, T., CarM•.o, C. and Lncour,]R, 1991. Adequa"}" oi a systcm$ 5lructun! in the modding of !raining dfcctJ; on p~rfom1unre. j >\ppl
this respect may not prove fruitful. A player history, or within player comparison, Physiol, 71(5), pp.2W4·21H9.
would help in assessing this and help us to move from being reactive to proactive. Bmai, T. and Thomar., L., 2006. Uoing mathcmntical modcling in trninin!J planning. lnt j Sport,; Physiol Perform, 1(4), pp,400-!05
C:lntagna, C, lmpclli22eri, F.M., Chaouachi, A., Bordon, C. nnd Manii, V., 2011. Effecl of t"1ining intcnoity distributionon acrobic fitn""';
Although the dose-response relationships we have found have been linear, more variab!es in elite to~cr playcrs: a ca~c>tudy.J Strcngth Cond Rcn, 25(1), pp.6&71.
Dcnadai, D.S., Ortiz, M.J., Grcco, C.C. nnd de )..folio, M.T., 2006. lntcrvnl trnining at 95% and 100',';J of thc velodty at V02 max: dícctson
may not always be better. Manzi et al. (2009) showed an inverted-U relationship aerobic ph)'siological indcxen and running pcrfom>ancc. Applied Phpiology Nulrilion and Mctubofüm, 31(6), pp.737·7·13.
di Prampero, P.E., Fuoi, 5., 5epukri, L., Morin, f.B., lklli, A and Antonultn, G., 2005. Sprint running: a new cncrgctic approach. J Exp
for iTRIMP and heart rate variability (HRV) changes in runners. They found higher Bio!, 20S(Pt 14), pp.Ul09-281{>.
Oi Salvo, V., füron, R., T,;drnn, H., Montem, F.J., Dud1I, N. and Pigoz:zl, F., 2007. Perfom1anç,, chílruclNistics acrording to plnying po~otion
training loads beyond a certain point incurred negative changes in HRV, probably in clilc~.oc<:<>r. lnlemalionnl Joum.11 oi Sports Mcdidnc, 2S(3), pp.222·227.
Edwardo, S. (1993). Thc heMl rate monilorbook. New York: Polar Elcclro Oy.
because of overtraining. By building a player history, we can therefore assess what Elloumi, M., Mnkni, E., Moalla, W., Bou.uiz. T., Tabka, Z., Lnc, G. and Chamarl, K., 2012. Monitoring training loud and fotiguc in rugby
the optímum "load" is by comparing peliods of different training loads with the scvens playcrs. Asianj SporIB Mcd, 3(3), ppJ75-1S4.
E<posilo, F., Impellizzeri, F.M., Margonalo, V., V,rnni, R., Pinini, G. and Vcicstcina$,A., 2001. Vnlidity ofhcurt rntcasan indkatorofaoro-
performance response. This is an iterative process that would continue to change. bkdcmílnd during socccr actívitics in amuleur socccr p!aycm. Europcanjoumal of Applicd Phyr.iology, 93, pp.167·172.
Estevc-Lanao, j., Fostcr, C., &iler, S. und Lucia, A., 2007. lmpnct of !rnining intCIUlity distribution on performance in endurnncc nthlclm.
The frequency at which this iteration needs to take place depends on the sensi- )ou mal ofSt.,,ngth and Conditioning Rcscurch, 21(3), pp.9.\3-949.
Fmlcr, C., Duines, E., Hcctor, L., Snydor, A.C. and Wcl&h, R., 1996. Athlctic pcrfom>ancc in rclation to lrnining load. Wisconsin Med!Ca!
tivity of the load measures to physiological change. Maybe the process becomes journnl, 95({>), pp.3i0.37~.
Gnbbctt, T,J, and Domrow, N .. 2007. Rc!ationllhips bctwccn trnining load, injul)~ and fitncss in sub-elite collbion sport athlctes. ]ou mal
less iterative when the load measure is more sensitive to changes in the athlete's of SporL• Sdcnres, 25, pp.lSOi·l519.
Gaudim>, P., laia, F.M., Alberti, G., Hawkins, R.O., Strudwicl:, A.J. and Gregson, W., 2013. Syslcmatk lli.15 bctwccn Running Spccd and
physiology, such as in the case of HR, where the load adjusts to changes in physio- Mctabolic Powcr Data in Elite Socccr l'laycr.;: lnflucncc of Dril11}i>C. lnt J Sports Mcd.
logy. An increase in fitness \vould result in a decreased HR for the sarne externai Gaudino, P., laia, F.M.,AlbertL G., Strudwicl:, A.J., Atkinwn, G. and Grcg 0.on, W., 2013. Monitoring Training in Elite Soc"'r Playcm: Sys·
tcmatic Bias bctwccn Running Spced and Mctabolic Powcr Duta. ln! J Sporlr. Mcd, 3·1(11 ), pp.963-968.
load, meaning a higher externai load (intensity or volume) is required to match the G"'&"º"• W, Drust, D,, Atkfoe,on, G. and Sul\'o, V., 2010. Mntch·!o-match vnri.1bility of high·oixed activitics in l'remicr l<!a!lue $CXCCr.
lntJ Sporl> Mcd, 31(4).
internai load. Hoff, )., Wioloff, U., Engcn, LC .. Kcmi, O.J. and Hc!gcrud, )., 2002. Socc.>r spedfic aerobic cndurnncc training. British joumal ofSports
Medicine, 36(3), pp.218-221.
lellamo, F., Manzi, V., Caminiti, G., V.tale, C., C.1stagna, C., Mawaro. 1-.t, Franchinl, A., Rooano, G. and Voltcrmni, M., 2012. Matchcd
dof.c inlcrval and rontinuous excrdse training inducc similar cnrdion!spiratol)" and metabolk adapt~tiom in palicnts wilh hcart foilu"'.
ln! j Cnrdiol.
lmpcllizzcri, F.M., Rampinini, E., Coutts,A.J., Sa>.1i, 1\. and Marrom, S. M., 200·\. U~ofRPE·baocd training loud ln socrer, Medicine and
SUMMARY Scien"' in Spor!s and facrdoc, 36(6), pp.1W2·10-17.
!mpelhzzcri, F.M., Rílmpinini, E. und 1-.farcorn, S.M., 2005. l'hyoiologica! =essmcnt of nerobic truining ln socccr. joumal of Sporl5 Sei·
cnces, 23(6). pp.533-592.
Most methods of measuring training Ioad have limitations, so it is important that Lm·cll, R. and ,\bt, G., 2013. lndividualization of tomc'-motion analysis: a casc'-cohort eirnmplc. lnt J Sporto Physiol Pcrfom>, 8(·1).
pp.-156453.
soccer coaches select the method with the Ieast limitations that fits their club's Ludn, A., Hoyos, )., S,mtnlln,A, E.1mcst, C. and Chichnrro,j.L., 2003, Tour de Frnnccvernus \'uclt,1 a Espana: Which io ho1rdcr7 Mcdidm'
and Sden"' lnSporW nnd Exen:is~, 35(5), pp.872-87$.
budget. It is also important to consider the limitations when interpreting trai- Munzi, V., Antonio, B., Mnrin, J.F., Ivan, C. and Cario, C., 2012. Individual tmining·load and acrobic-fitncss variabks in premicrship
socccr playcn; during lhe prc-compctitlvc r.earnn. J Sl.,,ngth Cond Res.
ning load data, but the right information, gathered and used in the right way, )..fanzi, V,, Castagna, C., Padu~, E., Lombardo, M., O'Oltavio, S., MaViaro, M., Vollcrrani, M. and !cllnmo, F., 2009. DN.,.re;ponn• rcb-
tionship of m1tonomic M!"\"OU.~ ,;y·stcm resporucs to indwidu.1hzcd truining impul~c in marathon runncm Am J Phy5iol tk.1r! Core
could help improve a coaches decision 1naking when periodizing individual and Physiol, 2%(6), pp.Hli33·1740
squad training programs. A good knowledge of training load methods, limita- Maru:i, V., Icl!amo, F., lmpclliucn, FM,, D'Ottavio, S. and Ca$\~gna, C., 2009, Rdation botwccn individuah~~d trnimng impufo~s nnd
pcrfom>nnce in dis!anc..· runner~. Medicine and Sdcnce in Sports and Ewrcio~, 41(11), pp.2090.2096.
tions and monitoring methods can make a positive impact on soccer players in Minctti, A.E., Moia, C., Roí, GS, Susta, O. and Fcrrclti, G., 2(102 Enorgy co~t of wulklng and runnmg a! extreme uphill ~nd downhill
5lopcs. J Appl Physiol (1935), 93(3), pp.1039-10·16
terms of their performance and health. Mohr, M., Kruotrup, P and Ban5~bo, J, 2W3 )lfotch pcrformnne<: of h1gh·sl.1ndnrd socccr pbycrs with spccial "'l~"'ncc to devclopm~nt
of fotigue. j Sports Se~ 2l(i), pp,519·528.
Morton, R.H,, 1990. Modeling human powcr and cndurnnN journal oi Mathcmohcnl Biology, 28(1), pp.494>·1.
O;gnach, C., Po~•r, S., Tiernardmi, R., Rin)]do, R. and di l'rnmpcro, P.E., 2010. [nergy cosi and mctnbolic powcr in chtQ rnce<:r a ncw
moldt analysb npproach. Mcd So Sports E.~cn:, •12(1), pp.170-178
REFERENCES lbmpinini, E., Coufü, A., Cn~t.1gn~, C., Sae.si, R. and Impclhzwn, FM., 200i. Vanation 1n top levei rncrer match performan(I.' Jntcmnl!·
onal Joumal ofSporl5 Mcdidnc, 21l(i2), pp.lO!S.102~
R.1mpinini, E., Impdlizzcri, F.M, Ca5tagna, C., Coutts, A). and Wi~lofi, U., 2007. Tcchnical performance dunng "°""'r ma1chco o! lhe
!lalian S,,ric A lcnguc: Efícct oi fotigue nnd rompctiti,·c levei. Joumal ofSckncc nnd Medicine inSport.
Ab~ G. '"'d Lovcll, R., 2009. TI>e m,e of individuo1lized opccd nnd intcnsity th.,,c.holdn for dct~m>ining the diot;mre nm nt hi!lh-intcm;ity RogulsYJ, D.. Dawson, ll., Hcosman, J. and GnbbclL T, /., 2013. Training nnd gume louds and injury ri5k in elite Au~tralrnn foolb.llkrs.)
in profo,..:;ionnJ so"cr. journnl ofSporls Scicnreo, 2i(9), pp.S93-S9S. Sci Med Sport, 16(6), pp.499·503.
Akubat, !., 2009. A Compnrirnn OI Mcthod.s For C:ih:ulntinn OfThc Trainin!J tmpube. Papcr P"-'fientcd at thc !nlemational oports scicnre Scikr, S. and T(mnC"oocn, E., 2009. lntcn•als, thrmholds and long nlow d ir.lance: lhe role of inlcrnity nnd durution in cndurnncc tramm11
and sports medicine confcrenc•>, Newcnstk'-upon·tyne. Sport~ Sdcnre, 13, pp.32·53.
Akubnt, L, Patcl, E., lbrrdt, S., and Abt, G., 2012. Mc!hods of monitoring lhe lruinin11 nnd mntch load and thcir rdntionr<hip to changcs Stílgno, K. M., Thatcher, R, and \',rn Some"'"· K.A., 2007. A modificd TR!MP lo quantiíy lhe in·ocarnn traimng !oad oi toam ~port pl.1ycm
in fitnc.i:; in professmnal youth oocc~r pluycm.J Sports So. Journal oi SportsScicne<:::-, 25(6), pp.629·63-l.
Alcxiou, H., und Coull5, A., 2008. A compurison of mctho<Ll uocd for qu;mtifying interno! t"1inin11 lond in womcn r.ocrer pluycrs. lnlcr- W"llacc>, I..K., Slattel)", KM. and Coutt:;, A.J., 2013. A compari~on of mcthndo for quílntlfying training load: "'btion~hips b<twccn modd-
nulionul Joum,11 of Sports Phy:iiology and Pcrfom>ancc, 3(3), pp.320.330 kd and actual trainini.; respomc&. Eur J Appl Physiol.
Dukcr, O,, 2011. Rcccnt tn!ndfi in high·intcnoity acrobic trnining for fiel d r.por!o. UKSCA(22), pp.3-11. Winlcrbottom, W., 1952, SocccrCoaching. London: Nald"'tt Pn.-oo
llong~bo, )., Mohr, M. and Kruo1rup, P., 2()(}(,. Phpic«I and mctnbolic dcmands of training nnd matdl·pl.1y ln thc elite football playcr.
journal of Spor\5 Scicnre;, 2·1(7), pp.665·!>7·1.
Dnni:;tcr, E,W,, 1991, Modcling Elite AthMic Pcrform.1ncc. ln/. D. MucDoug.111, H. A. Wcngcr & H. ). G"'cn (Edo.), Physiological T~.,;ting

ll
of EliteAthkteo (pp.403421). Chumpnign, !llinois: Humun Kinetic;.
llaniotcr, E.W., C.1lvcrt, T.W., Sava11c, M.V. and \luch, A., 1975. Asyslcm model oi training for athlctic pcrfom>oncc. Au5lralian Journul
ofSporto Mcdicim.·, 7, pp,170.176.
ll.inbtcr, E.W., C.1rlcr, j.ll. and Zarkndru>, P., 1999. Trnining thcory and tapcr; validation in trfathlon alhlelen. Europcan Joumal of Applicd
Phpiology, 79(2), pp.132·191.
llorg. G., Ha&;mcn, P. nnd L1111cr.;trom, M., 1987. Pcrcciwd cxcr!ion rdatcd to heart rale and blood factale during am> and leg excrciõc.
EuroJX:nn /oumul of Applicd Physiology and Ckruput!onul Physiology, 56(6), pp.679·635.
Dot, S,D. and Hollandcr, A.P., 2000. Thc rdaliomhip b<!tween hcart rntc and nxn;en uptake during non·otcady st.1te cxcrcise. Ergonomks,
43(10), pp.1578-1592.
Brink, M.S., Nedcrhof, E., Vi~~chcr, C., S<:hmikli, S.I.. and I.emmink, KA., 2010. Monitoring load, n.;:overy, nnd pcrfom>ancc in young
elite SO'«'r playcro. )ou mal ofSt"'ngth and Conditionlng Rcse.1rch, 2.\(3), pp.597·603.
lluchhcit, M., A! Haddad, H., Simp>on, ll. M., Pafo1~i, O,, Dourdon, P. C., Oi Salvo, V. and Mendoz-Vill,1nucvn, A., 2013. Monitnring
Acccleratiom With Gl'S in Footba!l: Time to Slow Down? lnt J Sporl5 Physiol Perfom>.

1
--ti
FITNESS IN SOCCER
184
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER
Training continuum j 1ss
Training /oad monitoring in soccer

11
TRAINING CONTINUUM
Jan Van Winckel, Werner Helsen, Jean-Pierre Meert,
Kenny McMillan, Paul Bradley

11.1 INTRODUCTION
In the preceding chapters, we described and defined various physical abilities, such
as speed and endurance, as well as physical pararneters, such as volume and inten-
sity. We also outlined different methods that can be used to calculate training load.
In this chapter, we aim to provide an overview of the different effects of training.
There is a Jack of clarity regarding the different terms in the existing literature, with
the concepts of overtraining, overreaching and overload being used interchange-
ably. For example, the term "overtraining syndrome" is used regularly in soccer
jargon, yet this state rarely occurs in soccer. Declines in performance can also be
dueto other life stressors, so the term "underperformance syndrome" is sometimes
used (Budgett et al., 2000),
Successful training must involve overload, but it must also avoid the combination
of excessive overload and inadequate recovery. Athletes can experience short-term
performance decrements without severe psychological or other lasting negative
symptoms. This Acute Fatigue (AF) or Functional Overreaching (FOR) will eventu-
ally lead to an improvement in performance after adequa te recovery. When athletes
do not sufficiently respect the balance between loading and unloading, Non-Func-
tional Overreaching (NFOR) can occur. The distinction between NFOR and the
Overtraining Syndrome (OTS) is very difficult and depends on the clinicai outcome
and exclusion diagnosis (Meeusen et al., 2013).
lSG I FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
! 1s1
Training cantinuum Training continuum

The reduction in aerobic endurance is significantly greater than for other motor
Process Training (overload)
abilities, such as strength, power and flexibility. ln a study conducted by Sal-
Acute fatigue Functional Non-Functional Overtraining tin (1968), five people were kept in bed for 20 days. Their V02m" fel! by 25%.
(AF) overreaching overreaching syndrome (OTS) This drop can be mainly attributed to a decline in the heart's performance that
Outcome
(short-term OR) (extreme OR)
occurs, in particular, during the first 12 days of detraining.
Oay(s) Days -weeks Weeks - months Months - ..
Recovery The physiological effects of 2-4 weeks detraining:
o vo2mnx: - 5-10%
lncrease Temporary Stagnation Decrease
o resting and submaximal exercise HR: + 5-10%
Performance performance decrease
decrement o blood volume: -5-10%
o stroke volume: - 6-12%
Acute fatigue Overreaching Continued Several months
o cardiac output: reduced
after a day with after a pre- excessive with stressfu!
training !oad competition, o flexibility (suppleness): reduced
two training season training
sessions camp after a training stressful team o lactate threshold: reduced
Example campwith environment, 0 muscle glycogen stores: - 15-30%
inadequate excessive load
o aerobic enzyme activity: reduced
recovery and inadequate
recovery
Physiological adaptations lost over a particular period need more time to recover
Table 11. 1: The different stages that differentiate normal training from OR (functional and non- than it takes to detrain them. Fourteen days of detraining is sufficient to induce a
functionaf OR) and the OTS. (Meeusen et ai., 2013)
significant decrease in vo2mnx' but it takes considerably longer than two weeks to
return to the sarne baseline leveis. The mechanisms of physical deconditioning are
many, but it seems that hypovolemia (a decrease in volume of blood plasma), decre-
ases in the activity of oxidative enzymes, and lower muscle glycogen stores are the
11.2 DIFFERENT STAGES OF THE TRAINING CONTINUUM first factors responsible for a decrement in performance (Oliviera et ai., 2008).

11.2.1 Detraining 11.2.1.1 Effects of training parameters


Undertraining or detraining involves a load thatis insufficient to maintain or stimu- As highlighted above, detraining is a consequence of reduced frequency, intensity
late positive adaptation. Many terms-such as tapering, active recovery and unloa- and / or volume. An overview of the effects of a reduction in these three factors is
ding-are also used interchangeably in relation to detraining or underh·aining. set out below:
Set out belo\V is an overview of the most widely used terms: 1. Reduction in frequency: If training is reduced from six sessions to three ses-
1. Active recove1y or unloading allows both the training volume and intensity to sions, while the volume and intensity are maintained, there is no substantial
drop. Active recovery is used to recover from match load or successive heavy detraining effect.
training loads. 2. Reduction in intensity: If the training intensity is reduced by 50%, performance
will be diminished significantly.
2. Taper: The highest levei of performance follows on from a period of tapering. 3. Reduction in volume: Even if the total volume is reduced by 50%, the detrai-
Tapering is defined by Mujika et al. (2003) as a progressive, nonlinear reduction ning effect can be limited.
of training load over a particular period in arder to reduce psychological and This shows that a reduction in intensity, in particular, induces a detraining effect.
physiological stress and therefore optimize performance. Tapering differs from
unloading in the sense that although the volume and frequency decrease, the Reference Days of inactivity Percentage
intensity remains the sarne (80-100%). This process is very individual, but the
best results are typically seen after a recovery period of 7-14 days, which is not Houston, Bentzen, & Larsen, (1979) 15 -4 o/o vo~m>ll

possible in the calendar of professional soccer. ln soccer, tapering strategies are Martin etal. (1986) 40 -20 % vo2""',
imposed in every microcycle for the days preceding a match and during the last Houmard, Hortobagyl, & Johns (1992) 14 -5%VO ,_,
phase of preseason, just before the start of the season. Coyle et ai. (1984) 21 -8 % Cardiac Output

Chi et ai. (1983) 21 -64 ºlo activity aerobic enzymes


3. Detraining: The term "detraining'' is used when a player's performance levei
Costlll et ai. (1985) 7 -20 o/o Glycogen store
drops. The detraining effect will appear, for example, a few weeks into the
off-season, when players' fitness leveis begin falling rapidly. Tabfe 11.2: OveNiew of detraining effects
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
188 Training continuum 1189
Training continuum

11.2.2 Retaining (maintenance) 11.2.5 Dysfunclional ar Nan-Funclianal Overreaching (NFOR)


A retaining or maintenance load is used when further positive adaptation and/ When coaches do not sufficiently respect the balance between training and reco-
or overload are contraindicated, but maintenance of physical capacity is desired. very, NFOR (extreme OR) may occur. At this stage, the first signs and symptoms
Soccer training for 60-70 minutes at 60-70% intensity is a good example of main- of prolonged training distress are performance decrements, psychological distur-
tenance training for professional players. Although strategies to maintain stable bance, decreased vigor, increased fatigue, and hormonal disturbances. Players will
performance throughout the season are key to a successful season, retaining loads often require weeks or months to recover. An example in soccer would be when
are rarely investigated by scientific research. a team plays competitive games twice a week for six consecutive weeks without
respecting adequate recovery between games. Dysfunctional overreaching is the
11.2.3 Acuie fatigue point along the training continuum when functional overreaching results in more
Overload training disturbs players' homeostasis and results in acute fatigue, follo- persistent decreases in performance (Moore and Fry, 2007).
wed by an improvement in performance. (Soccer example: two consecutive inten-
sive training sessions). Intensified training is commonly employed by coaches in 11.2.6 Overtraining syndrame (OTS)
an attempt to enhance performance. Subsequently, the player may experience acute Although this term is frequently used, overtraining rarely occurs in soccer. OIS
feelings of fatigue and decreases in performance because of a single intense trai- occurs mainly in individual athletes (especially endurance athletes) and is the con-
ning session or an intense training period. The resultant acute fatigue can be fol- sequence of an excessive training load over a prolonged period. ln most cases, OIS
lowed, after an adequate rest period, by a positive adaptation or improvement in will occur in combination with other stressors, such as psychological, immunolo-
performance, and this is the foundation of effective training programs (Meeusen et gical, social, and so on. The confusion surrounding OIS is complicated by the fact
al., 2013). The sequence of h·aining and the interrelationship between training and that the clinicai features are non-specific, anecdotal, and numerous (Meeusen et
recovery are crucial factors in achieving the desired training response. ai., 2013).

The term overtraining is often use d in soccer. In this book, the term "overtraining" Ihe distinction between NFOR and OTS is very difficult, because a player will
is used as a "verb" to refer to a process of intensified training that possibly results often display the sarne clinicai, hormonal, and psychological signs and symptoms.
in short-term overreaching (functional OR), extreme overreaching (non-functional A key phrase in the recognition of OTS might be the "prolonged maladaptation" of
OR), or OTS, depending on the appropriate balance between loading and unloa- several biological, neurochemical, and hormonal regulation mechanisms (Meeusen
ding cycles (Halson and jeukendrup, 2004). et al., 2013). Recovery from overtraining syndrome can take months (Kreider et al,
1998).
11.2.4 Funclional overreaching (FOR) ar shart-term OR
When training continues and fatigue accumulates, or when coaches purposely use ln a study by Morgan et al. (1988), 12 male swimmers were assessed prior to,
a short period (e.g., a training camp) to increase training load (fatigue accumula- during, and after increasing their workloads from 4,000m to 9,000m at 94% VO 2m.1x
tion), players can experience short-term performance decrements without severe over a ten-day period. Swimmers completed a POMS (profile of mood status), mus-
psychological or long-term negative symptoms. This functional OR (or short-term cle soreness scale, and 24-hour history each morning before starting the first of
OR) \vill ultimately lead to an improvement in performance after adequate reco- two daily training sessions. Seven swimmers successfully completed the required
very (supercompensation effect). (Soccer example: A seven-day training camp fol- training regimen, but three others had difficultly completing the training require-
lowed by 3-4 days of adequate recovery.) ments, and these athletes had significantly higher levels of POMS mood distur-
bance. Many of the physiological and psychological responses tended to stabilize
Overreaching is an integral part of successful training regimes, and it can be ana- after the first five days of exposure to the training stress. Three other swimmers
lyzed using a multidisciplinary approach involving physiological and psychome- were so severely affected by the training that they had to be dropped from the
tric data. Overreaching is often utilized by coaches during a typical training cycle study. In those swimmers, the psychological changes were very marked.
to enhance performance. Intensified training can result in decreased performance,
but when appropriate periods of recovery are provided, a "supercompensation"
effect may occur, with the player unveiling (because of reduced leveis of fatigue)
an enhanced performance. This process is often used during "training camps," and
it will lead to a temporary performance decrement that is followed by improved
performance. In this situation, the physiological responses will compensate for the
training-related stress (Steinacker et al., 2004). This form of short-term "Overrea-
ching" can also be called "Functional Overreaching."
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
190
Training continuum Training continuum J 191

11.3 LOAD ANO LOAD TOLERANCE 11.3.1 Conceptual framework describing the interplay between load and
Overtraining, acute fatigue and overreaching are the result of an imbalance bet- load tolerance
ween load (physiological, mechanical, and psychological) and the load tolerance
of the player. If the accumulated load exceeds the player's load tolerance for too
long, functional or dysfunctional overreaching may occur, resulting in a decline Injury threshold (load tolerance threshold)
lOOo/o
in performance and a substantial risk of injury. The training process should the-
refore always constitute a perfect balance betvveen the accumulated load and the
load tolerance. Players' load tolerances are determined individually. Within any
team, there will be players who will respond positively or only barely to a training
plan, depending on the nature of players and their ability to cape with the trai-
ning demands and non-training stress factors. In an appropriate training plan, the
player will receive an suitably individualized training stimulus (duration, intensity ô
·~
and frequency) that will increase the load tolerance (functional adaptation). Trai- !E 50%
ning is nota one-sided form of loading, and overload phenomena vary for different ]
physical abilities.

ºº''º 60min 90min 120min 150min 180min


Duration

Fig. 11.2: This figure shows lhe effects oftraining /oad (duration x intensity) for an individua/ player.
lf this p/ayer trains just be/ow the injury threshold (foad to!erance}, his or her filness wifl improve,
subsequentfy increasing the thresho/d. lf the pfayer trains too far be/ow this threshofd, he or she wifl
either sustain the fitness levei (retaining /oad) oreven lose it (detraining foad). Training above the
injury thresho/d wifl cause overreaching and may /ead to injury.

Load: load tolerance We illustrate this based on a number of example training sessions for a player:
Frequency Physical fitness TI: Session of ± 60 minutes at ± 30%: This load is insufficient for the player
Duration Lifestyle to maintain fitness.
!ntensity Stress T2: Session of ± 70 minutes at ± 60%: This load is sufficient for a player to
Social support rnaintain fitness.
T3: Session of ± 100 minutes at ± 55%: This load is sufficient for the player
Fig. 11.1: Relationship between /oad (physiofogical, mechanica/, mental) and load toferance. to rnake progress. The load is just below the injury threshold, so training 'vill
consequently improve the player's fitness and therefore push the injury thres-
hold higher.
T4: Session of ± 120 minutes at ± 45%: Although the training parameters for
this session differ from training session T3, the load is also sufficient for the
player to rnake progress.
TS: Session of ± 70 minutes at 70%: This load is too high for this player, so the
likelihood of injury increases.
T6: Session of ± 130 1ninutes at ± 70~~: This load is much too high for the
player, so the risk of the player sustaining an injury because of accumulated
fatigue is high.
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
192
Training continuum Training continuum 1193

Tl is a 95-minute session at 30%. This is a low-endurance training session that is


100% therefore ideal for player 1, but this training load is insufficient to elicit adaptation
in players 2 and 3.
T2 is an 80-minute session at 50%. This training load is ideal for player 2, because
it is a good stimulus to cause fatigue and consequently adaptation. The load is too
high for player 1 and too lO\V for player 3.
Finally, T3 is a 75-minute training session at 70%. ln this example, the load is ideal
for player 3, but too high for player 2 and much too high for player 1.

This graph perfectly illustrates the everyday situation in soccer where too much
training is carried out in a group setting. For example, Hoff et al. (2002) demonstra-
ted that players with the highest V02max had the lowest percentage of V0 2max during
small-sided games. This indicates that soccer players with higher fitness leveis may
not receive sufficient training stimulus to further increase their fitness when trai-
ning in ateam environment (Hoff et al., 2002).
Finally, we should also highlight that this is a simplified model that does not take
account of the consequences arising from previous loads and recovecy and the dif-
60min 90min 120min 150min 180min fering effects of intensity and volume training. It clearly depicts, however, the inter-
play betvveen load and load tolerance.
Duration
Fig. 11.3: This figure shows the shift in the player's injury threshold due to increased fitness leveis.
11.4 OVERTRAINING DETECTION SCALE
The table below presents a scale that can be used for the early detection of overtrai-
ning. Overtraining phase 2 can be used as an indicator for detecting and avoiding
100% overreaching at an early stage. Training has to be adjusted from this threshold in
order to avoid injuries.
Injury threshold player 3

Overtraining detection scale


Injury threshold player 2
Overtraining phase O no pain/fatigue atai!

player feels muscle pain/fatigue in lhe morning after


Overtraining phase 1
·~ Injury threshold player 1 waking up
É 50% Overtraining phase 2 p!ayer feels muscle pain/fatigue in between exercises
.E Overload zone player 1
player feels muscle pain/fatigue at lhe start of the warm up
Overtraining phase 3
Overload zone player 2 but the pain/fatigue fades during warm up

player feels muscle pain/fatigue at lhe start of lhe training,


Overtraining phase 4
but the muscle pain/fatigues fades during training
Muscle pain/fatigue is constantly present during lhe
Overtraining phase 5
training session.
0%
60min 90min 120min 150min 180min Overtraining phase 6 Training is no longer possible.

Duration Table 11.3: Overtraining detection scale


Fig. 11.4: This is a typica/ representation of a group of soccer pfayers. Here we have if/ustrated lhe
overload zones for three p/ayers. P/ayer 1 is a physically weaker p/ayer. Player 2 is a physical/y This table can be used to question the players, such as by using questionnaires or
moderate pfayer, and p/ayer 3 is a physica/fy strong p/ayer who is ab/e to handfe a high load. For
lhe sake ofthis examp/e, we discuss three training foads, T1, T2 and T3. smartphone apps, when they arrive at the club each morning. This subjective infor-
~ation can be used by the coaches to adjust training parameters.
FITN ESS 1N SOCCER
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER 195
194 Training continuum J
Trainíng continuum

11.5 TRAINING FLAWS 11.6 RELATION BETWEEN LOAD, INJURIES, FITNESS AND PERFORMANCE
Several authors have discussed flaws in the training process (Harre, 1982; Fry et al., ! ln this section, we describe a theoretical concept to describe the relationship bet-

'
1992; Noakes, 1991; Dalton, 1992; Fosteret ai., 1999; Bompa, 1999; Dick, 2003; Smith, ween training load, injuries, fitness and performance in soccer. We start with the
2003). These training flaws are summarized below: scientific fundaments of our concept.

• Improper balance between intensity and recovery 11.6.1 Relation between load and performance


Inappropriate lifestyle
Insufficient support of the social environment
11 Relation between volume of training and team
f
• Neglecting adequate recovery in the microcycle, mesocycle, and macrocycle success
sequences
Adapted from: Ekstrand et ai. 1982
• High volume of maximal and submaximal intensity training 1 Hlgh

l
• The overall volume of intense training is too high
0
Excessive attention and time are spent in complex technical or mental aspects
without adequate physical and mental recovery
• Demands on an athlete are made too quickly relative to load tolerance, com- 1
promising the adaptive process
0 Improper technique
• Muscle weaknesses and imbalances
• Early specialization
• Not enough or too many hard training sessions
• Starting intensive training sessions without a proper "aerobic" platform Low Hours of tra!nlng Hlgh

• Excessive number of competitions with maximum physical and psychological


demands combined with frequent disturbances in the daily routine and insuf- Fig. 11.5: Relationship bet>veen volume oftraining and team success
ficient training
• The player lacks trust in the coaching staff because of high expectations or goal Ekstrand et al. (1982) found a direct association between team success in soccer,
setting that has led to frequent performance decrements or failure in the past as expressed by league points during the year, and the volume of training. In this
0
The training load is increased too rapidly after a break from training due to shtdy, the volume of training for each team was expressed as the number of prac-
illness, injury or the off-season tice hours in which the 15 players participated (i.e., attendance multiplied by num-
• Not altemating hard and easy training ber of practice sessions).

Some authors (Pyne, 1996; Daniels, 1998; Harre, 1982) have published some recom-
mendations to avoid overtraining and elicit adaptation:

0 Long-term performance goals for the season form the basis upon which the
training program is designed
• Progressive and cyclical increase in training load
0 Incorporating a maximum of 2-3 hard sessions in a microcycle
0
Logical sequence to the order of the training phases
• Hard and easy training sessions are alternated
• Training process is supported by continuous scientific monitoring
• Intensive use of recovery strategies throughout the training program
• Emphasis on skill development and refinement maintained throughout the
training program
• Underlying platform for the improvement and maintenance of general athletic
abilities
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
196 Training continuum Training continuum 1197

11.6.2 Relation between training load and injuries


Relation between training and number of injuries
Adapted from: Ekstrand et ai. 1982
Relation between training load and
,,,,,~--------------------------
likelihood of injury
";•h Adapted from: Gabbett & Domrow 2007,
Gabbett 2010

Low Hours of tralnlng Hlgh

Low Tra!n!ng load High Fig. 11. 7: Relationship between volume of training over a soccer season and the number of injuries

Fig. 11. 6: Relationship between training /oad and the fike/ihood of injury in col/ision sporl athletes Ekstrand et ai. found a curved relationship between injuries and training in soc-
(footnote: This figure is not entire/y accurate in its modification. At vef}' high loads, lhe risk of cer. Teams with fewer than average training hours (<1400 hr/team) showed an
injury pfateaus, and further increases in /oad result in only minimal change in injury risk (Gabbett,
personal communication) increasing number of injuries with increased training, while teams with greater
than average training hours showed a decrease in injuries with increased training
(p < 0.01). The researchers attributed the increasing number of injuries with in-
ln a study of Gabbett (2010), athletes who surpassed a predefined training load creased training to prolonged exposure. The fewer injuries in teams with higher trai-
threshold were 70-fold more likely to test positive for non-contact muscle injury. ning volumes is explained in the study as a reflection of the well-known fact that
Previous research reported a relationship betvveen training loads and injury rates, well-trained athletes sustain fewer injuries. The fact that players in this study did
suggesting that the harder athletes train, the more injuries they will sustain (Gab- not sustain more injuries with increased training could be dueto the levei of the play-
bett, 2004). Gabbett and Domrow (2005) demonstrated that team sport athletes who ers (Division 4 in Sweden). These players are probably not exposed to training loads
perform less than 18 weeks of preseason training are at increased risk of sustaining that are sufficient to elicit overreaching levels and surpass injury threshold levels.
a reinjury, while players with a low off-season V0 2max are at an increased likelihood
of sustaining a contact injury (Gabbett and Dornrow, 2005). 11.6.3 Relation between number of injury days and performance
Enhancements in soccer require training loads that balance the minimum training
loads required to elicit a fitness enhancement 1vith the maximum training load
Relation between number of injury days and the
bearable (load tolerance) before sustaining an injury. Gabbett and Domrow (2005)
found a relationship between the log of training load per week and the odds of final league standing
injury during the pre-, early-, and late-competition phases. These results confirm H!çh
Adapted from: Arnason et ai. 2004
earlier research that demonstrated that the likelihood of sustaining an injury is
higher in the preseason preparation period when training loads are greatest (Gab-
bett, 2004).

HJgh posltion Final le~gue standing Low po~ition

Fig. 11.B: Re/ation between number of injury days and the final league standing
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
198
Training continuum Training continuum 1199

Arnason et al. (2004) investigated the relationship between the number of injury This is a hypothetical representation of the association between training Ioad
days and the final league standing. Injuries to key players, as well as a reduced (x-axis) and injuries, fitness and performance (y-axis).
number of available players, are expected to affect team performance. Although Injury: Injuries are often associated with reductions in performance. It is not clear,
injured players can be replaced by substitutes, the researchers observed a trend however, whether poor performance is the cause or the effect of high injury rates.
toward a significant relationship between the total number of injury days per team The likelihood of training injury increases with mounting training loads (Gabbett,
and team success. They explain this association by the fact that in Iceland, soccer 2004; Gabbett and Domrow, 2005; Gabbett and Ullah; Gabbett, 2010; Gabbett and
teams have limited resources to replace injured players. ln the major European lea- Ullah, 2012). ln this graph, the rate of injury increases exponentially because it
gues, however, teams are in a position to buy new quality players when needed, is assumed that the higher the training load, the more players will surpass their
so it is possible that injuries could be seen to be more of a financial issue and less injury thresholds.
directly related to team performance on the pitch. The association between inju- Fitness: The fitness of players increases with increasing training loads. At some
ries and final league standing was confirmed in a study by Birale et al. (2013). The point (point 8 on the graph), however, the load will become too high for the load
researchers reported strong correlations between injury incidence and high league tolerance of the players. Overtraining will occur, and additional training stimuli
rankings in the Qatari Stars League. They also found a significant relationship bet- will be detrimental to fitness.
ween a lo\v number of injuries and the number of games won, number of goals sco- Performance: Performance is influenced by two antagonistic factors. Injuries affect
red, goal difference, and total number of points in a season. Hãgglund et al. (2013) performance in soccer negatively (Arnason et al., 2004; Hãgglund et al., 2013;
investigated the influence of injuries on team performance in soccer and found that Eirale, 2013), while fitness affects performance positively.
a lower injury burden and higher match availability were related with higher final Point 6 on the graph indicates the optimal relationship between training injury
league ranking. Similarly, lower injury incidence, lower injury burden, and higher and fitness. Injury rates start to increase, but due to the raised levels of fitness,
match availability were related with increased points per league match. The resear- performance reaches its peak level. Fitness leveis increase further with increasing
chers concluded that injuries had a significant influence on performance in league training load (point 7), but the injury rates start to increase exponentially. These
play and in European cups in male professional soccer. They therefore stressed the injury rates influence performance negatively, so performance starts to decrease.
importance of injury prevention to increase a team' s chances of success. The prevention of injuries and the enhancement of fitness are often regarded as two
discrete pursuits at different ends of the training continuum. Medical and technical
staff often appear to have different goals. Medical staff see the value in monitoring
11.6.4 Theoretical concept on the association between load, injuries, fitness training loads to reduce injuries, while technical and sports science staff would like
and performance athletes to complete high training loads to elicit positive physical adaptations. The
key performance indicator of ateam doctor or physiotherapist should theoretically
relate to the "injury" curve on the graph, and they might even be more comfortable
Relation between load, injuries, fitness and with a low training load and a reduction in training (Orchard, 2012). Some soccer
H!gh
performance managers often use injuries as an excuse for poor results because there is still a
common view that injuries are generally random and therefore out of a manager's
contra! (Orchard, 2012).

-
~

- '-
:r_;
...:.. ~
-
••ili·• Injuries
- r Fitness
•••
J ... ·· - -M-Performance
1 .... r'"··
i-·~·ili-·····l&:·····i.-.; .. SUMMARY
lo ••
1 2 3 4 s 6 7 8 9 10
low Tralning load (AU) High A successful periodized soccer training program must involve overload in order
to induce beneficial training adaptations, but it must also avoid the combination
of excessive overload and inadequate recovery. In order to optimize perfo1mance
Fig. 11.9: Relationship between training load and fitness, performance and injuries (modified from enhancement and ensure that players reach the fitness levei requiredr scienti-
Orchard, 2012) fic monitoring of training loads is essential to help players avoid accumulating
excessive fatigue and surpassing their own individual load tolerance and injury
threshold.
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
2001 Training continuum Fatigue i 201

REFERENCES
Amaoon, A., Sigurd%on, S.B., Gudmundr,son, ,\, and Holme, L, 2{){).j. Phyoic,11 fün~r.. injurie,;, and tcam pcrfonnanre in socccr. Medicine
and Scfonre in SporbJ and Excrosc, 36(2), pp.271.>-285.
Budgelt, R., Ncwsholme, E., Ldrniann, 1'L, Sharp. C., Joncr., D., Peto, T., Collin>, D., Ncnirkar, R. and White, P., 2000. Rcdefining thc ovcr·
training syndromc as thc uncxplulncd undcrpcrfomrnnre syndromc. British ]ou ma! of Sporls Medicine, 34, pp.67-68.
Bompa, T.O., 1999. Pcriodiialion: thcory and rnclhodology of trninlng. ·Uh cd. Charnpaign, JL: Human Kinctics.
Chi, M.Y., Hintz, C.S., Coyle, E.F., Mnrtin, W.H., lvry,J.L., Ncmcth, P.M., Ho!!ooz};J.0., Lowry, O.ti., 1983. Effccts of dctraining on cnzy·
mes of cncrgy rnetabo!ism in indi,idual human mu,cle fibcrn. AmJ Physiol, 2.J.\, pp.276--287.
Costill, D.L., Fink,. W.J., Hargrcaws, M., King. D.S., Thomíls, !\. and Ficlding. !\., 1985. Metílboliccharactcristics of "kelctal musdeduring
dctraining lrom compeli tive owimmcrn. Mcd Sei Sports E><cr<:, 17, pp.339-343.
1
Coylc, E.F., Mílrtin, W.H., Sinacorc, D.!\., /oyncr, M./., Hagbcrg. J.M. ílnd Hollosky J.O., 19S-1. Tim<> rnuroc oi Ioos of adaptation,; after
slopplng prolongcd inten.'c endurance training. JAppl Physiol, 57, pp.1857-1864.
Dalton, S.E., 1992. Ovcruoe injuries in adolescent athlctcs. Sports Mcd., 13(1), pp.58-70.
Dílniclo, )., 1998. Danicb' running fonnula. Champaign, JL: Human Kinetie5.
Dkk. F.W., 2002. Sports training principies. 4th ed, London: Aand C Black. p.214.
Eirale, C, ToL J.L., Farooq. A, Smilcy, F. and Ch.1L1bL H., 2013. Low injury rate slrongly rorrcfo1c" with tcam succeso in Qutari profcSli͕
onal football. llr J Sports Med, 47, pp.$07-8.
Ekstrand, /., Gillqui!;t, J., Mõller, M., Oberg. B. and Liljedahl, S.O., 1983. lncidence of soccer injuries and thcir relation to trnining and te~m
FATIGUE
suo:ess. Thc American joumal of 5ports medicine, 11(2), pp.63-7. Jan Van Winckel, Kenny McMillan, Paul Bradley,
Fostcr, C., Danieb, J.T. and Scilcr, S., 1999. Pcrnpcctiveson corrcct appro;ichen to training. ln:J.M. Slcinacl:er, cd. 1999. Ovcrload, perfor-
mance, incompctcnre, and rcgcneration in sport. Ncw York: Kluwcr Academk/Plcnum Publishcrs. pp.27-11. David Tenney, Werner Helsen
Fry; A.C, Kracmcr, W.j., S1one, M.H., Kcam")~ J.T., Flcck, S.J., Thru~h, J., Gordon, S.E., and TriplctL N.T., 1992. Endocrinc and per·
fonnance w.;ponscs during one month of pcriodiicd wcight!ifting with amino acid supplcmcntation. ). Appl. Sport Sei. Rcs., 6:(183).
Gabbclt, T.J., 200-1. lnflucnre of training and matcll intcnnity on injuries in rugby lcaguc. Joumal ofSportsSdcnces, 21, pp.409-117.
Gabb<!tt T.J. and Domrow, N., 2005. Ri!;k foctors for injury in subclitc rugby lcague playcrs. Am JSports Mcd, 33(3), pp.428-34.
Gabbclt, T.J., 2010. Thc dcvclopmcnt and ;ipplication of an injury prediction model for nonrontact, soft·tissue injurie~ in elite rollioion
sport athlcte5. J Strcngth Cond Rl'!<, 2-1(10), pp.2593-2603.
Gabbctt, T./. and Jcnkin.•, D.G., 2011. Rc!ationship bctwccn training load and injury in profossional rugby !cague pluycr.;. J Sci Mcd
Spor~ 14(3), pp.204·9.
Gabbctt, T.J. and Ullah, S., 2012. Rclationship bctwccn running loads and solHiosuc injury in elite tcam sport athlctcs.J Strcni;th Cond
Jk;, 26(4), pp.953-60.
Halson, S.L., and jeukendrup, A.E., 2004. Does ovcr·training cxist? An analy:;is of o•·crrcacliini; and overtmining rescarch. Sports Medi·
dnc, 34(14), pp.%7·981.
HSgglund, M., W,1ld~n, M., Magnu%on, H., Kristcnson, K., Bcngmson, H. and Ekstmnd,J., 2013. lnjurics affcct team perfonnance nci;;a·
tively in profe'"--sional foolball: an ll·ycar fo1low·upof1hc UEFAChampion,; Leaguc injury study. Br JSports Mcd, 47, pp.738-742.
Harre, O., l9S2. Prindplesof sports training: introduction to lhe th•'O'}' and mcthods oi training. ht cd. Bcrlin: Sportwrlag.
Houmard, J.A., Hortobngyl, T. nnd Johns, R.A., 1992. Effocts of shorHcrm training CC'"--SJtion on pcrfonnancc measureo in di!;tance run·
ncrs. !nt J Sports Mcd, 13, pp.sn~S76.
Houston, M.E., Bentzen, H. and Larscn, H., 1979. Intcrrclationships lx:twcen "kclctal mu~deadaptations nnd performance as studied by
detmining and retraining. Acta Physiol Sc.1nd, 105, pp.163-170.
Kreidcr, R., Ff)l A.C. and O'Toolc, M., 1998. 01:crtraining in sport: lcmu;, dcfinitions, ;ind prevalcncc. ln: R. Krcldcr, A.C. Fry and M. 12.1 INTRODUCTION
O'Toolc, cds. 1998. Ovcrtraining in sport. Ornmpaign, IL: Human Kinctirn. pp.7.<).
Martin, W.H., Coyle, E.F., Bloomfield,A.S. and Ehsan~ A.A., 1936. Effccts of physiol dcronditioningafterintcnsc cndurance trainingon Throughout this textbook, the management of fatigue is considered as a critical
lcít ventricular dimcru;ions and strokc volume. J Am Coll Cardiol, 7, pp.9!.12-939
Mccuscn. R., Do dos, M., Foster, C., ff)", A., Glccson. M., Nicman, D., Rag!in, / ., Rictjcns, G., Stcinackcr, )., Urhauscn, A, 2013. Prevcntion.
component to successfully plan a soccer season. Before discussing in more detail
diagnosis and !reatmenl oi the ovcrtraining syndromc: Joint conscn5us statcmcnt oi thc Europcan College ofSport Scicnce {ECSS) and
lhe Amcrican College of Spor!s Mcdicin<> (ACS!'.1). Europcan Joumal of Sport SdcnC<', 13(1), pp.1·24.
the methods of managing fatigue, let us first examine the term fatigue in this chap-
Moore, C.A. and Ff); A.C., 2007, Nonfunchonal ovcrreaching during ofí·scaoon training for skill po:;ition plílycr-J in collegialc Amcrimn ter. There are many definitions of fatigue in the existing literature. Fatigue is mostly
8occer. /ouma1 ofStrength and CondHionong rer.car<:h, 21{3), pp.793·800.
Morgan, W.P., Costill, O.C., Flynn, M.G, Rílr;lin, J.S. and O' Connor, l"J., 19S.S. Mood disturbancc following incrc,1scd training in swim· defined as an acute impairment of performance that includes both an increase in
mcrn. Mcd Sei Sports &cr<:, 20, pp.40S-11·1.
Mujika L and Padilla, S, W03. Scicnlificba~cs for prernmpctition tapcring slrntcgh.'!<. Mcd Sci Sports E><crc, 35(7), pp.1182·7. the perceived effort to exert a desired force or povver and / or any reduction in the
Noak'-".l, T.D., 1991. Lore of running. 3rd ed. Olílmpílign. lL: Humnn Kinctics.
Olivicra, N., ki;;rnndb. R., Hogcza, J., l.lerthoinb, S. ~nd Wciwbndd T., 2003. Arrét d<> l'cntraincmcnt ct Mconditionncmcnt à l"cffort ability to exert maximal muscle force or power (Gandevia, 2001). ln soccer, fatigue
aérobie. Sciencc&Sport, 23(~). pp.136--M·l.
On:hard, /., 2002.. Undcrstanding wmeof thc risks for rnft 1i"5uc injury-;i Malcolm l.llight legacyí J Sei Mcd Sport, 5(2), pp.5·7.
is generally referred to as an inability to maintain physical and technical perfor-
Or<:hard, J.W., 2009. On thc valucoftcam medical slafi: can the "Moncyball" approach bcapplicd to injuries in profossíonal football? l.lr
J Sports Mcd, 13(13), pp.9f>3.5.
mance during a match. The exercise intensity of top-class soccer players declines in
On:hard, J.W., James, T., Portur,, M., Kountouris, A. and Oennis, R., 2009. Fa>t bowlcr.; ln cricket dcmon:;lratc up to 3· to 4·wcck dday periods during a game, most likely due to fatigue, particularly toward the end of
betw°"'n high workloads and inc..,aoed risk ofinjury. AmJ Sports Mcd, 37(6), pp.1186-92.
Orchurd, 2012. Who is to biame for ali thc footbal! injuries? !online] Availablc at: <;http:/ fblogs.bmj.rom/bjsm/2012/06/20/ the match (Mohr et ai., 2005).
w fio..is--10· blilmL.. for·all· thc· foo tl>il ll·injuric.< />
Prne, O., 1996. Tiw periodizalion oi swimming training Qt lhe Australian tnstitute ofSport. Sporls Coach, 18, pp.34-8. Although extensive research has examined the causes of fatigue in soccer, a number
Smith, D.J., 2003. A framcwork for undcrstanding the training proccss Jc,1ding to elite pcrfonnnncc. Sports Mcd., 33(15), pp.1103·26.
Stcinackcr, J., Lonncs, W., Liu, Y., Rcis.mcckcr, S., Opitz·Grc%, A., Ilallcr, B., Gtinthcr, K.. Pclerson, K.G., Kallus, K.W., Lchmann, M. and of questions remain. The molecular basis of the fatigue process, in particular, is still
Altenburg, D., 2000. Training of Junior Rowcrs before Wor!d ChampionEhips. Effccts on pcrfonnance, moodstatc andsdectcd honnonal
and mctabolic reoponses. J Sports Mcd Phys Fítness, •IO, pp.327-35 ..
not understood completely. There are different causes for different types of sport.
For example, the fatigue induced by an SOOm run is completely different to that of
a marathon. The loss of muscle function is quite complex and varies from reduced
functioning of the motor cortex in the brain to the binding of actin and myosin.
There are various causes of fatigue, and scientists typically divide them into cen-
tral and peripheral factors. Fatigue can be classified as central when the origin is
proximal and/ or peripheral when the origin is distal to the neuromuscular junction
(Gandevia, 2001). Central fatigue seems to be the main cause of the decline in maxi-
mal voluntary contraction and sprinting ability, whereas peripheral fatigue seems
to be more related to increased muscle soreness and therefore may be linked with
muscle damage and inflammation (Rampinini et al., 2011).

FACULDAIJ~ n~ DESPORTO
DA UNIVERSIDADE DO PORTO
zoz I FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
i 203
Fatigue Fatigue

12.2 FATIGUE IN A SOCCER MATCH Rahnama et ai. This study compareci the strength (measured wilh isokinetic equipment) of
One of the consequences of playing a match is a decrease in muscle power, which (2003) the knee flexors (hamstrings) and the knee extensors {mainly quaciriceps).
The strength of lhe two muscle groups haci already decreased ciuring
is reflected by a drop in physical capacity toward the end of the match. Research the break and ciiminisheci further towarci the end of lhe match. The ratios
initially primarily focused on peripheral factors, such as diminished energy stores, between both muscle groups fell, reducing lhe stability of the knee joint.
increase in body core temperature, fluid loss, muscle damage and various com-
binations of factors. Recently, more attention has been paid to the central factors, Rahnama et al. ln this stuciy, the fatigue of a number of muscles in a soccer match was
(2006) measured. This shows that fatigue during a match increaseci for various
mental fatigue and the role of the nervous system. Generally speaking, it can be
muscles (rectus femoris, biceps femoris, tibialis anterior) towarci lhe enci of
concluded that physical performance decreases toward the end of a match (Rampi- the game.
nini et al., 2008), although one cannot discount the influence of tactics and context
Rampinini et ai. A top ltalian team covers a greater distance anci works more ai high
(e.g., match importance, location, standard and score board) on the physical per- (2007) intensity in top games when compareci with games ata lower levei.
formance of players. Therefore, it has been suggested that fatigue can be more effi- Rellly (2003) Diminished performance is inversely proportiona! to VOzmo>'
ciently quantified using performance measurements (e.g., the distance run during a
Reilly et ai. Diminisheci sprinting performance was observeci at the enci of a match.
match). Evidently, this is a difficult task because players do not always tax their full (2002)
capacity during a match and only usually tax themselves during intense periods of
Strudwick and The ciistance covereci ciuring a match has increased significantly since the
match play when they carry out a flurry of high-intensity activities with minimal Reilly (2001) introciuction of lhe Premier League.
recovery. Recent research pointed out that senior soccer players are able to cope
Van Gool et ai. Van Gool et al. stuciied lhe ciistance run during matches in the Be!gian
with the high demands of match play and demonstrated that no differences were (1988) league. A distance of 444m was run in the first ha!f.
found in examples such as counter movement jumps executed both directly before
and after a match (Cortis et al., 2013). It might be that teams and players pace their Tabfe 12. 1: OveNiew ofexisting soccer Jiterature.
efforts in order to sustain the sarne work rate throughout the duration of the game,
suggesting that players may exert an effort below their physical capacity in the first 1
half as an energy conservation technique (Carling et al., 2008). 12.3 UNDERLYING MECHANISMS OF FATIGUE

Research Findings 12.3.1 Metabolic effects


The decrease in muscle function is
Bangsbo et ai. The distance covered in lhe first half was 5°/o greater than in the second
(1991)
referred to as peripheral fatigue.
half.
During a soccer match, maximum
Bradley and Players covering the most total distance in lhe first half illustrated lhe mos! strength rarely decreases by more
Nonkes (2013) pronounced declines in the seconci half. This was not evident for players
covering moderate anci low first half distances than 30% because of new motor
units being recruited when needed.
Bradley et ai. Players ran 21 % less distance at high intensity in lhe last 15 minutes of lhe
(2009) match compareci with the first 15 minutes. ln addition, synergistic muscles
Bradley et ai. The distance covered at high speed was 18o/o lower in lhe last 15 minutes
can help compensate for any loss
(2010) of lhe malch compareci with lhe first 15 minutes. of strength. Muscle strength fa11s
Krustrup et ai. Players' performance over a 30m sprint dropped ciuring lhe break and
by around 10% after brief intense
(2006) immeciialely after the match. exertions and can drop to 30% after
long physical exertions. This fati-
Mohr et ai. (2003) The distance covereci in lhe second half was 160m less lhan in lhe first
half. gue could be caused by metabo-
lic factors, such as a reduction of
Mohr et ai. (2003) A 5-minute perioci of increaseci intensity is fol!oweci by a period of
significantly less activity.
adenosine triphosphate (ATP) and
creatine phosphate (CP) stores, a
Rahnama et at. The risk of injury was grealer in lhe firsl anci lasl 15 minutes of lhe match.
depletion of muscle glycogen, or
(2002)
drops in pH due to muscle acido-
Gaudino et ai. They conc!ucieci lha! there are significanl differences between lhe first anci sis, as well as biochemical factors
(2010) second ha!ves of lhe game. The distances covereci in the seconci half,
when compareci to the first half, are significantly lower for ai! categories of such as chlorine (CI·), sodium (Na+), potassium (K+), calcium (Ca2+), lack of oxygen
run (p<0.05). ln lhe seconci half, lhe dislance covered ai very high intensity (hypoxia), and structural damage (e.g., micro-traumas). Diminished functioning
is significantly lower (p<0.01), while lhe number of recovery times greater
than 120s increases significantly compareci to lhe first half (p<0.01 ). of a muscle can also be of a neural origin through the reduced functioning of the
motor cortex in the brain. This process is referred to as central fatigue.
1 FITN ESS 1N SOCCER
204 FITNESS IN SOCCER
Fatigue
Fatigue ! 20s

12.3.2 Glycogen stores


Although lactate and acidosis are often referred to as possible causes of fatigue in
The depletion of glycogen stores in the muscles can be a contributing factor to fati-
soccer, it is unlikely that elevated muscle lacta te and lowered muscle pH cause fati-
gue in soccer. ln a study by Krustrup et al. (2006), a high number of individual
gue during a soccer game (Mohr et al., 2005).
muscle fibers were partly depleted of glycogen toward the end of a soccer match.
They concluded that low glycogen leveis in individual muscle fibers explained
the impairment in sprinting at the end of the game. Furthermore, a decrease in 1.s
blood lactate toward the end of matches indicates a lower utilization of glycogen
(Bangsbo, 1994). Players also complete fewer sprints and work less "off-the-ball" 7.4
in the second half if they start a match with low glycogen stores (Saltin, 1973).
7.3
However, blood glucose concentration does not reach criticai values during a "8
soccer match (Ekblom, 1986). Glycogen stores can be increased through training ~ 7.2
.5
adaptations. :r
~

'·'
7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
Lactate {mmol/I}

Fig. 12.2: Relation between pH in blood and /actate. Acidosis is not caused by lactate but rather by
processes closely linked to lhe production of /actate.

12.3.4 Fatigue resulting from lhe rate ofthe energy supply


o 2 3 4 5 = - Perceived exertion Muscles need oxygen in order to tum over energy via the oxidative system. Oxy-
Duratfon (hours)
- - Muscle glycogen gen is transported to the muscles by the blood. In the blood, hemoglobin binds with
oxygen. The quantity of hemoglobin in the blood determines the speed at which
Fig. 12. 1: Relationship between muscle g/ycogen and perceived exertion o ver lime.
fatigue occurs during periods of intensive physical exertion. A second factor is the
oxygen-binding capacity. At high altitudes, the 0 2 pressure of inhaled air is lower
than at sea level, causing fatigue to occur more rapidly.
Consuming an energy drink containing carbohydrates (CHO) during the half-
time interval, or using good nutrition strategies during the days leading up to the
12.3.5 Exercise-induced muscle damage (EIMD) and delayed onset of
match, can therefore delay fatigue (see Chapter 4).
muscle soreness (DOMS)
A player may feel pain in his or her muscles after a match or strenuous training.
This is often attributed to a buildup of lacta te in the muscles, but this is an incorrect
12.3.3 Lactate and Acidosis
hypothesis. Muscles are put under strain during physical activity, and if a muscle
There is a discrepancy bet'vveen blood lactate and muscle lactate. Muscle lactate
is overloaded (in particular eccentrically), microtraumas occur in the muscle tis-
increases linearly with the intensity. while blood lactate increases exponentially.
sue, resulting in damage to muscle cells and capillaries. This mechanism develops
The intracellular accumulation of lactate per se is nota major factor in muscle fati-
an inflammatory reaction, which can be established via a blood analysis. Reduced
gue (Allen et al., 2009). The formation of lactate rather delays the fatigue process.
muscle force, increased muscle soreness, increased concentrations of blood creatine
One of the consequences of anaerobic glycolysis is that hydrogen ions are produced
kinase (CK) and myoglobin (two indicators of muscle damage) are higher after
in addition to lactic acid. This causes acidosis in the cell. Acidity is expressed as a
intensive physical activity, and these may be factors that contribute to performance
pH value. The higher the pH value is, the more alkaline the sample is. The pH value
impairment after a match (Ascensão et al., 2008). Furthermore, overtraining causes
can vary between O and 14, with 7.0 being the neutral value. Everything greater
a buildup of residual substances, causing the capillaries to dílate so the residual
than 7.0 is alkaline, and everything less than 7.0 is regarded as acidic. The pH value
substances are easier to remove. This involves an accumulation of fluid in the mus-
in a resting muscle is approximately 7.4. This value is important for most enzymes,
cles, causing the blood vessels to contract and resulting in a Jack of oxygen. The
because they only function in an optimum way at values of around 7.4. This is why
pain a player feels one or two days after strenuous exertion is therefore the result
there are a number of buffers built into the cell to absorb these hydrogen ions. Over
of pressure on the pain nerves in the muscles and the release of residual substances
time, however, the buffer capacity of cells is exceeded, and the pH value in a cell
that stimulate the nerves.
can fall to 6.9.
ZOG I FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
Fatigue
207
Fatigue

12.3.6 Muscle cramps 12.3.8 Early dismissal


A cramp is a painful involuntary contraction of a group of muscles. Cramps mostly Carling and Bloomfield (2010) examined the effects of an early dismissal (after five
occur at the end of a soccer match. It is often claimed that cramps are a result of minutes of play) on work rate in a professional soccer match. The researchers pro-
lactate or lack of fitness. Both claims are most probable not true, because muscle pose that in 11 vs. 11, players may not always utilize their full physical potentials,
cramps mostly occur in soccer players who have reached a certain levei of fitness. as this match illustrated an increase in overall work rate when reduced to 10 play-
Muscle cramps can most likely be attributed to loss of fluid during the match and ers. They conclude that ateam with 10 players is likely to incur higher levels of fati-
muscle fatigue. Minerais such as calcium, iron, magnesium, potassium and sodium gue, and tactical alterations may be necessary and/ or players may adopt a pacing
are lost insweat. Sweat contains approxirnately between 300 and 1500 mg of sodium strategy to endure the remainder of the match.
per liter. Since soccer players may lose more than three liters of water during mat-
ches (Mustafa and Mahmoud, 1979), they can also lose 3,000mg of sodium during
a match. Sodium lasses in three liters of sweat can equal or exceed daily intake 12.3.9 Travei
(3,000-4,000mg) and lead to deficiencies. To prevent cramps, it is advisable to drink Elite soccer players are frequent travelers and sometimes have to cross multiple
at regular intervals and eat a balanced diet during the week. With some players time zones. These journeys are undertaken to participate in club or international
who have high sodium concentrations in their sweat, it is often noticeable that their competition in single engagements or for more prolonged tournaments, such as the
shirts display areas of sweat with white fragments after physical exertion. These World and European cups. On other occasions, soccer players take advantage of
white fragments are the lost sodium. Stofan et al. (2003) reported that American altitude or seasonal differences in weather conditions to attend training camps in
Football players with high sodium concentrations in their sweat may be particu- other parts of the world where the climate is more favorable to strenuous exercise
larly susceptible to muscle cramps (Stofan et al., 2003). Bergeron (2003) suggested (Reilly et al., 2007). Traveling is associated with negative effects such as stiffness
that failure to adequately replace sweat salt losses predisposes players to muscle because of being in a cramped posture for too long, anxiety about the journey, the
cramps in teruris and proposes that these can be prevented by ensuring an adequate change to an individual's daily routine, and dehydration dueto time spent in the
salt intake. The most common form of sodium is sodium chloride, or table salt. dry air of the aircraft cabin. Travel fatigue lasts for only a day or so, but for those
Milk and celery also naturally contain sodium, as does drinking water, although who fly across several time zones, there are also the longer-lasting difficulties asso-
the amount varies depending on the brand of mineral water. Water is commercially ciated with "jet lag." The problem of jet lag can last for over a \.Veek if a flight cros-
available that contains larger quantities of electrolytes. ln hot or humid conditions, ses 10 time zones or more and reduce performance (Waterhouse et al., 2004). The
it is reasonable to plan an intake of up to l,OOOmg (one-half teaspoon of salt) of body clock gradually adapts to the local time of the new environment, and when
sodium per liter of fluid loss. this process is complete, the symptoms of jet lag disappear (Lemmer et al., 2002).
It appears also ineffective to train hard at home prior to embarkation, because arri-
12.3.7 Temperature and fluid loss ving tired at the airport of departure may slow the adjustment later (Waterhouse
An increase in body core temperature is beneficial for performance. Warming up et al., 2003). The sarne negative effects can be experienced while attempting to shift
the muscles prior to the game and after the half-time break raises the performance the phase of the body clock in the required direction for some days prior to depar-
levei. However, an excessively high body temperature (hyperthermia) reduces a ture, and this is counterproductive because the quality of training and subsequent
player's performance. Factors such as dehydration and hyperthermia have been performance can be compromised by this strategy (Reilly and Maskell, 1989). Some
suggested as mediators responsible for the development of fatigue in the later sta- data have shown that eastward travei is more detrimental to performance. This is
ges of a soccer game (Reilly, 1997). This is most likely a central form of fatigue, whe- because the body clock's rhythm is naturally longer than the 24-hour light-dark
reby a criticai core temperature of 40ºC cannot be exceeded (Morrison et al., 2004). cycle (approximately 25-26h long), so it is easier for the body to adapt to changes
However, there may not be an exact criticai threshold for thermoregulation, but that lengthen the day rather than shorten it (Leatherwood and Dragoo, 2013).
rather one that varies \.Vith training, acclimation and time of day (Noakes, 2006).
Various publications have demonstrated that training and competing in hot and/
or humid conditions may result in reduced performances (Edwards and Clark,
2006; Duffield et ai., 2009). A study of Mohr et ai. (2010) provides direct evidence of
decreased repeated sprint and jump performances induced by soccer match play
and pronounced reduction in high-intensity running toward the end of an elite
game played in a hot environment. They conclude that this fatigue could be associ-
ated with training status and hyperthermia/ dehydration.
2os I FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
i 209
Faâgue Fatigue

12.3.9.1 Recommendations to decrease the effect of air travei on performance 12.4 EFFECTS OF FATIGUE
(Leatherwood and Dragoo, 2013): Performance-related symptoms

General performance Decline


0 ln advance of travel, shift the body clock to the new time zone using gradual,
one-hour-a-day shifts in sleep scheduling. This recommendation contradicts Recovery periods lncrease
the advice oi Reilly and Maskell (1989). Technical execution Decline
• Circadian phase shifting can be facilitated by proper timing of Iight exposure
Kicking speed Decline
an<l the use of supplemental melatonin, taken orally in doses ranging from 2
to5mg. Kicking precision Decline

• Exposure to natural daylight is preferred over exposure to artificial light. Number of bad passes lncrease
• Expose travelers to social contact at times appropriate for the local time at the Concentration Decline
destination.
Fatigue lncrease
• Avoid caffeine during travei, as this stimulant can interfere with appropriately
timed restorative sleep and alter the ability to effectively adapt to a new time Test-related symptom
zone. Muscle strength Decline
0 Short (20-30 min) naps can be helpful in recovering from sleep deprivation Decline
Muscle speed strength
and restoring a normal state of arousal.
Coordination Decline
o Consume extra fluids for the duration of air travel to combat dehydration.
Avoid alcohol and caffeine, as these act as diuretics and can increase fluid Time (endurance, speed, agility, repeated sprinting capacity) Jncrease
losses. Technical execution Decline
0 If possible, make arrangements for dietary selections that are optimal for indi-
Technical precision Decline
vidual performance. While travelling, eat smaller meals before and during
flight. Then, upon arrival, time meals to match habits appropriate to the Subjective fatigue lncrease

destination. Subjective muscle pain lncrease


0 If travelling outside of the country, avoid non-bottled water and raw or mini- Decision making lncrease or remains lhe sarne
mally cooked foods, as well as peel fruits and vegetables that have been
washed. Tabfe 12.2: Overview ofthe effects offatigue in soccer.

12.4.1 Overview of the effects on physical performance


ln the preceding paragraphs, we gave an overview of the effects of fatigue during
soccer matches:
0 Decreased distance in the second half
0 After intense periods in the first half, players' sprint performances were signi-
ficantly reduced (Krustrup et ai., 2003)
o Peak sprinting speed was higher during the first five minutes of the first half
when compared with the second half (Bangsbo et al., 2010)
0 Less high-intensity activities (Andersson et al., 2008)
o Fewer sprints
• Impaired sprint performances in the initial phase of the second half when
compared with the first half (Mohr et ai., 2004)
o Longer recovery times between actions (Bangsbo et al., 2010; Bangsbo and
Mohr, 2005)
• Decreased activity after the most active periods
• Decreased passing precision (Rampinini et al., 2008)
o Mean sprint length decreased toward the end of the game (Mohr et al., 2010)

• Less distance at high intensity


• Increased risk of injuries
0 Diminished maximum speed (Anderson et al., 2008)
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
210
Fatigue Fatigue i 211

12.4.2 Technical skills ces the delaying of fatigue and leads to better results (Wilmore, 1968). Finally, it has
If fatigue increases, this will not be at the expense of techniqu~ in the first instance. also been shown that the stress hormone, adrenaline, was higher before and after
This has been evidenced by Davids et aL (2003) in their "dynamic systems theory," official matches as opposed to friendly matches in tennis (Ferrauti, 2001).
meaning that a reorganization of movements will produce a technical variation in
the first phase, but the output or result will remain the sarne. When a ball is kicked,
for example, the movement is carried out through different joints (i.e., hip, knee, Belgium first division (5 seasons)
and ankle) and muscles. A reorganization of the motion will cause the movement
Home Away Quarter
to be executed differently, but the output will remain the sarne on account of the
Over
body deploying other motor units. ln the second phase, both the technique and the Win Drm.'I Los! Win Draw Lost 0·15 16-30 3145 46-60 61-75 76-90
time
result are diminished (i.e., "technique deterioration"). ln a soccer match for exam- 412 S16 608
513 312 321 407 429 825 191 S93 408 79
ple, kicking speed and accuracy will decrease as fatigue increases (McMorris and
Rayment, 2007; Appiantono et ai., 2006). This was confirmed by Russell et ai. (2013)
when they demonstrated that soccer-specific exercise influenced the quality of per-
formance in gross motor skills, such as passing and shooting. Jordeta et al. (2007) Netherlands first division (5 seasons)
investigated the role of fatigue in taking penalty kicks and found a trend that was
Home Away Quarter
in the direction of more goals with shorter playing times.
Over
Win Draw Lost Win Draw Los! 0-15 16·30 3145 46·60 61-75 76·90
lime
12.4.3 Biomechanical factors 359 230 244 276 278 sas 132 276 404 323 390 379 68
In sports •vhere speed has to be used for a relatively long period, such as sprinting,
speed diminishes (e.g., by around 7% in the lOOm and almost 20% in the 400m) Tab/e 12.3: Overview of yel/ow cards given in the Belgian and Outch first dfvision o ver 5 seasons.
(Sprague and Mann, 1983). This is caused, in particular, by decreased stride fre-
quency and increased contact time with the ground. Maximum speed also diminis-
hes quickly in swimming. For example, the length of a breaststroke decreases by
more than 15~~ as fatigue increases (Thompson et al., 2000). 12.5 COUNTERING FATIGUE
Fatigue at the end of a match can be countered. Physical activity can be handled
12.4.4 Decision making economically, of course, so that there is sufficient energy left at the end of the match.
Although only a limited number of studies have looked at the relationship between However, there are also other strategies for counteiing fatigue.
fatigue and decisionmaking (McMorris et al., 1999; Royal et al., 2006), there is a ten-
dency for decisions to be taken more quickly •vhen athletes are fatigued. This may 12.5.1 Training
be explained by greater exercise-induced arousal (Presland et al., 2005). The relationship between a player's fitness and the distance covered in a match
has already been discussed in detail. Although this fitness is, in part, determined
12.4.5 Subjective fatigue genetically, it is of course also defined by the quantity and quality of training. Mohr
A great deal of research has been conducted in relation to the perception of fatigue et al. (2010) demonstrated a significant correlation between training status and fati-
(Baker et al., 2007; St Clair Gibson et ai., 2003; Baldwin et al., 2003; Burgess et al., gue development during match play. In another study of Mohr et al. (2003), the
1991). This subjective fatigue is measured based on the Borg scale or rate of per- physical performance of players during matches was examined. The researchers
ceived exertion (RPE). This perceived fatigue is driven by central factors, but it is showed that the number of training sessions during the week was related to the
mostly determined by peripheral fatigue, such as dehydration, lack of oxygen, rai- distance covered at high intensity. Moreover they showed that that physical perfor-
sed body temperature, low glycogen reserves, and low blood sugar levels. mance decreased significantly if the normal training program was interrupted by a
number of matches. Well-trained athletes thus cover greater distances at different
12.4.6 Psychological factors speeds and need less time to recover between high-intensity activities.
Research has shown that verbal encouragement can improve performance (Gan-
devia, 2001). Athletes are able to delay their fatigue when they receive encourage-
ment. A "hostile audience" can also reduce motivation and intensity, although this
was mainly demonstrated among non-athletes (Fisher, 1976). Players will also get
more yellow cards at away games than in home matches, especially when the team
is losing. The number of yellow cards given to a team is higher toward the end of a
match. This does, of course, also have something to do with the greater risk taken
by teams toward the end of a game. The presence of competitors likewise influen-
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER
FITNESS JN SOCCER l zl3
212 Fatigue
Fatigue

12.5.4 Tapering
12.5.2 Use of substitutes
ln the following section, we will see how fatigue is managed in order to prepare
A reduced work rate bet\veen playing halves could be countered by the strategic
players for matches in an optimum way. One of these "fatigue management" stra-
use of substitute players. Substitutes run a considerably greater distance in the last
tegies is tapering. Adequate tapering strategies have been shown to improve per-
15 minutes than players who are involved in the entire match (Di Salvo et al., 2007).
formance and delay fatigue (Coutts et al., 2007). Bosquet et al. (2007) performed a
This was confirmed by a study of Carling et al. (2010). They demonstrated that
meta-analysis and suggested that the optimal strategy to maximize performance
midfield substitutes covered greater overall and high-intensity distances and had
is a tapering intervention with a two-week period where training volume is pro-
a lower recovery time between high-intensity bouts when compareci with other
gressively decreased by 41-60% but without any modification to either training
rnidfield teammates who continued the match. Forwards covered less distance in
intensity or frequency.
their first ten minutes as a substitute compareci to their habitual work-rate profile in
the opening ten minutes when starting matches, but this finding was not observed
12.5.5 Nutrition
in midfielders. The authors suggest that it may be linked to an inability of these
The use of supplements like high-CHO drinks and caffeine may delay fatigue. The
players to "get into the game." The strategic use of substitutes can help a team's
potential of low-dose caffeine ingestion (2-5mg/kg of body mass) to enhance end-
physical performance.
urance performance is well established. However, in the case of soccer, care must be
taken not to overdose because visual information processing might become impai-
12.5.3 Acclimation
red (Hespel et ai., 2007). Good nutritional strategies during the week are extremely
The negative effects of competing in heat (hyperthermia) or at a high altitude
important for replenishing the glycogen reserves in the muscle to the maximum, as
(reduction in oxygen) can be countered by acclimation strategies. The adaptati-
well as for providing sufficient proteins to help muscle development and minerals
ons are dictated by combinations of environmental and individual characteristics
to improve the functioning of the muscles. The physical requirements of soccer
(Maeda, 2005).
training and match play draw heavily on players' CHO stores, so the benefits of
good nutritional practices for performance and health should be an essential part
Heat
of players' education, particularly for the parents of young players (Williams and
The elevated tolerance induced by the acclimatization of internai temperature is
Serratosa, 2006).
about 0.2ºC (Patterson et al., 2004), although it should be noted that some athle-
tes will never adapt to exercising or competing in heat.
12.5.6 Pre-cooling
The use of pre-cooling strategies prior to exercise significantly delays the occur-
Altitude
rence of fatigue and improves performance (Duffield et ai., 2010; Quod et al., 2008;
Altitude affects athletic performance in a negative manner. The reduction in oxy-
Castle et al., 2006). The logic for this is that pre-cooling will extend the time before
gen partial pressure in the atmospheric air, because of altitude ascent, reduces
reaching the criticai core temperature (Price et ai., 2009). Although evidence for
oxygen availability and consequently reduces performance. FIFA banned inter-
the transfer of these findings to a valid soccer environment is limited, pre-cooling
national matches above 2,500 meters in 2007 and suspended, under pressure,
may reduce physiological and perceptual loads to improve performance for soccer
the ban in May 2008. Traveling to lower altitudes does not affect performance,
training and competition in hot enviromnental conditions (Duffield et al., 2013).
but traveling to a higher altitude has negative effects. In particular, away teams
However, these pre-cooling effects are largely lost during the first half. Direct skin
perform poorly in Quito, Ecuador (2,800 meters), and La Paz, Bolivia (3,600
cooling >Vith wet/ cold towels (Marsh et al., 1999) or holding the hands in cold water
meters). However, away teams do relatively well in Bogotá, Colombia (2,550
during the break is a cheap method for keeping the body temperature as low as
meters) (Williams, 2011). Athletes may benefit from altitude acclimation to incre-
possible (Goosey-Tolfrey, 2008). Drinking ice-slushies and water can also improve
ase their performance. The performance-enhancing effects, such as increased
performance in very warm environments (Ross et al., 2011). Duffield et al. (2013)
red blood cell count, could increase performance back at sea level. Although the
investigated the effects of field-based pre-cooling strategies (ice-vests, cold towels,
effects of acclimation on performing at high altitude has been demonstrated in
and 350 mL ice-slushie drinks) for professional soccer players during training and
various research, Aughey et al. (2013) concluded that neither 13 days of acclima-
competition in the heat. The researchers presented equivocai findings for the effects
tization nor lifelong residence at high altitude protects against the detrimental
of pre-cooling for professional soccer players during competitive training and mat-
effects of altitude on the match activity profile (Aughey et al., 2013). Recent rese-
ches in the heat. However, performance and thermoregulatory response trends
a:ch by Buchheit et al. (2013) examined the effects on performance and physiolo-
showed the sarne positive similarities to previous laboratory evidence.
g1cal responses to a 14-day off-season training in heat. The researChers postulate
that the combination of heat and hypoxic exposure during sleep / training might
12.5.7 Recovery
offer a promising "conditioning cocktail" in team sports.
Like every important form of training, adequa te recovery is an essential part of trai-
ning. ln the following chapter on fatigue-management strategies1 we will discuss
recovery strategies extensively.
FITNESS IN SOCCER
2141 Fatigue
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Fatigue i 21s
12.5.8 Sleep fitness and good nutritional practice can help to attenuate the fatigue experien-
Sleep rernains one of the biggest mysteries of general daily life and sports perfor- ced during match play. It is also important that residual fatigue from n1atch play
mance in particular. As a state that seemingly freezes all productive activity and is dealt with as effectively as possible using specific recovery strategies. Fatigue
puts animals in danger of being caught by predators, sleep must serve an important management and recovery strategies are now discussed in the following chapter.
purpose because it has survived so many years of evolution (Sehgal and Mignot,
2011). It is common sense that a "good tiredness" (understood as being physical)
leads to a "good sleep" and, conversely, that a state of "being off form" follows "a REFERENCES
bad night" (Davenne, 2009). Athletes are highly sensitive to any kind of disruptive
Allc11, N.E., Carming, C.G., Shcrrington, C. and Fung, V.S., 2009. Brodykincofo, rnusclc wcokncoc. and rcdu"'d muodc powcr in Pi!rkin-
factors that can desynchronize their circadian rhythms, such as sleep loss, jet lag oon'~ discaw. Mowmcnt Disordcr:;, 2.J(9), pp.134·1· 1351.
Andero5on, H., Ekblom, B. i!nd Krustrup, P., 200S. Elite foo1b.1H on ilrtificiill turf •wsus notural grru;o: movcmcnl patlcm, !cehniml r.!an·
(Waterhouse et al., 2000), or irregular schedules due to training or competitions dards, i!nd playcr imprcsc.ions. / Spor!s Sei, 26, pp.113-122.
Appiantono. T., Nunomc, H., !kcgami, Y. Jnd Silno S., 200{>. Thc cffcct of musdc fatir;uc on instcp kicking kinctics and kincmatics in
(Davenne, 2009). It has long been proven that insufficient sleep can substantially a~sociation footbi!ll. J Sp-0rbJ Sei, U, pp.951·60.
Mccns.'io, A, Rebelo, A., Oliveira, E., l'.farqucs, F., l'crcira, L., i!nd M"&"lh~cs, )., 2GOS. Biochcmiml impact of a wcccr match·analysis oí
reduce fitness (Bougârd et al., 2006; Reilly and Edwards, 2007). Information-pro- oxida tive slrcs.> and mundc darnagc markcr5 throughout rc<:0vcry. Clin Eioehcm, ·11(10- ll), pp.8-11·51-
cessing abilities will also not be as efficient. When sleeping, the brain processes the Aughcy, R.J., Hi!mmond, K., Vi!rlc;~ M.C.,&hmidt, W.F., Bourdon, !';C., !luchhcit, M.,Simpson, B., Garvic.1n·Lcwis, L.A,. Klcy, M., Soria,
R., Snrgcnt, C., Roach, G.D., Claros, /.C., Wachsmuth, N, and Gon.'. C.J., 2013. So=r activlly profi!c of altitude versus sca·lcvel nath·cs
information it receives during the day. Finally, insufficient sleep results in emoti- during acdimatisation !03600 m (lSA3600). Dr JSports Mcd;·l7(l), pp.i107·ill3.
Ilakcr, L.ll., Doughcrt}~ K.A., Cho1'~ M. and Kcnncy, W.L., 2007. Progrcosivc dehydrntion cau,;c~ a progwwivc dcdinc in baskctbnll skill
onal instability. The exercises will feel more difficult, and mental toughness will performance. Mcd Sei Sports Excrc, 39, pp.111.\·23.
Ilnldwin, /., Snow, R.J .. Gibala, M.j., Gamham,A., Howarth, K., nnd Fcbbraio, M.A., 2003. Glyrogcn availabilily does not affcct thc TCA
diminish. When sleeping, people mostly spend 90 minutes ín the first four sleep cydc orTAN poolo during prolonged, fotiguing excrdoe.J Appl Physiol, 9·1, pp.2181-7.
llangsbo,J., Nom.'gaard, L. and Thor~o, F., 1991. Aclivity profilc of compctítion soccer. ClnJ SportsSd, 16, pp.110-116.
phases before entering the REM period. The first cycle of REM sleep lasts around Ilnngsbo, J.. 1994. 111c phrsiology of socC<"r- with spcda! rcfewnce to inlcnse inlcrmHtent cxcrcisc. Acta Physiol Srnnd, 151, pp.1-193.
Ilangsbo, J., Nielscn, ).)., Mohr, M., Randcm, M.B., Krustrup, B.R., Drito, J., Nybo, L. ;md Krustrup, !~, 2010. Performance cnhanccments
10 minutes, with the subsequent REM cycles becoming increasingly longer. The i!nd muscular .1daptalÍO!l5 of a 16-weck rccrcalional football inlcrvcntion for untrnincd womcn. Sc,1nd J Mcd Sd Sporlo, 20(Suppl 1),
final REM phase lasts as longas an hour. REM sleep accounts for around 20-25% of pp.2·!-30.
Ilcrgcron, M.F., 2003. Hcat cramp>: Fluid and clcctrolytc challcngcs during tcnnls in lhe hcat. jouma! ofScicncc and Medicine ín Sport,
the total time spent sleeping by an adult. Professional players are advised to have a 6, pp.19·27.
llooqucL L., Montpctit, )., Arvisnil;, D., Mujika, !., 2007. Effccls oi ti!pcring on performance: a mcta·analrsis. Mcd Sei Sports Excrc, 39,
short (less than 30 minutes to avoid sleep inertia) and daily regular sleep period at pp.135S.6S.
Ilougard, C., ).fouso.~y, S. ;md Davcnnc, D., 2006. Combined dfcct,-;of lime oi day and slccp dcprivntion on two-whcckr driving pcrfor-
the beginning of the afternoon. Finally, sleep extension (getting as much extra sleep mancc. lkchcrchc Tr.1n&portSécurité, 91, pp.137-151.
llri!dlcy, P.S., Dl Mar.do, M., Pcart, D., Okc11, P. ond Shcldon, !l., 2010. Hig!Hntcnsity acU;·ity profilc~ of elite wcccr playcn; at diffcrcnt
as possible) may help minimize the effects of accumulated sleep deprivation, and performance lcvclr.. J St,.,,ngth Cond Rer,, 2·!(9), pp.2343-2351.
Dradley, l'.S., Shcldo11, W., Woostcr, !l,, Olt>cn, P., !loona.•, P. and Kruotrup, P., 2009, Hit;h·intcnsity runnint; in English FAPrcmicr Lcague
this could be a beneficial strategy for optimal performance (Dement 2005). to«<:r mntchcs. Joumal ofSporbJ Socnccs, 27(2), pp.159·168
llrndlcy, P.S. and Noakcs, TO., 2013. Match running performance fluclual1onr. in elite wc«"r: indica tive of fotigue, pacing or situational
mflucnccr.? j Sporls Sd., 31(15), pp.1627-33.
Tips for a good night's sleep: Boivi11, D.D ,Jame5, F.O., Wu,A, Cha.P,irk. P-F., Xrnng, H. and Sun, Z.S., 2003. Circadiandocki;cncso>cillatcmhuman periphNol! b!ood
mononudcar cdfo. Illood, 102(12), pp..!1·13---1145
o Make sure you are distracted as little as possible by night-time noise. Buchhc•l, M., RJcmaio, S, Dfüborough, J, Hockmg, J, Mcndcz.Villnnuc'"ª, A, Bourdon, PC., Vooo, S., Livmr;<ton, S.. Chmtian, R.,
Périnrd, J, Cordy, J and Coutls, A.J., 20!3 Addmg hcat to lhe hvc~high tr.1in·low altitude modcl' a pructical ;,,,.,,ght from profo>c.ional
111 Make sure the surroundings are dark, because darkness is the evolutionary foolb:ill. tlr J Sporls Mcd, ·17(1), pp.'59·i&?
Burgcs;;. M.L., Ilobcrtson, R.J,, D.wrn,J.M and Norrir., f M., 19?1 Hl'E, blood glum;c, and c,,,bohydralcoxidation duringcxcm~c: dfcct.'i
signal for sleep. Environmental light, especially the altemation of light and of gluco;;e frdingo Mcd Sei Sports E.wrc, 2.3. pp.353-9
Carling, C.. Dloomfield, J, Ncbcn, L. and lkill)', T., 2003 1111' role of motion an~ly•m. on ch1c $Ocçcr: .:ontcmporary performanC\' mca"u·
darkness due to the rotation of the earth, ís one of the principal time-givers, rcmmt tcchmquc'J nnd work rnlc data. Sporb Mcd, 3g, pp 839-62
and it synchronizes the internai clock (Boivin et al., 1994). C.1rhng, C. aml Illoomflcld, L 2010 111e dice! oi ,111 Nrly d1<;m,,;:;nl nn pbycr work·ratc in n pmfcoomnnl WCC\'r mntch, )ou mal of Scicncc
nnd Medicine in 5port. 13, pp.12!'.>-128
o Make sure the room is not too cold or too hot. A temperature of 18ºC is ideal. Cortb, C., Tcs:=itorc, A, Lupo, C., Pcrroni, F., P~;;cc, C and C.1prnnica, L.. 2013 d»ni;~.• m 1ump, oprm!, and roordinativc puformancc;;
altera scmor oocccr m,1tch. / Stwngth Cond Reo, 27lll), pp.29S9·%
111 Make sure you have a good mattress, a good pillo\v, and sufficient space. Peo- Coutts, A., Ilcabum, P., Piv,1, T,J. and Murph)~ A, 2007. Changc' in dcclcd bmchcmic.11, mmcubr nwngth, powcr, and cndurancc
mcaouwo during dchkrn1c º''Crll.'ilchmg nnd tnpcring in rugby leai;uc plil)'Cr~. lnkmat.onal joumnl OI Sporlc. Mcd1cim>, 2S(2),
ple change their sleeping position around 40-60 times in a night pp.116-121
D,wcnn~, D., 2009. Skcp of athletco • probkmc. 'md po%1blc ~oluhonr.. Brnlogical Ilhythm RC5~.m:h, ·lÜ(l), ppAS.52
D~vido, K.,.Glazicr, !\ Aro1ú10, D. ;md DJrtlctt, R., 2003. Movcmenl syoterno "" dynamical 5ystcm~: the funcbonal role of v.uiabi!ity i!nd
1t5 1mplical!on~ for sp-0rts rncd1onc, Sporl:l Mcd, 33(•1), pp,2-15·60.
Dcmcnt, WC., 2005 Skcp cxtcnf·ion: gctting a.o much c~trn slcep a5 po:~;íblc. Chnics in Sporls Mcd, 2-J, pp.251-265
Di Sah'o, V., Il.uo.11, R., T,;ch.m, H,, Caldcron Montcro, F./., Dachl, N. and Pigoni, F., 2007 Pcrforrnanccchnraclcmtlc~ uixordmg to play·
SUMMARY mg pootl1on m chtcsoc"''- Jnt J Sports Mcd, 28(3), pp.222·7.
Dufflcld, R., Cou!ls. A/. and Qu•nn, J., 2009. Corc tcmpm1tm<' rc3ponr.c,; nnd nutch running pcrform;mre during mtcrmot1cnt- r.pnnt
cxctci1;~ compdition in warm condotions. joumnl of Strcngth and Cond1lioning Ilcocarch, 23(·!), pp.!23S.12·\.l
Fatigue in soccer generally manifests itselfs as an inability to maintain physi- Dulficld, R., Grccn, R., Cootb, P und Maxwdl, N., 2010. Prc;;oolmg c.rn preHnt thc reduct1on oi f.~lf-paccd cxcrcioc mtcm.ity m thc h~al
Mcdicincand Soonre in Sporls i!nd Excm,;c, 42(3), pp.57i-5S.!
cal and technical performance during competitive match play. It is not unusual Dufficld, R., Cou1W, A, M<:C~ll, A. and I!Ufbe"".,S, D., 2013, l'rc-coo\ing for footbnll tr;uning and rompctition in hot ,1nd humid <:0nditrnru
EuropNn Joumal ofSport Sdcn«', 13(1), pp.5S-67
to see intensity in soccer players declining in certain periods during a game, Edwards, A.M. and Clark. N.A, 2006. TI1crmorcgulatory ob,ervaliono in ooccer match play: Prufcc~ional and wcrcation.ll Icvd apphcati·
ons usin;; an intestina! pill systcm to mensure corc tcmf"'r.ltull.'. !lritiHh /oumal ofSports Medicine, 40(2), pp.133-138.
especially in the last 20 mins. This chapter has identified that there are various Ekblom, B., 1986. Applicd phy"iology of oocccr. Sportr. Medicine, 3, pp.50--60,
causes of fatigue, and they are typically described as either central or periphe- Ekstrnnd, J., Gillquiot, J., Milllcr, M., Obcrzy B. and Liljcdahl, S.O., 1933. lnddcncc oi wccer injurie~ and thdr rclolion lo trammg nnd tcam
sucress, Thc Amcrknnjouma! oi •iporW mcdidnc, 11(2), pp.63-7
ral fatigue. Central fatigue is when the origin is proximal to the neuromuscular frrrm1ti, A., Ncuman11, G., Weber, K., Kcul, )., 2001. Urine catccholamine conccnlrations and psrchophysic:ol :;Ire"°' in c!itctcnni: under
practicc and toumament condllioM,j Spor!s Mcd Phy5 Fitncs~. ·11, pp.269·7·!.
junction, whereas peripheral fatigue is when the origin is distal to the neuromus- Fi~.hcr, AC., cd., 1976. l'"ychology of sport: istiuco and im;ightn. Mounlilin Vicw, CA: 1-fayfield Publishlng Company
Gandcvia, S.C., 2001. Spinal and supraspina! factors ln hurnan mutclc fotigue. Physiol Re'~ 81(4), pp.1725-89.
cular junction. Central fatigue seems to be the main cause of the decrement in Gooscy-Tolfrcy, V., Swainson, M .. Iloyd, C., Atkinso11, G. and Tolfw;~ K., 2003. Thc clfoctivcn<".;s ofhand coo!ing '11 rcdudng cxcros~in­
duccd hypcrthcrrnln nnd improving dintancc-race pctformoncc ln whcekhairand abk-bodicd athlc!co. JAppl Phy~iol, 105, pp.37-13
strength and sprinting ability, while peripheral fatigue seems to be more related Hcsf"'l, P., Mauglm11, R.J. and Grccnhoff, P.L., 2006. Dictary supplcmcnts for foolb"ll. /oumal of 5pOrtsscicn"-"'• 24(7). pp.7.J9-61
to metabolic disturbances and increased muscle soreness. Improved physical
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Fatigue
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Fatigue management i 211
jordcta, G., Hurlrnam, E., Vioochcra, C. and Kocn, A. P. M. Lcrnrninkíl, 2007. Kid<s from lhe penolty mark in so=r: The roles of strc&;,
skill, and fotiguc for kickoutcornc". Joumnl ofSporbl Scicncco, 25(2), pp.121-129.
Krustrup, P., Mohr, M., Stccnsbcrg. A., Bcnckc, J., Kj;.,r, M. and lfangr.bo, J., 2006. Muscl" and blood rnctobolites during a ooce<>r game:

1
irnplic•lions for sprinl pcrform11ncc. Mcd Sci Sporls Exerc, 38, pp.1165-1174.
lca!hcnvood, W.E. nnd Dragoo, J.L., 2013. Effoct of airline trave! on performance: a rcvicw of thc litcraturc. Br J Sports Me, 47, pp-561 ·567.
M.wda, T,, 2005. Pcrspectin-s on cnvironmcnta! ndaptability nnd physiological polymorphism in lhcrmorcgulation. / Physiol Anthrop
Appl Hum Se~ 24, pp.237-2.l(l.
Marsh, D. and Slcivcrt, G., 1999. Effoct of prccooling on hlgh intensity cycling performanre. llr J Sports Me<l, 33, pp.393-7.
McMorris, T., Myers, S., MacGillivary, W.W., Sex.<mith, j.!t, F.111owficld, )., Grnydon, J. and Forsler, D., 1999. Excrdoe, p!aoma
catccholaminc ron(l)ntratiom; and dedsion-making pcrfonnancc of soccer playcrs on a soccer·spcdfic te.;t, J Sports Sd, 17, pp.667-76.
McMorris, T. and Rayrncn~ T., 2007. Short-durntion, high-inlcm;ily cxcrd>e and performance of a sporls·spcdfic ski11: a preliminary
study. l'c=pl Mot Skilfo. 105, pp.523-30.
Mohr, M., Krustrup, !'. and ll.>ngobo, )., 2003. l>fatch pcrform.1nre oi high·slandard wcccr playcrs wilh opccial rcfcrenre lo lhe dcvclop-
mcnt of fatigue.) Sporl>Sd, 21, pp.519-523.
Mohr, M., Krustrup, P., Nybo, l., Niclscn, J.J. and Bangsbo, J., 2004. Mu:>elc tcmf"'rature and sprint p<!rfom>ancc during socccr matchcs
- beneficial cffocts of re-warm upat halí-time. Scandj Med Sd Sports, 14, pp.156-162.
Mohr, M., Kruslrup, !': and Bangsbo, )., 2005. Fatigue in socccr. A brid revicw.Jouma! ofSportsSdcnres, 23(6), pp.593-599.
Mohr, M., Mujika, l., Santistcban, J., Randern, M.B., Bischoff, R., Sola no, R., Hcwltt, A., Zubillaga, A., Pcltob, E. and Kn1&trup, !'., 2010.
Examinatlon of fatigue devclopmcnl in elite SOCCT'r in a hot crwironment: a multi-experimental approach. Scand J Mcd Sei Spmts, 20(3),
pp.125-32.
Morri5on, 5., Slcivcrt, G.G., Chcung, S.S., 2{){1.1. !'ar.:;ivc hyp<!rthcrmia redure:; \"Oluntary activatlon and iwmetric force production. Eur
FATIGUE MANAGEMENT
JAppl Physiol, 91. pp.729-736. Jan Van Winckel, Werner Helsen, Kenny McMillan, John Fitzpatrick,
Mustafa, K.Y. and Mahmuud, N.E., 1979. Ernporalivcwatcr lo.,~ in African S<l<X'Cr playcr<J. J Sporls Mcd Phys Fitm..s:;, 19, pp.1111-3.
Noake.;, T.D., 2006. E><en:isc in lhe hcat: old idcas, ncw dogm"". lnt Sport Mcd J, 7, pp58·74.
Ester Lowette, Kyle Woodruff, Paul Bradley, David Tenney
l'alterson, M.J., Stock!', /.M. and Taylor, N.A., 2004. Sustained and gcncra!i>ed extraccl!ulm fluid cxpansion fo!lowing hNt acdimalion.
J Physlol, 559, pp.327-33-1.
P=land, J.D., Dowson, M.N. and Cairru;, S.P., 2005. Changes of motor drive, cortical arousal and pcm,,ivcd cxertion following prolonged
cycling tocxhauslion. Eur J Appl Physiol, 95, pp.-12-51.
!'ria:', MJ, Boyd, C. and Gooscy-Tolfrcy, V.L., 2009. The physiologicalcffccb;of P"'"evcnt and rnidevcntcooling during intcrmittcnt run-
ning in thc hcat in elite fcmalc socCT'r players..Applicd Physiology, Nulrition and Mctabolism, 3-1(5), pp. 942·9·19.
Quod, M.J., l>forlin, D.T., l.aursen, P.B., Gardncr, A.S., Habon, S.L., Marino, l'.E., Tatc, M.P:, Mainwaring, D.E., Gore, C.J., Halm, A.G.,
200S. Practical prerooling: Effoct oncyding time lrial performance in warm conditiono.joumal ofSporls Sdcncm, 26(1<1), pp.H77-HS7.
Rahnama, N., Lccs,A. and Rcilly, T., 2006. Elcctromyography of sclec1cd lowcr-Hrnb rnusdcs foligucd by cxen:isc ai thc intcnsily of soe·
Cl)r-rnatch play. J Elcctromyogr J(inesiol, 16, pp.257-263.
Rahnama, N., Rcilly, T. and Lees, A., 2002. lnjury riskof playing actioM during romp<!litivc ~occer. 6r J Sporl~ Mcd, 36, pp.35.J-359.
lbhnama, N., Rcilly, T.. lccs, A. and Grnham-Smith, P., 2003. Musdc fotiguc indu«d by excrcir,c simu- lating lhe work ratcof comp<!ti-
live so=r. /ou mal of Sports Scicncc:1, 21(11), pp.933-942.
Rampinini, E., Coults, A.J., Castagna, C., Sassi, R. and lmpclliz..~cri, F.M., 2007. V.uintion in top leve! soccer match performance. lnt J
Sports Mede, 28, pp.1018-2·1.
Ifampinini, E., lrnpclliueri, F.M., Cas1agna, C., Aaalin, A., Ferrari Bra\"o, D. and Wisloff, U .. 2003. Effcc! of match·rdutcd fílliguc on
short·p.1rsing abilíty in young r.occcr playcrn. Med Sci Sporl< Excrc, 40(5), pp.934~12.
R.1mpinini, E., Bosio, A., Ferrarcsi, !., Pctruolo, A., Morelli, A. and Sassi, A., 2011. Match-rclated fatigue in ooccer playcrs. Medicine and
Scicncc in Sporls and Excrdoe, 43(11), pp.2161~70.
Reilly, T. and Maskcll, !'., 1989. Effectsof allcring lhesle<."p--wakccydc in human dn:adian rhythm~and motor performance. ln: l'roc~'C­
dins• of the !'rocecding> of lhe First !OC World Congl'<'ss on Sport Sdencc. Colorndo Spring~. p.106.
Rcill;: T., 2003, Molion ana!ysis and phy>iologica! dcmands. !n: T. Reilly and 1\.M. Williams, cds. 2003. Sei- encc and so=r. London·
Routlcdge. pp. 59-72.
Rcilly, T. and !Ugby, M., 2002. Elfoct of an actffc warm-down following compctilivc socccr. ln: W. Spinks, T. Rcillya and A. Murphy A,
cds. 2002. Sdencc and Football !V, London:Routlcdge. pp. 226-229.
Rc11!y, T., Atkiruon, G. and Wdlerhomc,)., 1997. Trawl Fatigue and jct Lag. joumal ofSport Scienccs, 15, pp.365-369.
Rc1!!y, T, Walcrhouoc,J. and Edwílrdf,, li., 2005. )cl lng and air travcl: implicalioM for pcrformanre. Clin Sporlo Mcd, 2<1(2), pp.367-&l.
Rci!!y. T. and Edw.1rds, li., 2007. Allcred s!C<."p-wake cydcs and physical P"rformancc in Mhlclf.MJ. Phyr.iol Bchav, 90, pp.274-28-1.
Rei!ly, T. and Mar.kell, !', 1939, EffcctJ; of allcring lhe stccp-wakc cydc ín human circadian rhythms and motor pcrfonnanCT'. !n: Procc-
dingsofthc First JOC World Congrcs> on Sporl< Science, p.106. Co!orndoSprings: US OlyrnpicCommi1tce.
Rci!ly, T., Dru"t, B. and Clarkc, N., 2008. Musdc foliguc during football match·pla;-. Sports Mcd, 38, pp.357·67. 13.1 INTRODUCTION
Ross, M.L.R., Garvic"n, LA., jearocke, N.A., Lwrsm, l'.ll., Abbiu;, C.R., Martin, D.T. and llurkc, L.M., 2011. Novel Prcrooling Stralcgy ln the preceding chapter, we conside-
Enhanccs Time Tri.1! Cyding in lhe Hcat. Medicine And Scicnce ln SporlsAnd Exerci.se, 43(1), pp.123-133.
Ropl, K.A., Farrow, D., Mujika, !., Hal5on, S.L., Pyne, D. andAbcmcthy, n., 2006. Thc elfectsof fati&0con dcdsion makingand ohooting red the causes and effects of fatigue.
skill P"rfonnnncc in walcr polo playcm. j SportsSci. 2'1, pp.807-15.
Ruoscll, M., R"'-.,;, G. and Kinge,ley, M. 2013. Tcrhnica! dcmands of socCT'r matchplay ln thc Eng!ioh ChJmpionship. )oumal ofSll'<'ngth We also discussed the various ways
and Conditioning Re.;Nrch, (Epubahcad of prinl).
St ClairGiboon, A., lladcn, D.A., Lamber!, M.J., Lambert, E.V,, H.ulcy, Y.X., Hamp$on, D., Rustcll, V.A. and Noakco, T.D., 2003. The con~­ of countering fatigue. ln this chapter,
dous pem,,ption of lhe 5cnr.ation of fatigue. Sporls Mcd, 33, pp.167-176.
Sallin, li., 1973. Mc!abolic lundammtals in cxcrdsc. Mcd Sei Sports, 5, pp.137-16. we will discuss the concept of "fatigue
Sehgal, A and Migno!, E., 2011. Gcnctics ofSlc>cp and Slcep Disordcrs. Ccll, 146(2), pp.19-1·207.
Spraguc, P. and Mann, R.V., 1983. Thccffectsof mm.rui ar fatigue on thc kincticsof sprint mnning. Rcr. Q facn:Sport, 54, pp.60-6. management," which involves monito-
Stickgold, R. and \VJlker, M.P., 2007. Slccp-def"'ndcnt memory conr.olidalion and reconsolidation. Slccp Med, S, pp.331-3-13.
Stofan, j.R., Zachwicja, ).)., Horswill, C.A., LlCambrn, M., Murra); R. and Eichner, E. R., 2003. Swcat and wdium lü!'ocr. in NCAA Divir,ion
ring, manipulating, and adjusting fati~
1 footba!! playcrs wilh a history of wholc-body muodc cramplng. Medicine ,1nd Sdencc in Sporl5 and Excrcfoc, 35, 5-18. gue. Professional players are expected
Strudwick, T. and Rcilly, T., 2001. Work·r•le profilesof dile premicr lNguc (ootball playcn;. Jnsight FA Coach ,\5socj, 42(2), 28-29.
Thompr.on, K.G., Haljand, R. and MacL1ren, D.!':, 2000. An analysis of sclccted kincmatic variablc:; in nalional and elite rnale and fcmale to compete in 60-70 high-level mat-
100-rn and 200-rn breaototrokc swimmers.J Sporw Sc1, 18, pp.-121-31.
Van Gool, D., V,1n Gcrwn, D. and Boutmam;,J., 1988. Thc physiologic,1! load impoccd on playcrs during real match·play. ln: T. Rcilly, A. ches per year. Therefore, it is virtually
Lccs, K. Davidsd al., cdr.. 1983. Sden"' and foolball (pp. 51-59). l.ondon: E and FN Spon.
Vignc, G., Gaudino, C., Rogowski, 1., Alloa!ti, G. and Hauticr C., 2010. Ac!i\"ity l'rofile in Elite !lalian Socccr Tcarn. !nt / Sports Mcd, impossible to peak by means of clas-
31(5), pp.304-310.
\V.;tcrhoo,;;.-,j., Ne;·1ll, A., Edwardr., D., Godfrey, R., Rcilly, T., 2003. The rcl.1tionohip bctwcm a=wmcntsofjct lngand someofil• symp- sic peaking strategies, as there will be
tomr.. Chronobiol ln!, 20(6), pp.1051-73.
Watcrhouse, J., Rcilly, T. and Edward o, li., 200.J. The stn'SS of travei.) Sporls Sei., 22(10), pp.946-65; dif.russion 965-6.
a loss of consistent performance in the
W,1tcrhouse, /., Reilly, T., Atkinson, G. ~nd Edwardr., ll., 2007.jct lag: !rendsand çoping r.lralegics. Lancei, 369(9567), pp.1117-29. preceding and ensuing weeks. It is up
W,1te<hous:, J., Atkinr.on, G., Edwards, B. and Rei!!y; T., 2007. Thc role of a ~hort posl-lunch nap in improving rognilivc, motor, and sprinl
perfonnancc in partidpanls wilh partia\ slccp dcpri\"ation. J Sporl• Sei, 25(14), pp.1557-2166. to the coaching staff to keep the team
Wcilzman, E.D., 1976. Circadian rhythms ~nd cpisodic hormonc occl'<'lion in man. Ann Rcv Med, 27, pp.225-2·13.
William,;, T., 2011. The Effccl~ of Allllude on So=r Match Outcomcs. M!T Sloan Sporls Ana!ytics Confcrencc. at a maximal stable levei for an entire
William,;, C. and Serratooa, L., 2006. Nutrilion on mal eh day. /oumal of Spor!s Sdcn(l)S, 2·1(7), pp.687-697.
Wilmore, J.H., 1963. lnfluenreofrnotivation on phyr.ic~l work capadty and pcrfonnancc.J Appl Phys\ol, 2'1, pp.-159-63. season. This process is referred to as
performance stabilization.
[ FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
218
Fatigue management Fatigue management i 219

13.2 PERFORMANCE STABILIZATION 13.3 FATIGUE MANAGEMENT


At the very top level, performance stabilization can be considered at least as impor- As we already mentioned in the preceding chapters, performance preparedness
tant as performance enhancement. It is a challenge for every soccer coach to keep results from the interplay betw'een the body's long-term fitness increase, which
the players at an appropriate leve! (around 85% of peak physical capacity) for the is stimulated by training, and the opposing short-term aftereffects of fatigue, also
entire season, although periods with higher performance levels can be strategically caused by training (Siff and Verkhoshansky, 1999). Specifically, it reflects the readi-
planne<l during the season. ness of an athlete to participate in an enhanced level of training and / or excel in
competition (Zatsiorsky, 1995). Fatigue is the degree to which training or match-in-
Performance stabilisation duced stress masks the capacity to display fitness. The higher the accumulated fati-
110% ~--------------------------- gue leveis, the greater the inability to utilize the increased fitness levels. This does
!OS% ~---------------- not imply that fitness levels have decreased but rather that they are simply masked
'= by match- or training-induced fatigue. This also implies that, within physiologi-

~~~-~--rL~
1 ,,...--....,,

cally acceptable leveis, the greater the increase in accumulated fatigue induced by
training stress, the greater the potential to increase fitness levels once the player
has the opportunity to recover from the stress and fatigue imposed by training or
r.v-----
7;11
'~
_ ------
~ matches. Fatigue leveis should accumulate at various times of a training program
~$% !----------------------------
to create overload and elicit adaptation. Training is nothing more than systemati-
cally disrupting homeostasis and permitting higher leveis of performance to occur.
Fatigue need to be managed at tw'o levels:
-100Mdo>l•pcr1s 74)> 1 W1' B21> s&% 901' ~5% ~n: 9Sli arn oou 7Sli 70% 75% 82% S6% sm ?ali 97% ~ 87% i
-_=-__:i:~~"'-~- ª~-L!~- ·-ig~ E.~- . ~.l!J,E:>..L~'!.. ~,. -~~ -~~- ~~- .!~!>..L.~- -~-11±.1.~'!. _!!_~~ _!~.!_-~U~~ ~~l
1. Within a mesocycle:
Fig. 13. 1: Exampfe of a buildup in an individual sport (e.g., marathon ar cyc/e racing) as opposed to o Within a mesocycle, a certain specific load is imposed in each microcycle
performance levei in soccer.
in order to generate specific fatigue, causing the body to make a specific
adaptation.
• Within each mesocycle, an unloading period (a lowering of volume and/ or
To maintain this constant high levei, a clear strategy has to be developed to manage intensity) is applied to allow fatigue to decline and let supercompensation
and manipulate a player's fatigue. We refer to this as fatigue management. take place. The term "regeneration" is used at times to refer to periods of
extended recovery within a long-term training plan (Hackney, 1999).
Match
2. Within a microcycle:
o Recovery strategies to reduce the fatigue induced by matches as fast as
possible.
• Loading strategies in arder to create specific acute fatigue to elicit adaptation.
o Tapering strategies to allow fatigue to decline and consequently increase pre-
paredness for an upcoming match.
Fatigue
management
Recovery strntegies Loadlng strategles
'" ~-------+---------!

-..i.- Prnparednc.1s
Match
••«•• Fitncss

Match Monday Tucsd~y Wcdo~sday Th1mdoy Friday Saturdoy Pre·matdi


Fig. 13.2: Representation ofthe fatigue management strategies in a microcycle

Fig. 13.3: Fatigue management within a microcycfe composed of three phases


1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
220 Fatigue management [ 221
Fatigue management

1. Phase 1: Recovery strategies Recovery can be defined on different leveis:


The objective in this phase is to eliminate fatigue induced by the game as rapidly
andas thoroughly as possible. The training load is reduced, and recovery strate- 1. Within a training session or match: The amount of time between exercises (trai-
gies are applied. Preparedness will decrease dueto excessive fatigue, but fitness ning session) or high-intensity efforts (match)
levels remain high dueto the rnatch load. 2. Within the microcycle: the amount of time between sessions on a daily basis
2. Phase 2: Loading strategies 3. Within the mesocycle: the amount of time between longer cycles or periods of
In the second phase of fatigue management, the training load is high in arder to training .
create accumulated fatigue and overload. ln this phase, the load is adapted to 4. Within the year planning: the amount of time during the off-season and m1d-sea-
the physical periodization. Preparedness declines due to accumulated fatigue, son breaks.
whereas specific fitness increases.
3. Phase 3: Tapering strategies
ln this phase of the microcycle, the main objective is to enhance the players' pre- 13.4.1 Recovery between high-intensity efforts
paredness as much as possible. This is done by lowering the training load via Krustrup et ai. (2006) and Mohr et ai. (2010) demonstrated that the ability to per-
reducing the volume 1vhile keeping the intensity sufficiently high (80%). form repeated bouts of high intensity, an important physical ability in soccer, ~s
reduced toward the end of soccer games. Some research has demonstrated a posi-
tive effect of active recovery on performance in repeated sprints and on the speed
13.4 RECOVERY STRATEGIES of Jactate removal (Bogdanis et al., 1996). This contradicts recent research that pos-
Fatigue occurs in various forros, namely physiological, psychological, neural and tulates that active recovery adversely affects performance, decreases the speed
hormonal. A good recovery strategy has to tackle these different forros of fatigue. of replenishment of phosphocreatine, and increases fatigue (Dupont et al., 2003;
Moreover, Gould and Dieffenbach (2002) demonstrated that failure to adequately Dupont et ai., 2004; Spencer et ai., 2006; jougla et ai., 2010). On the other hand, pas-
recover from the stress of training induces a state of overtraining and burnout. sive recovery induces a faster re-oxygenation of myoglobin (Dupont et al., 20~4).
The term under-recovery is often used in this regard. Under-recovery predisposes In conclusion, it seems better to recover passively between intensive bouts dunng
players to overtraining injuries during a congested fixture period where players a match, but the recommendation that players should 1valk or stand still during
are required to compete repeatedly within a short period (e.g., tvvo games a week) and following bouts of repeated sprinting needs to be coordinated with tactical
(Dupont et al., 2010). Professional soccer players are exposed to demanding com- windows of opportunity.
petition schedules and can be easily exposed to 70 games in a single competitive
season (King and Duffield, 2009). Playing competitive soccer involves eccentric 13.4.2 Recovery post-match
work, particularly during competition, resulting in varying leveis of exercise-indu- Several studies have demonstrated that it takes more than 72 hours to reach pre-
ced muscle damage (EIMD). This EIMD is characterized by delayed-onset muscle match values for physical performance and normalize muscle damage and inflam-
soreness (DOMS) (Impellizzeri et ai., 2008), decreased muscle function Uakeman et mation (Andersson et al., 2008).
al., 2009), impaired performance (Reilly and Ekblom, 2005), and increased percei- The magnitude of match-induced fatigue, extrinsic factors (e.g., match resul~, _qua-
ved fatigue (Twist and Eston, 2009). Many biochemical and tissue repair processes lity of the opponent, match location, playing surface, envirorunental cond1tions)
take place after a match, and the body needs rest to recover completely for the next and/ or intrinsic factors (e.g., training status, age, sex, muscle fiber typology), could
game or training session. Although the recovery process is initiated automatically, influence the time course of recovery (Nédélec et al. 2012).
it can be assisted by appropriate recovery strategies. The capacity to recover from Severa! post-match recovery interventions have been suggested to _e~ha~ce per-
training and competition is therefore an important determinant in soccer perfor- formance (Barnett, 2006). These recovery strategies are broadly class1fied 1nto two
mance (Kellmann, 2002; Odetoyinbo et ai., 2009). categories (Bompa, 1999): active and passive recovery. Active recovery strategies
include cycling, jogging, aqua-jogging, and deep-water running,. f~llowed _by stret-
Athletes attempt to recover from training and competition as quickly as possible, ching exercises. These interventions are regularly used after tra1n1ng sess1ons and
so their performances in the subsequent training session or game are not compro- matches in professional soccer (Dabedo et al., 2004). ln particular, when n:atches
mised by muscle soreness or reductions in physical abilities. According to Peter- are played on a weekly or twice-weekly basis, focus is placed on accele:ating t~1e
son (2005), "The concept of effective, regular, and varied recovery activities has recovery and consequently the regeneration processes. This commences 1mmed1a-
become part of the Ianguage of today's smart, professional athlete." Recovery tely after the match by using nutritional strategies to replenish glycogen stores and
can be defined as an inter- and intra-individual multidisciplinary (physiological drinking water or carbohydrate beverages to restore fluid balance. With the next
and psychological) process to restore the initial performance leve!. This definition competitive match 3-7 days away, a recovery training session is often planned the
implies that recovery is much more than just rest - it is a strategy that should be next day as well. It is still unclear whether immediate post-match recovery offers
adapted according to the type, intensity and volume of the previous training cycle additional benefits when compared to a traditional next-day recovery. A cool down
(Steinacker and Lehmann, 2002). after a tough training session often feels good, and the psychological relief of some
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
222
1
Fatigue management Fatigue management i 223

easy jogging, stretching and discussing the session with teammates can work won- 13.4.3 Types of recovery
ders for the mental well-being of players. However, a cool down after a game or
during bad weather conditions is often impractical and can put additional psycho- 13.4.3.1 Allowing sufficient recovery time
logical and physiological stress on the players. Is it really necessary to start active Soccer governing bodies such as FIFA and UEFA should consider the physiological
recovery sessions immediately after the game, or can this wait until the next day? and mental consequences for players in periods of congested fixtures and lighten
Dawson and colleagues (2005) investigated four types of immediate post-match the physiological strain as much as possible by mandating a minimum of 72 hours
recoveries: behveen competitive matches (Reilly, 2005; Ispirlidis, 2008). A soccer match increa-
ses the levels of oxidative stress and muscle damage throughout a 72-hour period
1. Control (i.e., no proactive recovery): The players were instructed to perform no (Andersson, 2010; Ascensao, 2008; Ispirlidis, 2008). The recovery time between two
recovery procedures other than eating (fruit), drinking (water and soft drinks), matches in a week seems sufficient to maintain levels of physical performance, but
and showering. it is not long enough to maintain a low injury rate. Adequate recovery strategies
2. Stretching: The players were led through 15 minutes of gentle static stretching are necessary to maintain a low injury rate among soccer players during periods of
of the legs and back, involving two or three reps of 30s-held stretches across congested match fixtures (Dupont, 2010).
several muscle groups and joints.
3. Pool walking: The players were taken through 15 minutes of easy walking
(moving forwards, backwards and sideways) in the shallow end of a 28ºC 13.4.3.2 Active recovery
swimming pool. Active recovery (Baldari et al., 2004; Tessitore et al., 2007):
4. Hot/Cold cycling: The players altemated behveen standing in a hot (- 45ºC) • reduces muscle soreness (Reilly, 1998)
shower for two minutes and standing waist deep in icy water (-12ºC) for one • increases muscle-damage recovery (Gill et al., 2006)
minute, repeated until five hot and four cold exposures had been completed. 0 prevents venous pooling in the muscles after maximal effort (This can cause
Additional ice was added to the cold water as required to maintain a constant dizziness and sometimes fainting. When an athlete or player faints or collap-
temperature. ses after maximal efforts (or vvhen crossing the finish line), the most common
cause is stopping so suddenly that the blood pools in the extremities (usually
The authors concluded that performing any forro of immediate post-match reco- the legs), depriving the brain of oxygen for a moment. Typically, this is refer-
very did not significantly enhance the recovery of muscle soreness, flexibility and red to as postural hypotension (Crisafulli et al., 2006).)
po\ver within the first 48 hours follO'vving a game when compared to just perfor- • restares metabolic perturbations (Bangsbo et al., 1994; Bogdanis et al., 1996)
ming a "next-day" recovery training session. • increases lactate clearance. (Maximum clearance occurred at active recovery
close to the lactate threshold (Menzies et al., 2010). However, for team sports
like soccer, lactate removal is not a determining factor, as matches are gene-
rally 3-9 days apart.)

./ Running activities
Reilly and Rigby (2002) investigated the effect of post-match active recovery in soc-
cer and reported that muscle soreness disappeared hvo days after the match in the
active post-match recovery group. They found that amateur soccer players vvho
did an immediate post-n1atch recovery comprised of some jogging, stretching and
a leg-muscle "shakedown" (by a partner) for 12 minutes had lower muscle soreness
ratings and \vere closer to their pre-match jump and sprint performances both 24
and 48 hours after the match \Vhen compared to a group of players \Vho did not
perform any recovery. ln another interesting study by Rey et al. (2012), the effect of
immediate post-training active- and passive-recovery interventions on anaerobic
performance and lower-limb flexibility in professional soccer players \VaS investi-
gated. The active recovery consisted of 20 minutes of low-intensity exercises, incluM
ding 12 minutes of submaximal running at 65% of maximum aerobic speed and
8 minutes of static stretching, involving 3 bilateral repeats of 30s-held stretches to
the hamstring, quadriceps, gastrocnemius, and adductor muscles. The investiga-
tors suggest that post-training active-recovery intervention may help in restoring
counter movement jump performance, but this does not represent performance
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
224
1
Fatigue management Fatigue management i 22s

enhancements in the 20m sprint, Balsom agility test, and lower-limb flexibility for lysis that the expected percentage improvements in performance recovery from
professional soccer players. post-exercise cooling are large enough to be relevant for competitive athletes. ln
particular, for whole-body CWI, cooling-induced improvements of S~'o ar more can
Running activities followed by static stretching could reduce delayed onset muscle be expected. These results are similar to those of Leeder et aL (2011) and Bleakley
soreness. However, the research is inconclusive about the effects of low-intensity et al. (2012), who identified positive effects of cooling on the reduction of muscle
running exercises on recovery. soreness, although they found only small or unclear effects on performance indices.
Halson (2011) postulated that no gold standard exists for CWI as regards water
./ Pool sessions temperature, immersion depth, and duration. Based on the available literature, the
Exercising in water has been suggested by some researchers (Dowzer and Reilly, recommendation is for a whole-body immersion lasting 10-20 minutes in a water
1998; Oda et al., 1999; Suzuki et al., 2004). The advantages of running in water temperature of 10-15ºC (Halson, 2011).
{aquajogging ar deep-water running) over normal running are numerous:
• It avoids excessive eccentric actions, especially in deep water. ../ Compression gannents
0 It naturally massages the muscles (via the water turbulence). Compression garments (CGs), such as compression socks, were originally used
• It reduces mechanical load on the joints. ín clinicai settings. While the benefits of CGs include being relatively cheap, easy
• It aids recovery from musculoskeletal fatigue. to use, and non-invasive, the current literature indicates that wearing these gar-
• It increases the physiological and psychological indices of relaxation. ments has limited physiological or performance effects, although reports of detri-
mental effects are rare (Macrae, 2011). Various research has suggested that CGs
../ Stretching increase the removal of cellular debris, moderate the formation of edema associ-
Few publications have investigated the effect of stretching on recovery. Many coa- ated with EIMD, attenuate muscle oscillation, change sub-maximal oxygen usage
ches still believe that stretching post-exercise will increase blood flow. Research during exercise, alleviate swelling, and reduce perceived muscle soreness during
demonstrates clearly that stretching after a workout does not help and may in fact post-exercise recovery. They have also been suggested to offer mechanical support
discourage blood flow (Poole et al. 1997, Mika et al. 2007). (dynamic casting effect) to the muscle, allovving faster recovery following dama-
Montgomery et al. (2008) postulated that static stretching after exercise could be ging exercise (Kraemer et al., 2001). Recent research pointed out that a whole-body
recommended as a recovery strategy in order to prevent delayed onset muscle sore- compression garment worn during the 24-hour recovery period following an
ness and improve range of motion. Contradicted findings were published by Wessel intense heavy-resistance training \Vorkout enhances various psychological, physio-
and Wan (1994) who found that stretching before or after exercise did not improve logical, and performance markers of recovery, when compared with non-compres-
DOMS. Coaches should be careful in applying stretching after intensive training or sive control garment conditions. The use of compression appears to help in the
match play. This causes exercise-induced muscle damage, and post-exercise stret- recovery process after an intense heavy-resistance training workout in men and
ching can potentially cause further trauma. ln conclusion, serious stretching after women (Kraemer et al., 2010). This was confirmed by Jakeman et al. (2010) when
an intensive training or game is contraindicated for recovery. they concluded that compression clothing is an effective recovery strategy follo-
wing EIMD. A recent review by MacRae et al. (2011) concluded that the temptation
to take findings from one cohort (e.g., untrained people) ar exercise type (e.g., jum-
13.4.3.3 Passive recovery ping) and apply them to other cohorts and exercise types (e.g., untrained people
../ Cold-water immersion (CWI) and prolonged running) is questionable. The garment type, the applied pressure,
These are the possible mechanisms of post-exercise cooling: and the duration of wear often differ, complicating the matter further. Hence, more
research is required before practical recommendations can be made.
• It reduces pain and swelling, having an anti-inflammatory effect and reducing ln conclusion, wearing CGs might support recovery and reduce DOMS, and no
the potential for DOMS. detrimental effects have been reported. Players could be encouraged to use com-
0 It causes vaso-constriction, which increases blood flow and metabolic trans- pression socks during recovery or taper, particularly when travelling by car or
portation post-exercise. Additionally, CWI rnay decrease nerve transmission plane.
speed (Wilcock, 2006) and alter the receptor threshold, leading to decreased
pain perception. There may also be a psychological mechanism whereby the ./ Sleep
body feels more "awake" and perceives a reduced sensation of fatigue after The effect of sleep on athletic performance has become a topic of great interest
exercise (Cochrane, 2004). because of the growing body of scientific evidence demonstrating a direct rela-
tionship between criticai sleep factors (sleep length, sleep quality; and circadian
ln conclusion, a cold-water bath after a match will not cause any harm, and it rnay sleep phase) and human performance (Samuels, 2008). Research speculates that
likely boost recovery and constitute a good recovery strategy for those with a "mar- sleep supports improvements in sport performance, because during phases of deep
ginal gains" philosophy. Poppendieck et al. (2013) concluded in theír meta-ana- sleep, growth hormone is released. Growth hormone stimulates muscle growth
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
226
1
Fatigue management Fatigue management i 221

and repair, prometes bone building, and helps athletes recover. On the other hand, ./ Psychological strategies
a lack of sleep has been associated with under-recovery, alterations in mood and Performance in soccer is a result of a complex synergistic interaction of technical,
motivation, anda negative effect on athletic performance. tactical, physiological, psychological, environmental, and social factors. ln this
regard, the athlete has been described as a "psychosocio-physiological entit;r"
Sleep deprivation: (Kenttã and Hassmén, 2002). Soccer players currently face more social pressure
• reduces the ability to store glycogen than ever before, and they are exposed to increased media demands, sponsor-
• reduces decision-making quality and reflexes ship requirements, and information overload (Botterill and Wilson, 2002). Mental
• increases stress hormones (cortisol) recovery is a vital part of the recovery process (Maughan, 1998). Mental-recovery
0
negatively affects recovery. (Skein et al. (2013) examined the effects of over- strategies may include debriefing, emotional recovery, mental toughness skills,
night sleep deprivation on recovery following competitive rugby league and relaxation techniques. A successful debriefing enables both the coach and the
matches. They found that sleep deprivation negatively affects recovery, player to evaluate game performance and identify specific areas in need of change.
specifically impairing CMJ distance and cognitive function.) Moreover, goals can be reframed, with realistic goals being set for the next training
• lowers leveis of growth hormone needed to help repair the body session or match. Venter (2012) investigated the perceptions of team athletes on the
importance of recovery modalities. The results from this study demonstrated that
For optimal performance, players should be encouraged to maximize their sleep in team players do perceive psychosocial aspects to be among the most important
a dark, calm, relaxing and fresh atmosphere during the week preceding competition recovecy modalities. Sport psychologists could assist coaches with effective debrie-
(Halson, 2008). This was confirmed by Mah et al. (2011) who investigated measures fing procedures after matches to aid mental and emotional recovecy, as well as
of basketball performance after sleep extension. Participants were first asked to facilitating team cohesion to address aspects of psychosocial recovecy. There may
follow their habitual sleep period (e.g., an eight-hour sleep period). They were then be a need to educate players and coaches in regard to recovecy modalities, and this
subsequently asked to voluntarily extend their total sleep time, with a minimum might also assist with psychosocial recovery.
goal of a ten-hour sleep period for a five-to-seven-week period. The participants
were found by all the measures to have enhanced basketball performance after the Effective strategies:
habitual sleep extension. Total sleep times increased by approximately two hours,
and participants were shown to sprint faster and have greater shooting accuracy o Organize a debriefing after each game.
when compared to their baseline performance. Alertness also improved-as did • Set realistic goals.
mood, weariness, and fatigue-leading the investigators to conclude that optimi- o Social networks can help players <leal with the problems, disappointments,
zing sleep need (i.e., reaching sleep satiation) was likely to have a positive impact joys and stresses of life (Quinn and Fallon, 1999).
on measured athletic performance. Although there is an individual variation in • Appoint players carefully for media demands and sponsor needs.
the amount of sleep required for essential recovery processes, the adaptive sleep • Reframe goals if long-term goals look difficult to reach.
range is approximately 8-10 hours (Bompa, 2009; Calder, 2003). Athletes should be o Give players space to develop effective pre- and post-match strategies.
encouraged to take a 20-minute nap (often called a "po\ver nap") during the day o Social support may increase performance (Freeman and Rees, 2008).
(Postolache and Oren, 2005). Naps should be scheduled in. the mid-to-late after- • Try to protect players from the negative impact of stressors (Botterill and
noon after 2pm but not after 4pm, because this can result in sleep inertia (Samuels, Wilson, 2002; Rees and Hardy, 2004).
2008). Naps can equate to an hour of "extra" nighttime sleep (Horne, 2011). o Encourage players to create a playlist of music they enjoy that generates a
range of moods and atmospheres soas to produce a stimulating or calming
Recommendations for females aged 18+ and males aged 19+ (Samuels, 2008): effect (Calder, 2000).
0
Ensure a comfortable sleep environment when travelling and competing. • Do not force players into post-match recovery strategies that are perceived
0 Monitor for competition stress and aruciet)' insomnia. as stressful.
0
Observe sleep to identify sleep disorders. o Encourage friends and teammates to provide listening and emotional sup-
• Maintain a regular sleeping and napping routine. port; challenge evaluation of attitudes, values and feelings; express appre-
• Monitor for a delayed sleep phase, such as difficult;r falling asleep and waking ciation; and motivate other players to greater excitement and involvement
up for school. (Barefield and McCallister, 1997).
• Get early-morning light exposure for 30 minutes daily.
• Maintain reliable nutrition routines. Breakfast is the most important meal of lt can be concluded that relaxation strategies-such as meditation, music, muscle
the day. relaxation, visualization, breathing exercises, music, and floatation-are regularly
• Focus on reducing sleep debt. Get 56-70 hours of sleep per week. used, yet the effects of these strategies have been barely investigated.
• Do not train if unrested and sleep deprived.
• Avoid technology (e.g., PCs, smartphones, tablets) before bed.
FITNESS IN SOCCER
228
1 FITN ESS 1N SOCCER Fatigue management i 229
Fatigue management

heart rate and an increase in fuel supply to the muscles. At times, this reaction to a
./ Nutrition and hydration (See chapter 4)
stressful situation can be less than ideal. For instance, consider standing in front of
Alcohol consumption occurs regularly in many team sports, typically as part of a
a crowd to give a speech with a pounding heart and sweaty palms. For a stressor
post-match celebration or as an escape from the realization of failure (Maughan,
such as exercise, though, these physical changes are optimal for physical exertion.
2006). This behavior is widespread and often seen as an acceptable part of team
Cortisol plays a necessary role in performance during exercise. The increase in heart
culture (Barnes et al., 2012). O'Brien et al. (2005) studied a student population and
rate and the fuel supply to working muscles provides the necessary adaptations to
found higher rates of hazardous drinking in elite sportspeople (O'Brien et al., 2005).
perform at a high level. After exercise has ended, however, a sufficient period for
On the other hand, it has been reported that sports participation might delay drin-
recovery is necessary to retum to baseline hormonal levels. Adequate time allows
king debut in youngsters (Hellandsjo Bu et al., 2002). Barnes et al. (2010) concluded
the clearance of elevated leveis of circulating cortisol, while insufficient time leads
that alcohol magnifies the severity of skeletal muscle injury and therefore delays
to chronically elevated leveis. If cortisol leveis remain elevated for a prolonged
recovery of strength over the following 24-hour period, suggesting that partici-
period: a number of adverse side effects will occur. These include slower recovery
pants of sports involving intense eccentric muscular work should be encouraged
rates, immune system suppression, gastrointestinal problems, lower testosterone
to avoid alcohol intake in the post-event period when optimal recovery is required.
leveis, weight gain, cardiovascular disease, insomnia, fatigue, psychological stress,
This was confirmed a few years later by the sarne research group after 80 minutes
depression, increased blood pressure, reduced serotonin levels, memory disorders,
of a simulated rugby game. The consumption of lg of alcohol per kilogram ofbody
decreased bone formation, blood sugar imbalance, fertility problems, and more.
mass had a negative impact on lower-body vertical power output.
While these side effects are numerous and undesirable, they can be avoided with
the practice of appropriate lifestyle habits. Proper recovery from exercise requi-
./ Massage
res a multi-factorial approach. Healthy lifestyle habits strongly influence the time
There is limited scientific evidence showing that massage might assist in recovery
needed to balance disrupted hormone leveis. A timely recove1y can be achieved
strategies (Monedero and Dorme, 2000). Recent research by Jakeman et al. (2010)
with adequate sleep, proper nutrition, and the practice of various other beneficial
reported that a combined treatment of a 30-minute manual massage and a 12-hour
lifestyle habits. During sleep, a natural balance of circulating hormones occurs. A
lower-limb compression significantly decreased perceived soreness at 48 and'72
good night's rest results in a sleep-induced decline of elevated cortisol levels, These
hours after plyometric exercise when compared to passive recovery or compression
rise even further, however, with insufficient sleep. Seven and a half hours of sleep
alone. This was confirmed by Hilbert et al. (2003) when they reported moderated
per night may be considered a sufficient amount, but nine hours is optimal. Proper
muscle-soreness ratings 48 hours after exercise when a massage was administered
nutrition provides all of the essential vitamins and minerais necessary for bodily
2 hours after eccentric exercise. Massage should be carefully administered after
functions. Nutritional factors will also strongly affect hormonal leveis. Maximizing
intensive training or match play, since massage can possibly counter the natural
foods like fruits, vegetables, and nuts while minimizing foods like trans fats, refined
recovery process of the body. Some researchers even suggest that a massage should
carbohydrates, and sugar will result in a decline of circulating cortisol. Conversely,
not be applied after training ora match because post-exercise massage could cause
poor dietary habits will result in an increase in the leveis of this hormone. The
further trauma when training or match play has caused EIMD (Barnett, 2006).
practice of many other various habits will also influence leveis of circulating cor-
Moreover, it seems that the training level of the therapist affects the effectiveness of
tisol. Severa! parameters will reduce cortisol levels and therefore decrease the time
massage (Moraska, 2007).
needed for recovery. These factors include proper hydration, massage, meditation,
deep-breathing techniques, laughter, music therapy, reduction of psychological
./ Cortisol and the autonomic nervous system
and emotional stress, and consumption of whole foods such as fruits, vegetables,
Cortisol, or hydrocortisone, is a steroid hormone produced by the adrenal glands in
beans, nuts, seeds, and wild fish. Likewise, several factors increase cortisol levels,
response to a stressar. A stressar is any potential source that places a physical, men-
extending the time necessary for recovery. These factors include alcohol consump-
tal, or emotional strain on the body or mind during a demanding circumstance.
tion, caffeine intake, severe caloric restriction, a low-fiber diet, the consumption of
When faced with a stressar, the brain triggers a cascade of hormones that ultima-
insufficient micronutrients and antioxidants, a sedentary lifestyle, and being over-
tely leads to the release of cortisol (sympathetic nervous system). This hormone is
weight. Cortisol and sympathetic dominance is a necessary component of exercise,
responsible for physically preparing the body to <leal with whatever situation has
but prolonged elevated levels can be detrimental to performance. While the role
been encountered. This physiological reaction is often referred to as the "fight-or-
this hormone plays in exercise is elaborate and complex, the necessary methods
~ight" response. This term applied in a much more literal sense during prehistoric
for recovery are simple. Adequate sleep, proper nutrition, and the practice of good
times. An encounter with a rival looking for a fight ora hungry predator Iooking for
lifestyle habits will result in improved recovery from exercise and an increase in
a meal demanded the physical preparation necessary to endure the conflict or run
performance.
from the danger. Since the evolution of civilization, however, the need to fight or
run for survival is a rare occurrence. Typical stressors today include school exams,
deadlines at work, and troubles with relationships. Although humanity's social
b~haviors hav~ rapidly evolved, the reaction to stress remains the sarne. Physiolo-
g1cal changes induced by the stress response still include a temporary elevation of
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER Fl:NESS IN SOCCER 1
231
230 Fatigue management
Fatigue management

13.4.3.4 lndívidua/ization o Organize a debriefing and set realistic goals after the match.
Since various studies on the effectiveness of recovery strategies show a high 0 Organize whole-body, cold-water immersion lasting 10-20 minutes ata water
inter-individual variability, coaches should utilize different recovery strategies temperature of 10-lSºC. (This may be after the game or the day after.)
with different players. Coaches should also consider appropriate diets, rehydra- • Avoid stressful situations.
tion, and a controlled lifestyle, and this may be a sufficient recovery intervention ° Customize recovery and don't oblige players to participate in recovery strate-
for young elite athletes (Tessitore et al., 2007). It may be even advisable to custo- gies that could be perceived as stressful.
mize recovery interventions individually based on the requirements and preferen- • Explain the use of the recovery strategies.
ces of players. After a match, emotional and mental states can increase or decrease • Focus on mental recovery after the game.
fatigue. One player might want togo to the forest or park for a recovery session to
clear his head, while another player might perceive this as an additional source of ln conclusion, post-match recovery can help prevent muscle soreness and therefore
frustration, exacerbating the psychological fatigue. the quality of subsequent training. However, passive post-match recovery strate-
It seems essential to customize recovery methods according to gender, especially gies-such as mental recovery, social support, nutrition, hydration and adequate
given the effects of gender on the physiological responses during exerdse and the sleep-are probably the most irnportant recovery strategies for the hours directly
post-exercise recovery period, so as to maximize the processes of physiological following a game. Active recovery strategies are best planned for the following
recovery while minimizing the risks of injury in female athletes (Hausswirth and day, because no differences have been found when using immediate post-match
Le Meur, 2011). Venter (2012) examined how elite team athletes perceive the impor- active recovery. Coaches should also be aware that rest and mental recovery are
tance of various recovery modalities. Differences between men and women, play- important. Forcing players to come to the ground through busy traffic, or forcing
ers frorn various team sports, and different leveis of participation were determined. skeptical players to undergo cold-water immersion or contrast baths, will probably
Recovery modalities that were rated as important by all players-regardless of gen- frustrate adequate recovery because it increases mental stress, and this will subse-
der, type of sport, or levei of participation-were sleep, fluid replacement, and soci- quently jeopardize recovery.
alizing with friends. Gender could play a role in how the importance of recovery
rnodalities was perceived. Men rated anice bath and supplernents as significantly Short-term rccovcry
more important than women, while women rated discussions with their teammates
and coaches after training and matches as significantly more important than men. Process Duration

Phosphocreatine stores 3-5 min. The replenishment of CP stores is an oxygen


dependent processes (Bonen et ai., 1978)
13.4.4 Recovery strategies: Conclusion Breakdown and processing of lactate 1-3 hours. The half-life period is approximately 15
The recovery phase must be considered as an inherent component of the trai- min. Awide range of lactate e!imination constants
(expressed as half-life period: 9.2-18.2 min) has been
ning process. It must therefore be granted the sarne degree of attention in its pro- demonstrated in cyclists after exhaustive exercise.
gramming and management as the exercise sessions themselves (Hausswirth and This supports the hypothesis of inter-individua!
Le Meur, 2011). Given the importance of improving how athletes feel, combined variation in lactate kinetics. (Frnncaux et a!., 1989)
recovery strategies could be used after intense soccer match play to help perceived
recovery (Kinugasa and Kílding, 2009). Table 13.1: Short-tenn recovery (< 6 hours).

Recommendations:
• Replenish glycogen stores immediately after a match (intake of carbohydrates). Recovery between 6 and 36 hours
• Consume proteins to assist muscle regeneration.
• Don't drink alcohol before or after a match. Process Duration

• Warm up properly, because this will decrease post-match DOMS. Glycogen compensation 24-36h
• Restore fluid balance.
Normalization and replenishment of electrolyte concentrn!ions (N, Ka) 6h
• Do not use massage.
• Replenish electrolytes. Buildup of contractile proteins 12-48h
• Sleep a minimum of 10 hours for each of the two days following a match (sleep
Tab/e 13.2: Recovery between 6 and 36 hours.
extension).
• Take a daily nap of 25 minutes after lunch (between lpm and 4pm).
• Avoid any eccentric work in the two days following the match.
• Avoid explosive actions, such as sprinting or shooting drills, in the 48 hours
after a match.
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
232 1
233
Fatigue management Fatigue management

RECOVERY >48H 13.5.2 Heart Rate Variability (HRV)


Process Duration It has been proposed that the cardiac autonomic nervous system-assessed nonin-
vasively via exercise heart rate (HRex), heart rate recovery (HRR) or heart rate vari-
Replenishment of musc!e enzymes 48-60h
ability (HRV) (Buchheit et al., 2012}-may provide useful information regarding
Rebuilding of protein structures, 48-72h functional adaptations to a given training stimulus. HRV recordings have been
including mitochondria
shovvn to reflect acute fatigue following exercise (Mourot et al., 2004) and used to
Supercompensation of glycogen 48-72h make inferences about appropriate training periodization (Kiviniemi et al., 2007}.
reserves
The usefulness of a marker to assess physiological adaptation to training ideally
Replenishing electro!ytes (Mg, Fe) 48-72h requires it to be easy to administer, so frequent monitoring will be possible with
Replenishment of hormones 48-72h minimal inconvenience to the athlete (Borresen and Lamber, 2008). Studies monito-
catecho!amine resynthesis ring daily morning HRV at rest (Plews et al., 2012; Sartor et al., 2013) or post-exer-
Cortisol resynthesis 3-5 days cise (Buchheit et al., 2012) have used protocols that require recordings in excess of
five minutes. This may not be practical in a team sport environment. It has been
Replenishing of glycogen stores Pi eh li (197 4) investigated the reptenishment of glycogen
stores after exercise. During the first five hours, there suggested that ECG recordings as short as 10 seconds can accurately predict car-
was a marked storage of glycogen in the muscle that diac vagai tone (Hamilton et al, 2004). This therefore opens the doar for shorter,
was re!ated to the carbohydrate intake, but pre-exercise more practical HR recordings, which could then be used to access daily HRV in a
concentrations of muscle glycogen were first observed
after 46 hours. The increase in glycogen occurred in team environment.
both fiber types, but the fast twitch fiber replenished
their g!ycogen somewhat faster than the slow twitch 13.5.2.1 Guidelines for col/ection
fibers, suggesting a higher g!ycogen synthetase activity.
Day-to-day variation in HRV values is high because of a number of environmental
New production of structura! proteins days to weeks factors, such as noise, temperature, light and so on (TaskForce, 1996). The lack of
{enzymes, mitochondria, binding
support tissue) sensitivity ofHRV measures to detect fatigue may at times be caused by the relative
"errar" of these recordings (AI Haddad et al., 2011), and these factors most likely
Tabfe 13.3: Recovery > 48 hours. account for the large discrepancy between studies. Thus, a consensus on the most
valid and reliable HRV índex and collection method needs to be established for
consistent research methodology and data collection in a practical environment.
13.5 MONITORING FATIGUE ANO RECOVERY IN SOCCER As is shown in the literature, HRV assessments can be highly sensitive to physiolo-
gical and environmental changes. The physiological changes are what we want to
13.5.1 lntroduction monitor, so it is therefore very important to limit the number of externai factors that
The implementation of a successful training program in soccer requires an appro- can lead to inaccurate, unreliable results. In arder to gain the most accurate and the-
priate training stimulus relative to the physical capabilities of the player, coupled refore most useful results, it is vital to be consistent in your measurement protocol.
with adequate recovery periods. Failure to maintain this equilibrium can increase One of the most important factors in gaining accurate results is the timing of the
injury risk and lead to overtraining (Kuipers and Keizer, 1988). Therefore, in hig- measurement. Research and product guidelines from companies offering HRV-as-
hly trained soccer players subjected to high training loads, any methods likely to sessment products (e.g., OmegaWave, iThlete, etc.) suggest that the most accurate
improve the knoi;vledge of a player's training status are of great interest to coa- time for assessment of ANS status is first thing in a morning upon waking. During
ches. Multiple methods for monitoring load and status have been suggested, but sleep, the parasympathetic branch of the ANS is dominant, repairing and rebuil-
their invasive (e.g., blood markers) (Heisterberg et al., 2013) and/ or exhaustive ding muscles and replenishing fuel stores. Thus, after a night of rest is the optimum
(e.g., maximal tests) (Meeusen et al., 2006) nature makes them difficult to monitor time for HRV assessment. However, this may not be the most practical method in
frequently in a team sport environment. More recently, a number of more practi- a team environment. It requires each player to have access to equipment at home
cal testing methods have been suggested and researched, such as heart rate vari- and trust in the players to complete this assessment correctly away from coaching
ability (HRV), monitoring of neuromuscular fatigue through jump tests, and the and medical staff.
use of subjective questionnaires. This chapter will therefore detail various practical Another assessment protocol proposed by Martin Buchheit is the 5' -5' test. This
methods for monitoring fatigue and recovery, outline protocols for data collection involves 5 minutes of running ata submaximal pace (9 km/h) folloi;ved by 5 minu-
in a squad environment, and provide information on various analysis methods. tes of recovery. This test allows for assessment of HRex during the 5-min run, HRR
Finally, it will offer the reader some steps and information on developing a play- during the first 60s of recovery and post-exercise HRV from the final 3 minutes of
er-monitoring system that can be used to visualize data and provide the coach or recovery. The rationale behind this method of assessment is the ability to assess
sports scientist with an overview of a player's training status. multiple HR indices all at once and its ability to eliminate environmental stressors

l
that are apparent during resting HRV assessments. While this protocol is time con-
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
234 . 235
Fatigue management Fatigue management

suming, rnaking it less practical for daily monitoring of fatigue and recovecy in ./ HRV Indices
soccer, it could be used on a weekly, monthly or post-training-phase basis, and it Using the R-R interval gained from the ECG, a number of time-domain and fre-
has been shown to correlate well with fitness- and drill-based running performance quency-domain methods can be used for analysis (mathematical calculations
(Buchheit et al., 2012). used to assess HRV from R-R intervals). Task-Force (1996) suggests the variety of
A more practical method of assessing HRV may be a morning resting reading con- time-domain measures of HRV is not important, because many of the measures
ducted on arrival at the training ground. This allows for a quick and reliable assess- correlate closely with others. However, the Ln rMSSD is suggested as the prefer-
ment on a daily basis under the supervision of coaching and medical staff. When red index for assessing short-term components of HRV. Ln rMSSD is a mathemati-
using this protocol, it is important to educate the players about their morning rou- cal calculation behveen R-R intervals and stands for "the natural logarithm of the
tines. Players must consume no liquids other than water, particularly no energy square root of the mean sum of the squared differences behveen R-R intervals."
drinks or coffee. They must also refrain from any strenuous activity and not con- Ln rMSSD has been shown to be the most reliable HRV index for short-term recor-
sume any food until after the assessment. Further details and an example of this dings, and it is used by manufacturers of HRV-assessment products for a number
protocol will be set out later in the chapter. of reasons:
• Breathing frequency, unlike other spectral índices of HRV, does not signi-
13.5.2.2 Analysis .ficantly influence Ln rMSSD and is therefore more suited to ambulatory
Once a valid and reliable assessment protocol has been set out and data has been measures.
collected, the next important step is data analysis. With modem technology like • Ln rMSSD can capture leveis of parasympathetic activity over a short time
iThlete and OmegaWave, all of the analysis is dane for you. You simply perform the frame, which is more convenient for athletes \Vho have limited time to acquire
ECG recording and are given a HRV score. Some statistical analysis on your "readi- a reading.
ness" to train is even provided using rolling averages and worthwhile-change sta-
tistics. However, for a sports scientist, it is important to understand the process ./ Daily vs. Weekly Analysis
behind these numbers. The first step in the analysis of HRV is obtaining high-qua- As previously stated, day-to-day variation in HRV can be high dueto environmen-
lity ECG tracings under stable, controlled conditions. ln a practical environment, tal noise. This makes the analysis of daily changes difficult to interpret. Research
this will usually be completed via HR telemetry. The second step is the recognition has proposed that when HRV is used to assess changes in both negative and posi-
of the QRS complex (Figure 13.4A). Peak detection is often performed with com- tive adaptation, both weekly and seven-day rolling averages may provide better
mercially available sofhvare. An algorithm is then used (Beckers et al., 1999) for methodological validity than values taken on a single day. For example, Plews et al.
threshold detection. The result is a discrete, unevenly spaced time event series: the (2013) found that when HRV data points were averaged over a week, a meaningful
tachogram obtained from the ECG. It is crucial that these signals are corrected for representation of training status was apparent in an NFOR (non-functional over-re-
abnormal and missed beats before processing (Aubert and Ramaekers, 1999; Pum- aching) elite triathlete (i.e., worthwhile reductions in weekly-averaged HRV were
prla et al., 2002). After this step, an R-R interval (ali intervals behveen adjacent QRS observed only during the period of NFOR). Comparatively, when single day values
complexes resulting from sinus nade depolarizations, often called a normal-to-nor- were used for analysis, the HRV data were misleading (i.e., worthwhile reductions
mal (N-N) interval) can be obtained (Figure 13.4B). in HRV indicative of NFOR occurred when the athlete was training and perfor-
ming effectively). This suggests that averaged morning resting HRV data provi-
A des a more consistent representation of actual changes in an athlete's autonomic
balance with training when compared with a single isolated value.
1
1! ./ Weekly Coefficient of Variation (CV)
An innovative method of assessment proposed by Plews et al. (2013) is a weekly
rolling coefficient of variation (CV). The authors found a reduction in the day-to-
day variability of HRV, in conjunction with rolling average HRV, in an athlete that
was diagnosed with NFOR. The authors therefore suggested weekly rolling CV
B
may provide a more complete measure for diagnosing NFOR, as it is still unclear
whether HRV should be expected to increase ar decrease in the case of overtraining
(OT). The use of rolling CV would be therefore applicable irrespective of the trend
towards parasympathetic ar sympathetic dominance and the stage of NFOR ar OT.

Fig. 13.4: A) Hearl rate QRS complex obtained from ECG. B) Example of hearl rate R-R intervaf. 1
1
f

;q!
'.~~--,
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
236 Fatigue management Fatigue management 1237

./ HRV to HR Ratio Figure 13.5 shows HRV to HR profiles for six players in the sarne squad, all of
A further method of HRV analysis that was suggested by Plews et al., (2013) is who completed the sarne six-week preseason training program. All players show
the Ln rMSSD to R-R interval ratio. They propose that a common misconception distinctly different profiles, despite the fact that ali players coped well with the
made by sports practitioners using HRV to assess ANS status is that there is a direct demands of training, as is evident in the stable levels of HRV (-0.01 (-0.11; 0.09)
linear relationship between the vagal-related indices of HRV and the parasympa- AU/ day) and wellness (-0.02 (- 0.06; 0.03) AU / day) throughout the training period
thetic influence on heart rate (HR). ln reality, however, the relationship is quadratic
(Goldberger et ai., 1994). This means that at both low (high HR) and high (low HR) This has important implications for practitioners working in soccer, where data
levels of vagal tone, vagal-related HRV indices are reduced. This is an important may be analyzed as a group and the conceptions of what is optimal may be applied
consideration for practitioners using HRV to assess training status in elite athletes, to the group as a whole. Furthermore, the optimal relationship between HRV and
who typically have a low resting HR, undergo high training loads, and are there- RHR is likely to be individual (i.e., correlated, low-correlated or saturated [Kivi-
fore prone to saturation (e.g., decrease in HRV and decrease in HR) (Kiviniemi et niemi et al., 2004]). This implies that longitudinal monitoring and an understan-
al., 2004). For example, during the different phases/loads of training, reductions in ding of an individual player's response to training and competition (HRV to HR
HRV can occur, "theoretically" indicating ANS stress. However, this trend should "fingerprint") is needed before this relationship can be useful enough to assist with
only be interpreted in light of the respective changes in resting HR to assess whether training prescription and act as a possible predictor of overtraining.
this decrease can be the result of the saturation phenomenon or not. This can be
achieved by using the HRV to HR ratio, which simultaneously considers changes in 13.5.2.3 HRV Summary
both vagai tone (HR) and vagal modulation (HRV). However, research has shown In summary, reductions in HRV may be associated with fatigue in soccer players.
that individual players can display very different HRV to HR ratios when they are However, the conclusions from past literature suggest isolated HRV values should
fatigued or in an optimal state (Plews et al., 2013; Fitzpatrick et al., unpublished). be viewed with caution. We suggest the use of both the HRV rolling \veekly aver-
age and HRV-to-HR ratio to correctly interpret fatigue, ora "readiness to perform,"
110 in soccer players. (i.e., Worthwhile reductions in HRV with concurrent increases in
100
r=-0.60
{-0.90;-0.fi4)
the HRV to HR ratio are more indicative of fatigue, with decreases in both possibly
indicating readiness to perform.) Furthermore, the optimal relationship between
~
'" ..
00

~
~

.. .~, ' ',,
,, ''·
'',, .
HRV and HR for training and performance alone is likely to be individual. This
implies that longitudinal monitoring and an understanding of a particular athlete's
70 response to training and competition is required for effective monitoring.
r=-0.17
(-0.4!1;UH)
"!ow<eire!atod"
00
13.5.3 Monitoring Neuromuscular Fatigue
"'
10•
, .. -0.37
(-0.64;-0.03)
Measures of neuromuscular function are often used to assess recovery after soccer

00 .... ..
.,.,..
·1ow-o;... li1:,,d· training or match play (Magalhães et ai., 2010) because of their greater ability to
monitor low-frequency fatigue compared with other indirect markers. Measures of
~ ~
..,
~
• • •• ,.!' neuromuscular function include various jump tests (e.g., countermovement jump,
~
• 70
....,~ squat jump), sprint performance, and isokinetic dynamometry. Jump procedures
r:.(l,59 are popular due to their replication of the stretch-shortening capabilities of the
"00
(-0.79:-0.30)
•tricar'" lower-limb musculature and the ability to evaluate fatigue (Komi, 2000). Moreover,
jump measures are ideal for a soccer environment because they are noninvasive,
110 easy to administer, easy to interpret, and cause minimal additional fatigue (Twist
t= -0.42
and Highton, 2013). While some research has questioned the sensitivity of jump
·~=~~~)º"
100

. ... ,..,
procedures in assessing neuromuscular fatigue in tearn sports (Cormack et al.,
--
..
00

'
~ '
''-.,
2008), others have found it to detect impaired muscle function in soccer players
>
~ ',,_ •, following match play (Magalhães et ai., 2010) .
~
70
r=.(l.75
00

00
(-0 61;-0.~6)
'L~nr'" •
40 00
" 70
'HR (tioot.mlrr')
00 00 100 40 50 00 70 00
HR(IX:nlltli"'f 1 )
00 100

Fig. 13.5: HRV to HR profi/es for six different players who ai/ followed lhe sarne training program
over a six-week preseason training period (Fitzpatrick et ai., unpublished).
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
238 Fatigue management Fatigue management 1239

13.5.3.1 Methods of Assessment If the flight time to contraction time ratio is going to be measured, one simple
3D kinematic motion analysis is considered the "gold-standard" criterion method method of assessing this is a drop jump (DJ). Astudy by Hamilton (2009) suggested
to evaluate jump performance; however, this procedure is time consuming and the DJ may offer a more valuable insight into the neuromuscular changes associa-
impractical in an applied setting. Another data collection method is to use a por- ted with fatigue, due to the comparable muscle qualities required for success in a
table force platform. This can provide comprehensive data on a number of para- drop jump, agility tasks, and maximal running speed.
meters, such as muscle force, power, rate of force development, jump height, and
flight-time characteristics during jumping. Another useful variable that appears to 13.5.3.3 Dropjump protocol to assess recovery
be sensitive to fatigue changes after match play is the flight time to contraction time 0 Each player should perform a thorough standardized warm up consisting of
ratio or reactive strength index (RSI, jump height ! contact time). This represents dynamic stretching and jumping activities.
the time from the initiation of the countermovement until the player leaves the • As suggested by Taylor et ai. (2012) multi pie triais (>4) should be performed to
force plate. Collecting data on several parameters is particularly useful given that ensure the most reliable results.
peak force recovers more quickly than peak power and rate of force development 0 Instruct players to drop from a box height of 30cm then jump vertically for
in team sport players after a match (McLellan et ai., 2011). maximal height with minimal contact on the ground and with minimal flexion
Some protocols may include single countermovement jumps, while other resear- of lhe knee and hip.
chers have suggested multiple jumps (e.g., five repeated countermovement jumps) 0 Verbal encouragement should be given to players to perform maximally.
because several variables within this protocol might react differently than with a o If using a contact mat, calculate the reactive strength index (RSI) by dividing
single jump, and this could be useful in understanding the mechanisms of fatigue jump height by contact time.
(Cormack et al., 2008). Jump performance can also be assessed using a contact mat 0 Take the mean of multiple DJ-RSI scores for analysis.
or similar system, but this provides only measures of flight time, predicted jump
height based on vertical displacement, and contact time. This method does unde- 13.5.4 Psychometric and subjective monitoring tools
restimate jump height when compared with a criterion measure, but it still has Changes in subjective psychometric wellness and mood states have frequently
good reliability (Moir et al., 2008). The contact mat therefore provides a cost-effec- been described as consistent, sensitive, and early markers of overreaching and
tive alternative to measuring neuromuscular function when a portable force plat- overtraining in competitive athletes (Meeusen et al., 2006; Urhausen and Kinder-
form is not available. mann, 2002). Alterations in perceived fatigue and muscle soreness are also known
to outlast reductions in neuromuscular performance and biochemical markers in
13.5.3.2 Types ofJumpAssessment elite team sport players (Twist et al., 2012). An advantage of subjective measures is
The countermovement jump (CMJ) is one method often used to assess neuro- their ability to capture other aspects of player >vellness, such as fear of failure, com-
muscular fatigue. Although this test has been widely researched across a range peti tive failure, excessive expectations from a coach or the public, and the demands
of sports, inconsistency still exists with regard to how effective CMJ performance of competition, as well as the professional and social areas of a player's life. This
is as an indicator of fatigue. Most notably, studies by Cormack et ai. (2008; 2008a), change in psychological state, or mental fatigue, is also known to alter an individu-
examined the reliability of a number of CMJ parameters during inter- and intra-day al's sense of effort, forcing athletes to down-regulate their exercise capacity (Mar-
repeat tests and the response of several of these variables following a single AFL cora et al., 2009). Measurement of these subjective markers is therefore deemed
game. These studies identified that CMJ height lacked the necessary sensitivity to necessary to better understand fatigue and recovery in soccer players.
optimally detect the changes associated with neuromuscular fatigue. They propo- A range of tools for the measurement of subjective wellness exist, such as the Pro-
sed that because CMJ height is a performance outcome, small alterations in techni- file of Mood States questionnaire (POMS), the Daily Analysis of Life Demands for
que are not acknowledged during data analysis, yet it is these minor modifications Athletes questionnaire, the Recovery-Stress Questionnaire for athletes, and the
that occur when neuromuscular fatigue is present. It was proposed by Cormack et Total Quality Recovery scale. These all enable coaches to easily monitor the con1-
al. (2008) that the CMJ ratio of flight time to contraction time appears to be the most plex psychophysiological stresses that are associated with fatigue and recovery,
useful variable for monitoring neuromuscular stahts because of its high sensitivity such as muscle soreness, sleep quality, mood disturbances, and altered attitudes
and the substantial changes observed following match play. to training. Unquestionably, the time course of changes in a player's psychological
state during periods of intense training and underperformance is concurrent with
This is further supported by the work of Taylor et al. (in review). The authors physiological and performance changes. However, a concern raised by coaches is
looked at various kinetic and kinematic variables in order to examine their sensiti- the subjectivity of these measures and the scope for athletes to manipulate respon-
vity to fatigue-induced neuromuscular status. They found jump height to be sensi- ses to facilitate a favorable outcome. Moreover, when questionnaires are completed
tive to changes in neuromuscular status, but this was not apparent in ali subjects. daily. coupled with the length of some questionnaires, concerns over player com-
Findings showed that negative responses in the flight time to contraction time ratio pliance need to be considered.
were observed during deliberate overreaching for ali subjects.
240
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER
Fatigue management
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Fatigue management 1241

13.5.4.1 Profile of Mood States (POMS) Sleep and Rcst (4 points)


POMS is a psychological rating scale that measures the state of mind/rnood for 3 points
Good night of quality sleep
sportspersons via six scales: Tension-Amciery, Depression-Dejection, Anger-Hosti-
lity, Vigor-Activity, Fatigue-Inertia, Confusion-Bewilderment. Players are asked to Daily nap (20-60min) 1 point

self-report a series of mood states. The original test was developed by McNair and Relaxation and Emotional Support (3 points)
co-workers and has 65 items. A shorter version of tl;ie POMS test was developed
Fu!I mental/muscular relaxation ASAP after practice 2 points
by Cella and colleagues in 1987 that contains only 11 of the original POMS items.
The POMS scale has been used in thousands of scientific investigations and is very Maintaining a relaxed state throughout lhe day 1 point
useful in assessing how players cape with training loads. Stretching and Warm down (3 points)

Proper warm down after each training period 2 points


13.5.4.2 RESTQ-sport (The Recovery-Stress Questionnaire for Athletes)
There are also questionnaires available for monitoring recovery. The RESTQ-sport Stretching all lhe exercised muscle groups 1 point
(Kellmann and Kallus, 2001) assesses the player's perception of recovery. The
RESTQ-sport has been used worldwide to monitor perceived recovery. Coutts and Table 13.4: Total quality recovery
Reaburn (2008) assessed whether the Recovery-Stress Questionnaire for Athletes
(RESTQ-Sport) could be used to monitor changes in perceived stress and reco- 13.5.4.4 Ratings of Perceived Exertion
very during intensified training of rugby league players. They concluded that the Ratings of perceived exertion (RPEs) are a qualitative and simple way of rneasuring
RESTQ-Sport is a practical psychometric tool for monitoring responses to training the exertion perceived during training. It takes into consideration the mental and
in team sport athletes. physical factors that cause the stresses of training. The concept of perceived exer-
However, the test cannot be executed daily because it asks the athlete about how tion was introduced by Gunnar Borg as the "Borg RPE Scale®." This was done by
often the respondent participated in various activities during the preceding three placing verbal anchors from sirnple category (C) scales (rank order scales) at the
days and nights. best possible position on a ratio scale (a "CR-scale"), covering the total subjective
dynamic range, so that a correspondence in rneaning was obtained between the
13.5.4.3 Total quality recovery (TQR) numbers and the anchors. The range of 6-20 was created so the HR can be simply
The TQR (Kentta and Hassmen, 2002) is a 20-point scale that assesses recovery as a estimated by multiplying the Borg score by 10. This gives an approximate heart rate
combination of recovery actions and the athlete's perceptions of recovery. Players for a particular level of activity.
using the TQR concept collect points in a 24-hour period. A score of 20 is the maxi-
mum score, while 13 is considered the rninimum score. Scores below this arbitrary Total Quality Rccovery
threshold could indicate under-recovery. This questionnaire makes the player
6 No recovery at all
aware of the important factors for boosting recovery, such as eating regularly and
7 extremely poor recovery
drinking enough before and after physical exertion. It is very easy to use and can be
used daily, and it is easily assessed by both players and coaches. 8
9 very poor recovery

Scoring Recovery Points 10


11 poor recovery
Nutrition & Hydration (8 points)
12
Breakfast 1 point
13 reasonable recovery
Lunch 2 point
14
Supper 2 points
15 good recovery
Snacks between meals 1 point 16
Carbohydrate reloading after practice 2 points 17 very good recovery

Adequate hydration (8 points) 18


19 extremely good recovery
throughout lhe day 1 point
20 Maximal Recovery
During and post-workout 1 point
FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
J FITNESS IN SOCCER 243
242 Fatigue management
Fatigue management

Another simple measure that can be added to a daily wellness questionnaire is


13.5.4.5 Wellness questionnaires
"areas of muscle soreness, stiffness and pain." This can allow coaches, sports scien-
Possibly a more practically applicable solution is the use of shorter, simpler ques-
tists, and medical staff to monitor any potential areas of discomfort and injury
tionnaires, such as that proposed by McLean et al. (2010). A simple questionnaire
such as this is time efficient, always available for daily collection, and able to cap- (Figure 13.7).
ture data on a number of wellness measures. Figure 13.6 shows an example ques-
tionnaire adapted from Mclean et al. (2010). It includes fatigue and energy leveis,
sleep quality, sleep duration, general muscle soreness, and stress and mood leveis.

Fig. 13. 7: A simp/e anatomica/ diagram that can be used to allow p/ayers to note down areas of
soreness on their daily we/lness questionnaire (TopSportsLab)

Y Analysis of Daily Wellness Questionnaire


All five measures on this simple daily questionnaire are scored on a 1-5 scale, with 1
"Eo "Eo being very poor and 5 being very good. This allows for certain variables to be either
z z analyzed on an individual basis or through a summed score (out of 25) that gives
the Total Daily Player Wellness. Statistical analysis of the questionnaire, along with
all other measures of fatigue and recovery, will be explained in the next section.
ro
o~
- o
~
o
o
""o
~::;
ID ~
13.5.5 Statistical analysis
The fundamental goal for any player-monitoring system is the ability to inform
"' X
.!!!
ID <!)
0
o decisions and ultimately improve performance. Although daily assumptions can
be made using various data-collection methods, as discussed above, it is important
"' to note that it can take months and even years of data collection to truly understand
what the data means and how to use it. Jumping to conclusions based on an inade-
quate amount of data can lead to poor decisions being made that have a negative
effect on performance.
To successfully collect, analyze, and interpret data, the first step is your collection
protocol. Below is an example of a typical daily routine that can be carried out each
morning in around 20 minutes.

8:30am - Players arrive at the training ground and fill out Daily Wellness
·'ª"
"iii Questionnaires as they collect their training kits.
àe. 8:35am - Players report to the gymnasium for a one-minute HR assessment.
OJ This involves a few minutes of relaxation followed by the one-minute HR
OJ
ü; reading to assess HRV and Resting HR.
8:40am - Following their HRV assessment, players perform a standardized
warm up before completing four drop jumps on a contact mat to assess daily
Fig. 13.6:. Example Dai/y Wellness Questionnaire. (Adapted from Mc/ean et ai., 2010) RSL
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
244 245
Fatigue management Fatigue management

Once this protocol has been cornpleted, players are free to have breakfast and relax the training Ioad in the days or weeks preceding a competition or match. This is
until the start of training. ln this time, the data can be analyzed by support staff done in order to reduce accumulated fatigue and unmask fitness leveis, because
and reported to coaches, detailing players who require rest or a reduced training residual fatigue may mask or attenuate fitness gains that have occurred through
load and players who are in an optimum condition to train fully. If this system is to overload training (Kuipers and Keizer, 1988). This decrease in training load could,
work, an efficient data-collection database and analysis system needs to be in place. however, compromise training-induced adaptations. Lower leveis of training load
Following data collection, the next important step is analyzing the data and and the subsequently decreased leveis of accumulated fatigue can cause a partial
deciding which changes in the daily measures warrant intervention. The use of loss of training-induced performance adaptations, a process known as detraining
arbitrary thresholds (e.g., a change of 5%) has been discouraged (Twist and High- or deconditiong. Coaches must determine the extent to which the training load can
ton, 2013) because the variation observed, when identifying a fatigued condi- be reduced at the expense of the training parameters while retaining or improving
tion, may fall within the boundaries of typical variation for some measurements adaptations (Mujika, 2011). Exercise intensity during a taper seems to be the key in
(e.g., jump measurements -1-6%; Cormack et al., 2008). One possible statístical maintaining or elevating performance. Research has demonstrated that low trai-
method that may provide a better insight into the magnitude of change is the smal- ning intensities either maintained or deteriorated performance (McConnell et al.,
lest worthwhile change statistic (SWC) (Hopkins et al., 2009). This is calculated by 1993), while tapers using intensities of 90% V0 2max (Costíll et al., 1985) resulted in
multiplying the between-player standard deviation by 0.2. Figure 13.8 depicts an enhanced performance. Houmard and Johns (1994) advised using interval training
example of how this method can be used to show a positive or negative change in work (>90% V0 2maJ with sufficient recovery behveen bouts to maximize exercise
monitoring data. intensity. They suggest this is necessary to maintain training-associated adaptati-
ons despite the reduction in training volume. This was confirmed by Bosquet et
Dally assessment of HRV al. (2007) who found that maximal gains are obtained with a tapering interventíon
Mon Toe Thurs of a two-1veek duration where the training volume is exponentially decreased by
P/aycr 1
Player 2
85.9
79.9
BS.2
79.9
Wed
88,7
81.4
85.7
81.9
"'
85.7
ll4.7
Chang e Thur-Fri
o.o
2.8
No Change
Positive Change
41-60%, without any modification to either training intensity or frequency.
Player3 87.9 87.4 86.2 82.7 87.6 4.9 Positive Change
Player4 63.0 62.7 64.G 65.4 65.B 0.4 Trivial 13.6.1 Effects ofTaper
Playcr 5 79.0 79.9 79.9 81.4 81.9 0.5 Trivial Tapering provides for:
Avcrage 79.8 • increased hemoglobin
50 8.4 • increased hematocrit value
swc 1.68 • decreased percentage of neutrophils
• increased red blood cell volume
Fig. 13. 8: Example of monitoring changes in rolling average HRV using SWC. • increased production of new red blood cells
• increased buffer capacity for lactíc acid
This method can be applied to ali monitoring data to give coaches and support • increased muscle glycogen
staff a qualitative description of the magnitude of daily changes in recovery status. • increase in testosterone
• reduction of cortisol
• increase in the testosterone-cortisol ratio
13.6 TAPERING o increased sleep (This is important because of gro1vth hormone being released
Tapering is part of fatigue-management strategies. ln the last phase of the micro- during certain phases of sleep, resulting in muscle tissue repair [Taylor et al.,
cycle, mini-tapering strategies should be applied. Tapering is one of the most 1997]).
important challenges for a coach, because it is a method of strategically unloading • improved perceived sleep quality
athletes in order to reach peak leveis of preparedness for competitíon. Various fac-
tors have to be taken into account in this regard, such as the accumulated fatigue
of the preceding days, physical and psychological stress, and recovery (e.g., sleep,
nutrition, etc.). Tapering is a progressive non-linear reductíon of the training load
during a variable period of time in an attempt to reduce the physiological and
psychological stress of daily training and optimize sports performance (Mujika
and Padilla, 2003). Various forms of tapering have been described in the literature,
such as a linear taper in training load (Hickson et al., 1982), an incremental step-
wise reduction (Houmard and Johns, 1994), and an exponential taper with slow
or fast time-constant decay of the training load (Banister et al., 1995). Training
parameters like intensity, duration, frequency and volume can be altered to lower
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
246 247
Fatigue management Fatigue management

13.6.2 Rules for good tapering 13.6.3.2 Mesocycle


13.6.2.1 lntensíty 1. Tapering strategies are applied every third week to allow the body to recover
Intensity during tapering must be rnaintained in arder to avoid detraining. It is while avoiding detraining:
through the reduction of the other training parameters (i.e., volume, frequency and 2. Reduce the total training volume by 60% by reducing the duration of training
duration) that efficient tapering should be achieved. Bosquet et al. (2007) highligh- sessions,
ted that the training load should not be reduced at the expense of training intensity 3. ICeep the volume of high-intensity training sessions high.
during a taper (Bosquet et ai., 2007). 4. Increase the recovery time between exercises.
5. Reduce training frequency by 20%.
13.6.2.2 Frequency 6. Activities during tapering should be specific to the technical/tactical requi-
Decreasing training frequency has not been demonstrated to improve perfor- rements of the sport. So, in particular, reduce activities that are not specific to
mance. Bosquet et al. (2007), however, highlighted that frequency of training is clo- the sport.
sely linked to other training parameters, such as volume and intensity.

13.6.2.3 Volume 13.6.4 Macrocycle


Research suggests that the volume of training can be reduced to 50-70% of normal There is an ongoing discussion in the media about players' recovery time before
without the special adaptations specific to the training being compromised. Mujika the start of every major tournament. Many players sustain injuries during such
et al. (2000) reported some years ago that better performance ensues from low-vo- toumaments, and some "star" players remain below their normal leveis. Natio-
lume rather than moderate-volume tapers. This finding was confirmed by Le Meur nal federations try to solve this problem by shortening the competition or brin-
et al. (2012) when they suggested that athletes would maximize taper-associated ging it forward. Everyone probably remembers the 1992 European Championships
benefits by roughly halving their training volume. when Denmark unexpectedly won the tournament. Ten days before the start of
the UEFA European Football ChampionshipT"' finais qualifiers, Yugoslavia were
13.6.2.4 Duration excluded and replaced by Denmark, the runners-up in their qualifying group.
Research shows that the optimal taper duration depends on the pre-taper training National coach Richard Meller Nielsen had to contact his players, many of whom
volume and intensity, and it is generally 4-21 days. Tapering takes longer for speed had already left on vacation. They Jiterally changed from their holiday clothes into
and strength athletes than it does for endurance athletes on account of the nervous training gear. Some players had already been on vacation for four weeks. Accor-
system recovering more slowly. It may be concluded that a taper duration of 7 to ding to many observers, the psychological and physical freshness of the players
15 days appears to represent the threshold between the positive effects of lowering had a decisive factor in the success.
accumulated fatigue and the negative effects of deconditioning (Fitz-Clarke et al., Two scientific studies describe preparations for an international toumament. ln the
1991) on performance. first study, Bangsbo et al. (2006) describe the preparation of the Danish national
team for the 1996 European Championships. The players were given a 1-2 week
13.6.3 Conclusion break before the start of preparations, followed by 18 days of training divided into
The effects of mini-tapers have not yet been examined in team sports. Almost two nine-day phases. The intensity of the exercises was identical in both phases,
all research on tapering strategies has focused on individual (endurance) sports. but the volume was reduced in the second phase. The researchers emphasized that
Based on this research, we suggest the following strategies within the microcycles, it is important to measure the training load during all exercises. The load during
mesocycles, and macrocycle of team sports, non-fitness exercises also has to be taken into account.
ln 1998, France won the World Championships. Four years later, the sarne natio-
13.6.3.1 Microcycle nal team was eliminated at the group stage, despite fielding a virtually identical
Mini-tapering strategies are applied during the last two days before a match to team. A study conducted in 2003 (Ferret and Cotte, 2003) describes the difference
reduce levels of accumulated fatigue, unmask fitness levels, and increase freshness between the two preparation programs. In 1998, 14 players arrived 32 days before
and preparedness. the start of the competition, 11 players arrived 25 days before, and finally, three
1. Reduce the training duration by 50-60%. players started their preparations 19 days before the start of the competition. Four
2. Training intensity remains the sarne. years later, 7 players started preparing 25 days before the competition, 15 players
3. Increase the recovery time between exercises. started 18 days before, and one player started only 8 days before. According to
4. Stimulate mental recovery. the authors, the team had enough time in 1998 to prepare properly for the World
5. Stimulate sleep extension. Championships by optimizing the players' fitness. The staff organized two trai-
6. Wear compression socks while traveling. ning camps (Tignes and Clairefontaine). The group started with high volumes of
7. Skip commercial activities and sponsor needs. training, followed by three weeks of tapering, during which a few friendly games
8. Manage media demands. were played and the players were given rest periods to eliminate fatigue. ln 2002,
FITNESS IN SOCCER
FITNESS IN SOCCER
2481 Fatigue management Fatigue management 1249
ilorref-"n,J. and Lambert, M.I., 200S. Autonomic control olhc.1rt rale during and aftcr excrdoc. Spor!S mcdicin~, 38(8), pp.633·M6
the players had only a few days to prepare. During this period, it was impossible to llosqucl, L, Montpclit,)., Arvu;ais, D. and Mujil:a, !., 2007. Effo:lfi of tapcring on performance: a mcta·analysw. Med Sei Sporl!i Exerc,
39(8), pp-1358-65. ' - ' - •
rebuild fitness and still allow tapering. Medical and biochemical markers showed Bottcrill, C. and Wilson, C., 2002. Ovcrlraining: Emotional and mlcrdiodphnary d1mem;10M. ln: M. Kcllm,mn, cd. 2002. Enhaneing reco·
very: Prevcnting underpcrformancc in athlctc". Champaii;n, li.: Human Kinctics. pp. 1·!3-160. .
that the players were fatigued. ln these circumstances, it was impossible for the Buchheit, M., Simpson, M.ll., Al Haddad, H., ilourdon, P.C and Mcndcz.Villanucva, A, 2012. Monitoring diangc5 in phyoica! pcrfor-
man<:<> with hNrt rate mcaoure; in young r.oc<:<>r pfaycrn. Eur) Appl. Phyoiol, 112(2), pp.711-723
staff to prepare the team properly. Caldcr, t\., 2003. Rccowry otrategics foroports pcrfomrnn<:<>. USOC Olympic Coa~h E·Mag.1zinc
Camm, A.J., MaHY~ M., lliggcr, J.T., Breithardt, G., Ccrutti, S., Cohen, R.J, ond Smgcr, D.H:, 1996. Hcu:t rale variabilitf' st.1ndards oi
mcaoun'mcnt, physiologkal inlcrprelntion and dinkal U5C. T,15k Force oí thc Europcan Society of CardmloID' and lhe North Amcociln
Sodctyof P,mng and Elcclrophysiology. Circu!.1t10n 93(5), pp.IOB·1065. . _ . _
Cochranc, O,J., 200·1. A!tcmating hot and cold watcr immcroion for ilthlclc rccovcry; A rcv1cw, l'hys1ol !hcr,1py m Sport, ~(1), p.p.2&-32.
Cormack, S.J., Newton, R.U. and McGuigan, M.R., 2005. Ncurommcul,1r and cndocr:ne respoll!lC5 of dite playcrs to anAu,trahan rulcs
foolball malch. lntcmalional jouma! of r.porL• phydology and performance, 3(3), p3J9. _ . .
SUMMARY Cormack. S.J., Newton, R.U., McGuigan, M.R. and Doylc, T.L, 2008. Rc!iability oi mcaoun'o obtamcd durmg omf;IC and repcalcd coun-
tcrmovcment jumps. lntcmational )ou mal of Sports Phy~lology and Pcrforman<:e, 3(2), p.131. _ .
Cooti!l, 0.1.., King, O.S., Thomilo, ft_, H,1rgreaves, M., 19S5. Eficclsol redu<:ed lraining on muorular powcrmsw1mmcrn. PhysSportsmcd,
ln elite soccer, off-season and preseason periods are becoming shorter and shor- g;,~f;~,tj~~~d Rcubum, r., 2003, Moniloring çJ1ani;cs in rugby lcilguc playcrs' pcrccivcd strc% and rccovcry during intem;ificd traimng.
ter, and players are increasingly expected to play in more cornpetitive games ~~:'fu\~~~~-~~!, $.~~f~f;t~~~~:~o, F. and Concu, A., 2003. Hcmodynamics during aclive nnd pusr.ive recavei)" from a oinglc bout of
1

throughout the calendar year. Therefore, performance stabilization for the r.upramaximal c~erdsc. Eur. J. Appl. Phyoiol., S9, pp.209-216. . . .. ,·
Dadebo, B., White, J. and George, K.P., 2004. Asurvcy of flc"1bility tr.1iningprolocols and hamotrmgstru1ns m profo;.J,,onal football dubs
modem soccer player is extremely important, and correct fatigue management in Englnnd. Br / Sports Mcd, 33(4), pp.358-39·!
Dawoon, B-, Cow, s., Modra, S., Bishop, o. and Stewart G., 2005. Effcct;; of immcdiatc post·gilm<!' recovcry proccdures on musclc ~orene%.
strategies are becoming paramount in the modem game. Simple, inexpensive powcr and flc,.1bi1ity lc•·c!s o;·cr thc ncxt,lS hourn.) Sei Mcd Sporl, 3(~), pp.21~21.
Dowzcr, C.N. and !l.c11l;~ T., 1993. Dccp-watcr runrnng. Sport Excrc. lnj., 4, pp.~0-61. . . . _ .
wellness questionnaires can be used by coaches to help monitor the fatigue sta- Dupon! G., )'.foalla, W., Guinhouya, C., Ahmaidi, S. and ilcrthoin, s_, 2001. Puso1vc ,·ersur. aclive recovcry duoni; high-mtcnmty mtcrmot-
tus of each player, providing easy-to-understand information in order to adjust tcnt cxcrdscs. Mcd Sd Sport!> ll~crc, 36(2), pp302-8. . .. ·
Dupont, G., Biandei, N. and Berthoin. S., 2003. Pcrforman.:c for short mtcrmlllcnt ruos' actwc rccovcry vs. pa%l\"C recovcl)·· Eur l Appl
the training program accordingly. The implementation of tapering and recovery Phy~iol, 89(6), pp.5-113-S~.
Dupont, G., Moalla, W., Guínhouya, C., Ahmaidi, S, and ilcrthoin, S., 2001. Pa&õl>"c vernu" Aclive Rccovcry durinf; High-lntcru1ty Inter·
strategies throughout a competitive season is critical to stabilize the performance mitlent Excrd<co. Med. Sei. Sports E.xerc., 36(2), pp. 302-303. .
Dupont, G., Ncdclec, M., McCall, A., McCormack, D., llcrlhoin, S. and Wioloff, U., 2010. Effcct of 2 ooc.:ermatch"" ma weck on phyoical
of the players, so that they can perform as close to their peak as possible over performance and injury rale. Am / Sports Mcd, 38, pp.1752 175S
Ferrei, J, and Co!lc, T., 2003. Analpc dcs dificrcn<:e:. de preparation mcdicosporhvc d~ !'Equipe de Fr~ncc ~e football ro.ur k5 mup_:" du
an extended period of time. It is important that the coach pays particular atten- monde 1993et 2002. Lu!tcrconlrc lc dopagccn gcrunl !a n'rupcratíon phy"1quc. Pubhcahoos de l'.urnvcr.11te deSaintEl!cnnc, PP 23-..:-·
Fi!z·C!nrkc, J.!l.., Morton, R.H. and Baniotcr, E.W., 1991. Optimmng i!thklic performance by mflucncc rurv~"l. J Appl l'hy~1ol, 11.
tion to the needs of the individual player, ensuring that each player's training
program is periodized correctly to avoid accumulation of fatigue and staleness. ~r~~;t~~;., J.F., Ade,/. ilndWe~lon,M., 2013. Moniloring hcart riltc variabilily and poychomctric wdlncso dunng pw:;caoon lrairnnz m
elite voulh soc<:er pfoyers. (Unpub!ishcd data).
Periodization is discussed in more detail in the following chapters. FranÇaux, M.A., jacqmin, P.A. and Sturbois, X.G. 1989, S1mplc kinctiç modd for thc &tudy of lilrtatc mctabolic adapli!tiOn to cxcror.o on
oport 8mcn rouhnocvaluillion. Arch lnt Physiol Boochcm, 97, pp.235---215
Fn."<'man, P. and Rces, T., 2003 Thc cflccl!i of pcrccivcd and "'cc1vcd oupporl on objccti,·c performance O<ltcomo. [uropcan Joumol of

2:~~t~~~n~~~~-~·0;~~~t;;! Coo!:, e., 2006. Ellect"·cnec,,s of po:;!-m;itch rcco•·el)" stratcg1cs in rugby playcrs. Br. /, Sporl!i Mcd, ·10.
~~i~~~~;, ).)., Ahmcd, M.W., P,irkor, M.A. and Kadi~h. A. .H., 199·1. D1swci.1lion of hc;irt rate v;iriability lrom por,isymputhotJC tone
Amcncon Joumal o! Ph)'~Hology-Hc.1rt and Cirrnlalory Phyo10IOS)\ 2&6(5), pp,H2152·H2157 .
REFERENCES Gould, o. ,1nd Dicficnbach, K., 2002. Poyd101o;;ical JCsucs 1'n youth oports; Compdoh~·c am·aoty. owrtra1mng, and bumout. ln. R /\úlm.1
and M. Clark, cds. 2002. Youth r.porlo m thc 21st ccntury: Organi•"'d oporw 1n thc 1"·'" of duldren and adolco;e<:nl!i. East l.anomg, M!
AI Haddad, H., Lwrom, P.B., Chollct, D.,Ahmaidi,S. and Buchhcil, M., 2011. Rcliabi!Hy of n'r.tingand pO'Jlcxcrci~c hcart rntc mcasurer.. Excmse Sdcncc Pubh;hcm
Hackncy. AC, 1999. Ncuroendocnno syr.tcm' extro~covcr!ood and rcgcncr.ition. ln: J.M Sldnnckcr. cd. 1999 Q,·crload, fot1guc. perfor·
lnlcmabonal joumal of ~ports medicine, 32(03), pp.595-605.
milnce incompctcncc, and rcgcncratoon 111 opor!. Ncw York l'knum. pp 173-Sõ.
Andcrnson, H .. Karlscn, A., Blomhoff, R., lfa.>:;tad, T. and Kadi, F., 20!0.Actlvc rcrowry tminini; does not afíccl thc-antioxidanl rcsponoe
lo 'occcri;amcs in chtc frmalc playcrn. Brilif,hJoumal of Nutntion, 104, pp-1492-J.199. Haloon, 5, 2003 Nulritwn, ~kep and reCOVCI)"· [ur J Sport Sd, 8(2), pp.1')9-22(>
H,ibon, S.L., 2011. Does the lime frame bc!wccn c~cro,;e influcncc thc cffcctivrnco~ oi hydrotherapy for WCOWI)'? ln!! Sports Pliy'aol
Andcnzon, ti., Raa5tad, T., Niboon, ),, Paulscn, G., Garthc, 1. and Kadi, F., 2003. Neuromur.rular fatigue and rccovcry in clilc fcmale
wro:or: dfocto of aclive rerovcry. Med Sci Sports Excrc, 40(2). pp.372-llll.
Aubcrt A.E. and Ramackcrn, D., 1999, Ncuro,,1rdiology< lhe bencfil!i of irrcf;ufarity' the b,1sic.-; of mcthodology, physloloi;y and current
~~1\~~~;1 ;(~~,P[~.~!\~.~~;~n.Tt.G., Foxcroft, O.R., !nr,cbngwcn,. j.E and !tdhng, G,, 2002. Tc.:nngc akohol ª.nd 1~t0>.tcal1~n
dl'buto tlw
impact oi fomily oociali~ation foctorn, 1ivin3.uca and parbdpa!wn. 1n organiwd oporls. Alcnhol and Al~ohoh;m, 3;11), PP d-SO H.1m1I·
donical applicMion5. ACtil Cmdiologica, S.1(3), pp.107·20.
ton, o, 2009. Explo~ive Pcrformanre in Youlh Socccr l'laycrn Dunng Severa! Game&'" Su=f.omn: A foumament S:cnano Au~!r,il"'n
Baldari, C, Vidcir.i, M., M.1dcira, F., Scrgio, J. and Guidcl!i, L., 2001. L1cliltc remova! during aclive rccovcry rda!cd lo thc individua!
anacrobie and vcnlibtory thN."Jholds in ~occcr pli!yers. EuropcanJoumal of Applicd Phyr.ioloi;y, 93, pp.22·1-230.
B<udicld, S. and McCi!lliotcr, S., 1997. S-Ocfal r.upport in the athletk trnining rnom< athlcks' cxpcctnlionr. of otaff and studcnt athlclic
~~~~io~ ~.~1~,g~~c~c;l~~'~'.t~o;::~ ~~:c~~~nc, PW.. 200·\. Cnn card!OC vogal tone be '"'timalcd lrom llw lO·~cwnd ECG~ lnkm.1hon.11
i~~:~;,~;t~~r~'.ºd~J)L~ ~:~~~py~o;õii"J,h)"siolog1'al nnd Nutnhona! Aopccts of !'o>t-Excrdoc Hcco~cw SJ"'ctfic Hccommcmbtrnm for
5
traincrJ.) Athl Tr.1in, 32(4), pp333-338. Bilni;>bo,J., Graham, T., johanf.cn, L. and Saltin, B., 1994. Muodc !actale metabolrnm in "'cowry
from inleru;e exhaustivc excrcise: Jmpact of !ight cxcrci"1.·.J. App!. Phyoiol., íl, pp.1890-1895.
Bangobo,J., Mohr, M., Poul,,,,n,A., Pcrer.-Gomez,J. and Kruotrup, P., 2006. Trainmg ,1nd ter.tini; thc eliteath!etc.J ExcrcSd Fit, 4, pp.l-J.I. Fcmille Athktc:;. Sports Medicine, .\1(10). pp e&H!S2.
Hciotcrbcrg, M.F, f,1hr.::nkrug, ]., Kru~trup, r., Sto,.,kov. A., K1;,,r, M., ,1nd ,\n.dcf',~n, ).!..'. 2013. Exlcm1H' momtorin3 throui;h mull;pk
Banislcr, E.W., C.utcr, J.B. ,md Zarbdas, P.C, 1999. Training theory and tapcr: validalion in hfothlon athlctcs. Eur J Appl Physiol, 79,
pp.182-91. blood samplcs m profc::o;1onul wcrer playcro. Thc· journal oi 5trcngth & Cond1tmmng lk,carch, 27(5),_ pp.12&0-1271
Hid:,;on, R.C, Kanakrnjr, C. Ouvir., J.R., Moon.•, A.l>I. and Rich, S, 1932. Rcduccd traminr, dumi.on cf!cot~on aciobc powor, cn<lur.1m·<·
Bamcs M.J., Mundcl, T. and Stann,1rd, S.R., 2012. Thc cffoctr. oi arntc akohol consumption on rccovcry from a simu!alcd rugby ma!ch.
Joumal oi Sports Scicnccs, 30(3), pp.295-304. and cardioc giowlh. j App! Phpiol, 53(1), pp.225-9 _ .,.... "
Bamc"J, M.J., Mündcl, T. ilnd Stannard, S.R., 2010. Arutc akohol com;umption aggravak'S thc dcdinc in nmr-de performance following
Hilbcrt,J.E.,Sforzo, G.A.andSweru;cn, r., 2003 Tiiecllccts ofmu55agcon ddaycd onsot mwodc wrcnc:.s Elr l SpmbMcd. _J1(l ), D' 1--"
Hopkit 15, W., Mar;hnll, S., Batlcrham, A. and Harnn, J, 2009. Progre:-O!ve st.1tiot1C'J for olud1cs m ~porto mcd1c1nc i!nd c~i:n:11,c• •,<0cnc"
r>l"'nuouscce<>ntric excn:foc, /oumal ofSdcn<:<> and Medicine inSport, 13, pp.189-193.
Bamclt, A., 2006. Using recavei)' modahtÍC$ bclwcen tr.1ining sc%iono in clitcathlctcs. Doeo it hclp? Sports Medicine, 36, pp.781-796. Medicine+ Scicncc in Sport5+ E~crc1w, ·llO), p.3. , ~
Hopkms, W.G, Hawlcy. ).A. •md Durkc. LM., 1999. Dci 13n .1nd analyMs of rc,c.uch on &por! pcrfmmancc cnhanccmcnt Md ~<1 »porb
Beckers, F, Ramackcro, D. and Auberl, A.E., 1999. ACTS: autom.1ted calculation of tachogr.1m1; and r.yr.togrom,,. Prof; Biomcd Rcs, 4,
pp.160.5.
Blcakley, C, McDonough, S,, Gardner, E., 6.utcr, G.D., Hopkino, J.T. and Davir.on. G.W. Cold·watcr immcrnlon (cryolherapy) for preven·
~:"::, ~l,(;~ri~-~~-~~~ of •,kop: 'Slccp dcbt" •·crsuo biologlCal adapl.1l10n of hum.m okop to w.1km<; n~ed.o Dwlor.;ul P<ydwlo;w,
ling ;md treuting musclc oorenesc. after excrcir.c. Cochranc Dat.1ba"" Syst Rcv; 2012 Fcb l5;2:CDOOS262. doi: I0.1002/J.l651!l5S.CDOOS262.
pub2.
~!~);.,~~;ti.:~. and Johm, R.A., 199·1. Erfocts of ta per on ~wim pcrforman<:<>: pr.Klkal 1mplk3!1011>. Sports M~d. 17(41. fp.'.22,J-32
Houmard, J.A., Costill, O.L, Milchdl, J-B, Park, S.H., HkkMr, !l..C. and Rocmm>Ch. j.N, 19'Kl Rcdueçd tr.11rnng m~mt.1 rn_; r~rl\>rm.m""-'
ilogdanio, G.C., Ncvill, M.E., L!komy, H.K., Graham, CM. and Louio, G., 1996. Elfret,; of aclive n'covcry on powcr output during repL'-
aled maximul oprinl cyding, Eur J Appl Phy$iO! Occup Physiol, 7·1(5), pp.461-9. in diotancc runncr,;. htt J Sporl> Mcd, 11, ppAó-52. . , , ,,,
IspirlidL\ /, Falou roe, L Jamurl<rn, A., Nikolaidio, M., /.\ichailidis, I, Dourou doo, ! , Margorns. K, ~h.lt:wukobo,~. '; '_,hah,tra'.~- "~[,
lloilcau, R.A., Mioncr, ).E., Dyk!itra, G.L and Spitzcr, T.A., 1983. Blood laclic acid remova! during treadmill and bicyclc cxcrcisc at vuri'ous Katraba,;a:;, J., Aloxiou, V. and Taxildarii;, K., 2003. Tim<.~Ç<]UF---" oi changco 111 mflamm.ltOI)' and perlormancç "'-'í""'''
lol101,.n,, a
inlensitics. /oumal of Sporl!i Medicine and Physical Fitnc&s, 2, pp.159-167.
Bompa, T., 1999, Pcriodization; Thcory and mcthodology oi training. London: Blackwcll Sdcnlific. rnc<:<>rg:amc.Clin)SportMcd,lS,pp423-431. . , " ,,,,
Bompa, T.O. and Haff, G.G., 2009, Period1zation: Thcory and Mcthodology of Training-1999 Hcprint. Ch.1mpaign, !L: Human Kinelico,
!mpcl!iz.ccri, F./.1, Rampinini, E., Ca,t,1gna, C, /.farhno, f:·'Fioorn, S. .ind.Wrnlofi, U, z~g 7ri~c~ of p~)~~7i~'loc trnminr,' n "'m1 'cr,u.,
pp.3-30. grur» on muodc sorenc~o and jumplngand "P"''l!ni:; ub1hty m 5oCC<:r pl.l)Cr5, ilr l Sporb 1\kd, l- PP 1- .,,, , d
Jakcman, j.R., flymc, C and falon, R.G., 2010a. Efficacy oi lowcr l1mb comprcc.s•on .1nd combm<.•d lre~:i:i~nt oi mon.u~-~'~"-"'!>'
1 "n
Boncn, A. Campbell, C. Kirby, lt and Bclc,15tro, A., 19i8. Rclationship betwccn r.low twilch musdc fibrcs and IJctic acid remova!. Cana-
lowcr limb compre,,ion on symp!o!lli oi excm~i.'-indun'd mu"de dam~gc m womcn J Strcnglh Cond Rco. _4(11), PP_ "l" 6.
dianJoumal oi Applied Sport Sdcn<:<>s, 3, pp.160· 162.
Jakcman, J.R., By,,;~, C. and faton, R.G., 2010b l.owcr hmb compre:;,wn iprmcnt improW5 r«ovcry from C'<Cr<1'e·mdue<:J mmc 1~
Borg, G., 1970. Pcrcciwd cxcrlion"" an indiç,!orof ~;om~tic st"'t.s. S<:andinavianjoumal of reh.1bilitation medicine, 2(2), pp.92-98.
damagein young. uctivc fomalco. Eur J Appl Phpiol, 109(6), pp.1137-44
FITNESS IN SOCCER Fl'.NESS IN SOCCER 1 zsl
Fatigue management Fatigue management

Jakcman. J.R., Macrac, R. and Es1on, R., 2009. A single 10.min lmut of cold·walcr immcrnion theropy aftcr strenuous plyomctrk cxcrcfac Olscn, o., Sjohaug, M., van Bet:kvcl~ M. and Mork. !'./., 2012. The clfoct of wann•(lp ~nd.cool-down exercite on delared ons.::t musclc
has no bcncJldol cffoct on rcro•·Ny from tl1csymp!oms of e><cocise-indu"'d rnusdc damagc. Ergonomia;, 52(.\), pp.456-460. sorcness in thc quadria::ps musde: a randomized contro!!ed triai. J_oui:nal _of H~man Kmct1cs, 35, pp.59-68. .
Joui;lo, A., Míc:illcf, J.P. and Mottcl, D., 2010. Effoctli of activc vs. pawi•·c rerovcry on "'l"'ªlcd rugby-spcdfic c~cn:h:.e5. Joumal of Sdcn.:e O'Drlcn, K.S., Biacide, J.M. and H(ln\er, J.A., 2005. Hazardous dnnking m elite Ncw Zcaland sportspeoplc, Alcohol and Akohohsm,
and Medicine ln Sport, 13, pp.350-355.
Kcllmarm, M. and Kallus, K.W., 1999. Mood, n.-rovcry·otm<...11 statc, and regencration. ln: J.M. Stcinackcr, cd. 1999. (h:erload, fotigw, ~~i!~~~~i~i Q,•ertraining: balancing practire and performana::. ln: S. Murphr, cd. Thc sport psych handbook. Champaizn, !L:
performance inrompctcnc.>, and 5S rt:l)Cncral1on in sport. Ncw York: Plcnum. pp.101-17.
~~~ª~-~;;~.~~~· ~:~ ;';. for Refilling of Glycogcn Stores in Human Mur.clc Fibrcs Following Excn:isc-lnduced Glrcoi;en DcpMion.
7
prcvcnting undc!p"rfonnan"' in alh!ctcs. dlampaígn, li..: Human Kinctic;. pp.57-77.
Kc!lrnann, M., 2002..1. Enhandng rerovery: Prevcnting undcrpcrformance in athlctcs. Champaign, IL: Human Kinctirn. Ada Phpiologica Scmdinavica, 90(2), pp.297-302. . . . . . ..
Kcllmarm, M., 2002. Undcrrcawcry and ovcrtraining: diffcnmt çoncepts: similar irnpact? ln: M. Kcllmann, cd. 2002. Enhancing recovcry: Plews, D.J., lamscn, P.B., Kilding, A.E. and Buchhcit, M., 2012.Hcart rate variabilily ln elite triathlelc~, is vanation m vanabthty the kcy
prevcnting undcrpcrfonnancc in athlctcs. Charnpaign, IL: Human Kinetio;. pp.3-2·1. to cffcctive training? A case comparison. Europcan joumal of applicd physiolo!Q', 112(1l), p~.3729-37•11. • .. . .
Kenltd, G. and HaliSmén, P., 2002. Undcll'l.'covcry and o.-ertraining: a conceptual modcl. ln: M. Kcllrnann, cd. 2002. Enhandng rero•cry. Plcws, D.J., laurocn, P.H., Stanlq, J., Kilding, A.E. m;d ~uchhcit, M., 20'.3: Trainmg Adapl<lhon and Hcart Rate V,mab1hty m Ehlc End-
King. M. and Duffic!d, R., 2009. Thc clfects of recovcry inter\"Cntions on con~crutivc days of intcrmi!lcnt sprint exerci.e. J Slrenglh Cond mance Ath!ctcs: Opening lhe Door to Effoclivc Momtonng. Sports Mcd1cmc, 43, m-71lt. .
R"5, 26, pp.1795-1802. Poolc, D.C., Musch, T.K. and Kindig, C.A., 1997. !n vivo microvnscular structural and functmnal conscqucnre; of musde !cnglh cl1angcs.
Klnugasa, T. and Kllding, A.E., 2009. A compariwn of posl·match n:covcry stratcgics in youlh soccer pfaycrs. J Stn:ngthCondRcs, 23(5), American )ou mal of Physiologr, 272, pp.2107-2114. . .
pp.1402-1407. Poppendic.:k. w., Faudc, O., Wegmann, M. and Meycr, T., 2013. Coolin,;and l'crlonnanre Rcrovcry ofTrmned Alhlctc:;:AMeta-Analy·
Kivinicmi, A.M., Ha(l!ala, A.J., Klnmmcn, H. and Tulppo, M.P., 2007. Endurance lrilining g(lidcd individ(la!ly by daily hcart rate varia· tica! Rcview Jntcmalional joumal of Sports Phyoio!ogy and Pcrfonnana::, S, pp.227-242. .
bility mcasuremcnts. Europeanjouma! of applied physiology, 101{6), pp.743--751. Postolnche, iT. and Oren, D.A., 2005. Bright light: alcrting, dn:adian phatc shifting and antidep~.sant tn:'1tmcnt. ClmSports Med, 24,
Kivinlcrn~ A.M .. Ha(ltala, A.J., S<!ppãncn, T., M:ikikallio, T.H., Huikuri, H. V. and Tulppo, M.P., 200!. Sat(lration ofhigh·fn:qucncy osciJfo.
~~!~,J!, f.: Howorka, K., Grovcs, D., Chcotcr, M. and N~Jan, )., 2002. Functional ru~essrncnt of heart rale variabilily: phrsiologicnl batlis
1
tions of RR intcrvals in heallhy subjccW anel paticnts alter arulc mrm:ardial infan:tion during ambulatory conditiom. Amerimn Joumal
of Physio!ogy·Heart and Circu!atory Physiology, 287(5), pp.H1921-Hl927. and practical app!icalions. Intcmationa!Jo(lmal ofCard1o!o~r, &4, pp.1-14_. . . . . .
Komi, P.V., 2000. S!n:1<h·shortcninz cydc: a powerfu! modcl to st(ldy normal and fotigi.icd muedc. Joumal of Biome<ltanio;, 33(10), Quinn, A.M. and fal!on, B.J., 1999. The changcs ln psy<hological charactcmltrn and react1ons of elite athlclc:J from miury oruct unhl full
pp.1197-1206. rcro.-cry Joumal of Applicd Sport Psychology, li, pp.210..229.
Kracmer, W.J., Bush, /.A., \Vicl:ham, R.B., Denegar, C.R., Gomez,A.L., Gotshalk. L.A., Ouncan, N.D., Volck,J.S., Putukian, M. and S<!\>as- Recs, T. ~nd Hard}\ L., 2(l(J.l. Matching.wcial support with strcssors: Effccts on factors underlying pcrfonnance in tcnnis. Porchology of
tianc!li, W.J., 2001. lnfl(lcnre of comp=sion thcrnpy on symptoms follmving ooll ti55ue injury from maximal ccrenlrk excró!;e. J Orlhop SportandExercisc,5,pp.319-337. .56 572 R ·11 T dRi b M
Sport Phys, 31(6), pp.282-29{1. Rcilly, T., 2005, An ergonomic modo! of thc socccr training process. Joumal o'.Sports ~cnce, 23(6), PP l· · e~ y, · an S y,' "
Kraemcr, W.J., l'lanagan, S.D., Coln!ltm:k. B.A., l'ragala, M.S., Earp, J.E., Dunn-Lcwis, C., Ho, J-Y, Thomas, G.A., Solomon-Hill, G., Pcn- 2002 Efiect of an aclive warm-<lown followlng competi tive ooccer.ln·. W.Spmks, T. Rci!lr and A. Murphy, cds. Socncc and footba!! !V.
wdl, Z.R., Powell, M.D., Wolf, M.R., Vokk,J.S., O.,ncgar, C.R., and Maresh, C.M., 2010. Elfccts ola wholc body compression garmcnt on London: Routlcdgc. pp.226-229. .
markcrs of n:covcry alter a heavy resistance worko(lt in mcn and worncn. J Strcnglh Cond Rcs, 21(3}, pp.S0.~14. Rcilly, T., 1998. Rcrovcry from stnmuo(ls training and malch"5. Sport Excn:. lni:,·1, pp.156-lSS.
Krustrup, P., Mohr, M., Stecnsbcrg, A., Benckc, /., Kj~er, M. and Bang~bo, J., 2006. Mu"dc and blood me!abolitcs durinz a wccer game: Rcill}", T., Drus~ B. •md Clatkc, N., 20!Jll, Muocle fotigueduring football matffi'_,play. _Sports Mcd, 38, pp.357 367.
implications for sprint pcrformanre. Mcd Sei Spmts Excn:, 38(6), pp.1165-74. Rei!! T and Ekblom B 2005 The us.:: of reco•·cry methods poot•cxcn:iw.J SportsSo, 23, pp.619-27.
Kuipcrs, H. and Kcizcr, H.A., 1988a. Overtlõlining in elite alhletes: revicw and directions for the f(l!(lre.Sports Mcd, 6(2), pp.;9-92. Rer, ~.,i.a60 -·ircfiilll, C~ L:tg~. DJUC!ltCros, J., Casfüs, L. and Dcllal A., 2010. The dfcct of a congestcd fixlure period on lhe activity of di1c
Kui~m, H. and Kcii~r, H.A., 198Sb. Overtraining in elite athlclcs. Sports Medicine, 6(2), pp.79- 92. soro:rplaycrs. Biol Sport, 27, pp.181rl85. . . .
law, R.Y. and Herbert, R.D., 2007. Wann-up re<luces defayed onsct musclc sorencss but cool·down does not: a randomiscd controlkd Rc , E., lago-Pci\as, e., Casáis, L. and lago·llallcstcros, J., 2012. Titcefiect of imrncdia1c posHraining nct1vc and pas~ive rcro•·ery mlcr·
triai. AU5! j Physiothcr., 53(2), pp.91·5. \"C~lions on anacrobic performance and lowcr limb flcxibilily in profosslonal socccr pfaycrs. Jorn:nal of Human Kinctics, 3'., pp.~21-9 ..
Lc Me(lr, Y., Hausswírth C. and Mujika !., 2012. Tapcring for compctition: A r<'vicw.Scicnre &Sports, 27, pp.7"-87. Rc , E., la o-Pcfiw, C., L:tgo-Ballc:;teros, J. and Cas;lis, L., 2012, Thc clfcct of n:covery otra!eg1cs on contrac:i•!e J.'ropert:cs usmg tcn-
!.ccdcr,J., Glssane, C., van Somcr<'n, K., Gn'goon, W. and Howatson, G, 2012 Cold watcr immcrsion and recm·cry fromstrenuous cxer- sio;yogra:hr and pcn:civcd musdc oon:ncso in profcssion.~l wcrer playcro. joumal of Strcnglh and Cond1tiomni; Rcscarch, 26(11),
dse: a rncta-analysis. Br / Sports Mcd, 46(4), pp.233-210.
l>facrM, B.A., Cottcr, J.D. and Laing. R.M., 2011. Compr<""..sion garmenlfi and Cl(Crcísc: gam1cn! consideMtiOM, physiology and perfor- ~p.Jos;- 8(: 2oos Slccp recovcry and performance: The ncw fronticr inhir,h-pcrfonn_ance alhletics: Ncurologk C!inirn, 26, pp.~69-150.
mance (Repor!). Sports Medicine, 41(10), p.815(29). S~~~r~ ;: V~i!ati, Ê., va~crdti, v.:Vailati, F. and la Tom.', A., 2013. Hcart rate vari~bihty n:ílcc15 tra~ning Joad and psychophys1ological
Magalhãc5, J., Rebelo, A., Oliveira, E, Silvn, J. R., Mnrqui>::, F. and Ai;ccruJo, A., 2010. Impact of Loughborough Intcnniltcnt Shutt!c R-.,;t status in ·oung clilc gymnasts. Joumnl ofStn:ngth & Condilioning Rescan:h, P(lbhshcd ahcad of pnnt. ,
•·ers(lo wccer match on phyuiolor,ical, bim:hcrniml and ncuromuorular pammctcrs. European joumal of applicd physiology, 108(1), Sc:hwanc:J.A.,Johnson, S.R., Vandcnal:k~r, C.ll,, 1933. Dclarcd onsct mur.de sorene5s and plasma crcatmc kin•tc phospho!e nnd LDH
pp.39-4S. activltics aflcrdownhill running. Mcd Sei Sports Excn:, 15, pp.51·56.
Mah, C.D., Mah, K.E, Kczirain, E.J. and Dcmcnt, W.C., 2011. Thc cficcts of sle<:p exlcnsion on thc athlclic pcrfonnance of collcgiate Shirn:ffo, S.M. and Sawka, M.N., 2011. Flui d and clcctrolylc nccds for trJining, compclition, and rcrovcry. Joumal oi Sports Sçicn'1l5,

~~~;~:ii·.,PJ~~:i~·~~. Mlnctt, G. M., Snapc, A., and l\forph)l A., 2013. Thc Elicct of Ovcmight Sk~p Deprivation Following Compctítivc
baskclbnll playcrs. Slccp, 34, pp.943-950.
Marror.i, S.M., Staiano, W. and Manning, V., 2009. Mental fotig(le imp;lirs phr"kal performance in humano. )ou mal of Applicd Physio·
Jogy, 106(3), pp.!l.57·SM. Rugby Lenguc Match"" on Post·Match Physio!ogiml and Pcrccptua\ Rccovcry. lnt. J. ~P:"rts Phys1ol_. Pctfonn., [Epub ahcad oi pnnt]
Maughnn, R.J., Jnd Shírrefo, S.M., 1993. Dohydr.1lion, rchydration and exercite in the hcal: Conduding n:marks. Jnt. J. sports. Mcd., 19, Siff, M.C. and Wrkho~han.oky, Y.V., 1999. Supcrtmining. 4th cd. Denvcr, CO. Suf"rtramrng lntemabonal. • . , .
pp.S167-Sl6S. Signorlle, J.F., [nga!IB, e. and Trcmb]3y, L.M., 1993. Thc diccts of activc and p=ive recovC<)' on shorHcrm, h1zh mlons1ty powcr output.
Maughan, R.J., 2006. Alrohol and football. J, Sports Sd., 2•l, pp.741-74$. CanJApp!Physiol,18(1),pp.31-12. . · d l · ts ct,
McConnell, G.K., Co.<;til!, D.!.., Widrick,J.J., Hickc); M.S., Tanaka,H. and Gastin, P.l.l., 1993. Rcduccd tminingvolurncand intcnsity main- Spcn(;)r, M., Bishop, o., Dawnon, JJ., Goodman, C. and Dufficld, R., 2006. Mctabolwm and performance m ropcatc cyc e 5pnn º'a l\C
tain acrobiccapndly but not performance in di5!ance runncrJ. !ntJ Sporlfi !o.kd, l•I, pp.33-7. vcrous pa 85ivc recoVCl)'· Mcd Sci Sportu Exen:, 38(8), pp.1492-'.1. d n h
McLcan, D.D., Coutts, i\.J., Kell;: V., McGuigan, M.R. and Connack, S./., 2010. Neurom(lsru!ar, endncrinc, and pcn:cptunl fotiguc n.>::pon· Stdnackcr, / .M. and Lchmann, M., 2002. Clinícal findings and mcchani:;ms of sl"-"" a_nd rcCOVC<)' ln athlctcs. ln: Kollmann, M., e , '" an·
sco during diffcr<'nt knglh bctwccn·match mkrocyd"" in profcsoional rugby !cague playcrs. lntcmational joumal of sports physio!ogy cin recov~ry· prevcnting underpcrformancc in athlctcs. Champaign, '"' Human Kmchc;. pp.103-lll.
and pNfom1ancc, 5(3), p.367. su:uki, M., U;.,cda, T., Nakaji, s., Shimoyama, T., Mashiko, T. andSugrn·ara, K, 200,1. Eficctofincorporatioglmv intcnoít}" cxcrd~e into
Mclcllan, C.P., Lowll, D.T. and G.ws, G.C., 2011. Markcrs of postmatch foliguc in profcssional rugby lcaguc plarcro. The Joumal of lhe r<'covery pcriod aftcr a rngby mal eh. JJr. J. Sports Mcd., 3S, pp.436-4.\0.
S~nglh &: Conditioning Rcscarch. 25(4). pp.103()..1039. Tar!or, K., Hopkin.o, w., Chapman, Q.W., Cronin, J.U., Nc~v,ton, .M.J., Connock, S. nnd Gill, N., 2012 Moni!oring ncuromuocu 1ar 1Migue
Mcemcn, R., Duelos, M., Glec~on, M,, Rictjms, G., Slcinackcr,J. and Urhauscn, A., 2006. Pn:vcntion, di;gnoois and treatmcnt af lhe o~cr­ w:ing vertical jump5 lntcmahooal joumal of Sports Mcd1cme (m rev1cw). ll
traimng syndromc; ECSS pooitlon ttMcmcnt 'lask for«''. EuropcanJoumal ofSport Sdenre, 6(01), pp.1·14. Tc~sitore, A." Mecu&~n, R., Cortis, e. and C.1pranica, L., 2007. Efkcts of dilfcr•nt rcco•·cry intcr\·cntions on anacrobic fCr/onnance,; 1" o·
Mcrdc~, !'., Mcnzic;, C., 1-lclntyrc, L., !'Mcl'§on P., Wilson, J. and Kcmi O.J., 2010. Hlood lacta te dcarnnceduring adivo n:covery aftor an wíng prcscasonsocC1lr training. J. Strength Cond. Rcs., 21(3), pp.745-750. , h , ,
inlmsc running bout dcpcnd!i on thc inlcnsity oi thcacth·c rerovcry.JoumJI ofSportsSdcno::;, 28(9), pp.975-932. Twist. e, Waldron, M., Highton, J., Hurt, D. and Danic\5, M., 2012. Ncuromu"cular, b1ochcmical and pcm::ptual poot-moto 1atoguc m
Moncdcro, J. and Donnc, Il,, 2000. Effcct of recovcry inlcrvcntions on lactatc remova! and s(lb;;cqucnt pcrfonnoncc. Jnt. J. Sports Mcd., profc"-Sional rugbr !cague forwardo and bacb. jouma! ofsports socnces, 3G(•I), pp.359-367.
21, pp.593-597. Twist: and fu;lon, R.G, 2009. The cffoct oi cxcrcisc-indu'<.-d mu~dc damagc on pcn:civcd cxertion and cyd1ng cnd(lran«' IX''1ormancc
e.
Mika, A., Miko, !':, Fcrnl1all, 1.1. nnd Unnilhan, V.B., 2007. Comparioon of n.>rovery str.1tcgics on muodc performance afler foliguing cxcr- Europcnnjouma! of Applícd Phrsiolog;: 105, pp.~59-567. . . .
cisc. Amcrican Joumol of Phpical Medicine and Rchabilil<ltion, 86, pp.474-181. Urhamsen, A. and Kindermann, W., 2002. Diagnosw oi overlrammg. Sports medicine'. 32(2), pp.95-102. , ,J·S
Mohr, M., !.fojtka, !., SJntbtcban, J., Randcro, M.D., [};schoff, R., Solano, R., Hcwítt, A., Zubillago, A., Pcltola, E and Krustrup, P., 2010. Vcntcr, R.E., 2012. Pcrceptioru oí tcam alhlNcs on thc importance of n:covcry modah!lcs. E(lropcan Joumnl of Sport Sc1cn'1l,f PP
Exami11o1tion of faliguc dcvclopmcnt in cli!c socçcr in a hot environmcnt: a multi-experimental approJ<h. Scand J Med Sei Sports, 20(3), W<.•gmann, M., Faudc, o,, Poppcndic.:k, W., r~c:_klilcdcn, A., Frohlich, M. and Mcyer, T, 2012. Pre-cooling and spotts per ormnnre· "
pp.125-132 mcta·nna!ytical revicw. Sporls Med., 42(7), pp.~b- SM.
Moir, G., ShJElri, P. and Connaboy, C., 2003. lnlcr<..csoion rcliability oi vertical jump hcíght in womcn and mcn. Tiw Joumal ofStr<'nglh Wciss S K 2006 HcltcrSlcep for)'o(lr Dabr &Cl1ild. Toronto; Robert Rose lnc. M <l
& Conditioning Rcscan:h, 22(6), pp.1779-17&4. WC>Js~I, j, ;nd \\~m, A. 1994. Effcci 0 1 otn:lching on thc in!cn~ity of dclaycd·onsct mundc son:ner.,:;. Clinicai Joum~I oi Sprt ' e icmc,
Montgomery, P., Pync, D, Hopkins, W., Donnan, J., Cook, K. ''"d Minahan, C., 2003. Thc cfied of n:covery strak>gics on physical perfor-
mance and rumulatlvc fotiguc in compclitivc baokclbatl. J Sports Sd, 26, pp.1135-JJ.\5. {\fif~~~-~l., Cronin, /,ll. mtd Hing.. A.H., 2006. Phy~lo!ogknl =·ponsc to watcr immersion.Jouma! ofSporW M~idn~, 3b(~), P~7~;:
Moratka, A., 2007. TI1cmpi>! cduotion impactn thc m=ge cffcct on postrace musde rccovcry. Mcd Sci Sports Excn:, 39(1), pp.:H-7. 765. Young. w., Hawkcn, M. nnd McDona!d, L., 19%. Rclationsh'1pbdwccnSpccd anel Ag1l1ty andStn:ni;lhQu~htEco m,\(l•tra rnn u º'
Morgan, W.P., Brown, D.R., RJr,lin,J.S., O'Connor, P.J. nnd Ellkbon, K.A., 1937. Psychological monitoringof o•·crtmining and stalcne55. football. Stn:ngth & Condltioning Conch, 4(·1), pp.3-6. . . . ..
Br JSports Mcd, 21(3), pp.107-1.\. Zat~iornl:r, V.M., 1995. Sdcnce and practlce oi strcngth lr~mmg. Champa1;;n, ll: H(lman Kmchc:;.
Mourot, L., Houhaddi, M., Tordi, N., Rouillon, J.O. and Rcgnard, J., 2004. Short- and long·lcrm dfcds of a sing!c bout of excrcise on
hcart rnte variabilitr: compari5on bctwccn con.otant and inlcrval training cxcrciB"5. European joumal oi applied physiolog}; 92(4·5),
pp.503·517.
Mujika, 1. and Padilla, S., 2003. Scicntific baS<.>s for pn:rompctition tapering stralcgics. Mcd Sei Sports E><crc, 35(7), pp.1182-7.
Mujika, 1., 2011. Tapering for trialhlon cornpclition. ). H(lm. Sport Exer<', 6(2), pp. 264-270.
Mujika, !., Goya, A., Padilla, S., Grijalba, A., Gorosli.1ga,E. and lbanci,J.,2000.Physlological n.-.:.Ponscntoa l).d !apcrin middloxlislance
runncrs: influcnce of training lnlcnsity nnd volume. Mcd Sei Sports Exerc, 32(2), pp.511-7.
NédClcc, M., McCaU, A., Carling, C., Lega li, F., Bcrthoín. S. and Dupont, G., 2012. Rcrovcry in w.;cer: par! J • poot-match fotig(lc and time
coumc of recovcry.Sports Med, 42(12), pp.997-1015.
Oda, S., Ma~umo!o, T., Nakagawa, K. and Moriya, K., 1999. Rdaxalion clfcds in humans of underwatcr cxercitcof modcratc in1~nsitr.
Eur. ). Appl. Physiol. Ocrup. Phy~io, 80, pp.253-259.
Odctoyinbo, K., Wooste~ B. and Lanc, A., 2009. The elfcct of a sucç~'SSion oi matd1cs on thc activity profik>:< of professíoMl so=r p!ayers.
ln: T. Rcilly and !'. Korku~u1~ eds. Sdcnce and Football VI. London: Routled,;c.
FACULDADE' OE DESPORTO
DA UNIVERSIDADE DO PORTO
FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER 253
252 Periodization in soccer
Fatigue management

1
PERIODIZATION IN SOCCER
Jan Van Winckel, Kenny McMillan, Cario Buzzichelli, David Tenney, Paul Brad/ey

Periodization is a planned/programmed distribution or variation in training


methods and means on a cyclic or periodic basis. As highlighted in the previous
chapter, an important aim of periodization in elite soccer is fatigue management.
Periodization for soccer entails organizing the season in a structured manner to
ensure the level of performance is kept as consistently high as possible (perfor-
mance stabilization) throughout the season. To achieve this, periods of loading,
unloading (recovery), and tapering (for the most irnportant competition(s) of the
year) have to be sensibly arranged. Periodization refers to the planned alternation
of loading and unloading (fatigue management), the structured sequence of which
physical ability (i.e., strength, speed, endurance) to develop, and the division of the
annual plan into distinct periods.

14.1 HISTORY OF PERIODIZATION


The Ancient Greeks used very elementary plans to prepare for the Olympic Games.
The legendary Milo of Croton (6th Century BC), winner of six Olympic Games, was
one of the first to use a primitive form of periodization by varying his training load
during his training program. Milo began his training most days by lifting a calf,
and as the animal grew bigger, the lifting load increased, consequently improving
his performance. At the end of his training process, he was able to carry the animal
around the Olympic stadium. Galen (129-200 AD) was a Roman physician, surgeon
and philosopher (Nutton, 1973). At the age of 28, he returned to Pergamon in Italy
as a physician to the gladiators and became one of the first to write about periodi-
zation. He believed that various types of exercise needed to be blended in arder to
improve performance. He divided exercises into three categories: without "hostile"
movement, such as weightlifting; quick exercises, such as ball games; and exercises
with a "hostile" nature, which we now refer to as plyometric exercises. It was not
until the iun-up to the Olympic Games in Helsinki (1952) that the experience of the
Russian coaches became the impetus for the methodological principies of training
systems. Researchers emphasized that the competition schedule had to be integra-
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
25 4 1 Periodization in soccer Periodizaffon in soccer l55

ted into the overall system and that "active rest" was very important. The former ments (hvo ~ub-systems of 11 elements) moving within a defined area (the pitch)
Eastern Bloc, especially the Soviet Union, believed in a multi-year development and depend1ng on a series of restrictions (the Jaws of the game). They had the play-
preparation period, and the coaches there delayed the special~zation phase of t~e ers perform tests and then analyzed the results via a computer. Lobanovskyi even
sport for longer. This was in contrast to Western coach~s who 1mplemented spec1- \Vent so far as to let Zelentsov and his computer system make the selection for the
alization much earlier and without any thorough multilateral development. ln the European Championships in 1988. The coach, who died in 2002, surprised friend
Soviet Union, as well as in other Eastern Bloc countries, a clear sports program exi- and foe alike by playing scientific "total football" with Dynamo Kyiv (1984-1990)
sted to train children from elementary school level up to the elite level. ln this way, long before Rinus Michels embodied "total" football in the Netherlands. He created
they monitored and controlled all the factors. Dr. Verkhoshansky hims~lf went so a system that evaluated every action in a match. A group of scientists noted each
far as to say that periodization was based on the principles of commun1sm. ln the successful and unsuccessful action relating to passes, tackles, shots and dribbles.
West, it was impossible to adopt the sarne training approach, because th~ culture These data were then analyzed by a computer, enabling each player to be evaluated
did not permit such a thing. East Germany could obviously not b~ left b~h1n~, a~d for "intensity, activity, error rate and effectiveness."
in 1956, the German High School for Physical Culture was estabhshed in Le1pz1g.
With the Cold War as the catalyst, sport became the flagship of various countries.
State support was more the iule than the exception. However, the medal also had 14.2 TYPES OF PERIODIZATION
a darker side. "Sport for all" was an empty concept, because East Germany .se~ec­ Periodization improves performance through various mechanisms:
ted children at a young age and only invested in the very strongest. Two d1stinct 1. A planned, progressive overload favoring positive morpho-functional adaptati-
trends then emerged from 1970 onwards: The West invested time_ ~nd_energy i~ t~e ons through planned alternation of loading and unloading
different areas of sport-such as school sports, health and rehab1htahon-while 1n 2. Avoiding reaching criticai leveis of fatigue and overtraining (Morton, 1997)
the East, the emphasis continued to be focused on the elite. It was in this race. for 3. Tapering at the right moment to reach peak condition
better performances that periodization models surfaced. ln th~ 1970s, many sc1en-
tists, mainly Bastem European, published a large number of im~o:tant works. on
periodization and the training process, such as Arosiev and Kahrun (1971), D1at- 14.3 SEASON PLANNING
schkov (1974), Zatsiorsky (1972), Matvejev (1974, 1981), Kusnezov (1972), Harre There are different ways of preparing players for a game or season. There is the "ad
(1974), Vorobiev (1974) and Tschiene (1977). Matvejev, the father of periodization hoc" approach (deciding from day to day), the intuitive approach (based on the
(1964), has not always received the recognition he deserves. V1ce-Pres1dent of Sport '.'best practice" of the coach), and structured periodization. There are definite gaps
Kolessov stated in 1991 (Sovietsky sport, 1991) that the "outdated" system of Pro- 1n the_current knowledge because periodization theory is based largely on empiri-
fessor Matvejev should not be pursued anymore. ca! ev1den~e, relate<l research (e.g., overtraining), anda few mesocycle-length vari-
The origins of soccer science lie in atlon stud1es. Most of these involved experimental periods no longer than two to
the former Soviet Union. The Rus- three months and/or subjects with limited training experience, whereas no actual
sians were the first to practice soc- multiple mesocycle or integrated shtdies (e.g., combined strength/power and
cer science in a structured •vay, sp~ed/endurance training) on advanced athletes have been published in English
with Valeriy Lobanovskyi playing {Phsk and Stone, 2003). Moreover, most of the scientific research published is in
an important role in developing the domain of. strength training, and it is not easy to translate these findings to
the kno\vledge and know-ho•v and ~eam sport sett~n?-s. For example, training parameters such as volume and intensity
intertwining soccer and sport sci- in strength tra1n1ng are completely different compared to training parameters in
ence. Lobanovskyi used statistics soccer. We have compiled a classification system belO\V that should enable soccer
and data as a means of gaining com- coaches to better understand the mechanisn1s of periodization. This format, which
petitive advantage in sport more has not been used anywhere else, attempts to a reach a consensus with regard to
than two decades before the foun- the terms used in the research literature. We have deliberately used ali the terms
dation of specialized companies used in publications in order to make it easier to find more information via search
such as TopSportsLab0 , Amisco, and engines and/ or publications.
ProZone. Lobanovskyi started as
the coach of Dneproprtovsk (1969-
1973), recruiting Anatoly Zelent-
sov, a statistician who was at the
time the Dean of the Dneproprtovsk
lnstitute of Physical Science. Soccer
became for them a system of 22 ele-
FITNESS IN SOCCER
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER
256 Periodization in soccer 1257
Periodization in soccer

14.4 TYPES OF PERIODIZATION


14.3.1 Season-planning components
Periodization can be considered a process of structuring training into phases to ln this section, we will see how different periodization models can be distinguis-
maximize athletes' chances of achieving peak performance and therefore their hed. We do this on the basis of four types of classifications:
competitive goals (Bompa, 1999). Accordingly, periodized training programs are
typically structured into macrocycles, mesocycles, and microcycles that progress 1. Volume and lntensity
from extensive to intensive workloads, as well as from general to special tasks Periodization models that vary intensity and volume.
(Plisk and Stone, 2003). Before discussing the types of periodization, we first give 2. Physical abilities
an overview of the yearly planning components below. There is a chance you will Models that vary the basic characteristics (physical abilities) of the sport being
find other definitions in the literature, but those used here are the most widely sup- h·ained (e.g., aerobic fitness, speed, etc.).
3. Workload
ported and accepted.
Models that vary in workload.
1. Multi-year plan or megacycle. For athletes, this is often a four-year (or Olym- 4. Integrated
pic) cycle. ln soccer, this cycle is used for younger players in academies, where Multidisciplinary models.
long-term objectives can be set using models such as the Long-Term Athlete
Development (LTAD) model designed by Dr. Balyi (Ford et ai., 2011).
2. Annual plan (Bompa)/Annual Macrocycle (Soviets). According to most
models, the annual plan comprises three macrocycles: the preparation phase,
the competition phase, and the transition phase. The preparation phase is nor-
mally divided up again into general and specific preparation, and the competi-
tion phase is split into a pre-phase anda competition phase.
3. Phase (Bompa)/Macrocycle (Soviets). The term "macro" comes from the Greek
word "makros," meaning "big." The term "cycle" refers to something that is
constantly repeated. It defines the general direction of the training process in a
certain period (general or specific preparatory, pre-competitive or competitive,
transitory).
4. Macrocycle (Bompa)/Mesocycle (Soviets). A macrocycle (Bompa) or mesocy-
cle (soviets) is a period of 2-5 weeks that specifies the direction of the training
process for each of its components (i.e., physical strength, speed, endurance,
and technical/tactical). ln this timeframe, one to three loading microcycles are
followed by one or two unloading microcycles (thus reducing intensity and/or
volume, but usually just volume). lt is particularly during these periods of redu-
ced load that progress can fully manifest itself.
5. Microcycle (from match to match or week to week). The term "micro" comes
from the Greek word "mikros," meaning small. This microcycle rons from
match to match in most cases, although it can be longer in the preparation phase
and shorter in the competition period.
6. Daily planning:
• Warm up
o Central section
• Rehabilitation and progression training
• Cooling down

ln this book, we use the terms macrocycle (for preseason, in-season, off-season,
etc.), mesocycle (2-5 weeks in length) and microcycle (from match to match). Fig. 14. 1: OveNiew of the different phases of a periodization model.
zss I FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
1259
Periodization in soccer Periodization in soccer

14.5 PERIODIZATION MODELS: INTENSITY ANO VOLUME This brings us to the final problem: The model implies that peaking will occur at
The basic concept of a trade-off between intensity and volume seems pretty ele- the end of the season. Team sports like soccer do not require a peak in performance.
mentary, but it has important ramifications because the interaction of these varia- This could possibly be handled by using a multi-peak approach (Bompa, 1984;
bles drives many of the decisions made when designing training programs (Plisk Wilks, 1995; Fleck and Kraemer, 1997). For example, an athlete can peak in the 60m
and Stone, 2003). Most scientific research only distinguishes between the variation indoor event in the winter and in the lOOm sprint in the summer season. Research
in volume and intensity. Volume can be defined as the total duration of the training, has shown that bi- and tri-cycle models have a greater impact than a model with
as well as the number of sets and repetitions in strength training or the number of a single peak. From this, Poliquin (1997) concluded that it was the variation of
kilometers in a cycling race. Correspondingly, the intensity could be the running the multi-peak models that was responsible for the greater progress. Bompa (1983)
or cyding speed, for example, or the one-repetition maximum (lRM) percentage in and Tschiene (1977) recommended periodization of this kind mainly for sportsmen
strength training. tvho have two or more periods of competition per year, followed by so-called tran-
sitory phases (Bompa) or prophylactic intervals (Tschiene). These are short periods
14.5.1 Linear models of relative rest, during which the body can recover well, injuries can heal, and moti-
vation can also be regained.
14.5.1.1 Linear periodization and single, double and tripie models
Leonid Metveyev, a Russian sports scientist, presented a model in which the annual 14.5.1.2 Reverse linear
macrocycle begins with a high volume of low-intensity training. The Metveyev Reverse linear periodization follows the modification in intensity and volume but
model and the Western spin-offs have the characteristic of intensity and volume in a reverse order to linear periodization models, increasing volume and redu-
working in inverse proportion. cing intensity (Rhea et ai., 2003). Reverse linear periodization methods are some-
times used in sports where aerobic endurance is important (e.g., cycle racing and
triathlons).

High

,. --- ....... . 14.5.2 Non~linear, undulating and daily undulating models


In a non-linear periodization training model, intensity and volume are changed
./..-:?'··············· . . . .. much more frequently compared to linear models (Kraemer and Fleck, 2007; Fleck,
. ( 2011).
Volume
lntensity
.•.•....··············:·:·:, 14.5.2.1 Undulating
... ............... Performance The undulating method makes use of alternating phases of intensity and volume
low within the microcycle, mesocycle or macrocycle. At the microcycle level, this can
be achieved by alternating intensities (and energy systems) day by day (e.g., light-
Time heavy-light-medium or heavy-medium-light). At the mesocycle level, it can be
achieved by either alternatíng the average load of each microcycle (e.g., heavy-
Fig. 14.2: Example of linear periodization in which the volume decreases and the intensity increases light-medium-light) or by including an unloading microcycle at the end of the
mesocycle. At the macrocycle leve}, it can be achieved by alternating different qua-
This model is particularly suitable for novice athletes. The body easily absorbs the lities of the sarne physical ability (e.g., strength-power-strength-power).
load because of the high volume and low intensity in the initial phase. Several studies have concluded that these undulating periodization models pro-
The main criticisms of this model are: duce significantly better results than non-periodized or strictly linear models (Fry
et al., 1992; Stone et al., 1999; Zatsiorsky, 1995).
• General preparation is too voluminous and general, thus making the athlete
detrain his specific physical abilities. 14.5.2.2 Dai/y undulating model (DUP)
• Preparation phase is too long for today's professional team sports, which have The daily undulating periodization (DUP) consists of increasing and decreasing
short preparation phases and long competitive phases. .. intensity and volume on a daily basis, and it is often planned according to the ath-
• Progression is too linear. This, in fact, is not a substantiated criticism because lete's feedback. The variation of training components is more frequent and lasts for
from the chart, it is impossible to depictwhat happens at the level of the micro- shorter periods (Fleck, 1999).
cycles and mesocycles, which can, and should, have alternations of loads.
• Unlike individual Olympic sports, team sports usually do not require an ulti-
mate peak at the end of the season.
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
260 261
Periodization in soccer PeriodizaHon in soccer

14.6 PERIODIZATION MODELS: PHYSICALABILITIES The sequential development of a physical ability can be integrated with the sequen-
The following models differ from each other in the way in which different physi- tial developments of other abilities. For example, all of the abilities labelled "a"
cal abilities (e.g., aerobic, endurance, speed) are trained. ln general, three different above could be trained simultaneously (Bompa, 1983) in a "complex" or "concur-
methods can be distinguished: rent" plan, or they could be separated into "blocks." A concentrated block usually
1. Unidirectional ar sequential method. separates strength development from speed or endurance. Concentrated block trai-
2. Parallel, concurrent or intermediary method. ning results in a long-term delayed training effect (LDTE) of 4-12 weeks, usually
3. Combined model. peaking after a duration equal to the block's duration. The advantage of this system
is that no other aspects are trained, thus avoiding additional strain on the body and
14.6.1 Unidirectional, block or sequential method making it easier to train one particular component in overload. This is often found
The sequential method is characterized by a phased unidirectional approach for among advanced athletes because of a great <leal of the training load being applied
each physical component. This method is especially applied to the mesocycle, with to one single aspect. The model proceeds from the principie that residual training
each physical ability, such as speed, being trained separately within a certain period. effects remain, and these can be built on in the next mesocycle. ln this way, more
stable progress can be made with long-term effects. Since block training is often
associated with injuries resulting from sudden transitions between two phases, less
Endufáílce sharply delineated periodizations are often recommended.

14.6.2 Parallel, concurrent or intermediary method


The concurrent model is used to train different physical abilities (e.g., endurance,
strength and speed) during the sarne phase in order to promote multilateral deve-
lopment. This fits into the macrocycle, the mesocycle or even the microcycle. The
concurrent model makes it possible to place emphasis on a particular factor, such as
by increasing the load for a particular component. This type of periodization may
Fig. 14.3: Exampfe of create a synergistic effect, allo\ving one skill to strengthen another during buildup.
sequential periodization

Examples of the sequential method for the various physical abilities:


Strength,
1. Preparation: Eridur:ance
a. Anatomical Adaptation
b. Hypertrophy
c. Maximum strength Strength
d. Specific Strength
2. Season: Retaining and maintenance of load Power
Fig. 14.4: Example of
Endurance: Pre;rnrntiort
concurrent periodization ln
a preparation phase. Eac/J
1. Preparation General Prcp~rJtion Spedfíc Preparntion
physical ability is trained
a. Aerobic endurance f!.11bu1!óirtg ol phy~lta! ilbilitku together.
b. Mix of aerobic and specific endurance
c. Specific endurance When using this model, it is important to assess the interaction of the different
2. Season: Specific endurance abilities. The interaction between different physical abilities is referred to as the
"interference phenomenon" (Docherty and Sporer, 2000). This phenomenon occurs
Speed' \Vhen adjustments resulting from training compete with other specific adaptati-
1. Preparation ons. Strength training, for example, has a profound negative influence on muscle
a. Aerobic endurance mitochondria, which are essential for endurance (MacDougall et al., 1979). Ho-ive-
b. Anaerobic endurance ver, if the interference phenomenon is accounted foi~ these physical abilities can be
c. Alactic speed (without accumulation of lactate) trained perfectly well in the sarne cycle, especially since soccer players normally
d. Specific speed don't need to fully maximize a single aspect. A soccer player must therefore try to
2. Season: Specific speed
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
262 263
Periodizatíon in soccer Periodization in soccer

maintain a certain levei in all physical abilities and improve on the specific require- lities are maintaine<l. The player will then make progress on one aspect, with the
ments of their positions (e.g., acceleration for a winger). others remaining at the sarne levei. This training model therefore not only combi-
A great <leal of research has been conducted over the last decades into the influence nes all the physical abilities within a particular stage; it also ensures progress in a
of strength training on aerobic training and vice versa. It is obvious that the hvo particular quality at the sarne time.
types of training will interfere with each other because of the body wanting to
constantly adapt to the load (Dudley an<l Djamil, 1985; Chromiac and Mulvaney,
1990). Several studies have shown that concurrent training can induce subopti- 14.7 WORKLOAD
mal strength and/or endurance adaptations (Gergley, 2009; Glowacki et al., 2004). A third classification of periodization is made based on the distribution of workload.
If both types of load are being trained, the body's adaptive capability is <lisrup-
ted. The challenge in practice is to integrate strength an<l en<lurance training so 14.7.1 Stepwise loading
they both enhance, rather than interfere with, each another. There is little infor- This type of periodization increases the training load in each microcycle and <lecre-
mation regar<ling soccer-specific concurrent training an<l the effects of training ases the load in the final microcycle. In this final phase, the body converts the work-
or<ler. Recent research in soccer (McGawley an<l An<lersson, 2013) foun<l a positive loa<l into progression (supercompensation).
effect of the concurrent training approach on key measures of soccer performance,
but the or<ler of completing high-intensity, run-base<l training an<l strength- and Stepwise model
power-base<l training appears inconsequential to performance a<laptations.

14.6.3 Periodization models: Combined model


The aim of the combined model is to combine the benefits of the two previous models,
namely the unidirectional approach of the sequential method and the advantages of
block training. This system trains the <lifferent physical abilities in the mesocycle and
a primary or secondary objective in the microcycle. The player thus adapts physio-
logically (functional over-reaching) to a specific ability, while the other parameters
will be maintained (retaining loa<l). This can prevent stagnation, over-training and
fatigue. Week 1 Week2 week3 Week4 WeekS Week6

Zatsiorsky emphasizes that this model has the advantages of the cumulative results
of training while accentuating the specific training effects of the "loading" of a spe- Fig. 14.6: Example of a stepwise modal

cific quality. This ensures greater improvement in performance. The positive accu-
mulation of these training effects results in a more uni<lirectional increase in work 14.7.2 Reverse step loading
capacity. ln this method, the training load is re<luced in each microcycle.

14.7.3 Fia! step loading


ln this model, a high training load is set for all aspects during a specific period. The

D D D training loa<l is then reduce<l to allow supercompensation to take effect. The flat
step loading model should not be used for mesocycles longer than three weeks (i.e.,
two loading microcycles and one unloa<ling microcycle, or 2+ 1 or 2:1).

D BD D Flat step loading

Rebuilding of physical abilities Maintenance

Fig. 14.5: ln this model, a specitic ability is trained each week, while lhe other systems are maintained.

Week 1 Week2 Week3 Week4


In simple terms, the combined model is a model in which one specific quality (e.g.,
spee<l, en<lurance, etc.) is traine<l as the primary objective, while all the other qua- Fig. 14.7: Example offlat step loading
FITNESS IN SOCCER
264
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER
Periodization in soccer
Periodization in soccer 1265

14.9 TYPES OF MICROCYCLES


14.7.4 Pyramid loading
In the literature, many terms are used to label the different microcycles. Below we
The training load is increased to a maximum and subsequently reduced again.
set out the terms used in the literature and the way they are distinguished.

Pyramid loading
Terms used in literature Load leveis

Low to medium load, gradual increase in work!oad and


Adjustment, rebuilding, initializing
intensity

Low load (low intensity, duration, frequency); physical and


Restoration, regeneration
mental recovery

Loading, building, devetopmental Progressively higher volume and/or intensity

Extreme workloads {S!eamaker, 1989). These


microcycles could cause many injuries because of an
Weekl Week2 Week3 Week4 WeekS lmpact, shock unaccustomed levei of intensity and/or volume. Scholastic
heritage of the Eastern Europe training theory with little
Fig. 14.8: Example of pyramid /oading. practical application.
Tapering, pre-competitive, tuning,
Low toad, high intensity
peaking, unloading
14.8 INTEGRATED
Medium load with emphasis on event-specific
There are also periodization models that pay attention to all the components of Maintenance, competitive
performances
sport training símultaneously.

14.8.1 Technical
14.11 PERIODIZATION IN SOCCER
Matvejev was the first scientist to incorporate the technical component into the
Applying periodized planning to team sports poses unique challenges due to the
periodization model. The skill-strength periodization model (SSP) was rnainly
variety of training goals, volume of concurrent training and practices, and extended
used in the Soviet Union. The model proceeds from the principie that the technical
competition season (Gamble, 2006). Planning must attempt to prepare players to
component has to be trained first and followed by the strength component.
peak for a match every week for the entire season. In elite soccer, peaking for every
match is not possible. Matvejev wrote back in 1977 that periodization is not justa
14.8.2 Psychological
simple plan but rather a set of la\vs or basic principies that accompany the training
Balague (2000) is one of the fe•v scientists to devote attention to the integration of
process. Bompa (1983) stated that periodization is the process of dividing the sea-
the psychological/mental aspect. She developed a model in which psychological
son into smaller parts, \vith the objective of achieving the best performances during
preparation goes hand in hand with physical development during different trai-
the most important phases of the season. According to Plisk (2004), periodization
ning cycles.
is a programmed variation of training content and training methods on a cyclical
basis. Kraemer (2004) added that, in addition to variation, periodization must also
14.8.3 Tactical periodization
consist of programmed recovery periods to boost recovery and bring the athlete
One of the best examples of synchronization between tactical and physical perio-
(player) back to his present potential. Periodization is a term that is often used
dization is the \VOrk of José Mourinho. He coordinates the two disciplines during
indiscriminately. It is difficult, if not impossible, to examine periodization models
the year and programs his exercises in such a way that the players train the tactical
in high-level soccer and map out their effects. The model described below is the-
principles while also pursuing physical periodization at the sarne time. We \Vill
refore based on scientific research and brings together different aspects that can
elaborate further on this in Chapter 15.
be found in the scientific literature. This is clone on the basis of several strategies.
When we use the term "periodization" in this book, we refer to the different fati-
gue-management strategies that can be applied when planning the season. Periodi-
zation in soccer is therefore the strategic planning of fatigue management.
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
266 Periodization in soccer Periodization in soccer 1267

14.11.1 lntegrated periodization ../ Formulate objectives and ambitions


Physical periodization must be synchronized with all the other aspects of soccer. Objectives and ambitions are set before preparation begins. These goals are agreed
We refer to this as an integrated approach. upon by everyone in the club (i.e., players, staff and management). There is a diffe-
Good planning takes account of the following periodization components: rence between an objective and an ambition. An objective could be, for example, to
• Technical periodization secure fourth place, qualify for the Europa League, or promote two youngsters into
• Tactical periodization the first team, An ambition could then be, for example, to play attractive soccer or
• Physical periodization compete for the title. It is important for objectives and ambitions to be shared by
• Psychological periodization everyone and recorded in a document that is communicated externally. This ensu-
o Communication and team building res that no false expectations are created.

The main focus of training will be different in any sport. ln soccer, however, one
component cannot be separated from another. Periodization can therefore best be
defined as a logical, phased method of organizing training variables for the pur- Season 2014~2015 Objective Mothod
pose of raising the technical, tactical, physiological and psychological potential of a
Reaching the final stage of the Tapering before champions league
player in arder to reach specific objectives. European League games
Ranking Performance stabilization and dai!y
14.11.2 Different phases of drawing upa season plan Fourth place in the domestic
work on physica!, tactical, mental
Before we start with discussing periodization strategies specific to soccer, let us first league
and technical periodization
give an outline of the method that will be applied:
Repetition of offensive tactics,
1. Formulate objectives and ambitions. Attack
Average of tvvo geais per
maximizing number of p!ayers in •
2. Divide the season into manageable phases. match
the box
o Setting up the first draft of the season plan
Daily work on defensive tactica!
o Assessing the current situation Defense Less than one goal per match
rules
• Adjust goals and ambitions. Respect for game philosophy,
3. Conduct a strength-weakness analysis of the group and the individual. Home results More than 15 wins at home
knowledge of team tactics
4. Adjust the training objectives in the mesocycle for the group and the individual. Away results More than 8 wins Know!edge of the opponent
5. Differentiate and individualize periodization.
Rebuilding of filness in preseason
1 st half of the season 40 points and respecting tactical periodization
during in-season
Training camp during the mid·
2nd half of the season Performance stabi!ization
season break
Off-season
Tabfe 14.1: Coffective obfectfves

DifferentiMion
and e::::::>,
individualisatlon
•lu" f•h
v~ a .. on o , e
actual situatlon
Before the start of each
mesocyde

Adjust tralning Adjust objectivcs


objcctives ond and ambitions
thc mesoçycte

Strength·
weakMss
asscssment
t? Fig. 14.9: Layout of a periodization p/an during t/1e seasOll
ZGS 1 FITN ESS 1N SOCCER
Periodization in soccer FITNESS IN SOCCER [ zsg
Periodization in soccer

./ Divide the season into manageable phases.


When dividing up the season, account has to be taken of:

° Co1npetition schedule. It goes without saying that the competition schedule


determines the periodization structure. There are, in general, five or six peri-
ods (macrocycles) in a soccer season:
- Preseason
- First half of the in-season
- Mid-season
- Second half of the in-season
- Play-offs
- Off-season
° Competih'on fonnula. A competition formula determines the amount of interest
that can be devoted to particular mesocycles. For exarnple, a play-off formula
or group phase in a cup or European competition will influence the way the
season is planned.
0
Availability of training facilitíes. The availability of practice pitches or fitness
rooms is important when planning and preparing for periodization, especially
for youth teams.
0
Availabílity of players. Factors such as school, work, and playing with the nati-
onal team also need to be taken into consideration.
o Training camps. Planning a training camp is an important decision. The sudden
increase in load can cause overload injuries. The ideal time to plan a training
camp is in the third week of preseason and during the mid-season break.
"'o m o Climate. Weather conditions like cold, heat and humidity can influence the
~
o
""'
o training plan.
N
E
0
Opponents. During in-season, the microcycles are planned according to the
e ro
o matches. The strength of an opponent can influence the structure of the
m
o !!!
• microcycle.
"'
The season is subsequently organized into macrocycles, mesocycles and microcycles.

Y Setting up the first draft of the season plan


After structuring the season into manageable periods, the content of the various
cycles is determined based on the expected status (i.e., physical, tactical, technical
and mental) of the players.

Y Assessing the current situation


This step is repeated before the start of each mesocycle. Time should be spent eva-
luating the previous mesocycle and planning the next one. This is done based on
m the following analysis:
N

o Schedule: What games are to be played? How many days are there between
matches?
0
Tests and questionnaires: Tests can be included during the season (e.g., HR test,
4' test, submaximal Yo-Yo test) to monitor how the players' fitness levels are
developing (actual value).
0
Opponents: Who are the opponents in the coming weeks?
o Injuries and availability of players: Injuries can affect the planning of a mesocycle.
FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
FITNESS IN SOCCER 271
2701 Periodization in soccer Periodization ín soccer

./ Adjusting objectives and ambitions


REFERENCES
Based on the preceding analysis, the objectives and ambitions are adjusted for both 1\nganrd, P. and Andcn;cn,J.L., 2010. Effocts of st..,ngth training on cndurancc capncily in lop·lcwl cndurance a~llcl"1i. Scand j Mcd S ·
Sports, 20(SuppL 2), pp.39.-47. ' ci
individuals and the group. A~tiaincn,J.P., Hui mi, J.l.; Kraemc:, W.J,, Lc_hti, M., Pabrincn, A., Mero, A.A., Karnvlrla, L, Sillan- paa, E,, Sclannc, H.,Alcn, M., Komu-
y.,
l«1~c"':' J., Kovanc_n, Nyman, K. ~nd Hiikkinen, K., 2009. St..,ngth. cndurnnce or combincd tr,lining clidt divcn;c okclclal muscle
m;oo1~ hcavy cham 1sol~rm pn:_por!Jon but unultc"'d androgcn "'""Plorconccn\rnt1"on 1"n mcn. lnt J Sporlo Mcd, JO(J2), pp.Bi9-837.
./ Conducting a strength-1-veakness analysis of the group and individuais r.uch ao Aros1ev and Kalmm (191 l ),
Astrand, P.O. nnd Rod~hl,,K, 1970. Tc~lbook. of work php;,ology, Ncw York: McGraw-Hill.
Strength-weakness assessments, which must be performed as part of any strate- llakcr, D., 1993. Pcriodisatmn ofSt..,nglh Tram.ing for Sports: A rcview, Strcngth and Conditioning Coa eh /oumal 1(3) pp 15-~1
Baker, D., 1995. Appl;:m~ th~ in.;-.cason pcrio~tznti~n oi "'."'.nglh and powcr lraining to lootbalL NSCAjoumal, 2Ó(2), Pp.ia-27..
gic planning process, are made for the team and each player. Based on this analy- 1l.1l,1guc, G., 2000. Pcriodtsal!on of psychologicol '.'k1lh trammg. jouma! oi Scicnce and Medicine in Spo<l, 3(3), pp.230-237.
íl~mpa, T.0,and Cm"ril.. M.C.. 2003, Pcakconditionmg/arvollqball. ln: /.C. Rccser;md R. llahr,cd~. Handbookof sporto mcdkinennd
sis, a personal development plan is drawn up for each player and adapted where ~cicncc: vollcyball. London: Blackwdl Sdcncc.
Bompo, T., l'>S.J. Thcory and mcthodology of trai1üng. The key to alhlctic pcrlormancc. lloc.1 Ralon, fL, Kcndall/Hunl.
necessary. llompa, T.0, 1983. Theory ~nd Mcthodology ofTraining. Dubuquc, Iowa: Kcndall Hunl Publishinr; Co.
llondarchuk, AP., 1986- Tr.1mmg of trocLmd Hddathk'!es. Kk''' Hc.11th Publi.shcr{Zdorovic).
llondarchul'~ A.P., 19S3- Conslructing ª. trnimns ~y~lcm. Trnck Tcdmiquc, 102, pp.325-1-3269 .
./ Adjusting the training objectives and methods in the mesocycle for the group llondarchuk, A.P., 2007. Transfor ~fTraming in Spo<l>. Michigan; Ulhmalc 1\thlctc ConU'p!o.
Bradley-Popovich, G., 2001. Nonhnc.1r ve~u.•, lincar pcnod1:wtio~ modcb. Strength Cond j, 23(1), pp.42-13
Training objectives and methods are adapted based on the current situation. ~urd, N.A., Tung. J.E., Moore, D.R. nnd Ph1lhps, S.).f., 2009. fac moe training and prolcm mctaboli,;m: Jnflu,cnccs of contrnclion, protdn
mtakc, and w~-bi!,;cd d1fforencec..] Appl Physiol, J().(i(5), pp.1692-lml,
Butov~~y«A., 1906. Prob!.ems of .rhy,;1cal Trni.ning nnd Sporl!i at lhe ln\cmationJl Congres,; in Bm'-"dS in Summer 1905, SI. Pctcr.. burg .
Chago:eL, N.R., 1957. füochem1cal changeo m ".'u,;dcs m "'sl1tution Mtcr phy~ical work. Ukr Diochcm j, 29, pp .JS0-157
./ Differentiation and individual periodization Chromiuc, ).A. and Mulvoncy, D.R., 1990. A rev1cw: thc dfrct,; oi combincd st..,ngth ;md cnduroncc trilining on olrength devclopmcnt
J i\ppl Sport Sei Rc,;, •l, pp.55·60. ·
The new mesocycle is adapted to individuals. The training plan is planned in Coundlmon,j., 1%3, Thc.>dcnce of swimming. Eni;:dwood Cliff, NJ• Prcntice-Hall.
advance, but individual periodization strategies are adjusted as necessary based on Daussin, F.N., .zoll, )., Dufour, S.P;, Poruot. E., Lonsdorfcr-Wolf, E., Doutrekau, S., Mcltuucr, R, l'iquord, F., Gcny, B. and Ridlard, R.,
~DOS. Elfoct of 1~tcrval versus co~trnuous training on cardiorcspiNlory and milochondriul functiotlll: rclíltiom.hip to «Crobic pcrformuncc
evaluations by the staff, as well as performance feedback from the athletes regar- •n:provcments in fü.'dcntury sub1ccts. Am J Physiol Rcg. 295(1), pp.RlM-272.
Dptschkm·, W.M., 197·1. D1cStcucrung und Optimicrung de,; Trainingoprozcs:;cr.. Bcrlin: Bartds & Wcr- mtz.
ding perceived fatigue. Docherty, D: ª.nd Sp-0rcr, B., 2000. A Propoo,cd Modcl for Exumining thc !nlcrforcnce Phcnomenon bctwccn Concurrcnt Acrobic nnd
St..,nr;th Trummg. Sporl!i Medicine, 30(6), pp.3S5--39.\.
~;.~~J'b.~.A. and Djamil, R., 1985. lncompotibility of cndurance- and strcngth-trnining modcs of e~cm,;c. J Appl Physiol, 59(5),

Fkck, S.J. and Kmcmcr, W., 1937, Designing "'sistance Training programr.. 2nd cd. Champaign, \L: Humnn Kinctics.
Flcck. S.J-. ~999, \edod.izcd stn:!~gt~ tr.:ining: A criticai revicw Joumal ofStn:!ng~' and Condilioning Rcse<tr<:h, 13, pp.82-89.
Fle~k. S.J.,-011. No.n-Lmcar Period1zation for Gcncríll fltnL'SC. & Athlelcs. J Hum Kinct, 29A, pp.>11-15
For , P., De~lcC'?ix, M:, L1oyd, R., Mcycn;, R., Moo~ª"" M., Oh•·cr,)., TI!l, K. and Willimns, C., 2011. ri1c long-termathlelcdcvclopmcnt
SUMMARY modcl: phyMological evtdcnce and applkation. Joumnl oi oport> scicncc~, 29(.l), pp.359-JO.
Fry, R.W., Morton, A._R. ~nd _Kcust. º-: 1.992. Pcrlodisation of traimng~•trl..'SO: A revicw. Can. ). SporlflSci., 17, pp.234-240.
G~~lblc, P., 2006. Pcriodizati.on oi trn1mng for lcam •portsathktcs. Slrenglh and conditioning joumol, 25(5), pp5f>.66.
Periodization is a planned variation in training methods on a cyclic or periodic Gc gley, ~·<;., 2009. Compari~on of \wo lowc«lmdy modcs of mdurancc trnining on lower·body ~t..,ngth dcvdopmcnt whilc conrur-
"'nl!y tru.mmg. J, Strcngth Cond. R"1i., 23(3), pp.979-937
basis. The soccer season should be periodized in such a way that allows fati- Gl~w.<tcki, S.P:,_ ~fartm, S.E., Maurcr, i\., Back, W., G=n, H.J., and Crouoc, S.F., 200·1. Effccts of rcoiot,1ncc, cndurilncc, and conrurrcnt
cxcrme on lrn1mng outcomcs in mcn. Mcd.Sd. Sport Excrc., 36(12), pp.2119-2127.
gue leveis to be attenuated appropriately and ensures that team performance is Grndiam, J., 2002. PcriodizallOn rer,çnrch nnd cxamplc applic.1tion. St..,nglh Cond j, 24(6), pp.62-70.
stabilized across the competitive season at as high a levei as possible. In order H'""'"' D., 1974. Training~lchrc. Bcrlin: Sportvcrlag.
Hawlcy, J.A., 2009. Molecular rcsponscs to strcngth and cnduranU' training: tire thcy incompatibld ApplPh)'"iol Nutr Mct b 34(3)
pp.355-361. ·' " , •
to achieve these aims, periods of Ioading,. recovery, and tapering have to be sen- Hoff, J. and Hdgcrud. )., 200·1. Endurnnce and St..,ngth Trnining for Soccer Playeru. Physiological Considcrations Sports M ·d 3·1(3)
sibly arranged. Due to the congested fixture list in elite soccer, there is very lit- pp.165-J8{). L C ' •
ja\.:ovlcl', N.N., 1977. Sportbiochemic. Leipzig: Bnrth Vcrlag.
tle time for soccer players to train between games, as many training sessions Kar~virt_n, L., Hákkincn, K., Kuuhitncn, ?·' Arija·lllnzquet, A., Sillanpoa, E., Rinkinen, N. and Hiikkincn, A., 2011. Individuol n.-;ponllcs
l?contbrncd cndurnnccand st..,ngth trmning lnoldcr adulls. Mcd Sei Sports Excrc, 43(3), pp.48-l-\!}(l.
are aimed at either recovering from match play or tapering in preparation for Kotov, 1917. OlympicSp-0rl.
Kracmcr, W.J,, 200.J. Roundlablc Disrus:;ion: Pcriodization ofTrajning Part 1. Nationnl Slrcngth and Conditioning A••odntin )• m•I
the next match. Therefore, it is time efficient if players train tactical principies 26, pp.50.69. "" vll vU " '

while maintaining/improving their physical condition or even during recovery K'.ª"".'cr, W.J: "":d Flcck, S.]., 2007. Oplimizing Stn:mgth Training D.,,;igning Nonlincar Pcriodiz.to!ion Workouls. Champalgn, JL: Humun
Kmctics Pubhshmg.
and tapering sessions. This concept of tactical periodization is discussed in more ::,,~:;:~'. C., Abrahams, H.M., Bactzncr, W., 1930. Athlctik: Ein Handbuch der lcbt.>nswichti. gcn Lcibcsübungcn, München: LF.

detail in the next chapter. Kusnezow, W.W., 1972. Kraft"orbc"'ilung. Bcrlin: Sp-0rl"crlag.
Lctunov, 1950. Rcflcctions on lhe Syotematic Fomlulalion ofTraining. Sovietskii Sport, 125.
1'fac0ougall, l:D., Salc, D.G.: Moroz, l-~·: Eldcr, G,C., Sutton, J.R. and Howald, H., 19i9. Milochondrial volume dcnsity ln humun okclclnl
mundc lollowing hcal'y rcomtancc trammg. Mcd Sd Sporls, 11(2), pp.IM-6.
Mnlvejcv, L.P., 1974. Pcriodisicrung dcsspo<llichcn Training•. Bcrlin: Barlcls & Wcmitz,
Mulvc1ev, L.P., 1977. Fundamentahofsp<.>rts lraining (Russiant Moscow; Rzkulturn i Spor~
Matvc1cv, LP., 1981. Fundamcntalsof sports lraining jEnr;li~h lranslolion of thc reviscd Ru%ian cdition]. Mo~cow: Progrcss Publishcru.
M<:Gawlcj; K. and Andcl'&.wn, P.l., 2013. TI1c Ordcr of Concurrent Traininr; Does not Affoct SocCl)r-Rcl,1tcd Pcrformnncc AdaptalioM.
!ntj Sporl.<; Mcd, 34(11), pp.983-90.
Morton, R.H-, 1997. Modclling lrnining and ovcrtraining. / Sporls Sei, 15, pp.335-40.
N~tton, V., 1973. Thc Chrono!ogy ofGalcn's fa>rly Cnrccr. Classical Qunrlcrly, 23(1), pp.153-171.
Pl~sk, S.S. and Stone, M.H.'. 20?3. l'c_rio~izat~on _Str~tcgies. N~ti~nnl Strcngth & Conditionlng Joumal, 25, pp.19-37.
~~~·~iÍ.2004. Roundtabk D1sru%ton. Permd1zotion of Traimng l'art L National St..,ngth and Conditioning As.,0ci,1tion Joumal, 26,

l'n.'S~C§,j., De Lima, C., Frollini, A.íl., Donatto, F.F. and Conte, M., 2009. Compariwn oflincar and rc\'C!"'oC linear periodiz.ltion effccts on
mo~m."lslnmglh,1nd body composition. J St..,ngth Cond Res. 23{11 pp.266-27.J.
Po.hquin, C., 1997. Thc p<.>liquin prindplcr.: Succe,;.'\ful methods for strcngth and mass dc•·clopmcnt. Nopa Ci\: Daylon Writcr'~Group
!'riCI), M. and Moss, P., 2007. The cffccls of work: Rest durndon on physiologirn! and pcrccplual =ro~ during intcrmittcnÍ excn:i~~
and pcr/annance. J Sp-0rls Sd, 25(H), pp.1613-1621.
Rhca, M.R., 2()0.l. Dctermining thc magnitude of trcatmcnl cffccts in otrcngth \rainlng rcscarch through lhe use of thc clfc<:t r.izc. J
St..,ngth Cond Rcs, 18(·1), pp.918-920.
Rhco. "''.·R., Phlllips, W.T., Burkelt, LN., Stonc, W.J., Boll, S.ll., Alvar, B.A. nnd Thomas, A.B., 2003. A comparison oi ]lncar and daily
undulatmg periodizcd progrnmo withcquatcd \'O lume and intcruHy for locitl muscular endurance, / Strcngth Cund RCi>, 17, pp.32·87.
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER J zn
212 j Periodization in soccer The Tactical Periodization Model

Schncider, V., Arnold, B., 11-farlin, K., Bcll, D. and Crockcr, P.. 1998. Detrnjning dfoct in collcgc foolbal! players during thc comp.;:titiw
wason. Strength Cond J, 12{1), ppA2-15.
Siff, M.C., 200J. Supcrtralnlng 6th Ed. Dcnvcr: Supcrtraining ln"titutc.

15
S!camakcr, R. 198?. Scrious trainins for,;eriour. alhlcl...,,. Champaign, IL' Ldourc Presr..
Starischk.l, S., 1983. Triliningsplanung. Schomdorf: Hofmann.
Stolen, T., Chamari, K., Ca5tni;nn, C. nnd Wisloff, U., 2005. Phyoiology of socrer: An updntc. Sporu Mcd, 35(6), pp.501-536.
Stonc, M.H.,O'Bryant, H.S., Sdiilling. B.K.,Johrumn, ltL., Picrcc, K.C., Hafí, G.G., Koch, A.J. and Stone, M.E., 1999, Pcriodization. PMt2:
Effrcts of m1mipulating volume and intcnsity. Strcngth Cond. j., 21{3), ppSl-60.
T.mg. ].E., Perco, J,G., Moon>, D.R., Wilkinson, S.D. and Phillips, S.M .. 2008. Rcoi>tance trnining nllcrs thc n--spo!'l~C oi fod r.lolc mixcd
musde protcin oynth"5i5 in young mcn.Am J Phyoiol Rcgul !nt•·gr Comp Phyoiol, 29.J(l), pp.R172-R178.
Tschicnc, !':, J9n. Einigc ncuc Aopcktc zur Pcriodberung dcs Hochlcir.tungstrainings. Lci"tuni;sport, 7, pp.379-382.
Tschicnc, P., 1995. A ncccs.o.1ry dircction in training: 111c intcgrnlion oi biological adaptiltion in thc training program. Coaching and Sport
Scicncc Joumal 1(3), pp.2-14.
Urhnuocn, A. and Kindcmtann, W., 2002. Diagnosis of ovcrtraining: what too!o do wc havc? Sports Mcd, 32(2), pp.95-102.
Vorolncv, A., 1974. Halterofilia: Ensayossobre fisiologfa y cntrenamicnto dcportivo. Mcxloo: Ed. Libros de México
Wdr, J.P., 2005. Quantifying test-rdcst reliabi!ity uoing thc intrada,;.s oorrelíltion cocfficicnt and thc SEM. J Strcngth Cond Rcs, 19(1),
pp.231-2-10.
\Vilks, R., 1995. Trainini; thcory and strcngth training. Strength nnd Conditioning ooach, 3, pp.10-15.
Wfüon, J.1'.L Marin, P.J., RhN, M.R., WiJ:;on, S.M.C., Locnnckc, J.P. and Andcrson, J.C., 2012. Concurnmt tmining: A mcta-ana!ysio cxa-
mining intcrfcrencc of acrobk nnd resistam:<' cxcrdsc. J Strcngth Cond Rco, 26(8), pp.2293·2307.
Ziwiornky, V.M., 19n. Die kfüperlichcn Eigenschnftcn dcsSport!crs. Dcrlin: Bartcl5 & Wcmitz.
THE TACTICAL PERIODIZATION MODEL
<UNDERSTANDING THE GAME'S DEMANDS
Zil5iornky, V.M., 1995. Scien<:<' and prnctic<' of "trength training. Champign, JL: Human Kinctic;.
TD ENHANCE SOCCER PERFORMANCE)
Juan Luis Delgado-Bordonau~ Alberto Mendez-Villanueva

15.1 INTRODUCTION

We accept that tlle football training niethodologies have been evolving and i111proving
greatly over ti1ne, but their origin renzains the sanze: nzethodologies which approac11
different aspects of the ga111e in analytical and decontextualized fonns (Ta111arit, 2007).

ln an attempt to simplify the complexity inherent in any human activity, sport-trai-


ning methodologies, like most other sciences, have used the "Cartesian" way of
thinking. Consequently, they suffered from a fragmentation of its various dimen-
sions (e.g., physical, technical, tactical and psychological). From this perspective,
these factors are first trained separately and combined later on when applied in
competition. Training methods have also been characterized by the division of the
season into severa} periods, and the periodization of these methods was structu-
red so "peak performance" would be reached at major competitions. To do this,
these training methods gave priority to the "physical" factors, because the con-
cept of "performance" appeared to be closely related to a set of adaptive biological
changes (functional and morphological) that occurs in the body. Training methods
were based upon the isolation of performance factors, and training was organized
through analytical approaches where decision-making processes played a secon-
dary role.
ln contrast to these analytical training approaches, the so-called integrated training
method has gained momentum in team SJ?orts. This is where physical, technical
and tactical aspects are developed in combination. ln short, integrated training pro-
metes a resemblance between competition demands and training activities, but it
does not address the contextual and specific features of all the game elements. Its
levei of specificity therefore only relates to the sport itself and not to a certain way
of play (game model).
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
274 275
The Tactical Periodization Model The Tactical Periodization Model

In this regard, Mourinho (quoted by Amieiro et al., 2006) said, "For me, things are
very clear. There is a traditional analytical-training approach; there is the integra-
ted training system that is clone with ball, but where fundamental concerns are not
very different from traditional practice; and there is my way of training (called 'tac-
tical periodization') that has nothing to do with the other two. The only difference
between traditional training and integrated training is that in the latter, players are
mentally deceived by giving them a ball. But training consequences are exactly the
sarne as the traditional training."
As highlighted by Guilherme Oliveira (2004), integrated training does not regard
the tactical dimension to be the driver of the entire training process, so the game
model is not used as a reference. Thus, the "integrated" approach becomes less spe-
cific than tactical periodization, because the decisions taken by the players at diffe-
rent times are not regulated and coordinated by a common language (i.e., the game
model). It does not allow the players to think in harmony and have the optimal
collective behavior the coach wants to see displayed at every moment of the game.
ln a similar vein, Carvalhal (cited in Amieiro et al., 2006) states, "There are two
types of work >vith the ball: integrated (i.e., integrated training) and systemic (i.e.,
tactical periodization). In the first, the ball is present, but it is not subordinate to the
game model. We advocate another kind of training in which the ball is present from
the first day in arder to create a model that is the way we want to play (collectively Fig. 15. 1: Moments of the soccer game.
and individually). Thus, the team is being organized to play from the first day, and
at the sarne time, performance is being modeled at all leveis: physical, technical According to Tactical Periodization, the tactical dimension is not reduced to a sys-
and psychological. We pay attention to all dimensions, but which coordinates all of tem of play or team shape (spatial organization). As stated by Mourinho (2002),
them (physical, technical and psychological) is the tactical work." "Tactics is understood as a well-defined set of principles of play, both for attack and
defense (and their transitions) in accordance with the way of play desired by the
coach. The ultimate goal is to 'organize' the 'chaos."'
15.2 TACTICAL PERIODIZATION: A NEW SOCCER TRAINING APPROACH This periodization is called "tactical" because, according to Frade (2003), "The
game's expression is tactical: the way we want to play." Tactical Periodization aims
"We ca11 differentiate a1nong traditional-analytical training tvhere the different factors are to make an operational game model. Every training exercise is contextualized with
trained in isolation. There is the so-called 'integrated training,' which uses the ball, but the reference to a global framework: the game model. Thus, the game model and its
f11nda1nental concerns are not very different fi·o1n tlze traditional one, and there is my ivay principies guide the training process from the very beginning. Tactical Periodiza-
of training, which is called Tactical Periodization. It lms nothing to do ivith the previous tion understands that training has to "model" the game through specific exercises
two, even though 1nany people 1night think so." (Mourinho,/. in Gaiteiro, 2006) that include ali the game principies relevant for each coach. As Gomes (2006) points
out, the specificity of an exercise not only covers its structural and temporal featu-
ln recentyears, along with the ever-changing soccer demands, we have seen a trend res-the coach should also direct players' attention to behaviors he or she wants to
toward a change in training concepts and methodologies, representing a break with develop. Thus, Tactical Periodization considers that specificity needs to be direc-
the past. Perhaps the biggest rupture from traditional soccer-training methods has ted not only to the design of the exercise itself but also to the coach's intervention
taken place in Portugal and Spain. One of the most contemporary training approa- (e.g., feedback). Consequently, training will guide the players into a pattern of play,
ches in soccer is the so-called Tactical Periodization method. The Tactical Periodi- aiming to develop a collective and individual identity. Frade (2004) stated, "The
zation method was developed by Vitór Frade, a lecturer at the University of Porto game is an ongoing phenomenon; its construction is created by the habits we want
(Portugal) who is responsible for Porto FC's coaching methodology. Several top-le- to see happening in the field, which are acquired throughout the action (training)."
vei coaches, such as Jose Mourinho, are also applying this method. Explained in Every game action, regardless of which of the four moments of the game it might
a simplistic manner, the main methodological and pedagogical principie behind happen at, involves a decision (tactical dimension) and an action ar motor skill
Tactical Periodization is that the soccer game has to be "trained/learned" with res- (technical dimension) that requires a particular movement (physiological dimen-
pect to its logical structure. For Tactical Periodization, the "logical structure" of the sion), and it is directed by volitional and emotional states (psychological dimen-
game revolves around the four moments of the game (see Figure 15.1). Accordingly, sion) (Oliveira, 2004). A good perfonner (i.e., a good soccer player) is, first and
at least one of these four moments of the game has to be accommodated in every foremost, an individual able to select the most appropriate response to different
single training exercise, following the principie of specificity. game scenarios, and these actions are always determined by a tactical context
FITNESS IN SOCCER
FITNESS IN SOCCER
The Tactical Periodization Model
l zn
276 The Tactica/ Periodization Model
1

A key aspect in building a game model relates to the style of play the coach wants
(Garganta and Pinto, 1998). Accordingly, the tactical dimension should be the to see represented in each of the different moments of the game and the interre-
dominant training component The tactical dimension leads the orders to achieve lationships between them. It is imperative for players to know exactly what they
the targeted goals. For example, the concept of "speed" would change to "relative have to do at every moment of the game. There are certain tactical behaviors and
speed," because a player sometimes needs to be second to be tactically "effective" patterns the coach wants to be revealed during the game, such as collective (i.e., the
in a given soccer situation. whole team), inter-sectorial (e.g., defenders and midfielders), sectorial (e.g., defen-
However, the tactical dimension does not exist by itself-it only makes sense when ders), and individual actions (Figure 15.3). Thus, the model consists of principies,
it occurs through the interaction of the other dimensions (Oliveira, 2004). This sub-principles, and sub-sub-principies of play, all of which are articulated with
implies that the tactical, technical, physiological and psychological elements are each other, representing the different moments of the game (Oliveira, 2003). The
never trained independently. Everything is included, with the main concern being compatibility of the different principies and moments of the game is particularly
that every exercise is organized around at least one of the four moments of the important, because behaviors can sometimes be incompatible. These behaviors and
game and the tactical principles of play. patterns, when articulated, expressa collective dynamic behavior and reveal a cer-
tain playing identity, which could be called a functional organization. The struc-
tural organization is ho\V the team is placed on the field-it is usually called the
15.3 GAME MODEL system of play (e.g., 1-5-3-2 or 1-4-3-3). Although the structure only represents a
fixed spatial shape, it can have an important role in promoting or constraining desi-
"To 1ne, the most únportant aspect in my tea1ns ís to have a defined ga111e 1nodel, a set of red ·behavior. For instance, to have good leveis of bali possession and circulation, it
principies tlmt provides orga11izatio11. Therefore, since the first day, our attention is direc- seems important for players to constantly create diagonals and "diamonds" among
ted to adlieve that." (Mourinho,]., in Gaiteiro, 2006) themselves. As such, some structural organizations can enhance these behaviors
more than others (e.g., structures with a high number of lines, both transversal and
Models are creations that are based on interpretations of reality (Le Moigne, 1990). longitudinal).
Modeling results from the need to understand the complex interactions between
the different elements of a system. ln the game of socce1~ there are specific features, Individual Levei Sectorial Levei
such as players' decision making. Those decisions cannot be coincidental, so they
have to be based on certain principles, making the team's actions follow an internal
logic. While constructing the game model for the team, coaches should consider
several factors that operate within a given specific context, with each factor being
equally important (Figure 15.2).

Jntersectorial Levei Collective Levei

Fig. 15.2: Factors that influence designing and building upa game mode/. Fig. 15.3: Tactical relationship leveis.
(Adapted from Oliveira, G. 2007)
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
278 279
The Tactica/ Periodization ModeJ The Tactical PeriodizaHon Model

Regarding the players, the game model should highlight and enhance their best The specific principies of the
features and capabilities. It is essential for the coach to acquire, as soon as possible, game model refer to a set of
a deep knowledge of the players, especially their levei of game understanding, match-play patterns the coach
because he or she will interpret the behaviors that lead to the team playing in a cer- wants the team to adopt at any of
tain way. ln this regard, Frade (2003) points out that the game "has to be bom first the four moments of the game. In
in the players' minds." Therefore, it is crucial for the coach to use strategies that let simple terms, it's how the coach
the players recognize the importance of certain behaviors, because their convicti- wants the team to play, accor-
ons are also vital in developing the game model. Consequently, the construction of ding to his or her conception of
the game model arises through a process that operates between the coach, players the game. Given the high unpre-
and the team itself. The coach's constant awareness about what he or she wants to dictability that exists during a
happen, both in collective and individual terms, and what is actually happening in soccer match, the coach has to try
the game should be the driver of the training process. However, it is important to to create predictability through a
understand that the definition and creation of a clear game model should not be process of preparation, planning
perceived as something that will require players to act as robots always following a and training. Accordingly, every
predefined plan. On the contrary, the main purpose of having a clear game model training session is designed to
is to reduce players' uncertainty, and this should give players more time to express be as significant as possible to
their creativity. the coach' s game model. The
The structure and expectations of the club or federation are also important aspects systematic repetition (i.e., trai-
in creating a game model. Coaching a team that can only train two or three times ning) of the tactical principles
a •veek and coaching ateam that can train five times are obviously different tasks. of play should allow the players
The scope for improvement, both collectively and individually, is also different. to transform the coach' s desired
The culture of the countries and clubs has also to be taken into account when cre- match-play pattems into habits,
ating a game model. which could be defined in lay
terms as "shortcuts created by
the brain" (McCrone, 2002). The
15.4 PRINCIPLES OF PLAY AND GAME MODEL creation of these habits, the main objective of which is to "save time," is only pos-
sible when the brain has already experienced the sarne or similar situations and
"We exercise our ga1ne 1110del; we exercise our principies and sub-principies oj play. The "recorded" them. The work of Haggard and Libet (2001) showed that the brain
players have to adapt their ídeas through a co1111non goal in arder to establish the sa111e prepares movement responses long before we are conscious about the execution of
behavioral language. We rvork exclusively on ga1ne situatio11s related to our ivay of play. the movement. Actions and decisions that are taken daily may seem to be conscious
We do our weekly planning to crente habits in arder to 1naintain high leveis of perfor- and instantaneous, but they are actually the result of subconscious processes in the
nzance, 1vhic11 often translates into 'playing well'." (Mourinho, 2005) brain. Thus, through these "habits," decision and reaction times can be substanti-
ally reduced (McCrone, 2002). This method of training intends to prepare players
The fundamental principies of play, according to Carlos Queiroz (1983), are "the to understand and react faster to every possible game situation.
rules which help the players to run and to coordinate their activities (individually Combined, these principies allow our soccer team to perform certain motor behaw
and collectively) during the moments of the game." Therefore, they are rules of viors and pattems on an individual, sectorial, intersectorial and collective scale.
action that support the basic objectives of soccer. According to the sarne author, Therefore, these principies are specifically designed according to our own way of
these fundamental principies are composed of hvo kinds of principie: the general play and team identity. Obviously, these principies should always be in accord with
principies, which are the general behavioral requirements, and the specific princi- the fundamental principies of play. The specific principies of the game model can
pies, which are related to the attacking and defensive moments. Both general and be manifested at different leveis of complexity. Tactical Periodization uses the follo-
specific principies are inherent to the game, regardless of the way or style of play. wing nomenclature to hierarchically organize them:
Specific principies include attacking principies (e.g., penetration, depth, mobility,
width and space) and defending principies (e.g., delay, depth, balance, concentra- 0 Main principies of play: related to collective behaviors.
tion and composure). General principies include avoiding outnumbered situations, o Sub-principies of play: related to intersectorial and sectorial behaviors.
avoiding parity, and creating overloads. However, there are many different ways to 0 Sub-subwprinciples of play: related to individual behaviors.
perform a given general or specific principie. Therefore, Guillerme Oliveira (2003)
states we can add a third type of principie of play: the specific principies of the
game model.
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER
280 FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
The Tactical Periadization Model The Tactical Periodization Model 281

Thus, the model consists of game principles, sub-principies and sub-sub-principies 15.5.1 Principie of Specificity
that represent the different moments of the game. When they are articulated with
each other, they express a functional organization embodying the identity of the "For n1e, training 111eans to train in specificity. That is, to crente exercises that allow 1ne to
team (Oliveira, 2003). In this sense, it is essential the coach knows well what he or exacerbate 1ny principies of play." (Mourinho, in Anzieiro et al, 2006).
she wants to see happening at each moment of the game. When defined, the princi-
pies, sub-principies and sub-sub-principies should be clearly exposed to the play- This is arguably the most important principie of Tactical Periodization. Specificity
ers, so everyone can clearly understand the way the team wants to play. However, arises when there is a permanent relationship between all the dimensions of the
making all the players understand the sarne thing and getting them to act with the game and the training exercises are specifically representative of the desired game
sarne objective at the sarne time is not an easy task, and this takes time. Therefore, model (style of play). Therefore, the concept of specificity directs and leads the
it is essential for players to have the will to learn, but it is also crucial for the coach "whole" training process. ln this regard, Vitor Frade (in Silva, 1998), affirms that
to convince the players to work to\vard a common project and establish a common regardless of a training exercise's features (e.g., with more ar fewer players, larger
language between all team members. At this point, it is worth mentioning that the or smaller spaces, etc.), it should always be articulated in a way that allows our
game principles are "open rules," so they merely guide the players to act in a coor- principles of play to be learned and transferred to competition.
dinated manner while always respecting players' freedom and creativity. However, every exercise is just "potentially specific." The fulfillment of the princi-
pie of specificity will be only truly achieved if during training, players understand
the aims and objectives of the exercise and maintain high levels of concentration.
15.5 TACTICAL PERIODIZATION: METHODOLOGICAL PRJNCIPLES The coach's intervention should also be appropriate (Oliveira, 2008). Then, speci-
To make an operational game model, Tactical Periodization has defined and deve- ficity is related to the capacity to make operational the principles of play and their
loped its own and unique methodological (pedagogical) principies (Figure 15.4). respective sub-principies. Thus, according to Tactical Períodization, the principie
of specificity should also lead the interactive intervention between the exercise, the
players and the coach.

15.5.2 Principie of making tactical principies of play operational (conditioned


practices)

"One of the 11zost difftcult questions is how to ntake operational our sti;le of play. We try
to achieve that by creating exercises ivhere ive are able to e1nbrace all the dhnensions (tech-
nical, tactícal, physícal and 111ental), but never forgetting our first concern: to enhance a
given principie of play of our ga111e 111odel." (Mourinho,]. in Gaiteiro, 2006)

When we observe a team, we find it tends to exhibit a dynamic behavior that con-
stitutes its identity, explaining some patterns of action. To transform these pattems
into practice, every training exercise must be performed in close relationship with
our style of play (game model) and the concept of specificity. These references
should always be present in our daily work in arder to provide specific adaptati-
ons and tactical kno\vledge. If a proposed exercise is designed without considering
our style of play, the promoted adaptations can have adverse effects and interfere
with the acquisition of the desired specific knowledge. It is crucial for exercises to
represent the way we want to play and the unpredictability inherent in the game.
Fig. 15.4: Methodological principies of Tactica/ Periodization. This implies that each of the proposed exercises has to bring forward something
the players cannot central. If the game is nonlinear, the training exercises, even
though they are less complex, should also be nonlinear and exclude any direct cau-
se-and-effect relationship. The coach's intervention plays a key role when conduc-
ting an exercise, because this positively or negatively catalyzes its specificity.
It is also important to note that the structural and functional configuration of the
exercises is crucial in order to comply >vith the specificity of the game. This means
there are exercises that, because of their structure, promote functionality (e.g., the
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
283
282 The Tactical Periodization Model
1 The Tactical Periodization Model

acquisition of subconscious behaviors). Alternatively, there are exercises that have 15.5.3 Principie of disassembly and hierarchical organization of principies
the exact sarne aim, the sarne number of players, and the sarne field dimensions, of play.
but the distribution (i.e., structure) of the players in the field is di:fferent to what
would be required in a game (e.g., central defenders training in a different play- "I ivrote a doc111nent that is never going to be published. It is niy 'training dossier,' zvhere
ing position and role). This can consequently promote inadequate subconscious I keep all 1ny training guidelines. That is, all my training goals and the tvay to achieve
behaviors and tactical knowledge. As stated by Mourinho (Amieiro et aL, 2006), the1n through 1ny rnethodological principies. If I would have to na1ne this docinnent, its
"Training is only worthwhile when it lets you make your ideas and principies ope- title would be: The evolution of n1y trainilzg concepts."
rational." Thus, coaches have to find exercises to guide their teams to do what they (Mourinho,/. in Lourenço, L. & Ilharco, 2007)
want them to do in a game.
It seems intuitive that when the aim is to teach or improve a particular principie Principles of play are very complex concepts because they involve severa! variables
or sub-principie of our game model, the best way to do it is to create appropriate that are intrinsically and inextricably related. This is why Tactical Periodization
exercises. Then, if we are interested in certain behaviors related to a given princi- breaks them down to reduce their complexity. Thus, the principies of play are sub-
pie of play, we should make them appear more often in the exercise. As such, the divided into sub-principies, and these are further fragmented into sub-sub-princi-
requested behavior has to appear much more frequently than it would during a pies. The aim is to make them more understandable for the players and therefore
formal game, because this enables players to create multiple mental images about help their assimilation. This process of disassembling the principles of play has
the desired target. Thus, the configuration of the exercise (i.e., playing space, num- to be done very carefully, always respecting the style of play (game model) and
ber of players, roles, objectives, etc.) must promete the appearance of the required the wholeness of the game (systemic vision). Each specific principie of the game
behavior(s), and this is called "conditioned practice." For example, setting up an model is directly related to one of the four moments of the game (see Figure 15.6
exercise where a team's defensive sector is under-loaded and constantly defending for an example). Equal value is not awarded to ali the principles of play, so there is
will cause behaviors related to defensive organization to continuously emerge. a hierarchical organization. The importance of each principie during the training
There will then be ample opportunities for coaches and players to "shape" these process is directly related to the intended game model. Some principies are more
behaviors. important and valued than others in terms of what is intended. A coach's ability
to articulate all the principles that conform to his or her game model will deter-
mine the team's "DNA," which is basically the coach's conception about the game

Fig. 15.5: Principie of making principies of play operationa/.

(Tamarit, 2007).

Fig. 15.6: Example of the Disassembly of a Principie of Play.


Adapted from Gomes, M. (2006)
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
284 The Tactical Periodization Model 285
The Tactical Periodization Model

15.5.4 Principie of horizontal alternation in specificity

"Our daily concerns are directed to 111ake operational our ga1ne nzodel. However, the
structure of the training session and w1iat to do eaclz day is nat only related to the tactical
objectives, but also roith the physícal Jitness co1nponent ta be prioritized." (Mourinho, in
Atníeiro et al., 2006)

This principle relates to the need to maintain a regular and fixed weekly pattem
that respects the balance between training and recovery demands (Amieiro et al.,
2006). The Principle of Horizontal Alternation in Specificity highlights the impor-
tance and relevance that Tactical Periodization gives to the physical/ physiologi-
cal dimension, contrary to the common and unfounded misconception that this
dimension is forgotten and untrained. In a simplistic manner, the three main trai-
ning (acquisition) days in the week altemate '\vhich physical-fitness component to
promete (assuming the team is playing one game per week) (Figure 15.7). This is
Sub-
dane by prioritizing strength (first acquisition day), endurance (second acquisition prlncfpfos
OFF Sub-
day) and speed (third acquisition day) factors. Thus, no two days within a given prlncipfes
Sf'EEO
week demand the sarne physical-fitness component. The main goal is to avoid a RECOVii:RY
large amount of stress on the sarne physical-fitness component, giving the body SUNOAY MONOAY TUESDAY WEDNESDAY THURSDAY FRIDAY SATUROAY SUNOAY

time to recover and consequently minimizing fatigue. Recovery will take place, at
least partly, by switching the dominant physical-fitness component and its associ-
ated neuromuscular, metabolic and morphological underlying factors throughout
the week. This altemation in the physical-fitness components to be prioritized is
said to occur horizontally along the weekly pattem, rather than between exercises
within the sarne training session (vertically). The tactical goals and objectives of
each training day can obviously vary in accordance with the specific needs of the
team, but the physical-fitness component being prioritized each day of the week
will remain the sarne. Thus, it can be said that for Tactical Periodization, the physio-
logical dimension provides the biological framework where the soccer-specific trai-
ning/ recovery continuum lays.

RECOVERY OAYS REGOvt!RYOAY

Sub-
princfp/<!s

SPEEO
ACTIVATfON
Sub· SUNOAY MONDAY TUESOAY WEDNESOAY THURSDAY FR!DAY SATURDAY SUNOAY
principies Sub-sub-
OFF Sub· principies
prlncfpfes Sf'EEO
ACTIVATION
RECOVER'f
Fig. 15. 7: Standard weekfy pattern.
(Adapted from Gomes, 2006)

THURSDAY FRIDAY SATURDAY SUNOAY


SUNDAY MONOAY TUESOAY WEDNESOAY
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
286 The Tactical Periodization Model 287
The Tactica/ Periodization Model

The specific training contents {i.e., exercises) for each week arise from the conti- 15.5.5 Principie of tactical fatigue and tactical concentration
nuous interaction between the game model, the performance of the team in their
previous game, and the characteristics of the upcoming opponent. The game model "Concentration needs to be trained. It can be done by training according to a specific phi-
acts as a reference to analyze previous game performance. Thus, positive and nega- losophy. I cannot dissociate training intensity fro1n tlze concept of concentration. When I
tive aspects can be identified, and any potential issues the team may face in the say that football is rnade by actions of high intensif:1.;, I also refer to the need for pennanent
next game can be anticipated. Accordingly, the training exercises should take into concentration; it is únplicit to the ga1ne." (Mourinho, in A1nieiro et al, 2006)
account any problems the team showed in the previous game, as well as those they
will probably face in the upcoming game (Figure 15.8). Soccer players' peak performance requires a constant tactical thinking, both in
game and in training. Players need to always concentrate. The development of a
tactical attitude requires an attitude that can think and decide quickly. High levels
of concentration, from the first to the last minute of the game, are an essential requi-
rement. Therefore, "intensity" is not an intangible concept-it is directly related to
the principies and sub-principies of play that, when trained through well-desig-
ned exercises, will direct players' future actions and thoughts. The more variables
that players need to analyze during the execution of training exercises, the more
demanding and intense the sítuation will be (Frade, 2003).
The intensity should be always maximal but relative, because it relates to the acti-
ons performed on a given training session. It will differ from day to day because
the complexities of training sessions also vary from day to day, dragging with it
the other dimensions of the game (Figure 15.9). We can exemplify the concept of
relative maximum intensity as follows. If the team played on Sunday, the player is
unlikely to be fully recovered (both physically and mentally / emotionally) by Tues-
day. To overcome all the challenges the Tuesday training session can impose, the
player should work at his or her maximum intensity of concentration. That maxi-
mum intensity, however, will not be enough to overcome the increased complexity
Fig. 15.8: Factors to take into account when setting weekly goa/s (and intensity) that the training tasks will demand, for instance, on Wednesday and
(Adapted from Gomes, M. 2006) Thursday (because the player's recovery status has also improved). Therefore, in
Tactical Periodization, the intensity is always maximal in terms of concentration,
but it is relative to a player's recovery and readiness to train. The higher the level
of concentration during the training exercises, the less chance there is of making
mistakes. A high concen-
tration provides a higher
degree of leaming, so coa-
ches should always seek
the maximum concentra-
tion during training.

Fig. 15.9: Factors to manage


exercise compfexity.
zss I FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
289
The Tactical Periodízation Model The Tactical Periodization Model

15.5.6 Principie of complex progression 15.5.7 Principie of performance stabilization

"Since the very beginning, the principies and sub-principies of our ga1ne model are "Ido not want niy tea1n to have peaks i11 pe1fonna11ce. Ido not ivant 111y tea111 to srving
prioritized through a set of exercises. But the best way to convey our ideas is by pe1fonnance. Rather than that, I prefer to always keep high leveis of performance. Tlzis is
loivering the co1nplexity thro11glz tactical, conditioned s1nall-sided ga1nes." because to 111e there are no períods or ganies that are 1nore inzportant than others."
(Mourinho,]. in Fernandes, 2003). (Mourinho, in Anzieiro et al., 2006)

This principie relates to the hierarchical organization of the principies and sub-prin- From a conventional viewpoint, the concept of performance is normally based on
ciples of play. It has nothing to do with a general-to-specific progression, from a set of quantitative-oriented criteria based essentially on the physiological dimen-
volume to intensity, or such like. For Tactical Periodization, the concept of progres- sion. Planning and periodization in soccer has to assign vital importance to the
sion is built around the acquisition of a certain way of playing. This progression concept of "performance stabilization," which derives from the game's long com-
appears at three different levels of complexity: during the season, throughout the petitive period. From this perspective, "being fit" is to "play well" and "playing
week (taking into account the previous game and the upcoming one), and finally well" is to carry out the on-field duties in accordance with the intended game
during each training session, thus becoming a complex progression where each model. Underpinning this concept is that collective and individual performance
level is related to the other. is the basis of the team's organization, and this is the fundamental objective to
According to Frade (2004), during the early stages of the training season, we should be maintained. Thus, what really matters is that a team regularly demonstrates
introduce the general principles of play (related to the four moments of the game: a certain quality of play (despite minar fluctuations) to guarantee consistency in
defensive organization, offensive organization, transition defense-attack, and tran- competition.
sition attack-defense). If players know and "can explain" when to apply the prin- A stable levei of optimal performance is achieved through the implementation and
cipies of play relative to each moment, it will be easier for them to assimilate the maintenance of the standard weekly plans (Figure 15.10). Thus, over the season,
specific principles that each coach has in his ar her game model. ln a second phase, weekly dynamics regarding training content, recovery schemes, and the number
we should work on the specific principies of "our" game model. At this stage, we and length of training units remain almost invariable.
can distinguish two moments, with the first being the defensive organization of the Soccer performance and training cannot be separated from competition and the
team, which we will begin to work with. From our point of view, it seems advisa- game. It must be translated in terms of play, a quality instead of quantity approach,
ble to focus first on the defensive organization, because by having a good defen- always working on offensive and defensive actions and the dynamics that allow
sive organization, the team will gain confidence and consistency, and this allows the connection of these two moments. By working in such a way, the methodologi-
coaches to progress into other game situations (defending properly to attack even cal Princip le of Stabilization is respected.
better). ln addition, defending is "easier" than attacking. Coaches can then pro-
gress to the more complex behaviors that the offensive organization requires. The
transitions are a key aspect of modern soccer, so coaches should try to train them
from the very beginning because they will be linked to the team' s defensive and
offensive organization.
To understand the entire logical structure, the Principie of Complex Progression
and the Principie of Horizontal Specificity Alternation should be linked. We refer
"' rtJl:Czy;m!Y
J\ClWATIOtl

MONCAY TUE$P/l.Y FR!CAY nATUnDAY


to a "building up" and "disassembly" of the principies and sub-principies and their
hierarchy within the weekly plan and over consecutive weeks, according to the
$'1iJ.ptboí#«
evolution of the players and the team. This methodological principle has two leveis Svh·•"/).prlo<ip/o
Off "~
ofplanning thatinteractwitheachother: the short term (i.e., game to game) and the
medium-to-long term (i.e., style of play and game model). SUND/l.Y MOH!IAY TIIUMY W~DNeSDJ\Y Tll\llUIOAY FAJl:>AY ~ATilnOAY

~UllDAY TIIUDAY W!!DNESDAY TIIU!UP/l.Y FmDllY nATilnD/l.Y SUNO/l.Y

Fig. 15. 10: fnteraction between horizontal aftemation and perfonnance stabilization principies.
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
The Tactical Periodization Model Macroeycle: Preseason 1291
SUMMARY
It seems to be the consensus today that the tactical dimension plays an important
role in achieving high performance in soccer. As Pinto, J. (1996) states, "It's incre-
asingly assumed the role of tactics as a center and coordinator of the different
factors of football performance. Tactical training therefore plays a decisive role
in the education and competitive performance of a football player. The deve-
1
lopment of tactical approaches implies the development of the ability to decide
quickly to be able to create solutions. That is, decision-making skills are inex-
tricably connected with the development of tactical knowledge." Thus, it beco-
mes important to consider tactics as the dimension that coordinates the game MACROCYCLE: PRESEASON
and training process. The tactical dimension of soccer does not exist by itself; Jan Van Winckel, Werner Helsen, Kenny McMillan, Paul Brad/ey
it makes sense only when it occurs through interaction with the other three: the
technical, physical and psychological. When developing a periodized training
schedule for a soccer team, it can be argued that tactical training should be the
dominant and most important dimension of the plan.

REFERENCES 16.1 INTRODUCTION


ln the previous chapters, we talked about the importance of "fatigue management"
Amieiro, N., Olivcira, ll., Resende-, N. and Barreto, R., 2006. Mourinho: Porqu~ tantas vitórias? Lisboa. Grndiva.
Fernandes, V., 2003. lmplcmcntaç.lo do Modelo de Jogo: da razão à adaptabilld,1de com cmoçJo. Monografia .,,,,lizada no âmbilo da and "performance stabilization" throughout the competitive in-season period. ln
di!;i:iplina de seminário, opç.'io de futebol. FCDEF-UP.
Faria, R., 1999. "PcriodizaçJo Táctka ... Um lmpcr.1tivo Conceptomctodológico do Rendimento Sup<!rior cm Futebol. Porto: R. Faria. Di•-
this chapter, we take a closer look at the preseason macrocycle. The preseason trai-
scrtação de Licenciatura apr1.-scntada à Faculdade deCiêndac.do Oc.<portoc de Educaç5o Física d:i UnivcrnidaOC do Porto.
Frade, V., 2003. Entrevir.ta in F. Ivfartiru;, 2003. A urcriodizaçlo Táctka" segundo Vflor Frade: Maio do que um conceito, um.1 forma de
ning period is traditionally the period when players complete the most physical
cotar e de reílcctir o futclm!. Porto: F. Martins. Dir,;crtação de Licenciaturn apresentada à Faculdade de De-;porto da Univcn;id,1dc do work, enabling them to cope with the physiological demands of the competitive
Porto.
Frade, V., 200~. Entrevista in P. Leal, 2{)(}1. Diferentes entendimento:;, diferentes orientações mctodológkas. l'orto: P. \.cal. Di=rtação de season (Bangsbo, 1994). Tae-Seok et al. (2011) examined the physiological loads of
Licencia tum apresentada â Faculdade de Desporto da Universidade do Porto.
Frade, V., 2006. Do.,icrde Metodologia de Fulelml L Doosierdasaulas n5o publicado. Fam!dadcdc O~-sporlo - Universidade do Porto. programmed "preseason" and "in-season" training in professional soccer players.
Gaiteiro, B., 200ú, A Ciéncia oculla do ouce55o: )o.fourinho ao,; olhos da ciência. Porto: B. Gallciro. Di&Sl!rtaç3o de Lkenciatorn apresentada
à Faculdade de Desporto da Univcn;idadcdo Porto. They concluded that the average physiological loads were higher in preseason than
Garganta, J., 2002. O treino da tn,tica e da técrika nos jogos desportivos à luz do compromisso cognlçlo - acçao. ln V. llmbanti, ,\lberto in in-season, anda greater proportion of time was spent exercising at 80-100% of
A., Jorge B. & António M. (Eds.), Esporte e atividade ffoica: intcracç~o cnt"' rendimento e saúde {pp.281-306). S3o l',lolo: Editora Manolc
Gargant.i, J. and Pinto, J., 1998. O Eruino do Futebol. ln A. Graça & /.Oliveira (Eds.), O cnoino dos jogos dcportivos, 3º Ed. {pp.95-135). maximum heart rate. During preseason, coaches usually focus on rebuilding fit-
Porto: Centro de Estudos dos Jogo:> Desportivos, FCOEF-UP
Gomes, M., 2006. Do l'é corno ncrika ao l'cm;amcnto Técnico dos Pés Dentro da Caixa Preta da l'"riodização Táctica - um Estudo de ness (retraining). Adjustments in load are a direct attempt to deliver a training sti-
Cnr.o. Porto: M. Gomes. Dis>ertnç<lo de l.iccnciaturn aprcr.cnt.1da ~ Fac\lldade de Dc-sporto da Univcruidadc do Porto.
Haggard, P. and Libe~ B., 2001. Conscious lnlcntion and Brain Activity /oumal ofConsdousncs:;Studies, $,No. li, 2001, pp..17-63 mulus to promote specific training adaptations (Tae-Seok Jeong et ai., 2011). This
Le Moignc,J., 1990. Li modélisation des syst~rnes complcxef.. Donod, 1',1ris.
Lourenço, L. and llham>, F., 2007. \.idcrança: As; Lições de Jo:ié Mourinho. Booknomic.;, contrasts with the goals of training sessions during the competitive season, where
Martinf., F., 2003. A "Pcriodizaç<lo T1klica "fiegundo Vilor Frade; llfoís do que um con<:t."Ho, uma forma de cot.ir e de reflcctir o futebol.
Porto: F. llfarlins. Dioocrt.iç:lodc Li<:t."nciatura ap,..,sm!ada ~Faculdade de Dcoportoda Universidade do Porto. emphasis is mainly on maintaining the physical abilities developed during pre-
Matvcje\~ L, 1931. O processo de treino desportivo. Lislm,1: Livros Hori~onte.
Mi:Crom', /., 2002. Como Funciona o Cérebro: um guia para principiantes. Dorling Kindcr.;ley - CivilizaçJo Edito,..,s. Porto.
season (Bangsbo et aL, 2006). During preseason, the training load can be as high
Mourinho,)., 2002. Quero ganhar tiluloc. com um futebnl al"ic!ivo. Revista Drngõ•>s; Ano 16, n"201. as one or two daily training sessions (90-120 minutes per session) for five days a
Oliveira, J.G., 2003. Entrevir.ta in ). Tawres (2003). "Uma no<;,'\o fund,1mcntal ·a ..~;pccifiddad": o como inve,;tigM a ordem das ucoisM.'"
dojogar, uma espécie de ím·Mi.incias de tipo frnct,1!"'. Porto:). Tavares. D•~r.crtaçilo de Licenciatura apn'S\'ntada 11 Faculdade de Desporto week (Impellizzeri et al., 2006). Overall, the aerobic capacity of team sport players
da Univcroidadc do Porto.
Oliveira, J.G., 200°!. Conhecimento Especifico em Futebnl. Contributos par.1 a definii;Jo de uma matriz diniomic.1 do proce,;so en~ino­ (e.g., basketball, rugby league and soccer) has been shown to increase throughout
aprcndizngem/ treino do jogo. Porto: J. Guilherme Oliveira. Disscrtaç.io de Mestrodo aprcscnt,1da ~ Faculdade de Desporto da Uní-
vcr.>idadc do Porto. the preseason and decrease during the competitive season when using a classical
Olivcirn, J.G., 2007. F.C. l'orto: Nu~~;tro MkrocidoScrnana! (Morfocido). VI Clinic FUtbol lla~e Fundación Oe.asuna.
Oliveira J.G., 2003: Apontamcntoc. do Curso de Tf\'inado"'" de Futebol UEFAb, Fedcraç,io l'ortogues.1 de Futebol, As:;oci,1<;,'IO Futebol do team sport conditioning approach (Stone and Kilding, 2009), Thus, the focus of
Porto. Asoociaçao Nacional de T"'inado"'s de Futebol. Porto. Tr.1balhonõo publicado.
Pinto,)., 1996.1\ tilctica no futebol; abordagem conceptual e Implicações na formação. ln/. Oliveira & F. Tav,1rec. (Eds), Mtratégi.1 e Tdctica
preseason is usually centered on long-term improvement of physical abilities. For
nos jogos Dcoportivm; Colectivos. FCDEF-UP. elite teams unfortunately, the emphasis during preseason is increasingly placed
Queiroz, C., 1986, Eotrutura cOrganlzaç~o dos E:<erdcios deTfl'inoem Futebol. Lisboa' FcderaçJo Portugu~-s.1 de Futebnl.
Silva, L, 199S. Rcndlmcn!osuperior no futebol, "sem leoücs"', quais a:; razil•>s? Porto'!.. Silva. Dis>er!~ção de Li<:t."ndat\lra apn.'&l'ntada 11 on commercial activities, or games are planned to meet sponsorship requirements.
Fanildade dcCilncias do De~portoc de EducaçJo F!sk,1 da Univeroidade do !'orlo.
Tamarit, X., 2007. Que e~ lo Pcriodfr~,ciún Táctica? v;,·enciorel juego pnrn condicionor e! ju.•go. MCSporffi. l'ontevedr,1 Although this may be lucrative in the short term, it could detrimentally affect per-
formance in the longer term.
FITNESS IN SOCCER
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER Macrocyc/e: Preseason 1293
292 Macrocycle: Preseason

16.2.3 Physiological load / Mechanical load


16.2 PRESEASON TRAINING PRINCIPLES
With the arrival of GPS <levices, the understanding of the mechanical load impo-
We highlight below some important training principies, which should be taken into
sed on players has increased enormously. Joints and muscles are subjected to a
consideration when setting upa training plan for the preseason macrocycle.
significant load when changing direction (five times the body weight or higher ),
which is why it is best to limit the number of impact training sessions in a micro-
16.2.1 Aerobic fitness
cycle. One of the main goals of preseason training is to improve various physical
Aerobic fitness is the keystone on which ali further training builds upon. For this
abilities, and this can be achieved by increasing the physiological load on players
reason, aerobic fitness has to be given sufficient attention before other physical abi-
while limiting the mechanical load, thus decreasing the chance of injury. However,
lities can be trained. In an interesting study, Magarey et al. (2013) examined the
it is also important during preseason to prepare players for the demands of match
relationship between preseason fitness testing and injury in elite junior Australian
play. By monitoring mechanical load during matches using GPS, reference values
football players. Players with lower levels of aerobic endurance (in a 20m mul-
can be created. Training can then be tailored to ensure players are able to meet their
ti-stage shuttle run) were at greater risk of shin/ankle/foot region injuries. The
mechanical demands (e.g., number of sprints performed, acceleration and decele-
researchers suggest that this is possibly dueto the fact that these players are subject
rations, the number of high intensity efforts, etc.).
to higher leveis of fatigue ata comparative workload.
16.2.4 Respect recovery
16.2.2 Off-season
If your club does not have appropriate facilities to allow players to rest and recover
Professional players should maintain aerobic fitness during the off-season to
between hvo training exercises or sessions, it is advisable to avoid two impact-trai-
reduce the detraining effect. McMillan et al. (2005) found that aerobic endurance
ning sessions per day.
performance increased significantly between the start of the preseason training
period and the early weeks of the competitive playing season. They suggested that
Examples:
this may be because players return to preseason training in a detrained state after
2 x 75 minute training sessions:
a summer intermission of several weeks. Bangsbo (1994) found, in contrast with
• Warm up = 2 x 30 minutes
lmpellizeri et al. (2006), no change in V02 mox after a preseason training period in
• Active learning time= 2 x 45 minutes
professional soccer players, although the speed at 3 mmol/L blood lactate concen-
0 Recovery before the next training session: a maximum of four hours after first
tration increased significantly. Impellizeri et al. (2006) suggest that the absence of
training session and 16-17 hours after second training session.
improvement in V02mnx' as found by Bangsbo, could be dueto the shorter summer
break of 2-3 weeks that is typical of professional soccer teams (compared to the
1x120 minute training session:
longer detraining period for the junior players used in Bangsbo's study). Amigo et
al. (1998) studied the effects of weeks of rest on three groups of adolescent soccer • Warm up = 1 x 30 minutes
• Active learning time = 1 x 90 minutes
players who had undergone systematic training for the previous 11 months. The
• Recovery before the next training session: 24 hours
researchers found a detraining effect: a decrease in the cross-sectional area of type
• When training twice a day, alternative training (cross~training principie) can
I and type II fibers and a significant decrement in the activities of aerobic enzymes.
also be included in the program. Rumring, aqua-jogging or cycling can also
Bangsbo and Mizuno (1988) found that a relatively short-term training intermis-
be used to improve aerobic fitness and create overload without the risk of
sion was not enough to cause a significant decrease in V0 2m,,,. but muscle oxidative
enzymes did decrease quickly. They suggest that for these two reasons, the levei injury.
of physical activity needs to be kept reasonably high during a detraining period to
16.2.5 Match load / Training load
ensure that the mitochondrial enzymatic activity of the players will be as high as it
Training should be as match specific as possible. The match itself is therefore good
was before the off-season period.
training in principle. After a hard traíning session, however, the body needs time
to recover and transform the training work into improved performance, so do not
plan any tough training sessions too soon before a match.
A match is one of the most difficult types of activity to monitor. Not all players will
be active for the entire match, and some players will be used as substitutes. It is the-
refore necessary to closely monitor matches so that all the players receive the sarne
training load. An extra training session the day after a match is not sufficient. The
load imposed by a match is often difficult to mimic, and players \vho are not used
regularly will have difficulties coping with the dernands of match-play..
FITNESS IN SOCCER
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Macrocycle: Preseason 1295
1
294 Macrocycle: Preseason

16.2.6 Workload management 16.2.7 Variation J Monotony


As we already read in the earlier chapters, it is important to manage and manipu- The greatest progress is made when there is sufficient variation in the training.
late fatigue (fatigue management). This can be dane based on objective parameters Variation also ensures that injuries are prevented. If monotony (the lack of varia-
given by heart rate monitors and GPS <levices, but it can also be based on subjective tion in load or intensity) is too high, the likelihood of injury increases.
parameters.
During the preseason period, it is important to closely follow the balance between 16.2.8 Finish the training session with an extensive exercise or cool down
load and load tolerance. This can be done by monitoring the status of players using You often see training sessions ending with an intensive exercise. This gives the
a simple questionnaire that can be displayed in the changing room (Fig. 16.1). There coach and players the impression that a satisfactory, intensive training session has
are also sofhvare applications available now for smartphones and computers that been completed. It is important, however, to finish the training session with a cool
can be used by players to record their stahts, down. By gently working the major muscle groups, rest products such as lactate are
actively processed. A cool down also allows body and muscle temperature, heart
rate, and blood pressure to gradually return to resting leveis.Dueto the increase in
Session RPI scale 1 O Session RPMF scale 20 Overtraining scale
muscle temperature, the cooling down period is a perfect time to stretch and incre-
RPJ Sca!e 10 How fatigued are your !eg Overtraining scare 6 ase or maintain joint range of movement and flexibility.
What best reflects the muscles? What best reflects your
intensity of the training? feeling?
16.2.9 Unloading week
O: Rest O: No fatigue atai O: No pain/fatigue at ali It is best to incorporate an unloading period of five to eight days into the presea-
1: Very, very low intensity 1: 1: Muscle pain/fatigue son phase if possible. This allows dissipation of any accumulated fatigue arising
2: Very !ow intensity 2: in the morning after
waking up
from the first few weeks of preseason training, and also provides time for players
3: Moderately intensive 3:
4: Somewhat intensive 4: 2: Muscle pain/fatigue in to recover from minor injuries. The unloading period is best planned in the third
5: lntensive 5: Legs feel slightly heavy between exercises or fourth week. This period also allows the staff to analyze data from heart rate
6: 6: 3: Muscle pain/fatigue at
monitors and GPS <levices and consequently adjust the training plan and set new
7: Very intensive 10: Legs feel fatigued the start of the warm
8: 15: Legs feel heavy up, but the pain/fatigue individual goals.
9: Maximal intensity 20: Training is impossible fades during warming
up 16.2.10 Periodization oftests
4: Muscle pain/fatigue at
the start ofthe training, All too often, physical tests are scheduled during the first week. This is not ideal as
the muscle pain/fatigue players often arrive in a detrained state and are physically unprepared for intensive
fades during training tests. It may be better, for example, not to carry out any speed or agility tests during
5: Muscle pain/fatigue
is constantly present
the first week of preseason. Instead, the ideal time to conduct these tests is in the fifth
during lhe training phase (intensity phase) of preseason. On the other hand, submaximal aerobic tests
session can be scheduled in the first microcycle, but maximal tests should be avoided in the
6: Training is no longer
possible.
first few days.

Player 1 16.2.11 Individual periodization in off~season


Player 2 Each player needs a minimum of tvvo to three weeks of relative rest after a stres~
Player3 sful (both physically and mentally) season. This means that players returning from
intemational duty must also be given the sarne time to sufficiently rest and process
Fig. 16. 1: Sheet that can be used to monitor subjective fatigue. ( RPI - Rate of Perceived lntensity; the physical and neural fatigue. If this break is not respected, it will have conse-
RPMF - Rate of Perceived Musc/e Fatigue) quences for the remainder of the season.
As training adaptations are only possible when an overload is created which results
in some fatigue accumulation, a player will often feel muscle soreness at the start 16.2.12 Foreign players
of the next training session in the preseason phase. Training sessions in soccer are Foreign players often want to stay in their home countries for as long as possible,
normally completed by the entire team, but because the fitness levels of players often retuming to the club a day or just a few days before the first training session.
can vary significantly, some players will train hard while others undergo a lighter This compromises the quality of their training sessions in the first week of presea-
training session. ln order to make sufficient progress for all players, it is therefore son, and it could lead to overtraining because of insufficient recovery from "travel
important to properly monitor the overload process. One of the golden rules is fatigue" (Reilly et ai. 1997). Ensure that players report for preseason training fresh
that a maximum of 25% of the players may be in overtraining scale phase 3 during and free from jet-lag, because this will allow time for the players to settle in and
preseason. cope with the demands of preseason training.
296
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER
Macrocycle: Preseason
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Macrocycle: Preseason i 297

16.3 ORGANIZATION OF THE MESOCYCLE 16.3.2 lntensive endurance phase (see table 16.2)
In the preseason phase, we opt for a six phase periodization strategy. Because pre- Training forms:
season can extend over a period of five, six, seven and sometimes even eight weeks, 0 Aerobic endurance
a phase in this mesocycle may be shorter or longer than a week. - Continuous intensive
These six phases are structured such that they comply with the concept of fatigue - V0 2max interval
management. ln the preseason macrocycle, loading strategies are therefore alterna- - Long-interval loads
ted with recovery strategies within each microcycle. At the end of the mesocycle,
a microcycle of unloading (tapering) is planned so the players can start the season 16.3.3 V02 max phase (see table 16.3)
"fresh." The preseason mesocycles differ from in-season mesocycles in that there is Training forms:
0 V0 ma~ interval
no specific tapering planned in the various microcycles before preseason matches. 2
- Long-interval loads
This is the structure of the preseason mesocycle: - Medium-interval loads
Volume phase
0 Short-interval loads
• Extensive endurance phase (EEP)
0 Intensive endurance phase (IEP) 16.3.4 High-intensity phase (see table 16.3)
• Unloading phase (UP) Training forms:
o vo2maxinterval
Intensity phase - vo2m.lx repetition
• VO,m., phase (V02P) - Long repetition loads
• Interval phase (IP) - Medium repetition loads
• Speed phase (SP) - Short repetition loads
• Tapering phase (TP) - Repeated sprint exercises

16.3.1 Extensive endurance phase (see table 16.2) 16.3.5 Speed phase (see table 16.4)
Training forrns: Training forms:
• Aerobic endurance • Resistance
• Continuous extensive - Starting speed
• Fartlek variable • Acceleration
° Continuous intensive 0 Maximum speed
• SAQ training
0 Medium repetition
0 Short repetition

16.3.6 Tapering (see table 16.4)


Training forms:
• Tapering strategies

Macrocycle Preseason Macrocycle

Mesocycle Mesocycle Volume Mesocycle lntensity

Microcycle Extensive
endurance
l endurance
lntensive 1Unload'
ing VO,~ l lnterval 1 Speed 1 Tapering

Table 16. 1: Organization of the preseason macrocyc/e


1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
298 299
Macrocycle: Preseason Macrocycle: Preseason

16.4 FRIENDLY MATCH PLANNING IN THE PRESEASON STAGE order to reduce the load. This can be clone in one of the first weeks of the season,
Casamichana et aL (2012) compared the physical demands of friendly matches for instance, if volume is the main objective.
(FMs) and small-sided games (SSGs) in semiprofessional soccer players using GPS Example of buildup:
technology. The researchers found the distance covered in the speed zones greater o 45 minutes ball possession
than 21 km/h was significantly higher in FMs as opposed to SSGs. Moreover, more • 15 minutes ball possession, 15 minutes pressing, 15 minutes ball possession
sprints per hour of play were performed during FMs, with greater mean durations • 15 minutes pressing, 15 minutes ball possession with low defensive line,
and distances, greater maximum durations and distances, anda greater frequency 15 minutes pressing
of sprints of 10-40 and >40 m. Finally, they demonstrated that the frequency of • 45 minutes pressing
repeated high-intensity efforts was higher during FMs. The results of this study
(Casamichana et ai., 2012) suggest that coaches should consider FMs during pre- 6. Plan the quality of your opponents.
season to elicit specific adaptations in the domain of high-intensity effort. Players will be fatigued during preseason because of the increased load, and this
Belo\v are a number of rules for planning and playing preseason fríendly matches: will inevitably compromise performance. When planning opponents for prac-
tice matches, it is therefore important to make the right choice. Preseason should
1. Do not plan matches in the first week. start with matches against weaker opponents before facing stronger opponents
Players often retum after the summer period with reduced fitness. They need in the last two weeks (when the load has decreased and performance and pre-
time to adapt to the load of soccer training again. If a friendly match is planned, paredness will increase).
it is best done against weaker opponents, with the players not playing for more When selecting the opponents, coaches should consider that everyone in the
than 45 minutes. club will have their own expectations. Suppose you play against a second-class
foreign team in week 2. However, this team starts its league the follo\ving week
2. Plan games according to the number of players. and plays 90 minutes with its strongest team. You are still working on building
Coaches sometimes make the mistake of planning two matches per week for a up fitness, and your team will therefore accumulate fatigue. Therefore, players
squad of 18 players. It should be remembered that improving performance is will be fatigued, or at least Iess prepared, when starting the game. The result
the main objective. This means that training needs to be approaching the injury might be that you lose the game, resulting in dissatisfaction both intemally and
threshold, and this leads to players often experiencing minor problems (medical externally (media and supporters). Try to avoid this, because the mental aspect
attention injuries). Playing with these medical attention injuries carries a great cannot be detached from the physical aspect.
risk. There will also be players who cannot participate in all of the preseason For this reason, practice matches should be arranged against lesser local teams
because of intemational obligations (professional players), jobs (amateur play- before subsequently facing stronger teams.
ers), or holidays. It is therefore better to plan friendly matches based on one per
16 players, possibly planning games against the reserve team or lesser oppo- 7. Important competitive matches during preseason.
nents in the middle of the week. These matches can potentially be delayed to You might possibly have to compete in a European or other cup competition
later in the preseason phase, or using the players of the reserve team. during the preseason phase. Your pre-season plan will have to take this matter
into account. Clear choicelmportant, strategic decisions have to be made, and
3. Varying playing time. communicated to all of the clubs players and coaching staff.
Start by getting everyone to play for 45 minutes. Then progress players up to
playing for 60, 75 and finally 90 minutes of match time before the competitive
season begins. Ideally, every players should have participated in at least two full
games before the competitive season commences.

4. Preseason is for all players.


Preseason is an important period for all players. If a player has a poor preseason,
this will jeopardize the rest of the season, so develop a preseason program for all
players rather than just the first-choice players.

5. Varying intensity.
Try to vary intensity during preseason friendly matches. For example, players
can be instructed to play a high-pressing game for 15 minutes. This will boost
the intensity, which in tum increases the load. This load can then be built up in
the following friendly matches. Periods of ball possession can also be played in
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER
300 Macrocycle: Preseason FITNESS IN SOCCER
Macrocycle: Preseason 1301

16.5 ORGANIZATION OF THE PRESEASON TRAINING CAMP


Training camps are often used in an inappropriate way to subject players to exces-
sive loads. The training camp schedule should be organized in such a way to ena-
ble players to recover from training sessions in an optimal manner. As a result, the
training load can be increased gradually. All the recovery strategies (e.g., sleep, rest,
nutrition, hydration, etc.) can be scheduled in an optimal way to ensure that fatigue
between sessions is reduced as quickly as possible.

Planning a preseason training camp is an important consideration. ln the past, a


training camp was often organized to start in the first two weeks of preseason. This
often led to injuries because of the load increasing far too quickly. A training camp
in preseason is best scheduled at the start of the third or fourth week, ideally before
the unloading phase. Double sessions are regularly planned during those weeks.

It is also important to consider the objective of a training camp. Is the aim to


strengthen team spirit or improve fitness? Or is it a combination of the two? Anight
out or team-building activities like go-karting will disrupt and delay recovery. A
training camp is not necessary for organizing a group activity, but if it is planned
as a team-building activity, it should be accompanied by a reduction in workload.
Training camps can also be organized solely for the purpose of playing friendly
matches. Professional soccer players may cover a distance of 30-45 kilometers
during a normal training week, which is approximately 70% of what a professional
player can process each week. Exceeding this threshold will lead to an exponential
increase in the number of injuries.

Ekstrand and Gillquist (1983) examined the injury incidence of soccer players
during training camps. Each soccer team in this study had two training camps, one
in March-April before the start of the Spring league play and one in July before the
start of the Autumn league play. The Spring season camp, lasting three days with
one to two practice sessions each day, had an injury incidence of 21.3 ± 15.2/1000
hours, which is three times that of average practice injury. The Autumn training
camp, lasting five days with one to two practice sessions per day, also had an injury
incidence that was higher than average, but it was lower than that of the Spring
camp (Ekstrand and Gilquist, 1983).

Non-impact sessions-such as running in running shoes, cycling, mountain biking,


or kayaking-can also be included in a training week in arder to build up fatigue
without too much mechanical impact. These are all cross-training options for soc-
cer players during the preseason phase .. There is a lower risk of injury while still
keeping a high load level. However, the effects of a new training mode do need
to be considered. Cycling involves a very different load to soccer, and it therefore
causes a specific form of fatigue. There are examples where coaches organize long
mountain-bike rides in the morning as recovery training followed by a friendly
match in the afternoon. This is likely to result in muscle injuries. Soccer players are
very specifically trained to produce maximum performance. A different mode of
training will therefore quickly entail peripheral local fatigue. You could compare
this to an elite cyclist having to play a soccer match in the morning and then parti-
cipate in a cycle race in the afternoon.

FACULDADF ne DcSPOltTO
DA UNIVERSIDAOE DO PORTO
s
;::~
Macrocycle Preseason I Mesocycle lntensity "q -1
z
om
" V>

~~
Monday Tuesday Wednesday Thursday Friday Saturday Sunday
.,, V>
vo2m>x phase ~o
~ n
Week4 Free Free AM:V021nt, AM:Melnt, AM:Mefnt, AM: Training Free Frequency: #7 "n
O m
Lolnt (Vai 80'/ Shlnt (Vo! 90'/ Shlnt (Vol 80'/ group 2 Volume: 535min § ;o
Rpi 12) Rpi 12) Rpi 12) Melnt, Shlnt lntensity: Rpi: 11.8
(Vai 80'/Rpi 12) Match: 75min
PM: Strength PM:V021nt, PM: Strength
training 30 x Lolnt (Vo! 70'/ training 30 x PM: Match +++
35"/25" (Core Rpi 11) 35"/25" (Core (75'-15')
círcuit) circuit)

High intensity phase

Week5 AM: Conl (Vol Group 1 Group 1 Group 1 Group 1 Group 1 Group 1 Group 1:
60' I Rpi 9) AM:V02Rep AM: LoRep, AM: LoRep, AM:MeRep, PM: Match Free Frequency: #10
(Vol 60'/Rpi 15) MeRep, RSE MeRep, ShRep ShRep (Vol 70'/ ++++ (90'-00') Volume: 580min
PM: V021nt (Vol 70'/Rpi 14) (Vol 80'/Rpi 14) Rpi 13) lntensity: Rpi: 12.2
(Vol 60'/Rpi 14) PM: Strength Match: 90min
training 40"/20"
(Core circuit) PM: Gani (Vai PM: Strength
30'/Rpi 7) training 40"/20"
(Core circuit)

Group 2 Group 2 Group 2 Group 2 Group 2 Group 2 Group 2:


AM: V02Rep PM: Match +++ AM: Conl (Vai AM: Melnt, Free Frequency: #10
(Vol 45'/Rpi 14) (90'-00') 45'/Rpi 10) Shlnt (Vol 70'/ AM:V02Rep Volume: 580
Rpi 13) (Vol 90'/Rpi 15) lntensity: Rpi: 12.2
PM: Strength PM: Strength Match: 90min
training 40"/20" training 40"/20" PM: Gani (Vai
(Core circuit) (Core circuit) 60'/Rpi 11)

Tab/e 16. 3: Organization of the mesocyc/e intensity in preseason

Macrocycle Preseason / Mesocycle lntensity

Monday Tuesday Wednesday Thursday Friday Saturday Sunday

speed phase

Week 6 Group 1 Group 1 Group 1 Group 1 Group 1 Group 1 Group 1 Group 1:


AM: COnl (Vol AM: Sp, Res, AM: Sp, Res, AM: Sp (Vai 60'/ :V021nt (Vol PM: Match Free Frequency: #8
60' I Rpi 7) RSA {Vol 60'/ (Vai 80'/Rpi 15) Rpi 14) 45'/Rpi 15) Volume: 455min
Rpi 16) +++++ {90'-00') lntensity: Rpi: 12.6
PM: Conl (Vai Match: 90min
PM: Strength 30'/Rpi 9)
training 30x
40"120"
(Core círcuit)

Group 2 Group 2 Group 2 Group 2 Group 2 Group 2 Group 2 Group 2:


Sp, Res, RSA AM: Sp, Res, PM: Match ++ AM: ConE (Vol AM: Conl (Vo! AM: Sp, Res, Free Frequency: 8
(Vol 70'/Rpi 15) (Vol 45'/Rpi 14) +(90'-00') 45'/Rpi 9) 60'/Rpi 19) RSA {Vol 80'/ Volume: 465min
Rpi 16) lntensity: Rpi: 12.6
PM: Sp, Res PM: Strength Match: 90min
(Vol 45'/Rpi 13) training 30x
40"120"
(Core circult)

Tapering phase

Group 1 AM: V02Rep Free AM: V021nt (Vai AM: Melnt (Vol 27 Free Frequency: #6 "a~ -<~
PM: Conl (Vol b(Vol 80'/Rpi 75'/Rpi 14) 45'/Rpi 12) Match (League) Volume: 335min " z
" m
45'/Rpi 9) 16) lntensity: Rpi: 13
Match: 90 ..
"
"
V>
-
V>
Group 2
PM: Lolnt (Vai
~~
~o
70'/Rpi 14) " n
iõlnom
Tab/e 16.4: Organization of the mesocycle intensity in preseason " "'
w
5l
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
304
Macrocycle: Preseason Macrocyc/e: Preseason 1305

Frequency lntensity

\--···----------·-·-·-----:;/--··---------- ·-·--·--·-------·--···
/

•e·-···---·----------·-····---------·-···-·--------·---------·--------··-·-·--·

Fig. 16.4: Evo/ulion of intensity in preseason


EXlens;ve enduronce lnten•"• onduronce UnloodlnR ph"o V02mo< photo H;gh lnton<ity ph3'e Spocd ph><e T•porin~ phose
ph••• ph•<•

Fig. 16.2: Evolution of frequency in preseason


SUMMARY
Volume
The objectives of preseason are to prepare the team technically, tactically and
physically for the forthcoming competitive season. Unfortunately, most coaches
,. ---- train players with too much intensity and volume during preseason training,
especially during preseason camps. This leads to players accumulating too much
fatigue and sustaining injuries, even before the season begins! Coaches should
= gradually increase the duration and intensity of training throughout the pre-
,. season period. It is also important for coaches to prepare their teams tactically
during this period and not place all the emphasis on fitness training. Tactical,
technical and fitness aspects can be trained simultaneously, as discussed in the
'"
previous chapter. Friendly games can be arranged strategically during presea-
'" - son, so players are exposed gradually to playing 90 minutes of match play, as
well as getting used to the playing style and tactics of the team.
'"
'"

..
E«•""""'"d"''"'"
~.,.
ln!OnW.or><ior>•«
p>'><
Uni<"~''"°"'"' 'Kllm"°'"'º H:1~f<"•n1>tvJ>hm s,o .. ~º""' T•p«inHh"'

Fig. 16.3: Evolution ofvo/ume in preseason


FITNESS IN SOCCER
Macrocyc/e: Preseason
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Macrocycle: in~season 1307

1
MACROCYCLE: 1N-SEASON
Jan Van Winckel, Werner Helsen, Jean-Pierre Meert, Kenny McMil/an, Paul Bradley

17.1 INTRODUCTION
In the preceding chapter, we discussed planning strategies during preseason. ln
this chapter, we will discuss how the in-season phase can be structured. The match
is the most important event of the week during in-season, and everything is there-
fore focused on attaining optimum performance on that day.
Team success can be partly attributable to the planning and execution of appropri-
ate in-season training periodization strategies. As explained in the previous chap-
ter that discusses fatigue management, planning during the in-season period is
focused on performance stabilization. It comprises four phases in each microcycle:
recovery, loading, tapering, and the match. The load can only be varied in the loa-
REFERENCES ding phase of every microcycle.

Amigo, N., Cadcfou, j,,\., Ferrcr, !,, Turados, N,, and Cusoo, R., 1993. Effcct of sumrncr intcrmis.sion on skeletal musclc of ado!.,,,ccnt
socccr plnyers, /ou mal ofSporl!i Medicine and Phyok.11Fitnc~:;,38(•1), pp.298-30-1.
Bangsbo, /., Mohr, M. and Krustrup, P., 2006. Physica! and mctabolic dcmands of lraining and nrnlch-play in thc dite footbaU playcr. 17.2 DURATION OF THE MESOCYCLE
Joumal ofSporl!i Sdcnccs, z.t, pp.665-674.
Dung .bo, J. •md Mi7.uno M., 1988. Morphologic<1l and rnetabolic allcrations in sa«er playern with dctraining and retraining and thcir
0

rdalion to performance. !n: T. Rcilly, A. LC<.-.,,, )(. Davids, W,j. Murphy, <xfo. 19813. Sdcnre and football. London/New York: E nnd FN
Spon. ppJl•J.124 17.2.1 Terminology
Bang~bo,J., 199·b. Physic,1! ronditioning. ln: B. Ekblom, cd. 1994. Football (Sorcer). Oxford: Blackwell Scicnlific. pp.12-1-133.
Bang,bo, J.. 199·11.>. The physiology of wcC\!r - With speciol rcfcrcnC\! to intcnsc intcnnitlent cxcrcise. Ac!.t Physiologica &andinilvica, When a periodization phase of three to six weeks is mentioned in the literature, this
151: pp.1-155.
füng,bo, )., Mohr, M. and Krustrup, P., 2006. Physic,11 ilnd rnctabolic dcmolnds of lrillning and match-ploly in lhe elite foolbolll playcr. J refers to the mesocycle. For the in-season phase however, we opt for a three-phase
5portsSci., 24(7), pp.66S-74.
Cn~ilrnkh.tn.t, O., C1~tdlnno, J. and Cast.1gna, C., 2012. Cornparing thc physirnl dcmands of fricndly rnatchcs nnd srnilll·r.idcd games in
mesocycle.
scrniprofc%1onal soccer plnycm. J Strcngth Cond Rcs. 26(3), pp.837-S.J3. It is difficult to prove the efficiency of a three-, four-, five-, or six-phase mesocycle
Coopcr, K. H., 1968. A mcolns of ar&.'r.~.ing rnn~irnal oxygcn uptake.Joumoll of thc Arnerican Medical Asoociation, 203, pp.201-204.
EMtrand ). ond Gillqufatj., 19!13. Titcavoidabfüty of soccer infurics. !ntJ Sporlfi Mcd, ·H2~ pp.12'1-8. in soccer. There are so many factors influencing a match that it is almost impossible
Hclgerud J., Wir,]Qff, U., Engen L. 'md Holf, J,, 2001. Acrobic cndurancc lrnining improves so«cr performance. Medicine and ScienC\! ín
Sports and Excrdsc, 33(11), pp.1925-1931 to design research that empirically and quantitatively proves a three-phase cycle
)cong. T.S., Rcilly, T., Morton, J., Bac, S.W. and Drust, B,, 2011. Quanlification of thc physiologlcal !oadini; of one weà of µprc-scuson"
and onc wcckof ""in-tcasonH troining in profcssiona! socccr plnycrs.Joumnl of sporb 1;dcnc\'S, 29(11), pp.1161-6. to be more advantageous than its six-phase counterpart. The issue of periodization
lrnpcllizzcri, EM., Ma reoro, S.M., Ca~tíll)!lil, C., Rei!!y, T,, S~s,;i,A. and fain, F.M., 2006. Phrsiological and performance cffcc\!! of gene ri e
vcrnus opccifk acrobic tr.1inini; in SOCC\!t playcro. lntcmational /oumal ofSport> Medicine, 27, pp.483-492
during the in-season period is based on best practice rather than evidence-based
Mogarcy, M.E., Estcrrnan, A., Spccchlcy, M., !k,15c, E. and Hcyncne, M., 2013. TI1c rdotiorn;hip bctwecn pn.-sc;i,;on fitnec.>5 lcsting nnd findings. Although we have tried to present relevant research findings where possi-
injury in dite junior Au>trnlian foolball playcrs. ]ou mal oi &iencc and Medicine in Sport, 16(·1), pp.307-311.
McMilfon, K., Hclgcrud, J., Gmnt, S,, Ncwcll, J., Wilson. J.• Mncdonald, R., and Holf, J., 2005. Lictatc thfl'Shold rcsponsc-s to a ocason of ble, most of the concepts discussed in this chapter are intuitive or anecdotal. Howe-
prof.,,;oional British youthsoro."r, Br J Sports Jl.lcd, 39, pp..132~136.
Rcilly, T., 2007. Thc trnining pro=s. ln: Thc scicnC\! of trnining - sorC\!r. A sdcntific approach to dcvcloping olrenglh, opccd and cnd- ver, it would be helpful for researchers to report findings that could add to the
urancc. London: Routledgc. pp.l-19.
Rcilly, T., Morton, J., Sang·Won Bac, Drust, B, Tae-Scok Jconzy 2011. Quanlificntionof thc physiological looding of onc wcck of "pre-sca· evidence base and therefore fully support or reject these anecdotal reports. Before
son"' and onc wcck of "in-oca~on" training in profcssional r.ocC\!r playcrs. Joumal ofSporWScicnccs, 29(11), pp.1161--6.
Rcilly, T., Atkinson. G. and WatcrhouscJ., 1997. Travei fatigue and jct-log. / SporWSd, 15(3), pp.365·9. looking at the structure of the mesocycle in detail, we first set out a number of prin-
Rcilly, T., 1997. Encrgctks ofhigh-intcnsity excn:~ l<OCC<!r) with parti cu for rderenC\! to fotiguc. J Sporls Sci, 15, pp.257-2&3.
Stonc N.M. and Kilding A.E., 2009. Acrobk Conditionini; for Te~rn Sporl Athle1~'S. Sporl~ Med, 39(8), pp.615-6-12
cipies to explain why we opt for a three-phase cycle during in-season.
FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
3 9
308
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER Macrocycle: in-season o
Macrocyc/e: in-season

17.3 ORGANIZATION OF THE MESOCYCLE


17.2.2 Metabolic training versus neural adaptation
The three-phase mesocycle is repeated in the competition macrocycle (in-season).
One criteria for defining the duration of the mesocycle could be based on whether
the aim of training is metabolic or neural in nature (Nádori et al., 1989). Longer
17.3.1 Physical abilities: Parallel or concurrent training
cycles are suggested for metabolic training and rebuilding fitness during presea-
We explained the various possibilities for organizing a training plan in the chap-
son, and shorter cycles are suggested for neural adaptation in arder to stabilize
ter about periodization. ln this book, we opt for a parallel/ concurrent approach,
performance during in-season.
where all PAs are trained simultaneously.
17.2.3 Accumulated fatigue
17.3.2 Physical parameters: Linear (volume) and undulating (intensity)
Zatsiorsky (1995) eluded that long periods of high-intensity training quickly resul-
Volume decreases linearly in each mesocycle, while intensity increases at first and
ted in fatigue. The body needs a period of relative rest (unloading) after a few
then decreases in the unloading week.
weeks of training (loading). This gives the player time to recover and convert the
work produced into functional adaptations (supercompensation). For this reason,
17.3.3 Workload: Reverse step loading
after a two-week training period, we typically schedule a week of active rest (unloa-
Finally, we prefer "reverse step loading." The load is decreased each week dueto a
ding) where the intensity is kept high while volume and frequency are reduced.
decrease in volume. The intensity is retained as much as possible in order to coun-
teract the detraining effect.
17.2.4 Detraining
One of the shortcomings of multi-phase mesocycles is that it takes a while before
a specific physical ability (PA) is trained (e.g., speed, aerobic endurance, power). lf
a PA is not trained for a period of six to ten days, detraining occurs (Arciero et al.,
1998), and this causes the performance levei of that PA to compromise the player's
overall physical performance. ln addition, that specific PA will decrease to such an
extent that retraining it will take longer than it took to Iose it. -<$- lnten~ity

~:z-volume

17.2.5 Concurrent training --.k-Tralnlng load


Severa} team sports require different PAs, such as endurance, power, speed and
strength. For example, in a soccer game, a player may be required to sprint past
his or her opponent to score a goal (explosive power), deliver a hard body check
(strength and muscularity), and run 11 km in a single game (endurance). The inclu-
sion of resistance training (to gain strength, hypertrophy, and power) combined Volume phase lntensity phase Unloading phase
with aerobic exercise (to enhance endurance) in a single program is known as con-
Fig. 17.1: Three-phase mesocycle
current training (Wilson et al., 2012). The biggest issue that can arise from this sort
of programming is that the two or three PAs that coaches are looking to enhance
17.3.4 Neutral week
often end up competing with each other for adaptation. ln soccer, however, unlike
ln weeks (microcycles) with midweek competitive matches, it is important to incor-
some other sports (e.g., 100m sprint, cycling, marathon running, etc.), it is unneces-
pora te a neutral week and defer the mesocycle by one week.
sary to reach the maximum genetic potential for every PA required. Soccer players
must develop all the required PAs, but with specific individual adjushnents accor-
ding to a player's technical ability and position.

17.2.6 Adaptability
A three-phase mesocycle is easier to adapt and therefore more flexible than a six-
week cycle. This gives the coach the possibility of adjusting his or her planning
more easily.
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
310 Macrocycle: in-season Macrocycle: in-season 1311

17.4 THREE PHASES OF THE "IN-SEASON" MESOCYCLE 17.4.3 Unloading phase


0 Objective: The objective of the unloading phase is physical, neural and mental
17.4.1 Volume phase recovery. This is mainly achieved by reducing the frequency and volume of
o Objective: The objective of the volume phase is to improve aerobic fitness, and training. During this week, players are given the opportunity to recover from
especially the central component. At intensities close to the lactate threshold the load they have experienced over the previous two weeks. Intensity is kept
(-70-80% vo2m~x' physiological adaptations occur primarily in the peripheral fairly high to ensure that any loss of fitness (detraining) is minimized. It is
component. Significant peripheral adaptation occurs, with substantial changes through reductions in the other training parameters (volume, frequency and
in muscle capillarization, oxidative enzyme activity, mitochondrial volume and duration) that recovery should be realized.
density, myoglobin, and the preferential use of free fatty acids as an energy sub- 0 Periodization: All of the physical abilities are maintained during this week.
strate. It is therefore important to use exercises where the players are constantly There is no aim to improve any particular PA.
moving (e.g., passing drills or tactical exercises where the players are forced • PAs: Maintenance with the emphasis on soccer-specific exercises and mental
to cover long distances). Other exercises include possession games where the and physical recovery
players are given certain tasks, meaning there are few orno breaks. 0 Methods: Continuous and HIIT methods at max 90%.
• Periodization: The emphasis is placed on volume during this week. The PAs of • Training para1neters:
speed and strength are maintained. Strength endurance is trained as well while - volume: 50%
trying to avoid interference with endurance. - intensity: 80%
0 Physical ability: Aerobic capacity - frequency: 65%
• Methods (See chapter 5): Continuous extensive, continuous intensive,
• Training para1neters:
- volume: 100% 17.5 REMARKS
- intensity: 70%
- frequency: 100% 17.5.1 Length oflhe different phases
• Strengtl1: Strength endurance The length of a microcycle can vary in every mesocycle. ln soccer, a microcycle is
often equated to seven days, but this is not always necessary. A three-phase meso-
17.4.2 lntensity phase cycle can last two or five weeks, depending on the number and timing of matches.
0 Objective: The objective of the intensity week is to improve aerobic power, As we have already explained before, a periodized plan should be adapted accor-
repeated sprint ability, and SAQ (speed, agility, quickness). This is done ding to the match schedule.
using High-intensity intermittent training (HIIT). These adaptations include
an improvement in the heart's capacity to pump blood, primarily through 17.5.2 Periodization of speed
increased stroke volume, which occurs because of an increase in end-diastolic Within this periodization model, each ability related to speed, agility and quick-
volume and an increase in left ventricular mass. Subsequently, these adaptati- ness (SAQ) (e.g., repeated sprint ability, speed, agility, etc.) should be trained every
ons result in an increased cardiac output, which, according to the Fick equation, week to avoid detraining.
will increase V0 2max (Stone and Kilding, 2009).
• Periodization: The emphasis is on intensity during this week. The PAs of aerobic Match Recovery Recovery Loading Loading Tapering Tapering Match
fitness, repeated sprint ability, speed, agility, quickness, and acceleration are
trained. G +1 +2 -4 -3 -2 -1 G
0 PAs: Speed, agility, quickness, aerobic power No No Speed Repeated SAQ Short
endurance sprint maximal
• Metlwds: (See chapter 6) Interval, repetition, SAQ RSA
ability sprints
0 Training para111eters: with
- volume: 70$-'b sufficient
- intensity: 90% (1/10)
recovery
- frequency: 85%
• Strength: Speed strength and maximum strength
Tab/e 17. 1: Periodization of speed
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
312
Macrocyc/e: in-season Macrocycle: in-season 1313

Player(s) Players(s) Result Duration


1 - 1 30"

2,3 - 2,3 60"

4.5.6 - 4.5.6 90"

1,2,3,4 - 1,2,3,4 120"

5 - 5 30"

6,1 - 6, 1 60"

1,2,3 - 1,2,3 90"

4,5,6,1 - 4,5,6,1 120"


.. .. .. .. .. .. ..
-
"' ..."' ... "' "' "' "'
2 2 30"
-
"" "" "" "'"" "" """' ""
t- N N N
3,4 3,4 60"

' ' ' '


5,6,1 - 5,6,1 90"
'
<D t-
"' ... t-
.,. "'
<D
2,3,4,5 - 2,3,4,5 120"

"'"" "'"" "" "" "'"" "" "" 6 - 6 30"


~ ~ ~

1,2 - 1,2 60"

3,4,5 - 3,4,5 90"


00
2o
6,1,2,3 - 6,1,2,3 120"
• -
••
e 4 4 30"
~ v .E
o. -
"-B N
B
5,6 5,6 60"
"'e
';; M
00 1,2,3 - 1,2,3 90"
•o V
A
M
"ueo 4,5,6,1 - 4,5,6,1 120"
'E
::> 00 •
o
M
3 - 3 30"

4,5 - 4,5 60"


.. .. .. .. .. .. .. 6,1,2 - 6,1,2 90"
• v .,. "' .,.
"'<D <D "" "'"" .,.""t-
00
•o.
00

~ 3,4,5,6 - 3,4,5,6 120"


"'"" "" "" "'"" "'
~

1"
"-B .Ee
N N

·;;; M M ' ' '


e V
2 A B t- Table 17.3: Example of a competition formal (intensity phase). There are two teams of six players.

"" "'"" "'"' "' "" "' "'"'"'


M N t- t- <D
B Each player is given a number. Games of 1><1 to 4><4. The pfayers with the number 1 play against
~ ~ N ~ ~
each other for 30 seconds, and players 2 and 3 then p/ay 2><2 against pfayers 2 and 3 from lhe
other team for 60 seconds, and so on.
cn 2:' 2:' 2:' 2:' 2:' 2:' 2:'
w w w
Q)

E • ~ 00
>
o
u
"'>uo >"'uo >
o
u
"'ou> "'u>o >
o
u
Tips for organizing small-sided games (SSGs)
Agree on a reward or punishment for the winning or losing team before the
"'"'
00 0

~•o. V
A
~
2o
e
i" i" i" i" i" i" i"
practice. This "\vill provide extra motivation for the players.
"O .E N N N N N N N
Q) o B
"O E "e "e "e "e "e "e "e ° Keep track of the individual scores throughout the season.
~
o " "'B
V
A
"' "' "' "' "' "'"' "' 0 Organize the teams so the competitive environment remains as wide as possi-
:l!
~"' 2"' 2 2"' 2"' 2 2"'
00
ro " M

~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ble. ln the 4v4 games, for example, teams of two players can be made to play
E
cn
e
I'
e e
E .E .Ee .Ee .Ee .Ee with another pair against two new pairs each time. This increases the intensity
~
o
Q)
... .,. .,. ... ... ... ... of the games.
cn ~ e
...w "'w
.•••
o 0 Make sure enough balls are available.
::> .1i ~o
~ N
"'w <D t-
E w 0 Organize pitch sizes with different dimensions and rules. This enables the
"'
~
o
z o E"' E"' E E E "'
E E

,.;
~
"' (!)"' (!)"' (!)"' (!)"' (!)"' (!)"'
(!)
players to work in different training zones and makes it easier to set up diffe-
rent training plans for individual players.
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
314 315
Macrocyc/e: in-season Macrocycle: in-season

17.5.4 Pre-training routines 17.5.8 Use of shooting exercises


Pre-training routines comprise: Shooting exercises are popular among soccer players. Although such drills are fun
o Pre-activation exercises to do, they can produce a local overload within the muscles that are involved. Addi-
o Injury prevention tionally, these shooting exercises are often not used specifically in the context of the
o Core stability game. For example, allowing central defenders, who rarely go forward during a
o Core endurance (dynamic} match, to shoot continuously at the goal is not only pointless; it also increases the
o Core strength (dynamic) local load of the muscles. These shooting exercises often result in exercise-induced
o Dynamic mobility muscle damage (EIMD), and this can lead to strain-type muscle injuries.
o Functional strength A few guidelines:
o Dynamic stretching • No shooting exercises less than 48 hours after a match (recovery phase) or less
o Neuromuscular control than 48 hours (tapering phase) before a match.
• Integrate shooting only if players are not fatigued and are htlly warmed up.
Pre-training routines can be performed
before the start of each training session
and have the additional benefit that the 17.6 INDIVIDUAL PERIODIZATION
players are better prepared for the next Individual periodization involves the individual planning and adjustment of load
training session. These sessions last bet- for each player. For example, older players may get an extra day off or be allo-
ween 20 and 30 minutes and are best wed to skip the afternoon session. Altematively, players may be given a different
dane indoors. role (neutral player or joker) during a game or possession drill. Improving players
and allowing them to reach their maximum genetic potential requires structured
17 .5.5 Flexibility training planning.
Flexibility training is an element of injury prevention. Static stretching is best orga-
nized at the end of a training session. The temperatures of the muscles are still high, 17.6.1 Age
so this is an ideal time to increase flexibility. Passive or active stretching should not The rate at which physiological adaptation occurs is variable (Vollaard et al., 2009)
be used before the start of a training session (see the Chapter 19). and seems to depend on the volume, intensity and frequency of training. Impor-
tantly, the development of physiological capacities seen in elite athletes does not
17.5.6 Freshness sprints occur quickly, and it may take many years of high training loads before peak leveis
The duration of the training session should be reduced by around 50% on the day are reached (Laursen.. 2010). Young soccer players often struggle to cope with the
before a match. Training should last at the most 45-60 minutes in arder to pro- increased training load. Rapid increases in training frequency, and thus training
vide the players with the freshness they need for the match. However, the intensity load (sometimes up to 100%), during the transition from youth to elite football can
should be kept sufficiently high (80%). This is done by playing small-sided games be difficult for young players to process.
for a maximum of two minutes with sufficient recovery and short maximal sprints. The body's ability to recover after training and matches also changes with age. With
increased age, the muscles' ability to repair and adapt is diminished. This could be
17.5.7 Home programs caused by a decrease in muscle capillarization and mitochondrial activity (Du et
Soccer players are individual athletes who play together in a team on match day. al., 2005; Fell and Williams, 2008). Older players may recover more slowly from
Every player is different, and each player needs a different load to make progress. training and matches, so they may need more time between successive sessions.
Training in soccer is too often adapted to the average player, meaning that physi-
cally weaker players are overloaded, while the physically stronger players are 17.6.2 Weight/BMI
subjected to an insufficient load (Hoff et al., 2002). Hence, there has to be a good Players with a higher body weight experience a higher mechanical load on their
balance between tactical sessions, where the players train in a group, and indivi- joints. When changing direction, the load can be five times the body weight (or
dual sessions to improve players. even up to ten times body weight for a vertical jump [Ortega et al., 2010]). This
One of the tools a soccer coach can use to individualize training is the use of home mechanical load is consequently higher for heavier players than it is for lighter
programs. These home programs have many advantages. Players do not lose any ones. One match involves approximately 1,300 changes in activity (Chaouachi et
time, so they have more time to recover and can adjust their training to their family / al., 2012). The mechanical impact on players is therefore higher compared to play-
work/school situation. ln addition.. training can be easily adjusted to a player's ers who are not so heavy in relation to their height. ln this regard, Boume et al.
individual needs. These training sessions can also be checked using HR monitors (2005) reported a decrease of cartilage cell viability \vhen applying impact loading
or GPS <levices. Thus, home programs are ideal for non-professional players, but to an animal k.nee at higher energy and increasing loading repetitions. However
they can also be used for professional players, especially during recovery sessions. it should be highlighted that only limited conclusions can be derived from these
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
316 317
Macrocyc/e: in-season Macrocycle: in-season

reports in regards to the human articular cartilage properties in vivo.(Brüggem~nn, 17.6.7 Playerrole
2011). As díscussed in previous chapters, data from accelerometers in GPS <levices Midfield players, full backs and wingers often experience a higher load during
may be used to quantify the body load placed ?~ p~ayers to allow monitoring to training sessions compared to central defenders or strikers. Wingers and full backs
take place, especially for players more prone to 1n1unes. often have a higher physiological load because of the regular use of cresses in tacti-
cal exercises. ln these exercises, wingers and full backs have to cover more distance
17.6.3 Players returning from injury than other positions in the team. Midfield players on the other hand often experi-
A player who has sustained a harnstring injury, for example~ can skip a trai1?ng· ence a higher mechanical load due to the demands of their position. They cover
session to allow him to work on the functional strength of hts or her hamstnngs shorter distances but make more changes in direction.
and other muscle groups to improve functionality and reduce the reoccurrence of
injuries.
17.7 HOW TO IMPLEMENT INDIVIDUAL PERIODIZATION
17.6.4 Fast and slow players There are many ways to implement individual periodization, so it is therefore
Fast players can often have a higher proportion of fast-n:itch .fibers, while slower necessary to differentiate as much as possible. Exercises must be specific and the-
players frequently have a larger proportion of .sl?w-~itch. fiber.s. Both types of refore directed toward the requirements of a specific position. This means that the
players will therefore respond differently to trammg stimuh. Qu~ck players (e.g., technical, tactical and individual physical periodization of this player should be
strikers, wide players) with less aerobic potential do not endure high loads as well adjusted according to the player's role and characteristics. A professional team
as players who are notas fast (e.g., central players in midfield and defense). with a high number of coaches should therefore ensure they work with the players
as individually and specifically as possible. This approach has proved to be suc-
17.6.5 Players with a history of injury cessful in some studies. Andrzejewski et al. (2010), for example, demonstrated a
A previous injury is an important risk factor for soccer inju1y. (Hãgglund et al., significant impact of the individualization of training loads on the development of
2006). Before the start of the season, it is important to get an ide~ of ea~ play- speed abilities in the examined players.
er's injury history. In soccer, questionnaires have been used at vanous s~ll le~els
to obtain information about the sports and medical histories of players, 1nclud1ng 17.7.1 Adjustments in frequency
previous injuries (Steffen et al., 2008). Training content can then be adapted based Players can skip training sessions or take part in additional training sessions.
on the injury history.
Two examples: . . . 17.7.2 Adjustments in volume/duration
• A player who has suffered a cartilage injury: The number of tmpact tra1n1ng Coaches can individualize training load by varying the duration of training for
(mechanical load) sessions needs to be reduced for this player. individual players. A good example of this is the real-time monitoring of small-si-
• A player \Vith a history of muscle injury (e.g., hamstrings): This player needs ded games. Adjustments in load can be made directly after the small-sided games.
to follow a special program to restore muscle strength and balance.
17.7.3 Adjustments during training sessions
17.6.6 Players with minor physical problems Group training sessions can, and should, be specific. Consider a winger who con-
The literature describes two types of injuries. A player able to train but with redu- stantly has to run along the flank during a tactical exercise in arder to deliver a
ced intensity or volume is classified as an "injured player." These injuri~s are refer- cross. Although the task of this player is specific, coaches do not ahvays consider
red to as "time loss injuries" (TL). ln addition to this, Fuller et al. (2006) introduced the additional training load for that player. Another example is a player taking
the concept of medical attention injuries (MA). These injuries spe.c~fically re.fe: to dozens of comer kicks, leading to increased local fatigue of the leg muscles.
medically diagnosable complaints without a time loss from competition or tra1n1ng.
In this respect, it is different from, and complementary to, the time loss ~':finitio~, 17.7.4 Adjustments during small-sided games
because it will not be recorded as an injury while the player fully partic1pates 1n A coach can schedule small-sided game tournaments in order to assign more or less
team training and competition. A quarter of these injuries eventua.ll~ l~ad to a time load to individual players. Certain players can take part in a greater or fewer short
Joss injury. ln an unpublished study of Helsen et al. (2010), MA 1n1ur1es as apre- games. For example, one player may need to play a series of only eight 4-minute 4
dictor of subsequent injury was investigated. The researchers concluded that ~~re vs. 4 games, while another player performs twelve. You can also choose to vary the
than a quarter (26%) of MA injuries resulted in a TL ínjury withi.n a ye~r. iY!A1niu- pitch dimensions to change the dynamic of the game. For instance certain players
ries should be considered a valuable predictor of reinjury. The1r morutonng and could always play on a bigger pitch rather than take part in SSGs to reduce the
follow-up are key factors within a multidisciplinary injury-prevention approach. amount of mechanically intensive accelerations and decelerations performed.
A specially adapted training schedule can be incorporated into the weekly planto
eliminate a possible maladaptation.
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
318 Macrocycle: in-season Macrocycle: in-season 1319

SUMMARY
Planning during the in-season period is mainly focused on performance stabi-
lization. The weekly program usually comprises four phases in each microcy-
cle: recovery from the last match, loading, tapering, and the match. The aims of
the training week are to maintain the players' fitness (or indeed improve fitness
where possible) while performing technical and tactical drills and ensuring that
the players go into the next match as fresh and as free from fatigue as possi-
ble, as well as being technically and tactically prepared. Each player's training
program should be individualized as much as possible. Technical, tactical and
fitness work periodization of this player should be adjusted according to the
player's role, characteristics, and fitness/fatigue leveis.

Physical Methodical Training Volume lntensity


Abbreviation Repitltions
ability Trainlng Methods (min) (Hfmax) %
Long s!ow 60
LSO 60-100 1
distance
Continuous 1-4 70
ConE 15 - 30
extensive
Continuous
Variab!e
Aerobic principie
endurance CV 30-45 1-3 60-100
endurance (without
method
recoveries)
Fart!ek variable 1-3 60-100
method
Fa 30- 45

Continuous 3-5 75
Conl 8-15
intensive
lnterval method (Medium to intensity, medium to high volumes)

vo2m:;x interval VO)nt 5-8 6-12 85-90


Long interval 90-95
Unt 3-5 5-6
toads
Medium interval 8-15
Mint 1-3 90-95
loads
lnterval Short interval
Anaerobic principie Sint 30-60sec 10-20 90-95
loads
endurance (incomplete
recoveries) Repetition method (High intensity, limited to low to medium volumes)

vo2m:lx repetition V0 2Rep 4 6-12 90-100


Long repetition
LRep 2-3 3-5 95-100
load
Medium repetition MRep 1-2 6-12 95-100
Short repetition
Srep 15-60sec Btot 10 95-100
loads
Repetition
Repeated principie Repeated sprint
sprint (incomp!ete exereises
RSE 3-7s 3-8 -
recoveries) •§ •§ w
e
o
lnterval Various z z ü
Seis of explosive
principie depending
Resistance sport-specific Res 5-15
(against on
movements
resistance) exercises
Repetition
Maximal
principie
Speed
(complete
contrac!ion speed Sp 3-75 10-20 -
method
recoveries)
Table 17.4: Overv1ew of lhe physicaf ab11ities and their abbreviations used ín the following
microcycfes
w
~

Volume phase semi-professional level


;;: ~
" --<
qz
Match day
+1 {Monday) +2 (Tuesday) 4 (Wednesday) -3 Thursday) -2 (Friday) -1 (Saturday) Total o~ V>
'"
{e.g. Sunday) "!:l.-
' V>

Loading Tapering Tapering


~ z
Fatigue Recovery Recovery Loading
managment strategies strategies strategies strategies strategies strategies 9· nô
~
~ n
# training
Frequency (#) 1 1 1 1 sessions: 4
!il '"
o~ "'
# Minutes: 285
Volume (min) 45 100 90 50 min

Average
lntensity (%) 50'% >75o/o 70o/o 75'%
intensity: 67"/o

Repeated sprint Coordination Freshness


SAQ Nane sprints
abi!ity and agility

Strenglh Match
Strength Dumbbell (Sunday)
endurance: # training
Nane endurance I and barbell Preactivation
sessions: 3
Strength/Core/ Core circuit upperbody
Stretch Free

Training Vo21nt, Lolnt, Conl, V02 lnt,


ConE Lolnt, Melnt
methods Melnt, Lolnt

Training forms Cross-country Small sided Possession Short small


running / cyc!ing games 7v7 to games /passing sided games
I aquajogging 4v4 and shooting (max. 2')
f deep water dri!ls I tactical
running drills

Less or more
Individual Free f Home
sma11 sided
periodization work
games

Table 17.6: Volume microcyc/e during in-season (semi-professional levei)

Volume phase amateur level

Match day (e.g.


+1 (Monday) +2 (Tuesday) 4 (Wednesday) -3 Thursday) -2 (Friday) -1 (Saturday) Total
Sunday)

Fatigue Recovery Recovery Loading Loading Tapering Tapering


managment strategies strategies strategies strategies strategies slrategies

# training
Frequency {#) 1 1 1 1
sessions: 3

# Minutes: 220
Volume (min) 45 90 70 20 60 min
Average
lntensity (%) 50'}ó >75°/o 65o/o 85 60"/o
intensity: 67"/o
Repeated sprinl Coordination Freshness
SAQ Nane
ability and agitity sprints

Strength
Match
endurance: #training
None Core circuit (Sunday)
Strength/Core/ sessions: 1
Stretch
Free
Training Vo2lnt, Lolnt, Conl, V02 lnt,
ConE Lolnt Lolnt, Me!nt
methods Melnt, Lolnt

Cross-country Possession
Cross-country ;;:~
running I cyc!ing Small sided games /passing Short small
Training forms I aquajogging games 7v7 lo and shooting
running (5 x 2'
ai 85% with 2'
sided games ~ =i
o z
I deep water 4v4 drills f tactical
rec.)
(max. 2') n rn
running drills "!:l.
' V>
V>
..ra -z
Free I
s· VI
~o
Individual Free I Home Differentiation ~ n
periodization work in intensity and !il n
volume o~ "'
'"
Gray: Possible home program
w
Tabfe 17. 7: Volume microcyc/e during in-season (amateur levei)
....N
w
i::l
lntensity phase elite level
";::q ~z_,
Match
+1 +2 -4AM -4 PM -3AM -3 PM -2 -1 cm
~ V>
day (e.g. Total
(Sunday) (Monday) (Tuesday) {Tuesday) (Wednesday) (Wednesday) (Thursday) (Friday) Q-
"' V>
Saturday)
!l? z
Fatigue Recovery Recovery Loading Loading Loading Loading Tapering Tapering ~·o
management strategies strategies strategies strategies strategies strategies strategies strategies ~ ()

# training
ara n
Q"'
rn
1 2 2 1 1
Frequency (#) sessions: 7
"'
#Minutes:
Volume (min) 45 55 65 55 20 55 40
335
Average
lntensity (o/o) 50°/o 75% >90% 75% 90'% 60°/o 80% intensity:
74%
Long sprint Repeated Coordination Freshness
SAQ None Nane Speed
(80%) sprint ability and agi!ity sprints
Match
Strength (Saturday)
Dumbbell
endurance: Core stability # training
Nane Core circuit and barbei! None Preactivation
Strength/Core/ and flexibility sessions: 4
upperbody
Stretch Free
Vo2Rep,
Trainlng LoRep, Conl, V02 lnt, ConE, Conl, Conl, V021nt, MeRep,
ConE Conl Melnt
methods MeRep, Lolnt Fa, V021nt Lolnt
V02int
Cross-country
Possession Possession
running I Non-impact
games I Small sided games I Tactical dri!ls /
Short small
cyc!ing I training I
Training forms passing and games 3v3 passing and sided games
aquajogging physio!ogical Sei pieces
shooting drills to 1v1 shooting drills (max. 90H)
I deep water / tactical dri!ls / tactical dri!ls
load
running
Free f Less Free I
Individual Free I Home or more Differentiation
periodization work sma!I sided ln intensity
games and volume

Table 17.8: lntensity microcycle during in-season (elite leve/)

lntensity phase semi-professional level

Match day -1 (Saturday)


+1 (Monday) +2 (Tuesday) -4 {Wednesday) -3 Thursday) -2 {Friday) Totaal
(e.g. Sunday)

Fatigue Recovery Recovery Loading Loading Tapering Tapering


managment strategies strategies strategies strategies strategies strategies

#training
Frequency {#) 1 1 1 1 sessions: 4

# Minutes: 215
Volume (min) 45 70 60 40 min

Average
lntensity {%) 50 >90°/o 75% 80%
intensity: 74%

Repeated sprint Coordination Freshness


SAQ None Match
ability and agility sprints
(Sunday)

Strength
Dumbbell
endurance: Free Core circuit and barbell Preactivation
# training
Nane
Strength/Core/ sessions: 3
upperbody
Stretch

Training Vo2Rep, LoRep, Conl, V02 ln!,


ConE MeRep, Melnt

q~~
methods MeRep, V02int Lolnt
_,
Cross-country Possession Q z
running I cycling Small sided games /passing Short small nm
Trainíng forms I aquajogging games 3v3 to and shooting sided games "' V>
"-V>
I deep water 1v1 drills I tactical (max. 90") ..ra -z
running drills :;· Vl
.:, o
a"' n
Less or more
Individual Free I Home ()
small sided
periodization work Qm
games

Tabfe 17.9: lntensity microcyc/e during in~season (semi-professional levei)


"' "'
w
N
w
"'~
lntensity phase amateur levei
;;: :':'
" -l
~
o m
z
Match day {e.g. +2 {Tuesday) -4 (Wednesday) -3 Thursday) -2 (Friday) -1 (Saturday) Totaal ~ V>
+1 (Monday)
Sunday) "~ -
V>

Tapering ~z
Recovery Recovery Loading Loading Tapering
Fatigue
managment strategies strategies strategies strategies strategies strategies 5' ô
~n
Frequency (#) 1 1 1
# training
sessions: 2
"nm
~
o~ "'
# Minutes: 140
Volume (min) 45 80 30 (8 X3')) 60 20 min

Average
lntensity (0/o) 30% >90~\i 90°,~ 80%1 85% intensity: 85o/o

Repeated sprint Coordination Freshness


SAQ None ability and agility sprints

Strenglh Match
(Sunday) # training
endurance: Core circuit
None sessions: 1
Strength/Core/
Stretch
Free

Training Vo2Rep, LoRep, Conl, V02 lnt, MeRep, Melnt


ConE Conl, V021nt
methods MeRep, V02int Lolnt

Cross-country Possession Cross-country


Cross-country games /passing
running I cycling Smal! sided running (8 x 3' running (7 x 1'
Training forms I aquajogging games 3v3 to and shooting at 90%1 with 2'
at 90% with 2' drills / tactical
I deep water 1v1 rec.)
rec.) drills
running
Free I
Individual Free/Home Differentiation
periodization work in intensity and
volume
Gray: Possib!e home program

T.abla 17. 10: Jntensity microcyc!a during in-season (amateur levei)

Unloading phase elite level

Match day
+1 (Sunday) +2 (Monday) -4 AM (Tuesday) -3 PM (Wednesday) -2 (Thursday) -1 (Friday) Total
(e.g. Saturday)

Fatigue Recovery Recovery Loading Tapering Tapering


Tapering strategies
management strategies strategies strategies strategies strategies

Frequency (#) 1 1 1 1 1
# training
sessions: 5

Volume {min) 45 70 70 55 40 # Minutes: 280

Average
lntensity (%1) 50% >80% 70% 70% 75°/o
intensity: 69%

Repeated sprint Coordination and Freshness


SAQ Nane Speed
ability agility sprints
Match
Strength {Saturday)
Dumbbell
endurance: Core stability #training
None and barbell Preactivation
Strength/Core/ and flexibility sessions: 3
Free upperbody
Stretch

Training Vo21nt, Lolnt,


ConE Conl, ConE Lolnt, Melnt
methods Mefnt,

Cross-country
running I cycling Small sided
Possession games
/passing and Tactical drills I
Small sided ~~
Training forms I aquajogging
I deep water
games 3v3 to
1v1
shooting drills I Sei pieces
games {max.
90") an -lzm
n

tactical drills "<: V>


running Q. V>
".. -z
Individua! Free I Home
Free I Less or 5· Ln
more small sided ~o
periodization work
games
Si" nn
o m
Tab/e 17.11: Unloading microcycle during in-season (elite levei)
~ "'
"'"'
"'
""'~
;: :!:'
Unloading Unloading phase semi·professional level " -l
'l z
O m
n V>
Match day -3 Thursday) -2 (Friday} -1 (Saturday) Totaal
+1 (Monday) +2 (Tuesday) -4 (Wednesday} Q-
"' V>
(e.g. Sunday) ~ z
Fatigue Recovery Recovery Loading Loading Tapering Tapering ~· i:S
strategies ~n
strategies strategies
managment strategies strategies strategies
# training
ara nm
Frequency {#) 1 1 1 1 sessions: 4 "" "'
50 40 # Minutes: 205
Volume {min) 45 70
Average
>80°/o 70°/o 75'% intensity: 69%
lntensity (o/o) 50

Repeated sprint Coordination Freshness


SAQ Nane abi!ity and agility sprints
Match
(Sunday)
Strength # training
endurance: Core circuit Preactivatian sessions: 2
Nane Free
Strength/Core/
Stretch

Training Vo2lnt, Lo!nt, Gani, Lalnt, Melnt


ConE Melnt,
methads

Cross-country Passessian
Small sided games /passing Small sided
running I cycling
games 3v3 to and shoating games (max.
Training forms I aquajogging
I deep water 1v1 drills I tactica! 90")
running drills

Less ar more
Individual Free I Home small sided
periodization work games

Tab/e 17.12: Unloading microcyc/e during in-season (semi-professionaf fevef)

Unloading phase amateur levei

Match day
+1 {Monday) +2 (Tuesday) -4 (Wednesday) -3 Thursday) -2 (Friday) -1 (Saturday) Tataa!
(e.g. Sunday)

Fatigue Recovery Recovery Laading Laading Tapering Tapering


managment strategies strategies strategies strategies strategies strategies

Frequency (#) 1 1
# training
sessians: 2

Volume (min) 45 70 20 60 20 # Minutes: 130


min

Average
lntensity (%) 50 >80% 90'% 60% 85 intensity: 70º/o

Repeated sprint Caardinatian Freshness


SAQ Nane
abillty and agility sprints
Match
Strength (Sunday)
endurance: # training
Nane Free Core circuit
Strength/Core/ sessians: 1
Stretch

Training Va21nt, Lalnt,


CanE Melnt, Shlnt Conl, Latnt, Melnt
methods Melnt,

Crass-country
running / cycling
Small side
Cross-cauntry
running (7 x 90"
Passession
games /passing
Cross-cauntry
running {7 x 60"
~~-l
n
Training forms I aquajogging
I deep water games 7v7 - 4v4 at 90% with 90"
and shaating
drills I tactical
ai 90%, with 2 an zm
rec.) min.)
running drills "'
QV>V>
ra -
º" z

Individual Free I Hame


Less ar more 5· tn
small sided ~o
periodizatian work
games ra n
"~ nm
Gray: Possible home program
§ "'
Tabfe 17.13: Unfoading microcycfe during in-season (amateur levei) w
~
~
00

;;: e;
..,Q z--<
Elite level Frequency Volume a
..,
m
V>
.., -
Volume lntensity Unloading
' .____ soo
~
" ' V>
i>z

--- ----
phase phase phase 400 ::. (./1
'1 o
300 "'n
Frequency 7 7 5 "~ n
m
200 o ,,

.1
~
440 380 280
Volume
'"°o
lntensity 67°/o 71% 69% Volume lntensity Unloadinc Volume lntensíty Untoading

Load 29480 26980 19320

lntensity Load
72.% 35000

zº:s;;;:
= :::
71% 3oo<Xl

=1
68%
67%
7 zz 15000
10000
65% 5000
65~' o
Volume lntemlty Unlooding Volume lntemity Unloadinc

Fig. 17.2: Distribution offrequency, volume, intensity and load (elite leve/) ín a mesocyc/e.

Frequency Volume

.
Semi-professlonal levei

~I ~-·
Volume !ntensity Unloading
phase phase phase

Frequency 4 4 4

Volume 285 235 205 o +------~-----------


Volume 1ntensity UnloadTnc Volume lntensity Unlooding

lntensity 67% 69~'o 69%

Lo a d 19095 16215 14145

lntensity Lo ad
25000 ~----------------

::f==:z
68%
67%
Z'
~------
' 20000
15000

'0000
~::::::::":'."'::::::~;;;:;;::::::::::::::::::~::::=
+
-1-------------------
.

sooo +-----------------
66%
Volume lntensity Unloading o+----------------
~ :!:
Volume lntenslty Unloading

.., --<
az
.., m
Q.
" ' V>
.." -z
5· (./1

.. o
Fig. 17.3: Distributíon offrequency, volume, intensity and /oad (semi-professionaf levei) in a mesocyc/e. " n
"n
"'m
g ,,

"'
N

""
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Macrocycle: in-season
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Macrocycle: in-season 1331

"'
~
Q) -o %

.9"'
E _I

õ" 1
>
1 1
1
li l'
~
! M
1 ~ i
2
~
! REFERENCES
1 Alcxandcr, O., Kennedy, M. and Kennedy, J., 19$0. Rugby !cague footboll injuries ovcr lwo cornpctition scasons. Mcd J Aust, 2,
~ ~ ~
§ pp..334-5.
Andrzcjcwski, M., Chmura, J., Str:r:ckzyk, R. and Konanki, J., 2012 lndMdualiz..tion of Physkal Loads and Spccd Abililics of Young
o

"~ ~ § ~ o
" Sncccr Pbycrs in a Six-Month Training Macrocydc. Joumal of Human Kinctks, 22(1), pp.35--U.
Arcicro, l'.J., Smith, O.L. and Callcs-8candon, J., 199B. Effcds of short-tcrm inoctivity on glucose to!eronce, encrgy expcnditure, and

1 blood flow in traincd subjerts. J Appl Physiol, 8-1, pp.1365-1373.


Bongsbo, J., Mohr, M. and Krustrup, P., 2006. Physicol and metabo\k demonds of trainin5 ond motch-ploy in thc elilc footbo!l p!aycr.
J Sports Sd, 21 (7), pp.665-74.
"'~
o
11 Oc\l, G., Syrotuik, D. and Socl>o, T., 1997. Elfocts of strcngth training or concum:nt st~ngth ond endurancc lraining on strcng!h,
tcstostcrone, and cortisol.J Strcngth Cond Rcs, 11 (1), pp.57-M.
Boumc, D., Muldrcw, K. and Hen:og, W., 2005. Carti!a5e ce\l viobi!ity aftcr in vivo impocl loading. JSB XXth Consrcss, p.6S.
"
~ >
H
4
Orilg;;emann, G.P., Brilggcmann, L., Hcinrich, K, Müllcr, M., Nichoff, A., 2011. lliologica! tissue response to impact like mechonical
loading. Footwear Sdence, 3, pp.13-22.
> ~
, ~

10'
-;;; Chaouachi, A., Manzi, V., Chaabli, A., Wong, D.P., Chamo ri, l(. and Castogno, C., 1012. Detcrminants ana!ysis of change-of-direction
u ability in elite soccer players. J Strength Cond Res, 26(10), pp.2667-2676.
e e ~ Dohmen, T., 200$. TI1c influencc of sociol forces: Evidencc from the bchaviot of football refo~es. Economic lnqui!)~46, pp.411-124.
.,."
Q)
~
Q)

.E ~
-~ 2o
'
§
Du, N., Dai, S., 05uri, K., K:tto, Y., Matoumolo, I., Kawase, H. and Matsuob, T., 2005. Hcarl rate rccovcry after exerdsc and neuro!
regulation ofhcart rate variability in 30~10 rcarold km ale marathon runners. Joumal of Sports Sdcncc and Mcdidnc, 4, pp.9-17.
~ •"E
...
Q)
~

1 ro
'4
!
Fell, J. and Wiltfams, A.D., 200$. TI1e clfcd of aging on •kclclal musdc rccovcry from cxcrdsc: possible implic•lions for lhe aging
athlde. Jm1mal of Agingand Physkal Activity, 16(1), pp.97-115 •
Fullcr, C., Ek•lrand,J.,Jungc, A., Andersen, T., llahr, R., Dvorak,J., HOwlund, M., McCrory, P. and Mccuwisse, W., 2006. Conscnsus
li \ -E :&
-~
statcmcnt on injury definitinns and data colkction proccdures in sludics of football ($OCCer) injuries. Dr J Sporls Med, ·lCI, pp.193·201.
Gabbctt, T.J., 2003. lnddcncc of injury in ocmi-profossional rugbf league p!aycrs. Dr 1 Sporls Med, 37, pp.3(i.<l-1.
~
_,, Il Garicano, L., Palocio"·Hucrta, !., and Prcndcrgast, C., 2005. Favnurislism undcr rndal prcssure. Rcview of Eco no mies and S!atislks,
! 5712), pp.20&-216.
1
! \ ~
! 'o
~
'ií
1
Gorkin, M.J., 1962. Ui& loads and basics of oport training. Thcory Pract Phys Cul!, G, pp.4S-9.
Gram, Mathieu, 2010. A méMgc à !rois: Injury prcvention, Medical attention and Time loss injuries. Leuven: K.U.Leuvcn. Facu!tcit
~ Bewegings- en Rcvalidalicwc!enschappen.
E
~
! tt•gglund, M., Waldén, M. and Ekdrand, J., 2006. Prcvious injury as a risk factor for injury in elite football: a prospcctivc studr O\'Cr
h>'O consccutivc seaions. llr J Spnrts Mcd,40, pp.767-772.

l
Hoff, J., Wislofi, U., Engen, L.C., Kcmi, O.J., Hclgcrud J., 2002. Socce,...spcdfk aerobic enduranrn training. llr J Sports Mcd, 36, pp.218-

.;
m
:'.} N
.;
rl
~-
o
~ ~ ~ ~ § "~ 221. Laurscn, P.ll., 2010. Training for intensc e~erdse performance: hi5h-intcnsily orhish·•·o!ume lraining? ScandJ Mcd Sei Sporu,
20(2), pp.l-10.

"e
ro
Nádori, L and Granek, 1., 1959. Thcnrelkal and mcthndologica! basis of lrainins plannin5 wilh •pedal considcrations within a
microcydc. Linrn!n, NE: National Strcnsth and Condilioning Asoodatinn.
Ortcgo, D.n., Uíes, E.C.R. and Berrai de la, F.J., 2010. Anolysis of thc vertical ground reaction forcu ond lcmpot3l factors in lhe fan-
~
O>
e

ro ro
•" o '1'-
o
o
o ]
ding phasc of a countcrmnvemenl jump. Rosa Joumal of Sports Sdcncc and Medicine, 9, pp.282·2ll7.
Pl3tonov, V.N., 1997. Genora! thcory of athlctcs' preporotion in lho Olfmpk sports. Kiev: Olympk Litcralurc.
o~
N
~ ~ a; Pollard, R. and Pollord, G., 2005. Long-tcrm trends in lmmc advantasc ln profcs..,sionol tcam sporls in North Ame rica and England
-E
"""'
(16;fi-2003). Joumal of Sports Sdcnces, 23, pp.337-350.
oi Pollard, R., 2006. Homo advanlago in oncocr. Variations ln its magnitude and a Htcralure ~vlow nf lhe intcr-rclated factors assodatcd
E with its cxistcncc. Joumal of Sporl Bchavior,29, pp.169-189.

õ
~dl
""
e ro
~-ã
N
o
;e '1'-
~
~
o
N
~

~
~
,.;
o
e
1' Pollard, R., 2008. Homc advant•ge in football: A currcnl rcvicw nf an umrnh·cd pu:ulc. Open Spo.U Sdcnces Joumal, 1, pp.12-H.
Rickman, N. and Witt, R., 2008. Fa\'ouritism and finando[ incentives: A natural cxpcrimcnl Economica, 75, pp.269-309.
Sa!tin, B. and Esscn, ll., 1971. Musclc glycogcn, !octate, ATP, and CP in in!crmittcnl onrdsc. ln: n. Pcmov and n. Sa!in, cds. Musclc
mctabolism duringoxordsc. New YoTk: Plcnum Press. pp.419-27.
>
.!1
~
o

o
o- ª
B
',§
Scoppa, V., 2008. Are subjecHve evaluations bfascd by soda! factorn or connections? An cconometric analyois of socccr rdcroe ded·
sion,;. Empirical Economks, JS, pp.123-1·10.
Sporer, ll., 2000. A Propn,cd Mudei for Examinins lhe lntcrfcrcncc Phcnomenon bctwcen Cnncurrcnl Aerobic and Stron5th Training.
~ *ii Spnrts Mcdidne,30(6), pp.385-391.
f;i
E ••
Ew
o ro
o c,'i!. .,o ~
o
e
S!cffcn, K., Mrktcbust, G., Andersen, T.E., Holme, J. and Bahr, !\., 2003. Sclf·Repnrtcd lnjury Hislnry and Lowcr Limb Function as
Risk Factors for Injuries in Fcma!c Youlh Socccr. 111c Ameriein Jouma! af Sports Medicino, 36(4), pp.700·703.

"' ~

;I
~ N ~
~ S!ono, N.M. and Kilding, A.E., 2009. Acrobic conditionins forlcam sport athlclcs. Sports Medicine, 39(8), pp.615·612.
;g-ã N ID ;>: o Tcrjung. R.L., Baldwin, KM. and Windcr, W.W., 1974. Glycogcn rep!ction in different lypc of musclc and li\'cr aftu exhausting
~ cxerdse. Am Phrsiol, 226, pp.1387-95.
Vollaard, N.B., Constantin·Teodosiu, O., Frcdriksson, K, Roopckers, O., Jansson, E., G~cnhaff, P.L, TimmoM,J.A. and Sundbcrg,

2e 6 C.J., 2009. Systcmatic analfsis of adaptations in acrobio capadty and submaximal energy mctabolism provi de~ • uni que iMight into

1
de!erminanls of human aerobk performance.] Appl Physiol, l<ffi, pp.14711-1486.
;;
•oo- •oE ~e Wilson, J.M., Morin, P.J., Rltca, M.R., Wilson, S.M.C., Locnncke, J.P. ~nd Andorson,J.C., 2012. Concum:nt troinln&' A mc1a·an~lyois

~ :g :§ "roo "
~
eumining intcrfcrencc of acrobic and resist~ncc C>Ccroise. J StrongU. Cond Re,;, 26(B), pp.1293-2307. Zatsforskf, V.M., 1995. Scioncc
ond ProcticcofStrength Tr.oining. Champalgn, II.: Human Kindics.
~
"- ~

1
~
;;,,:
+,
1
332 1
flTNESS IN SOCCER
Macrocycle: in-season
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Microcycle: Week planning 1333

MICROCYCLE: WEEK PLANNING


1
Werner Helsen, Jan Van Winckel, Paul Bradle'h Kenny McMillan

18.1 INTRODUCTION
As was already mentioned in the previous chapters, weekly planning in soccer is
entirely focused on preparing for the forthcoming match. At the beginning of each
week, the emphasis is placed on recovering from the fatigue accrued during the
previous match, while at the end of the microcycle, different tapering strategies are
applied in arder to optimally prepare players for their next match. Only training
sessions at least 48 hours prior to, or after, a match can be used to physically over-
load the players.

18.2 STRUCTURE OF A TRAINING SESSION


A training session consists of the following parts:

1. Pre-activation or functional strength training


2. Warmup:
0 cardiovascular stimulus:
- increase oxygen uptake
- increase heart rate
- activate the transportation of oxygen to the active muscles
o dynamic stretching
0 speed: ATP-CP system and activate lactate removal (longer exertion with suf-
ficient rest)
3. Technical/tactical training
4. Small-sided games (SSGs)
5. Progression phase: ln this phase, work is dane for each player individually
based on a strength-weakness analysis; this can be technical (e.g., shooting, pas-
sing, receiving, etc.), tactical (e.g., line defense), mental, and physical (e.g., repe-
ated sprint ability, speed, etc.)
6. Recovery phase:
a cooling down
a restoration of fluid balance
• replenishment of energy substrates
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
334
Microcycle: Week planning Microcycle: Week p/anning 1335

7. Prevention phase: in the first minutes of the exercise (Krustrup et al., 2001). Most of the heat produced
Prevention exercises are done in close collaboration with the sports science and during the first seconds of exercise seems to accumulate in the contracting muscle,
medical staff: but after those first minutes, most of the produced heat is transported to the inner
0 increase active and dynamic flexibility (e.g., static, active, PNF method) core by the blood or lyrnph drainage (Gonzales-Alonso et ai., 2000). An increased
0 eliminate muscular maladaptations body temperature increases the amount of oxygen available in the working tis-
0 restore muscular balances sues, therefore helping oxygen to dissociate from hemoglobin and myoglobin.
• increase proprioception Moreover, an increase in rnuscle temperature reduces the time needed to reach the
0 increase core strength peak torque and the half-relaxation time of an electrically evoked twitch (Davies
0 increase core balance and Young, 1985; Sega! et al., 1986).
0 increase core endurance The rnain aim of a warm up is to prepare the body for optirnal performance.
0 other forms of injury prevention Warm-up strategies are planned by coaching staff who rely on previous trial-and-er-
ror experiences (Bishop, 2003). A typical warrn up in soccer consists of 30-40 minu-
tes of moderate- to high-intensity activities (Mohr et ai., 2004). This contrasts with
18.3 PRE-ACTIVATION research suggesting that 5-10 minutes at 40-70% of V0 2mnx is sufficient to improve
The warm up of all the different muscle groups (pre~activation) can be initiated in performance (Bishop, 2003). However, coaches should take care and ensure that
the dressing room ora specially designated roam, such as a gym or fitness roam if performance itself is not jeopardized by increasing pre-competition fatigue, decre-
available, and it should focus particularly on the deep musculature. It is not always asing blood glucose leveis and muscle glycogen stores, and prematurely elevating
easy to properly warm up these musde groups in cold-weather conditions. The core temperature (Gregson et al., 2005). During the transition from rest to exercise,
deep musculature serves as anchor points for the other muscle groups, so they the body increases the oxygen supply to the muscles through the complex orches-
must be well prepared. tration of pulmonary, cardiovascular and muscular processes.

18.4 WARM UP
According to Bishop (2003), warm-up techniques can be broadly classified into two
major categories: (i) passive \Varm up or (ii) active warm up. Passive warm up
involves raising muscle temperature (Tm) or core temperature (Te) by some exter-
nai means (e.g., hot showers or baths, saunas, diathermy, and heating pads). Active
warm up involves exercise and is likely to induce greater metabolic and cardiovas-
cular changes than passive warm up. Active \varm up is probably the most \videly
used warm-up technique. During the \Varm up, a player prepares various systems
(cardiovascular, neural, pulmonary and muscular) for the lo ad they \Vill be sub-
jected to in the game. An active warm up increases the total oxygen uptake and
guarantees faster lactate elimination during training or a match. A passive warrn
up, such as a hot bath, does not generate these effects. It is insufficient to merely
warm the muscles to the right temperature. All the systems that are linked to oxy-
gen transportation and consumption need to be activated before starting a match
or traÍning session. Burnley et al. (2002) concluded that the V02 response to heavy
exercise can be significantly altered by both sustained high-intensity submaximal
exercise and short-duration sprint exercise. ln contrast, passive warnüng elevated
muscle temperature but had no effect on the V0 2 response.

Referring to the beneficial effects of increased temperatures on muscle extensibility,


two studies by Shellock and Frentice (1985) and Strickler et ai. (1990) both suggest
that a warm-up phase and dynamic stretching should always precede training to
prevent stretching-induced injury. According to Shellock and Prentice (1985), most
of the physiological effects of a warm up are temperature dependent. Mechanical
efficiency of the muscle contraction is close to 20%, while most of the energy produ-
ced (70-80%) is thermal energy. Heat production by contracting muscles increases
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
336 337
1 Microcyc/e: Week planning Microcyc/e: Week planning

18.4.1 Effects ofwarming up heating. Research has demonstrated that a hot and humid climate reduced
A thorough warm-up has the following effects: short-sprint performance (Maxwell et al., 1999) and sprint time in a 90-minute
soccer-specific protocol (Morris et al., 1998, 2000), as well as during an inter-
• The muscle temperature increases (39ºC). mittent-sprint protocol on a bike (Noakes et al., 2001).
• Depending on the intensity and duration of the warm up, short-term perfor- • Muscular performance diminishes through extended static stretching. For
mance is likely to be improved if the recovery interval allows phosphocreatine example, the 20m-sprint performance of rugby union players decreased after
(PCr) stores to be significantly restored (Bishop, 2003). static stretching (Fletcher and Jones, 2004).
• The stroke volume of the heart, and the cardiac output increases.
• Local vasodilation redistributes blood from the viscera to the working mus- 18.4.2 Post-activation potentiation phenomenon
cles. This redistribution of blood flow allows increased nutrient and oxygen Another physiological mechanism that helps clarify the increase in performance
delivery and improves the efficiency of waste product remova!. following a dynamic warm up is a phenomenon called post-activation potentia-
• The rise in temperature triggers enzyme activity, which increases the meta- tion (PAP). Following a short bout of high-intensity exercise (preload stimulus),
bolism in the body, resulting in more energy being available for the muscles. the muscle is in both a fatigued and a potentiated state (referred to as post-activa-
• The quantity of oxygen-rich blood to the muscles increases, improving the tion potentiation). Consequently, subsequent muscle performance depends on the
metabolism in the muscles. balance between these two factors (Kilduff et al., 2007). PAP refers to an increased
o A warm up longer than ten minutes can impair long-term performance by power output following a specific stimulus (Robbings, 2005). For example, follo-
decreasing muscle glycogen content (Gollnick et al., 1973) and/or decreasing wing a bout of dynamic exercise, the muscles show a clear enhancement in the rate
heat-storage capacity (Gregson et al., 2002). of force development, such as jumping height. This period of improvement has
• It is thought that the compliant muscle can be stretched further after warming been demonstrated to last between 5 and 20 minutes (Chiu et al., 2003). It seems
up (Safran et ai., 1988). that the majority of the enhancement is achieved in fast-twitch fibers (French et
o Nerve conduction velocity increases, with the impulses reaching the muscles, ai., 2003). Kilduff et ai. (2007) concluded that muscle performance in rngby (e.g.,
tendons and ligaments faster. power) can be enhanced following a bout of heavy exercise (preload stimulus)
o Improved coordination. in both the upper and the lower body in cases where adequate recovery (of 8-12
• Positive influence on the contraction and reflex times of the muscles. minutes) is given between the preload stimulus and performance. Till and Cooke
• The range of movement of the joints increases. (2009) found no significant group PAP effect on sprint and jump performance after
• The muscles are better prepared for extreme movements with a high range of both dynamic and isometric maximum voluntary contractions (MVCs) when com-
motion. pared with a control "\Varm-up protocol. However, the large variation in individual
• The risk of injury is reduced (Olsen et al., 2005). Grooms et al. (2013) inves- responses (-7.l~b to +8.2%) may suggest that PAP should be considered on an indi-
tigated the effects of a soccer-specific warm-up program (F-MARC 11 +) on vidual basis.
lower extremity injury incidence in male collegiate soccer players. They con-
cluded that the F-MARC 11 + program reduced overall risk and severity of
lower extremity injury when compared with controls in collegiate-aged male
soccer athletes.
• Higher rate of force development and therefore a decrease in time to peak
torque.
• Higher half-relaxation time.

However, a warm up can also have negative effects, such as:

• The glycogen reserves diminish:


The substrates (muscle glycogen, blood glucose) will be used during the warm
up. An excessively long warm up can therefore have a negative influence on
performance. A warm up of 15-20 minutes is sufficient (depending on the out-
side temperature).
• The body temperature could rise to dangerous levels (hyperthermia):
In hot weather conditions, the body temperature can rise too high and affect
performance.Ata body temperature above the critical temperature of approxi-
mately 40ºC, the body will limit performance in an attempt to prevent over-
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
338 339
Microcycle: Week planning Microcycle: Week planning

18.4.3 Structure of lhe warm up 18.5 CENTRAL SECTION


A warm up comprises four elements: cardio-vascular stimulus, dynamic stretching,
speed, and initiation of V0 2 kinetics. 18.5.1 Technical/tactical training.
The first phase of the main section of training comprises technical/ tactical training.
18.4.3.1 Cardiovascular stimu/us (5 minutes) These exercises are kept as match specific as possible, of course, with the empha-
This first phase entails light running with the aim of activating the cardiovascular sis placed on correct execution of the technique. Each exercise must be properly
(heart and blood vessels) and the pulmonary (oxygen) systems for intense exercise. incorporated into the periodization schedule. Both technical/ tactical training and
This phase Iasts five minutes and involves light running only. Light passing and match training have to be adapted accordingly. This can be done by increasing or
kicking exercises can also be used, with the emphasis on warming up rather than reducing field sizes, incorporating additional running exercises, or adjusting the
the speed and precision of the pass. rotation system.

18.4.3.2 Dynamic stretc/Jing (5~10 minutes) 18.5.2 Match-specific exercises


Soccer is played in an open-air environment. When passive stretching is used, the In the second phase of the central section, technical and tactical exercises are carried
muscles cool down again. It is therefore better to use dynamic stretching to prepare out in a match situation. Depending on the schedule for the season, these match
for a match or training session, particularly because soccer is a dynamic sport. Tra- exercises are modified in order to obtain the right intensity of physical exertion.
ditionally, many soccer players prepare for a match by performing extensive static Virtually every exercise can be adapted to the periodization requirements by adjus-
stretching. However, static stretching only increases static flexibility and impairs ting distance, the number of players, or technical changes (e.g., the number of tou~
performance. Although this does have a place in weekly training planning (as part ches on the ball).
of injury-prevention programs), it is better to use it at the end of a training session
(see the following chapter). On a different note, some players still prefer to perform
static stretching before a match, because that is how they have always done it, so 18.6 PROGRESSION PHASE
they need it to mentally prepare before the game. Finally, in the progression phase, ali players work on their weaknesses. Each player
Dynamic stretching is better for preparing the body for the movements needed is given an individual program, which can be technical, physical, mental and/or
during a match, although some players need time to do their own thing. Coa- tactical.
ches will need to change the mind-set of these players by explaining the pros and
cons of static versus dynamic stretching, but this will take some time-you cannot
change it overnight. Mandengue et al. (2005) examined whether athletes •vere able 18. 7 RECOVERY PHASE
to self-select their optimal warn1 up. They concluded that while most athletes could
self-determine the intensity of their optimal \Varm up, some still needed guidance 18.7.1 Cool down
from others. There is a lack of scientific research on the physiological effects of a cool down.
Exercise leads to an increase in body temperature, heart rate and blood pressure.
18.4.3.3 Speed There is also a buildup of waste and byproducts (e.g., lactate, creatine kinase) in the
The improvement of speed, agility and quickness is planned at the end of a warm muscles. Furthermore, hormones, such as adrenaline and endorphins, are released
up. The player is not fatigued yet, guaranteeing the quality of the speed training. into the circulatory system during exercise. If a player stops after training without
A high-intensity exercise is carried out (for more than 15 seconds) after the speed executing a cool down, his leveis of circulating adrenaline and endorphins remain
training, follo•ved by a few minutes of recovery. high. This can cause an aroused state or even a sleepless night. Players may not feel
like doing a cool down after a strenuous game or training session, but they must
18.4.3.4 Starting V02 kinetics understand that it is worth doing for the potential benefits, although scientific evi-
V0 2 kinetics has to be initiated during the warm up. This enables players to start dence is lacking for this.
the match without losing too much energy.
18.7.2 Restoring lhe fluid balance
Most players are already dehydrated before they start the morning training ses-
sion. Fluid lost while sleeping is not restored because players often do not drink
enough liquid with their breakfasts. In a study by Shirreffs and Maughan (1998),
almost one-third (6/17) of the soccer players studied provided a pre-training urine
sample with an osmolality above 900 mosmol/kg. These values may be indicative
of a state of mild hypohydration before training began (Shirreffs and Maughan,
1998). Measuring body weight can give a good indication of hydration. The diffe-
FITNESS IN SOCCER
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER Mícrocycle: Week planning 1341
340 Microcyc/e: Week planning

18.8 PREVENTION PHASE


rence between the typical body weight in the afternoon and the typical weight in
The prevention phase is executed on the pitch or in the fitness room. Players work
the moming indicates how much extra water a player needs to drink. Fluid lost
to restore maladaptations and strengthen or improve deficiencies. For example,
during the training session can be measured in the sarne \vay. It is assumed that a
some players can strengthen their hamstrings (Nordic hamstrings), while others
1 kg loss of body mass is equal to a liter of sweat loss (Shirreffs et al., 2006). Mau-
strengthen their abdominal muscles or do proprioception exercises (balancing exer-
ghan and colleagues (2005) investigated fluid and electrolyte balance in elite male
cises to train the neuromuscular system). The Nordic Hamstring exercise was deve-
soccer players training in a cool environment. The mean sweat loss during training
loped by Mj0lsnes et al. (2004). This exercise, which can be dane on the field, has
was 1.69+0.45 L (a range of 1.06-2.65 L). The mean fluid intake during training was
been demonstrated to increase the eccentric strength in the hamstring muscles of
423+215 ml (a range of 44-951 ml). The results of this study suggest that sweat loss
professional male soccer players.
may be substantial in soccer players training in a cool environment. The resear-
chers speculate that because of adjustments in clothing, and perhaps also in activity
levels, the total sweat and electrolyte losses may be similar to those experienced
when training in hotter climates. Furthermore, fluid intake appears to be lower in SUMMARY
teams training in the cold than it is in teams training in the heat.
A typical training session consists of several different components. Before any
Training in a rain jacket, or other clothing, to deliberately cause weight loss during
technical/tactical training commences, pre-activation drills and warm-up exerci-
a training session is useless and potentially dangerous. This weight loss is simply a
ses prepare the soccer player both physically and mentally for the forthcoming
loss of fluid that should be restored immediately anyway. A player perspires to cool
session. Thereafter, the main component of the training session usually consists
down the body. If this is hindered by wearing a rain jacket, the body temperature
of small-sided game play, technical and tactical drills, and individualized trai-
may rise to a dangerous level.
ning programs. If possible, fitness improvement or maintenance should be a part
of technical and tactical drills. The training session should end with a recovery
18.7.3 Replenishment of energy substrates
phase to help the player prepare for the next training session. If time permits,
There is an increase in the insulin levei immediately after training. This insulin is
individualized injury-prevention programs may then be canied out, as well as
important because it stimulates protein synthesis. Therefore, this is an ideal moment
individualized strength training and flexibility programs. Strength training,
to replenish the energy stores. The body absorbs carbohydrates and proteins more
flexibility training and injury-prevention strategies will be discussed in the fol-
rapidly after physical exertion than in normal circumstances. According to Burke
lowing chapters.
et al. (2006), each soccer player needs to equate daily carbohydrate intake to the
fuel needs of the training and competition schedule. A reasonable target range for
the carbohydrate intake of high-level players in less mobile roles, or teams or indi-
viduals with a less demanding training and competition schedules, is 5-7 g / kg/
day. For mobile players who want to maximize muscle glycogen refueling, such as
in preparation for matches or for recovery during an intensive training schedule,
a target of 7-10 g /kg/ day may be required. While there are some strategies to
promote fuel availability for match play and prolonged training sessions by using
nutritional practices on the day (Williams and Serratosa, 2006), tactics to restore
(after intensive training) or even supercompensate muscle glycogen content must
start 24-48 hours before a game. The importance of "fuelling up" before a match
has been demonstrated in some publications. Balsom et al. (1999) examined the
effect of a high-carbohydrate diet on performance. Participants follo\ved 48 hours
of either a high- or low-carbohydrate diet before short-term (<10 min) and prolon-
ged (>30 min) protocols of intermittent exercise (6s bouts at 30s intervals). Muscle
glycogen concentrations \vere reduced by at least SO~'o in the low-carbohydrate trial
compared with the high-carbohydrate triai, and there was an associated dramatic
reduction in the work performed in both exercise protocols.
FITNESS IN SOCCER
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Microcycle: Week planning Stretching 1343

1
REFERENCES STRETCHING
Jan Van Winckel, Kenny McMillan, Werner Helsen, Paul Bradley, David Tenney
Balsorn, P.D., Wood, K, Oh~oo, P. and Ekb!om, B., 1999b, Carbohydratc intnkcand rnultiplc sprint sports: With ~pccinl rcforcnre lo foot-
ball fo<><=r). lntcmational Jouma! oi Sports Medicine, 20, ppAS-52.
Bi>hop, D., 2003. Wann Up li: Pcrformanre Changcs FollowingActive W,irrn Up and How to Structurc lhe W,um Up. Sports Medicine,
33(7), pp.463-198.
Burke L.M., Loucks, A.D. nnd Broad, N., 2006. Encrgy and carbohydratc for trainingand rccovery. Joumal ofSporls Scicnccs, 24(7),
Bumlc;~ M,, Doust, J.H. and Jones, A.M., 2002. Effects of prior hcavy excrcioc, prior ~print cxcrcisc and pasoiw warmíng on oxygcn
uptak kinctie> during hcavy cxcrcise in humnns. Eur J App! Phpio!., 87(4-5), pp.-12~-32-
Chiu, L.Z., Fry, A.C., Wci5s, L.W., Sdülling. !JK, Brown, L.E. and Smith, S.L., 2003. PostactÍ\.'1ltion potentiation responoc in 1lthletk 1lnd
re<:reation.11ly traincd individuais. Joumal ofStrength and Conditioning Rcsean:h, 17(4), pp.671-577. 19.1 INTRODUCTION
Oavics, CT. and Young, K, 1985. Effect of heating on lhe contrnctile propcrtiesof trkcps ourae and mnximal powcr output duringjum-
ping in e!derly mm. Gcrontology 31(1), pp.1-5. Stretching is a routine part of the training regime of soccer players. However, there
Ekstrand,J., GiUquist,]., Mllller, M.,Obcri;. D. and Liljcdnh~ S.O., 1983. !ncid<.'11roolsocccr injuries and thcirrel1tion lo!ralning .1nd tc.1m
sucrcss. ThcAmerican joumal oi sport5 medicine, 11(2), pp.63-7.
is a great deal of controversy in relation to stretching. For a soccer coach, it is not
Fletcher, l.M. and )oni.-5, n., 200.J, The !lffcct of Different Warm-Up Stretch Protowls on 20-Mctcr Sprint PNformancc in Trained Rugby easy to draw the right conclusions from the often-conflicting information available.
Unlon Playcrs.Joumal ofStl'<.'ngth and Conditioning Rc!lear<:h, 18(4), pp.8S5-S88.
French, D.N., Kracmcr, W,J. and Cookc, CD., 2003. Chungcs in dynamk cxercioe performance following a oequenro of pn:conditioning Despite this problem, stretching has a long tradition of use, and it will likely conti-
ioomctricmusde ncliono:. Joum1ll ofStnmglh nnd Conditionlng Rcocar<:h, 17(4), pp.678-685
Gollnid:, f'.D., Armstrong. R.B. and Scmbrowkh, '\Y.L., 1973. Glyro;;cn dcplction pot1cm in human skclctal muscle fibrcr. 1lÍlor h~avy nue to be a part of training and rehabilitation programs (Covert et al., 2010). Sh·et-
cxerdoc. JApp! Phyoiol, 34(5), pp 615-S
GonOA1loz-Aloru;o, J., Qubtorff, B., KruMrup, P., Bangsbo, ). and SaHin, B., 2000. Hc.1! production in humon e.kckt.1! musclc at thc onnct of ching can be beneficial to some extent, but we must try to emphasize a pragmatic
intcn.<e dynamic excrdoc. J !'hpiol, 52·1, pp.603-615.
Greg,on, W., D,,t1crh.1m, ,\., Dru>t, B. and Cable, N.T., 2002. TI10 cffcct5 of prc-warmini:; on thc n1clobolic and thcrmorci:;ulatory reopon~ perspective and use any scientific evidence to inform our judgments. It seems that
lo prolonscd intcrmittcnt el<crci,;c in modcrntc ambicnt tcmpernturcs. J Sporu Sci, 20(1), pp..19-50.
Grod1inov~ky, A. and Ma gel,)., 1970. Effcct of warminr; upon running pcrformnn«'. Rcs Quart., .\1, pp.116-19.
the parameters of the stretch, such as the time to stretch and the holding duration,
Groomr., DR., P.1lmcr. T,, Ona!c, j.A., Mycr, GD. and Grindr.taff, T., 2013. Sot(er-opcdfic warm·up and lowcr cxt...,mity injury rale:; m are almost as important as the stretching technique used. This chapter provides an
rol!egiale mnlc socccr ployers. J Ath! Trnin, -18(6), pp.782-9.
H.1jog1ou, A, Fll.'",le~ C, DcKofiing, J.J, Ll!Cia ,A. Kcmozck, T.W. and Porca ri, J.P., 2005. Effrct of warm up on cyclc time triai pcrfor· overview of different stretching techniques and sets out how and \vhen these tech-
mance. Mcd Sd Sports llxcn:., 37(9), pp.l&OS-14
Joni.-5, A.M. and Koppo, K., 2005. Eífoct ofTmining on V02 Kincli"' and performance. ln: A.M. Jon..., and D.C. Poolc, cdo. Oxyi;cn Uptakc niques can be used.
Kincticr: inSport, Excrdr.e and Medicine. Abingdon:Taylor and Fmnds. p.JSS.
Kilduff, L.P., Bcv.m, H.R., King5lcy, M.1., Owen, N./., Bennclt, M.A., Dunre, f'.J., Horc, A.M., Maw, j.R. and Cunningham D.],, 2007
Po.olaclivation potcnti,1tion in proícosional rugby plílycr,,;, oplimul rccovcry.J Slrcng~' Cond Rca, 21{·!), pp.113-Ml.
Kruolrup, P., Gonzalcz·Alonoo, J., Qufotorff, B. nnd Bangsbo,]., 2001. Mur.dc hc1lt produclion and an~crobic cnergy tumovcr dunnr,
"'PCíltcd intcnoe dynamic cxcrcisc in humans. j Physiol, 536, pp.9-17·956. 19.2 TYPES OF STRETCHING
Mandcnguc, S.H., Sock, O., Biohop, D., Cfos~, F., nala-Mbalo, P. and Ahmnidi, S., 2005. Are athlctesablc \oocH-.:clcct thciroplima! warm
up? Joumol ofScicncc and Mcdidnc in Sport, 8(1), pp.26-34.
Maughan, RJ., Shir...,ffo, S.M., Mcr<..on, S.j, and Hornwill, C. 1\., 2005. Fluid and elcctrolylc balanre in elite mal e football (socccr) playcro
trainlng in a coo! cnvironmcnt. J SporIB5d., 23(1), pp.73-9, 19.2.1 Ballistic or elastic stretching
Maxwell, N.S., et al., 1999. Jntcrmittcnt runnini;; musde mctabolism in thc hcat and effect of hypohydmtion. Mcd. Sd. Sport~ D<cr.,
231, pp.675-633. Ballistic stretching is a form of stretching performed in a bouncing motion, using
McCutchcon, Lj., Gcor, R.J. and Hinchdiff, K.W., 1999. F.lfccH• of priorcxcrd$C on muodc mctuboli~m during sprint c~cro!'.e in human~
J Appl Phyoiol, 87(5), pp.1914---22. the momenhtm of a moving body or limb to attempt to force it beyond its nor-
Mjolr.ncs, R., Arnason, A., @5thagcn, T., Raa5t1ld, T. and Bahr, R., 200·1. A 10-wcck randomlzcd triai compMing ecccntric vs. ron.:>lnlrfr
hamstring st...,ngth tralning in wcll-trnincd f>Ot:«'r playcrr,. Scandinavian Joum.1! Of Medicine (;; Scicnre ln 5porto, H(S), pp.311-317 mal range of motion. This type of stretching is likely to increase flexibility through
Mohr, M., Krustrup, r., Nybo, L., Nich;cn, J.J. and 61lng~.bo, J., 200-l. Muode tcmpcralure ;md sprint pcrforman«' dunng r.oc.:>lr mal·
cho;"".r-beneficial cffcct oi re-warm-up at half·limc. Scand J Mcd Sd Sports, H, pp.156--162.
a neurological mechanism. It involves fast "bouncing" movements where a dou-
Morris,J.G., Ncvíll, M.ll., Lakomy, H.K.t\., Nichol"'l, C. and Wlllinm5, C., 1993. Effcct of a hotcnvironmcnton pcrformanroof proloni:;d.
intcrmittent, high-intcnsity shultle running.Joumal ofSporW Socn«"o, 16, pp.677·686
ble bounce is performed at the end range of movement. Ballistic stretching should
Oh:.en, O.E., Mykkbust, G, Engcbrctr,cn, L., Holmc, 1. and D.1hr, R. 2005. fac reir"-"-' to preveni lowcr Iimb injuriC'J in youth sports: clustcr only be used by athletes who know their limitations and who are supervised by
randomiscd controllcd triai. BMJ, 330(7459), p.449.
Robbiru:, O.W., 2005. Po5tuctivation potcntiation and it5 practical applicability; a bricf revicw. loumal oi St...,ngth ;md Condilioninz staff. Some shtdies have expressed concerns over the risk of muscle-strain injuries
Re~ean:h, 19(2), pp.453-15S.
Safran, M.n., Scaber,A.V, and Gar...,u, W.E., 1989. \V,1rm-up and muocufar injury P"'vcntion:An updalc. Sports Medicine, S, pp.239-2·1? (Vujnovic and Dawson, 2004), because ballistic stretching could potentially cause
Saltln, B., Gngge, A.P. and Stolwijk,J.A.J., 1968. Musdc tcmpcrnlu"' during oubmaximal c~crdsc in man. 11\ppl Physiol, 25, pp.6;9-6&1
Shdlock, EG. and Prenticc, W.E., 19S5. Warming-up and stretching for improvcd physica! pcrforman<:e and pre\•cntionof sporl5·rdatcd microtrauma to the muscle (Taylor et aL, 2004). These hypotheses are not supported
injuries. Sports Mcd., 2(4), pp.267·78.
Shirreffa, S.M. and Maughan, R.j., 1998. Urine 05molality and ronductlvily as markers of hydrnLion stalu5, Medicine and Scien«' ín
by current scientific literature, but nevertheless, coaches should be careful about
SportG and Excrósc, 30, pp.1598-1602.
Shirreffa, S.M., Sawk.1, M.N. and Stonc, M., 2006. Watcr and cle<:tro!ylc nccd5 for football training and match-p!.1y. /oumal of Sporb
using ballistic stretching after soccer activities that could cause EIMD (e.g., exces-
Scicn«"s, 24(07), pp.699-707. sive eccentric loading, match play, etc.). Soccer players need time to recover from
Stricklcr, T., Ma!onc, T. and GarrctL W.E., 1990. Thc dfocIB of pa,;,;i1•c warming on musdc injury. AmcricanJoumal of Sporw Mcdicin~,
18(2),pp.J.ll-t.15. these activities, and they should not attempt to improve flexibility while in this
Till, K.A. and Cooke C., 2009. Thc effcct.~ of postactivation potcntialion on sprint and jump performance of malc acadcmy socrer players.
J St...,ngth Cond Ri.-5., 23(7), pp.1960-7. state.
Williams, C. and Serra lo,.,, L., 2006. Nutrition on match day. Joumal oi Sports Sdcnet."l, 24, pp.687-697.
FITNESS IN SOCCER
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER
344 Stretching 1345
Stretchíng

19.2.4 Passive stretching or static stretching


19.2.2 Dynamic stretching
This type of stretching is not to be confused with ballistic stretching. Although the Passive stretching is also referre<l to as relaxing or static-passive stretching. ln this
manual of the American College of Sports Medicine puts dynamic stretching on technique, stretching is carried out \Vith the help of another part of the body, a part-
a par with ballistic stretching, there is a distinct difference between the two. ln ner, or an auxiliary aid. ln some books, passive and static stretching are separated.
contrast to ballistic stretching, dynamic stretching steadily develops the move- The difference is that in static stretching, the muscle is moved to a particular posi-
ment sequence, guaranteeing a gradual buildup in the warm-up process. Research tion and held, \Vhile in passive stretching, a particular position is achieved \vith the
shows that dynamic stretching is most effective \vhen the emphasis is on the gre- help of an auxiliary aid or another person. Static stretching increases static flexibi-
atest amplitude or range of motion rather than the greatest movement velocity. lity (Pov.'er et al., 2004) but does not affect dynamic flexibility (Halbertsma et al.,
Dynamic stretching improves flexibility to the sarne degree as static stretching 1996; McNair et al., 2000). Various studies have demonstrated that static stretching
(Beedle and Mann, 2007), although O'Sullivan an<l co-workers postulate that <lyna- has a negative effect on performance (Behm and Kibele, 2007), as \Vell as a nega-
mic stretching is less efficient at increasing static flexibility than static stretching is tive effect on reaction time,
(O'Sullivan et al., 2009). n1ovement time and balance
Dynamic stretching is a useful protocol for increasing flexibility and increasing per- (Behm et al., 2004). Bandy et
formance. Hovvever, it is unclear whether this effect is brought about by the stret- al. (1997) demonstrated that
ching or the warming up associated with it. Regardless, it is advisable to carry out performing static stretching
<lynamic stretching before a match and/ or training session. three times a day did not
induce significantly different
19.2.3 Aclive stretching gains in flexibility \Vhen com-
Active stretching is also referred to as static-active stretching. ln this type of stret- pared to stretching only once
ching, a part of the body is move<l into a particular position using agonist mus- aday.
cle strength. The antagonist is then stretche<l. This increases active flexibility and
strengthens the antagonist at the sarne time. It is consi<lered to have a lower risk
Fig. 19.2:
because players contrai the stretch force with their own strength rather than an
Example of passíve stretchíng.
externai force.

Example: The player stands still and raises A great deal of research has been conducted into the effects of static stretching on
his or her leg si<leways; the abductors (ago- performance. It can generally be said that static stretching prior to a n1atch has no
nists) are then activated, and the adductors effect, or possibly even a negative effect, on performance. T\VO highly cited revie\VS
(antagonists) are stretched (Fig. 19.1). (Behm and Chaouachi, 2011; Kay and Blazevitch, 2012) both suggest there is a dura-
tion effect on the impairments associated
\Vith stretchíng. If more than 60-90s of static
stretching is perforn1ed on a single muscle
group, it seems likely the player \Vill suffer
perforn1ance impairments. Less than 30s of
stretching per muscle group can still result
in deficits, but the research is conflicting
about this, so a player is less Jikely to suffer
deficits \vith short durations of static stret-
ching. It is not yet clear \vhether a \Varm
up after thís static stretching can reduce the
negative effects. Overall, static stretching
should be avoided prior to the start of a
match or training session.
Fig. 19.1: Example of active stretching.

Fig. 19.3: Passive stretchíng.


1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
346 Stretching 1347
Stretching

Example of the PNF n1ethod. The player \Vorks his quadriceps by bending his leg,
after \Vhich the leg is allo\ved to relax for 10 seconds. The muscle is then finally
stretched for 10 seconds.

Fig. 19.4: Stat1c stretcl1ing. The calf musc/es of the rear feg are stretched. The externa! a.id here is
the floor. ln the picture on the /eft, it is maínly t11e deeper calf muscfes lhat are stretched, and m 1/Je
right-hand photo, it is mainly the superficial calf musc/es.
Fíg. 19.6

19.2.5 PNF method (proprioceptive neuromuscular facilitation) 19.3 INCREASING FLEXIBILITY OR PREPARING THE BODY
There are various forros of the PNF method (reversal-hold, contract-relax, hold-re- When using stretching techniques, it is important to know in what context and in
lax, slo\v-reversal-hold). These techniques all consist of the combination of alterna- \vhat \vay these techniques should be used. For example, prolonged static stret-
ting the contraction and relaxation of agonist and antagonist 1nuscles (Shellock and ching is detrimental to performance if applied before a match. Ho\vever, if the tech-
Frentice, 1985; Burke et ai., 2000). PNF methods are complicated stretching tech- nique vvere used in a flexibility session to increase suppleness, it could lead to fewer
niques, and they need experience to be performed. The use of the PNF technique injuries in soccer. Dynamic stretching is optimal for warming up before a soccer
prior to match play or training is still questioned, and although PNF stretching has game. In arder to increase the range of movement, ho\vever, the use of static stret-
been reported to result in an increased range of motion when compared to static ching is preferred (Little and Williams, 2003).
stretching (Magnusson et al., 1996), it remains a questionas to whether this also
involves dynamic flexibility. 19.3.1 Flexibility
ln a large number of sports, flexible muscles are needed to enable optimal perfor-
Example of the PNF mance and prevent injuries. Sports that require flexible muscles include basketball,
method. The player holds volleyball and soccer. These are sports in 1vhich an SSC (stretch-shortening cycle)
his foot \vhile trying to is used. This 1neans that a muscle is first used eccentrically in order to then be used
straighten his leg. The leg is concentrically. A good example of an SSC is a jump in \vhich the knees are first bent
then relaxed for 10 seconds in order to then be able to jutnp higher. Flexible n1uscles are needed in these sports
and finally stretched again to convert the energy stored in the muscle duríng the eccentric action (bending
for another 10 seconds. the knees) into concentríc action (the jump itself). ln a study of Walshe and Wilson
(1997), athletes had to perform a jun1p after they jun1ped from a bench of 80-100
cn1. The results den1onstrate that flexible players jump significantly higher than
less flexible players do. On the other hand, Walshe and Wilson (1997) found that the
most flexible athletes experience more injuries than moderately flexible athletes.
Depending on the action, certain sports need less flexibility than others. Increased
Fig. 19.5: PNF stretching flexibility can even hinder performance in some cases. Sprinters, for example, need
J FITNESS IN SOCCER
348 FITNESS IN SOCCER
Stretching
Stretching 1349
to transfer the SSC very rapidly (vvithin 200ms), soa more taut muscle is better able
to transfer this energy quick1y. When the running distance and the contact time 19.4 USE DURING THE TRAINING WEEK
on the ground is two to three times longer than in sprinting, a n1ore flexible mus-
culo-tendinous unit is needed to store the elastic energy over a longer period and 19.4.1 Warm up before a match ortraining session
return it to the action at the appropriate time. The aim of the warm up is to prepare the body for physical activity. The players
must therefore activate the various systems (i.e., cardiovascular, pulmonary, neu-
To make the situation even more complex, very flexible athletes (hyperlaxity or ral, and inuscular) to ensure they can use these efficiently during the match or trai-
hypermobility) are more prone to sprain-type injuries. ning session. On the other hand, the muscles also have to be prepared for extreme
movements during a match ar training session. This could be a sliding tackle, for
19.3.2 Preparing the body for a match or training example, where the adductors (groin) are stretched to the extreme. For this reason,
The body must be prepared to perform before the start of a match or training session. dynamic stretching is used at the beginning of a training session or match. These
Players therefore have to call on the different systems (i.e., cardiovascular, respira- types of exercises stretch the muscles sufficiently, thus preparing them for extreme
tory, neural, muscular) to ensure they are ready to perform. The body needs time movements. Torres et al. (2008) suggest that dynamic stretching in a warm up is
to fully initiate oxygen uptake (VO, kinetics). In addition, the temperature of the better than static stretching because the movements are specific to sport.
muscles needs to increase by 1-2 deirees. Finally, the muscles also need to be prepa- Examples:
red for extreme movements, such as sh·etching to controla bar in the air. However, • Skipping
coaches should use a different technique in this regard rather than that applied for
0 • Carioca
increasing the flexibility of the inuscles. It is therefore recommended to use dynamic - Knee pull-ups
stretching before the start of a n1atch. This technique increases the ten1perature of -Sidesteps
the muscles and prepares the body for optimal performance ata high level. - Swinging the arms

19.3.3 What techniques do we use and why? 19.4.2 lnjury prevention


There is a great <leal of literature available in scientific journals. Although they Long-term development of flexibility is important for injury prevention, so flexi-
sometimes give conflicting information, we can nevertheless dra\V the follo\ving bility practices must be carried out through the season. Witvrou\v et al. (2003) and
conclusions: Bradley and Portas (2007) also found that hamstring muscle-strain injuries in elite
0 Static stretching may be detrimental to performance. In a study of Gelen, sta- players correlated significantly with lo\V hamstring flexibility in preseason. Wit-
tic stretching before a slalon1 ball dribbling test reduced performance by 8.Sjo vrouw et al. (2003) also reported that the decreased flexibility of the quadriceps
(Gelen, 2010). muscles should be considered an intrinsic risk factor for injury. Screening of flexi-
0 Static stretching increases the flexibilíty of the muscle. bility for players should be conducted during preseason, and flexibility training
0 Brief static stretching (< 30s) is Iess detrimental to performance. Research should be prescribed to players ovith reduced flexibility to lower the risk of deve-
demonstrated that 36" (6 repetitions of 6") of static stretching increases the loping a muscle-strain injury. That said, one must be pragmatic about this and rea-
ROM significantly (Murphy et al., 2010). Another study sho\ved that a minute lize that many other factors contribute to injuries in complex sports like soccer.
of static stretching caused less performance degradation than two or four
minutes of stretching (Young et a1., 2006). 19.4.3 Jmportant stretching guidelines for static stretching
0 The muscle cools down again during static or passive stretching, and the car- ª Never stretch \Vithout first getting the muscles to the right temperature, such
diovascular and respiratory systen1s return to rest status. as by spending a fe\v minutes jogging (a minimum of five minutes).
ª Dynamic stretching either has no detrin1ental effect or improves performance. ª Ensure the correct starting position and correct execution.
0 Intensive dynamic stretching is better than less intensive stretching.
0 Ensure a stable starting position.
0 Static stretching to the POD (i.e., Point Of Discomfort: the point at ovhich the ª Findas many support points as possible.
athlete indicates that the stretching feels uncomfortable) has negative effects ª Stretch the muscle (group) slo\vly.
on strength performance (Behm et al., 2006). Static stretching up to 90 1;~ of ª Stretch until you feel some tension in the muscle (no pain).
POD reduces the adverse effects of static stretching on performance (Manoel • Hold this position for 10-20 seconds.
et al., 2008). • Take care to continue breathing calmly and rhythmically.
Based on existing literature, it is clear that static stretching should not be used ° Concentrate on the muscle being stretched and check the tension.
before the start of a match. Instead, (intensive) dynamic stretching should be used ª Return from the stretching position slo\vly.
to prepare the players. To increase the flexibility of the muscles, it is therefore
0 Repeat each exercise several times.
recommended to incorporate flexibility training after the end of a training session
0 All exercises should be done for both the left and the right side.
or in a specific session.
0 Perform stretching techniques in a sufficiently warm roam.
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Stretching
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Strength trainíng and functional traíning 1351

SUMMARY
Stretching has a long tradition of use in soccer training programs, and this trend
will likely continue in n1odem soccer training. There is some evidence that pro-
longed static stretching before explosive power movements may be counter-pro-
ductive. Therefore, it is advocated that intense dyna1nic stretching should be
preferably performed before a match or training session. ln addition to enhan-
cing performance, the long-term development of flexibility may also be impor-
tant for inju1y-prevention purposes. Physiotherapists should routinely perform
flexibility screening, so that tight, inflexible muscles can be identified and appro-
priate stretching exercises advocated. Static stretching performed after soccer STRENGTH TRAINING AND
training seems the most suitable form of stretching for improving the long~term
flexibility of a soccer player's musculature. FUNCTIONAL TRAINING
Lieven De Veirman, Glen Reed, Pieter Jacobs, Jan Van Winckel

20.1 INTRODUCTION
REfERENCES Strength training has evolved tremendously over the Iast decennia, with a great
<leal of research trying to establish the fundamental principles of strength training.
Alter, M.J., 19%. Scicncc of flexibility Chompalgn, IL: Human Kinclíe5 Pubfü;hero. Speed-strength (power) is often a decisive factor in modern soccer. Concurrently,
llandy, W.D., lrion,J.M and Brigglcr M., 1997. ThcdfoctoftJmcand frcqucm:yofst,1ticst"'lchingonflexibihtyofthe hamstring muodcs
Phy~kal Thcmpy, i7, pp.lO'Xl-1096. the somatotype of soccer players has also changed over the last few decades from
llcedlc, ll.ll, and Mann, C.L, 2007. Acomparison of two m1rm up:; on joint range of motion.J Strcngth Cond Rcs, 21, pp.77ú-i79.
lldun, D.G, llambury, A., C.1lü!I, F, and Powcr, K., 200·1. Eficct of arutc·stalic slrctchmg on forre, balam:e, "'action time, and mo,·cmcnt ectomorphic (e.g., Cruyff, van Basten, Platini) to more mesomorphic athletes (e.g.,
time. Mcd Sci Sports Excrc, 36, pp.1397-1-102.
llchm, D.G., füadbury, E.E., Harncs, A.T., Hoddcr,J.N,, Lconard,A.M. and P,1ddock, N.R., 2006. Flcxibi!ity fonot rcfatcd loslrctch-lndu· Ibrahimovic, Ronaldo, Kompany, Rooney).
ccd deficit> in fon:c or powcr. J Sports Sd Mcd, 5, pp.33-12. ln this chapter, we discuss the physiology of muscle strength and the various
Bchm, D.G. and Kibclc, A, 2007. Effccts of d1ficring in1cnsitics of 5\atic strctchini; on jump performance. Eur J Appl Physiol, 101,
pp.557-594.
llchm, D.G. and dlaouad>~ A., 2011. A rcvicw of thc ac;utc elfrcts of ~latk and dynamicstrctdting on pcrlormanre. Eur / Appl Phydol,
strength training programs.
111(11), pp.2633-2651.
llr.1dlcj; ~ and Portao, M.D., 2007. Thc rc!Jtiunship bctwcen preocaoon rnngc of motion and mu~clc strain injury in elite ,;occcr playcm.
Jouma! of Strcnglh & Conditionlng Rc,;.:,arch, 21(·1), pp. 1155·1159.
Cowo1n, D., Joncs, ll., Tomliru;0n, P., Robin5on, J, and Polly, D., 1988. Thc cpidcmiology of phyoknl training injuries ln US lnfontry
trainc<'S: mcthodology; popufation, and riol: factors. USArmy Rcscarch lrutitutc of Envlronmcntal Medicine Tcchnolog)', NO:T>!-89, 20.2 PHYSIOLOGY OF MUSCLE STRENGTH
CovNt, C.A., A!cxandcr, M.P., Pctronir,, j.j. and D,wi,, D.S., 2010. Comparison of balfütic and slatiç fitrctching on hamstring musdc
lcnr;th u~ing anequal strclchlng dow.] Strength Cond Rc;;, 24(11), pp.300S-3014.
Gclcn, E., 2010. Ac:utc cfforu; of diffcrcnt warm-up mcthods on sprinl, slalom dribb!ing. and pcnalty kick perform1mcc in wcccr playcrs.
/ Strcngth Cond R<'S, 24, pp.950-956.
20.2.1 Muscle fibers
Halbcrtsma, J.P., van llolhuis, A.1. and Gockcn, LN., 1996. Sport strctching: cffcct on p,,,;sivc musclc stifínc~,; in short ham~trings of The human body has different types of muscle fiber. The ratio of these muscle fibers
hcalthy subjcctfi. Archivco of Physicnl Medicine and Rehabilitation 77(7), pp.6SS--692.
Kay, A. and Bla:wvich, T., 2012. Effoct oi ac;ulc staticslreh;hon maximal musdc pcrformnncc: Asystcmatic revicw. Medicine and Sdcncc is certainly not identical in all muscles.
inSports and Excrdsc, 4.\(1), pp.15-1--lM,
Littlc, T. and Williamr., A. 2003. Spcdficity of accelcrntlon, ma~imum specd and agility ln profcwional oom:r playcrs. j Strcngth Comi
Rcs., 19(1), pp.76-11.
Mugnuo>an, S.P., Simonscn, E.B.,Augaard, P., Drhn.'-Poulr.cn, P., McHugh, M.P. and Kjuer, M., 1996. Mcchankal and physica! n.-sponscs
to 5lretching with and wl~lOut prcisomctric rontruclion in human okelclal muodc. Archivcs of Phpical Medicine and Rchabihtation, sport discipline ºlo ST-fibers ºlo FT~fibers
77, pp.373-378.
Manoel, M.E., Hílrris-Ltwe, M.O., Danoff, ).V. nnd Miller, T.A., 200S.Acutccfíccw oi static, drnumh:, and proprio<:eplivc ncuromu"rulílr
facilitation olrctdtingon musdc power in womcn. J Strcnglh Cond Res, 22, pp.1528-153-1. Distance runners 70-75 25-30
/\-kNair, P.J., Dombrooki, E.W., Hcwson, D.J and Stanley, S.N., 2000. Strclching at thc anklc joint: vi>eoclu~ticrcsponsl!S to holdo ílnd con·
tlnuous pa~~ivc motion. Mcdicineand Scicncc inSports and Excrdoe, 33, pp.354·355.
Murphy, j.R., Di Santo, M.C., Alkanani, T. and Bdun, D.G., 2010. Activity ~forc and followingshor! duration st.1tlcstrctd1ini; improves
range of molion vs. a lraditional warm-up. Appl Physiol Nutr Mctab,35, pp.l-12. Swimmers 55-65 35-45
O'Sullivan, K., Murray, E. and Sninsbury, D., 2009. Thccffcd ofwarm-up, otatkiltretching and dyn.1mic stretching on hamstring flcxíbi-
lity in prcviously injured subjL"<:ts. ll!\lC Musc:uloskclct Disord, 10, pp.37-12
Powcr, K., lldun, D., Cahill, F., Carrol!, M. and Young, W. 200<1. An nc:ulc bout of static slrctching: cfíecl5 on foro! and jumping p~rfor· 100 m sprinters 25-30 70-75
mancc. Mcd Sd Sports Exerc, 36, pp.1359-1396.
She!!ock, F.G. (:!'rentice, WX. 1985. W.lrm up and slrctching for lmprovcd physical performance and prcvcnlion of sporl'l-rclatcd inju·
rico. Spls. Mcd., 2, pp.267-278. Taylor, W., Hcller, M., llcrgmann, G. and Duda, G., 200-l. Tíbio-Femoral Loading During Human Ga1t and Weight lifters 45-55 45-55
St,1ir Climbing. Joumul of Orthopacdic R~.,;carch, 22, pp.625-632.
Torre;, E.M., Kracmcr, W,]., Vlngrcn,J.l., Volck, j.S., Hatficld, D.L, Spiering. B.A., Ho, JX, Frupla, M.S., Thomas, G.A., Andcrson, J.M.,
Hakkinen, K. and Maresh, CM., 2008. Eficctsofstrdching on up~rbody muscular performance.] Strcni;th Cond Res, 22, pp.127()..1285.
W"lshc, A.D. and Wilson, G.J., 1997. Thc influcncc of musrulotcndinous stiffnC""..5 on drop jump performance. Can] Appl Phy~iol, 22, Non-athletes 47-53 47-53
pp.117-132.
Witvrouw, E., Dannecls, L., A=lman, ['., D'l·!avc, T. and Cnmbícr, D., 2003. Musdc flcxibilily asa ri~l:factor fordcvclopingmusde lnju·
rics in mate profo,;:;ional oocccr playcrs: A proopective study. Amcrican Joum.11 of Sporls Medicine, 31{1), pp.41-46. Soccer players 40-55 45-60
Young. W., Clothier, P., Otago, l., Bruce, L., and liddcl!, D. 200.1. Acutcdicctsofstaticstrctdting on hip flexor and quaciriCl.'psflcxibility,
rangcof motion and foot ~pecd ln k.kkinga wccer.J Sei Mcd Sporl, 7(1), pp.23-31.
Young, W., Elias, G. and Powcr, )., 2006. Eficcls of static stretdting volume and inlcnsity on plantar flcxorcxp!csivc force production und
range of motion. / Sport Mcd Phys Fitncss, 46, pp.403-\11. Table 20. 1: Muscfe fiber composition in different sporls.
FACULDAD~ OE DESPORT01
DA UNIVERSIDADE DO PORTO
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
352
1
Strength training and functional training Strength training and functional training 1353

Muscle fibers can be generally classified in hvo ways. On the one hand, they can be 20.2.3 Stretch-shortening cycle
classified based on the mATPase, but they can also be classified based on the myo- The strength of a muscle increases (by 15%.) if it is pre-stretched (Cavagna and Cit-
sin heavy chain (MyHC) isoform identification. Based on the activity of myosine tero, 1974; Bobbert et al., 1996, Bobbert and Casius, 2005). This can be seen •vhen
ATPase, muscle fibers are classified as slo•v oxidative (or type I fibers), fast glycoly- jun1ping, for example, in a counter-movement jump (CMJ) where the muscles are
tic (or type Ilb fibers), and fast oxidative (or type Ila fibers). first extended (bending the knees) and then stretched again (knees straightened).
Myosin, more specifically the MyHC, is composed of three different forms or iso- If a muscle isn't pre-stretched, such as in a squat ju1np (SJ), the movement is n1ore
forms. Based on the identification of the MyHC isoforms present in the n1uscle strength based.
fibers, the MyHC forms (MyHC !, MyHC IIA, and MyHC IIX [often referred to as
IIB in older literature}) can be identified. However, there are muscle fibers in •vhich
more than one form of MyHC occurs, and these hybrids contain hvo different
MyHC forn1s in different proportions. Based on MyHC, •ve can distinguish six dif-

l
ferent muscle fibers in a continuum from slow to fast: I, IC, IIC, IIA, Ilax and IIX.

20.2.2 Muscle architecture


Muscle strength is dependent on the cross-sectional surface area of a muscle. When
muscle strength is expressed in strength per cm2, it does not differ all that much a d !
bet\veen untrained athletes and those who have undergone extensive strength trai-
ning. It an1ounts to around 6.3 kg/ cm2 in both cases. The difference in strength can
" a J g

Fig. 20.2: Difference between a CMJ and SJ. An SJ starts in an afready loaded position, and there
"
be predominantly attributed to a larger cross-sectional surface area. is no stretch-shortening ability to provide power.

20.3 STRENGTH TRAINING ANO THE NERVOUS SYSTEM


It ís often wrongly believed that muscular adaptations from training take place
Fusõform Pennate solely within the 1nuscle itself. Ho•veve1~ strength is generated by muscles that are,
in turn, governed by the central nervous system. The central nervous system deci-
des ho•v many n1uscle units are recruited and whether synergist 1nuscles might
be involved. It can also disable the antagonists or reduce their effects. The central
nervous system thus activates, synergizes and inhibits the n1uscles responsible for
a moven1ent. Short stimulations of a few milliseconds provide for subdued move-
ment, while constant stin1ulation of the muscles can facílitate longer movement.

Strength
---
Fig. 20, 1: Comparison of lhe surface are a of lhe actin and myosin fi/aments The sum of the actin
and myosin fi/aments, the proteins responsibfe for the contraction of a musc/e fiber, is almost
double for a pennate musc/e compared with a fusiform muscle.

Hypertrophy
Muscle strength also depends on the architecture of the muscle fibers. This is the
arrangement of muscle fibers, and it determines a muscle's mechanical function.
Several different n1uscle architectures are described in the scientific literature, such
Neural
as triangular (m. pectoralis n1ajor), (uni)pennate (m. semimembranosus) and fusi-
form (n1. sartorius). Force production and gearing vary depending on the different
geometries of the muscle (Moreau et al., 2010). ln the rectus femoris (part of the
quadriceps) and the gastrocnenüus muscle (part of the calf)-both of which are
unipennate, and bipennate muscles respectively-the muscle fibers have a feather-
Time
like structure that aln1ost doubles the muscular strength.
Fig. 20.3: Adaptations through strength training: lnfluence of training on strength, hypertrophy and
neural adaptation.
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
354 Strength trainíng and functional traíníng 1355
Strength training and functional training

Results will be achieved quickly at the start of the training program. It is there- Four types of strength can be distinguished:
fore also in this period that new reference values need to be determined at regular maximal strength: The capacity of a muscle or muscle group to execute maxi-
intervals in arder to fine tune the strength training program. Strength training also mum strength against a resistance in one contraction
rnakes the muscles thicker (hypertrophy) over the course of time because of more explosive strength (power): The capacity of a muscle to overcome a relatively
sarcomeres coming together. high resistance as quickly as possible (e.g., ln the first phase of a sprint, the
The nervous system not only provides for the movement itself; it can also learn quadriceps need to use explosive strength to start the sprint.)
to engage motor units faster during a particular movement. Finally, the nervous strength endurance: The capacity of a muscle or muscle group to exert maxi-
system ensures maximum efficiency during a particular movement. It activates the mum strength over a certain period (e.g., consider running, where the muscles
right motor units and makes them respond at just the right moment. of the body perform one and the sarne action)
The good news is that these activities performed by the central nervous system can speed strength: The capacity of a muscle to overcome a relatively small
be trained, but the training of isolated movements only teaches the nervous system resistance as quickly as possible
to perform the movement in question at the sarne angle and at the sarne speed.
For this reason, muscles need to be trained in a natural movement pattern during These parameters can be easily interpreted via the Force-Velocity curve (Seen in
training sessions. To increase kicking speed, for example, it would be insufficient Figure 20.4).
to simply train the strength of the quadriceps muscle. Although the strength of the
quadriceps may \vell increase, it will not result in greater kicking speed, because
the movement was not trained in an synergized way where all the muscles (e.g., IBench press Bencll press throw iPush·up c!ops Seoted medicine boll

quadriceps, hamstrings, etc.) produce the movement together.


'-----!· ! throws
lSquat ISqu<it sn11tch (l.e., bar stilrts 1Powcr snatcll from hang (l.c., bar IBox Jumps
~rom tllc floor and cotch takcn 1st11rts from abovc the knees ilnd
However, some strength exercises do provide a crossover to sporting activities. i
1indccp squilt pos1tion) ic;•itcll takcn in 1/4 squot position)
Many authors (Balsom et ai., 1992; Wisloff, Helgerud and Hoff, 1998; Hoff, Berdahl
"S~"-º"~"7'_'_'"-'"-'-'-"C~!'~º-"-º"-"------+iP_o_w_oc_'_''-º"_fro_m_h'_"~º-___.;!_Boun.d !_"9____~
and Barten, 2001; Hoff, Gran and Helgerud, 2002; Wisloff et al., 2004; Deane et al., IShou!dcr prcss Push press iSplit Jerk 0
wheelbarrow
1
2005; Stone et aL, 2006) have found evidence of increased strength levels correlating
to improved performance parameters. Tab/e 20.2: Exercise exampfes ofthe force-velocity curve, taken from Turner (2009).

20.4 TYPES OF STRENGTH 20.5 TYPES OF STRENGTH TRAINING


These four types of strength can be used in different strength training sessions,
with each having a different objective:
general strength training: These are the normal weight-training exercises that
Maximal strength strengthen the muscles and connective tissues.
specific or functional strength training: This type of strength training is as
close as possible to the biomechanical requirements of the activity.
Strength-speed preventive strength training: This type of strength training places an addi-
tional load on particular muscle groups in order to reduce the risk of injury.
Power

20.6 PLYOMETRICS
Speed-strength Plyometrics is a special form of strength training. Plyometrics has its roots in the
former Eastern Bloc, where it was known as shock training. The term "plyometric"
comes from Latin, with the words "ply" representing progress and "metric" sig-
nifying a measuring rod.
Plyometrics is a training form that uses fast, explosive exercises to improve power·
output and the neural (nerve) activation of the muscles. Plyometrics is based on the
Velocity physiological phenomenon of the stretch-shortening cycle (SSC), which, as mentio-
ned above, is based on the principie that when a muscle stretches quickly and then
Fig. 20.4: The Force-Ve/ocity CuNe, which highfights lhe difference between the different training contracts, the power the muscle can produce increases. The receptors Iocated in a
modalities muscle respond to the information that a muscle is getting longer. ln the eccentric
phase, the muscle stretches, and the elastic energy is stored in the "series elastic
FITNESS IN SOCCER
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER Strengtl1 training and functional training 1357
356 Strength training and functional training

The quantification of plyometric exercise has recently been assessed via the measure
component" (SEC) and the muscle spindles become activated. The amortization of the reactive strength índex (RSI). The RSI is derived from the height jumped in
phase is the time behveen the eccentric and concentric motions, and during this a depth jump and the time spent on the ground developing the forces required
phase, the type la afferent nerves synapse with the alpha motor neurons. These for the jump (McClymont, 2008). A low RSI score essentially means an individual
alpha n1otor neurons then transmit signals to the agonist muscle group. Once the can quickly change behveen an eccentric and concentric contraction (Flanagan and
amortization phase is co1nplete, the concentric action occurs, which is the shor- Comyns, 2008). An athlete with a good SSC ability \vill be able to tolerate a higher
tening of the agonist muscle fibers. This causes the elastic energy to be released load in the forro of a higher drop jump.
from the SEC while the alpha motor neurons stimulate the agonist muscle group.
Wilson, Elliot and Wood (1991) found that the SSC had a half-life of 0.85 seconds
and that a contact time of over 1 second dissipated the effect of the SSC by over
55%. This finding is further supported by Cronin, McNair and Marshall (2002), Jump
who found that the SSC has to be utilized within 0.2 seconds to prevent the effect
Height (m)
i
Reactive
from being lost. This is \vhy a short amortization phase is essential.
Strength ~
The mechanical model for musclotendínous behavior has a contractile element ln dex Ground
(CE), which exerts active force during shortening; a series elastic component (SEC), Contact
which serves to store the energy and later release it; and finally a parallel elastic Time (s)
component (PEC), \Vhich stores the elastic energy in parallel to the contractile com-
ponent of the muscle (Bosco et al., 1982).
Fig. 20. 6: Formula for ca/culating the RSI. An RSI can be increased by increasing jump height andl
or decreasing contact time
PE

(((((y(l' FORCE
Flanningan and Comyns (2008), proposed that strength and conditioning coa-
ches can determine the optimu1n height for depth-jump activity by using RSI
over a range of jump heights (e.g., 15, 30, 45cm). If the RSI is either maintained or
improved by increasing depth-jump drop height, then it can be assumed that the
individual's reactive strength capabilities are sufficient for that jump height. If the
RSI decreases ata certain drop height, it i;vill be beyond the fast SSC threshold, and
CE this may indicate a heightened risk of injury.
Flanagan and Comyns (2008) designed a four-phase model for the progression
1 of fast SSC exercise. A progressive program is required to ensure all movements

~ are performed using a correct technique because of the fatiguing and high-impact
Fig. 20.5: Hilfs (1938) three-component model highfighting the interaction between Contractile (CE),
Paraflel (PEC) and Series efastic components (SEC). nature of the exercise. The reader is advised to read Flanagan and Comyns (2008)

Schmidtbleicher (1994) divided the SSC into t\vo types: short and long SSC. Short
~ for more inforn1ation on the breakdo\vn of each phase.

SSC includes a ground contact time (GCT) of <250ms, involves small angles, and
is represented by exercises such as the drop jump or sprinting. A longer GCT 1
(>250ms) represents long SSC, where greater body angles are seen, such as is evi-
dent in exercises like jump shots. "Focuson !anding •Anklejumps& • Fixed jump height • Shortground contact
There is plenty of evidence to support the use of plyon1etrics to increase perfor- mechanicsduring skippins "Emphasis on short time & maximize jump
jumps • Emphasis on short groundcontact& height
mance characteristics like running economy, sprint speed, and jump height, to •Quictlandings ground contact-jump zome dcgrcc of jump • ''Jump fost,jump high"
nan1e but a few (Myer et al., 2006; Potteiger et al., 1999; Rimmer and Sleivert, 2000; •Minimal f!e;iion ilt height unimportant hcight • RSl uscd a5 fccdb;;ck
knces& hip.s • Legs like "stlff springs" • CT use d as fccdback too!
Spurs, Murphy and Watsford, 2003; Turne1~ Ü\vings and Schwane, 2003, Paavolai- • "Freezew on ground • ~stay on bal!s of foet" tool • RSI u~cd to optimize
nen et al., 1999; Vossen et al., 2000). Nevertheless, plyometrics is not applied that contact • Hurdlc hcight can be dropping hcight & to
increased when CT is monitor p!yometric
often. This is not only due to a Jack of knowledge but also to the fact that plyome- indicativo oi fost SSC pnformance
tric exerdses need to be prescribed wíth the necessary scientific background. The
normal method is to vvork \vith the body i;veight, \vhich means that n1ore than 70
kg of i;veight is used as the load for an adult man. Correct execution and the right Fig. 20. 7: Ffanagan and Comyns (2008) four-phase model for developing fast SSC properties.
feedback are therefore very important.
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
358 Strength training and functional training 359
Strength training and functional training

20.7 SETTING UP GENERAL STRENGTH TRAINING PROGRAMS Complex Training: This alternates biomechanically similar high-load
weight-training exercise \Vith plyo1netric exercise, set for set, in the sarne 1vor-
20.7.1 Determining the maximum kout (Ebben, 2002). This creates a post-activation potentiation of the n1uscle
The measuring of 1 RM (repetition ma:ximum) is in1portant for deternüning the and allo\VS the use of 1nultiple training types.
nurnber of repetitions. It is the •veight that e<1n be repeated just once. iviake sure the Exmnplc: Five sets of 3-5 repetitions at sos;1 of 1 RNI follo\ved by five sets of 3-5
player can perform the exercise \Vith proper technique \Vhen measuring l RlvI. If counter-move1nent jt1111ps. Rest is nu1ch higher dueto the nnture of co1nplex
the player sho\VS ínsufficient training experience, a 3-5 Ri\tl measuring can be used training.
and 1 RM can be "calcuh1ted." Set out belo•v is a description of ho\v the 1 RM value
co.n be detern1ined: Cluster Training: This con1prises an intra-rep rest of anv\vhere bet\vcen 15-30
s VV<1rm up by performing 5-10 repetitions at around 40';~1. seconds. There are generally hvo types of cluster-trJ.i.ning n1ethodology: 1)
o Rest for 1-2 ITlinutes. undulating, \vhere the resistance is increased in il typic<il pyra1nid fashion
o Stretch the inuscle group. (Haff et ai., 2003) and 2) ascending, \vhere the n~sistance is increased after each
Carry out 3-5 repetitions at 70~(1. successive repetition.
0 Try the \Yeight you think you \Vill be able to repeat once. Exm11plc: One to three sets of lüxl repetitions at 85'';, of 1 Ri\1 \Vith 15 seconds
"' \.-Vait for 3 1ninutes. rest bet\\'een each rep (i.e., 1 repetition con1pleted 10 titnes \'dth 15 seconds
Try again \Vith n1ore \Veight if it \vas too easy or less if the \Veight felt like too rest bet\veen repetitions).
n1uch.
20.7.3 Effects
20. 7 .2 Organizational forms of strength training Single versus multiple sets:
Equal load and repetition: This forn1 is ideal for getting used to the various The greatest training effect is achieved in the first set of repetitions. Although
exercises. It is also used to realize a specific objective. For exan1ple, the training the follovving sets also generate an additional effect, this is far less than in the
of speed-strength can be achieved \Vith a constantly high nun1ber of repetiti- first set. If there is not n1uch time available, it can be beneficial to do justa sin~
ons at low resistance. This organizational form should be used to get the play- gle set of each exercise.
ers used to strength training. Frequency (nu1nber of training sessions per \Veek):
Example: Three sets of eight repetitions at 70% of 1 RM. Recent research shows that hvo or three strength workouts per \Veek are ideal.
Further training sessions do not provide for n1uch further improven1ent in
Equal load and varying repetition: This forn1 is used to mix speed-strength performance. Different forms of strength training can be organized, of course,
and explosive strength. The load is set at 60-70%, with the number of repetiti- enabling the frequency to be increased.
ons varying behveen 6 and 15. Number of repetitions:
Exmnple: One set of eight repetitions plus one set of 12 repetitions plus one set Three to five repetitions are best for devolving strength biomotors (Turner,
of eight repetitions at 65 % of 1 RM. 2009).
Intensity:
Equal repetitions and varying load: The objective of this form is to familiarize lt is best to keep the intensity of training between 85-lOOrb of 1 RM. This inten-
the n1uscle with different types of loads. sity range will generate the greatest effect.
Example: Three sets of ten repetitions at 60, 70, and 80% of 1 RM.

High pyramid: This form \Vill improve maximal and explosive strength. The
number of repetitions is lo\v, but the load is high.
Exmnple: Seven sets: Eight repetitions at 80% of 1 fü\i[, six repetitions at 85S6,
four repetitions at 901b, one repetition at 100'.,'b, four repetitions at 90'.,'b, and síx
repetítions at 85t,:d.

Lovv pyramid: This form is used to train muscle endurance as well as speed-
strength. The Ioad is lo\ver, but the number of repetitions is higher.
Example: Seven sets: 20 repetitions at 5056 of 1 RM, 15 repetitions at 60~6, ten
repetitions at 70;;'b, six repetitions at 80%, ten repetitions at 70'.,'i;, 15 repetitions
at 60::~, and 20 repetitions at 50'.,'~.
360
1
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Strength training and functional traíning
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Strength training and functional training 1361
20.8 GENERAL STRENGTH TRAINING EXERCISES 0 Muscles: Quadriceps, Harnstrings, Glutes
We give a number of examples of general strength training exercises belo\v. Toward o Execution: Stand with feet in a staggered stance. The ideais to then lower the
the end of this section, we \vill discuss other training modalities (e.g., stability ball, body, keeping your back straight so the back leg is bent.-Continue the descent
TRX, medicine ball, etc.). until the knee is just above the floor and then drive backup. If working with
wornen, you should ensure the Q angle is at a minimum. This can also be
./ Bent-over Row dane with the rear foot elevated .
o M11scles: Trapezius, Rhombiods, Latisimus Dorsi, Teres Major, Teres Minar,
Deltoid (Posterior), Biceps Brachii ../ One-Iegged squat
o Executíon: Player stands in an athletic stance, bending the torso to an angle of The player positions himself in a similar position
approximately 45 degrees. Keeping the back straight, the player "rows" the to the goblet squat, but in this case, one foot is in
bar to his chest \vith an overhand grip. the air, placing all the movement on the standing
leg. Ensuring the sarne coaching points noted
above (i.e., chest up and out, core engaged, weight
coming through heel, back straight), we squat
down as low as possible before requiring an ascent
to finish the movement. Players can in turn perfect
this by adding in load or doing it from a bench to
get greater depth.

Fig. 20.11: One-/egged squat

../ One-Iegged hopping on the spot


This uses the sarne basic position as the one-legged squat. The player hops quickly
A B on his left leg at a rate of three jun1ps per second for 40 seconds. The right foot
remains in the sarne position and the hips are fixed. The player ensures that he
Fig. 20.8: A) Start Position of the Bent~Over Row: Back slays ffat, not rounded, so lumbar spine lands on the mid-foot. The sarne procedure is then repeated with the right leg.
stays strong. B) Finish position: Efbows tuclred in, and bar being pul/ed into chest.

../ One-Iegged squat lvith a lateral hop


v' Split Squat This also uses the sarne starting position as the one-legged squat. The player bends
his right knee at an angle of 90° and hops on his left leg lOcrn to the outside and
then back to the center. The player then hops laterally and returns to the center.

Fig. 20.9: Split Squat Fig. 20. 1O: Rear Foot Elevated Split Squat Fig. 20.12: Shou/der rehabilitation circuit- W, T and Y.
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
362 Strength training and functional training 363
Strength training and functional training

./ Single-Arm, Single-Leg, Straight-Leg Deadlifts.


0 Muscles: Hamstrings (Semitendinouis,
Semimembranouis and Bicep Femoris).
Gluteus Maximus, Glutes Medius, Erector
Spinea.
• Execution: Just put one foot in a TRX set
to approximately knee height, so the leg
is bent at around 90 degrees. Any higher
Fig. 20. 13: P/ayer ho/ds a pfank posilion while rolfing the may be uncomfortable. From there, hinge
bali out in front of the body, keeping the hips, back and head at the hips and reach the leg in the TRX
inline. By rolling the bali away, it p!aces stress on the core.
straight back behind you, making sure to
keep a flat back.

Fig. 20. 15: Single-Leg, Single-Arm Deadlift.


Dumbbef/ is held in the opposite arm to the Jeg.
During descent, push the leg in the suspension kit away
while maintaining a flat back.

./ Single-Leg Squat (Pistol Squat).


• Muscles: Hamstrings (Semitendinouis,
Semimembranouis and Bicep Femoris),
Fig. 20. 14: Stir the Gluteus Maximus, Glutes Medius, Qua-
Pot: The pfayer driceps (Vastus Lateralisal, Vastis mee-
ho!ds simifar position
as above, but this
diatialis, Vastus intermediasis & rectus
time he ro/ls the bal/ femoris).
around in a circle 0 Execution: Stand on one leg. Slowly lower
using the forearms,
p/acing stress on the
yourself down-keeping your back flat,
obliques. chest up and proud, and core engaged.
Ensure the weight is moving onto the heel
as the descent continues. As you reach the
bottom, drive up using the heel and hips
20.9 TRX/SUSPENSION TRAINING. (but not the back) to starting position.
Many clubs now also incorporate suspension training into their strength program-
ming for players, and this adds a great <leal of variety to a program. The advantage Fig. 20. 16: Pistol Squat

of the TRX is that it is compatible with most places (most come with a doar hinge),
so even when travelling, strength training can still be completed. It allows you to
train the entire body, and you can combine movements for greater complexity (e.g., ./ Chest flies
train in all planes of motion). When using a suspension training system, it is impor- 0 Muscles: pectoralis major, deltoi-
tant to remember the following: deus, triceps brachii, anconeus
o Ensure the suspension trainer is used under supervision at all times in order o Execution: Start off in the position
to guarantee correct execution. above, but instead of lowering
• It is imperative that the body stays in line (e.g., not breaking at the hips and yourself into a press-up position,
the back is not hollow). the arms come out to the side,
o The head should always be kept in a neutral position. forcing you to lower down. The
• Vary the angle of the trainer, because the steeper the angle is, the easier the movement is similar to a pec fly.
movement will be.
Some examples of exercises using the TRX/suspension trainer are highlighted
Fig. 20. 17: Pec Fly
below:
FITNESS IN SOCCER
364
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER Strength training and functional training 1365
Strength training and functional training

./ Behind-the-head throw ./ Chest press


./ Leg Raises ./ Plank
0 Muscles: Rectus Abdominis, Ten- 0 Muscles: Transverse Abdominus,
sor Fascia Latae, Obliqus exter- rectus abdominus and erector
nus abdominis, rectus femoris spinae.
o Execution: Holding yourself up o Execution: This is an isometric
\vith elbows soft (not locked exercise that requires you to hold
out), keep your posture upright, a position (bridge) between your
inhale, and bring your knees to forearms and toes. Ensure that
your chest. your hips, back and head stay in
line, drawing the abdomen in and
contracting the glutes as well.

Fig. 20.21: Medicine baff behind-head throw: Fig. 20.23: Chest Press: This can be done
The bali is thrown behind the head backwards simpfy in an athletic position or add a jump
or up into the air. Once more, ensure that before throwing. Again ensure extensions of the

1 tripie extensions ofthe ankfe, knee and hip are


prominent throughout the movement.
ankles, knees and hips.

./ Rotation throws ./ Back Twist Throw

Fig. 20.18: Leg Raises Fig. 20.19: Pfank

20.1 O MEDICINE BALL ./ Medicine Ball Slam


The medicine ball can be incorporated
into training to help develop the for-
ce-velocity curve. Medicine balls are a
great tool in helping to develop explo-
sive power and rotational strength, and
they add variation to programs. You
can use different weights of medicine
balls for repetition ranges, different
sizes (e.g., Slam Balls, etc.) and different
Fig. 20.22: Rotation Throws: The bali sits on Fig 20.24: Back Twist Throw: With your back
surfaces to deliver a training stimulus. one side of lhe body. Rota te through so the bafl to the wal/, tum and throw the bali side to side.
As a power exercise, the medicine ball is thrown against the wall. This helps to develop rotational power.
is great because it can help with triple
extension of the ankle, knee and hip (all
required in sprinting mechanics, jumps,
etc.). You can also use these in normal
training, such as press-ups on a medi-
cine ball. A fet.v uses of medicine ball Fig. 20.20: Medicine Balf Sfam: Extend through
ankfe, knee and hip, sfamming the ba/f onto
exercises are highlighted below.
the f/oor.
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
366 Strength training and functiona/ training 1367
Strength trainíng and functional training

20.11 FUNCTIONAL STRENGTH TRAINING FOR THE SOCCER PLAYER 20.11.2 Specific strength training I Basic principies of functional training
lt is easier to describe the notion of "functional" by introducing and explaining a
20.11.1 lntroduction: What actually is 11 functional"? few basic principies related to functional training. Functional movement patterns
"Functional" is a very broad term that may mean different things to different peo~ are individual and sport specific, yet they are based on a number of universal prin-
ple. Something that is "functional" for one person may not be for others. The ques~ cipies that help to determine our analysis, testing and training.
tion is rather more like whether something is "functional for whom" or "functional
for what." What is functional for you is determined by the person responsible for 20.11.2.1 Functional training is Three-dimenslonal
you and your training. Functional training is much more than squatting, pulling, We constantly move in three dimensions (simultaneously) during functional acti-
pushing, and using all kinds of "functional" fitness equipment. vities. The three planes are forwards-backwards (sagittal plane), left-right (frontal
How many ways are there to squat and lunge? The answer is simple: an infinite plane), and left-right rotations (transverse plane). This means that each joint can
number of ways. A squat to lift a box from the floor is different to a squat you do move in six different directions, so we absolutely have to take account of this in our
to get something from the bottom of the fridge. Look at how many different squat training. We very often observe that only the sagittal plane is discussed in strength
and }unge positions a soccer player finds himself in during a match or training ses- training. Weight machines, in particular, are frequently limited to movements in
sion. Functional movement is very complex for soccer players because they get into this plane, while we find that most injuries occur in the transverse plane through
numerous different positions and situations during a match. extreme rotations (cruciate ligament injuries are a good example of this). It is impor-
The aim of functional training is to prevent injuries from occurring in these various tant to understand how each muscle and joint moves functionally in the three pla-
situations and eventually also become stronger in these situations. To achieve this, nes, and we certainly need to train them in these three planes. For example, when
it is important to train movements and not muscles. We want to prevent injuries the knee finds itself in the valgus position, only the muscles that are activated at
when a striker shoots hard at the goal or when a defender blocks a shot. Also, we the right moment and respond properly can inhibit the movement and prevent the
want the goalkeeper to be able to punch away a high cross powerfully and explo- knee from twisting too far and damaging the anterior cruciate ligament.
sively. We can incorporate these specific movements of soccer into our strength
training. Does this mean that we cannot lift any heavy weights or that hypertrophy 20.11.2.2 Jntegrated
training has to be functional? Of course not. There is nothing wrong with a soc- It is also important to understand that any change in one plane has consequences
cer player with a large muscle mass, nor is there anything wrong with lifting hea- for the other planes. Each influence on a system has consequences for other subsys~
vier weights. However, when it comes to specific strength training for soccer and tems. The body is an integrated whole in which bones, muscles, joints, ligaments,
wanting to make our players stronger in the various movements on the pitch, we proprioceptors and the nervous system work together in order to function. It is not
should perhaps apply a somewhat more functional thought process. We want to functional to isolate one of these systems and train it separately, even if that were
take advantage of that muscle mass in a positive manner. even possible. There is no such thing as proprioceptive training. The proprioceptors
All exercises can be featured on a functional training continuum, such as the are trained all the time, and the nervous system is stimulated constantly. Whether
following: we are lying down, sitting or standing up, we are always giving signals through
the proprioceptors. ln our strength training, we can ensure that we stimulate the
Least Functional Most Functional nervous system in a functional way so the muscles respond in the most appropriate
Leg Press - Machine Squat - Barbell Squat - One-Leg Squat Airex Pad - One-Leg squat manner. By holding a static position during a "plank," or by consciously driving
the knee above the second toe, but not past the toes, we give limited information to
Least Functional Most Functional the proprioceptors, causing them to perhaps not respond appropriately if our body
Machine Bench Press- Bench press- 08 Bench press- Push-Up- Medicine Bali Chest Pass then unconsciously makes a potentially dangerous movement.

These are justa few examples of exercises along the continuum, but other examples 20.11.2.3 Taking account of gravity, mass and ground reaction forces
include hop-dominant, vertical press, horizontal pull, and torso exercises. We are constantly subjected to gravity and ground reaction forces. When we stand
up straight and take a step forward and run, jump, and so on, there are movements
in our muscles and joints that are caused by gravity and other influences that result
from ground reaction forces. The front foot will pronate, the knees and hips will
bend, the body will stoop forward and bend laterally, and so on. We will therefore
not spend any time on the m. tibialis posterior, for example, to create eversion in
the foot. For the sarne reason, we will not focus on the hamstrings to bend the knee,
nor will we focus on the hip flexors (muscle group) to bend the hip. ln an upright
position, rather than these movements being brought about by the muscles, they
merely slow down the opposite movements. For example, when we are standing
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
368 Strength training and functional training 1369
Strength training and functional training

up, the abdominal muscles do not bend the torso. The body does not have to exert 20.11.2.5 Controlled movements: Conscious intent and unconscious reaction
itself to lower the head to the knees \vhen it is upright, because it is done by gravity. All our movements are influenced by where we are looking, what our hands are
For this reason, we train the muscles in a functional way in our coaching (by stret- doing, or what our intention of movement is. This means that a soccer player
ching them) and, as a result, it's clear that there is little point in doing exercises like consciously kicks a ball toward the goal, but it's his body that decides the way in
crunches. Ground reaction forces are everywhere on the soccer pitch, and they are which to execute the task. We cannot consciously activate muscles and move joints
absorbed by the body upon landing from a jump or planting a foot to change direc- or decide which movement comes from which part of the body. This all occurs
tion or decelerate. It is therefore important that athletes are aware of these forces. subconsciously. This also means the body will take the path of least resistance, so
muscles and joints with limited mobility or flexibility will be dra\vn on less, so
20.11.2.4 30 /oad - 30 unload other joints and muscles have to compensate for this. This can unfortunately lead
Initially, gravity would appear to impede us in all our movements. It causes a stoo- to overload.
ped posture when we are older, prevents us from being able to jump high, makes Movement occurs subconsciously. Proprioceptors respond subconsciously and
the ball drop faster from a throw-in, and makes us work harder if we want to pick activate muscles without us having to think about the process. We could there-
something up. ln biomechanical terms, however, gravity is the greatest ally in all fore question why we ask our players in a strength training session to keep their
our movements. knee over their foot during a lunge and not let it extend beyond the toes. We could
Without gravity, there would not be any load phase, and we would be unable to also question why \ve ask players to consciously tense their abdominal muscles
unload in the opposite direction. Just try jumping without first bending your knees. during the plank exercise. The conscious stimulation of muscles and controlled,
We want togo up, but the body first goes down in order to load the muscles before rigid movements are far removed from what actually happens on the soccer pitch.
jumping up. Likewise, a goalkeeper will first rotate backwards before throwing the lt misleads the proprioceptors and prevents or impedes movements that then occur
ball. ln most situations the goalkeeper will be running forward and the arm and on the pitch. ln every training exercise, particularly in the context of injury protec-
ball will trail behind him dueto momentum. This will create a lengthening (eccen- tion and strength training, it is important to let these subconscious movements and
tric load) of the anterior muscle chain and result in an unload (the throw). It is reactions take place. This way, the body also knows what it needs to do when it is
therefore important to consider what gravity does to us in the tlu·ee planes of move- confronted with the sarne movements on the soccer pitch.
ment. How does it use the movements to activate the proprioceptors, and how do
these activate the muscles so We get the desired chain reaction in the body? They 20.11.2.6 Kinetic Chain
have to be able to provide both mobility and stability in order to absorb or slow It is unnecessary to explain that the body is a whole. The foot is attached to the
down a movement. The energy stored by the muscles during stretching (eccentric ankle, the shinbone, the knee, the hip, and so on up to the head and the arms. If
loading phase) is then used to create the opposite movement (concentric unloading l stand upright with my right hand extended to the left, this influences the entire
phase). It is therefore necessary to first analyze the movements made by a soccer body. My upper body rotates to the left, as does my pelvis. My right foot will turn
player during a match in order to then create a training environment and exercises inwards and my left foot outwards. All the muscles and joints move in a chain reac-
that include the sarne movements. The stronger and more flexible a soccer player is tion, and this is often referred to as the kinetic chain. ln addition, the most remar-
in the loading phase, the more powerful the unloading phase will be. kable aspect is how this all occurs subconsciously. For a particular movement on
the pitch (e.g., a goal kick taken by the goalkeeper) it is important to know what
influence the hands, eyes, and kicking foot have on the rest of the body. This is the
only way we can prepare our players in an optimal manner during strength trai-
ning sessions for all the movements that can occur on the soccer pitch.

20.11.2. 7 Growing Stronger and Reducing injuries


It is important that through functional training we are making our muscles stron-
ger and therefore more resilient to injury. The main thing we want as a medical
department is zero or minimal non-contact injuries. Many coaches use functional
training because it sounds good, but they fail to perfect a move before adding load.
This means that if an athlete can't bodyweight squat with the correct technique, it
is then worked upon. We don't take a shortcut to correct the imperfection so we
can add load, because this will create a problem elsewhere in the kinetic chain.
Growing stronger means we can tolerate more load through the body, so the body
will be able to handle more sprints, decelerations and changes in direction. It is
important that exercise selection is functional based, so instead of using leg-exten-
sion machines, we use a split squat. It is also important to note that not all exercises
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
370 1 Strength training and functional training Strength training and functional training 1371

need to be functional to the sport. Olympic lifting movements like the clean, jerk player carry out his movement more quickly, with a greater ROM, ar a heavier
and snatch are explosive movements that will promete a greater rate of force deve- load? We will once again use the motor skills of a specific movement to make a
lopment, teach hip extension, and load the hamstrings eccentrically in the catch player better and stronger.
positions. Although the exercise movement is not a soccer action, it is functional In recent times, the strength training continuum has shifted to a joint-by-joint
because of the benefits of the exercise. approach initially put forward by coaches such as Mike Boyle and Gray Cook This
approach looks at the body from the ground up and determines which joints need
20.11.3 Training soccer movements: Specific strength training for soccer stability ar mobility to maximize performance gains. It is important to add that all
players must resemble soccer joints require both mobility and stability, but they will be at different points on a
The basic principies form the guideline and foundation for the creation of exercise stability-mobility continuum. Stability is a part of mobility, and the body must be
programs. We do not want to just haphazardly give the players some exercises to able to move in a mobile and stable way. Stability without mobility is rigidity. This
do and then leave them to their fates. This is why it is important to have a certified breakdown ultimately helps us understand how many common injuries occur. An
strength coach and have a11 sessions completed with supervision. When we set example for this would be if the ankle lacks mobility (Range of Motion), there will
up an exercise program, it is equally important to know how players move, both be implications further up the joint-by-joint approach, normally found in the next
as a player and as a coach, and this is often the only thing we do not leam in rela- joint up, the knee in this example. The Functional Movement Screen (FMS) created
tion to strength training. Most information concerning strength training is based by Gray Cook is one example of how mobility or stability issues within the joints
on anatomical research carried out on bodies in a laying position. We leam a lot might be highlighted.
about individual muscles in isolation, but the body only knows about movements
made by severa! muscles together. Each time a joint moves, a large number of mus- 20.11.5 Transition zones
cles play an important role. One muscle is stretched, another muscle shortens, and The transition zones are the extreme stretch zones of a movement when transfer-
other muscles stabilize, with a11 the muscles 1vorking together. Muscles respond ring from one movement to another. Most movements in soccer have two transition
to movement by creating movement themselves, and, as already mentioned, they zones. When kicking, there is a transition zone where the kicking leg transfers from
are subject to various forces that they contrai and stabilize before themselves deve- the rear-swinging phase to the for\vard-swinging phase. After the ball has been
loping the desired power. A specific movement of a joint in a particular plane of kicked, the leg swings through and is slowed down in the second transition phase.
movement can be obtained in five different ways. Although it goes without saying Both zones are equally important, and it is useful to train in both zones in arder to
that the form of the joints, as well as the muscles and ligaments, can limitar prevent get stronger and avoid injuries. The aim is not to train directly and constantly in
a particular movement, the principie applies in every joint. An example of this is one maximal eccentric position, but it is necessary to know how far a player can
given below. go and how strong he is in this zone. It is usually in these zones that a player will
The extension in the hip created before a player kicks a ball can be obtained by: sustain injuries. The transition zones are individual and sport specific. As coaches,
• leaning the body back without moving the leg we can set up and adapt strength training programs based on a player's individual
• bringing the leg back without moving the body potential.
• raising the leg and leaning the body back, but letting the body move faster
than the leg 20.11.6 Proprioceptors
• leaning the body forward and bringing the leg back, but letting the The proprioceptors have already been mentioned a few times in the preceding sec-
leg move faster than the body tion. They are sensory organs located in the muscles, ligaments, joint capsules and
0 leaning the body back and also bringing the leg back so on. They convert physical input and movement information into electrical sig-
nals that are sent through the body. This information is transmitted to the spinal
In soccer, the extension is mostly created by the final method above through the column and the brain, although bridging this distance would often take too long
momentum in the run-up to the bali. ln this way, we can analyze each movement in for the information to be received by the muscles and allow them to respond. It
each joint at any moment and then incorporate this into the strength training sche- is highly likely that there is also a direct network between the muscles and the
dule. The better we can incorporate soccer movements into strength training, the joints in the fascia and the tissues in order for this information to get to the mus-
greater the transfer of strength training to the soccer pitch will be. cles more quickly. There are various proprioceptors: the Pacinian corpuscles, the
Golgi-Mazzoni corpuscles, the Ruffini corpuscles, the Golgi ligament endings, free
20.11.4 Stability and mobility nerve endings and muscle spindles. They all have a different sensitivity, adapting
For soccer players, it is also paramount to not remain neutral but rather be able to quickly or slowly to a constant stimulus, and they are located in different places in
pass through a neutral position in the different planes of movement and contrai the muscles, joints, joint capsules, ligaments and fascia. This means that the pro-
these movements subconsciously, therefore being able to respond appropriately via prioceptors are difficult to see, and although we do not know exactly how they
the proprioceptors and the muscles. ln other words, can a player become destabi- work, it is clear that we have to take them into account. When we talk about move-
lized in a soccer-specific position or movement and still control it? Also, can the ments, muscles and joints, we know that although a proprioceptor gives certain
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITN ESS 1N SOCCER
372
Strength training and functional training Strength training and functional training 1373

information, we need all the information from all proprioceptors in arder to have a Set out below is a series of exercises for the different components of the kicking
clear picture of what is happening in the body. It is for the proprioceptors, in par- movement:
ticular, that we incorporate functional training and soccer-specific movements into
our coaching. The question we ask ourselves is how we can integrate the proprio- ./ Position before kicking (these exercises create extension, abduction and exter-
ceptors into our training in an efficient as possible manner. Proprioceptive training nai rotation in the kicking leg
is often discussed in the area of rehabilitation or training. This creates a false picture
of \vhat the proprioceptors exactly do. Proprioceptors are present everywhere in
the body, constantly ernitting signals for movement. We cannot turn them off, and
non-proprioceptive training does not exist. We must therefore ensure that we train
in a functional way in order to stimulate the proprioceptors in the correct manner.

20.11.7 Practice
./ Analyzing soccer movements
Now we have all this information, as \vell as some idea of what functional training
means for a soccer player, there perhaps remains the question of how to do this and
Fig. 20.25: Forward /unge: Swing
what exactly to do. For this reason, we will also analyze a soccer-specific movement
lhe arms over lhe fronl leg.
in this chapter and devise an exercise program for it. The most obvious movement
is shooting for goal.

We analyze the positions of the banes in the right hip joint during the load phase
before kicking and the swing phase after kicking:
• Before kicking: flexion, abduction, externai rotation
• After kicking: flexion, abduction, internai rotation

The movement carried out in the right hip during the kicking motion is: flexion
(from a bent position to a more bent position), adduction (from abduction to adduc-
tion) and internai rotation (from externally rotated to internally rotated).
Fig. 20.26: Fof\vard /unge from a
An additional factor is that all of the movement takes place on one leg. ln our trai-
raised position: Swing the arms
ning, we \vill start with what the player in question is most successful at. This could over the front /eg.
be on hvo legs with the support of the hands, for example, depending on his or her
possibilities. Ultimately, we want to do everything possible to get to the stage of
single-leg training exercises.
Although the above examples are soccer-specific actions, soccer movements are
also short, sharp, dynamic movements that should never be forgotten. The ham-
strings need to be strong to handle the loads placed on them .

./ Setting up exercises
The program for training the preceding movement can consist of three parts. We
Fig. 20.27: Jumping forwards
want to make the player more flexible and stronger in the position prior to kicking,
from a one-/egged position:
in the position after kicking, and in his movement \vhile kicking. Depending on Swing bolh arms over the front
our objective (e.g., flexibility, mobility, strength, etc.), we can add weights or other feg.
training equipment to the exercises. We can also vary each position and movement
in the three planes of movement. Depending on the player, we will begin with an
easy or more difficult exercise.
FITNESS IN SOCCER
1 f ITN ESS 1N SOCCER
374 Strength training and functional training Strength training and functional training 1375

./ Position after kicking - kicking Ieg Cl


e.,,
'C$-
·- u til o
e ,.,
rn " ~ "O
~-; ~ ~ o
.o
<ll W,E!
>
Eõ o. TIro 2
o rn
.e .e .e
~e ~
:e"' o. ;:: .2

e ,.,
Fig. 20.28: Foot on the bench: Swing the arms over the front /eg. ~> "O
o
.o €
TIrn :oo. ~
./ Position after kicking- support leg 3' ~ e. ~ X
o
.Q o. ::J o
"'"
e
o
e :g
o
~ ">~
.e
Cl
:e
-~
ü
ro
~
o.
"
:g€
;:: _g
~
o
u
ª"
;e
X

"'
e.

Ê
"'
~

e
o
e :g
o
~ e ~
">
Fig. 20.29: Forward lateral
/unge: Swing the arms toward .e
:Bro "
õ ,., :a.,, e.

lhe rear /eg.


Cl
:e ~
o.
.e "O
;:: _g
~
o
u
"'"
""
~

Ê
e
o
e ,., :g
o "O
20.11.8 Drawing upa plan N
~
>
o
.o ">~
The intensity and sequence of matches during a season require thorough plan- E :oe. e.
~ TIrn

ning of ali aspects that are important to a soccer player. Modem-day soccer has
become very demanding on the physical capacities of the athletes. Players have "E ~
o. ::J
e. ~
o
u
~

Ê""
to be strong, fast and powerful, yet also able to sustain this for 90 minutes. At the e
o
sarne time, a coach also wants his best players to be able to play in all matches by e
o ,., :g
avoiding injuries as much as possible. A player must therefore be as fresh as pos- ~
"O
o
.o
">~
3' > e.
sible on the day of the match while also being able to train as hard as possible bet- o t5ro :oe.
vveen matches. For this reason, each aspect of strength training also has its place in
the plan for the season and the match. It goes without saying that 1.ve will not plan
5
"'~ ~
o. ::J
e. ~
o
u Ê"'
~
e
<I
any functional strength training with weights for the days before or after a match. ~.e
~
However, we can incorporate injury-prevention exercises ar functional flexibility o~
:o
ro
,.,
.e
.2
ro
.,,e"' o
~
E
training into the warm up for a training session ar in a brief strength training ses- E
~
sion on those days. If we assume that all our exercises are functional, we can then "'
rn ~"O
>-o
ro-
" rn e
·;;;
e
õ ""'_,,
N
propose the following weekly plan: e .o" .!!!
.Q
"e.
~
.Q

""
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
376 377
Strength training and functional training Strength training and functional training

Preactivation is the dynamic preparation of the muscles for what they will be doing players often train at their limits, and any additional stimulus on the legs can push
on the pitch. This can be dane in a very functional way, with body weight and with them over the limit. Although this has to be taken into account, this type of training
movements that also occur on the pitch. We want to make the proprioceptors and certainly has its place in the players' weekly training schedule in the context of
muscles alert with light eccentric movements without causing fatigue or muscle injury prevention and flexibility.
damage. This is dane, in principle, for each training session and match.

Fig. 20.32: Example: Fonvard /unge extending to lhe ank/es with dumbbel/s and retuming to the
shou/der press.

Finally, core training has also been included in the schedule. The muscles in the
Fig. 20.30: Example: Hip extension with variations in lhe different planes of movement. Light sprin- hip and abdominal regions are often consciously tightened during these training
ging on the front leg to oblain dynamic stretching in lhe hip region.
sessions.

Pure strength training with additional weight has to be structured very carefully. We explained earlier that muscles function in a different way, and this is why we
The upper body can be stimulated almost every day without affecting physical will also \vork as dynamically as possible in these training sessions. The "core" is
readiness later on the pitch. However, we even try to do upper-body training in an an important link in all the movements made on the pitch, so it is important to train
upright position as much as possible and with movements similar to those used it in these movements. This can also be very functional and upright. The explosive
on the pitch. Hypertrophy training can also be carried out in a functional way and throwing of medicine balls from different positions is a very interesting option here.
with transfer to soccer.

Fig. 20.33: Example with a


medicine ball.

Fig. 20.31: Push-pull movemenl on lhe cable machine. Training rolation in lhe torso/hip region and of
lhe upper-body musc/es in a functional position.

Full-body training or inclusion of the lower body in strength training requires a


very controlled and cautious approach. This also applies to functional flexibility
training. Players who have not had any experience of this can suffer from muscle Fig. 20.34: Examp!e with a
stiffness in the first few training sessions. As coaches, we have to take this into cab/e machine.
account because it can have a direct impact on pitch training. Professional soccer
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Strength training and functional training
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Strength training and functional training 1379

This weekly plan is of course only an example, and we do not for a moment claim REFERENCES
that this is the best plan for all of the players all of the time. For example, a player
may need more focus on prevention because of recurring injuries. In the case of a Balsom, P.D., Seger, J.Y, Sjedin, B. and Ekblorn, B., 1992. Physiologicil Re5ponoco to M;ixlmal ln1cnsity !ntcrmíltcnt e•Cró8!. European
less athletic or younger player who is not selected so much, greater attention can be Journal of Applicd Physiology, 65(2), pp.l-1-1-149
Bo.bbcrt, M.F., G_crritscn, K.G., Litjcm;, M.C. and Van So!.'S!, A.J., 1996. Why is countermo\'cment jump height grca!cr than squal jump
paid to full-body training. The content of strength training sessions is different in hc1ght? Med. So. Sports Exerc., 28, pp.1402-1-112.
Bobbcrt, M.F and C'15iuo, R.L.J., 2005. ls thc cffcct of a countcrmovement on jump hdsht dic to active statc dcwlopmcnt? Mcd Sci Sports
the preparation stage than it is in the middle of the season, when there is a succes- Excrc., 37(3), pp.·1-10-146.
Busco, C., lto, A., Komi, P.V., Luhtancn, P., Rahkila, P., Ruoko, H. and Vit=!o, J.T., 1982. Ncuromusrulm funetion 1md mcclunical cffici-
sion of weekend and mid\veek matches. cncy of hunt.1n !cg extensor musde5 during jumping cxcrósc>s. Aeta. Physiol. Scand., 114(.1), pp.5-H-50.
Ca\'agna, G.A and Cil!erio, G.G., 1974. Effcct of strctchlng on lhe elastk cliaractcristics and the contractilc components strialed Muodc.
ln a broader plan (e.g., over four weeks), we can ensure we vary the exercises and J. Phpiol., 239, pp.l-14.
alter the intensity and weight lifted. For example, we can spend one week impro- Cronin, J.B., McNair, P.J and Marshall, R.N., 2001. Magnitude and dcci.y of Strctch·lnduced enhanccmcnt of Powcr Output. Eur J Applied
Phyr.ioL, 8-1(6), pp.575-581.
ving the movements needed for jumping and heading, as well as preventive work Deanc, R.5., Chow, J.W., Tillman, M.D. and Foumicr, K.A., 2005. EffoclS of Hip flexor training on sprint, shuttle run, and \'Crlical jump
pcrforrnanre. Journal of Strcngth & Conditioning R"5carch, 19(3), pp.615-621.
on ankle injuries and calf flexibility. Then the following week, we can pay more Ebbcn, W.P., 2002. Complcx Training:A llricf Re\'icw. jouma! ofSportsSci and Mcddne, l, pp.42-16.
Flanagan, E.P. and ComyM, T.M.., 2003. Thc Use of Contact lime and thc Rcactivc Strcngth !ndcx to Optimiic fost Strctch·Shorlcning
attention to the kicking movement and avoiding injuries in the hip region. We can Cyde Training. Strcngth & Conditíonins Journal, 30(5), pp.32-38.
Ha~, G.C., Hobbs, R.T., Haff, E.E., Sands. W.A., Piercc, K.C. and Stone, M.H., 2()(13. ClustcrTraining: A No\'cl Mclhod for lntroducing
vary this with repetitions, work-rest ratios, planes of movement, and so on. Trnming Programmc Variation. Strcngth & Conditioning Joumal, 30(1), pp.67-76.
Ho/f, J. Bcrdahl, G.O. and Ilratcn, S., 2001.Jumping hcisht dcvclopment and body wcight considcrations in ski jumping. ln: Muller, E.,
Sclnvamcdcr, H., Rau:lmcr, C., Lindingcr, S. and Korncxl, E., 2001. Sdenre and Slding. Hamburg: Vcrlag Dr Kovac. Pp.-103-112.
Hoff, J., Gr.m, A. and Hei gero d,/., 2002. Maximal Strcngth Training improves acrobiccndurance P"rformancc. Scand j Mcd Sci Spolt!l,
12, pp.288-295.
SUMMARY Hill, A.V., 1970. First and Lastcxpcrimcnt5 in musdc mcchanics. Ncw York: Cambridsc Univcroity Pres&.
McClymont, D., 2003. Thc use of lhe rcacti•·e strcngth índex as an indica!or of plyomctric traíning conditions. ln: Reil!y, T., Cibri,J. and
Arnu'jo, D., cds. Science and Foolbnll V:l11e Prorecdings ofthc Fif!h World Congrc:;s on Sports Sdcnceand FootbnlL Li~bon, Portugal,
11-15 April. Ncw York: Routledgc; 2008. pp.·IOS-116.
ln this chapter, the physiology of muscle strength and various strength training Morcau, N.G., Simpwn, K.N., Tccfcy, S.A., Damiano, D.L., 2010. Musde archi1ccturc prcdicts maximum strcngth and is rc!atcd to activity
!c\'cl5 in cerebral pnlsy. Physica! therapy, 90(11), pp.1619-30.
programs lvere discussed. Strength training in soccer is now an essential com- Mycr, G.D., Ford, K.R., Mctcan, S.G. and Hcwetl, T.E., 2006. The Effocl• of P!yomctric \'crsus dynamic ~t<1bilization nnd balance training
ponent of the training week and should be incorporated in the weekly training on lower cdrcmity biomcchanics. Amcrican )ou mal of Sports Medicine, 34(3), pp.445-155.
Puavolaincn, L., Hakkincn, K. Hamalancn, J., Nummcla, A. and Ru>ko, H., 1999, Explosivc strcngth training improves Skm running lime
program when possible. Strength training should be periodized into the annual by i~pro"ing ninnins cconomy and mu~dc power. J Appl Physiol, 86(5), pp.1527-1533.
Pottc1gcr, J.A., Lockwood, R.H., Hnub, M.D., Do lera_~ B.A., A!umzaini, K.S., Schroedcr, J.M. and Zcb110, C.J., 1999. Mutde powcr and fibcr
training program in order to enhance performance and to reduce the risk of inju- c~1iracteristic foll<;>l~·ing 8 wccks of plyomctrk trnimng. Journal of filrcngth and Conditionins Rc~carch, 13, pp.275-279.
Rimmcr, E. and Slm\'crt, G., 2000. Effccts oi a plyomelrk interwntion program on Sprint pcrformance. /ournal ofStrcnsth ;md Condi·
ries. Strongerplayers can sprint quicker, jump higher, and change direction more tioningJoumal, 14(3), pp.295-301.
Spuns, R.W., Murph;~ A.J. and Watsford, M.L., 2003, The Effcct oi Plyomctrk training on dist<1ncc running. Eur J Appl Physiol, S9(1),
efficiently, and they may also be more resilient to injury than weaker players. pp.1-7.
Sto.n~, M.H., Sto~e, M.E., Sands, W.A., Picrc~, K.C., Newton, RU., H.11f, G.G. and Carlock, J., 2006. Mmdnmm Strcngth nnd S!rcngth
Heavy two-legged strength exercises such as the squat can be used to improve tramms -A rclahonship to cndurance? Strcngth & Conditioning Joumal, 26(3), pp.4·1-53.
maximal strength, while one-legged exercises such as the pistol squat can be Turner, A., Owings, M. and 5chwane, J., 2003. lmprovemcnt in ninning economy aftcr 6 w""ks of plyometric trnining. )ou mal of Strcngth
and condilioning rc1:<,;1rch, 17(1), pp.60-ó7
performed to improve functional strength. Improving upper body strength can Turner, A., 2009. The Sdence and pradice oi Periodization: A Brid Revicw. Strcngth & Conditioning Journal, 33(1), pp.34-16.
Wilson, G.J., Wood, G.A. nnd Ellio\I, B.C., 1991. Optlm~l stiffness of ~cries clíliltic componcnt in a otrctch-~hortcn cyde ~Ctl\'i\y. / Appl
help a player to push opponents off the bali and win aerial duels. Core stability Physiol, 70, pp.S25-íl33.
Wisloff, U., Helgcrud, J. nnd Hoff,J., 1993. Strcnglh and Endurance oi Elite Socrer Playcrn. Medicine and Sdcnce inSport5and Excrcioc,
exercises should be performed as often as possible to improve pelvic stability 30(3), pp.462-167.
Wislo,ff, ':1·' Dst~gn~, .e.' 1-!clsc.rud, J., Joncs, R. and ~-off, J., 200-I. Slrong Corrdation of Maximal S<iuot Strcngth with Sprint Pcrform~ncc
and control in order to reduce the risk of groin and pelvic injuries. and \crhcnl Jump Hcight m EhtcSotror P!aycrs. Bnhsh Journal ofSports Medicine, 3S, pp.285-283.
\'ossen, J.F., Kramcr,J.F., Burkc, D.G. and Vowcn, D.P., 2000. Comparison ofdynamkpush-up troining and plyomctrk push·up tr.lining
on uppcr-body powcr and strcngth. Journol of Strcnglh and CondiHoning Rcscarcli, J.1(3), pp.248-253.
3SO 1
FITNESS IN SOCCER
Strength training and functional training
FITNESS IN SOCCER
lnjury prevention 1381

1
INJURY PREVENTION
Jan Van Winckel, Steven Probst, Balder Berckmans, Pieter Jacobs, Mathíeu Gram

21.1 INTRODUCTION
Due to the specific physical demands of soccer, the incidence of injuries is signifi-
cantly higher than in other team sports such as field hockey, volleyball and basket-
ball. The risks of acute injury in professional soccer are threefold greater than in
the construction, manufacturing, and service sectors of industry (Drawer and Ful-
ler, 2002). Large-scale epidemiological studies indicate that the injury prevalence
rate in professional soccer is approximately 15%. This means that for a squad of 25
players, approximately four players will be unavailable at any given time due to
injuries. Hãgglund (2007) reported that 65-95% of players had at least one injury
every year. ln a recent study in European professional soccer, Ekstrand et al. (2011)
demonstrated that a team with a 25-player squad can expect 15 muscle injuries
every season, with muscle injuries accounting for more than a quarter of the total
layoff time.

Contact injuries are responsible for just over a half of all injuries, and these are often
linked to externai factors and therefore not completely avoidable. Non-contact inju-
ries, however, can be largely avoided, and these are divided into acute non-contact
injuries and overload injuries. Muscle injuries, such as strains, are generally regar-
ded as the largest group of avoidable injuries. Extensive epidemiological studies by
Professor Ekstrand et al. (2011), conducted over a ten-year period with 51 different
professional clubs, have shown that muscle injuries account for 35% of the total
number of injuries. Up to 80% of these muscle injuries are non-contact injuries that
could be avoided to a large extent through individual injury-prevention programs
and workload management. This substantial number of muscle injuries is respon-
sible for more than 25% of the overall absence of players from match-play and
therefore has a major impact on the success of the team. This is especially signifi-
cant when considering that muscle injuries alone (in a squad of 25 players at pro-
fessional levei) are responsible for 223 days of unavailability per season, including
37 match days and 148 training days. Injuries to the hamstring muscle group are
the most common injuries, accounting for 37% of all muscle injuries. The average
unavailability per muscle injury lasts 14 days before the player can return to squad
training.
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
382
lnjury prevention Jnjury prevention 1383

21.2 CONSEQUENCES OF INJURIES


Injuries and the associated unavailability of players have substantial consequences 1. Estab!i~h!ns the extent of
the injmy prob!em:
for the players as well as the coach and the club. The development of youth players • lndclence
and the careers of professional players can in some cases be severely interrupted. · Severltv
ln both cases, it can take a long period of rehabilitation before they are able to per-
form at the top level again. This means the coach cannot field his strongest team,
resulting in diminished performance. Poor match performances and results also
have economic consequences for the club. Injuries therefore have a greater impact
/
than just the players' physical complaints. ln 2003, for example, Scandinavian rese-
archers conducted a study of more than 300 players in Iceland's two highest pro- 4. kse~$ing its 2. htabli~hing the
effeçtivenen by repeatiog aetio!ocv;::nd meehanbm
fessional soccer divisions (Arnason, 2003). The aim of the study was to examine step 1 of sports injuries
what part individual fitness and proneness to inju1y played in a team's success. The
conclusion was that teams with fewer injuries finished the season in a significantly
higher place in the league than teams with more injuries. Similar to this, Hãgglund
et al. (2013) reported that injuries have a significant influence on performance in
the league and European competitions in male professional soccer. The findings
stress the importance of injury prevention strategies to increase a team' s chances
of success. 3. !ntroducing a preventive
/
mea~ure

ln economic terms, the main effect of a large number of injuries is the high cost
incurred by the club. The medical costs related to injuries are substantial. Recent
research demonstrated that these costs can be reduced through injury-prevention
strategies (Verhagen, 2013). Moreover, clubs continue to pay salaries while injured Fig. 21. 1: Four-step sequence of injury·prevention research (Meeuwisse et ai., 1992).
players (the club's assets) cannot perform. Their market value also drops, resulting
in the transfer possibilities for such players falling as well. The greatest source of
income for most clubs comes from training and guiding players to a higher levei, ln 2005, Bahr and Krosshaug designed a conceptual model that elaborated on the
with the result that they can be sold to other clubs for substantial amounts of characteristics of the inciting event as a component of the causal pathway. This
money. Given the average wages of players in Europe (e.g., €150,000 per annum in model suggests that an injury is the result of a complex interaction between intrin-
Belgiurn, €250,000 in the Netherlands and €350,000 in England), the average pay for sic and extrinsic risk factors rather than being exclusively caused by the injury
players in the USA ($150,000 per year in MLS), and the high incidence of injuries, mechanism that is generally associated with the onset of injury. Each player has
it is obvious that even a 5% reduction in the number of injuries would have a huge their o\vn particular set of intrinsic factors or risks. Intrinsic risk factors can be
financial benefit. A recent study sho\ved that 2% of all professional players in the further subdivided into modifiable or non-modifiable factors. Modifiable risk fac-
Premier League ended their careers because of injury (Windsor insurance, 1997). tors can potentially be altered to reduce injury rates through the in1plementation of
This is in stark contrast to another study in \vhich the researchers asked players injury-prevention strategies (Meeu\visse, 1991}.
\vhy they had stopped playing soccer. Of those questioned, 50%) said they had been
forced to end their careers prematurely because of injury (Drawer and Fuller, 2011). Intrinsic risk factors-such as physicul fitness, technical level, muscle strength and
flexibility, and joint mobility-can be n1anipulated by targeted training and physio-
therapy sessions. If intrinsic strength improves, the player may be less predisposed
21.3 CONCEPTUAL MODEL: INJURY PREVENTION to injury. The co1nbination of these individually determined intrinsic risk factors
Injury prevention is an organized strategy in \Vhich all sections of the club have to gives the player a certain predisposition to injury. This predisposed player is then
\Vork closely together. ln 1992, van Mechelen and co-workers argued that measures exposed to extrinsic risk factors, making him even more susceptible to injury.
to prevent sports injuries do not stand alone. They presented a model of preven- Examples of extrinsic risk factors include \Veather conditions and the playing sur-
tion based on the surveillance of injury, identification of risk factors, and imple- face. For example, a field in poor condition can have a negative influence on the
mentation of prevention strategies. Two years later in 1994, Meeuwisse put forth a player's intrinsic predisposition, and this makes him n1ore susceptible to injury. A
multifactorial model of causation. This model attempted to account for the inter- good soccer field, ideal \.veather conditions, anda referee who has the match under
action of multiple risk factors, both intrinsic (internai) and extrinsic (externai). It control all have favorable influences on the player's predisposition. Although these
sho\vs clearly the importance of identifying intrinsic predisposing factors, as well extrinsic risk factors are outside our professional domain, they do need to be inclu-
as recognizing those extrinsic factors that interact to make an athlete susceptible to ded in order to draw up an accurate profile for each player.
injury, before an injury-inciting event occurs (Figure 21.1).
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
384 lnjury prevention lnjury prevention 1385

Although high-risk players are susceptible to injury, they may not have been inju- 21.4 INTRINSIC RISK FACTORS
red yet. It is the presence of both intrinsic and extrinsic risk factors that renders a Intrinsic risk factors can be subdivided into modifiable and non-modifiable factors.
player susceptible to injury. The simple presence of these risk factors is, however,
insufficient to produce injury. The sum of these risk factors and the interaction bet- 21.4.1 Non~modifiable factors
ween them "prepares" the athlete for an injury to occur in a given situation (Bahr Despite that these factors cannot be altered, coaches have to take them into account
and Krosshaug, 2005). The final link in the chain that actually causes the injury is in arder to avoid injuries and develop individual programs. This differentiation is
the inciting event (Meeuwisse, 1992). referred to as individual periodization.

Injury Mechanism 21.4.1.1 Age


The chronological age of peak performance varies between sports and depends
Risk factors Injury mechanism on the player's attained technical skill, developed power, endurance capacity, and
Intrinsic risk foctors Extrinsic risk foctors
experience. The majority of players are at their most successful after they have rea-
Inciting e\'ents
ched athletic maturation. Athletes participating in rugby, soccer, volleyball, speed

'"'
C~nMr
lhmMnfact<>U
o Rd~tt<'
o Te.1nun.1tc
oOppcruont
f'1l\itnnnwnt
til

""'ro
n
'"e>
Tr~inlns proar;om
o Pui<><l!;;.~U"n
""1.l=<)·de
o ~frsocyde
-"
..a.
;;i
skating, distance running, and cross-country skiing achieve success in their late
twenties or early thirties (Bompa, 1999).

Heltl1t o Humldity
O Temf"'tOt<m> g, o Mlcr<><)'1C•
o D.>il;·pl=
o. Adolescents are more injury prone
An.1tonty
Heohh Soc<:erl1dJ
ro- 3. WorJJ:>.:1d
"' than children. Injury rates increase
~
l'lwsl:.1.1 fitn~;; o Surfa'~ F~tlzu~
l'tÓprl<lN!pllon
fl~-<ilo~Hy
~!w:ru!Jr bilme<:>
o Malnl<''""'""
Spc•t•~qull'flWl\l
o Oot!w:;
"'g:.
;;;
Jcizitmolion
Warmup
R~rowry iil"
with age through a diverse range
of sports (Yde and Nielsen, 1990;
Mut.ouL1r 5lrrn5th o 5h= SkillJ"'rforrnou"'"
Proi<-<:lh-ccqulpmrnt iil" Emery, 2003).
o Sh!n &'l<'\rJ;

' Hdm«t
.
e
The research supports age as a
significant risk factor for injury
Intervention strntegies
(Freckleton and Pizzari, 2013).
1. Screening intrinsk risk foctors and training weaknesses
Several studies have shown clearly
2. Reducing the extrinsic risk foctors
that older players are more prone
3. Monitoring \\'Orkload & managing fatigue
to muscle injury, particularly to the hamstrings (Verrall et al., 2011; Henderson et
ai., 2010; Freckleton and Pizzari, 2013). Hãgglund et ai. (2013) demonstrated that
Fig. 21.2: lnjuf'f mechanism (adapted torm Bahr and Krosshaug, 2005). older players (above mean age) had an almost twofold increase in the rate of calf
injury, but the researchers didn't find any association in other muscle groups.

This final link will tell us, within the conceptual model, something about "the The reason why older players are more susceptible to muscle injury is unclear,
moment" when a player will sustain an injury. It is only when a player is actually but it has been suggested that age-related changes in older athletes, such as incre-
on the pitch taking part in a h·aining session or match that he can sustain an injury. ased body weight and a loss of flexibility, may partially explain the increased risk
A very injury-prone (susceptible) player can undergo a training session perfectly (Gabbe et al., 2006). ln another interesting study by Orchard et al. (2002), increasing
well with a good warm up, good training conditions, and a specially adapted trai- age and sporting experience were identified as intrinsic risk factors for groin injury.
ning load. These results could be partially explained by the fact that the body's collagen tissue
An injury is therefore effectively sustained by the interaction behveen intrinsic changes in nature with progressing age, so it may not be as able to respond to rapid
and extrinsic risk factors during the "inciting event." This can also be altered by changes of directions or recover from fatigue (Mays et al., 1991; Wang et al., 2003).
applying particular periodization, adapting the training load, or manipulating Moreover, it has been demonstrated that peak hip adductor and abductor torques
other underlying mechanisms. Excessively heavy workouts or excessively short significantly decrease with advancing age Gohnson et al., 2004).
intervals between training sessions can be factors in provoking an injury. Each
player has, figuratively speaking, his own "Achilles heel," a certain area of the ln a meta-analysis conducted by Fousekis et al. (2013), a trend where younger play-
body that is more susceptible to injury. For one player, it might be his right knee, for ers were at greater risk of ankle sprain was also apparent to the limit of statistical
another, it might be his left hamstring. The vast majority of injuries are sustained significance (.05 < P < .10). This was confirmed in a study by McKay et al. (2001) in
in the area of this figura tive" Achilles heel" when the load imposed by the coach is basketball players. They reported that younger athletes were at an increased risk of
higher than the player's load tolerance. sustaining anl<le injuries when compareci with older athletes.

:-- ,

;>fli/jj/S
386
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER
lnjury prevention
FITNESS IN SOCCER
lnjury prevention 1387

21.4.1.2 Gender 21.4.2 Modifiable factors


It is well documented that female athletes sustain significantly more knee injuries
than male athletes, specifically anterior cruciate ligament (ACL) sprains. Female 21.4.2.1 Body fat percentage (overweight)
athletes are three times more likely to incur ACL ruptures (Sutton and Bullock, Being overweight causes the body to waste a great <leal of energy on inefficient
2012). ln a study of ACL injuries in elite Norwegian handball players, Myklebust et movement. A body fat percentage under 10% is recommended for a soccer player.
al. (2000) found that women had a fivefold increased risk of sustaining ACLinjuries An increase in fat percentage produces an exponential increase in the mechanical
when compareci with men. This may be dueto female athletes having, genetically load, forces that articular, ligamentous, and muscular stluctures must resist. Care
speaking, less strength and the knee often being too flexible (hyperlaxity). Addi- should be taken when determining body fat percentages via skinfold measure-
tionally, many explanations have been suggested in the literature for why female ments, because these involve a margin of error. Skinfold measurements are, howe-
athletes incur more serious knee injuries than male athletes, including anatomical, ver, very useful in practice for measuring a player's development over time. These
hormonal, and neuromuscular factors (Hewitt, 2000). Unique anatomical features measurements are quick and practical, making them very useful for large numbers
of female athletes, such as a larger quadriceps angle (i.e., the Q angle or the angle of players. Current trends in body composition research include compartmental
at which the femur meets the tibia), could possibly cause a larger relative inward assessment using dual-energy x-ray absorptiometry (DEXA). The advantage of
rotation of the knee anda greater pull on the knee muscles during physical activity, DEXA over other laboratory methods is the ability to assess regional, in addition to
therefore contributing to more ACL injuries among females. total body, composition and analyze separate compartments of the body (i.e., fat,
soft tissue and bane) (Wagnei; 1999).
21.4.1.3 Height
Meta-analysis suggested that height did not differ between groups of injured and 21.4.2.2 Weig/1t
uninjured players (Freckleton and Pizzari, 2013). Freckleton and Pizzari (2013) included seven studies in their meta-analysis. They
did not demonstrate a difference in weight between the injured and uninjured
21.4.1.4 Ethnicity groups, although there was a trend toward heavier athletes being more susceptible
Woods et al. (2004) found an association with a significantly increased risk in play- to hamstring injury. Fousekis et al. (2013) found that players with increased body
ers of black origin. weight had a significantly higher risk of non-contact ankle sprains.

21.4.1.5 Anatomica/ characteristics 21.4.2.3 Joint position sense


Anatomical characteristics, such as increased foot width, have been linked with an Joint position sense has been identified as an intrinsic risk factor for ankle sprains
increased risk of ankle sprains (Barker et al. 1997; Baumhauer et ai., 1995). in numerous publications (Willems et ai., 2005; de Noronha et al., 2006; Tropp et al.,
1984). Tropp et ai. (2006) investigated postural equilibrium through stabilometry in
soccer players. They demonstrated that in players with a history of previous ankle
joint injury, no increased postural sway was found. On the other hand, players sho-
wing abnormal stabilometric values ran a significantly higher risk of sustaining an
ankle injury during the following season \Vhen compareci to players \Vith normal
values. Trojian and McKeag (2006) investigated the ability of the single-leg balance
(SLB) test, carried out during preseason e'xaminations, to predict an ankle sprain
during the autumn sports season. The researchers found a significant association
behveen a positive SLB test and future ankle sprains.

21.4.2.4 Hamstring to opposite l1amstring ratio (H:H0P,)


The risk of sustaining a hamstring strain-type injury \Vas sho\vn to increase \Vith a
lo\vered hamstring to opposite hamstring concentric ratio at 60° / s in an Australian
football population (Orchard et al., 1997).

21.4.2.5 MRJ (magnetic resonance imaging) data


Research carried out by Verrall et al. (2001) assessed han1string muscle injuries
(strains) with MRI to identify risk factors for reinjury. Athletes from three professi-
onal Australian Rules football teams tvith an injury volume greater than 21.8 cm3
were 2.3 times more likely to be reinjured. Furthermore, an MRI-measured injury
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
388 389
lnjury prevention lnjury prevention

transverse size greater than 55% indicated athletes were 2.2 times more likely to be affects the quality of movement, resulting in a need for other structures to com-
reinjured. pensate. This can in retum result in overload and injury. Similar to this, Fong et al.
(2011) found that dorsiflexion ROM restrictions may be associated with a greater
21.4.2.6 Preseason fitness risk of ACL injury.
Players failing to maintain their fitness during the off-season, and therefore starting
the preseason in poor physical fitness, are more prone to injury during preseason. 21.4.2.B Prevíous injury
These players train with other fitter players and consequently suffer from accumu- One of the most cited intrinsic risk factors for lower extremity muscle injury in soc-
lation of fatigue more quickly. These injuries then put them even further behind the cer is a previous injury (Hãgglund et al., 2006; Engebretsen et al., 2010). Players who
other players, leading to a vicious cycle. Leetun et al. (2004) found that decreased experienced a muscle injury in the previous season had increased injury rates of up
leveis of preseason sport-specific training (i.e., less than 18 sessions during presea- to three times when compared with previously uninjured players (Hãgglund et al.,
son) were risk factors for groin strain injury. 2013). Bennell et al. (1998) also found that Australian soccer players with a previ-
ous history of hamstring muscle strain-type injuries were 2.1 times more likely to
21.4.2.7 Flexibi/ity sustain another hamstring injury. Hãgglund and colleagues demonstrated in 2013
Intuition tells us there is a relationship between increased flexibility and decreased that hamstring injury was associated with past calf injury, calf injury with past
incidence of injury in soccer. quadriceps injury, and quadriceps injury with past hamstring injury. The author
suggested that altered running biomechanics caused by the first injury might be an
./' Ankle and knee joint laxity influencing factor. Previous injury has also been related to ankle sprains (Kofotolis
The association between ankle laxity and ankle injury is unclear. Several studies, et ai., 2007) and groin injury (Arnason et ai., 2004).
however, have shown a relation between knee laxity and knee injury. Ramesh et al.
(2005) found that anterior cruciate ligament injury is more common in those with An increased risk of incurring the sarne type of injury in subjects with a history
joint laxity, particularly those with hyperextension of the knee. Myer et al. (2008) of injury can be due to several reasons. These include inadequate rehabilitation,
confirmed these findings >vhen they found that a positive measure of knee hyper- muscle strength impairment, muscle imbalance, diminished muscle flexibility, the
extension increased fivefold the odds of anterior cruciate ligament injury in female presence of scar tissue, and functional instability (Engstrom, 1998). Several studies
athletes. identified a premature return to play as an injury risk factor. Ekstrand and Gillquis
(1983) found that players who were inadequately rehabilitated, or ;vho returned
./ Muscle tightness prematurely to a pre-injury levei of competition, were at increased risk of suffering
Poor flexibility has been identified as an intrinsic risk factor for lower extremity an identical injury. Finally, a previous injury is a good predictor for identifying a
muscle injury (Ibrahim et al., 2007; Bradley et al., 2007; Witvrouw et ai., 2003). ;veak zone. The fact that a player frequently sustains an injury in the sarne zone
A meta-analysis by Freckleton and Pizzato (2013) did not find a significant rela- shows that the zone in question could be a weak link. Extensive screening can
tionship between AI<E (active knee extension) test results and hamstring injury, expose the various risk factors.
although the relationship was approaching significance. The PKE (passive knee
extension) test was not related to hamstring injuries. Watsford et ai. (2010) demon- 21.4.2.9 H:Q ratio
strated that mean hamstring musculotendinous stiffness and mean leg stiffness ln general, the evidence for the isokinetic H:Q ratio being an intrinsic risk factor for
were greater in AFL players who subsequently incurred a hamstring muscle strain- hamstring muscle strain-type injuries is scarce and unclear. Although the H:Q ratio
type injury. has been identified as a risk factor, the speeds (60, 90, 180 degree/ sec) at which sig-
nificance levels are found are contradictory. Bennell et al. (1998) found H:Q ratios
./ Range of motion (ROM) could not predict hamstring muscle strain-type injuries, despite measuring ratios at
Reduced hip extension ROM (or reduced hip flexor Iength) is associated with ham- varying speeds. ln conflict to these findings, Yeung et al. (2009) demonstrated that
string injury (Gabbe et al., 2006a,). This research showed that for each 1 degree the likelihood of hamstring muscle strain-type injuries increased wíth a decrease
increase on the modified Thomas test (i.e., decreasing hip flexor flexibility), the in the concentric H:Q ratio at 180 degree/sec. A ratio of less than 0.6 was found
likelihood of hamstring muscle strain-type injury increased by 15% in players aged to increase injury risk by 17 times. ln another interesting study by Croisier et al.
25 or more. (2008), an imbalance profile (a player who has a deficit on two or more isokinetic
tests) was an effective method of identifying injury-prone players.
Excessive mobility in the joints-such as the ankle, knee and hip-can give rise
to an excessive range of movement in the joint, possibly causing injury. Limited
mobility (e.g., in the hip or ankle joint) can also increase a player's susceptibility
to injury (Fong et al., 2011). Due to the asymmetric Ioad in soccer, the mobility of
the joints can be limited by muscle tension on one particular side of the body. This
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
390 391
lnjury prevention lnjury prevention

21.4.2.10 Quadríceps and hamstring peak torque 21.4.2.14 Limb dominance


A meta-analysis (Freckleton et al., 2013) demonstrated that an increase in qua<lri- In soccer, the dominant kicking leg may be at increased risk of injury because it is
ceps peak torque is an intrinsic risk factor for hamstring muscle strain-type inju- preferentially used for kicking. Quadriceps and groin injuries were more frequent
ries. On the other hand, the study did not support hamstring peak torque as a risk in the dominant leg, probably because of a greater volume of shooting and pas-
factor for hamstring muscle strain-type injuries. Bennell et al. (1998) also studied sing / crossing actions by the dominant leg, resulting in injury (Hãgglund et al.,
eccentric hamstring peak torque, but they did not find any significant difference 2013). Moreover, limb dominance may result in lingering muscle imbalances in soc-
between groups. cer players. This could lead to an increased likelihood of injury, and unbalanced
strength between the dominant and non-dominant legs has been found in soccer
21.4.2.11 Eccentric strength players (Rahnama et ai., 2005). Ekstrand and Gillquist (1983) found that the domi-
Engebretsen et al. (2010) found that a simple eccentric strength test was unrelated nant leg sustained significantly more ankle injuries (92.3%) than the non-dominant
to an increased risk of hamstring muscle strain-type injuries. leg in male soccer players. This was also reflected in a study of Barker et al. (1997)
that found limb dominance to be a risk factor for ankle sprains. No significant dif-
21.4.2.12 Bodymassindex ferences were detected in the number of hamstring injuries between the dominant
The body mass index (BMI), or Quetelet index, is a measure for human body shape and non-dominant legs in various publications (Verrall et al., 2006; Henderson et
based on an individual's mass and height. It is defined as the individual's body ai., 2010).
mass divided by the square of the individual's height, with the value being univer-
sally given in units ofkg/m2. 21.4.2.15 Fatigue
Fatigue has been identified in the literature as a component in the occurrence of
mass (kg) muscle injury (Worrell, 1994; Garrett, 1996), especia11y since muscle injuries occur
BMI = more frequently to\vard the end of matches (Hawkins et al., 1993).
(height (m))'
21.4.2.16 Aerobic fitness
Gabbe et al. (2006) sho\ved that a BMI of more than 25 was associated with ham- Chomiak et ai. (2000) clearly showed that diminished physical fitness is a risk fac-
string muscle strain-type injuries. BMI is inaccurate as a measure of body compo- tor for all injuries in a group of male soccer players. Poor aerobic fitness can induce
sition in soccer. For example, tall and muscular players may score high BMI levels, fatigue, leading to a reduction in the protective effects of the musculature on joints.
incorrectly rating them as being too fat. For example, a player with a BMI of 26
may have a body fat percentage of just 8%. This player then has a very high muscle 21.4.2.17 Psycl1ological factors
mass, so a high BMI is not necessarily a problem. However, a high BMI does give Ivarsson and Johnson (2010) examined psychological factors as predictors of injury.
rise to a greater mechanical load on the joints. A change of direction can cause a The researchers found that increased injury risk among junior soccer players was
load equal to five times the body weight. predicted by ineffective coping skills, such as worry. Other ineffective coping skills
Fousel<ls et ai. (2013) found that players with higher BM!s had a significantly higher shown in the literature are self-blame, behavioral disengagement and denial (Ans-
risk of non-contact ankle sprain. This might be because the ankle joint absorbs the hel and Sutarso, 2007; Lane et ai., 2004).
mechanical loads produced through the constant interaction of the player with the
ground and their opponents (Ekstrand and Tropp, 1990). This could make the joint Smith et al. (1993) identified a number of physical and psychosocial variables as
susceptible to injuries. Similarly, Tyler et ai. (2006) identified increased weight and predictors of injury: levei of participation, type of sport, age, previous injury, pre-in-
BMI as intrinsic risk factors for ankle sprains. Players with a high BMI might also jury stress, mood state scales, and self-esteem. Moreover, they found significant
have shorter playing careers than those with a lower BMI due to the mechanical load post-injury increases for depression and anger, whereas vigor was significantly less
accumulated during their careers, which can lead to chronic injuries such as oste- after ínjury (Smith et ai., 1993). Williams and Andersen (1998) have proposed inter-
oarthritis. Even after their careers end, these players often have to contend with the ventions for reducing injury risk. They suggest an athlete can decrease the risk
consequences of years of high mechanical Ioads. of injury by lessening his susceptibility to the effects of different stressors. Recent
research by Ivarsson et al. (2013) demonstrated that injury occurrence was signi:fi-
21.4.2.13 Functional asymmetry cantly associated with both the initial levei of daily hassle and the change in daily
A difference between the left and right side of the body is an indication of asymme- hassle.
try. This is often sport-specific because of a one-sided load, or it may be the result
of an incomplete rehabilitation or a persisting injury. A difference of more than
10-15% represents an increased risk. Correction of muscle imbalances at preseason
has been found to decrease the likelihood of hamstring injury in soccer players
(Croisier et ai., 2008).
[ FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
392 393
lnjury prevention lnjury prevention

21.4.3 lnjury prevention and intrinsic risk factors 21.4.4 Screening: lnjury-prevention strategy
There are two ways of reducing the effects of intrinsic risk factors. The first approach The importance of preventing injuries in sports is evident when considering the
entails measuring these risk factors and setting up a specific program to eliminate disabling consequences, personal grief and high financial cost caused by these inju-
deficits or maladaptations. It does need to be considered that working on one iso- ries (Dallinga et al., 2012). Ultimately, a screening is set up to identify the risk of
lated risk factor is often not sufficient to avoid injury. Injuries occur through the injury within an athlete. In order to reduce this risk by means of correcting the
interaction between different risk factors. Working in an isolated way is therefore weak link, individualized injury-prevention strategies are mandatory. Thinking
less efficient than eliminating the deficiencies and imbalances through functional outside the box, and thus beyond the local injury level, is imperative when for-
exercise therapy that targets more than a local area or one single risk factor. mulating an adequate injury-prevention program. This principie is supported by
Another method at a lower level, which is particularly feasible for youth players, various findings, such as the empirical findings of Dr. Müller-Wohlfahrt, the club
is a general program based on the specific demands of the sport and the typical doctor at Bayern Munich, which showed the implication of the spine in 90% of
maladaptation caused by playing soccer. Maladaptation is an adjustment of the muscular problems (Vazei, 2013). The importance of assessing beyond the local
body caused by one-sided training. The advantage of this is that players can be injury level is also in accordance with other research (Panayi et al., 2009; Fox et al.,
given a general program, thus freeing up time to work with the most injury-prone 2006; Hoskins et ai., 2005; Woods et a!., 2004).
players on an individual basis. An example of maladaptation in soccer players is Ekstrand et al. (2011) found four major muscle groups to account for more than 90%
the relatively weak knee flexors (hamstrings) as opposed to the knee extensors of all injuries in soccer, among which the hamstring muscle was the most affected.
(quadriceps ). Taking this into consideration, an appreciation of neuromuscular connections, as
A good initiative in this context was introduced by FIFA under the FIFA 11 and well as an overall lumbar-pelvic structural assessment, is recommended as part
FIFA 11+. The intention was to offer 11 simple exercises (10 + fair play) to clubs of the screening to help resolve chronic hamstring problems (Panayi et al., 2009;
of all levels and players of all ages. This enables players to work on stability, pro- Woods et al., 2004). A possible clarification is the significant role the biomechanics
prioception, core stability, eccentric hamstring strength, and so on. These exercises of the sacroiliac joint and hip, along with lumbar-pelvic stability and alignment,
are easy to do and require little equipment. Nevertheless, it has evidently proved play in hamstring function and thus the injury mechanism (Hoskins et al., 2005;
difficult to implement these exercises in practice. In this regard, the FIFA 11 + antici- Woods et al., 2004). Many other aspects can be assessed, providing significant inju-
pated offering a standardized warm up incorporating all these exercises in a dyna- ry-prevention information (Dallinga et al., 2012). The selection of tests, however,
mic manner. This means that ali coaches can plan this into their training or match will depend on multiple variables, such as the specific sports epidemiology, time,
warming up on a regular basis without negatively affecting training with the ball. and means at hand.
At the top international levei, injury-prevention programs are, of course, set up on In order to implementa successful screening protocol, a frequent and equally timed
the basis of individual player profiles. Based on thorough screening at the start of set of tests should be performed. These should ideally be rated by the sarne person
the season, the individual injury-prone zones are set out together with the most to enhance intra-rater and inter-rater reliability respectively. A frequent testing pro-
important intrinsic risk factors. After a certain time, the screening is repeated, so gram enables a baseline to be established. As such, new values can be compared
it can be objectively evaluated \vhether a player has improvedor not in relation to with the purpose of deciding whether an athlete is at risk of injury and requires an
particular physical parameters. additional individualized injury-prevention program.

21.5 EXTRINSIC RISK FACTORS

21.5.1 Away games


Hagglund et al. (2013) demonstrated that match play on away grounds was asso-
ciated with reduced rates of adductor and hamstring injuries.

21.5.2 Effect of changes in the score


Ryynanen et al. (2013) exanüned the effect of changes in the score on injury inci-
dence during the 2002, 2006 and 2010 FIFA World Cups. The researchers found an
extensive variation in incidence of injury related to changes in the score during mat-
ches of international men's soccer. Injury incidence was lowest (54.8/1000 match-
hours [mh]) during the initial 0-0 score and highest (81.2/ 1000 mh) when the score
was even but goals had been scored. Players in a winning team run a higher risk of
suffering an injury than players in a drawing or losing team.
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER 1
394 395
lnjury prevention lnjury prevention

21.5.3 Effect of PGDJs 21.5.6 Injuries caused by opponents (foul play)


Ryynãnen et al. (2013) investigated the association between potentially game-dis- Ryynãnen et al. (2013) compared the incidence and characteristics of foul play inju-
rupting incidents (PGDis)-such as red and yellow cards, goals, and injuries-and ries and non-foul injuries. They demonstrated that the number of injuries was asso-
the injury incidence in soccer during three FIFA World Cups in 2002, 2006 and 2010. ciated with the number of fouls in a match. The length of absence resulting from
Official match statistics were obtained for all the matches played in the three tour- foul play injuries was significantly shorter than that of non-foul injuries.
naments. They concluded that the injury incidence was significantly higher during Two mechanisms leading to ankle sprains have been found that are thought to be
match periods within a minute of, or during a five-minute period following, a yel- specific to soccer.
low or red card, another injury, ora goal (PGDis) than during other match periods. 0 Player-to-player contact with impact by an opponent on the medial aspect of
the leg, just before or at foot strike, resulting in a laterally directed force cau-
21.5.4 Synthetic grass and floor surface sing the player to land with the ankle in a vulnerable, inverted position.
Some research into the impact of synthetic grass has been funded by its manu- ° Forced plantar flexion where the injured player hits the opponent's foot when
facturers. Additionally, the results in current literature are contradictory. For these attempting to shoot or clear the ball (Andersen et al., 2004).
reasons, it is difficult to evaluate the effects of synthetic grass. What is certain, It is said that 18-31% of all match injuries stem from fouls during a match. Depen-
however, is that the first and second generations of synthetic grass involved a gre- ding on the study, 76-100% of these injuries are caused by opponents.
ater risk of injury because of the lack of shock absorption and the larger impact on Astrid Junge indicated in one of her studies that almost all players were prepared
joints caused by greater surface stiffness. Zanetti et al. (2013) found that in slalom, to commit a professional foul if they felt it was necessary. The majority of them said
artificial grounds produced higher horizontal peak accelerations compareci to this was all part of the game.
natural ground. Orchard et al. (2003) proposed playing on artificial turf as one of
the primary extrinsic risk factors of ankle sprains. 21.5.7 Protective equipment
Nowadays, we see more and more synthetic grass pitches in youth academies. Shin guards are compulsory during matches. However, shin guards are not wom
Hughes et ai. (2013) found only small differences in the ability to perform certain in training sessions at all clubs. Nevertheless, this preventive measure can help
movements when comparing artificial and natural surfaces, concluding that fati- reduce the number of contact injuries (contusions).
gue and physiological responses to soccer activity do not differ markedly between
surface type when using the high-quality pitches of the present study. 21.5.8 Appropriate footwear
Nevertheless, players must always take care when they switch from one surface to When changing shoe brand, type or size, the feet will need time to adapt. Traditio-
another. The stiffness of a surface affects impact forces, and this may result in over- nally, the old shoes are replaced at the end of the season. Preseason is then started
load to the joints and tendons. Friction is necessary, however, for rapid starting, with new shoes on hard ground and a higher number of training sessions. This
accelerating, stopping, cutting, and pivoting, all of which are inherent to soccer. results in players with foot problems and injuries every year.
This mechanical overload could affect injury incidence. A change of surface creates It is often suggested that the man-shoe-surface interaction is a major problem in
a different load, and this change in load can partially be responsible for the discom- soccer injuries, but until now, there is little evidence that using different commer-
fort experienced among players. Consider this at the start of the season, when the cially available soccer shoes can influence the risk of injury. ln this regard, Gehring
pitches are hard, or during rainy or snowy weather. Ali of these circumstances and et al. (2007) compared soccer shoes with round and bladed studs. No significant
conditions create a different load. Players often indicate after training sessions or differences in externally applied knee joint loads during a complex injury-related
matches on synthetic pitches that they have problems in the area of the adductors, movement were found. The significant increased activation of quadriceps femoris
calves and hamstrings. As always, the body must be given time to adapt to a diffe- with round studs during the criticai weight acceptance can be associated with an
rent type of load. Given the friction that occurs between the shoes and the surface, additional internai load on the anterior cruciate ligament. The researchers conclude
as well as the fact that synthetic grass allows fewer rotations, the knee joínt and that there is no higher risk of suffering non-contact knee joint injuries with bladed
ankle are more susceptible to injury on synthetic grass. Wearing specially adapted soccer shoes. Galbusera et al. (2013) found that studded and bladed cleats did not
foohvear for playing on synthetic grass can reduce this friction. significantly differ in their interaction with the playing surface.

21.5.5 Weather conditions 21.5.9 Ankle bracing and taping


A temperature of 14-lSºC is ideal for playing soccer. If it is warmer, dehydration There is a general consensus in the literature that ankle taping or bracing decrea-
can then give rise to muscle injuries. If it is colder, the muscles can cool down, ses the Jikelihood of ankle injury (Sitler et ai., 1994; Tropp et ai., 1985). Engstrom
making them more susceptible to injury. Insufficient hydration or a Jack of glyco- (1998) suggests that the use of anlde braces could possibly increase the kinesthe-
gen affects performance. Only 2% dehydration, possibly caused by hot weather, tic awareness of the ankle and increase support to the joint by limiting hind foot
can give rise to a 20% decrement in performance. motion, specifically inversion. ln recent years, scientific authors have highlighted
the importance of combining proprioception and stability exercises together with
preventive taping or bracing.
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
396 lnjury prevention lnjury prevention 1397

21.5.10 Preseason 21.6 GENERAL INJURY PREVENTION FOR SOCCER PLAYERS


Hãgglund et al. (2013) reported that quadriceps injuries were more frequent during Every soccer player has, at some time, been sidelined for a short or long period
preseason, whereas adductor, hamstring, and calf injury rates increased during the because of injury. It is an intrinsic element of contact sports that players have to
competitive season. ln a study by Stevenson et al. (2000), the incidence of injury miss matches because of injuries caused by tackles and other contact. The coach can
was related to the time of season. ln a study of recreational sports (Australian foot- never completely avoid this sihtation. On the other hand, many non-contact and
ball, field hockey, basketball, and netball), the researchers found that injury inci- avoidable injuries also occur. These injuries are caused when players with particu-
dence to the lower extremity was highest in the first four weeks of the season. lar intrinsic risk factors are lined up in training sessions and/ or matches. Firstly,
There are two possible reasons for this. Firstly, preseason is typically the time when more attention has to be paid to the real cause of injuries, especially where recur-
physical fitness needs to be rebuilt. Therefore, the workload imposed during these ring injuries are concerned. ln the chapter on functional training, it "\Vas mentioned
first few weeks is higher than during the season. Players "\Vith poor physical fitness that the body works like a chain and that any difference in mobility betvveen joints
are especially susceptible to injury. Another cause of this increased incidence of or muscles has an influence elsewhere in the chain. For this reason, injury-preven-
injuries is the detrained state of some players. Even with a normal load, these play- tion programs may be general, but they first need to be adapted to the player in
ers will sustain injuries more easily. ln the mid-season break (off-season), it is the- question.
refore important for players to maintain their aerobic fitness and avoid detraining. The second point that needs attention in the prevention of injuries is training in
On the other hand, it is important in preseason to measure aerobic fitness and then the transition zones. These are also described in the chapter on functional strength
optimize and adjust/individualize the training program accordingly. training. These are the zones where most of the muscle injuries occur. The muscles
are stretched to the maximum, with rapid transitions from eccentric to concentric
21.5.11 End of lhe season contractions. The more flexible and stronger the muscles are, the less chance there
A series of interesting shtdies by Tim Gabbett have shown that it is easier to sustain is of trauma being caused during eccentric movements. Injury-prevention exercises
an injury in the second half of the season when compared with the sarne load at the should be part of the daily training program, either incorporated into the warm up
start of the season. lt is not entirely clear why this occurs. It could be dueto (neural) for pitch training or during a specific session in the fitness room.
fatigue ora lack of concentration after a long season. Injuries to four major muscle groups of the lower extremity-adductors, ham-
strings, quadriceps, and calf muscles-account for more than 90% of all muscle
21.5.12 Skill level injuries in professional soccer (Ekstrand et aL, 2011). Hamstring and groin muscle
Numerous studies have investigated strain-type injuries are common in sports that involve sprinting, acceleration, dece-
the association behveen skill level and leration, rapid changes in direction, and jumping (Drezner, 2003; Estvvanik et al.,
the likelihood of injury. The results 1990; Orchardetal., 1997; Smodlaka, 1980). Hamstring injuries are also recorded as
are contradictory, however, and need the most common of all injuries, resulting in an average of four missed games per
further investigation. Petterson et al. injury (Hawkins et al., 2001). To establish prevention programs, it is important to
(2000) shtdied the association bet- identify risk factors associated with the occurrence of injury, preferably using ana-
ween skill level and injury in male soc- lysis accounting for the multifactorial causes of injury (Meeuwisse, 1994). We will
cer players. They demonstrated that focus now on the most important injuries-namely hamstring, quadriceps, calf and
young players \vith low skill levels had groin strains, and ankle sprains-since these injuries account for the majority of all
twice the incidence of all injuries as a injuries in soccer.
group when compared to more skilled
players. 21.6.1 Hamslrings
The hamstrings are a bi-articular muscle group, consisting of the semitendinosus,
21.5.13 Posilion on lhe field semimembranosus and biceps femoris muscles. Classic anatomy teaches us that
ln soccer, goalkeepers sustain signi- the principal functions of the hamstrings are hip extension and knee flexion. ln
ficantly fe\ver injuries than outfield soccer and for movement in general, they are primarily called on for restraining
players, but they are more prone to hip flexion and knee extension, like in the swinging out phase when kicking and/
upper-limb injuries, particularly shoul- or sprinting, often from an extended position. Muscles cannot, relatively speaking,
der injuries (Woods et al., 2004). produce much from an extended position. This is often the case in soccer, however,
resulting in muscles such as the hamstrings being susceptible to injury.
Depending on the type of activity, a trauma can occur in the area of the biceps
femoris (resulting from a cyclical exercise, such as a max sprint) or the semí-mem-
branosus muscle (resulting from strain or hyperextension, such as when kicking).
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
398
Jnjury prevention lnjury prevention 1399

The gluteus maximus is the most important muscle group for restraining hip core exercises to elicit greater muscle activation of, among others, the abdominal
flexion and the primary extensor of the hip. These actions are used in numerous muscles than isolated exercises such as crunches (Gottschall et al., 2013). Flexion
rnovements in soccer, such as taking off to jump, a powerful change of direction, of the hip when upright or moving is generated automatically by gravity, with
and restraining a kicking movement. Because of their location and attachn1ent, the body playing more of an active role in restraining this movement. Soccer play-
these muscles are called on in virtually every movement as a stabilizer. Power- ers have to be stable when moving, and they have to be able to return to a stable
ful, well-developed glutei are the basis for a strong athlete. If this muscle group is position after being thro\vn off balance. The core muscles and the pelvic region are
11.;eakened or does not respond to movement in time, other muscle groups-such essential in this regard. Training these muscles with dynamic core stability exerci-
as the hamstrings, tvhich are mobilizers-compensate for this, and this can lead to ses and unconscious movements will make the soccer player better in this regard.
overload and injury. It is therefore important to train both the gluteus group and Given the asymmetric characteristics of soccer, the rotation component is of huge
the hamstrings eccentrically (eventually in a lengthened position) and in synergy, importance. This must therefore be anticipated.
so they are better able to cope with this load. Soccer players also need to frequently deal with overload injuries and hypertonia
of the hip flexors. It is once again important to know that these muscles are mainly
21.6.2 Adductors activated in arder to produce concentric movements (e.g., when kicking the ball,
Hamstring and adductor problems are among the most common injuries in soc- taking throw-ins, heading and running). The sarne principies also apply here: Train
cer players. Adductor injuries often occur because of the load around the hip joint as much as possible in an upright, dynamic and functional manner. In addition, it
being high during a match, such as when a player shoots for goal or changes direc- is important to keep in mind that tightness of the posterior pelvic muscle chain is
tion at high speed, as well as \vhen playing on slippery ground when the adductors possibly restraining the concentric movement of the hip flexors.
are constantly adjusting in order to find stability. The adductors are subjected to a
repetitive high load due to the asymmetric movements in soccer and the typical 21.6.4 Joint sense
kicking motion. Good core stability and correct strength ratios betvveen the diffe- Cruciate ligament injuries with or without contact with an opponent are also res-
rent muscles of the lower limbs and eccentric tendon training will reduce the risk ponsible for a large portion of player unavailability. A major risk factor in this
of injury. regard is the instability of the knee that can be induced through proximal instabi-
lity or ankle instability. The mechanism behind most cruciate ligament injuries is
21.6.3 Pelvic girdle often the torsion or tvvisting of the knee \vhen landing after a heading duel or \vhen
The pelvis is the central point of the body \Vhere a large number of muscles have changing direction.
their origin or points of attachment. The pelvic girdle is involved in just about Joint sense provides the soccer player \Vith information about his own body, such
every movement in soccer. A soccer player therefore sustains many injuries in this as where, andin whatstate, various parts of the body are. Italso indicates fatigue or
region. The risk of injuries is reduced if the muscles are well developed in this alertness of the connective tissue, such as the muscles and ligaments. As previously
region. We often see injuries in soccer players in the form of pubalgia, overloading stated, the proprioceptors are called on constantly when a player is in motion. Any
of the adductors or hip flexors, or tendonitis of the abdominal muscles. form of training is proprioceptive training. Functional injury-prevention exercises
We also often see injuries in the area of the lower central abdominal muscles and/ help to train the proprioceptors with regard to activating the necessary muscles
or at the common attachment point for the adductors. These can be caused by an quickly and correctly in arder to contrai a particular movement or return from an
imbalance between the upward and oblique strength of the abdominal muscles unstable position. This trains unconscious reactions and increases body awareness.
(on the pubis) and the downward and lateral pulling force of the adductors (on All of the above helps to prevent injuries. Exercises can be made more challenging
the pubis inferior). Pain in this region can also result from biomechanical or arti- and more difficult by, for example, working on unstable surfaces, closing the eyes,
cular imbalances in the rest of the body, causing more stress to be exerted on this or distracting a player by throwing him a ball.
region and making these muscles work harder than expected. Examples of this Hübscher and Refshauge (2013) published a review on the effectiveness of neuro-
include differences in leg length and differences in mobility between the right and muscular training for the prevention of sports injuries in athletes. Their pooled
left ankle. The performing of extreme abductions can also lead to chronic microt- analyses revealed that multi-intervention exercises (comprising balance and agility
rauma and cause pain. training, stretching, plyometrics, running exercises, cutting and landing technique,
The lateral (internai and externai) abdominal muscles and the transversus abdo- and strength training) significantly reduced the relative risk of lower-limb injuries,
minis ensure stabilization of the torso when running, as well as helping to create acute knee injuries, and ank.le sprain injuries.
the strength needed for kicking, throw-ins and heading. They are therefore of great
importance. Isokinetic tests show that when compared with the back muscles, the
abdominal muscles are weaker (ratio of 70%) in most soccer players than the expec-
ted average (ratio of 75%).
ln addition, it is not sufficient to train the abdominal muscles with concentric
movements, such as classic crunches. ln fact, research has shown the integration of
Touch & Raise /!;
- StiJrliooPruil.km: o

-
Star.doncnefoct
-Aclkm:
Toutll the ground with ywr lunds, rat>etl'w?m uph-ij!h and lift 'j{)Ur oth!>r kMe ~
Full name- Birth year .::!. =i
"'1-leg starn:ewith arms and rontrall!ercl koee rniSed
-En&ngPosilion:
~~
lmporUmt: ".., V>
V>
Fk!x tlm kr~ of tl'w? star.dir.g !eg a ~ttle bit "' -z
§" V>
REPS: lOxeach leg "·o
o ()
1. Prom~ elbowtouth ~ ()
- SlartiooPosilion: m
2.
3.
HandandfootstaJ1(e
"'
4.
5.
"""""'
Tootll tlle elbowwitlltt..2 llomolalernl kn!!'e
-End!hg Positkm:
Harnlar.d 1-!oot stance pruillon 11;itll the other leg lx!ndedL'jl frc-nl touch!r;g
theelbcw
6. lmoortant:
Keep tl'w? b3tk- buttocks-leg ln one fim. ar.d do not louchllm ground,,.,ith
thelxmOOd leg. Toperformwitllallfghspeed.

REPS: lOxl!ach knee up front


Oyrlãmic lun;e Superman
- stcrthgPruitioo: -Stcrliooi'Dsilkm:
standononefoot Handandfoot5tar.ce
-Actioo; -Adioo:
Toucll the groumlwitllywr lla.-.6, ralsethem upW_zh and ~fl \'Ollí otherknee U!t ooe arrnand lhe oppo:;ite leg frorn theground
-EndfnqPosil.km:
""
-End!hg PruiUoo:
1-~5tancewittiarrnsarulC<Jr,tralatercilmeernt>ed
Dlafionat l·h:mdarul 1-foot starn.:eposlHonwitll theother llpp!'rand lower
limb$Mled hwizor.tal
lmportant: lmoortant:
Fli!~ llm ~ cf füe standlng lega !ittle bi1 Oooot rota te tlv.! Mps and tnml< whenfoc'>iri;g contactwith lhe grcur.d

REPS: lOxeach leg REPS: 10)teach d13Gona!


Oynamit:Side bridge Prone Butterfly
-5/crfinql'tJ$ítioo: -5tllt1.im!Pruilion:
:,:ae Drl(ll1:e forearm prultlonwitlltlle fitet on top of eacllothel Prcne posltlon witll tt-.earms aklng lhe l:o&f and lhe ~gs la&ether lf.tedfrorn
-Atlion: thegrouml
Ufltlle hl;:-s up as l'\!gll as posslb'.e tobecorr~ a >lraigllt Hnew>111 lhe bod"f -Action:
-Endioo Pmitirn: Spr~adtM legs andbrlr.g tt.earms upwards uptoabcve lhe he3d
Flll!y (O',>;<r}l!xtend?d5ide brk!ge ..fndinqPosil.ion:
lmoortant: Prooe posltlon Witllthe arm; together abave lhe h<!ad and lhe legs op!!n and
Keep one straisr.t tne withlegs- buttod:s - b;ick,. avo!d l!ip fuxioo Mtedfrom thegrouod
lrnporta11t:
Oooot lookup. Klillplhelegs ~·fted.

REPS: 10xead1 :1ide REPS:lOx

V-Squatting
-StcrtiooPasilkm:
Open otar.ce witll toes pcintinr. outside
-Aclkm:
Clapthe lur.ds bellind tlle b;ick, sit dm1m as d!2ep as possihk~ wi!llout ~fting
Full name- Birth year heels from t!N! gioundand tooch lhe ground at the line of lhe fl(>e!s.
)'Ol-'f
- EmJiooP05itioo:
Ma,;irmilsquattedpcsfllon
lmtJOTl.ool:
IIBeplhe kmm> pcintlng m lhe same directionas til-!! foot.

REPS:lSx
1. Supine abduction
2. -StottiooPosilicn:
SUpme witll the legs crossed anti liftedfrom the groond
3. U/Ult;".'t; oextenSIDn
-Attkvi:
4. Spreadlhe !egs op!!n as wideas prusib!e
- flldjoo eruITToo;
5. Suplne with the ~ll.S lifted frnm lhe ground ar.d rnoximJI spread. Ho!dtll!;
6. pcsltKITTfor3".
lmportmit:
Uft the shou!ders a little bit from lhe ground and 1ook up

REPS: lOx
Quadruped Hip extenslon Supine knee ltfting
-Slarti:iaPositkm: -StartinoPositioo:
Handar.d knee star.ce, botll nipar.d kr~e jci/11: ln S<t f'.e~fon, wltlla fbt back .supmewitllllm k&:.esbendedin SO' andbotll feeta titt~bit IJledfrorn tlle
-Aclirm: ground
Uftooe !egs:k;wlyup wh!!ekeep:ng tlle<JO'ber.d ai tt.ek~, up to fu!I h!p -Aclkm:
extimsKm IJft alternately 1 krn::-e above lhe ti;ps (slow tempo)
-Endinq Positioo: -fm!ioo Position:
Hand and 1-lmee stancewi!llthe atfü:-r !i'g bernkd ln ti;p extensiO!l Stlpir.e witlll legill S-O'withthefootjustabo'>'e theground& theotherleg
~~ lmportmit: hiledllj'.l toS-0' ln b-Otllhip and!meê jcir.ts
=e-:.
a;:= Do not rotate the hipar tnmk lffiJlortant:
u~ lhe shou,'ders a little bit

"""'=
m ,.,_ ~

::;
~= REPS: lOxeach leg REPS:lOxeach !eg
ª ...
E;~ - Stcrtinq Positicn·
1-ltigSquat
-StrzrtiooPositioo:
Supine plirik-IC61ifting .â:~
e "'
Standooonefoot supme p!arlk Mtll lhe shoulders and heel.s oo tlle groond, theb-Jttocks lifted
m "" -Adion: from the ground and the anm cre>sed cwerlhe trunl: "
~z
V>

"""'
~;g
B1md down the knee toa maxõmurn where lhe 5upportmg foct stiU CJn IR! kept
flatonthegrooru.l
-Aclioo:
Raf:leam! bend altemritel'(ooe leg with fui!'( hp flexloo "
;§ V>
o
-EmJimi Pmitkm:
~~
-Endinq/lo$1tkm: ~ ()

e!º
1-leg rnJxklul bemkd staoce Witll the ctber leg L'jl fmrn tlm ground S\!pine p!ank wi1h 1 leg benck">d uJM·ards witll the !mee & hip ln SO'
g. ~
tmportant:
Keep the knei'! pol11!íng ffl the sarne d<ri;ctlon as thefoot. oo not letthe kn~
buckt.:i lr1wards.
rmvortant:
Kl*pthe buttrn:ks m;ixlrnaliyliftedfrom theground ~ "'
REPS: lOxeat:h leg REPS: lOxeach leg ..../!;
1 FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
402 lnjury prevention /njury prevention 1403

21.7 INJURY-PREVENTION PROGRAMS


Targeted, efficient injury prevention involves finding a balance behveen a player's
load tolerance and the load imposed on the player. Injuries can be reduced by incre-
asing a player's load tolerance and individualizing the traíning load to the needs
of the player. The player's load tolerance can be divided into general load tolerance
and local load tolerance. General load tolerance comprises a player's general physi-
cal fitness, determined from a variety of physical abilities. Basic fitness also inclu-
des the quantity and quality of sleep, as well as other psychosocial factors, such as
stress, personal situation and fatigue. The general load tolerance can be increased
by influencing these factors.

Local load tolerance relates to specific zones of the body. This local load tolerance is
built up from the interaction between the different intrinsic risk factors per zone. It
is a fact that one isolated intrinsic risk factor can be compensated for by other fac-
tors that have an influence on that particular zone. Intrinsic risk factors and imba-
lances can be eliminated via targeted, individual injury-prevention programs. The
scientific literature includes (limited) evidence of preventive programs that have an
effect on intrinsic risk factors. The influence of most interventions is on ankle and
knee stability, as well as hamstring and adductor strength.
The second complementary "vay of avoiding injuries is to individualize and
manage the load imposed on players. This can be done by adapting the training
workload to the individual and applying recovery strategies behveen training ses-
sions and matches.
Workload should be individualized
within the periodization model. The
coach has to create fatigue to allow
the body to adapt to the higher trai-
ning load (overload). During the sarne
~-
microcycle, the coach has to ensure the
players are given adequate recovery
in order to produce an optimum level
of performance. To achieve this, the
accumulated fatigue of the training
week has to be reduced by applying
the right recovery strategies. The reco-
very time is different for each player.
Some players recover from a training
stimulus quickly, while others recover
very slowly. Factors that influence this
recovery include age of the player, and
aerobic fitness status ..

Fig. 21.3: A player's injury risk profife based


on an injury-prevention screening of the
intrinsic risk factors. Body zones at risk are
high/ighted (Screenshot TopSportsLab).
FITNESS IN SOCCER
FITNESS IN SOCCER
4041 lnjury prevention lnjury prevention 1405

21.7.1 Effectiveness of injury~prevention programs


Laursen et al. (2013) investigated the effectiveness of exercise interventions to pre-
vent sporting injuries. Their meta-analysis analyzed 25 trials, including 26,610 par-
ticipants with 3,464 injuries. The study showed no beneficial effects of stretching,
whereas studies •vith multiple exposures, proprioception training. and strength
training showed a tendency toward an increasing effect. Strength training redu-
ced sports injuries to less than a third, and overuse injuries \Vere almost halved.
They concluded that both acute injuries and overuse injuries could be reduced
through the use of injury-prevention programs. Their findings were also confirmed
by Owen et al. (2013), who examined the effectiveness of a structured injury-pre-
vention program on the number of muscle injuries and the total number of injuries
within elite professional soccer. The study was conducted over two consecutive
seasons, of which the first (2008-2009) was the intervention season and the second
(2009-2010) was the control season. The training program was performed twice
weekly for the entirety of the season (58 prevention sessions). Significantly fewer
muscle injuries were observed in this study during the intervention season. The
researchers concluded that a multicomponent injury-prevention training program
may be appropriate for reducing the number of muscle injuries during a season,
but it may not be adequate to reduce all other injuries.

SUMMARY
It is highly important for soccer players to partake in a scientifically sound inju-
ry-prevention program throughout every season of their careers. The medical
staff of clubs should routinely screen their players in order to identify possible
injury risks and to puf in place individual programs to help reduce the occur-
rence of injury. Most importantly, the coach has to periodize training load cor-
rectly throughout the season, because too much, or even too little, training can
predispose the players to injury. Accumulated fatigue should be avoided at all
cost in order to reduce the occurrence of non-contact soft tissue and joint injuries.

REFERENCES
Amar.1! De Nomnh~, M., Borges Jr.. N.G., 200~. Latcr,11 nnklc sprnin: ic.okinctk lcst rcliabihty and comprioon bdw~m mvcrtors and
cvcrtoro. Cim B1omcch (Brir.tol, Avon), 19, pp.863-371.
An~hcl, M.T. and Sutaroo T., 2007, Rclotiom.hips botwC<'n ~ooura-,; of aculc ~!''-"'" and coping stylc• m compclitivc oport ª';a funct10n of

~{~~:~n~.Â~~~~~~~:r;~'. Á.~ci°a~l:e;;.~~-l~Í,a~~~on, E., 1996. Socccr injuricr. in lcdand. Scand / Mcd Sd Sporb, 6(1), pp ..W·S.
i\mur.on, A, Sigurtfaoon, S.B., Gudmundo.;.on, A.. Holmc, !., Engcbrclom, L. und Bohr, R. 200·\, Risk focto,-,; for m1uricc. m footbull. Am J
Sporlo Mcd, 32(1 mpp.), pp.SS-16S.
Bnhr, R. and Kro5õh,1ug. T. 2005. Unden;t,1nding thc ;njury m.,.;honi.~nrn-a hy componcnt 1<• preveni injurie.,; in ~port. llr] Sporto Mcd,
39, pp.32·1-329
IJ,ukcr, H.B., llcynnon, ll.D. ond Hcm;trom, A.EH .. 1997. Anklc injury risk facto,-,; in oporls. Sporto Mcdio11c, 23, pp 69·74.
Baumhauer, /.F., Alos.1, D.M .. Rcnstrüm, P.A., Trcvino, S. ond Ilcynnon, B, 1995. A proopcctivc ~tudy of anklc mjury nnk foctors. Am J
Spori,; Mcd, 23, pp.56-1-570
Bcnndl, K.L., Talbol, R., Wajswdncr, H., Tcchovankh, W. i!nd Kdl)'• D., l<J<JS. lntra.rnlcr and !nlcHcstcr rcliab1hty of a wc•ght bc,oring
!unge· mc;v;urc of anklc doroiílcxion. Auotralian l'hyoiothcr.1py, 2·1(2), pp.211-217
llompa, T.O., l<J<J9. Pcriodiiation: thcory und mcthodology of tr.1mmg,1th cd. ChJmpuii;n, !L: Human Kincliu.
Bradlcy; P.S .. Olwn, P.D. and Porlao, M.D., 2007. Thc dfcct of r.tullc, ballislk, and proprioccptivc neuromuscubr focihtation olrctchmg on
vcrlkal jump performance. J Strcngth Cond Rl>s, 21, pp.223--226.
Chomiak, J., Jungc, A., l'ctcr.:on, L. and Dvor.1k. j., 2000, Sevcrc injuncr. in footbal! pbycn. lnílucndng factors. Arn J Sport,; Mcd,
21\((;uppl 5), pp.S53-6S.
Croi,icr,].L., G,1ntcaumc,S., Binct. /, Gcnty, M., Ferrct,J.M., 2008. Slrength imbalanc..-s a11d prowntian ofham!llring injury in profc~,;iO"­
nal soce<:r playcrn: a proopccli>"c 5tudy. Am. ). Spor\5 Mcd., 36, pp.1469-1475.
FITNESS IN SOCCER FITNESS IN SOCCER
lnjury prevention lnjury preventíon 1407
D.1!linga, /.M., Bcnjaminsc, A. and Lemmink. K., 2012. Which Scrccning T""ls Can !'rcdict lnjury to thc l<lwcr E:<tl'<'milies in Tcam Petcrson, L.,Jungc, A., Chomiak,J., Graf·tlaumann, T. and Dvorak, )., 2000. lncidcncc of footbaU injuri~"-' and rornplainl• in diffcrnnl age
Sports1 ASystcrn«tic Revicw. Sport" M<.'<l, 42(9), pp.;9\-SJS. groups and skil!·lcvd groups.. Am J Sporl'i Mcd, 2B(•uppl 5), pp.SSl-7.
Drawcr, S. and Fullcr, C., 2002. Evaluating thc leve! of injury in English proke;:;ion,1! foolball usíng a risk bascd <iSoes:;mcnt proc=. Br R.1hnarna, N., Lc'l.':I, A. and Bambacdchi. E., 2005.Arornparir.on oi mmclcsl,..,ngth and flcxibllitybcMecn thcdornlnant and non-domi·
J Sporl~ Mcd., 36(6), pp.446-151. 11ant lcg in Englisluoe<:crpfayern. Ergonomíc:;, 48(11-1·11 pp.1568-1575.
Drc~ncr, J.A., 2003. !'rac!knl managcnwnt: harnslring mu.1dc injuri~;. Clinica] joumnl oi Sport Medicine, 13, ppAS-52. Ramcsh. R., Von Anr., O.. Az:zopardi, T. and Schranz, P.J., 2005. Thc ri~k of anterior crud.1te !igamcnt ruplurn with gencrnlir,cd joint faxity.
Ekotrnnd, J. and Gillquiot, J., 1983. The avoid.1bility of soccer injuries. ln!) Sporl~ Mcd, 4, pp.12-1--ll. J llonc Joint Surg Br., 8i(6), pp.S00-3.
Ek;trnnd, J., Gillqufot, J., Mollcr, M,, O~rg, B. and Uljcdahl, S.O., 1933. lncidcnce of r.occcr injuries and thcir rclation lo trnlning and tcam Ry;·n'1ncn, J., Dvorak, J., Pcterson. L., Kautiainen, !-!., Karl=n, J., Jung e. A. and BUrjcsson, M., 2013. lncrca<cd risk of injury followini;
"ucQ>C,,;.AmJ Sportr. Mcd, 11(2), pp.63-7. red and yellow cards, injuries and goals in FIFA World Cups. tlr J Sports Med, ·17, pp.970-973.
Ekl;trnnd, J., Hagglund, M. and Waldcn. M., 2011. Epidcmiology of musclc injurie>s in profossiona! footb.11! (socccr). Am J Sporlo Mcd, Ryyni!ncn, J .. /onge, A., Dvorak, J ., Petcrson, L., Karlsson, J. ,1nd fülrjcsson, M., 2013. The cflcct of changc>J in lhe score on injury incidcncc
39(6), pp.1226-1232. during thrce F!FA World Cups. Br) Sports Mcd, -17, pp.960-9M.
Emcry, C. A., 2003. link foctors for injury in child and adolcsccnt sport: a fiyotcmatic review of lhe lilcratuN. Clinicai Joumal ofSporls Ryyniincn, )., Jungc, A., Dvorak, J .. l'dcrson, L.. Kautiaincn, H .. l<arl.%on, J. and Bürjcs.wn, M., 2013. Foul play is aosociatcd with injury
Medicine, 13, pp.256-268. incidcncc: an cpidcrniologica! study of lh"'~ FIFA \\'orld Cups (2002-2010). BrJ Sports Med, 47, pp.986-991.
Engebrntocn, A.H,, Myklcbust, G., Holrnc, 1., Engcbrntscn, L. nnd lfahr !t, 201(). lntrinsk ri5k foctorJ forharnstring injuries among malc Sitler, M., Ryan, J., Whcclcr, Il., McBride, J.. Ardera, R., Ander<.,on, J.• Horodyski, M .. 199·1. Thc cfficacy of a scmirigid anklc stabiliwr to
socccrp!a)'CrJ: a prospco:livccohort study. AmJ Sports Mcd. 38, pp.1147-1153. reduccarutcankle injuries in baskctl.>all. A randornizcd clinica! study at W.,,;t Point. Am J Sports Med, 22, pp.454-ól.
Eng,trorn, B.K. and Rcnstrom, ?.A., 1993. How can injurics lm prevcntcd in thc World Cup socccr athlcte? Clin Sporls Mcd, 17, pp.755-6!L Smith, A.M .. Stuart, M.J., \Vie'S~~Bjorn<ta!, D.M., Mil!incr, EK, O'Fallon, W.M., Crowson, C.S., 1993. Compctitivc athlclcs: Pn..'- and
Estwanik,J., Sloan<', B. and Rosmbcrg. M., 1990. Causes of groín strain. PhysSporlsrncd, 18, pp.55-60. post-injury mood stale and sc!f-eslcem. MayoClinic Proec<!dings, 68, pp.939-949.
Fong, C.M., Blackbum, /.T., Norcro"s, M.E, McGrnth, M. and Padua, D.A., 2011. Ankle dorniílexion ROM and l;mding biomcchanlC!i. Srnodlaka, V., 1900. Groin pain in socccr playcrn. PhysSportomed. 8, pp.57-61.
Joumal of Athlctic training,·16(1), pp.5-10. Sodennan, K., A!lrcd~on, H .. Pictila, T., ct a!., 2001. Risk foctors for lcg ínjurlcs in fcrnalc soro>r playcrs: a prosP"ctive ínvestigation
Fousckís, K, Tscpis, E. and V.1j)cn.1s, G., 2012 !ntrin>ic risk foc!ors of nono.mtact anklc spr.1iru; in soccct A prosP"ctivc sludy on 100 during onc out-door scason. Knee Surg Sporls Tr~umato! Arthrosc, 9, pp.313-21.
profc::sional players. Am JSports Med. 40, pp.l&\2-50. Stewnson, M.R., Hamer, ?., Finch, C.F., Elliot, B. and ICremow, M., 2000. Sport, ase, and scx spcdfic inddencc of sporu lnjurie:1 in Wcs·
fo,, M., 2006. Elfoct on hamstring !lcxibility of hamstring slretching romparcd to hamstring strdching and s.1croiliac joint manipulation. lemAuslralia. Br JSporls Med, 34{3), pp.lSS-9-1.
Clinicai d1iropractic, 9, pp.21--32. Sulton, K.M. and Bullock, J.M., 2013. Anterior cru date Hgarncnt ruptu"': diffc,..,ncct> bctwecn m.1les and femalcs. J Arn Acad Orthop
Frccklclon, G. and Pizzari. T., 2013. Risk foctom for hamstring musclc strain injury in sport: a systernatic "'víew and rne!a-analrsis. Br J Surg, 21(1), pp.41-50.
Sports Mcd, 47(6). pp.351-358. Thacker, S.B .• Glkhrist, /., Stroup, D.F. and Dcxter, K.C., 200-1. The impact of stretching on sports lnjury riok: a systematic revi e•" of the
Gabbc, B.J., Bcnncll, K.L., Fine!~ C.F., Wajswelner, H. and Orchmd, J.W., .2006. Predictorsofhamstrini; injury at thc elite levei of Austr11- literatu,..,, Med Sei Sports Excrc, 36(3), pp.371·8.
lian footba!l. Scand J Sei Med Sport, 16, pp.7-13. Trojan, T.H. and Mcl<cag. D.B., 2006. Single lcg balance test to identify risk of anklc ~prains. Br J Sports Med, •10, pp.610-614.
Gabbe, B.j., Finch, C.E, W.ijowelncr, H. and Bcnnell, K.L., 2001. p,..,dictorn oflowercxtrernity injurico at lhe rommunity le~·cl of Austra· Tropp, H., Askling. C. and Gillquíst /., 1985. p,..,vcnlion of anklespmiw.AmJ Sports Mcd, 13, pp.259-62.
lian foolball. ClinJ Sport Mcd, 14(2), pp.5\i-63. Tropp, H., Ekstrand, J. and Gillqui51, /., 19&1. Stabllometry in lunclíonal inslability of thc ankle and its value in predíding injury. Mcd
Galbuscro., F~ Tomcsc, D.Z., Anasclti, F., Bernlni, S., Volpi, P., L.1 Barbem, L. and Vi!la T., 2013. Does so=r dcat design in!lucncc thc Sei Sporls Excrc. 16(1), pp.6-H\6.
rotalional inleraction wilh thc playing surfacc? Sports Biomcchanks, 12(3), pp.293-301. Tylcr, T.F., McHugh, M.P., Mirnbella, M.R., Mullaney; M.J. and Nicholru;, S./., 2006. Risk foctors for noncontact ankle sprail\9 in high school
Garrett /r., W.E., Rich, F.R., Nikoloou, !':K., Voglcr UI, /.B., 1989. Compuled tomogrnphy of harnstring musdc stmiM. Mcd. Sei. Sports foolball players: the role of previous ankle sprains and body ma5'i indcx. Amerlcan Joumal of Sports Medicine. 34, pp.·171-5.
Exerc. 21, 506-514. van Mechelcn, W., Hlobil, H. and !<cm per, H., 1992. !nddencc, :;cwrit}~ ctiology and P"'Vcntionof sporls injuri<.'S - a "'vicw of cone<."pl•.
Gchring. D., Rott, F., Stap<!lfcldt, B. and Gollhofcr. A., 2007. Effect of SOC«"r shO<! dcats on kne>c joint Ioads. !nt J Sports Mcd, 28(12), Sports Medicine, 14, pp.82-99.
pp.1030-4. Vcrhagcn, E.A., 2013. Cosling an injury prevcntion program in amateur adult soccer. Clin J Sport Med, 23(6), pp.500-1.
Gol!!>chall, J.S., Mi!ls, J. and Hasting~, B., 2013. Integration rorc cxcrciscs clidt grcater rnusde activation than isolation exercises. J Verra!l G.M., Sl,wotinek, ).!'., Bamcs P.G., Fon, G.T. and Es1cnnan, A., 2006. As=sment of phrsical e~amfr1.1tion and rnngnctic ,..,,;onancc
St,..,ngth Cond Res, 27(3), pp.590·6. imaging findings of harnstring iníury as prndictof'J for rccurrent lnjury. j Orthop Sporls Phys Thcr, 36, pp.215-21.
Hãgglund, M., Waldo!n, M. and Ekstrnnd,),, 2006. Prcvious injury ru; a risk faclor for injury in elite foolball: A prospcctiw study ovcr two VerralL G.M., Slavolinck, J.P., Bames, P.G., Fon, G. and Spriggins, A.. 2001. Clinicai risk foctors for harnstring rnusdc straln lnjury: a pros·
conscrutivc sc;1sons. Br J Sports Mcd, 40, pp.767-m. pcctive sludy with cor,..,lation oi injury by masnclic rcsonancc imaging. Br J Sports Med, 35(6), pp.·135--10.
Hiigi;lund, M., Wald<!n, M. and Ekstrand,J., 2013. Ri"k foctors for lowcr cxtremity musde injury in profossional soco:cr: the UEFAlnjury Wagner, D.R. and Hcyward, V.H., 1999, Tcdmiqucs of bod)' composilíon a>ocsomcnt: a rcview of laboratory and fiel d melhods. R"" Q
Study.AmJ Spor!s Med., 41(2), pp.327-35. fu:crc Sport, 70(2), pp.135-49.
Hawkins, ltD. and Fullcr, C.W., 1996. Risk asse-Jsrncnt ln professional foolball: M examinntion of acciden!$ and íncidcnt:; in lhe 1994 Wang, L., Huddleslon, S. and Peng. L., 2003. Psychologica! skill u&c by Chincsc swimrners. lntemalional Sports Joumal, 7, ppAS·55.
World Cup finais. Br jSport Mcd, 30, pp.165-170. W,1tsford. M.L., Murphy; A./., Mclachtan, K.A., Bryant, A.L .. Cameron, M.L.. Crosslcy, K.M. and Makdiwi, M., 2010. A pro,,pcctiw l>ludy
Hawkiru;, R.D. and Fuller, C.W., 1996.Risk asscr.smcnt in profcsr;ional football; an examina1ion of acddenls and incidcnls in the 199·1 ofthe relatiorn;hip betw~""CI\ lowcr body sllfincss and harnstring injury in prolcssional Australi.1n ru!e:; foolballcrs. Arnerican Joumal of
World Cup final,;. Br J Sporl Mcd, 30, pp.165-170. Sport:; Medicine, 38, pp.205S-20M.
Hcndcr;on, G., Bamcs, C.A. and Portas, M.D., 2010. Factorn associated with increascd propcnsity for hamstring injury ln Engll>h P"'mier Wlllcms, T.M., l.\'ltvrouw, E., Ddbacro, K., Mahicu, N., De, B.l. and De, C.O., 2005. lntrinsicrisk foclors forinverslon anklesprairu;in rnale
Leagucr~ccr players.J Sei Med Sport, 13(4), pp.397-\02. oubjects: a pro5pcctive slud;•. Am JSporls Mcd, 33, pp..\15--123.
Hcwllt, T.E., 2000. Ncuromu5cular and honnonal factorn íl!~<odalc'<Í wilh knce injuric5 in fcrnale athletes: slralci;ic5 for intcrvcn1ion. Williams, J.M. and Andcr:wn, M.B., 1998. Psychosodal anlcC<.'dents of sport injury: Review and critique of thc st,..,ss and injury modcl.
Sporl!l Mcd, 29, pp.313-27. )ou mal of Applicd Sport Psychology; 10, pp.5-25.
Hookins, W.T. and Po!!ard, H.P., 2005. Su=•o.sfu! management of hamstring injuries in Australian Ruk>s footba!lcrs: lwo case "'ports. \'lindsor Jru;urancc Brokcm Umitcd, 1997. Inwoligation in1o c.in.'Cr cnding incidents to prof.,.-,,:;ionol footbJllero in England and Waleo,
Chiropraclic& o~tropathy, 13:4. from 1987/88to 1994/95. London:\'lindrnrlnnumnce;.
Hübocher, M. and Rcfohaugc, K.M, 2013. Neuromuscular training stratcgies for prevcntins lowcr !imb injuries: what's new and what ª"' Witvrouw, E., Dannee!s, L., Aosclman, ['., D'havc, T. and Cambicr, D., 2003. Muscle llcxíbility as~ rfr,k foclor fordevcloping mur,clc inju-
thc pmctical irnplications of what wc a!,..,ady know? Br j Sports Mcd, 47, pp.939-9·!0. rics in rnale profcsoional 5occcr playero: A prospcclivc study. Am. ). Sporl!l Mcd., 31(1), pp.41~16.
Hughc~, M.G., Dirdscy, L., Mcyern, R .• Newrombc. D., Oliver,J.L., Smith, P.M., Stcmbridge, M., Stonc, K. and Kcnvin, D.G .. 2013. Effecls Woods, C., Hawklns, R.D., t>follby, S., Huloe, M., Thomas, A. and Hodson, A., 200-t. The Football Association Medical Rcscan:h Pro-
of playing surfacc on physioloi;icol responres and pcrfonnancc variablcs in a ronlrollcd football simulation. J Sports Sei, 31(8), pp.878-86. grilmme: an audit of injuries in profossional footbal! - on.1!ysir,ofharnstrini; injuric>s. Br J Sporls Med, 3.'l(l), pp.36--11.
!brahim, A .. Murrdl, G.A. and Knaprnan, P. 2007. Adduclor slrain and hip range of rno•·cment in male profcssional socccr playcrn. J Wom:ll, T.W., 199·1. Factorn assod,1ted with harrutring injuries. An npproach to trc,1lment and prevenlative mcasu=. Sporls Mcd, 17,
OrthopSurg, 15, pp.46-49. pp.33S-J.t5.
!varnson, A., JohnEon, U., Lindwall. M., Guotafason, H. and 1\ltcmyr, M., 2013. Psychosocial $Ires~ as a prcdktorofinjury in elite junior Yde. J. ~nd Nielscn, A.O., 19~. Sports injuries in adolescmts' bali games: SOro>r, handba11, and bnr.kclball. British Joumal of Sports
socccr: A lalcnt i;rowth curve analysi.~. J Sei Med Sport, pii: Sl.\40-2·\.10(13)00173-8. doi: 10.1016/j.jsamo.2013.10.2·12. !Epub nhcnd of print] Medicine, 24, pp.51-5-1.
Johnson, F.B., Sindair, D.A. and Gual'<.'nlc, L., 1999. Molcrulnr biology of ai;ing. Ccll, 96, pp.291-302. Yeung. S.S., Sucn, A.M. and Ycung, E. W., 2009. A prospectivc cohort study of han1string injuries in rompoti1ívc sprinlcrs: pre~cagon mus-
)unge, A., Chomlak, J. and Dvorak, )., 2000. Incidcm:c of footba!l injuries ln youth players - Comparison oi playcrn frorn two European dc imbalance il5 a po8.liblc risk fo<:tor. Br.J.Sporls Mcd .. ·13, pp.SS9-9.J.
"'gionr.. Amcrican)oumal ofSports Medicine, 28(5), pp.547·50. Z.1nctti, E.M., Bii;nardi, C., Frnnccschini, G. and Audenlno, A.L., 2013, Amatcur football pilches: rnco:hanical propcrlies of thc natuml
Kofotoli5 N. and l<elJis E., 2007. Ankle Sprain Injurie'" A 2· Year Prospcctive Cohort Study in Fcrnale G"'ck Profcs:;ional B<1Sketball Play- ground and oi differnnt arlifidil! turf infill5 and their biomcchanical imp!ications. J Sports Sd, 31{7), pp.i67·7B.
crn. Jouma! oi athlclic training, 42(3), pp.3813-9,l.
L.1nc, A.M., Halt R. and Llmc, /., 200-l. Sclf-efficacy and stalí&tic.; pcrfonnance arnong sport studics otudcnl>. Tcaching in Higher Edu-
cation, 9, pp.435-+l!l..
L.1ucr<,,cn, J.B., Bertcl,;cn, D.M. and Andersen, L.B., 2013. 111c effcctivem.·ss of excrcir.c intcrwntioru; lo preveni sports injuries: a 5ystema-
!ic rcvicw and mcta·analysisof randornfocd controllcd triais. Br J Sports Med, [Epub ahcad of print].
Lcclun, D.T,, !"'land, M.L.. Wi!bon,).D .• Ballantyne, B.T. and Davi.; JM., 2()0.j. Co"' stability mcasuresíl!i risk foclors for lowcrextrcrnity
injury in athlctes. Mcd Sei Sports Exerc, 36(6), pp.926-3-1.
Mcl<ay, G.O., Goldie, P.A., P~yne, W.R. and Q.1kes, B., 2001. Ankle injuries in baskctball: injury rale and risk foctors. Br J Sports Med,
35, pp.lOJ--8.
Mccuwio.•c, W., 1994. Asse-.;sing causation in sport injury: Amullifoctoria! model. Clinj Sport Med., ·l, pp.66--liO.
Mccuwitsc, W.H .. 1991. Prcdictabi!íty of ~porls injuries: What i5 thccpidemiological cvidcnce? Sports Medicine, 12(1). pp.13-15.
Mycr, G.D., Ford, K.R., Paterno, M.V., Nick, T,G. and Hewctt, T.E., 2005. Thc effcct:;of genernlizcdjoint fo~ity on riskof anterior crudate
ligarncnt injury in young fernale alhletcs. Am J Sports Mcd., 36(6), pp.1073-SO.
Myklebust, G., Hachlum, S., Holm, J. and Bahr R., 1998. A proopecllve rohort studyof anterior crudale ligammt injuries in elite Non,·c-
gian tcarn handball. Scand J Mcd Sd Sporls, $, pp.149--S3.
Niclscn, A.B. and Yde, J., 1959. Epidcrniology and trnumatologyof injuric>s in socccr.Arn) Sports Med, 17, pp.803-7.
Orclrnrd, ). and Seward, H., 2002. Epidemioloi;y of injurie>s in thc Australfan Football Lcaguc, scasoru; 1997-2000. Britioh joumal of Sporls
Medicine, 36(1), pp.39-14.
Orchard, J., 1'.far<..dcn, )., Lord, S. and Garlick, D., 1997. P"'season harnstring muscle wcakne55 a,;sociated with harnstring musdc injury
inAustrnlian = r players. Amj Sporls Med, 25, pp.Sl-5.
Owen, A.L., Wong de!, P.• Odiai, A., Paul, D.J., Orhant, E. and Collic, S., 2013. Effect of an injury P"'vcntion progrnm on musclc injuri.,,;
inclitc profcssional $\Jcccr. J Strensth Cond Rcs, 27(12), pp.3275·85.
!'anayí, S., 2010. The nccd for lumbar-peMc aos=ment in the rernlution of chronic hnrnstring str.1in. )ou mal of Body work & Movement
Thcrapies, 14, pp.294-298.
Pelerson, L., Juni;c, A., Chomiak, J., Graf-Baumann, T. and Dvorak, J., 2000. lncidencc oi foolb.11! injuries and compfoints in diffcnmt age
groups and skiU·levc! groups. Arn J SporW Med, 28(suppl 5), pp.551-7.
TESTIMONIALS

"ln the fo11r years 1ve 1vorked together at Club, I got to know Jan to be a true professional,
perhaps the best in Belgiunz in lzis field"- Luc Devroe, former Technical Director at Club
BruggeKV.

''As instructor at lhe Belgian UEFA-Pro license course, Jan 1nade an ilnpression by transla-
ting difficult theoretical fitness-training concepts into plain footballing language and prac-
tical exercise 1naterial. Tllis enabled our UEFA-Pro course participants to acquire the ability
to get tlzeir players physically ready to detiver top-levei football perfonnances" - Bob Bro-
waeys, Director of the Federal Trainers' School.

"Due to, and thanks to, Jan's vision, expertise and professionalisnz, the teanz stood out
tlzrough its fa11tastic general fitness and extre1nely low injury rate." - Adrie Koster,
ex-coach of Ajax Amsterdam and Club Brugge KV

"Duríng his períod as plzysical coach at Club Brugge, Jan Van Winckel proved t/Iat lzis
solid scientific approach leads to strong results. He also gave our club's training approach
a ne1v dimension, supported 11ot by intuition but rather on the basís of physiologícal and
bio111ec11a11ícal criteria." - Dr. M. D'Hooghe, Honorary Chairman of Club Brugge and
Chairman of the FIFA Medical Committee

"Due to, and tlwnks to, Jan's visioll, expertise and professionalisnz, the tea111 stood 011t
through its fantastic general fitness and extrenzely low injury rate." - Adrie Koster,
ex-coach of Ajax Amsterdam and Club Brugge I<V

"l ltave seldo111 seen a coach 1vho can translate scie11ce into practical football application so
well." - Aad de Mos, ex-coach of (among others) Ajax Amsterdam, PSV Eindhoven,
Werder Bremen, RSC Anderlecht

"fall is one of tlle best in his field, probably one of the best in the zvorld." - Carl Hoefkens,
former player of the Belgian national team, West Bromwich Albion and Stoke City

"Jan's 1vork is characterized by professionalism, precision and the systemic use ofmodenz
training principies. His scientific work has had a direct i111pact 011 the success of the club in
recent years." - Prof. Ahmed El-Shafee, general manager of Al-Ahli Saudi Football
Club

You might also like